:: RootR ::  Hosting Order Map Login   Secure Inter-Network Operations  
 
zshall(1) - phpMan

Command: man perldoc info search(apropos)  


ZSHALL(1)                            General Commands Manual                            ZSHALL(1)



NAME
       zshall - the Z shell meta-man page

OVERVIEW
       Because  zsh  contains  many features, the zsh manual has been split into a number of sec‐
       tions.  This manual page includes all the separate manual pages in the following order:

       zshroadmap   Informal introduction to the manual
       zshmisc      Anything not fitting into the other sections
       zshexpn      Zsh command and parameter expansion
       zshparam     Zsh parameters
       zshoptions   Zsh options
       zshbuiltins  Zsh built-in functions
       zshzle       Zsh command line editing
       zshcompwid   Zsh completion widgets
       zshcompsys   Zsh completion system
       zshcompctl   Zsh completion control
       zshmodules   Zsh loadable modules
       zshcalsys    Zsh built-in calendar functions
       zshtcpsys    Zsh built-in TCP functions
       zshzftpsys   Zsh built-in FTP client
       zshcontrib   Additional zsh functions and utilities

DESCRIPTION
       Zsh is a UNIX command interpreter (shell) usable as an interactive login shell  and  as  a
       shell  script  command  processor.  Of the standard shells, zsh most closely resembles ksh
       but includes many enhancements.  Zsh has command line editing,  builtin  spelling  correc‐
       tion, programmable command completion, shell functions (with autoloading), a history mech‐
       anism, and a host of other features.

AUTHOR
       Zsh was originally written by Paul Falstad <pf AT zsh.org>.  Zsh is  now  maintained  by  the
       members  of  the  zsh-workers mailing list <zsh-workers AT zsh.org>.  The development is cur‐
       rently coordinated by Peter Stephenson <pws AT zsh.org>.  The coordinator can be contacted at
       <coordinator AT zsh.org>, but matters relating to the code should generally go to the mailing
       list.

AVAILABILITY
       Zsh is available from the following anonymous FTP sites.  These mirror sites are kept fre‐
       quently  up to date.  The sites marked with (H) may be mirroring ftp.cs.elte.hu instead of
       the primary site.

       Primary site
              ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/
              http://www.zsh.org/pub/

       Australia
              ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/
              http://www.zsh.org/pub/
              http://mirror.dejanseo.com.au/pub/zsh/

       Hungary
              ftp://ftp.cs.elte.hu/pub/zsh/
              http://www.cs.elte.hu/pub/zsh/

       The up-to-date source code is available via anonymous CVS and Git from  Sourceforge.   See
       http://sourceforge.net/projects/zsh/  for  details.  A summary of instructions for the CVS
       and Git archives can be found at http://zsh.sourceforget.net/.

MAILING LISTS
       Zsh has 3 mailing lists:

       <zsh-announce AT zsh.org>
              Announcements about releases, major changes in the shell and the monthly posting of
              the Zsh FAQ.  (moderated)

       <zsh-users AT zsh.org>
              User discussions.

       <zsh-workers AT zsh.org>
              Hacking, development, bug reports and patches.

       To  subscribe  or  unsubscribe, send mail to the associated administrative address for the
       mailing list.

       <zsh-announce-subscribe AT zsh.org>
       <zsh-users-subscribe AT zsh.org>
       <zsh-workers-subscribe AT zsh.org>
       <zsh-announce-unsubscribe AT zsh.org>
       <zsh-users-unsubscribe AT zsh.org>
       <zsh-workers-unsubscribe AT zsh.org>

       YOU ONLY NEED TO JOIN ONE OF THE MAILING LISTS AS THEY ARE  NESTED.   All  submissions  to
       zsh-announce  are  automatically forwarded to zsh-users.  All submissions to zsh-users are
       automatically forwarded to zsh-workers.

       If you have problems subscribing/unsubscribing to any of the mailing lists, send  mail  to
       <listmaster AT zsh.org>.    The   mailing   lists   are   maintained   by   Karsten  Thygesen
       <karthy AT kom.dk>.

       The mailing lists are archived; the  archives  can  be  accessed  via  the  administrative
       addresses  listed  above.   There  is  also  a hypertext archive, maintained by Geoff Wing
       <gcw AT zsh.org>, available at http://www.zsh.org/mla/.

THE ZSH FAQ
       Zsh has a list of  Frequently  Asked  Questions  (FAQ),  maintained  by  Peter  Stephenson
       <pws AT zsh.org>.    It  is  regularly  posted  to  the  newsgroup  comp.unix.shell  and  the
       zsh-announce mailing list.  The latest version can be found at any of the Zsh  FTP  sites,
       or  at  http://www.zsh.org/FAQ/.   The contact address for FAQ-related matters is <faqmas‐
       ter AT zsh.org>.

THE ZSH WEB PAGE
       Zsh has a web page which is located at http://www.zsh.org/.  This is maintained by Karsten
       Thygesen  <karthy AT zsh.org>,  of SunSITE Denmark.  The contact address for web-related mat‐
       ters is <webmaster AT zsh.org>.

THE ZSH USERGUIDE
       A userguide is currently in preparation.  It is intended to complement  the  manual,  with
       explanations  and  hints  on  issues where the manual can be cabbalistic, hierographic, or
       downright mystifying (for example, the word `hierographic' does not  exist).   It  can  be
       viewed in its current state at http://zsh.sourceforge.net/Guide/.  At the time of writing,
       chapters dealing with startup files and their contents and the new completion system  were
       essentially complete.

THE ZSH WIKI
       A  `wiki'  website  for  zsh  has been created at http://www.zshwiki.org/.  This is a site
       which can be added to and modified directly by users without any special permission.   You
       can add your own zsh tips and configurations.

INVOCATION
       The following flags are interpreted by the shell when invoked to determine where the shell
       will read commands from:

       -c     Take the first argument as a command to execute, rather than reading commands  from
              a  script  or standard input.  If any further arguments are given, the first one is
              assigned to $0, rather than being used as a positional parameter.

       -i     Force shell to be interactive.  It is still possible to specify a  script  to  exe‐
              cute.

       -s     Force  shell  to  read  commands  from  the  standard input.  If the -s flag is not
              present and an argument is given, the first argument is taken to be the pathname of
              a script to execute.

       If  there  are any remaining arguments after option processing, and neither of the options
       -c or -s was supplied, the first argument is taken as the file name of a script containing
       shell  commands  to be executed.  If the option PATH_SCRIPT is set, and the file name does
       not contain a directory path (i.e. there is no `/' in the name), first the current  direc‐
       tory and then the command path given by the variable PATH are searched for the script.  If
       the option is not set or the file name contains a `/' it is used directly.

       After the first one or two arguments  have  been  appropriated  as  described  above,  the
       remaining arguments are assigned to the positional parameters.

       For  further  options,  which  are  common  to  invocation and the set builtin, see zshop‐
       tions(1).

       Options may be specified by name using the  -o  option.   -o  acts  like  a  single-letter
       option, but takes a following string as the option name.  For example,

              zsh -x -o shwordsplit scr

       runs  the  script  scr, setting the XTRACE option by the corresponding letter `-x' and the
       SH_WORD_SPLIT option by name.  Options may be turned off by name by using  +o  instead  of
       -o.   -o  can  be  stacked  up  with  preceding single-letter options, so for example `-xo
       shwordsplit' or `-xoshwordsplit' is equivalent to `-x -o shwordsplit'.

       Options may also be specified by name in GNU long  option  style,  `--option-name'.   When
       this  is  done,  `-' characters in the option name are permitted: they are translated into
       `_', and thus ignored.  So, for  example,  `zsh  --sh-word-split'  invokes  zsh  with  the
       SH_WORD_SPLIT  option turned on.  Like other option syntaxes, options can be turned off by
       replacing  the  initial  `-'  with  a  `+';  thus  `+-sh-word-split'  is   equivalent   to
       `--no-sh-word-split'.   Unlike  other  option  syntaxes,  GNU-style long options cannot be
       stacked with any other options, so for example `-x-shwordsplit' is an error,  rather  than
       being treated like `-x --shwordsplit'.

       The  special  GNU-style  option  `--version'  is  handled; it sends to standard output the
       shell's version information, then exits successfully.  `--help' is also handled; it  sends
       to  standard output a list of options that can be used when invoking the shell, then exits
       successfully.

       Option processing may be finished, allowing following arguments that start with `-' or `+'
       to  be treated as normal arguments, in two ways.  Firstly, a lone `-' (or `+') as an argu‐
       ment by itself ends option processing.  Secondly, a special option `--' (or  `+-'),  which
       may  be  specified  on  its own (which is the standard POSIX usage) or may be stacked with
       preceding options (so `-x-' is equivalent to `-x --').  Options are not  permitted  to  be
       stacked  after  `--' (so `-x-f' is an error), but note the GNU-style option form discussed
       above, where `--shwordsplit' is permitted and does not end option processing.

       Except when the sh/ksh emulation single-letter options are in effect, the option `-b'  (or
       `+b')  ends  option  processing.   `-b'  is  like  `--', except that further single-letter
       options can be stacked after the `-b' and will take effect as normal.

COMPATIBILITY
       Zsh tries to emulate sh or ksh when it is invoked as sh or  ksh  respectively;  more  pre‐
       cisely,  it  looks  at the first letter of the name by which it was invoked, excluding any
       initial `r' (assumed to stand for `restricted'), and if that is `b', `s' or  `k'  it  will
       emulate  sh  or ksh.  Furthermore, if invoked as su (which happens on certain systems when
       the shell is executed by the su command), the shell will try to find an  alternative  name
       from the SHELL environment variable and perform emulation based on that.

       In  sh  and  ksh compatibility modes the following parameters are not special and not ini‐
       tialized by the shell: ARGC, argv, cdpath, fignore, fpath, HISTCHARS,  mailpath,  MANPATH,
       manpath, path, prompt, PROMPT, PROMPT2, PROMPT3, PROMPT4, psvar, status, watch.

       The usual zsh startup/shutdown scripts are not executed.  Login shells source /etc/profile
       followed by $HOME/.profile.  If the ENV environment variable is set on invocation, $ENV is
       sourced  after the profile scripts.  The value of ENV is subjected to parameter expansion,
       command substitution, and arithmetic expansion before being  interpreted  as  a  pathname.
       Note that the PRIVILEGED option also affects the execution of startup files.

       The  following  options  are  set  if  the  shell is invoked as sh or ksh: NO_BAD_PATTERN,
       NO_BANG_HIST, NO_BG_NICE, NO_EQUALS,  NO_FUNCTION_ARGZERO,  GLOB_SUBST,  NO_GLOBAL_EXPORT,
       NO_HUP,    INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS,    KSH_ARRAYS,    NO_MULTIOS,    NO_NOMATCH,   NO_NOTIFY,
       POSIX_BUILTINS,    NO_PROMPT_PERCENT,    RM_STAR_SILENT,    SH_FILE_EXPANSION,    SH_GLOB,
       SH_OPTION_LETTERS, SH_WORD_SPLIT.  Additionally the BSD_ECHO and IGNORE_BRACES options are
       set if zsh is invoked as sh.   Also,  the  KSH_OPTION_PRINT,  LOCAL_OPTIONS,  PROMPT_BANG,
       PROMPT_SUBST and SINGLE_LINE_ZLE options are set if zsh is invoked as ksh.

RESTRICTED SHELL
       When the basename of the command used to invoke zsh starts with the letter `r' or the `-r'
       command line option is supplied at invocation, the shell  becomes  restricted.   Emulation
       mode is determined after stripping the letter `r' from the invocation name.  The following
       are disabled in restricted mode:

       ·      changing directories with the cd builtin

       ·      changing or unsetting the PATH, path, MODULE_PATH,  module_path,  SHELL,  HISTFILE,
              HISTSIZE,  GID,  EGID,  UID, EUID, USERNAME, LD_LIBRARY_PATH, LD_AOUT_LIBRARY_PATH,
              LD_PRELOAD and  LD_AOUT_PRELOAD parameters

       ·      specifying command names containing /

       ·      specifying command pathnames using hash

       ·      redirecting output to files

       ·      using the exec builtin command to replace the shell with another command

       ·      using jobs -Z to overwrite the shell process' argument and environment space

       ·      using the ARGV0 parameter to override argv[0] for external commands

       ·      turning off restricted mode with set +r or unsetopt RESTRICTED

       These restrictions are enforced after processing the startup  files.   The  startup  files
       should  set up PATH to point to a directory of commands which can be safely invoked in the
       restricted environment.  They may also add  further  restrictions  by  disabling  selected
       builtins.

       Restricted  mode  can  also  be activated any time by setting the RESTRICTED option.  This
       immediately enables all the restrictions described above even if the shell still  has  not
       processed all startup files.

STARTUP/SHUTDOWN FILES
       Commands  are  first read from /etc/zsh/zshenv; this cannot be overridden.  Subsequent be‐
       haviour is modified by the RCS and GLOBAL_RCS options;  the  former  affects  all  startup
       files,  while  the second only affects global startup files (those shown here with an path
       starting with a /).  If one of the options is unset at any point, any  subsequent  startup
       file(s)  of  the  corresponding  type will not be read.  It is also possible for a file in
       $ZDOTDIR to re-enable GLOBAL_RCS. Both RCS and GLOBAL_RCS are set by default.

       Commands are then read from $ZDOTDIR/.zshenv.  If the shell is a login shell, commands are
       read  from  /etc/zsh/zprofile and then $ZDOTDIR/.zprofile.  Then, if the shell is interac‐
       tive, commands are read from /etc/zsh/zshrc and then  $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc.   Finally,  if  the
       shell is a login shell, /etc/zsh/zlogin and $ZDOTDIR/.zlogin are read.

       When  a login shell exits, the files $ZDOTDIR/.zlogout and then /etc/zsh/zlogout are read.
       This happens with either an explicit exit via the exit or logout commands, or an  implicit
       exit  by  reading  end-of-file from the terminal.  However, if the shell terminates due to
       exec'ing another process, the logout files are not read.  These are also affected  by  the
       RCS  and  GLOBAL_RCS options.  Note also that the RCS option affects the saving of history
       files, i.e. if RCS is unset when the shell exits, no history file will be saved.

       If ZDOTDIR is unset, HOME is used instead.  Files listed above as being in /etc may be  in
       another directory, depending on the installation.

       As  /etc/zsh/zshenv  is  run  for all instances of zsh, it is important that it be kept as
       small as possible.  In particular, it is a good idea to put code that does not need to  be
       run  for  every single shell behind a test of the form `if [[ -o rcs ]]; then ...' so that
       it will not be executed when zsh is invoked with the `-f' option.

       Any of these files may be  pre-compiled  with  the  zcompile  builtin  command  (see  zsh‐
       builtins(1)).  If a compiled file exists (named for the original file plus the .zwc exten‐
       sion) and it is newer than the original file, the compiled file will be used instead.



ZSHROADMAP(1)                        General Commands Manual                        ZSHROADMAP(1)



NAME
       zshroadmap - informal introduction to the zsh  manual  The  Zsh  Manual,  like  the  shell
       itself, is large and often complicated.  This section of the manual provides some pointers
       to areas of the shell that are likely to be of particular interest to new users, and indi‐
       cates where in the rest of the manual the documentation is to be found.

WHEN THE SHELL STARTS
       When  it  starts,  the  shell  reads commands from various files.  These can be created or
       edited to customize the shell.  See the section Startup/Shutdown Files in zsh(1).

       If no personal initialization files exist for the current user, a function is run to  help
       you  change  some  of the most common settings.  It won't appear if your administrator has
       disabled the zsh/newuser module.  The function is designed to  be  self-explanatory.   You
       can  run  it by hand with `autoload -Uz zsh-newuser-install; zsh-newuser-install -f'.  See
       also the section User Configuration Functions in zshcontrib(1).

INTERACTIVE USE
       Interaction with the shell uses the builtin Zsh Line Editor, ZLE.  This  is  described  in
       detail in zshzle(1).

       The  first decision a user must make is whether to use the Emacs or Vi editing mode as the
       keys for editing are substantially different.  Emacs editing mode is probably more natural
       for beginners and can be selected explicitly with the command bindkey -e.

       A history mechanism for retrieving previously typed lines (most simply with the Up or Down
       arrow keys) is available; note that, unlike other shells, zsh will not  save  these  lines
       when the shell exits unless you set appropriate variables, and the number of history lines
       retained by default is quite small (30 lines).  See the description of the shell variables
       (referred  to  in the documentation as parameters) HISTFILE, HISTSIZE and SAVEHIST in zsh‐
       param(1).

       The shell now supports the UTF-8 character set (and also others if supported by the  oper‐
       ating  system).   This  is  (mostly) handled transparently by the shell, but the degree of
       support in terminal emulators is variable.  There is some discussion of this in the  shell
       FAQ,  http://zsh.dotsrc.org/FAQ/ .  Note in particular that for combining characters to be
       handled the option COMBINING_CHARS needs to be set.  Because the shell is now more  sensi‐
       tive  to the definition of the character set, note that if you are upgrading from an older
       version of the shell you should ensure that the  appropriate  variable,  either  LANG  (to
       affect  all  aspects of the shell's operation) or LC_CTYPE (to affect only the handling of
       character sets) is set to an appropriate value.  This is true even if you are using a sin‐
       gle-byte  character  set  including extensions of ASCII such as ISO-8859-1 or ISO-8859-15.
       See the description of LC_CTYPE in zshparam(1).

   Completion
       Completion is a feature present in many shells. It allows the user to  type  only  a  part
       (usually the prefix) of a word and have the shell fill in the rest.  The completion system
       in zsh is programmable.  For example, the shell can be set to complete email addresses  in
       arguments  to  the  mail command from your ~/.abook/addressbook; usernames, hostnames, and
       even remote paths in arguments to scp, and so on.  Anything that  can  be  written  in  or
       glued  together with zsh can be the source of what the line editor offers as possible com‐
       pletions.

       Zsh has two completion systems, an old, so called  compctl  completion  (named  after  the
       builtin  command  that  serves  as  its  complete and only user interface), and a new one,
       referred to as compsys, organized as library of builtin and user-defined  functions.   The
       two  systems  differ  in  their interface for specifying the completion behavior.  The new
       system is more customizable and is supplied with completions for many commonly  used  com‐
       mands; it is therefore to be preferred.

       The completion system must be enabled explicitly when the shell starts.  For more informa‐
       tion see zshcompsys(1).

   Extending the line editor
       Apart from completion, the line editor is highly extensible by means of  shell  functions.
       Some useful functions are provided with the shell; they provide facilities such as:

       insert-composed-char
              composing characters not found on the keyboard

       match-words-by-style
              configuring what the line editor considers a word when moving or deleting by word

       history-beginning-search-backward-end, etc.
              alternative ways of searching the shell history

       replace-string, replace-pattern
              functions for replacing strings or patterns globally in the command line

       edit-command-line
              edit the command line with an external editor.

       See the section `ZLE Functions' in zshcontrib(1) for descriptions of these.

OPTIONS
       The  shell  has  a  large  number  of options for changing its behaviour.  These cover all
       aspects of the shell; browsing the full documentation is  the  only  good  way  to  become
       acquainted with the many possibilities.  See zshoptions(1).

PATTERN MATCHING
       The  shell  has a rich set of patterns which are available for file matching (described in
       the documentation as `filename generation' and also known for historical reasons as `glob‐
       bing') and for use when programming.  These are described in the section `Filename Genera‐
       tion' in zshexpn(1).

       Of particular interest are the following patterns that are not commonly supported by other
       systems of pattern matching:

       **     for matching over multiple directories

       ~, ^   the ability to exclude patterns from matching when the EXTENDED_GLOB option is set

       (...)  glob  qualifiers,  included  in parentheses at the end of the pattern, which select
              files by type (such as directories) or attribute (such as size).

GENERAL COMMENTS ON SYNTAX
       Although the syntax of zsh is in ways similar  to  the  Korn  shell,  and  therefore  more
       remotely  to  the  original  UNIX  shell, the Bourne shell, its default behaviour does not
       entirely correspond to those shells.  General shell syntax is introduced  in  the  section
       `Shell Grammar' in zshmisc(1).

       One  commonly  encountered  difference is that variables substituted onto the command line
       are not split into words.  See the description of the shell option  SH_WORD_SPLIT  in  the
       section  `Parameter  Expansion'  in zshexpn(1).  In zsh, you can either explicitly request
       the splitting (e.g. ${=foo}) or use an array when you want a variable to  expand  to  more
       than one word.  See the section `Array Parameters' in zshparam(1).

PROGRAMMING
       The  most  convenient  way  of  adding enhancements to the shell is typically by writing a
       shell function and arranging for it to be autoloaded.  Functions are described in the sec‐
       tion  `Functions' in zshmisc(1).  Users changing from the C shell and its relatives should
       notice that aliases are less used in zsh as they don't perform argument substitution, only
       simple text replacement.

       A  few  general  functions, other than those for the line editor described above, are pro‐
       vided with the shell and are described in zshcontrib(1).  Features include:

       promptinit
              a prompt theme system for changing prompts easily, see the section `Prompt Themes'


       zsh-mime-setup
              a MIME-handling system which dispatches commands according to the suffix of a  file
              as done by graphical file managers

       zcalc  a calculator

       zargs  a version of xargs that makes the find command redundant

       zmv    a command for renaming files by means of shell patterns.



ZSHMISC(1)                           General Commands Manual                           ZSHMISC(1)



NAME
       zshmisc - everything and then some

SIMPLE COMMANDS & PIPELINES
       A  simple  command is a sequence of optional parameter assignments followed by blank-sepa‐
       rated words, with optional redirections interspersed.  For a  description  of  assignment,
       see the beginning of zshparam(1).

       The  first  word is the command to be executed, and the remaining words, if any, are argu‐
       ments to the command.  If a command name is given, the parameter  assignments  modify  the
       environment of the command when it is executed.  The value of a simple command is its exit
       status, or 128 plus the signal number if terminated by a signal.  For example,

              echo foo

       is a simple command with arguments.

       A pipeline is either a simple command, or a sequence of two or more simple commands  where
       each  command  is separated from the next by `|' or `|&'.  Where commands are separated by
       `|', the standard output of the first command is connected to the standard  input  of  the
       next.   `|&'  is  shorthand  for `2>&1 |', which connects both the standard output and the
       standard error of the command to the standard input of the next.  The value of a  pipeline
       is the value of the last command, unless the pipeline is preceded by `!' in which case the
       value is the logical inverse of the value of the last command.  For example,

              echo foo | sed 's/foo/bar/'

       is a pipeline, where the output (`foo' plus a newline) of the first command will be passed
       to the input of the second.

       If  a  pipeline  is preceded by `coproc', it is executed as a coprocess; a two-way pipe is
       established between it and the parent shell.  The shell can read  from  or  write  to  the
       coprocess  by  means  of  the `>&p' and `<&p' redirection operators or with `print -p' and
       `read -p'.  A pipeline cannot be preceded by both `coproc' and `!'.   If  job  control  is
       active,  the  coprocess can be treated in other than input and output as an ordinary back‐
       ground job.

       A sublist is either a single pipeline, or a sequence of two or more pipelines separated by
       `&&'  or  `||'.   If  two pipelines are separated by `&&', the second pipeline is executed
       only if the first succeeds (returns a zero status).  If two  pipelines  are  separated  by
       `||',  the  second  is  executed only if the first fails (returns a nonzero status).  Both
       operators have equal precedence and are left associative.  The value of the sublist is the
       value of the last pipeline executed.  For example,

              dmesg | grep panic && print yes

       is  a  sublist consisting of two pipelines, the second just a simple command which will be
       executed if and only if the grep command returns a zero status.  If it does not, the value
       of  the sublist is that return status, else it is the status returned by the print (almost
       certainly zero).

       A list is a sequence of zero or more sublists, in which each sublist is terminated by `;',
       `&',  `&|',  `&!',  or a newline.  This terminator may optionally be omitted from the last
       sublist in the list when the list appears as a complex command inside `(...)' or  `{...}'.
       When  a  sublist  is terminated by `;' or newline, the shell waits for it to finish before
       executing the next sublist.  If a sublist is terminated by a `&', `&|', or `&!', the shell
       executes  the  last  pipeline  in it in the background, and does not wait for it to finish
       (note the difference from other shells which execute the whole sublist in the background).
       A backgrounded pipeline returns a status of zero.

       More  generally,  a  list can be seen as a set of any shell commands whatsoever, including
       the complex commands below; this is implied wherever the  word  `list'  appears  in  later
       descriptions.  For example, the commands in a shell function form a special sort of list.

PRECOMMAND MODIFIERS
       A  simple  command may be preceded by a precommand modifier, which will alter how the com‐
       mand is interpreted.  These modifiers are shell builtin commands  with  the  exception  of
       nocorrect which is a reserved word.

       -      The command is executed with a `-' prepended to its argv[0] string.

       builtin
              The  command word is taken to be the name of a builtin command, rather than a shell
              function or external command.

       command [ -pvV ]
              The command word is taken to be the name of an  external  command,  rather  than  a
              shell  function  or  builtin.    If the POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, builtins will
              also be executed but certain special properties of them are suppressed. The -p flag
              causes  a  default  path to be searched instead of that in $path. With the -v flag,
              command is similar to whence and with -V, it is equivalent to whence -v.

       exec [ -cl ] [ -a argv0 ]
              The following command together with any arguments is run in place  of  the  current
              process,  rather  than  as a sub-process.  The shell does not fork and is replaced.
              The shell does not invoke TRAPEXIT, nor does it source zlogout files.  The  options
              are provided for compatibility with other shells.

              The -c option clears the environment.

              The  -l option is equivalent to the - precommand modifier, to treat the replacement
              command as a login shell; the command is executed with a - prepended to its argv[0]
              string.  This flag has no effect if used together with the -a option.

              The  -a  option  is  used to specify explicitly the argv[0] string (the name of the
              command as seen by the process itself) to be used by the replacement command and is
              directly equivalent to setting a value for the ARGV0 environment variable.

       nocorrect
              Spelling  correction  is not done on any of the words.  This must appear before any
              other precommand modifier, as it is interpreted immediately, before any parsing  is
              done.  It has no effect in non-interactive shells.

       noglob Filename generation (globbing) is not performed on any of the words.

COMPLEX COMMANDS
       A complex command in zsh is one of the following:

       if list then list [ elif list then list ] ... [ else list ] fi
              The  if  list  is  executed, and if it returns a zero exit status, the then list is
              executed.  Otherwise, the elif list is executed and if its status is zero, the then
              list  is executed.  If each elif list returns nonzero status, the else list is exe‐
              cuted.

       for name ... [ in word ... ] term do list done
              where term is at least one newline or ;.  Expand the list of  words,  and  set  the
              parameter  name  to each of them in turn, executing list each time.  If the in word
              is omitted, use the positional parameters instead of the words.

              More than one parameter name can appear before the list of words.  If N  names  are
              given, then on each execution of the loop the next N words are assigned to the cor‐
              responding parameters.  If there are more names than remaining words, the remaining
              parameters are each set to the empty string.  Execution of the loop ends when there
              is no remaining word to assign to the first name.  It is only possible  for  in  to
              appear as the first name in the list, else it will be treated as marking the end of
              the list.

       for (( [expr1] ; [expr2] ; [expr3] )) do list done
              The arithmetic expression expr1 is evaluated first  (see  the  section  `Arithmetic
              Evaluation').   The  arithmetic  expression  expr2 is repeatedly evaluated until it
              evaluates to zero and when non-zero, list is executed and the arithmetic expression
              expr3  evaluated.  If any expression is omitted, then it behaves as if it evaluated
              to 1.

       while list do list done
              Execute the do list as long as the while list returns a zero exit status.

       until list do list done
              Execute the do list as long as until list returns a nonzero exit status.

       repeat word do list done
              word is expanded and treated as an arithmetic expression, which must evaluate to  a
              number n.  list is then executed n times.

              The  repeat syntax is disabled by default when the shell starts in a mode emulating
              another shell.  It can be enabled with the command `enable -r repeat'

       case word in [ [(] pattern [ | pattern ] ... ) list (;;|;&|;|) ] ... esac
              Execute the list associated with the first pattern that matches word, if any.   The
              form  of  the  patterns  is the same as that used for filename generation.  See the
              section `Filename Generation'.

              If the list that is executed is terminated with ;& rather than  ;;,  the  following
              list is also executed.  The rule for the terminator of the following list ;;, ;& or
              ;| is applied unless the esac is reached.

              If the list that is executed is terminated with ;| the shell continues to scan  the
              patterns looking for the next match, executing the corresponding list, and applying
              the rule for the corresponding terminator ;;, ;& or ;|.   Note  that  word  is  not
              re-expanded; all applicable patterns are tested with the same word.

       select name [ in word ... term ] do list done
              where  term  is  one or more newline or ; to terminate the words.  Print the set of
              words, each preceded by a number.  If the in word is omitted,  use  the  positional
              parameters.   The PROMPT3 prompt is printed and a line is read from the line editor
              if the shell is interactive and that is active, or else standard  input.   If  this
              line  consists of the number of one of the listed words, then the parameter name is
              set to the word corresponding to this number.  If this line is empty, the selection
              list  is printed again.  Otherwise, the value of the parameter name is set to null.
              The contents of the line read from standard input is saved in the parameter  REPLY.
              list is executed for each selection until a break or end-of-file is encountered.

       ( list )
              Execute  list  in  a  subshell.   Traps  set by the trap builtin are reset to their
              default values while executing list.

       { list }
              Execute list.

       { try-list } always { always-list }
              First execute try-list.  Regardless of errors, or break, continue, or  return  com‐
              mands  encountered  within try-list, execute always-list.  Execution then continues
              from the result of the execution of try-list; in other words, any error, or  break,
              continue,  or  return  command is treated in the normal way, as if always-list were
              not present.  The two chunks of code are referred to as the  `try  block'  and  the
              `always block'.

              Optional  newlines  or  semicolons may appear after the always; note, however, that
              they may not appear between the preceding closing brace and the always.

              An `error' in this context is a condition such as a syntax error which  causes  the
              shell  to  abort execution of the current function, script, or list.  Syntax errors
              encountered while the shell is parsing the code do not cause the always-list to  be
              executed.  For example, an erroneously constructed if block in try-list would cause
              the shell to abort during parsing, so that always-list would not be executed, while
              an  erroneous  substitution  such  as  ${*foo*} would cause a run-time error, after
              which always-list would be executed.

              An error condition can be tested  and  reset  with  the  special  integer  variable
              TRY_BLOCK_ERROR.   Outside  an  always-list the value is irrelevant, but it is ini‐
              tialised to -1.  Inside always-list, the value is 1 if an  error  occurred  in  the
              try-list, else 0.  If TRY_BLOCK_ERROR is set to 0 during the always-list, the error
              condition caused by the try-list is reset, and shell execution  continues  normally
              after the end of always-list.  Altering the value during the try-list is not useful
              (unless this forms part of an enclosing always block).

              Regardless of TRY_BLOCK_ERROR, after the end of always-list the normal shell status
              $?  is  the  value  returned  from try-list.  This will be non-zero if there was an
              error, even if TRY_BLOCK_ERROR was set to zero.

              The following executes the given code, ignoring any errors it causes.  This  is  an
              alternative  to  the  usual convention of protecting code by executing it in a sub‐
              shell.

                     {
                         # code which may cause an error
                       } always {
                         # This code is executed regardless of the error.
                         (( TRY_BLOCK_ERROR = 0 ))
                     }
                     # The error condition has been reset.

              An exit command (or a return command executed at the outermost function level of  a
              script)  encountered  in  try-list  does  not  cause  the execution of always-list.
              Instead, the shell exits immediately after any EXIT trap has been executed.

       function word ... [ () ] [ term ] { list }
       word ... () [ term ] { list }
       word ... () [ term ] command
              where term is one or more newline or ;.  Define a function which is  referenced  by
              any  one  of word.  Normally, only one word is provided; multiple words are usually
              only useful for setting traps.  The body of the function is the list between the  {
              and }.  See the section `Functions'.

              If  the  option SH_GLOB is set for compatibility with other shells, then whitespace
              may appear between between the left and right parentheses when there  is  a  single
              word;   otherwise, the parentheses will be treated as forming a globbing pattern in
              that case.

              In any of the forms above, a redirection may appear outside the function body,  for
              example

                     func() { ... } 2>&1

              The  redirection  is  stored with the function and applied whenever the function is
              executed.  Any variables in the redirection are expanded at the point the  function
              is executed, but outside the function scope.

       time [ pipeline ]
              The  pipeline is executed, and timing statistics are reported on the standard error
              in the form specified by the TIMEFMT parameter.  If pipeline is omitted, print sta‐
              tistics about the shell process and its children.

       [[ exp ]]
              Evaluates  the  conditional  expression  exp and return a zero exit status if it is
              true.  See the section `Conditional Expressions' for a description of exp.

ALTERNATE FORMS FOR COMPLEX COMMANDS
       Many of zsh's complex commands have alternate  forms.   These  are  non-standard  and  are
       likely  not to be obvious even to seasoned shell programmers; they should not be used any‐
       where that portability of shell code is a concern.

       The short versions below only work if sublist is  of  the  form  `{  list  }'  or  if  the
       SHORT_LOOPS  option is set.  For the if, while and until commands, in both these cases the
       test part of the loop must also be suitably delimited, such as by `[[ ... ]]' or  `((  ...
       ))',  else  the  end  of  the  test will not be recognized.  For the for, repeat, case and
       select commands no such special form for the arguments is necessary, but the other  condi‐
       tion (the special form of sublist or use of the SHORT_LOOPS option) still applies.

       if list { list } [ elif list { list } ] ... [ else { list } ]
              An alternate form of if.  The rules mean that

                     if [[ -o ignorebraces ]] {
                       print yes
                     }

              works, but

                     if true {  # Does not work!
                       print yes
                     }

              does not, since the test is not suitably delimited.

       if list sublist
              A short form of the alternate `if'.  The same limitations on the form of list apply
              as for the previous form.

       for name ... ( word ... ) sublist
              A short form of for.

       for name ... [ in word ... ] term sublist
              where term is at least one newline or ;.  Another short form of for.

       for (( [expr1] ; [expr2] ; [expr3] )) sublist
              A short form of the arithmetic for command.

       foreach name ... ( word ... ) list end
              Another form of for.

       while list { list }
              An alternative form of while.  Note the limitations on the form of  list  mentioned
              above.

       until list { list }
              An  alternative  form of until.  Note the limitations on the form of list mentioned
              above.

       repeat word sublist
              This is a short form of repeat.

       case word { [ [(] pattern [ | pattern ] ... ) list (;;|;&|;|) ] ... }
              An alternative form of case.

       select name [ in word term ] sublist
              where term is at least one newline or ;.  A short form of select.

RESERVED WORDS
       The following words are recognized as reserved words when used as the first word of a com‐
       mand unless quoted or disabled using disable -r:

       do  done esac then elif else fi for case if while function repeat time until select coproc
       nocorrect foreach end ! [[ { }

       Additionally, `}' is recognized in any position if neither the  IGNORE_BRACES  option  nor
       the IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES option is set.

ERRORS
       Certain errors are treated as fatal by the shell: in an interactive shell, they cause con‐
       trol to return to the command line, and in a non-interactive shell they cause the shell to
       be  aborted.  In older versions of zsh, a non-interactive shell running a script would not
       abort completely, but would resume execution at the next  command  to  be  read  from  the
       script,  skipping the remainder of any functions or shell constructs such as loops or con‐
       ditions; this somewhat illogical behaviour can be recovered by  setting  the  option  CON‐
       TINUE_ON_ERROR.

       Fatal errors found in non-interactive shells include:

       ·      Failure to parse shell options passed when invoking the shell

       ·      Failure to change options with the set builtin

       ·      Parse errors of all sorts, including failures to parse mathematical expressions

       ·      Failures  to set or modify variable behaviour with typeset, local, declare, export,
              integer, float

       ·      Execution of incorrectly positioned loop control structures (continue, break)

       ·      Attempts to use regular expression with no regular expression module available

       ·      Disallowed operations when the RESTRICTED options is set

       ·      Failure to create a pipe needed for a pipeline

       ·      Failure to create a multio

       ·      Failure to autoload a module needed for a declared shell feature

       ·      Errors creating command or process substitutions

       ·      Syntax errors in glob qualifiers

       ·      File generation errors where not caught by the option BAD_PATTERN

       ·      All bad patterns used for matching within case statements

       ·      File generation failures where not caused by NO_MATCH or similar options

       ·      All file generation errors where the pattern was used to create a multio

       ·      Memory errors where detected by the shell

       ·      Invalid subscripts to shell variables

       ·      Attempts to assign read-only variables

       ·      Logical errors with variables such as assignment to the wrong type

       ·      Use of invalid variable names

       ·      Errors in variable substitution syntax

       ·      Failure to convert characters in $'...' expressions

       If the POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, more errors associated with  shell  builtin  commands
       are treated as fatal, as specified by the POSIX standard.

COMMENTS
       In  non-interactive  shells, or in interactive shells with the INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS option
       set, a word beginning with the third character of the histchars parameter (`#' by default)
       causes that word and all the following characters up to a newline to be ignored.

ALIASING
       Every  token in the shell input is checked to see if there is an alias defined for it.  If
       so, it is replaced by the text of the alias if it is in command position (if it  could  be
       the  first  word of a simple command), or if the alias is global.  If the text ends with a
       space, the next word in the shell input is treated as though it were in  command  position
       for  purposes  of  alias  expansion.   An alias is defined using the alias builtin; global
       aliases may be defined using the -g option to that builtin.

       Alias expansion is done on the shell input  before  any  other  expansion  except  history
       expansion.   Therefore,  if  an  alias is defined for the word foo, alias expansion may be
       avoided by quoting part of the word, e.g. \foo.  Any form of quoting works, although there
       is  nothing  to  prevent  an alias being defined for the quoted form such as \foo as well.
       For use with completion, which would remove an initial backslash followed by  a  character
       that  isn't special, it may be more convenient to quote the word by starting with a single
       quote, i.e. 'foo; completion will automatically add the trailing single quote.

       There is a commonly encountered problem with aliases illustrated by the following code:

              alias echobar='echo bar'; echobar

       This prints a message that the command echobar could not be found.  This  happens  because
       aliases  are expanded when the code is read in; the entire line is read in one go, so that
       when echobar is executed it is too late to expand the newly defined alias.  This is  often
       a  problem  in  shell  scripts, functions, and code executed with `source' or `.'.  Conse‐
       quently, use of functions rather than aliases is recommended in non-interactive code.

       Note also the unhelpful interaction of aliases and function definitions:

              alias func='noglob func'
              func() {
                  echo Do something with $*
              }

       Because aliases are expanded in function definitions, this causes the following command to
       be executed:

              noglob func() {
                  echo Do something with $*
              }

       which  defines  noglob  as  well as func as functions with the body given.  To avoid this,
       either quote the name func or use  the  alternative  function  definition  form  `function
       func'.   Ensuring  the alias is defined after the function works but is problematic if the
       code fragment might be re-executed.

QUOTING
       A character may be quoted (that is, made to stand for itself) by preceding it with a  `\'.
       `\' followed by a newline is ignored.

       A  string  enclosed between `$'' and `'' is processed the same way as the string arguments
       of the print builtin, and the resulting string is considered to  be  entirely  quoted.   A
       literal `'' character can be included in the string by using the `\'' escape.

       All characters enclosed between a pair of single quotes ('') that is not preceded by a `$'
       are quoted.  A single quote cannot appear within single quotes unless the option RC_QUOTES
       is  set,  in which case a pair of single quotes are turned into a single quote.  For exam‐
       ple,

              print ''''

       outputs nothing apart from a newline if RC_QUOTES is not set, but one single quote  if  it
       is set.

       Inside  double  quotes  (""), parameter and command substitution occur, and `\' quotes the
       characters `\', ``', `"', and `$'.

REDIRECTION
       If a command is followed by & and job control is not active,  then  the  default  standard
       input  for  the  command  is the empty file /dev/null.  Otherwise, the environment for the
       execution of a command contains the file descriptors of the invoking shell as modified  by
       input/output specifications.

       The  following  may appear anywhere in a simple command or may precede or follow a complex
       command.  Expansion occurs before word or digit is used except as  noted  below.   If  the
       result  of  substitution  on  word produces more than one filename, redirection occurs for
       each separate filename in turn.

       < word Open file word for reading as standard input.

       <> word
              Open file word for reading and writing as standard input.  If  the  file  does  not
              exist then it is created.

       > word Open  file word for writing as standard output.  If the file does not exist then it
              is created.  If the file exists, and the CLOBBER option is unset,  this  causes  an
              error; otherwise, it is truncated to zero length.

       >| word
       >! word
              Same  as  >, except that the file is truncated to zero length if it exists, even if
              CLOBBER is unset.

       >> word
              Open file word for writing in append mode as standard output.  If the file does not
              exist,  and  the CLOBBER option is unset, this causes an error; otherwise, the file
              is created.

       >>| word
       >>! word
              Same as >>, except that the file is created if it does not exist, even  if  CLOBBER
              is unset.

       <<[-] word
              The  shell  input  is  read  up  to  a  line  that  is  the  same as word, or to an
              end-of-file.  No parameter expansion, command substitution or  filename  generation
              is  performed on word.  The resulting document, called a here-document, becomes the
              standard input.

              If any character of word is quoted with single or double quotes or a `\', no inter‐
              pretation  is placed upon the characters of the document.  Otherwise, parameter and
              command substitution occurs, `\' followed by a newline is removed, and `\' must  be
              used to quote the characters `\', `$', ``' and the first character of word.

              Note  that word itself does not undergo shell expansion.  Backquotes in word do not
              have their usual effect; instead they behave similarly  to  double  quotes,  except
              that  the backquotes themselves are passed through unchanged.  (This information is
              given for completeness and it is not recommended that backquotes be used.)   Quotes
              in  the  form $'...' have their standard effect of expanding backslashed references
              to special characters.

              If <<- is used, then all leading tabs are stripped from word and from the document.

       <<< word
              Perform shell expansion on word and pass the result to  standard  input.   This  is
              known  as  a  here-string.   Compare the use of word in here-documents above, where
              word does not undergo shell expansion.

       <& number
       >& number
              The standard input/output is duplicated from file descriptor number (see dup2(2)).

       <& -
       >& -   Close the standard input/output.

       <& p
       >& p   The input/output from/to the coprocess is moved to the standard input/output.

       >& word
       &> word
              (Except where `>& word' matches one of the above syntaxes; `&>' can always be  used
              to  avoid this ambiguity.)  Redirects both standard output and standard error (file
              descriptor 2) in the manner of `> word'.  Note that this does  not  have  the  same
              effect as `> word 2>&1' in the presence of multios (see the section below).

       >&| word
       >&! word
       &>| word
       &>! word
              Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descriptor 2) in the manner
              of `>| word'.

       >>& word
       &>> word
              Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descriptor 2) in the manner
              of `>> word'.

       >>&| word
       >>&! word
       &>>| word
       &>>! word
              Redirects both standard output and standard error (file descriptor 2) in the manner
              of `>>| word'.

       If one of the above is preceded by a digit, then the file descriptor referred to  is  that
       specified by the digit instead of the default 0 or 1.  The order in which redirections are
       specified is significant.  The shell evaluates each redirection  in  terms  of  the  (file
       descriptor, file) association at the time of evaluation.  For example:

              ... 1>fname 2>&1

       first  associates file descriptor 1 with file fname.  It then associates file descriptor 2
       with the file associated with file descriptor 1 (that is, fname).  If the order  of  redi‐
       rections  were reversed, file descriptor 2 would be associated with the terminal (assuming
       file descriptor 1 had been) and then file descriptor  1  would  be  associated  with  file
       fname.

       The  `|&'  command  separator  described in Simple Commands & Pipelines in zshmisc(1) is a
       shorthand for `2>&1 |'.

       The various forms of process  substitution,  `<(list)',  and  `=(list())'  for  input  and
       `>(list)'  for  output, are often used together with redirection.  For example, if word in
       an output redirection is of the form `>(list)' then the output is  piped  to  the  command
       represented by list.  See Process Substitution in zshexpn(1).

OPENING FILE DESCRIPTORS USING PARAMETERS
       When  the  shell  is parsing arguments to a command, and the shell option IGNORE_BRACES is
       not set, a different form of redirection is allowed: instead of a digit before the  opera‐
       tor  there is a valid shell identifier enclosed in braces.  The shell will open a new file
       descriptor that is guaranteed to be at least 10 and set the parameter named by the identi‐
       fier  to  the  file descriptor opened.  No whitespace is allowed between the closing brace
       and the redirection character.  For example:

              ... {myfd}>&1

       This opens a new file descriptor that is a duplicate of file descriptor  1  and  sets  the
       parameter  myfd  to the number of the file descriptor, which will be at least 10.  The new
       file descriptor can be written to using the syntax >&$myfd.

       The syntax {varid}>&-, for example {myfd}>&-, may be  used  to  close  a  file  descriptor
       opened  in this fashion.  Note that the parameter given by varid must previously be set to
       a file descriptor in this case.

       It is an error to open or close a file descriptor in this fashion when  the  parameter  is
       readonly.   However,  it is not an error to read or write a file descriptor using <&$param
       or >&$param if param is readonly.

       If the option CLOBBER is unset, it is an error to open a file descriptor using a parameter
       that  is  already  set  to an open file descriptor previously allocated by this mechanism.
       Unsetting the parameter before using it for allocating a file descriptor avoids the error.

       Note that this mechanism merely allocates or closes a file descriptor; it does not perform
       any  redirections  from  or to it.  It is usually convenient to allocate a file descriptor
       prior to use as an argument to exec.  The syntax does not  in  any  case  work  when  used
       around  complex commands such as parenthesised subshells or loops, where the opening brace
       is interpreted as part of a command list to be executed in the current shell.

       The following shows a typical sequence of allocation, use, and closing of a file  descrip‐
       tor:

              integer myfd
              exec {myfd}>~/logs/mylogfile.txt
              print This is a log message. >&$myfd
              exec {myfd}>&-

       Note  that the expansion of the variable in the expression >&$myfd occurs at the point the
       redirection is opened.  This is after the expansion of command  arguments  and  after  any
       redirections to the left on the command line have been processed.

MULTIOS
       If  the  user  tries to open a file descriptor for writing more than once, the shell opens
       the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that copies its input to all the specified out‐
       puts, similar to tee, provided the MULTIOS option is set, as it is by default.  Thus:

              date >foo >bar

       writes  the date to two files, named `foo' and `bar'.  Note that a pipe is an implicit re‐
       direction; thus

              date >foo | cat

       writes the date to the file `foo', and also pipes it to cat.

       If the MULTIOS option is set, the word after a redirection operator is also  subjected  to
       filename generation (globbing).  Thus

              : > *

       will truncate all files in the current directory, assuming there's at least one.  (Without
       the MULTIOS option, it would create an empty file called `*'.)  Similarly, you can do

              echo exit 0 >> *.sh

       If the user tries to open a file descriptor for reading more than once,  the  shell  opens
       the  file  descriptor  as  a pipe to a process that copies all the specified inputs to its
       output in the order specified, similar to cat, provided the MULTIOS option is set.  Thus

              sort <foo <fubar

       or even

              sort <f{oo,ubar}

       is equivalent to `cat foo fubar | sort'.

       Expansion of the redirection argument occurs at the point the redirection  is  opened,  at
       the point described above for the expansion of the variable in >&$myfd.

       Note that a pipe is an implicit redirection; thus

              cat bar | sort <foo

       is equivalent to `cat bar foo | sort' (note the order of the inputs).

       If  the  MULTIOS  option  is unset, each redirection replaces the previous redirection for
       that file descriptor.  However, all files redirected to are actually opened, so

              echo foo > bar > baz

       when MULTIOS is unset will truncate bar, and write `foo' into baz.

       There is a problem when an output multio is attached to an  external  program.   A  simple
       example shows this:

              cat file >file1 >file2
              cat file1 file2

       Here, it is possible that the second `cat' will not display the full contents of file1 and
       file2 (i.e. the original contents of file repeated twice).

       The reason for this is that the multios are spawned after the cat process is  forked  from
       the  parent  shell,  so  the  parent shell does not wait for the multios to finish writing
       data.  This means the command as shown can exit before  file1  and  file2  are  completely
       written.   As  a workaround, it is possible to run the cat process as part of a job in the
       current shell:

              { cat file } >file >file2

       Here, the {...} job will pause to wait for both files to be written.

REDIRECTIONS WITH NO COMMAND
       When a simple command consists of one or more  redirection  operators  and  zero  or  more
       parameter assignments, but no command name, zsh can behave in several ways.

       If  the parameter NULLCMD is not set or the option CSH_NULLCMD is set, an error is caused.
       This is the csh behavior and CSH_NULLCMD is set by default when emulating csh.

       If the option SH_NULLCMD is set, the builtin `:' is inserted as a command with  the  given
       redirections.  This is the default when emulating sh or ksh.

       Otherwise,  if  the parameter NULLCMD is set, its value will be used as a command with the
       given redirections.  If both NULLCMD and READNULLCMD are set, then the value of the latter
       will  be used instead of that of the former when the redirection is an input.  The default
       for NULLCMD is `cat' and for READNULLCMD is `more'. Thus

              < file

       shows the contents of file on standard output, with paging if that is a terminal.  NULLCMD
       and READNULLCMD may refer to shell functions.

COMMAND EXECUTION
       If a command name contains no slashes, the shell attempts to locate it.  If there exists a
       shell function by that name, the function is invoked as described in  the  section  `Func‐
       tions'.  If there exists a shell builtin by that name, the builtin is invoked.

       Otherwise,  the  shell  searches  each element of $path for a directory containing an exe‐
       cutable file by that name.  If the search is unsuccessful, the shell prints an error  mes‐
       sage and returns a nonzero exit status.

       If  execution  fails  because  the file is not in executable format, and the file is not a
       directory, it is assumed to be a shell script.  /bin/sh is spawned to execute it.  If  the
       program is a file beginning with `#!', the remainder of the first line specifies an inter‐
       preter for the program.  The shell will execute the  specified  interpreter  on  operating
       systems that do not handle this executable format in the kernel.

       If  no external command is found but a function command_not_found_handler exists the shell
       executes this function with all command line arguments.  The function should return status
       zero if it successfully handled the command, or non-zero status if it failed.  In the lat‐
       ter case the standard handling is applied: `command not  found'  is  printed  to  standard
       error  and  the  shell exits with status 127.  Note that the handler is executed in a sub‐
       shell forked to execute an external command, hence changes to directories,  shell  parame‐
       ters, etc. have no effect on the main shell.

FUNCTIONS
       Shell  functions  are defined with the function reserved word or the special syntax `func‐
       name ()'.  Shell functions are read in and stored internally.  Alias  names  are  resolved
       when the function is read.  Functions are executed like commands with the arguments passed
       as positional parameters.  (See the section `Command Execution'.)

       Functions execute in the same process as the caller and share all files and present  work‐
       ing directory with the caller.  A trap on EXIT set inside a function is executed after the
       function completes in the environment of the caller.

       The return builtin is used to return from function calls.

       Function identifiers can be listed with the functions builtin.  Functions can be undefined
       with the unfunction builtin.

AUTOLOADING FUNCTIONS
       A  function  can  be  marked as undefined using the autoload builtin (or `functions -u' or
       `typeset -fu').  Such a function has no body.  When the function is  first  executed,  the
       shell  searches  for  its  definition  using  the elements of the fpath variable.  Thus to
       define functions for autoloading, a typical sequence is:

              fpath=(~/myfuncs $fpath)
              autoload myfunc1 myfunc2 ...

       The usual alias expansion during reading will be suppressed if the autoload builtin or its
       equivalent  is  given the option -U. This is recommended for the use of functions supplied
       with the zsh distribution.  Note that for functions precompiled with the zcompile  builtin
       command  the  flag -U must be provided when the .zwc file is created, as the corresponding
       information is compiled into the latter.

       For each element in fpath, the shell looks for three possible files, the newest  of  which
       is used to load the definition for the function:

       element.zwc
              A  file created with the zcompile builtin command, which is expected to contain the
              definitions for all functions in the directory named element.  The file is  treated
              in  the  same  manner as a directory containing files for functions and is searched
              for the definition of the function.   If the definition is not  found,  the  search
              for a definition proceeds with the other two possibilities described below.

              If  element  already  includes  a .zwc extension (i.e. the extension was explicitly
              given by the user), element is searched for the definition of the function  without
              comparing  its  age  to that of other files; in fact, there does not need to be any
              directory named element without the suffix.  Thus  including  an  element  such  as
              `/usr/local/funcs.zwc'  in  fpath  will speed up the search for functions, with the
              disadvantage that functions included must be explicitly recompiled by  hand  before
              the shell notices any changes.

       element/function.zwc
              A file created with zcompile, which is expected to contain the definition for func‐
              tion.  It may include other function definitions as well,  but  those  are  neither
              loaded  nor  executed; a file found in this way is searched only for the definition
              of function.

       element/function
              A file of zsh command text, taken to be the definition for function.

       In summary, the order of searching is, first, in the parents of directories in  fpath  for
       the newer of either a compiled directory or a directory in fpath; second, if more than one
       of these contains a definition for the function that is sought, the leftmost in the  fpath
       is  chosen;  and  third, within a directory, the newer of either a compiled function or an
       ordinary function definition is used.

       If the KSH_AUTOLOAD option is set, or the file contains only a simple  definition  of  the
       function, the file's contents will be executed.  This will normally define the function in
       question, but may also perform initialization, which is executed in  the  context  of  the
       function  execution,  and  may  therefore  define local parameters.  It is an error if the
       function is not defined by loading the file.

       Otherwise, the function body (with no surrounding `funcname() {...}') is taken to  be  the
       complete  contents  of the file.  This form allows the file to be used directly as an exe‐
       cutable shell script.  If processing of the file results in the function being re-defined,
       the  function itself is not re-executed.  To force the shell to perform initialization and
       then call the function defined, the file should contain initialization code (which will be
       executed  then  discarded)  in  addition  to a complete function definition (which will be
       retained for subsequent calls to the function), and a call to the shell function,  includ‐
       ing any arguments, at the end.

       For example, suppose the autoload file func contains

              func() { print This is func; }
              print func is initialized

       then  `func; func' with KSH_AUTOLOAD set will produce both messages on the first call, but
       only the message `This is func' on the second and subsequent calls.  Without  KSH_AUTOLOAD
       set,  it  will produce the initialization message on the first call, and the other message
       on the second and subsequent calls.

       It is also possible to create a function that is not marked as autoloaded, but which loads
       its  own  definition  by  searching fpath, by using `autoload -X' within a shell function.
       For example, the following are equivalent:

              myfunc() {
                autoload -X
              }
              myfunc args...

       and

              unfunction myfunc   # if myfunc was defined
              autoload myfunc
              myfunc args...

       In fact, the functions command outputs `builtin autoload -X' as the body of an  autoloaded
       function.  This is done so that

              eval "$(functions)"

       produces  a  reasonable result.  A true autoloaded function can be identified by the pres‐
       ence of the comment `# undefined' in the body, because all  comments  are  discarded  from
       defined functions.

       To load the definition of an autoloaded function myfunc without executing myfunc, use:

              autoload +X myfunc

ANONYMOUS FUNCTIONS
       If  no  name  is given for a function, it is `anonymous' and is handled specially.  Either
       form of function definition may be used: a `()' with no preceding name,  or  a  `function'
       with  an  immediately  following  open brace.  The function is executed immediately at the
       point of definition and is not stored for  future  use.   The  function  name  is  set  to
       `(anon)'.

       Arguments  to  the function may be specified as words following the closing brace defining
       the function, hence if there are none no arguments (other than $0) are  set.   This  is  a
       difference  from  the  way  other functions are parsed: normal function definitions may be
       followed by certain keywords such as `else' or `fi', which will be treated as arguments to
       anonymous functions, so that a newline or semicolon is needed to force keyword interpreta‐
       tion.

       Note also that the argument list of any enclosing script or function is hidden  (as  would
       be the case for any other function called at this point).

       Redirections  may  be  applied  to  the anonymous function in the same manner as to a cur‐
       rent-shell structure enclosed in braces.  The main use of anonymous functions is  to  pro‐
       vide  a  scope  for local variables.  This is particularly convenient in start-up files as
       these do not provide their own local variable scope.

       For example,

              variable=outside
              function {
                local variable=inside
                print "I am $variable with arguments $*"
              } this and that
              print "I am $variable"

       outputs the following:

              I am inside with arguments this and that
              I am outside

       Note that function definitions with arguments that expand to nothing, for example  `name=;
       function  $name  {  ...  }',  are  not  treated as anonymous functions.  Instead, they are
       treated as normal function definitions where the definition is silently discarded.

SPECIAL FUNCTIONS
       Certain functions, if defined, have special meaning to the shell.

   Hook Functions
       For the functions below, it is possible to define an array that has the same name  as  the
       function with `_functions' appended.  Any element in such an array is taken as the name of
       a function to execute; it is executed in the same context and with the same  arguments  as
       the  basic  function.   For example, if $chpwd_functions is an array containing the values
       `mychpwd', `chpwd_save_dirstack',  then  the  shell  attempts  to  execute  the  functions
       `chpwd',  `mychpwd'  and `chpwd_save_dirstack', in that order.  Any function that does not
       exist is silently ignored.  A function found by this mechanism is referred to elsewhere as
       a  `hook  function'.   An error in any function causes subsequent functions not to be run.
       Note further that an error in a precmd hook causes an immediately following periodic func‐
       tion not to run (though it may run at the next opportunity).

       chpwd  Executed whenever the current working directory is changed.

       periodic
              If  the  parameter  PERIOD is set, this function is executed every $PERIOD seconds,
              just before a prompt.  Note that if multiple functions are defined using the  array
              periodic_functions only one period is applied to the complete set of functions, and
              the scheduled time is not reset if the list of functions is altered.  Hence the set
              of functions is always called together.

       precmd Executed  before  each  prompt.  Note that precommand functions are not re-executed
              simply because the command line is redrawn, as happens, for example, when a notifi‐
              cation about an exiting job is displayed.

       preexec
              Executed  just  after  a command has been read and is about to be executed.  If the
              history mechanism is active (and the line was not discarded from the  history  buf‐
              fer),  the string that the user typed is passed as the first argument, otherwise it
              is an empty string.  The actual command that will be executed  (including  expanded
              aliases)  is  passed  in two different forms: the second argument is a single-line,
              size-limited version of the command (with things like function bodies elided);  the
              third argument contains the full text that is being executed.

       zshaddhistory
              Executed  when  a  history  line has been read interactively, but before it is exe‐
              cuted.  The sole argument is the complete history line  (so  that  any  terminating
              newline will still be present).

              If  any of the hook functions returns status 1 (or any non-zero value other than 2,
              though this is not guaranteed for future versions of the shell)  the  history  line
              will  not  be saved, although it lingers in the history until the next line is exe‐
              cuted, allowing you to reuse or edit it immediately.

              If any of the hook functions returns status 2 the history line will be saved on the
              internal history list, but not written to the history file.  In case of a conflict,
              the first non-zero status value is taken.

              A hook function may call `fc -p ...' to switch the history context so that the his‐
              tory  is  saved in a different file from the that in the global HISTFILE parameter.
              This is handled specially: the history context is automatically restored after  the
              processing of the history line is finished.

              The  following example function works with one of the options INC_APPEND_HISTORY or
              SHARE_HISTORY set, in order that the line is written out immediately after the his‐
              tory entry is added.  It first adds the history line to the normal history with the
              newline stripped, which is usually the correct behaviour.   Then  it  switches  the
              history  context  so that the line will be written to a history file in the current
              directory.

                     zshaddhistory() {
                       print -sr -- ${1%%$'\n'}
                       fc -p .zsh_local_history
                     }

       zshexit
              Executed at the point where the main shell is about to exit normally.  This is  not
              called  by  exiting subshells, nor when the exec precommand modifier is used before
              an external command.  Also, unlike TRAPEXIT, it is not called when functions exit.

   Trap Functions
       The functions below are treated specially but do not have corresponding hook arrays.

       TRAPNAL
              If defined and non-null, this function will be executed whenever the shell  catches
              a signal SIGNAL, where NAL is a signal name as specified for the kill builtin.  The
              signal number will be passed as the first parameter to the function.

              If a function of this form is defined and null, the shell and processes spawned  by
              it will ignore SIGNAL.

              The  return status from the function is handled specially.  If it is zero, the sig‐
              nal is assumed to have been handled, and execution continues normally.   Otherwise,
              the  shell  will behave as interrupted except that the return status of the trap is
              retained.

              Programs terminated by uncaught signals typically return the status  128  plus  the
              signal  number.   Hence the following causes the handler for SIGINT to print a mes‐
              sage, then mimic the usual effect of the signal.

                     TRAPINT() {
                       print "Caught SIGINT, aborting."
                       return $(( 128 + $1 ))
                     }

              The functions TRAPZERR, TRAPDEBUG and TRAPEXIT  are  never  executed  inside  other
              traps.

       TRAPDEBUG
              If  the  option DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD is set (as it is by default), executed before each
              command; otherwise executed after each command.  See the description  of  the  trap
              builtin  in  zshbuiltins(1)  for  details  of additional features provided in debug
              traps.

       TRAPEXIT
              Executed when the shell exits, or when the current function exits if defined inside
              a  function.   The  value of $? at the start of execution is the exit status of the
              shell or the return status of the function exiting.

       TRAPZERR
              Executed whenever a command has a non-zero exit status.  However, the  function  is
              not  executed  if  the command occurred in a sublist followed by `&&' or `||'; only
              the final command in a sublist of this type causes the trap to  be  executed.   The
              function  TRAPERR  acts  the  same  as TRAPZERR on systems where there is no SIGERR
              (this is the usual case).

       The functions beginning `TRAP' may alternatively be defined with the trap  builtin:   this
       may  be  preferable  for  some uses.  Setting a trap with one form removes any trap of the
       other form for the same signal; removing a trap in either form removes all traps  for  the
       same signal.  The forms

              TRAPNAL() {
               # code
              }

       ('function traps') and

              trap '
               # code
              ' NAL

       ('list traps') are equivalent in most ways, the exceptions being the following:

       ·      Function  traps  have all the properties of normal functions, appearing in the list
              of functions and being called with their own function context rather than the  con‐
              text where the trap was triggered.

       ·      The return status from function traps is special, whereas a return from a list trap
              causes the surrounding context to return with the given status.

       ·      Function traps are not reset within subshells, in accordance  with  zsh  behaviour;
              list traps are reset, in accordance with POSIX behaviour.

JOBS
       If  the  MONITOR  option is set, an interactive shell associates a job with each pipeline.
       It keeps a table of current jobs, printed by the jobs  command,  and  assigns  them  small
       integer  numbers.   When a job is started asynchronously with `&', the shell prints a line
       to standard error which looks like:

              [1] 1234

       indicating that the job which was started asynchronously was job  number  1  and  had  one
       (top-level) process, whose process ID was 1234.

       If  a  job  is  started  with  `&|' or `&!', then that job is immediately disowned.  After
       startup, it does not have a place in the job table, and is not subject to the job  control
       features described here.

       If  you are running a job and wish to do something else you may hit the key ^Z (control-Z)
       which sends a TSTP signal to the current job:  this key  may  be  redefined  by  the  susp
       option  of  the external stty command.  The shell will then normally indicate that the job
       has been `suspended', and print another prompt.  You can then manipulate the state of this
       job, putting it in the background with the bg command, or run some other commands and then
       eventually bring the job back into the foreground with the foreground command  fg.   A  ^Z
       takes  effect immediately and is like an interrupt in that pending output and unread input
       are discarded when it is typed.

       A job being run in the background will suspend if it tries to read from the terminal.

       Note that if the job running in the foreground is a shell  function,  then  suspending  it
       will  have  the  effect  of  causing the shell to fork.  This is necessary to separate the
       function's state from that of the parent shell performing the job  control,  so  that  the
       latter can return to the command line prompt.  As a result, even if fg is used to continue
       the job the function will no longer be part of the parent shell, and any variables set  by
       the  function  will  not  be visible in the parent shell.  Thus the behaviour is different
       from the case where the function was never suspended.  Zsh is different  from  many  other
       shells in this regard.

       The  same  behaviour is found when the shell is executing code as the right hand side of a
       pipeline or any complex shell construct such as if, for, etc., in order  that  the  entire
       block  of  code  can  be managed as a single job.  Background jobs are normally allowed to
       produce output, but this can be disabled by giving the command `stty tostop'.  If you  set
       this  tty  option,  then background jobs will suspend when they try to produce output like
       they do when they try to read input.

       When a command is suspended and continued later with the fg or wait builtins, zsh restores
       tty  modes that were in effect when it was suspended.  This (intentionally) does not apply
       if the command is continued via `kill -CONT', nor when it is continued with bg.

       There are several ways to refer to jobs in the shell.  A job can be  referred  to  by  the
       process ID of any process of the job or by one of the following:

       %number
              The job with the given number.
       %string
              Any job whose command line begins with string.
       %?string
              Any job whose command line contains string.
       %%     Current job.
       %+     Equivalent to `%%'.
       %-     Previous job.

       The  shell  learns  immediately whenever a process changes state.  It normally informs you
       whenever a job becomes blocked so that no further progress is  possible.   If  the  NOTIFY
       option  is  not  set, it waits until just before it prints a prompt before it informs you.
       All such notifications are sent directly to the terminal, not to the  standard  output  or
       standard error.

       When  the monitor mode is on, each background job that completes triggers any trap set for
       CHLD.

       When you try to leave the shell while jobs are running or suspended, you  will  be  warned
       that  `You  have suspended (running) jobs'.  You may use the jobs command to see what they
       are.  If you do this or immediately try to exit again, the shell will not warn you a  sec‐
       ond  time;  the  suspended  jobs  will  be terminated, and the running jobs will be sent a
       SIGHUP signal, if the HUP option is set.

       To avoid having the shell terminate the running jobs, either use the  nohup  command  (see
       nohup(1)) or the disown builtin.

SIGNALS
       The  INT and QUIT signals for an invoked command are ignored if the command is followed by
       `&' and the MONITOR option is not active.  The shell itself always ignores the  QUIT  sig‐
       nal.   Otherwise,  signals have the values inherited by the shell from its parent (but see
       the TRAPNAL special functions in the section `Functions').

       Certain jobs are run asynchronously by the shell other than those explicitly put into  the
       background;  even  in  cases where the shell would usually wait for such jobs, an explicit
       exit command or exit due to the option ERR_EXIT will cause the shell to exit without wait‐
       ing.  Examples of such asynchronous jobs are process substitution, see the section PROCESS
       SUBSTITUTION in the zshexpn(1) manual page, and the handler processes for multios, see the
       section MULTIOS in the zshmisc(1) manual page.

ARITHMETIC EVALUATION
       The shell can perform integer and floating point arithmetic, either using the builtin let,
       or via a substitution of the form $((...)).  For integers, the shell is  usually  compiled
       to use 8-byte precision where this is available, otherwise precision is 4 bytes.  This can
       be tested, for example, by giving the command `print - $(( 12345678901 ))'; if the  number
       appears  unchanged,  the  precision is at least 8 bytes.  Floating point arithmetic always
       uses the `double' type with whatever corresponding precision is provided by  the  compiler
       and the library.

       The let builtin command takes arithmetic expressions as arguments; each is evaluated sepa‐
       rately.  Since many of the arithmetic operators, as well as spaces,  require  quoting,  an
       alternative form is provided: for any command which begins with a `((', all the characters
       until a matching `))' are treated as a quoted expression  and  arithmetic  expansion  per‐
       formed as for an argument of let.  More precisely, `((...))' is equivalent to `let "..."'.
       The return status is 0 if the arithmetic value of the expression is non-zero, 1 if  it  is
       zero, and 2 if an error occurred.

       For example, the following statement

              (( val = 2 + 1 ))

       is equivalent to

              let "val = 2 + 1"

       both assigning the value 3 to the shell variable val and returning a zero status.

       Integers  can  be  in  bases  other  than 10.  A leading `0x' or `0X' denotes hexadecimal.
       Integers may also be of the form `base#n', where base is a decimal number between two  and
       thirty-six  representing  the arithmetic base and n is a number in that base (for example,
       `16#ff' is 255 in hexadecimal).  The base# may also be omitted, in which case base  10  is
       used.  For backwards compatibility the form `[base]n' is also accepted.

       An  integer  expression or a base given in the form `base#n' may contain underscores (`_')
       after the leading digit for visual guidance; these are ignored in  computation.   Examples
       are 1_000_000 or 0xffff_ffff which are equivalent to 1000000 and 0xffffffff respectively.

       It  is  also  possible  to specify a base to be used for output in the form `[#base]', for
       example `[#16]'.  This is used when outputting arithmetical substitutions or when  assign‐
       ing  to  scalar  parameters, but an explicitly defined integer or floating point parameter
       will not be affected.  If an integer variable  is  implicitly  defined  by  an  arithmetic
       expression, any base specified in this way will be set as the variable's output arithmetic
       base as if the option `-i base' to the typeset builtin had been used.  The expression  has
       no  precedence  and  if  it  occurs  more than once in a mathematical expression, the last
       encountered is used.  For clarity it is recommended that it appear at the beginning of  an
       expression.  As an example:

              typeset -i 16 y
              print $(( [#8] x = 32, y = 32 ))
              print $x $y

       outputs first `8#40', the rightmost value in the given output base, and then `8#40 16#20',
       because y has been explicitly declared to have output base 16, while x (assuming  it  does
       not already exist) is implicitly typed by the arithmetic evaluation, where it acquires the
       output base 8.

       The base may be replaced or followed by an underscore, which may itself be followed  by  a
       positive  integer (if it is missing the value 3 is used).  This indicates that underscores
       should be inserted into the output string, grouping the number for  visual  clarity.   The
       following integer specifies the number of digits to group together.  For example:

              setopt cbases
              print $(( [#16_4] 65536 ** 2 ))

       outputs `0x1_0000_0000'.

       The  feature can be used with floating point numbers, in which case the base must be omit‐
       ted; grouping is away from the decimal point.  For example,

              zmodload zsh/mathfunc
              print $(( [#_] sqrt(1e7) ))

       outputs `3_162.277_660_168_379_5' (the number of decimal places shown may vary).

       If the C_BASES option is set, hexadecimal numbers in the standard C  format,  for  example
       0xFF  instead  of the usual `16#FF'.  If the option OCTAL_ZEROES is also set (it is not by
       default), octal numbers will be treated similarly and hence appear  as  `077'  instead  of
       `8#77'.   This  option  has  no  effect  on the output of bases other than hexadecimal and
       octal, and these formats are always understood on input.

       When an output base is specified using the `[#base]' syntax, an  appropriate  base  prefix
       will be output if necessary, so that the value output is valid syntax for input.  If the #
       is doubled, for example `[##16]', then no base prefix is output.

       Floating point constants are recognized by the presence of a decimal point or an exponent.
       The decimal point may be the first character of the constant, but the exponent character e
       or E may not, as it will be taken for a parameter name.  All  numeric  parts  (before  and
       after  the  decimal  point  and in the exponent) may contain underscores after the leading
       digit for visual guidance; these are ignored in computation.

       An arithmetic expression uses nearly the same syntax and associativity of  expressions  as
       in C.

       In the native mode of operation, the following operators are supported (listed in decreas‐
       ing order of precedence):

       + - ! ~ ++ --
              unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, {pre,post}{in,de}crement
       << >>  bitwise shift left, right
       &      bitwise AND
       ^      bitwise XOR
       |      bitwise OR
       **     exponentiation
       * / %  multiplication, division, modulus (remainder)
       + -    addition, subtraction
       < > <= >=
              comparison
       == !=  equality and inequality
       &&     logical AND
       || ^^  logical OR, XOR
       ? :    ternary operator
       = += -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=
              assignment
       ,      comma operator

       The operators `&&', `||', `&&=', and `||=' are short-circuiting, and only one of the  lat‐
       ter  two  expressions in a ternary operator is evaluated.  Note the precedence of the bit‐
       wise AND, OR, and XOR operators.

       With the option C_PRECEDENCES the precedences (but no other properties) of  the  operators
       are  altered  to  be  the  same as those in most other languages that support the relevant
       operators:

       + - ! ~ ++ --
              unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, {pre,post}{in,de}crement
       **     exponentiation
       * / %  multiplication, division, modulus (remainder)
       + -    addition, subtraction
       << >>  bitwise shift left, right
       < > <= >=
              comparison
       == !=  equality and inequality
       &      bitwise AND
       ^      bitwise XOR
       |      bitwise OR
       &&     logical AND
       ^^     logical XOR
       ||     logical OR
       ? :    ternary operator
       = += -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=
              assignment
       ,      comma operator

       Note the precedence of exponentiation in both cases is  below  that  of  unary  operators,
       hence `-3**2' evaluates as `9', not -9.  Use parentheses where necessary: `-(3**2)'.  This
       is for compatibility with other shells.

       Mathematical functions can be called with the  syntax  `func(args)',  where  the  function
       decides  if  the  args is used as a string or a comma-separated list of arithmetic expres‐
       sions. The shell currently defines no mathematical functions by default,  but  the  module
       zsh/mathfunc  may  be  loaded with the zmodload builtin to provide standard floating point
       mathematical functions.

       An expression of the form `##x' where x is any character sequence such as  `a',  `^A',  or
       `\M-\C-x' gives the value of this character and an expression of the form `#foo' gives the
       value of the first character of the contents of the parameter foo.  Character  values  are
       according  to  the  character set used in the current locale; for multibyte character han‐
       dling the option MULTIBYTE must be set.  Note that this form is different from `$#foo',  a
       standard  parameter  substitution  which  gives  the length of the parameter foo.  `#\' is
       accepted instead of `##', but its use is deprecated.

       Named parameters and subscripted arrays can be referenced by  name  within  an  arithmetic
       expression without using the parameter expansion syntax.  For example,

              ((val2 = val1 * 2))

       assigns twice the value of $val1 to the parameter named val2.

       An  internal integer representation of a named parameter can be specified with the integer
       builtin.  Arithmetic evaluation is performed on the value of each assignment  to  a  named
       parameter  declared integer in this manner.  Assigning a floating point number to an inte‐
       ger results in rounding down to the next integer.

       Likewise, floating point numbers can be declared with the float  builtin;  there  are  two
       types,  differing  only in their output format, as described for the typeset builtin.  The
       output format can be bypassed by using arithmetic substitution instead  of  the  parameter
       substitution,  i.e.  `${float}'  uses  the defined format, but `$((float))' uses a generic
       floating point format.

       Promotion of integer to floating point values is performed where necessary.  In  addition,
       if  any  operator which requires an integer (`~', `&', `|', `^', `%', `<<', `>>' and their
       equivalents with assignment) is given a floating  point  argument,  it  will  be  silently
       rounded down to the next integer.

       Scalar variables can hold integer or floating point values at different times; there is no
       memory of the numeric type in this case.

       If a variable is first assigned in a numeric context without previously being declared, it
       will be implicitly typed as integer or float and retain that type either until the type is
       explicitly changed or until the end of the scope.  This can have unforeseen  consequences.
       For example, in the loop

              for (( f = 0; f < 1; f += 0.1 )); do
              # use $f
              done

       if f has not already been declared, the first assignment will cause it to be created as an
       integer, and consequently the operation `f += 0.1' will always  cause  the  result  to  be
       truncated to zero, so that the loop will fail.  A simple fix would be to turn the initial‐
       ization into `f = 0.0'.  It is therefore best to declare numeric variables  with  explicit
       types.

CONDITIONAL EXPRESSIONS
       A  conditional expression is used with the [[ compound command to test attributes of files
       and to compare strings.  Each expression can be constructed from one or more of  the  fol‐
       lowing unary or binary expressions:

       -a file
              true if file exists.

       -b file
              true if file exists and is a block special file.

       -c file
              true if file exists and is a character special file.

       -d file
              true if file exists and is a directory.

       -e file
              true if file exists.

       -f file
              true if file exists and is a regular file.

       -g file
              true if file exists and has its setgid bit set.

       -h file
              true if file exists and is a symbolic link.

       -k file
              true if file exists and has its sticky bit set.

       -n string
              true if length of string is non-zero.

       -o option
              true if option named option is on.  option may be a single character, in which case
              it is a single letter option name.  (See the section `Specifying Options'.)

       -p file
              true if file exists and is a FIFO special file (named pipe).

       -r file
              true if file exists and is readable by current process.

       -s file
              true if file exists and has size greater than zero.

       -t fd  true if file descriptor number fd is open and associated with  a  terminal  device.
              (note: fd is not optional)

       -u file
              true if file exists and has its setuid bit set.

       -w file
              true if file exists and is writable by current process.

       -x file
              true  if file exists and is executable by current process.  If file exists and is a
              directory, then the current process has permission to search in the directory.

       -z string
              true if length of string is zero.

       -L file
              true if file exists and is a symbolic link.

       -O file
              true if file exists and is owned by the effective user ID of this process.

       -G file
              true if file exists and its group matches the effective group ID of this process.

       -S file
              true if file exists and is a socket.

       -N file
              true if file exists and its access time is not newer than its modification time.

       file1 -nt file2
              true if file1 exists and is newer than file2.

       file1 -ot file2
              true if file1 exists and is older than file2.

       file1 -ef file2
              true if file1 and file2 exist and refer to the same file.

       string = pattern
       string == pattern
              true if string matches pattern.  The `==' form is the preferred one.  The `='  form
              is for backward compatibility and should be considered obsolete.

       string != pattern
              true if string does not match pattern.

       string =~ regexp
              true  if string matches the regular expression regexp.  If the option RE_MATCH_PCRE
              is set regexp is tested as a PCRE regular expression  using  the  zsh/pcre  module,
              else  it  is tested as a POSIX extended regular expression using the zsh/regex mod‐
              ule.  Upon successful match, some variables  will  be  updated;  no  variables  are
              changed if the matching fails.

              If the option BASH_REMATCH is not set the scalar parameter MATCH is set to the sub‐
              string that matched the pattern and the integer parameters MBEGIN and MEND  to  the
              index  of  the  start  and  end, respectively, of the match in string, such that if
              string is contained in variable var the expression `${var[$MBEGIN,$MEND]}' is iden‐
              tical  to  `$MATCH'.  The setting of the option KSH_ARRAYS is respected.  Likewise,
              the array match is set to the substrings that matched parenthesised  subexpressions
              and  the  arrays  mbegin  and  mend  to the indices of the start and end positions,
              respectively, of the substrings within string.  The arrays are  not  set  if  there
              were no parenthesised subexpresssions.  For example, if the string `a short string'
              is matched against the regular expression  `s(...)t',  then  (assuming  the  option
              KSH_ARRAYS  is  not set) MATCH, MBEGIN and MEND are `short', 3 and 7, respectively,
              while match, mbegin and mend are single entry arrays containing the strings  `hor',
              `4' and `6, respectively.

              If  the  option  BASH_REMATCH is set the array BASH_REMATCH is set to the substring
              that matched the pattern followed by the substrings that matched parenthesised sub‐
              expressions within the pattern.

       string1 < string2
              true if string1 comes before string2 based on ASCII value of their characters.

       string1 > string2
              true if string1 comes after string2 based on ASCII value of their characters.

       exp1 -eq exp2
              true  if  exp1  is numerically equal to exp2.  Note that for purely numeric compar‐
              isons use of the ((...)) builtin described in the section  `ARITHMETIC  EVALUATION'
              is more convenient than conditional expressions.

       exp1 -ne exp2
              true if exp1 is numerically not equal to exp2.

       exp1 -lt exp2
              true if exp1 is numerically less than exp2.

       exp1 -gt exp2
              true if exp1 is numerically greater than exp2.

       exp1 -le exp2
              true if exp1 is numerically less than or equal to exp2.

       exp1 -ge exp2
              true if exp1 is numerically greater than or equal to exp2.

       ( exp )
              true if exp is true.

       ! exp  true if exp is false.

       exp1 && exp2
              true if exp1 and exp2 are both true.

       exp1 || exp2
              true if either exp1 or exp2 is true.

       For  compatibility,  if  there is a single argument that is not syntactically significant,
       typically a variable, the condition is treated  as  a  test  for  whether  the  expression
       expands  as  a string of non-zero length.  In other words, [[ $var ]] is the same as [[ -n
       $var ]].  It is recommended that the second, explicit, form be used where possible.

       Normal shell expansion is performed on the file, string and  pattern  arguments,  but  the
       result of each expansion is constrained to be a single word, similar to the effect of dou‐
       ble quotes.

       Filename generation is not performed on any form of argument to conditions.   However,  it
       can  be  forced  in  any  case  where  normal shell expansion is valid and when the option
       EXTENDED_GLOB is in effect by using an explicit glob qualifier of the form (#q) at the end
       of  the  string.   A  normal  glob qualifier expression may appear between the `q' and the
       closing parenthesis; if none appears the expression has no effect beyond causing  filename
       generation.  The results of filename generation are joined together to form a single word,
       as with the results of other forms of expansion.

       This special use of filename generation is only available with the [[ syntax.  If the con‐
       dition  occurs  within the [ or test builtin commands then globbing occurs instead as part
       of normal command line expansion before the condition is evaluated.  In this case  it  may
       generate multiple words which are likely to confuse the syntax of the test command.

       For example,

       [[ -n file*(#qN) ]]

       produces  status  zero  if and only if there is at least one file in the current directory
       beginning with the string `file'.  The globbing qualifier N ensures that the expression is
       empty if there is no matching file.

       Pattern  metacharacters are active for the pattern arguments; the patterns are the same as
       those used for filename generation, see zshexpn(1), but there is no special  behaviour  of
       `/' nor initial dots, and no glob qualifiers are allowed.

       In  each of the above expressions, if file is of the form `/dev/fd/n', where n is an inte‐
       ger, then the test applied to the open file whose descriptor number  is  n,  even  if  the
       underlying system does not support the /dev/fd directory.

       In the forms which do numeric comparison, the expressions exp undergo arithmetic expansion
       as if they were enclosed in $((...)).

       For example, the following:

              [[ ( -f foo || -f bar ) && $report = y* ]] && print File exists.

       tests if either file foo or file bar exists, and if so, if  the  value  of  the  parameter
       report  begins  with `y'; if the complete condition is true, the message `File exists.' is
       printed.

EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES
       Prompt sequences undergo a special form of expansion.  This  type  of  expansion  is  also
       available using the -P option to the print builtin.

       If  the  PROMPT_SUBST  option  is  set,  the prompt string is first subjected to parameter
       expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion.  See zshexpn(1).

       Certain escape sequences may be recognised in the prompt string.

       If the PROMPT_BANG option is set, a `!' in the prompt is replaced by the  current  history
       event number.  A literal `!' may then be represented as `!!'.

       If  the  PROMPT_PERCENT  option  is  set, certain escape sequences that start with `%' are
       expanded.  Many escapes are followed by a single character, although some of these take an
       optional integer argument that should appear between the `%' and the next character of the
       sequence.  More complicated escape sequences are available to provide  conditional  expan‐
       sion.

SIMPLE PROMPT ESCAPES
   Special characters
       %%     A `%'.

       %)     A `)'.

   Login information
       %l     The  line  (tty)  the  user  is  logged in on, without `/dev/' prefix.  If the name
              starts with `/dev/tty', that prefix is stripped.

       %M     The full machine hostname.

       %m     The hostname up to the first `.'.  An integer may follow the  `%'  to  specify  how
              many  components  of  the  hostname are desired.  With a negative integer, trailing
              components of the hostname are shown.

       %n     $USERNAME.

       %y     The line (tty) the user is logged in on, without `/dev/'  prefix.   This  does  not
              treat `/dev/tty' names specially.

   Shell state
       %#     A  `#'  if  the  shell  is  running  with  privileges, a `%' if not.  Equivalent to
              `%(!.#.%%)'.  The definition of `privileged', for these purposes,  is  that  either
              the  effective user ID is zero, or, if POSIX.1e capabilities are supported, that at
              least one capability is raised in either the Effective  or  Inheritable  capability
              vectors.

       %?     The return status of the last command executed just before the prompt.

       %_     The status of the parser, i.e. the shell constructs (like `if' and `for') that have
              been started on the command line. If given an integer number that many strings will
              be  printed; zero or negative or no integer means print as many as there are.  This
              is most useful in prompts PS2 for continuation lines and PS4 for debugging with the
              XTRACE option; in the latter case it will also work non-interactively.

       %d
       /      Current working directory.  If an integer follows the `%', it specifies a number of
              trailing components of the current working directory to show; zero means the  whole
              path.   A  negative  integer  specifies leading components, i.e. %-1d specifies the
              first component.

       %~     As %d and %/, but if the current working directory starts with $HOME, that part  is
              replaced  by  a  `~'.  Furthermore, if it has a named directory as its prefix, that
              part is replaced by a `~' followed by the name of the directory, but  only  if  the
              result  is  shorter than the full path; see Dynamic and Static named directories in
              zshexpn(1).

       %e     Evaluation depth of the current sourced file, shell function,  or  eval.   This  is
              incremented  or decremented every time the value of %N is set or reverted to a pre‐
              vious value, respectively.  This is most useful for debugging as part of $PS4.

       %h
       %!     Current history event number.

       %i     The line number currently being executed in the  script,  sourced  file,  or  shell
              function given by %N.  This is most useful for debugging as part of $PS4.

       %I     The  line  number  currently being executed in the file %x.  This is similar to %i,
              but the line number is always a line number in the file where the code was defined,
              even if the code is a shell function.

       %j     The number of jobs.

       %L     The current value of $SHLVL.

       %N     The  name of the script, sourced file, or shell function that zsh is currently exe‐
              cuting, whichever was started most recently.  If there is none, this is  equivalent
              to the parameter $0.  An integer may follow the `%' to specify a number of trailing
              path components to show; zero means the full path.  A  negative  integer  specifies
              leading components.

       %x     The  name  of  the  file containing the source code currently being executed.  This
              behaves as %N except that function and eval command names are  not  shown,  instead
              the file where they were defined.

       %c
       %.
       %C     Trailing component of the current working directory.  An integer may follow the `%'
              to get more than one component.  Unless `%C' is used,  tilde  contraction  is  per‐
              formed  first.   These  are  deprecated as %c and %C are equivalent to %1~ and %1/,
              respectively, while explicit positive integers have the same effect as for the lat‐
              ter two sequences.

   Date and time
       %D     The date in yy-mm-dd format.

       %T     Current time of day, in 24-hour format.

       %t
       %@     Current time of day, in 12-hour, am/pm format.

       %*     Current time of day in 24-hour format, with seconds.

       %w     The date in day-dd format.

       %W     The date in mm/dd/yy format.

       %D{string}
              string is formatted using the strftime function.  See strftime(3) for more details.
              Various zsh extensions provide numbers with no leading zero or space if the  number
              is a single digit:

              %f     a day of the month
              %K     the hour of the day on the 24-hour clock
              %L     the hour of the day on the 12-hour clock

              In addition, if the system supports the POSIX gettimeofday system call, %. provides
              decimal fractions of a second since the epoch  with  leading  zeroes.   By  default
              three decimal places are provided, but a number of digits up to 6 may be given fol‐
              lowing the %; hence %6.  outputs microseconds.  A typical example of  this  is  the
              format `%D{%H:%M:%S.%.}'.

              The  GNU extension that a `-' between the % and the format character causes a lead‐
              ing zero or space to be stripped is handled directly by the shell  for  the  format
              characters  d,  f, H, k, l, m, M, S and y; any other format characters are provided
              to strftime() with any leading `-', present, so the handling is  system  dependent.
              Further GNU extensions are not supported at present.

   Visual effects
       %B (%b)
              Start (stop) boldface mode.

       %E     Clear to end of line.

       %U (%u)
              Start (stop) underline mode.

       %S (%s)
              Start (stop) standout mode.

       %F (%f)
              Start  (stop)  using  a  different foreground colour, if supported by the terminal.
              The colour may be specified two ways: either as a numeric argument, as  normal,  or
              by  a sequence in braces following the %F, for example %F{red}.  In the latter case
              the values allowed are as described for the fg zle_highlight attribute; see Charac‐
              ter  Highlighting in zshzle(1).  This means that numeric colours are allowed in the
              second format also.

       %K (%k)
              Start (stop) using a different bacKground colour.  The syntax is identical to  that
              for %F and %f.

       %{...%}
              Include a string as a literal escape sequence.  The string within the braces should
              not change the cursor position.  Brace pairs can nest.

              A positive numeric argument between the % and the { is treated as described for  %G
              below.

       %G     Within  a %{...%} sequence, include a `glitch': that is, assume that a single char‐
              acter width will be output.  This is useful when outputting characters that  other‐
              wise  cannot be correctly handled by the shell, such as the alternate character set
              on some terminals.  The characters in question can be  included  within  a  %{...%}
              sequence  together with the appropriate number of %G sequences to indicate the cor‐
              rect width.  An integer between the `%' and `G' indicates a character  width  other
              than  one.   Hence  %{seq%2G%} outputs seq and assumes it takes up the width of two
              standard characters.

              Multiple uses of %G accumulate in the obvious fashion; the position of  the  %G  is
              unimportant.  Negative integers are not handled.

              Note that when prompt truncation is in use it is advisable to divide up output into
              single characters within each %{...%} group so that the  correct  truncation  point
              can be found.

CONDITIONAL SUBSTRINGS IN PROMPTS
       %v     The  value  of  the  first element of the psvar array parameter.  Following the `%'
              with an integer gives that element of the array.  Negative integers count from  the
              end of the array.

       %(x.true-text.false-text)
              Specifies  a  ternary  expression.  The character following the x is arbitrary; the
              same character is used to separate the text for the `true' result from that for the
              `false'  result.  This separator may not appear in the true-text, except as part of
              a %-escape sequence.  A `)' may appear in the false-text as  `%)'.   true-text  and
              false-text  may both contain arbitrarily-nested escape sequences, including further
              ternary expressions.

              The left parenthesis may be preceded or followed by a  positive  integer  n,  which
              defaults  to  zero.   A  negative integer will be multiplied by -1, except as noted
              below for `l'.  The test character x may be any of the following:

              !      True if the shell is running with privileges.
              #      True if the effective uid of the current process is n.
              ?      True if the exit status of the last command was n.
              _      True if at least n shell constructs were started.
              C
              /      True if the current absolute path has at least n elements  relative  to  the
                     root directory, hence / is counted as 0 elements.
              c
              .
              ~      True  if  the current path, with prefix replacement, has at least n elements
                     relative to the root directory, hence / is counted as 0 elements.
              D      True if the month is equal to n (January = 0).
              d      True if the day of the month is equal to n.
              e      True if the evaluation depth is at least n.
              g      True if the effective gid of the current process is n.
              j      True if the number of jobs is at least n.
              L      True if the SHLVL parameter is at least n.
              l      True if at least n characters have already been printed on the current line.
                     When  n  is  negative,  true if at least abs(n) characters remain before the
                     opposite margin (thus the left margin for RPROMPT).
              S      True if the SECONDS parameter is at least n.
              T      True if the time in hours is equal to n.
              t      True if the time in minutes is equal to n.
              v      True if the array psvar has at least n elements.
              V      True if element n of the array psvar is set and non-empty.
              w      True if the day of the week is equal to n (Sunday = 0).

       %<string<
       %>string>
       %[xstring]
              Specifies truncation behaviour for the remainder of the prompt string.  The  third,
              deprecated,  form  is  equivalent  to  `%xstringx',  i.e. x may be `<' or `>'.  The
              string will be displayed in place of the truncated portion of any string; note this
              does not undergo prompt expansion.

              The numeric argument, which in the third form may appear immediately after the `[',
              specifies the maximum permitted length of the various strings that can be displayed
              in  the  prompt.  In the first two forms, this numeric argument may be negative, in
              which case the truncation length is determined by subtracting the absolute value of
              the  numeric  argument from the number of character positions remaining on the cur‐
              rent prompt line.  If this results in a zero or negative length, a length of  1  is
              used.   In other words, a negative argument arranges that after truncation at least
              n characters remain before the right margin (left margin for RPROMPT).

              The forms with `<' truncate at the left of the string, and the forms with `>' trun‐
              cate  at  the  right  of  the  string.   For  example,  if the current directory is
              `/home/pike', the prompt `%8<..<%/' will expand to `..e/pike'.  In this string, the
              terminating character (`<', `>' or `]'), or in fact any character, may be quoted by
              a preceding `\'; note when using print -P, however, that this must  be  doubled  as
              the  string  is also subject to standard print processing, in addition to any back‐
              slashes removed by a double quoted string:  the worst case is therefore  `print  -P
              "%<\\\\<<..."'.

              If  the  string  is  longer than the specified truncation length, it will appear in
              full, completely replacing the truncated string.

              The part of the prompt string to be truncated runs to the end of the string, or  to
              the  end  of the next enclosing group of the `%(' construct, or to the next trunca‐
              tion encountered at the same grouping level (i.e. truncations  inside  a  `%('  are
              separate),  which ever comes first.  In particular, a truncation with argument zero
              (e.g., `%<<') marks the end of the range of the string to be truncated while  turn‐
              ing  off  truncation from there on. For example, the prompt '%10<...<%~%<<%# ' will
              print a truncated representation of the current directory, followed  by  a  `%'  or
              `#',  followed  by  a  space.   Without  the  `%<<',  those two characters would be
              included in the string to be truncated.  Note that `%-0<<' is a distinct

              Truncation applies only within each individual line of the prompt, as delimited  by
              embedded  newlines  (if  any).  If the total length of any line of the prompt after
              truncation is greater than the terminal width, or if the part to be truncated  con‐
              tains  embedded  newlines,  truncation  behavior  is  undefined and may change in a
              future version of the shell.  Use `%-n(l.true-text.false-text)' to remove parts  of
              the prompt when the available space is less than n.



ZSHEXPN(1)                           General Commands Manual                           ZSHEXPN(1)



NAME
       zshexpn - zsh expansion and substitution

DESCRIPTION
       The following types of expansions are performed in the indicated order in five steps:

       History Expansion
              This is performed only in interactive shells.

       Alias Expansion
              Aliases  are  expanded  immediately  before the command line is parsed as explained
              under Aliasing in zshmisc(1).

       Process Substitution
       Parameter Expansion
       Command Substitution
       Arithmetic Expansion
       Brace Expansion
              These five are performed in one step in left-to-right fashion.  After these  expan‐
              sions, all unquoted occurrences of the characters `\', `'' and `"' are removed.

       Filename Expansion
              If the SH_FILE_EXPANSION option is set, the order of expansion is modified for com‐
              patibility with sh and ksh.  In that case filename expansion is  performed  immedi‐
              ately after alias expansion, preceding the set of five expansions mentioned above.

       Filename Generation
              This expansion, commonly referred to as globbing, is always done last.

       The following sections explain the types of expansion in detail.

HISTORY EXPANSION
       History  expansion allows you to use words from previous command lines in the command line
       you are typing.  This simplifies spelling corrections and the  repetition  of  complicated
       commands or arguments.

       Immediately before execution, each command is saved in the history list, the size of which
       is controlled by the HISTSIZE parameter.  The one most recent command is  always  retained
       in  any  case.   Each  saved  command in the history list is called a history event and is
       assigned a number, beginning with 1 (one) when the shell starts up.   The  history  number
       that  you  may see in your prompt (see EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1)) is the
       number that is to be assigned to the next command.

   Overview
       A history expansion begins with the first character of the histchars parameter,  which  is
       `!'  by  default,  and  may  occur anywhere on the command line; history expansions do not
       nest.  The `!' can be escaped with `\' or can be enclosed between a pair of single  quotes
       ('')  to  suppress  its special meaning.  Double quotes will not work for this.  Following
       this history character is an optional event designator (see the  section  `Event  Designa‐
       tors')  and  then an optional word designator (the section `Word Designators'); if neither
       of these designators is present, no history expansion occurs.

       Input lines containing history expansions are echoed after being expanded, but before  any
       other  expansions take place and before the command is executed.  It is this expanded form
       that is recorded as the history event for later references.

       By default, a history reference with no event designator refers to the same event  as  any
       preceding history reference on that command line; if it is the only history reference in a
       command, it refers to the previous command.  However, if the option CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY  is
       set,  then every history reference with no event specification always refers to the previ‐
       ous command.

       For example, `!' is the event designator for the previous command, so `!!:1' always refers
       to the first word of the previous command, and `!!$' always refers to the last word of the
       previous command.  With CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY set, then `!:1' and `!$' function in  the  same
       manner  as  `!!:1'  and  `!!$', respectively.  Conversely, if CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY is unset,
       then `!:1' and `!$' refer to the first and last words, respectively,  of  the  same  event
       referenced  by  the  nearest other history reference preceding them on the current command
       line, or to the previous command if there is no preceding reference.

       The character sequence `^foo^bar' (where `^' is  actually  the  second  character  of  the
       histchars  parameter)  repeats  the last command, replacing the string foo with bar.  More
       precisely, the sequence `^foo^bar^' is synonymous with `!!:s^foo^bar^', hence other  modi‐
       fiers   (see   the  section  `Modifiers')  may  follow  the  final  `^'.   In  particular,
       `^foo^bar^:G' performs a global substitution.

       If the shell encounters the character sequence `!"' in the input, the history mechanism is
       temporarily disabled until the current list (see zshmisc(1)) is fully parsed.  The `!"' is
       removed from the input, and any subsequent `!' characters have no special significance.

       A less convenient but more comprehensible form of command history support is  provided  by
       the fc builtin.

   Event Designators
       An  event  designator  is a reference to a command-line entry in the history list.  In the
       list below, remember that the initial `!' in each item may be changed to another character
       by setting the histchars parameter.

       !      Start  a  history  expansion, except when followed by a blank, newline, `=' or `('.
              If followed immediately by a word designator (see the section `Word  Designators'),
              this  forms  a  history  reference with no event designator (see the section `Over‐
              view').

       !!     Refer to the previous command.  By itself, this expansion repeats the previous com‐
              mand.

       !n     Refer to command-line n.

       !-n    Refer to the current command-line minus n.

       !str   Refer to the most recent command starting with str.

       !?str[?]
              Refer  to the most recent command containing str.  The trailing `?' is necessary if
              this reference is to be followed by a modifier or followed by any text that is  not
              to be considered part of str.

       !#     Refer  to  the  current command line typed in so far.  The line is treated as if it
              were complete up to and including the word before the one with the `!#' reference.

       !{...} Insulate a history reference from adjacent characters (if necessary).

   Word Designators
       A word designator indicates which word or words of a given command line are to be included
       in  a  history  reference.   A `:' usually separates the event specification from the word
       designator.  It may be omitted only if the word designator begins with a  `^',  `$',  `*',
       `-' or `%'.  Word designators include:

       0      The first input word (command).
       n      The nth argument.
       ^      The first argument.  That is, 1.
       $      The last argument.
       %      The word matched by (the most recent) ?str search.
       x-y    A range of words; x defaults to 0.
       *      All the arguments, or a null value if there are none.
       x*     Abbreviates `x-$'.
       x-     Like `x*' but omitting word $.

       Note  that a `%' word designator works only when used in one of `!%', `!:%' or `!?str?:%',
       and only when used after a !? expansion (possibly in an earlier command).   Anything  else
       results in an error, although the error may not be the most obvious one.

   Modifiers
       After the optional word designator, you can add a sequence of one or more of the following
       modifiers, each preceded by a `:'.  These modifiers also work on the  result  of  filename
       generation and parameter expansion, except where noted.

       a      Turn  a file name into an absolute path:  prepends the current directory, if neces‐
              sary, and resolves any use of `..' and `.' in the path.  Note that the  transforma‐
              tion takes place even if the file or any intervening directories do not exist.

       A      As  `a',  but also resolve use of symbolic links where possible.  Note that resolu‐
              tion of `..' occurs before resolution of symbolic links.  This call  is  equivalent
              to a unless your system has the realpath system call (modern systems do).

       c      Resolve a command name into an absolute path by searching the command path given by
              the PATH variable.  This does not work for  commands  containing  directory  parts.
              Note  also that this does not usually work as a glob qualifier unless a file of the
              same name is found in the current directory.

       e      Remove all but the part of the filename extension following the `.'; see the  defi‐
              nition  of the filename extension in the description of the r modifier below.  Note
              that according to that definition the result will be empty if the string ends  with
              a `.'.

       h      Remove a trailing pathname component, leaving the head.  This works like `dirname'.

       l      Convert the words to all lowercase.

       p      Print the new command but do not execute it.  Only works with history expansion.

       q      Quote  the  substituted  words, escaping further substitutions.  Works with history
              expansion and parameter expansion, though for parameters it is only useful  if  the
              resulting text is to be re-evaluated such as by eval.

       Q      Remove one level of quotes from the substituted words.

       r      Remove a filename extension leaving the root name.  Strings with no filename exten‐
              sion are not altered.  A filename extension is a `.'  followed  by  any  number  of
              characters  (including  zero) that are neither `.' nor `/' and that continue to the
              end of the string.  For  example,  the  extension  of  `foo.orig.c'  is  `.c',  and
              `dir.c/foo' has no extension.

       s/l/r[/]
              Substitute r for l as described below.  The substitution is done only for the first
              string that matches l.  For arrays and for filename  generation,  this  applies  to
              each word of the expanded text.  See below for further notes on substitutions.

              The  forms  `gs/l/r'  and  `s/l/r/:G'  perform global substitution, i.e. substitute
              every occurrence of r for l.  Note that the g or :G  must  appear  in  exactly  the
              position shown.

              See further notes on this form of substitution below.

       &      Repeat  the  previous  s substitution.  Like s, may be preceded immediately by a g.
              In parameter expansion the & must appear inside braces, and in filename  generation
              it must be quoted with a backslash.

       t      Remove  all  leading pathname components, leaving the tail.  This works like `base‐
              name'.

       u      Convert the words to all uppercase.

       x      Like q, but break into words at whitespace.  Does not work  with  parameter  expan‐
              sion.

       The  s/l/r/ substitution works as follows.  By default the left-hand side of substitutions
       are not patterns, but character strings.  Any character can be used as  the  delimiter  in
       place  of  `/'.   A  backslash  quotes the delimiter character.  The character `&', in the
       right-hand-side r, is replaced by the text from the left-hand-side  l.   The  `&'  can  be
       quoted  with a backslash.  A null l uses the previous string either from the previous l or
       from the contextual scan string s from `!?s'.  You can omit the rightmost delimiter  if  a
       newline  immediately follows r; the rightmost `?' in a context scan can similarly be omit‐
       ted.  Note the same record of the last l and r is maintained across all  forms  of  expan‐
       sion.

       Note that if a `&' is used within glob qualifiers an extra backslash is needed as a & is a
       special character in this case.

       If the option HIST_SUBST_PATTERN is set, l is treated as  a  pattern  of  the  usual  form
       described  in  the  section FILENAME GENERATION below.  This can be used in all the places
       where modifiers are available; note, however, that in globbing qualifiers  parameter  sub‐
       stitution  has  already  taken  place,  so  parameters in the replacement string should be
       quoted to ensure they are replaced at the correct time.  Note also that  complicated  pat‐
       terns  used  in  globbing  qualifiers  may  need  the  extended  glob  qualifier  notation
       (#q:s/.../.../) in order for the shell to recognize the expression as  a  glob  qualifier.
       Further,  note that bad patterns in the substitution are not subject to the NO_BAD_PATTERN
       option so will cause an error.

       When HIST_SUBST_PATTERN is set, l may start with a # to indicate  that  the  pattern  must
       match  at  the  start  of the string to be substituted, and a % may appear at the start or
       after an # to indicate that the pattern must match at the end of the string to be  substi‐
       tuted.  The % or # may be quoted with two backslashes.

       For  example,  the  following  piece  of  filename  generation code with the EXTENDED_GLOB
       option:

              print *.c(#q:s/#%(#b)s(*).c/'S${match[1]}.C'/)

       takes the expansion of *.c and applies the glob  qualifiers  in  the  (#q...)  expression,
       which consists of a substitution modifier anchored to the start and end of each word (#%).
       This turns on backreferences ((#b)), so that the parenthesised subexpression is  available
       in  the  replacement  string as ${match[1]}.  The replacement string is quoted so that the
       parameter is not substituted before the start of filename generation.

       The following f, F, w and W modifiers work only with parameter expansion and filename gen‐
       eration.  They are listed here to provide a single point of reference for all modifiers.

       f      Repeats  the  immediately  (without a colon) following modifier until the resulting
              word doesn't change any more.

       F:expr:
              Like f, but repeats only n times if the expression expr evaluates to n.  Any  char‐
              acter  can  be  used instead of the `:'; if `(', `[', or `{' is used as the opening
              delimiter, the closing delimiter should be ')', `]', or `}', respectively.

       w      Makes the immediately following modifier work on each word in the string.

       W:sep: Like w but words are considered to be the parts of the string that are separated by
              sep.  Any character can be used instead of the `:'; opening parentheses are handled
              specially, see above.

PROCESS SUBSTITUTION
       Each part of a command argument that takes the form `<(list)', `>(list)' or  `=(list)'  is
       subject  to  process  substitution.   The  expression may be preceded or followed by other
       strings except that, to prevent clashes with commonly occurring strings and patterns,  the
       last  form  must occur at the start of a command argument, and the forms are only expanded
       when first parsing command or assignment arguments.  Process  substitutions  may  be  used
       following redirection operators; in this case, the substitution must appear with no trail‐
       ing string.

       In the case of the < or > forms, the shell runs the commands in list as  a  subprocess  of
       the  job  executing the shell command line.  If the system supports the /dev/fd mechanism,
       the command argument is the name of the device file corresponding to  a  file  descriptor;
       otherwise,  if  the  system  supports  named pipes (FIFOs), the command argument will be a
       named pipe.  If the form with > is selected then writing on this special file will provide
       input  for  list.   If < is used, then the file passed as an argument will be connected to
       the output of the list process.  For example,

              paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) |
              tee >(process1) >(process2) >/dev/null

       cuts fields 1 and 3 from the files  file1  and  file2  respectively,  pastes  the  results
       together, and sends it to the processes process1 and process2.

       If  =(...) is used instead of <(...), then the file passed as an argument will be the name
       of a temporary file containing the output of the list process.  This may be  used  instead
       of the < form for a program that expects to lseek (see lseek(2)) on the input file.

       There  is  an  optimisation  for  substitutions of the form =(<<<arg), where arg is a sin‐
       gle-word argument to the here-string redirection <<<.  This form produces a file name con‐
       taining  the  value  of  arg after any substitutions have been performed.  This is handled
       entirely within the current shell.  This is effectively the reverse of  the  special  form
       $(<arg) which treats arg as a file name and replaces it with the file's contents.

       The  = form is useful as both the /dev/fd and the named pipe implementation of <(...) have
       drawbacks.  In the former case, some programmes may automatically close the file  descrip‐
       tor  in  question  before  examining the file on the command line, particularly if this is
       necessary for security reasons such as when the programme is running setuid.  In the  sec‐
       ond  case,  if  the  programme does not actually open the file, the subshell attempting to
       read from or write to the pipe will (in a typical implementation, different operating sys‐
       tems  may  have  different behaviour) block for ever and have to be killed explicitly.  In
       both cases, the shell actually supplies the information using a pipe, so  that  programmes
       that expect to lseek (see lseek(2)) on the file will not work.

       Also  note  that  the previous example can be more compactly and efficiently written (pro‐
       vided the MULTIOS option is set) as:

              paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) \
              > >(process1) > >(process2)

       The shell uses pipes instead of FIFOs to implement the latter two process substitutions in
       the above example.

       There  is an additional problem with >(process); when this is attached to an external com‐
       mand, the parent shell does not wait for process to finish and hence an  immediately  fol‐
       lowing  command  cannot  rely on the results being complete.  The problem and solution are
       the same as described in the section MULTIOS in zshmisc(1).  Hence in a simplified version
       of the example above:

              paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) > >(process)

       (note that no MULTIOS are involved), process will be run asynchronously as far as the par‐
       ent shell is concerned.  The workaround is:

              { paste <(cut -f1 file1) <(cut -f3 file2) } > >(process)

       The extra processes here are spawned from the parent shell which will wait for their  com‐
       pletion.

       Another  problem  arises any time a job with a substitution that requires a temporary file
       is disowned by the shell, including the case where `&!' or `&|' appears at the  end  of  a
       command containing a substitution.  In that case the temporary file will not be cleaned up
       as the shell no longer has any memory of the job.  A workaround is to use a subshell,  for
       example,

              (mycmd =(myoutput)) &!

       as the forked subshell will wait for the command to finish then remove the temporary file.

       A general workaround to ensure a process substitution endures for an appropriate length of
       time is to pass it as a parameter to an anonymous shell function (a piece  of  shell  code
       that is run immediately with function scope).  For example, this code:

              () {
                 print File $1:
                 cat $1
              } =(print This be the verse)

       outputs something resembling the following

              File /tmp/zsh6nU0kS:
              This be the verse

       The  temporary  file created by the process substitution will be deleted when the function
       exits.

PARAMETER EXPANSION
       The character `$' is used to  introduce  parameter  expansions.   See  zshparam(1)  for  a
       description of parameters, including arrays, associative arrays, and subscript notation to
       access individual array elements.

       Note in particular the fact that words of unquoted parameters are not automatically  split
       on  whitespace unless the option SH_WORD_SPLIT is set; see references to this option below
       for more details.  This is an important difference from other shells.

       In the expansions discussed below that require a pattern, the form of the pattern  is  the
       same  as  that  used for filename generation; see the section `Filename Generation'.  Note
       that these patterns, along with the replacement text of any substitutions, are  themselves
       subject  to parameter expansion, command substitution, and arithmetic expansion.  In addi‐
       tion to the following operations, the colon modifiers described in the section `Modifiers'
       in  the section `History Expansion' can be applied:  for example, ${i:s/foo/bar/} performs
       string substitution on the expansion of parameter $i.

       ${name}
              The value, if any, of the parameter name is substituted.  The braces  are  required
              if the expansion is to be followed by a letter, digit, or underscore that is not to
              be interpreted as part of name.  In addition, more complicated forms  of  substitu‐
              tion  usually require the braces to be present; exceptions, which only apply if the
              option KSH_ARRAYS is not set, are a single subscript or any colon modifiers appear‐
              ing  after  the  name, or any of the characters `^', `=', `~', `#' or `+' appearing
              before the name, all of which work with or without braces.

              If name is an array parameter, and the KSH_ARRAYS option is not set, then the value
              of  each  element  of  name  is  substituted, one element per word.  Otherwise, the
              expansion results in one word only; with KSH_ARRAYS, this is the first  element  of
              an array.  No field splitting is done on the result unless the SH_WORD_SPLIT option
              is set.  See also the flags = and s:string:.

       ${+name}
              If name is the name of a set parameter `1' is substituted, otherwise `0' is substi‐
              tuted.

       ${name-word}
       ${name:-word}
              If  name is set, or in the second form is non-null, then substitute its value; oth‐
              erwise substitute word.  In the second form name may be omitted, in which case word
              is always substituted.

       ${name+word}
       ${name:+word}
              If  name is set, or in the second form is non-null, then substitute word; otherwise
              substitute nothing.

       ${name=word}
       ${name:=word}
       ${name::=word}
              In the first form, if name is unset then set it to word; in  the  second  form,  if
              name  is  unset or null then set it to word; and in the third form, unconditionally
              set name to word.  In all forms, the value of the parameter is then substituted.

       ${name?word}
       ${name:?word}
              In the first form, if name is set, or in the second form if name is  both  set  and
              non-null, then substitute its value; otherwise, print word and exit from the shell.
              Interactive shells instead return to the prompt.  If word is omitted, then a  stan‐
              dard message is printed.

       In  any  of  the  above expressions that test a variable and substitute an alternate word,
       note that you can use standard shell quoting in the word value to selectively override the
       splitting  done  by  the  SH_WORD_SPLIT  option  and  the = flag, but not splitting by the
       s:string: flag.

       In the following expressions, when name is an array and the substitution is not quoted, or
       if  the `(@)' flag or the name[@] syntax is used, matching and replacement is performed on
       each array element separately.

       ${name#pattern}
       ${name##pattern}
              If the pattern matches the beginning of the value  of  name,  then  substitute  the
              value  of  name  with  the  matched portion deleted; otherwise, just substitute the
              value of name.  In the first form, the smallest matching pattern is  preferred;  in
              the second form, the largest matching pattern is preferred.

       ${name%pattern}
       ${name%%pattern}
              If  the  pattern matches the end of the value of name, then substitute the value of
              name with the matched portion deleted; otherwise,  just  substitute  the  value  of
              name.  In the first form, the smallest matching pattern is preferred; in the second
              form, the largest matching pattern is preferred.

       ${name:#pattern}
              If the pattern matches the value of name, then substitute the empty string;  other‐
              wise,  just  substitute  the value of name.  If name is an array the matching array
              elements are removed (use the `(M)' flag to remove the non-matched elements).

       ${name:|arrayname}
              If arrayname is the name (N.B., not contents) of an array variable, then  any  ele‐
              ments  contained  in  arrayname  are removed from the substitution of name.  If the
              substitution is scalar, either because name is a scalar variable or the  expression
              is  quoted, the elements of arrayname are instead tested against the entire expres‐
              sion.

       ${name:*arrayname}
              Similar to the preceding substitution, but in the opposite sense, so  that  entries
              present in both the original substitution and as elements of arrayname are retained
              and others removed.

       ${name:^arrayname}
       ${name:^^arrayname}
              Zips two arrays, such that the output array is twice as long as the shortest (long‐
              est  for `:^^') of name and arrayname, with the elements alternatingly being picked
              from them. For `:^', if one of the input arrays is longer,  the  output  will  stop
              when the end of the shorter array is reached.  Thus,

                     a=(1 2 3 4); b=(a b); print ${a:^b}

              will  output  `1  a  2  b'.  For `:^^', then the input is repeated until all of the
              longer array has been used up and the above will output `1 a 2 b 3 a 4 b'.

              Either or both inputs may be a scalar, they will be treated as an array of length 1
              with  the  scalar as the only element. If either array is empty, the other array is
              output with no extra elements inserted.

              Currently the following code will output `a b' and `1' as  two  separate  elements,
              which  can  be unexpected. The second print provides a workaround which should con‐
              tinue to work if this is changed.

                     a=(a b); b=(1 2); print -l "${a:^b}"; print -l "${${a:^b}}"

       ${name:offset}
       ${name:offset:length}
              This  syntax  gives  effects  similar  to  parameter  subscripting  in   the   form
              $name[start,end],  but  is  compatible with other shells; note that both offset and
              length are interpreted differently from the components of a subscript.

              If offset is non-negative, then if the variable name is  a  scalar  substitute  the
              contents  starting offset characters from the first character of the string, and if
              name is an array substitute elements starting offset elements from the  first  ele‐
              ment.   If  length is given, substitute that many characters or elements, otherwise
              the entire rest of the scalar or array.

              A positive offset is always treated as the offset of a character or element in name
              from the first character or element of the array (this is different from native zsh
              subscript notation).  Hence 0 refers to the first character or  element  regardless
              of the setting of the option KSH_ARRAYS.

              A  negative offset counts backwards from the end of the scalar or array, so that -1
              corresponds to the last character or element, and so on.

              When positive, length counts from the offset position toward the end of the  scalar
              or  array.   When  negative, length counts back from the end.  If this results in a
              position smaller than offset, a diagnostic is printed and nothing is substituted.

              The option MULTIBYTE is obeyed, i.e. the offset and length count multibyte  charac‐
              ters where appropriate.

              offset and length undergo the same set of shell substitutions as for scalar assign‐
              ment; in addition, they are then subject  to  arithmetic  evaluation.   Hence,  for
              example

                     print ${foo:3}
                     print ${foo: 1 + 2}
                     print ${foo:$(( 1 + 2))}
                     print ${foo:$(echo 1 + 2)}

              all have the same effect, extracting the string starting at the fourth character of
              $foo if the substitution would otherwise return a scalar, or the array starting  at
              the  fourth  element  if  $foo  would  return  an array.  Note that with the option
              KSH_ARRAYS $foo always returns a scalar (regardless of the use of the  offset  syn‐
              tax) and a form such as $foo[*]:3 is required to extract elements of an array named
              foo.

              If offset is negative, the - may not appear immediately after the : as  this  indi‐
              cates  the  ${name:-word}  form  of substitution.  Instead, a space may be inserted
              before the -.  Furthermore, neither offset nor length may begin with an  alphabetic
              character  or  & as these are used to indicate history-style modifiers.  To substi‐
              tute a value from a variable, the recommended approach is to precede it with a $ as
              this signifies the intention (parameter substitution can easily be rendered unread‐
              able); however, as arithmetic substitution  is  performed,  the  expression  ${var:
              offs} does work, retrieving the offset from $offs.

              For  further compatibility with other shells there is a special case for array off‐
              set 0.  This usually accesses to the first element of the array.  However,  if  the
              substitution  refers  the  positional parameter array, e.g. $@ or $*, then offset 0
              instead refers to $0, offset 1 refers to $1, and so on.  In other words, the  posi‐
              tional  parameter  array  is effectively extended by prepending $0.  Hence ${*:0:1}
              substitutes $0 and ${*:1:1} substitutes $1.

       ${name/pattern/repl}
       ${name//pattern/repl}
              Replace the longest possible match of pattern in the expansion of parameter name by
              string  repl.   The  first form replaces just the first occurrence, the second form
              all occurrences.  Both pattern and repl are subject to double-quoted  substitution,
              so  that  expressions  like  ${name/$opat/$npat} will work, but note the usual rule
              that pattern characters in $opat are not treated specially unless either the option
              GLOB_SUBST is set, or $opat is instead substituted as ${~opat}.

              The pattern may begin with a `#', in which case the pattern must match at the start
              of the string, or `%', in which case it must match at the end  of  the  string,  or
              `#%'  in  which  case the pattern must match the entire string.  The repl may be an
              empty string, in which case the final `/' may also be omitted.  To quote the  final
              `/'  in other cases it should be preceded by a single backslash; this is not neces‐
              sary if the `/' occurs inside a substituted parameter.  Note also that the `#', `%'
              and  `#%  are  not active if they occur inside a substituted parameter, even at the
              start.

              The first `/' may be preceded by a `:', in which case the match will  only  succeed
              if  it  matches  the  entire  word.   Note also the effect of the I and S parameter
              expansion flags below; however, the flags M, R, B, E and N are not useful.

              For example,

                     foo="twinkle twinkle little star" sub="t*e" rep="spy"
                     print ${foo//${~sub}/$rep}
                     print ${(S)foo//${~sub}/$rep}

              Here, the `~' ensures that the text of $sub is treated as a pattern rather  than  a
              plain  string.  In the first case, the longest match for t*e is substituted and the
              result is `spy star', while in the second case, the shortest matches are taken  and
              the result is `spy spy lispy star'.

       ${#spec}
              If  spec  is one of the above substitutions, substitute the length in characters of
              the result instead of the result itself.  If spec is an array  expression,  substi‐
              tute  the  number of elements of the result.  This has the side-effect that joining
              is skipped even in quoted forms, which may affect other  sub-expressions  in  spec.
              Note that `^', `=', and `~', below, must appear to the left of `#' when these forms
              are combined.

       ${^spec}
              Turn on the RC_EXPAND_PARAM option for the evaluation of spec; if the `^'  is  dou‐
              bled,  turn  it  off.   When  this  option  is  set,  array  expansions of the form
              foo${xx}bar, where the parameter xx is  set  to  (a  b  c),  are  substituted  with
              `fooabar foobbar foocbar' instead of the default `fooa b cbar'.  Note that an empty
              array will therefore cause all arguments to be removed.

              Internally, each such expansion is converted into the  equivalent  list  for  brace
              expansion.   E.g.,  ${^var}  becomes  {$var[1],$var[2],...},  and  is  processed as
              described in the section `Brace Expansion' below.  If word  splitting  is  also  in
              effect the $var[N] may themselves be split into different list elements.

       ${=spec}
              Perform  word  splitting using the rules for SH_WORD_SPLIT during the evaluation of
              spec, but regardless of whether the parameter appears in double quotes; if the  `='
              is  doubled,  turn it off.  This forces parameter expansions to be split into sepa‐
              rate words before substitution, using IFS as a delimiter.  This is done by  default
              in most other shells.

              Note  that  splitting is applied to word in the assignment forms of spec before the
              assignment to name is performed.  This affects the result of array assignments with
              the A flag.

       ${~spec}
              Turn  on  the  GLOB_SUBST option for the evaluation of spec; if the `~' is doubled,
              turn it off.  When this option is set, the string resulting from the expansion will
              be  interpreted  as a pattern anywhere that is possible, such as in filename expan‐
              sion and filename generation and pattern-matching contexts like the right hand side
              of the `=' and `!=' operators in conditions.

              In nested substitutions, note that the effect of the ~ applies to the result of the
              current level of substitution.  A surrounding pattern operation on the  result  may
              cancel  it.   Hence, for example, if the parameter foo is set to *, ${~foo//\*/*.c}
              is substituted by the pattern *.c, which may be expanded  by  filename  generation,
              but  ${${~foo}//\*/*.c}  substitutes  to  the string *.c, which will not be further
              expanded.

       If a ${...} type parameter expression or a $(...) type command  substitution  is  used  in
       place  of  name above, it is expanded first and the result is used as if it were the value
       of name.  Thus it is possible to perform nested operations:   ${${foo#head}%tail}  substi‐
       tutes  the  value  of  $foo  with both `head' and `tail' deleted.  The form with $(...) is
       often useful in combination with the flags described next; see the examples  below.   Each
       name or nested ${...} in a parameter expansion may also be followed by a subscript expres‐
       sion as described in Array Parameters in zshparam(1).

       Note that double quotes may appear around nested expressions, in which case only the  part
       inside  is treated as quoted; for example, ${(f)"$(foo)"} quotes the result of $(foo), but
       the flag `(f)' (see below) is applied using the rules for unquoted expansions.  Note  fur‐
       ther that quotes are themselves nested in this context; for example, in "${(@f)"$(foo)"}",
       there are two sets of quotes, one surrounding the whole expression, the other  (redundant)
       surrounding the $(foo) as before.

   Parameter Expansion Flags
       If  the opening brace is directly followed by an opening parenthesis, the string up to the
       matching closing parenthesis will be taken as a list of flags.  In cases where repeating a
       flag  is meaningful, the repetitions need not be consecutive; for example, `(q%q%q)' means
       the same thing as the more readable `(%%qqq)'.  The following flags are supported:

       #      Evaluate the resulting words as numeric expressions and output the characters  cor‐
              responding to the resulting integer.  Note that this form is entirely distinct from
              use of the # without parentheses.

              If the MULTIBYTE option is set and the number is greater  than  127  (i.e.  not  an
              ASCII character) it is treated as a Unicode character.

       %      Expand  all  %  escapes  in  the resulting words in the same way as in prompts (see
              EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1)). If this flag  is  given  twice,  full
              prompt  expansion  is  done on the resulting words, depending on the setting of the
              PROMPT_PERCENT, PROMPT_SUBST and PROMPT_BANG options.

       @      In double quotes, array elements are put into separate words.  E.g.,  `"${(@)foo}"'
              is  equivalent  to  `"${foo[@]}"'  and `"${(@)foo[1,2]}"' is the same as `"$foo[1]"
              "$foo[2]"'.  This is distinct from field splitting by the f, s or  z  flags,  which
              still applies within each array element.

       A      Create  an  array parameter with `${...=...}', `${...:=...}' or `${...::=...}'.  If
              this flag is repeated (as in `AA'), create an associative array parameter.  Assign‐
              ment is made before sorting or padding; if field splitting is active, the word part
              is split before assignment.  The name part may be a subscripted range for  ordinary
              arrays;  the  word  part  must  be  converted  to  an  array,  for example by using
              `${(AA)=name=...}' to activate field splitting, when creating an associative array.

       a      Sort in array index order; when combined with  `O'  sort  in  reverse  array  index
              order.  Note that `a' is therefore equivalent to the default but `Oa' is useful for
              obtaining an array's elements in reverse order.

       c      With ${#name}, count the total number of characters in an array, as if the elements
              were  concatenated with spaces between them.  This is not a true join of the array,
              so other expressions used with this flag may have an effect on the elements of  the
              array before it is counted.

       C      Capitalize  the  resulting  words.   `Words'  in  this  case refers to sequences of
              alphanumeric characters separated by non-alphanumerics, not to  words  that  result
              from field splitting.

       D      Assume  the  string or array elements contain directories and attempt to substitute
              the leading part of these by names.  The remainder of the path (the whole of it  if
              the  leading  part was not substituted) is then quoted so that the whole string can
              be used as a shell argument.  This is the reverse of  `~'  substitution:   see  the
              section FILENAME EXPANSION below.

       e      Perform  parameter  expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion on the
              result. Such expansions can be nested but too deep recursion may have unpredictable
              effects.

       f      Split the result of the expansion at newlines. This is a shorthand for `ps:\n:'.

       F      Join  the  words of arrays together using newline as a separator.  This is a short‐
              hand for `pj:\n:'.

       g:opts:
              Process escape sequences like the echo builtin when no  options  are  given  (g::).
              With  the  o  option,  octal escapes don't take a leading zero.  With the c option,
              sequences like `^X' are also processed.  With the e option,  processes  `\M-t'  and
              similar  sequences  like  the  print  builtin.   With  both of the o and e options,
              behaves like the print builtin except that in none of these modes  is  `\c'  inter‐
              preted.

       i      Sort case-insensitively.  May be combined with `n' or `O'.

       k      If  name refers to an associative array, substitute the keys (element names) rather
              than the values of the elements.  Used with subscripts (including ordinary arrays),
              force  indices  or keys to be substituted even if the subscript form refers to val‐
              ues.  However, this flag may not be combined with subscript ranges.

       L      Convert all letters in the result to lower case.

       n      Sort decimal integers numerically; if the first differing characters  of  two  test
              strings are not digits, sorting is lexical.   Integers with more initial zeroes are
              sorted before those with fewer or none.  Hence the  array  `foo1  foo02  foo2  foo3
              foo20 foo23' is sorted into the order shown.  May be combined with `i' or `O'.

       o      Sort the resulting words in ascending order; if this appears on its own the sorting
              is lexical and case-sensitive (unless  the  locale  renders  it  case-insensitive).
              Sorting  in  ascending  order is the default for other forms of sorting, so this is
              ignored if combined with `a', `i' or `n'.

       O      Sort the resulting words in descending order; `O' without `a', `i' or `n' sorts  in
              reverse  lexical  order.  May be combined with `a', `i' or `n' to reverse the order
              of sorting.

       P      This forces the value of the parameter name to be interpreted as a further  parame‐
              ter name, whose value will be used where appropriate.  Note that flags set with one
              of the typeset family of commands (in  particular  case  transformations)  are  not
              applied to the value of name used in this fashion.

              If used with a nested parameter or command substitution, the result of that will be
              taken as a parameter name in the same way.  For example, if you have `foo=bar'  and
              `bar=baz',  the  strings  ${(P)foo},  ${(P)${foo}},  and  ${(P)$(echo bar)} will be
              expanded to `baz'.

       q      Quote characters that are special to the shell in the resulting  words  with  back‐
              slashes;  unprintable or invalid characters are quoted using the $'\NNN' form, with
              separate quotes for each octet.

              If this flag is given twice, the resulting words are quoted in single quotes and if
              it  is  given three times, the words are quoted in double quotes; in these forms no
              special handling of unprintable or invalid characters is attempted.  If the flag is
              given four times, the words are quoted in single quotes preceded by a $.  Note that
              in all three of these forms quoting is done unconditionally, even if this does  not
              change the way the resulting string would be interpreted by the shell.

              If  a q- is given (only a single q may appear), a minimal form of single quoting is
              used that only quotes the string if needed to protect  special  characters.   Typi‐
              cally this form gives the most readable output.

       Q      Remove one level of quotes from the resulting words.

       t      Use  a string describing the type of the parameter where the value of the parameter
              would usually appear. This string consists of keywords separated by hyphens  (`-').
              The first keyword in the string describes the main type, it can be one of `scalar',
              `array', `integer', `float' or `association'. The other keywords describe the  type
              in more detail:

              local  for local parameters

              left   for left justified parameters

              right_blanks
                     for right justified parameters with leading blanks

              right_zeros
                     for right justified parameters with leading zeros

              lower  for  parameters  whose  value  is  converted  to  all  lower case when it is
                     expanded

              upper  for parameters whose value is  converted  to  all  upper  case  when  it  is
                     expanded

              readonly
                     for readonly parameters

              tag    for tagged parameters

              export for exported parameters

              unique for arrays which keep only the first occurrence of duplicated values

              hide   for parameters with the `hide' flag

              special
                     for special parameters defined by the shell

       u      Expand only the first occurrence of each unique word.

       U      Convert all letters in the result to upper case.

       v      Used  with  k,  substitute (as two consecutive words) both the key and the value of
              each associative array element.  Used with subscripts, force values to  be  substi‐
              tuted even if the subscript form refers to indices or keys.

       V      Make any special characters in the resulting words visible.

       w      With  ${#name},  count  words in arrays or strings; the s flag may be used to set a
              word delimiter.

       W      Similar to w with the difference that empty words between repeated  delimiters  are
              also counted.

       X      With  this  flag, parsing errors occurring with the Q, e and # flags or the pattern
              matching forms such as `${name#pattern}' are reported.  Without  the  flag,  errors
              are silently ignored.

       z      Split the result of the expansion into words using shell parsing to find the words,
              i.e. taking into account any quoting in the value.  Comments are not  treated  spe‐
              cially  but  as  ordinary  strings, similar to interactive shells with the INTERAC‐
              TIVE_COMMENTS option unset (however, see the Z flag below for related options)

              Note that this is done very late, even later than the `(s)' flag. So to access sin‐
              gle words in the result use nested expansions as in `${${(z)foo}[2]}'. Likewise, to
              remove the quotes in the resulting words use `${(Q)${(z)foo}}'.

       0      Split the result of the expansion on null bytes.  This is a shorthand for `ps:\0:'.

       The following flags (except p) are followed by one or more arguments as shown.  Any  char‐
       acter,  or  the matching pairs `(...)', `{...}', `[...]', or `<...>', may be used in place
       of a colon as delimiters, but note that when a  flag  takes  more  than  one  argument,  a
       matched pair of delimiters must surround each argument.

       p      Recognize the same escape sequences as the print builtin in string arguments to any
              of the flags described below that follow this argument.

       ~      Strings inserted into the expansion by any of the flags below are to be treated  as
              patterns.   This  applies to the string arguments of flags that follow ~ within the
              same set of parentheses.  Compare with ~  outside  parentheses,  which  forces  the
              entire substituted string to be treated as a pattern.  Hence, for example,
              [[ "?" = ${(~j.|.)array} ]]
       treats  `|'  as a pattern and succeeds if and only if $array contains the string `?' as an
       element.  The ~ may be repeated to toggle the behaviour; its effect only lasts to the  end
       of the parenthesised group.

       j:string:
              Join  the  words  of  arrays  together using string as a separator.  Note that this
              occurs before field splitting by the s:string: flag or the SH_WORD_SPLIT option.

       l:expr::string1::string2:
              Pad the resulting words on the left.  Each word will be truncated if  required  and
              placed in a field expr characters wide.

              The arguments :string1: and :string2: are optional; neither, the first, or both may
              be given.  Note that the same pairs of delimiters must be  used  for  each  of  the
              three  arguments.   The space to the left will be filled with string1 (concatenated
              as often as needed) or spaces if string1 is not given.  If both string1 and string2
              are given, string2 is inserted once directly to the left of each word, truncated if
              necessary, before string1 is used to produce any remaining padding.

              If either of string1 or string2 is present but empty, i.e. there are two delimiters
              together at that point, the first character of $IFS is used instead.

              If  the  MULTIBYTE option is in effect, the flag m may also be given, in which case
              widths will be used for the calculation of padding; otherwise individual  multibyte
              characters are treated as occupying one unit of width.

              If  the  MULTIBYTE  option  is not in effect, each byte in the string is treated as
              occupying one unit of width.

              Control characters are always assumed to be one unit wide; this allows  the  mecha‐
              nism to be used for generating repetitions of control characters.

       m      Only  useful  together  with  one of the flags l or r or with the # length operator
              when the MULTIBYTE option is in effect.  Use the character width  reported  by  the
              system  in  calculating how much of the string it occupies or the overall length of
              the string.  Most printable characters have a width of one  unit,  however  certain
              Asian  character  sets  and certain special effects use wider characters; combining
              characters have zero width.  Non-printable characters are  arbitrarily  counted  as
              zero width; how they would actually be displayed will vary.

              If the m is repeated, the character either counts zero (if it has zero width), else
              one.  For printable character strings this has the effect of counting the number of
              glyphs  (visibly  separate characters), except for the case where combining charac‐
              ters themselves have non-zero width (true in certain alphabets).

       r:expr::string1::string2:
              As l, but pad the words on the right and insert string2 immediately to the right of
              the string to be padded.

              Left and right padding may be used together.  In this case the strategy is to apply
              left padding to the first half width of each of the resulting words, and right pad‐
              ding  to  the second half.  If the string to be padded has odd width the extra pad‐
              ding is applied on the left.

       s:string:
              Force field splitting at the separator string.  Note that a string of two  or  more
              characters  means  that  all  of them must match in sequence; this differs from the
              treatment of two or more characters in the IFS parameter.  See also the = flag  and
              the  SH_WORD_SPLIT  option.   An empty string may also be given in which case every
              character will be a separate element.

              For historical reasons, the usual behaviour that empty array elements are  retained
              inside  double quotes is disabled for arrays generated by splitting; hence the fol‐
              lowing:

                     line="one::three"
                     print -l "${(s.:.)line}"

              produces two lines of output for one and three and  elides  the  empty  field.   To
              override this behaviour, supply the "(@)" flag as well, i.e.  "${(@s.:.)line}".

       Z:opts:
              As  z  but takes a combination of option letters between a following pair of delim‐
              iter characters.  With no options the effect is identical to z.  (Z+c+) causes com‐
              ments  to  be  parsed  as  a  string and retained; any field in the resulting array
              beginning with an unquoted comment character is a comment.  (Z+C+) causes  comments
              to  be  parsed  and removed.  The rule for comments is standard: anything between a
              word starting with the third character of $HISTCHARS, default #,  up  to  the  next
              newline  is  a  comment.  (Z+n+) causes unquoted newlines to be treated as ordinary
              whitespace, else they are treated as if they are shell  code  delimiters  and  con‐
              verted to semicolons.  Options are combined within the same set of delimiters, e.g.
              (Z+Cn+).

       _:flags:
              The underscore (_) flag is reserved for future use.  As of this  revision  of  zsh,
              there  are  no  valid  flags; anything following an underscore, other than an empty
              pair of delimiters, is treated as an error, and the flag itself has no effect.

       The following flags are meaningful with the ${...#...} or ${...%...} forms.  The S  and  I
       flags may also be used with the ${.../...} forms.

       S      Search  substrings  as  well as beginnings or ends; with # start from the beginning
              and with % start from the end of the string.  With substitution via  ${.../...}  or
              ${...//...},  specifies  non-greedy matching, i.e. that the shortest instead of the
              longest match should be replaced.

       I:expr:
              Search the exprth match (where expr evaluates to a number).  This only applies when
              searching  for  substrings,  either  with  the S flag, or with ${.../...} (only the
              exprth match is substituted) or ${...//...} (all matches from  the  exprth  on  are
              substituted).  The default is to take the first match.

              The exprth match is counted such that there is either one or zero matches from each
              starting position in the string, although for global substitution matches  overlap‐
              ping previous replacements are ignored.  With the ${...%...} and ${...%%...} forms,
              the starting position for the match moves backwards  from  the  end  as  the  index
              increases, while with the other forms it moves forward from the start.

              Hence with the string
                     which switch is the right switch for Ipswich?
              substitutions  of  the  form ${(SI:N:)string#w*ch} as N increases from 1 will match
              and remove `which', `witch', `witch' and `wich'; the form using `##' will match and
              remove  `which  switch is the right switch for Ipswich', `witch is the right switch
              for Ipswich', `witch for Ipswich' and `wich'. The form using `%'  will  remove  the
              same  matches as for `#', but in reverse order, and the form using `%%' will remove
              the same matches as for `##' in reverse order.

       B      Include the index of the beginning of the match in the result.

       E      Include the index of the end of the match in the result.

       M      Include the matched portion in the result.

       N      Include the length of the match in the result.

       R      Include the unmatched portion in the result (the Rest).

   Rules
       Here is a summary of the rules for substitution; this  assumes  that  braces  are  present
       around  the  substitution,  i.e.  ${...}.  Some particular examples are given below.  Note
       that the Zsh Development Group accepts no responsibility for any brain  damage  which  may
       occur during the reading of the following rules.

       1. Nested substitution
              If  multiple  nested  ${...}  forms are present, substitution is performed from the
              inside outwards.  At each level, the substitution takes account of whether the cur‐
              rent  value  is  a  scalar or an array, whether the whole substitution is in double
              quotes, and what flags are supplied to the current level of substitution,  just  as
              if  the nested substitution were the outermost.  The flags are not propagated up to
              enclosing substitutions; the nested substitution will return either a scalar or  an
              array as determined by the flags, possibly adjusted for quoting.  All the following
              steps take place where applicable at all levels of substitution.  Note that, unless
              the `(P)' flag is present, the flags and any subscripts apply directly to the value
              of the nested substitution; for example, the expansion  ${${foo}}  behaves  exactly
              the same as ${foo}.

              At  each  nested  level of substitution, the substituted words undergo all forms of
              single-word substitution (i.e. not filename generation), including command  substi‐
              tution,  arithmetic expansion and filename expansion (i.e. leading ~ and =).  Thus,
              for example, ${${:-=cat}:h} expands to the directory where the cat program resides.
              (Explanation:  the internal substitution has no parameter but a default value =cat,
              which is expanded by filename expansion to a full path; the outer substitution then
              applies the modifier :h and takes the directory part of the path.)

       2. Internal parameter flags
              Any parameter flags set by one of the typeset family of commands, in particular the
              L, R, Z, u and l flags for padding and capitalization, are applied directly to  the
              parameter  value.   Note these flags are options to the command, e.g. `typeset -Z';
              they are not the same as the flags used within parameter substitutions.

       3. Parameter subscripting
              If the value is a raw parameter reference with a subscript, such as ${var[3]},  the
              effect of subscripting is applied directly to the parameter.  Subscripts are evalu‐
              ated left to right; subsequent subscripts  apply  to  the  scalar  or  array  value
              yielded  by  the  previous subscript.  Thus if var is an array, ${var[1][2]} is the
              second character of the first word, but ${var[2,4][2]} is  the  entire  third  word
              (the  second  word  of  the range of words two through four of the original array).
              Any number of subscripts may appear.  Flags such as (k) and  (v)  which  alter  the
              result of subscripting are applied.

       4. Parameter name replacement
              The  effect  of any (P) flag, which treats the value so far as a parameter name and
              replaces it with the corresponding value, is applied.

       5. Double-quoted joining
              If the value after this process is an array, and the substitution appears in double
              quotes,  and  neither an (@) flag nor a # length operator is present at the current
              level, then words of the value are joined with the first character of the parameter
              $IFS,  by default a space, between each word (single word arrays are not modified).
              If the (j) flag is present, that is used for joining instead of $IFS.

       6. Nested subscripting
              Any remaining subscripts (i.e. of a nested  substitution)  are  evaluated  at  this
              point,  based  on  whether the value is an array or a scalar.  As with 3., multiple
              subscripts  can  appear.   Note  that  ${foo[2,4][2]}   is   thus   equivalent   to
              ${${foo[2,4]}[2]}  and  also  to  "${${(@)foo[2,4]}[2]}"  (the  nested substitution
              returns an array in both cases), but not to "${${foo[2,4]}[2]}" (the nested substi‐
              tution returns a scalar because of the quotes).

       7. Modifiers
              Any  modifiers, as specified by a trailing `#', `%', `/' (possibly doubled) or by a
              set of modifiers of the form :... (see the section `Modifiers' in the section `His‐
              tory Expansion'), are applied to the words of the value at this level.

       8. Character evaluation
              Any (#) flag is applied, evaluating the result so far numerically as a character.

       9. Length
              Any initial # modifier, i.e. in the form ${#var}, is used to evaluate the length of
              the expression so far.

       10. Forced joining
              If the `(j)' flag is present, or no `(j)' flag is present but the string is  to  be
              split as given by rule 11., and joining did not take place at step 5., any words in
              the value are joined together using the given string or the first character of $IFS
              if none.  Note that the `(F)' flag implicitly supplies a string for joining in this
              manner.

       11. Simple word splitting
              If one of the `(s)' or `(f)' flags are present, or the `='  specifier  was  present
              (e.g. ${=var}), the word is split on occurrences of the specified string, or (for =
              with neither of the two flags present) any of the characters in $IFS.

              If no `(s)', `(f)' or `=' was given, but the word is  not  quoted  and  the  option
              SH_WORD_SPLIT  is set, the word is split on occurrences of any of the characters in
              $IFS.  Note this step, too, takes place at all levels of a nested substitution.

       12. Case modification
              Any case modification from one of the flags (L), (U) or (C) is applied.

       13. Escape sequence replacement
              First any replacements from the (g) flag are performed, then any prompt-style  for‐
              matting from the (%) family of flags is applied.

       14. Quote application
              Any quoting or unquoting using (q) and (Q) and related flags is applied.

       15. Directory naming
              Any directory name substitution using (D) flag is applied.

       16. Visibility enhancement
              Any modifications to make characters visible using the (V) flag are applied.

       17. Lexical word splitting
              If  the  '(z)'  flag  or one of the forms of the '(Z)' flag is present, the word is
              split as if it were a shell  command  line,  so  that  quotation  marks  and  other
              metacharacters  are  used  to  decide  what  constitutes a word.  Note this form of
              splitting is entirely distinct from that described by rule 11.:  it  does  not  use
              $IFS, and does not cause forced joining.

       18. Uniqueness
              If  the  result  is an array and the `(u)' flag was present, duplicate elements are
              removed from the array.

       19. Ordering
              If the result is still an array and one of the `(o)' or `(O)'  flags  was  present,
              the array is reordered.

       20. RC_EXPAND_PARAM
              At  this  point the decision is made whether any resulting array elements are to be
              combined element  by  element  with  surrounding  text,  as  given  by  either  the
              RC_EXPAND_PARAM option or the `^' flag.

       21. Re-evaluation
              Any `(e)' flag is applied to the value, forcing it to be re-examined for new param‐
              eter substitutions, but also for command and arithmetic substitutions.

       22. Padding
              Any padding of the value by the `(l.fill.)' or `(r.fill.)' flags is applied.

       23. Semantic joining
              In contexts where expansion semantics requires a single word to result,  all  words
              are  rejoined  with  the first character of IFS between.  So in `${(P)${(f)lines}}'
              the value of ${lines} is split at newlines, but then must be  joined  again  before
              the P flag can be applied.

              If a single word is not required, this rule is skipped.

       24. Empty argument removal
              If  the  substitution  does  not appear in double quotes, any resulting zero-length
              argument, whether from a scalar or an element of an array, is elided from the  list
              of arguments inserted into the command line.

              Strictly  speaking,  the removal happens later as the same happens with other forms
              of substitution; the point to note here is simply that it occurs after any  of  the
              above parameter operations.

   Examples
       The  flag  f  is  useful to split a double-quoted substitution line by line.  For example,
       ${(f)"$(<file)"} substitutes the contents of file divided so that each line is an  element
       of the resulting array.  Compare this with the effect of $(<file) alone, which divides the
       file up by words, or the same inside double quotes, which makes the entire content of  the
       file a single string.

       The  following  illustrates  the rules for nested parameter expansions.  Suppose that $foo
       contains the array (bar baz):

       "${(@)${foo}[1]}"
              This produces the result b.  First, the inner substitution "${foo}", which  has  no
              array  (@)  flag,  produces a single word result "bar baz".  The outer substitution
              "${(@)...[1]}" detects that this is a scalar, so that (despite the `(@)' flag)  the
              subscript picks the first character.

       "${${(@)foo}[1]}"
              This  produces  the result `bar'.  In this case, the inner substitution "${(@)foo}"
              produces the array `(bar baz)'.  The outer substitution  "${...[1]}"  detects  that
              this  is  an  array  and  picks the first word.  This is similar to the simple case
              "${foo[1]}".

       As an example of the rules for word splitting and joining, suppose $foo contains the array
       `(ax1 bx1)'.  Then

       ${(s/x/)foo}
              produces the words `a', `1 b' and `1'.

       ${(j/x/s/x/)foo}
              produces `a', `1', `b' and `1'.

       ${(s/x/)foo%%1*}
              produces `a' and ` b' (note the extra space).  As substitution occurs before either
              joining or splitting, the operation  first generates the modified  array  (ax  bx),
              which  is  joined  to  give  "ax bx", and then split to give `a', ` b' and `'.  The
              final empty string will then be elided, as it is not in double quotes.

COMMAND SUBSTITUTION
       A command enclosed in parentheses preceded by a dollar sign, like `$(...)', or quoted with
       grave  accents, like ``...`', is replaced with its standard output, with any trailing new‐
       lines deleted.  If the substitution is not enclosed in double quotes, the output is broken
       into  words using the IFS parameter.  The substitution `$(cat foo)' may be replaced by the
       equivalent but faster `$(<foo)'.  In either case, if the option  GLOB_SUBST  is  set,  the
       output is eligible for filename generation.

ARITHMETIC EXPANSION
       A  string  of  the form `$[exp]' or `$((exp))' is substituted with the value of the arith‐
       metic expression exp.  exp is subjected to parameter expansion, command  substitution  and
       arithmetic expansion before it is evaluated.  See the section `Arithmetic Evaluation'.

BRACE EXPANSION
       A  string  of  the form `foo{xx,yy,zz}bar' is expanded to the individual words `fooxxbar',
       `fooyybar' and `foozzbar'.  Left-to-right order  is  preserved.   This  construct  may  be
       nested.  Commas may be quoted in order to include them literally in a word.

       An  expression  of the form `{n1..n2}', where n1 and n2 are integers, is expanded to every
       number between n1 and n2 inclusive.  If either number begins with a zero, all the  result‐
       ing  numbers  will  be  padded with leading zeroes to that minimum width, but for negative
       numbers the - character is also included in the width.  If the numbers are  in  decreasing
       order the resulting sequence will also be in decreasing order.

       An  expression  of the form `{n1..n2..n3}', where n1, n2, and n3 are integers, is expanded
       as above, but only every n3th number starting from n1 is output.  If n3  is  negative  the
       numbers  are  output  in reverse order, this is slightly different from simply swapping n1
       and n2 in the case that the step n3 doesn't evenly divide the range.  Zero padding can  be
       specified in any of the three numbers, specifying it in the third can be useful to pad for
       example `{-99..100..01}' which is not possible to specify by putting a 0 on either of  the
       first two numbers (i.e. pad to two characters).

       An  expression of the form `{c1..c2}', where c1 and c2 are single characters (which may be
       multibyte characters), is expanded to every character in the range from c1 to c2 in  what‐
       ever  character  sequence  is  used internally.  For characters with code points below 128
       this is US ASCII (this is the only case most users will need).  If any intervening charac‐
       ter  is not printable, appropriate quotation is used to render it printable.  If the char‐
       acter sequence is reversed, the output is in reverse order, e.g. `{d..a}'  is  substituted
       as `d c b a'.

       If  a  brace  expression matches none of the above forms, it is left unchanged, unless the
       option BRACE_CCL (an abbreviation for `brace character class') is set.  In that  case,  it
       is  expanded  to  a  list  of the individual characters between the braces sorted into the
       order of the characters in the ASCII character set (multibyte characters are not currently
       handled).   The  syntax  is  similar  to a [...] expression in filename generation: `-' is
       treated specially to denote a range of characters, but `^' or `!' as the  first  character
       is treated normally.  For example, `{abcdef0-9}' expands to 16 words 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 a
       b c d e f.

       Note that brace expansion is not part of filename  generation  (globbing);  an  expression
       such  as */{foo,bar} is split into two separate words */foo and */bar before filename gen‐
       eration takes place.  In particular, note that this is liable  to  produce  a  `no  match'
       error  if  either  of  the  two  expressions does not match; this is to be contrasted with
       */(foo|bar), which is treated as a single pattern but otherwise has similar effects.

       To combine brace expansion with array expansion, see the ${^spec} form  described  in  the
       section Parameter Expansion above.

FILENAME EXPANSION
       Each  word is checked to see if it begins with an unquoted `~'.  If it does, then the word
       up to a `/', or the end of the word if there is no `/', is checked to see  if  it  can  be
       substituted  in  one of the ways described here.  If so, then the `~' and the checked por‐
       tion are replaced with the appropriate substitute value.

       A `~' by itself is replaced by the value of $HOME.  A `~' followed by a `+' or  a  `-'  is
       replaced by current or previous working directory, respectively.

       A  `~' followed by a number is replaced by the directory at that position in the directory
       stack.  `~0' is equivalent to `~+', and `~1' is the top of the stack.  `~+' followed by  a
       number  is  replaced  by  the directory at that position in the directory stack.  `~+0' is
       equivalent to `~+', and `~+1' is the top of the stack.   `~-'  followed  by  a  number  is
       replaced  by the directory that many positions from the bottom of the stack.  `~-0' is the
       bottom of the stack.  The PUSHD_MINUS option exchanges the effects of `~+' and `~-'  where
       they are followed by a number.

   Dynamic named directories
       If  the function zsh_directory_name exists, or the shell variable zsh_directory_name_func‐
       tions exists and contains an array of function names,  then  the  functions  are  used  to
       implement  dynamic  directory  naming.  The functions are tried in order until one returns
       status zero, so it is important that functions test whether they can handle  the  case  in
       question and return an appropriate status.

       A  `~'  followed  by a string namstr in unquoted square brackets is treated specially as a
       dynamic directory name.  Note that the first unquoted closing square bracket always termi‐
       nates  namstr.   The  shell  function is passed two arguments: the string n (for name) and
       namstr.  It should either set the array reply to a single element which is  the  directory
       corresponding  to  the  name  and  return status zero (executing an assignment as the last
       statement is usually sufficient), or it should return status non-zero.  In the former case
       the  element  of  reply  is  used as the directory; in the latter case the substitution is
       deemed to have failed.  If all functions fail and the option  NOMATCH  is  set,  an  error
       results.

       The  functions  defined  as above are also used to see if a directory can be turned into a
       name, for example when printing the directory stack or when expanding %~ in  prompts.   In
       this case each function is passed two arguments: the string d (for directory) and the can‐
       didate for dynamic naming.  The function should either  return  non-zero  status,  if  the
       directory  cannot be named by the function, or it should set the array reply to consist of
       two elements: the first is the dynamic name for the  directory  (as  would  appear  within
       `~[...]'), and the second is the prefix length of the directory to be replaced.  For exam‐
       ple,  if  the  trial  directory  is  /home/myname/src/zsh  and  the   dynamic   name   for
       /home/myname/src (which has 16 characters) is s, then the function sets

              reply=(s 16)

       The  directory  name  so  returned is compared with possible static names for parts of the
       directory path, as described below; it is used if the prefix length  matched  (16  in  the
       example) is longer than that matched by any static name.

       It  is  not  a  requirement that a function implements both n and d calls; for example, it
       might be appropriate for certain dynamic forms of expansion not to be contracted to names.
       In  that  case  any  call  with  the first argument d should cause a non-zero status to be
       returned.

       The completion system calls `zsh_directory_name c' followed by equivalent  calls  to  ele‐
       ments  of  the  array  zsh_directory_name_functions,  if  it  exists, in order to complete
       dynamic names for directories.  The code for this should be as for  any  other  completion
       function as described in zshcompsys(1).

       As a working example, here is a function that expands any dynamic names beginning with the
       string p: to directories below /home/pws/perforce.  In this simple case a static name  for
       the directory would be just as effective.

              zsh_directory_name() {
                emulate -L zsh
                setopt extendedglob
                local -a match mbegin mend
                if [[ $1 = d ]]; then
                  # turn the directory into a name
                  if [[ $2 = (#b)(/home/pws/perforce/)([^/]##)* ]]; then
                    typeset -ga reply
                    reply=(p:$match[2] $(( ${#match[1]} + ${#match[2]} )) )
                  else
                    return 1
                  fi
                elif [[ $1 = n ]]; then
                  # turn the name into a directory
                  [[ $2 != (#b)p:(?*) ]] && return 1
                  typeset -ga reply
                  reply=(/home/pws/perforce/$match[1])
                elif [[ $1 = c ]]; then
                  # complete names
                  local expl
                  local -a dirs
                  dirs=(/home/pws/perforce/*(/:t))
                  dirs=(p:${^dirs})
                  _wanted dynamic-dirs expl 'dynamic directory' compadd -S\] -a dirs
                  return
                else
                  return 1
                fi
                return 0
              }

   Static named directories
       A  `~'  followed  by anything not already covered consisting of any number of alphanumeric
       characters or underscore (`_'), hyphen (`-'), or dot (`.') is looked up as a named  direc‐
       tory,  and  replaced by the value of that named directory if found.  Named directories are
       typically home directories for users on the system.  They may also be defined if the  text
       after the `~' is the name of a string shell parameter whose value begins with a `/'.  Note
       that trailing slashes will be removed from the path to the directory (though the  original
       parameter is not modified).

       It is also possible to define directory names using the -d option to the hash builtin.

       When  the  shell  prints  a  path  (e.g. when expanding %~ in prompts or when printing the
       directory stack), the path is checked to see if it has a named directory  as  its  prefix.
       If  so,  then the prefix portion is replaced with a `~' followed by the name of the direc‐
       tory.  The shorter of the two ways of referring to the directory is used, i.e. either  the
       directory name or the full path; the name is used if they are the same length.  The param‐
       eters $PWD and $OLDPWD are never abbreviated in this fashion.

   `=' expansion
       If a word begins with an unquoted `=' and the EQUALS option is set, the remainder  of  the
       word  is  taken  as  the name of a command.  If a command exists by that name, the word is
       replaced by the full pathname of the command.

   Notes
       Filename expansion is performed on the right hand side of a parameter assignment,  includ‐
       ing  those  appearing  after commands of the typeset family.  In this case, the right hand
       side will be treated as a colon-separated list in the manner of  the  PATH  parameter,  so
       that a `~' or an `=' following a `:' is eligible for expansion.  All such behaviour can be
       disabled by quoting the `~', the `=', or the whole expression (but not simply the  colon);
       the EQUALS option is also respected.

       If  the  option MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST is set, any unquoted shell argument in the form `identi‐
       fier=expression' becomes eligible for file expansion as described in  the  previous  para‐
       graph.  Quoting the first `=' also inhibits this.

FILENAME GENERATION
       If  a word contains an unquoted instance of one of the characters `*', `(', `|', `<', `[',
       or `?', it is regarded as a pattern for filename generation, unless  the  GLOB  option  is
       unset.   If the EXTENDED_GLOB option is set, the `^' and `#' characters also denote a pat‐
       tern; otherwise they are not treated specially by the shell.

       The word is replaced with a list of sorted filenames that match the pattern.  If no match‐
       ing  pattern  is  found,  the shell gives an error message, unless the NULL_GLOB option is
       set, in which case the word is deleted; or unless the NOMATCH option is  unset,  in  which
       case the word is left unchanged.

       In  filename generation, the character `/' must be matched explicitly; also, a `.' must be
       matched explicitly at the beginning of a pattern or after  a  `/',  unless  the  GLOB_DOTS
       option  is  set.   No filename generation pattern matches the files `.' or `..'.  In other
       instances of pattern matching, the `/' and `.' are not treated specially.

   Glob Operators
       *      Matches any string, including the null string.

       ?      Matches any character.

       [...]  Matches any of the enclosed characters.  Ranges of characters can be  specified  by
              separating two characters by a `-'.  A `-' or `]' may be matched by including it as
              the first character in the list.  There are also several named classes  of  charac‐
              ters,  in  the  form `[:name:]' with the following meanings.  The first set use the
              macros provided by the operating system to test for the  given  character  combina‐
              tions, including any modifications due to local language settings, see ctype(3):

              [:alnum:]
                     The character is alphanumeric

              [:alpha:]
                     The character is alphabetic

              [:ascii:]
                     The  character is 7-bit, i.e. is a single-byte character without the top bit
                     set.

              [:blank:]
                     The character is either space or tab

              [:cntrl:]
                     The character is a control character

              [:digit:]
                     The character is a decimal digit

              [:graph:]
                     The character is a printable character other than whitespace

              [:lower:]
                     The character is a lowercase letter

              [:print:]
                     The character is printable

              [:punct:]
                     The character is printable but neither alphanumeric nor whitespace

              [:space:]
                     The character is whitespace

              [:upper:]
                     The character is an uppercase letter

              [:xdigit:]
                     The character is a hexadecimal digit

              Another set of named classes is handled internally by the shell and is  not  sensi‐
              tive to the locale:

              [:IDENT:]
                     The  character  is  allowed  to  form  part of a shell identifier, such as a
                     parameter name

              [:IFS:]
                     The character is used as an input field separator, i.e. is contained in  the
                     IFS parameter

              [:IFSSPACE:]
                     The character is an IFS white space character; see the documentation for IFS
                     in the zshparam(1) manual page.

              [:WORD:]
                     The character is treated as part of a word; this test is  sensitive  to  the
                     value of the WORDCHARS parameter

              Note  that  the  square brackets are additional to those enclosing the whole set of
              characters, so to test for a single alphanumeric character you need  `[[:alnum:]]'.
              Named character sets can be used alongside other types, e.g. `[[:alpha:]0-9]'.

       [^...]
       [!...] Like [...], except that it matches any character which is not in the given set.

       <[x]-[y]>
              Matches  any  number  in the range x to y, inclusive.  Either of the numbers may be
              omitted to make the range open-ended; hence `<->' matches  any  number.   To  match
              individual digits, the [...] form is more efficient.

              Be  careful when using other wildcards adjacent to patterns of this form; for exam‐
              ple, <0-9>* will actually match any number whatsoever at the start of  the  string,
              since  the  `<0-9>'  will match the first digit, and the `*' will match any others.
              This is a trap for the unwary, but is in fact an inevitable consequence of the rule
              that   the   longest   possible   match   always  succeeds.   Expressions  such  as
              `<0-9>[^[:digit:]]*' can be used instead.

       (...)  Matches the enclosed pattern.  This is used for grouping.  If the  KSH_GLOB  option
              is  set,  then a `@', `*', `+', `?' or `!' immediately preceding the `(' is treated
              specially, as detailed below. The option SH_GLOB  prevents  bare  parentheses  from
              being used in this way, though the KSH_GLOB option is still available.

              Note  that grouping cannot extend over multiple directories: it is an error to have
              a `/' within a group (this only applies for patterns used in filename  generation).
              There  is  one exception:  a group of the form (pat/)# appearing as a complete path
              segment can match a sequence of directories.  For  example,  foo/(a*/)#bar  matches
              foo/bar, foo/any/bar, foo/any/anyother/bar, and so on.

       x|y    Matches either x or y.  This operator has lower precedence than any other.  The `|'
              character must be within parentheses, to avoid interpretation as a pipeline.

       ^x     (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches anything except the pattern  x.   This
              has  a  higher  precedence  than  `/', so `^foo/bar' will search directories in `.'
              except `./foo' for a file named `bar'.

       x~y    (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Match anything that matches the pattern x  but
              does  not  match  y.   This  has  lower precedence than any operator except `|', so
              `*/*~foo/bar' will search for all files in all directories in `.'  and then exclude
              `foo/bar'  if  there  was  such  a  match.   Multiple  patterns  can be excluded by
              `foo~bar~baz'.  In the exclusion pattern (y), `/' and `.' are not treated specially
              the way they usually are in globbing.

       x#     (Requires  EXTENDED_GLOB  to be set.)  Matches zero or more occurrences of the pat‐
              tern x.  This operator has high precedence; `12#' is equivalent to `1(2#)',  rather
              than  `(12)#'.  It is an error for an unquoted `#' to follow something which cannot
              be repeated; this includes an empty string, a pattern already followed by `##',  or
              parentheses  when part of a KSH_GLOB pattern (for example, `!(foo)#' is invalid and
              must be replaced by `*(!(foo))').

       x##    (Requires EXTENDED_GLOB to be set.)  Matches one or more occurrences of the pattern
              x.   This  operator  has  high precedence; `12##' is equivalent to `1(2##)', rather
              than `(12)##'.  No more than two active `#' characters may appear together.   (Note
              the  potential  clash with glob qualifiers in the form `1(2##)' which should there‐
              fore be avoided.)

   ksh-like Glob Operators
       If the KSH_GLOB option is set, the effects of parentheses can be modified by  a  preceding
       `@',  `*',  `+', `?' or `!'.  This character need not be unquoted to have special effects,
       but the `(' must be.

       @(...) Match the pattern in the parentheses.  (Like `(...)'.)

       *(...) Match any number of occurrences.  (Like `(...)#', except that  recursive  directory
              searching is not supported.)

       +(...) Match  at  least  one occurrence.  (Like `(...)##', except that recursive directory
              searching is not supported.)

       ?(...) Match zero or one occurrence.  (Like `(|...)'.)

       !(...) Match anything but the expression in parentheses.  (Like `(^(...))'.)

   Precedence
       The precedence of the operators given above is (highest) `^', `/', `~', `|' (lowest);  the
       remaining  operators  are  simply treated from left to right as part of a string, with `#'
       and `##' applying to the shortest possible preceding unit (i.e. a character, `?', `[...]',
       `<...>',  or  a  parenthesised expression).  As mentioned above, a `/' used as a directory
       separator may not appear inside parentheses, while a `|' must do so; in patterns  used  in
       other  contexts than filename generation (for example, in case statements and tests within
       `[[...]]'), a `/' is not special; and `/' is also not special after a `~'  appearing  out‐
       side parentheses in a filename pattern.

   Globbing Flags
       There  are various flags which affect any text to their right up to the end of the enclos‐
       ing group or to the end of the pattern; they require the EXTENDED_GLOB  option.  All  take
       the form (#X) where X may have one of the following forms:

       i      Case  insensitive:   upper  or  lower case characters in the pattern match upper or
              lower case characters.

       l      Lower case characters in the pattern match upper or lower  case  characters;  upper
              case characters in the pattern still only match upper case characters.

       I      Case sensitive:  locally negates the effect of i or l from that point on.

       b      Activate backreferences for parenthesised groups in the pattern; this does not work
              in filename generation.  When a  pattern  with  a  set  of  active  parentheses  is
              matched,  the  strings  matched  by  the groups are stored in the array $match, the
              indices of the beginning of the matched parentheses in the array $mbegin,  and  the
              indices  of the end in the array $mend, with the first element of each array corre‐
              sponding to the first parenthesised group, and so on.  These arrays are not  other‐
              wise  special  to the shell.  The indices use the same convention as does parameter
              substitution, so that elements of $mend and $mbegin may be used in subscripts;  the
              KSH_ARRAYS  option  is respected.  Sets of globbing flags are not considered paren‐
              thesised groups; only the first nine active parentheses can be referenced.

              For example,

                     foo="a string with a message"
                     if [[ $foo = (a|an)' '(#b)(*)' '* ]]; then
                       print ${foo[$mbegin[1],$mend[1]]}
                     fi

              prints `string with a'.  Note that the first parenthesis is  before  the  (#b)  and
              does not create a backreference.

              Backreferences  work with all forms of pattern matching other than filename genera‐
              tion,  but  note  that  when  performing  matches  on  an  entire  array,  such  as
              ${array#pattern},  or  a  global substitution, such as ${param//pat/repl}, only the
              data for the last match remains available.  In the case of global replacements this
              may still be useful.  See the example for the m flag below.

              The numbering of backreferences strictly follows the order of the opening parenthe‐
              ses from left to right in the pattern string, although sets of parentheses  may  be
              nested.  There are special rules for parentheses followed by `#' or `##'.  Only the
              last match of the parenthesis is remembered: for example, in `[[ abab = (#b)([ab])#
              ]]',  only the final `b' is stored in match[1].  Thus extra parentheses may be nec‐
              essary to match the complete segment: for example, use `X((ab|cd)#)Y'  to  match  a
              whole  string  of  either  `ab'  or  `cd'  between  `X' and `Y', using the value of
              $match[1] rather than $match[2].

              If the match fails none of the parameters is altered, so in some cases  it  may  be
              necessary  to  initialise  them  beforehand.  If some of the backreferences fail to
              match -- which happens if they are in an alternate branch which fails to match,  or
              if  they are followed by # and matched zero times -- then the matched string is set
              to the empty string, and the start and end indices are set to -1.

              Pattern matching with backreferences is slightly slower than without.

       B      Deactivate backreferences, negating the effect of the b flag from that point on.

       cN,M   The flag (#cN,M) can be used anywhere that the # or ## operators can be used except
              in  the expressions `(*/)#' and `(*/)##' in filename generation, where `/' has spe‐
              cial meaning; it cannot be combined with other globbing flags  and  a  bad  pattern
              error  occurs  if  it  is misplaced.  It is equivalent to the form {N,M} in regular
              expressions.  The previous character or group is required to match between N and  M
              times,  inclusive.  The form (#cN) requires exactly N matches; (#c,M) is equivalent
              to specifying N as 0; (#cN,) specifies that there is no maximum limit on the number
              of matches.

       m      Set  references to the match data for the entire string matched; this is similar to
              backreferencing and does not work in filename generation.   The  flag  must  be  in
              effect at the end of the pattern, i.e. not local to a group. The parameters $MATCH,
              $MBEGIN and $MEND will be set to the string matched  and  to  the  indices  of  the
              beginning  and  end  of the string, respectively.  This is most useful in parameter
              substitutions, as otherwise the string matched is obvious.

              For example,

                     arr=(veldt jynx grimps waqf zho buck)
                     print ${arr//(#m)[aeiou]/${(U)MATCH}}

              forces all the matches (i.e. all  vowels)  into  uppercase,  printing  `vEldt  jynx
              grImps wAqf zhO bUck'.

              Unlike  backreferences, there is no speed penalty for using match references, other
              than the extra substitutions required for the replacement strings in cases such  as
              the example shown.

       M      Deactivate the m flag, hence no references to match data will be created.

       anum   Approximate  matching: num errors are allowed in the string matched by the pattern.
              The rules for this are described in the next subsection.

       s, e   Unlike the other flags, these have only a local effect, and each must appear on its
              own:  `(#s)' and `(#e)' are the only valid forms.  The `(#s)' flag succeeds only at
              the start of the test string, and the `(#e)' flag succeeds only at the end  of  the
              test  string; they correspond to `^' and `$' in standard regular expressions.  They
              are useful for matching path segments in patterns other than those in filename gen‐
              eration  (where  path  segments  are in any case treated separately).  For example,
              `*((#s)|/)test((#e)|/)*' matches a path segment `test'  in  any  of  the  following
              strings: test, test/at/start, at/end/test, in/test/middle.

              Another  use  is in parameter substitution; for example `${array/(#s)A*Z(#e)}' will
              remove only elements of an array which match the complete pattern `A*Z'.  There are
              other  ways  of performing many operations of this type, however the combination of
              the substitution operations `/' and `//' with the `(#s)' and `(#e)' flags  provides
              a single simple and memorable method.

              Note that assertions of the form `(^(#s))' also work, i.e. match anywhere except at
              the  start  of  the  string,  although  this  actually  means  `anything  except  a
              zero-length  portion  at  the  start of the string'; you need to use `(""~(#s))' to
              match a zero-length portion of the string not at the start.

       q      A `q' and everything up to the  closing  parenthesis  of  the  globbing  flags  are
              ignored  by the pattern matching code.  This is intended to support the use of glob
              qualifiers, see below.  The result is that the pattern `(#b)(*).c(#q.)' can be used
              both  for  globbing  and  for  matching  against a string.  In the former case, the
              `(#q.)' will be treated as a glob qualifier and the  `(#b)'  will  not  be  useful,
              while  in  the  latter case the `(#b)' is useful for backreferences and the `(#q.)'
              will be ignored.  Note that colon modifiers in the glob  qualifiers  are  also  not
              applied in ordinary pattern matching.

       u      Respect the current locale in determining the presence of multibyte characters in a
              pattern, provided the shell was compiled with  MULTIBYTE_SUPPORT.   This  overrides
              the  MULTIBYTE  option; the default behaviour is taken from the option.  Compare U.
              (Mnemonic: typically multibyte characters are from Unicode in the  UTF-8  encoding,
              although any extension of ASCII supported by the system library may be used.)

       U      All  characters  are considered to be a single byte long.  The opposite of u.  This
              overrides the MULTIBYTE option.

       For example, the test string fooxx can be matched by the pattern  (#i)FOOXX,  but  not  by
       (#l)FOOXX,  (#i)FOO(#I)XX or ((#i)FOOX)X.  The string (#ia2)readme specifies case-insensi‐
       tive matching of readme with up to two errors.

       When using the ksh syntax for grouping both KSH_GLOB and EXTENDED_GLOB must be set and the
       left  parenthesis should be preceded by @.  Note also that the flags do not affect letters
       inside [...] groups, in other  words  (#i)[a-z]  still  matches  only  lowercase  letters.
       Finally,  note  that when examining whole paths case-insensitively every directory must be
       searched for all files which match, so that a pattern  of  the  form  (#i)/foo/bar/...  is
       potentially slow.

   Approximate Matching
       When  matching  approximately,  the  shell keeps a count of the errors found, which cannot
       exceed the number specified in the (#anum) flags.  Four types of error are recognised:

       1.     Different characters, as in fooxbar and fooybar.

       2.     Transposition of characters, as in banana and abnana.

       3.     A character missing in the target string, as  with  the  pattern  road  and  target
              string rod.

       4.     An extra character appearing in the target string, as with stove and strove.

       Thus,  the  pattern  (#a3)abcd  matches dcba, with the errors occurring by using the first
       rule twice and the second once, grouping the string as [d][cb][a] and [a][bc][d].

       Non-literal parts of the pattern must match exactly,  including  characters  in  character
       ranges:  hence  (#a1)???   matches  strings of length four, by applying rule 4 to an empty
       part of the pattern, but not strings of length two, since all the  ?  must  match.   Other
       characters  which  must  match exactly are initial dots in filenames (unless the GLOB_DOTS
       option is set), and all slashes in filenames, so that a/bc is two errors  from  ab/c  (the
       slash  cannot  be transposed with another character).  Similarly, errors are counted sepa‐
       rately for non-contiguous strings in the pattern, so that (ab|cd)ef  is  two  errors  from
       aebf.

       When  using  exclusion  via the ~ operator, approximate matching is treated entirely sepa‐
       rately for the excluded part and must be activated separately.  Thus,  (#a1)README~READ_ME
       matches READ.ME but not READ_ME, as the trailing READ_ME is matched without approximation.
       However, (#a1)README~(#a1)READ_ME does not match any pattern of the form  READ?ME  as  all
       such forms are now excluded.

       Apart  from exclusions, there is only one overall error count; however, the maximum errors
       allowed may be altered locally, and this can  be  delimited  by  grouping.   For  example,
       (#a1)cat((#a0)dog)fox  allows  one error in total, which may not occur in the dog section,
       and the pattern (#a1)cat(#a0)dog(#a1)fox is equivalent.  Note that the point at  which  an
       error is first found is the crucial one for establishing whether to use approximation; for
       example, (#a1)abc(#a0)xyz will not match abcdxyz, because the error  occurs  at  the  `x',
       where approximation is turned off.

       Entire  path  segments  may  be  matched  approximately,  so  that  `(#a1)/foo/d/is/avail‐
       able/at/the/bar' allows one error in any path segment.  This is much less  efficient  than
       without the (#a1), however, since every directory in the path must be scanned for a possi‐
       ble approximate match.  It is best to place the (#a1) after any path  segments  which  are
       known to be correct.

   Recursive Globbing
       A  pathname  component  of  the  form  `(foo/)#' matches a path consisting of zero or more
       directories matching the pattern foo.

       As a shorthand, `**/' is equivalent to `(*/)#'; note that this therefore matches files  in
       the current directory as well as subdirectories.  Thus:

              ls (*/)#bar

       or

              ls **/bar

       does  a  recursive  directory search for files named `bar' (potentially including the file
       `bar' in the current directory).  This form does not follow symbolic links;  the  alterna‐
       tive  form `***/' does, but is otherwise identical.  Neither of these can be combined with
       other forms of globbing within the same path segment; in  that  case,  the  `*'  operators
       revert to their usual effect.

   Glob Qualifiers
       Patterns  used  for filename generation may end in a list of qualifiers enclosed in paren‐
       theses.  The qualifiers specify which filenames that otherwise  match  the  given  pattern
       will be inserted in the argument list.

       If  the option BARE_GLOB_QUAL is set, then a trailing set of parentheses containing no `|'
       or `(' characters (or `~' if it is special) is taken as a set of glob qualifiers.  A  glob
       subexpression  that would normally be taken as glob qualifiers, for example `(^x)', can be
       forced to be treated as part of the glob pattern by doubling the parentheses, in this case
       producing `((^x))'.

       If  the  option EXTENDED_GLOB is set, a different syntax for glob qualifiers is available,
       namely `(#qx)' where x is any of the same glob qualifiers used in the other  format.   The
       qualifiers  must still appear at the end of the pattern.  However, with this syntax multi‐
       ple glob qualifiers may be chained together.  They are treated as a  logical  AND  of  the
       individual  sets  of  flags.   Also,  as the syntax is unambiguous, the expression will be
       treated as glob qualifiers just as long any parentheses contained within it are  balanced;
       appearance  of  `|',  `(' or `~' does not negate the effect.  Note that qualifiers will be
       recognised in this form even if a bare glob qualifier exists at the end  of  the  pattern,
       for  example  `*(#q*)(.)' will recognise executable regular files if both options are set;
       however, mixed syntax should probably be avoided for  the  sake  of  clarity.   Note  that
       within  conditions  using the `[[' form the presence of a parenthesised expression (#q...)
       at the end of a string indicates that globbing should be  performed;  the  expression  may
       include  glob  qualifiers, but it is also valid if it is simply (#q).  This does not apply
       to the right hand side of pattern match operators as the syntax already has  special  sig‐
       nificance.

       A qualifier may be any one of the following:

       /      directories

       F      `full'  (i.e. non-empty) directories.  Note that the opposite sense (^F) expands to
              empty directories and all non-directories.  Use (/^F) for empty directories.

       .      plain files

       @      symbolic links

       =      sockets

       p      named pipes (FIFOs)

       *      executable plain files (0100)

       %      device files (character or block special)

       %b     block special files

       %c     character special files

       r      owner-readable files (0400)

       w      owner-writable files (0200)

       x      owner-executable files (0100)

       A      group-readable files (0040)

       I      group-writable files (0020)

       E      group-executable files (0010)

       R      world-readable files (0004)

       W      world-writable files (0002)

       X      world-executable files (0001)

       s      setuid files (04000)

       S      setgid files (02000)

       t      files with the sticky bit (01000)

       fspec  files with access rights matching spec. This spec may be a octal number  optionally
              preceded  by  a  `=',  a  `+',  or a `-'. If none of these characters is given, the
              behavior is the same as for `='. The octal number describes the  mode  bits  to  be
              expected,  if  combined  with  a  `=',  the  value  given must match the file-modes
              exactly, with a `+', at least the bits in the given  number  must  be  set  in  the
              file-modes,  and  with  a `-', the bits in the number must not be set. Giving a `?'
              instead of a octal digit anywhere in the number ensures that the corresponding bits
              in the file-modes are not checked, this is only useful in combination with `='.

              If  the  qualifier  `f'  is followed by any other character anything up to the next
              matching character (`[', `{', and `<' match `]', `}',  and  `>'  respectively,  any
              other  character  matches  itself) is taken as a list of comma-separated sub-specs.
              Each sub-spec may be either an octal number as described above or a list of any  of
              the characters `u', `g', `o', and `a', followed by a `=', a `+', or a `-', followed
              by a list of any of the characters `r', `w', `x', `s', and `t', or an octal  digit.
              The  first  list  of characters specify which access rights are to be checked. If a
              `u' is given, those for the owner of the file are used, if a `g' is given, those of
              the  group  are checked, a `o' means to test those of other users, and the `a' says
              to test all three groups. The `=', `+', and `-' again says how the modes are to  be
              checked and have the same meaning as described for the first form above. The second
              list of characters finally says which access rights are to  be  expected:  `r'  for
              read  access,  `w'  for  write access, `x' for the right to execute the file (or to
              search a directory), `s' for the setuid and setgid bits, and  `t'  for  the  sticky
              bit.

              Thus,  `*(f70?)'  gives  the files for which the owner has read, write, and execute
              permission, and for which other group members have no rights,  independent  of  the
              permissions  for  other users. The pattern `*(f-100)' gives all files for which the
              owner does not have execute permission, and `*(f:gu+w,o-rx:)' gives the  files  for
              which  the owner and the other members of the group have at least write permission,
              and for which other users don't have read or execute permission.

       estring
       +cmd   The string will be executed as shell code.  The filename will be  included  in  the
              list  if and only if the code returns a zero status (usually the status of the last
              command).

              In the first form, the first character after the `e' will be used  as  a  separator
              and  anything  up to the next matching separator will be taken  as the string; `[',
              `{', and `<' match `]', `}', and  `>',  respectively,  while  any  other  character
              matches  itself.  Note that expansions must be quoted in the string to prevent them
              from being expanded before globbing is done.  string  is  then  executed  as  shell
              code.   The  string globqual is appended to the array zsh_eval_context the duration
              of execution.

              During the execution of string the filename currently being tested is available  in
              the  parameter  REPLY; the parameter may be altered to a string to be inserted into
              the list instead of the original filename.  In addition, the parameter reply may be
              set  to  an  array  or  a string, which overrides the value of REPLY.  If set to an
              array, the latter is inserted into the command line word by word.

              For example, suppose a directory contains a single file `lonely'.  Then the expres‐
              sion  `*(e:'reply=(${REPLY}{1,2})':)'  will cause the words `lonely1' and `lonely2'
              to be inserted into the command line.  Note the quoting of string.

              The form +cmd has the same effect, but no delimiters appear around  cmd.   Instead,
              cmd  is  taken  as  the  longest  sequence  of  characters following the + that are
              alphanumeric or underscore.  Typically cmd will be the name  of  a  shell  function
              that contains the appropriate test.  For example,

                     nt() { [[ $REPLY -nt $NTREF ]] }
                     NTREF=reffile
                     ls -l *(+nt)

              lists  all  files  in the directory that have been modified more recently than ref‐
              file.

       ddev   files on the device dev

       l[-|+]ct
              files having a link count less than ct (-), greater than ct (+), or equal to ct

       U      files owned by the effective user ID

       G      files owned by the effective group ID

       uid    files owned by user ID id if that is a number.   Otherwise,  id  specifies  a  user
              name:  the  character  after  the  `u'  will be taken as a separator and the string
              between it and the next matching separator will be  taken  as  a  user  name.   The
              starting separators `[', `{', and `<' match the final separators `]', `}', and `>',
              respectively; any other character matches itself.  The  selected  files  are  those
              owned  by this user.  For example, `u:foo:' or `u[foo]' selects files owned by user
              `foo'.

       gid    like uid but with group IDs or names

       a[Mwhms][-|+]n
              files accessed exactly n days ago.  Files accessed  within  the  last  n  days  are
              selected  using  a  negative value for n (-n).  Files accessed more than n days ago
              are selected by a positive n value (+n).  Optional unit specifiers `M',  `w',  `h',
              `m'  or  `s' (e.g. `ah5') cause the check to be performed with months (of 30 days),
              weeks, hours, minutes or seconds instead of days, respectively.   An  explicit  `d'
              for days is also allowed.

              Any  fractional part of the difference between the access time and the current part
              in the appropriate units  is  ignored  in  the  comparison.   For  instance,  `echo
              *(ah-5)' would echo files accessed within the last five hours, while `echo *(ah+5)'
              would echo files accessed at least six hours ago, as times  strictly  between  five
              and six hours are treated as five hours.

       m[Mwhms][-|+]n
              like the file access qualifier, except that it uses the file modification time.

       c[Mwhms][-|+]n
              like the file access qualifier, except that it uses the file inode change time.

       L[+|-]n
              files less than n bytes (-), more than n bytes (+), or exactly n bytes in length.

              If  this flag is directly followed by a size specifier `k' (`K'), `m' (`M'), or `p'
              (`P') (e.g. `Lk-50') the check is performed with kilobytes,  megabytes,  or  blocks
              (of  512  bytes) instead.  (On some systems additional specifiers are available for
              gigabytes, `g' or `G', and terabytes, `t' or `T'.) If a size specifier  is  used  a
              file is regarded as "exactly" the size if the file size rounded up to the next unit
              is equal to the test size.  Hence `*(Lm1)' matches  files  from  1  byte  up  to  1
              Megabyte inclusive.  Note also that the set of files "less than" the test size only
              includes files that would not match the equality test; hence `*(Lm-1)' only matches
              files of zero size.

       ^      negates all qualifiers following it

       -      toggles  between making the qualifiers work on symbolic links (the default) and the
              files they point to

       M      sets the MARK_DIRS option for the current pattern

       T      appends a trailing qualifier mark to the filenames,  analogous  to  the  LIST_TYPES
              option, for the current pattern (overrides M)

       N      sets the NULL_GLOB option for the current pattern

       D      sets the GLOB_DOTS option for the current pattern

       n      sets the NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT option for the current pattern

       Yn     enables  short-circuit  mode:  the  pattern will expand to at most n filenames.  If
              more than n matches exist, only the first n matches in  directory  traversal  order
              will be considered.

              Implies oN when no oc qualifier is used.

       oc     specifies how the names of the files should be sorted. If c is n they are sorted by
              name; if it is L they are sorted depending on the size (length) of the files; if  l
              they  are  sorted by the number of links; if a, m, or c they are sorted by the time
              of the last access, modification, or inode change respectively; if d, files in sub‐
              directories  appear  before  those  in  the  current directory at each level of the
              search -- this is best combined with other criteria, for example `odon' to sort  on
              names  for  files  within  the same directory; if N, no sorting is performed.  Note
              that a, m, and c compare the age against the current time, hence the first name  in
              the  list  is  the youngest file. Also note that the modifiers ^ and - are used, so
              `*(^-oL)' gives a list of all files sorted by file size in descending  order,  fol‐
              lowing  any symbolic links.  Unless oN is used, multiple order specifiers may occur
              to resolve ties.

              The default sorting is n (by name) unless the Y glob qualifier is  used,  in  which
              case it is N (unsorted).

              oe and o+ are special cases; they are each followed by shell code, delimited as for
              the e glob qualifier and the + glob qualifier respectively (see above).   The  code
              is  executed  for each matched file with the parameter REPLY set to the name of the
              file on entry and globsort appended to zsh_eval_context.  The  code  should  modify
              the parameter REPLY in some fashion.  On return, the value of the parameter is used
              instead of the file name as the string on which to sort.  Unlike other sort  opera‐
              tors, oe and o+ may be repeated, but note that the maximum number of sort operators
              of any kind that may appear in any glob expression is 12.

       Oc     like `o', but sorts in descending order; i.e. `*(^oc)' is the same as  `*(Oc)'  and
              `*(^Oc)'  is  the  same as `*(oc)'; `Od' puts files in the current directory before
              those in subdirectories at each level of the search.

       [beg[,end]]
              specifies which of the matched filenames should be included in the  returned  list.
              The  syntax  is  the  same as for array subscripts. beg and the optional end may be
              mathematical expressions. As in parameter subscripting they may be negative to make
              them  count  from  the last match backward. E.g.: `*(-OL[1,3])' gives a list of the
              names of the three largest files.

       Pstring
              The string will be prepended to each glob match as  a  separate  word.   string  is
              delimited  in  the  same  way as arguments to the e glob qualifier described above.
              The qualifier can be repeated; the words  are  prepended  separately  so  that  the
              resulting  command line contains the words in the same order they were given in the
              list of glob qualifiers.

              A typical use for this is to prepend an option before all  occurrences  of  a  file
              name;  for  example, the pattern `*(P:-f:)' produces the command line arguments `-f
              file1 -f file2 ...'

              If the modifier ^ is active, then string will be  appended  instead  of  prepended.
              Prepending and appending is done independently so both can be used on the same glob
              expression; for example by writing  `*(P:foo:^P:bar:^P:baz:)'  which  produces  the
              command line arguments `foo baz file1 bar ...'

       More  than one of these lists can be combined, separated by commas. The whole list matches
       if at least one of the sublists matches (they are `or'ed, the qualifiers in  the  sublists
       are  `and'ed).  Some qualifiers, however, affect all matches generated, independent of the
       sublist in which they are given.  These are the qualifiers `M', `T', `N', `D',  `n',  `o',
       `O' and the subscripts given in brackets (`[...]').

       If  a  `:'  appears in a qualifier list, the remainder of the expression in parenthesis is
       interpreted as a modifier (see the section `Modifiers'  in  the  section  `History  Expan‐
       sion').   Each  modifier  must be introduced by a separate `:'.  Note also that the result
       after modification does not have to be an existing file.  The name of  any  existing  file
       can be followed by a modifier of the form `(:..)' even if no actual filename generation is
       performed, although note that the presence of the parentheses causes the entire expression
       to be subjected to any global pattern matching options such as NULL_GLOB. Thus:

              ls *(-/)

       lists all directories and symbolic links that point to directories, and

              ls *(%W)

       lists all world-writable device files in the current directory, and

              ls *(W,X)

       lists all files in the current directory that are world-writable or world-executable, and

              echo /tmp/foo*(u0^@:t)

       outputs  the  basename  of  all  root-owned files beginning with the string `foo' in /tmp,
       ignoring symlinks, and

              ls *.*~(lex|parse).[ch](^D^l1)

       lists all files having a link count of one whose names contain a dot (but not those start‐
       ing  with  a  dot,  since  GLOB_DOTS  is explicitly switched off) except for lex.c, lex.h,
       parse.c and parse.h.

              print b*.pro(#q:s/pro/shmo/)(#q.:s/builtin/shmiltin/)

       demonstrates how colon modifiers and other qualifiers may be chained together.  The  ordi‐
       nary qualifier `.' is applied first, then the colon modifiers in order from left to right.
       So if EXTENDED_GLOB is set and the base pattern matches the regular file builtin.pro,  the
       shell will print `shmiltin.shmo'.



ZSHPARAM(1)                          General Commands Manual                          ZSHPARAM(1)



NAME
       zshparam - zsh parameters

DESCRIPTION
       A  parameter  has a name, a value, and a number of attributes.  A name may be any sequence
       of alphanumeric characters and underscores, or the single characters `*', `@',  `#',  `?',
       `-',  `$',  or  `!'.   The value may be a scalar (a string), an integer, an array (indexed
       numerically), or an associative array (an unordered set of name-value  pairs,  indexed  by
       name).   To  declare  the type of a parameter, or to assign a scalar or integer value to a
       parameter, use the typeset builtin.

       The value of a scalar or integer parameter may also be assigned by writing:

              name=value

       If the integer attribute, -i, is set for name, the value is subject to arithmetic  evalua‐
       tion.  Furthermore, by replacing `=' with `+=', a parameter can be added or appended to.

       In  scalar  assignment,  value  is  expanded  as a single string, in which the elements of
       arrays are joined  together;  filename  expansion  is  not  performed  unless  the  option
       GLOB_ASSIGN  is  set.   See the section `Array Parameters' for additional forms of assign‐
       ment.

       To refer to the value of a parameter, write `$name' or `${name}'.  See Parameter Expansion
       in  zshexpn(1) for complete details.  This section also explains the effect of the differ‐
       ence between scalar and array assignment on parameter expansion.

       In the parameter lists that follow, the mark `<S>' indicates that the  parameter  is  spe‐
       cial.   Special  parameters  cannot  have  their  type changed or their readonly attribute
       turned off, and if a special parameter is unset, then later recreated, the special proper‐
       ties  will  be retained.  `<Z>' indicates that the parameter does not exist when the shell
       initializes in sh or ksh emulation mode.

ARRAY PARAMETERS
       To assign an array value, write one of:

              set -A name value ...
              name=(value ...)

       If no parameter name exists, an ordinary array parameter is  created.   If  the  parameter
       name exists and is a scalar, it is replaced by a new array.  Ordinary array parameters may
       also be explicitly declared with:

              typeset -a name

       Associative arrays must be declared before assignment, by using:

              typeset -A name

       When name refers to an associative array, the list in  an  assignment  is  interpreted  as
       alternating keys and values:

              set -A name key value ...
              name=(key value ...)

       Every  key  must  have  a value in this case.  Note that this assigns to the entire array,
       deleting any elements that do not appear in the list.

       To create an empty array (including associative arrays), use one of:

              set -A name
              name=()

   Array Subscripts
       Individual elements of an array may be selected using a subscript.   A  subscript  of  the
       form  `[exp]'  selects the single element exp, where exp is an arithmetic expression which
       will be subject to arithmetic expansion as if it were surrounded by `$((...))'.  The  ele‐
       ments  are  numbered  beginning  with 1, unless the KSH_ARRAYS option is set in which case
       they are numbered from zero.

       Subscripts may be used inside braces used to delimit a parameter name, thus `${foo[2]}' is
       equivalent to `$foo[2]'.  If the KSH_ARRAYS option is set, the braced form is the only one
       that works, as bracketed expressions otherwise are not treated as subscripts.

       If the KSH_ARRAYS option is not set, then by default accesses to an array element  with  a
       subscript that evaluates to zero return an empty string, while an attempt to write such an
       element is treated as an error.  For backward compatibility the KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT  option
       can  be set to cause subscript values 0 and 1 to be equivalent; see the description of the
       option in zshoptions(1).

       The same subscripting syntax is used for associative arrays,  except  that  no  arithmetic
       expansion  is applied to exp.  However, the parsing rules for arithmetic expressions still
       apply, which affects the way that certain special characters must be protected from inter‐
       pretation.  See Subscript Parsing below for details.

       A  subscript of the form `[*]' or `[@]' evaluates to all elements of an array; there is no
       difference between the two except when they  appear  within  double  quotes.   `"$foo[*]"'
       evaluates  to  `"$foo[1]  $foo[2]  ..."',  whereas  `"$foo[@]"'  evaluates  to  `"$foo[1]"
       "$foo[2]" ...'.  For associative arrays, `[*]' or `[@]' evaluate to all the values, in  no
       particular  order.  Note that this does not substitute the keys; see the documentation for
       the `k' flag under Parameter Expansion Flags in zshexpn(1) for complete details.  When  an
       array  parameter  is referenced as `$name' (with no subscript) it evaluates to `$name[*]',
       unless the KSH_ARRAYS option is set in which case it evaluates  to  `${name[0]}'  (for  an
       associative  array, this means the value of the key `0', which may not exist even if there
       are values for other keys).

       A subscript of the form `[exp1,exp2]' selects all elements in  the  range  exp1  to  exp2,
       inclusive. (Associative arrays are unordered, and so do not support ranges.) If one of the
       subscripts evaluates to a negative number, say -n, then the nth element from  the  end  of
       the  array  is  used.  Thus `$foo[-3]' is the third element from the end of the array foo,
       and `$foo[1,-1]' is the same as `$foo[*]'.

       Subscripting may also be performed on non-array values, in which case the subscripts spec‐
       ify  a  substring  to  be  extracted.   For example, if FOO is set to `foobar', then `echo
       $FOO[2,5]' prints `ooba'.

   Array Element Assignment
       A subscript may be used on the left side of an assignment like so:

              name[exp]=value

       In this form of assignment the element or range  specified  by  exp  is  replaced  by  the
       expression  on  the right side.  An array (but not an associative array) may be created by
       assignment to a range or element.  Arrays do not nest, so assigning a  parenthesized  list
       of values to an element or range changes the number of elements in the array, shifting the
       other elements to accommodate the new values.  (This  is  not  supported  for  associative
       arrays.)

       This syntax also works as an argument to the typeset command:

              typeset "name[exp]"=value

       The  value  may  not be a parenthesized list in this case; only single-element assignments
       may be made with typeset.  Note that quotes are necessary in  this  case  to  prevent  the
       brackets  from  being interpreted as filename generation operators.  The noglob precommand
       modifier could be used instead.

       To delete an element of an ordinary array, assign `()' to that element.  To delete an ele‐
       ment of an associative array, use the unset command:

              unset "name[exp]"

   Subscript Flags
       If  the  opening bracket, or the comma in a range, in any subscript expression is directly
       followed by an opening parenthesis, the string up to the matching closing one  is  consid‐
       ered to be a list of flags, as in `name[(flags)exp]'.

       The  flags s, n and b take an argument; the delimiter is shown below as `:', but any char‐
       acter, or the matching pairs `(...)', `{...}', `[...]', or `<...>', may be used, but  note
       that  `<...>'  can only be used if the subscript is inside a double quoted expression or a
       parameter substitution enclosed in braces as otherwise the expression is interpreted as  a
       redirection.

       The flags currently understood are:

       w      If  the parameter subscripted is a scalar then this flag makes subscripting work on
              words instead of characters.  The default word separator is whitespace.  This  flag
              may not be used with the i or I flag.

       s:string:
              This  gives  the string that separates words (for use with the w flag).  The delim‐
              iter character : is arbitrary; see above.

       p      Recognize the same escape sequences as the print builtin in the string argument  of
              a subsequent `s' flag.

       f      If  the parameter subscripted is a scalar then this flag makes subscripting work on
              lines instead of characters, i.e. with elements separated by newlines.  This  is  a
              shorthand for `pws:\n:'.

       r      Reverse  subscripting: if this flag is given, the exp is taken as a pattern and the
              result is the first matching array element, substring or word (if the parameter  is
              an  array,  if  it  is  a  scalar,  or if it is a scalar and the `w' flag is given,
              respectively).  The subscript used is the number of the matching element,  so  that
              pairs of subscripts such as `$foo[(r)??,3]' and `$foo[(r)??,(r)f*]' are possible if
              the parameter is not an associative array.  If  the  parameter  is  an  associative
              array,  only the value part of each pair is compared to the pattern, and the result
              is that value.

              If a search through an ordinary array failed, the search sets the subscript to  one
              past the end of the array, and hence ${array[(r)pattern]} will substitute the empty
              string.  Thus the success of a search can be tested by  using  the  (i)  flag,  for
              example (assuming the option KSH_ARRAYS is not in effect):

                     [[ ${array[(i)pattern]} -le ${#array} ]]

              If KSH_ARRAYS is in effect, the -le should be replaced by -lt.

       R      Like  `r',  but  gives  the last match.  For associative arrays, gives all possible
              matches. May be used for assigning to ordinary array elements, but not for  assign‐
              ing  to  associative  arrays.  On failure, for normal arrays this has the effect of
              returning the element corresponding to subscript 0; this is empty unless one of the
              options KSH_ARRAYS or KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT is in effect.

              Note that in subscripts with both `r' and `R' pattern characters are active even if
              they were substituted for a parameter (regardless  of  the  setting  of  GLOB_SUBST
              which controls this feature in normal pattern matching).  The flag `e' can be added
              to inhibit pattern matching.  As this flag does not inhibit other forms of  substi‐
              tution,  care  is still required; using a parameter to hold the key has the desired
              effect:

                     key2='original key'
                     print ${array[(Re)$key2]}

       i      Like `r', but gives the index of the match instead; this may not be combined with a
              second  argument.   On the left side of an assignment, behaves like `r'.  For asso‐
              ciative arrays, the key part of each pair is compared to the pattern, and the first
              matching  key  found is the result.  On failure substitutes the length of the array
              plus one, as discussed under the description of `r', or the  empty  string  for  an
              associative array.

       I      Like  `i',  but gives the index of the last match, or all possible matching keys in
              an associative array.  On failure substitutes 0, or the empty string for  an  asso‐
              ciative  array.   This  flag  is  best  when testing for values or keys that do not
              exist.

       k      If used in a subscript on an associative array, this flag causes  the  keys  to  be
              interpreted as patterns, and returns the value for the first key found where exp is
              matched by the key.  Note this could be any such key as no ordering of  associative
              arrays is defined.  This flag does not work on the left side of an assignment to an
              associative array element.  If used on another type of parameter, this behaves like
              `r'.

       K      On  an  associative  array  this  is  like  `k' but returns all values where exp is
              matched by the keys.  On other types of parameters this has the same effect as `R'.

       n:expr:
              If combined with `r', `R', `i' or `I', makes them give the nth or  nth  last  match
              (if expr evaluates to n).  This flag is ignored when the array is associative.  The
              delimiter character : is arbitrary; see above.

       b:expr:
              If combined with `r', `R', `i' or `I', makes them begin at the nth or nth last ele‐
              ment,  word,  or character (if expr evaluates to n).  This flag is ignored when the
              array is associative.  The delimiter character : is arbitrary; see above.

       e      This flag causes any pattern matching that would be performed on the  subscript  to
              use  plain string matching instead.  Hence `${array[(re)*]}' matches only the array
              element whose value is *.  Note that other forms of substitution such as  parameter
              substitution are not inhibited.

              This flag can also be used to force * or @ to be interpreted as a single key rather
              than as a reference to all values.  It may be used for either purpose on  the  left
              side of an assignment.

       See  Parameter  Expansion Flags (zshexpn(1)) for additional ways to manipulate the results
       of array subscripting.

   Subscript Parsing
       This discussion applies mainly to associative array key strings and to patterns  used  for
       reverse  subscripting  (the  `r',  `R', `i', etc. flags), but it may also affect parameter
       substitutions that appear as part of an arithmetic expression in an ordinary subscript.

       It is possible to avoid the use of subscripts in assignments to associative array elements
       by using the syntax:

                 aa+=('key with "*strange*" characters' 'value string')

       This  adds  a new key/value pair if the key is not already present, and replaces the value
       for the existing key if it is.

       The basic rule to remember when writing a subscript expression is that  all  text  between
       the  opening  `['  and  the closing `]' is interpreted as if it were in double quotes (see
       zshmisc(1)).  However, unlike double quotes which normally cannot nest, subscript  expres‐
       sions  may  appear  inside double-quoted strings or inside other subscript expressions (or
       both!), so the rules have two important differences.

       The first difference is that brackets (`[' and `]') must appear as  balanced  pairs  in  a
       subscript  expression  unless they are preceded by a backslash (`\').  Therefore, within a
       subscript expression (and unlike true double-quoting) the sequence `\[' becomes  `[',  and
       similarly  `\]' becomes `]'.  This applies even in cases where a backslash is not normally
       required; for example, the pattern `[^[]' (to match  any  character  other  than  an  open
       bracket)  should  be  written  `[^\[]' in a reverse-subscript pattern.  However, note that
       `\[^\[\]' and even `\[^[]' mean the same thing, because backslashes  are  always  stripped
       when they appear before brackets!

       The  same  rule  applies  to parentheses (`(' and `)') and braces (`{' and `}'): they must
       appear either in balanced pairs or preceded by a backslash, and backslashes  that  protect
       parentheses  or  braces  are removed during parsing.  This is because parameter expansions
       may be surrounded by balanced braces, and  subscript  flags  are  introduced  by  balanced
       parentheses.

       The  second  difference  is  that  a  double-quote (`"') may appear as part of a subscript
       expression without being preceded by a backslash, and therefore that  the  two  characters
       `\"' remain as two characters in the subscript (in true double-quoting, `\"' becomes `"').
       However, because of the standard shell quoting rules, any double-quotes that  appear  must
       occur  in  balanced pairs unless preceded by a backslash.  This makes it more difficult to
       write a subscript expression that contains an odd number of double-quote  characters,  but
       the  reason for this difference is so that when a subscript expression appears inside true
       double-quotes, one can still write `\"' (rather than `\\\"') for `"'.

       To use an odd number of double quotes as a key in an assignment, use the  typeset  builtin
       and  an enclosing pair of double quotes; to refer to the value of that key, again use dou‐
       ble quotes:

              typeset -A aa
              typeset "aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"=QQQ
              print "$aa[one\"two\"three\"quotes]"

       It is important to note that the quoting rules do not change when  a  parameter  expansion
       with a subscript is nested inside another subscript expression.  That is, it is not neces‐
       sary to use additional backslashes within the inner subscript expression; they are removed
       only  once,  from the innermost subscript outwards.  Parameters are also expanded from the
       innermost subscript first, as each expansion is encountered left to  right  in  the  outer
       expression.

       A  further complication arises from a way in which subscript parsing is not different from
       double quote parsing.  As in true double-quoting, the sequences `\*', and `\@'  remain  as
       two characters when they appear in a subscript expression.  To use a literal `*' or `@' as
       an associative array key, the `e' flag must be used:

              typeset -A aa
              aa[(e)*]=star
              print $aa[(e)*]

       A last detail must be considered  when  reverse  subscripting  is  performed.   Parameters
       appearing  in the subscript expression are first expanded and then the complete expression
       is interpreted as a pattern.  This  has  two  effects:  first,  parameters  behave  as  if
       GLOB_SUBST  were  on  (and  it  cannot be turned off); second, backslashes are interpreted
       twice, once when parsing the array subscript and again when parsing  the  pattern.   In  a
       reverse  subscript,  it's necessary to use four backslashes to cause a single backslash to
       match literally in the pattern.  For complex patterns, it is often easiest to  assign  the
       desired  pattern to a parameter and then refer to that parameter in the subscript, because
       then the backslashes, brackets, parentheses, etc., are seen only when the complete expres‐
       sion  is converted to a pattern.  To match the value of a parameter literally in a reverse
       subscript, rather than as a pattern,  use  `${(q)name}'  (see  zshexpn(1))  to  quote  the
       expanded value.

       Note  that  the  `k' and `K' flags are reverse subscripting for an ordinary array, but are
       not reverse subscripting for an associative array!  (For an associative array, the keys in
       the  array  itself  are  interpreted  as patterns by those flags; the subscript is a plain
       string in that case.)

       One final note, not directly related to subscripting:  the  numeric  names  of  positional
       parameters (described below) are parsed specially, so for example `$2foo' is equivalent to
       `${2}foo'.  Therefore, to use subscript syntax to extract a substring  from  a  positional
       parameter,  the expansion must be surrounded by braces; for example, `${2[3,5]}' evaluates
       to the third through fifth characters of the second positional parameter, but `$2[3,5]' is
       the entire second parameter concatenated with the filename generation pattern `[3,5]'.

POSITIONAL PARAMETERS
       The  positional  parameters  provide access to the command-line arguments of a shell func‐
       tion, shell script, or the shell itself; see the section `Invocation', and also  the  sec‐
       tion  `Functions'.  The parameter n, where n is a number, is the nth positional parameter.
       The parameter `$0' is a special case, see the section `Parameters Set By The Shell'.

       The parameters *, @ and argv are arrays containing all  the  positional  parameters;  thus
       `$argv[n]',  etc.,  is  equivalent  to  simply  `$n'.  Note that the options KSH_ARRAYS or
       KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT apply to these arrays as well, so with either  of  those  options  set,
       `${argv[0]}' is equivalent to `$1' and so on.

       Positional  parameters  may be changed after the shell or function starts by using the set
       builtin, by assigning to the argv array, or by direct assignment  of  the  form  `n=value'
       where  n is the number of the positional parameter to be changed.  This also creates (with
       empty values) any of the positions from 1 to n that do  not  already  have  values.   Note
       that,  because  the  positional  parameters form an array, an array assignment of the form
       `n=(value ...)' is allowed, and has the effect of shifting all  the  values  at  positions
       greater than n by as many positions as necessary to accommodate the new values.

LOCAL PARAMETERS
       Shell  function  executions  delimit scopes for shell parameters.  (Parameters are dynami‐
       cally scoped.)  The typeset builtin, and its alternative forms declare, integer, local and
       readonly (but not export), can be used to declare a parameter as being local to the inner‐
       most scope.

       When a parameter is read or assigned to, the innermost existing parameter of that name  is
       used.   (That is, the local parameter hides any less-local parameter.)  However, assigning
       to a non-existent parameter, or declaring a new parameter with export,  causes  it  to  be
       created in the outermost scope.

       Local parameters disappear when their scope ends.  unset can be used to delete a parameter
       while it is still in scope; any outer parameter of the same name remains hidden.

       Special parameters may also be made local; they retain  their  special  attributes  unless
       either  the existing or the newly-created parameter has the -h (hide) attribute.  This may
       have unexpected effects: there is no default value, so if there is no  assignment  at  the
       point the variable is made local, it will be set to an empty value (or zero in the case of
       integers).  The following:

              typeset PATH=/new/directory:$PATH

       is valid for temporarily allowing the shell or programmes called from it to find the  pro‐
       grams in /new/directory inside a function.

       Note  that  the  restriction  in  older  versions  of zsh that local parameters were never
       exported has been removed.

PARAMETERS SET BY THE SHELL
       The following parameters are automatically set by the shell:

       ! <S>  The process ID of the last command started in the background with &,  or  put  into
              the background with the bg builtin.

       # <S>  The number of positional parameters in decimal.  Note that some confusion may occur
              with the syntax $#param which substitutes the length of param.  Use ${#} to resolve
              ambiguities.   In  particular, the sequence `$#-...' in an arithmetic expression is
              interpreted as the length of the parameter -, q.v.

       ARGC <S> <Z>
              Same as #.

       $ <S>  The process ID of this shell.  Note that this indicates the original shell  started
              by  invoking zsh; all processes forked from the shells without executing a new pro‐
              gram, such as subshells started by (...), substitute the same value.

       - <S>  Flags supplied to the shell on invocation or by the set or setopt commands.

       * <S>  An array containing the positional parameters.

       argv <S> <Z>
              Same as *.  Assigning to argv changes the local positional parameters, but argv  is
              not  itself a local parameter.  Deleting argv with unset in any function deletes it
              everywhere, although only the innermost positional parameter array is deleted (so *
              and @ in other scopes are not affected).

       @ <S>  Same as argv[@], even when argv is not set.

       ? <S>  The exit status returned by the last command.

       0 <S>  The  name used to invoke the current shell, or as set by the -c command line option
              upon invocation.  If the FUNCTION_ARGZERO option is set, $0 is set upon entry to  a
              shell  function  to the name of the function, and upon entry to a sourced script to
              the name of the script, and reset to its previous value when the function or script
              returns.

       status <S> <Z>
              Same as ?.

       pipestatus <S> <Z>
              An  array  containing  the exit statuses returned by all commands in the last pipe‐
              line.

       _ <S>  The last argument of the previous command.  Also, this  parameter  is  set  in  the
              environment of every command executed to the full pathname of the command.

       CPUTYPE
              The  machine  type  (microprocessor  class  or machine model), as determined at run
              time.

       EGID <S>
              The effective group ID of the shell process.  If you  have  sufficient  privileges,
              you  may  change  the  effective group ID of the shell process by assigning to this
              parameter.  Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you may start a  single  command
              with a different effective group ID by `(EGID=gid; command)'

       EUID <S>
              The effective user ID of the shell process.  If you have sufficient privileges, you
              may change the effective user ID of the shell process by assigning to this  parame‐
              ter.   Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you may start a single command with a
              different effective user ID by `(EUID=uid; command)'

       ERRNO <S>
              The value of errno (see errno(3)) as set by the most recently failed  system  call.
              This  value is system dependent and is intended for debugging purposes.  It is also
              useful with the zsh/system module which allows the number to be turned into a  name
              or message.

       GID <S>
              The real group ID of the shell process.  If you have sufficient privileges, you may
              change the group ID of the shell process by  assigning  to  this  parameter.   Also
              (assuming  sufficient privileges), you may start a single command under a different
              group ID by `(GID=gid; command)'

       HISTCMD
              The current history event number in an interactive shell, in other words the  event
              number  for  the  command  that caused $HISTCMD to be read.  If the current history
              event modifies the history, HISTCMD changes to the new maximum history  event  num‐
              ber.

       HOST   The current hostname.

       LINENO <S>
              The  line  number  of  the current line within the current script, sourced file, or
              shell function being executed, whichever was started most recently.  Note  that  in
              the  case  of shell functions the line number refers to the function as it appeared
              in the original definition, not necessarily as displayed by the functions builtin.

       LOGNAME
              If the corresponding variable is not set in the environment of  the  shell,  it  is
              initialized  to  the  login  name  corresponding to the current login session. This
              parameter is exported by default  but  this  can  be  disabled  using  the  typeset
              builtin.  The value is set to the string returned by the getlogin(3) system call if
              that is available.

       MACHTYPE
              The machine type (microprocessor class or machine model), as determined at  compile
              time.

       OLDPWD The  previous  working directory.  This is set when the shell initializes and when‐
              ever the directory changes.

       OPTARG <S>
              The value of the last option argument processed by the getopts command.

       OPTIND <S>
              The index of the last option argument processed by the getopts command.

       OSTYPE The operating system, as determined at compile time.

       PPID <S>
              The process ID of the parent of the shell.  As for $$, the value indicates the par‐
              ent of the original shell and does not change in subshells.

       PWD    The present working directory.  This is set when the shell initializes and whenever
              the directory changes.

       RANDOM <S>
              A pseudo-random integer from 0 to 32767, newly generated each time  this  parameter
              is  referenced.   The  random number generator can be seeded by assigning a numeric
              value to RANDOM.

              The values of RANDOM form an intentionally-repeatable pseudo-random sequence;  sub‐
              shells  that  reference RANDOM will result in identical pseudo-random values unless
              the value of RANDOM is referenced or seeded in the parent shell in between subshell
              invocations.

       SECONDS <S>
              The  number  of  seconds  since  shell invocation.  If this parameter is assigned a
              value, then the value returned upon reference will be the value that  was  assigned
              plus the number of seconds since the assignment.

              Unlike  other  special parameters, the type of the SECONDS parameter can be changed
              using the typeset command.  Only integer and one of the floating  point  types  are
              allowed.   For  example,  `typeset -F SECONDS' causes the value to be reported as a
              floating point number.  The value is available to  microsecond  accuracy,  although
              the  shell  may show more or fewer digits depending on the use of typeset.  See the
              documentation for the builtin typeset in zshbuiltins(1) for more details.

       SHLVL <S>
              Incremented by one each time a new shell is started.

       signals
              An array containing the names of the signals.

       TRY_BLOCK_ERROR <S>
              In an always block, indicates whether the preceding list of code caused  an  error.
              The  value  is  1 to indicate an error, 0 otherwise.  It may be reset, clearing the
              error condition.  See Complex Commands in zshmisc(1)

       TTY    The name of the tty associated with the shell, if any.

       TTYIDLE <S>
              The idle time of the tty associated with the shell in seconds or -1 if there is  no
              such tty.

       UID <S>
              The  real user ID of the shell process.  If you have sufficient privileges, you may
              change the user ID of the shell by assigning to  this  parameter.   Also  (assuming
              sufficient privileges), you may start a single command under a different user ID by
              `(UID=uid; command)'

       USERNAME <S>
              The username corresponding to the real user ID of the shell process.  If  you  have
              sufficient  privileges, you may change the username (and also the user ID and group
              ID) of the shell by assigning to this parameter.  Also (assuming sufficient  privi‐
              leges),  you may start a single command under a different username (and user ID and
              group ID) by `(USERNAME=username; command)'

       VENDOR The vendor, as determined at compile time.

       zsh_eval_context <S> <Z> (ZSH_EVAL_CONTEXT <S>)
              An array (colon-separated list) indicating the context of shell code that is  being
              run.  Each time a piece of shell code that is stored within the shell is executed a
              string is temporarily appended to the array to indicate the type of operation  that
              is  being  performed.   Read in order the array gives an indication of the stack of
              operations being performed with the most immediate context last.

              Note that the variable does not give information on syntactic context such as pipe‐
              lines or subshells.  Use $ZSH_SUBSHELL to detect subshells.

              The context is one of the following:
              cmdarg Code specified by the -c option to the command line that invoked the shell.

              cmdsubst
                     Command substitution using the `...` or $(...) construct.

              equalsubst
                     File substitution using the =(...) construct.

              eval   Code executed by the eval builtin.

              evalautofunc
                     Code  executed  with  the  KSH_AUTOLOAD  mechanism  in  order  to  define an
                     autoloaded function.

              fc     Code from the shell history executed by the -e option to the fc builtin.

              file   Lines of code being read directly from a file, for  example  by  the  source
                     builtin.

              filecode
                     Lines  of  code  being  read  from  a .zwc file instead of directly from the
                     source file.

              globqual
                     Code executed by the e or + glob qualifier.

              globsort
                     Code executed to order files by the o glob qualifier.

              insubst
                     File substitution using the <(...) construct.

              loadautofunc
                     Code read directly from a file to define an autoloaded function.

              outsubst
                     File substitution using the >(...) construct.

              sched  Code executed by the sched builtin.

              shfunc A shell function.

              stty   Code passed to stty by the STTY  environment  variable.   Normally  this  is
                     passed  directly  to the system's stty command, so this value is unlikely to
                     be seen in practice.

              style  Code executed as part of a style retrieved by the zstyle  builtin  from  the
                     zsh/zutil module.

              toplevel
                     The highest execution level of a script or interactive shell.

              trap   Code executed as a trap defined by the trap builtin.  Traps defined as func‐
                     tions have the context shfunc.  As traps are asynchronous they  may  have  a
                     different hierarchy from other code.

              zpty   Code executed by the zpty builtin from the zsh/zpty module.

              zregexparse-guard
                     Code  executed as a guard by the zregexparse command from the zsh/zutil mod‐
                     ule.

              zregexparse-action
                     Code executed as an action by the zregexparse  command  from  the  zsh/zutil
                     module.

       ZSH_NAME
              Expands to the basename of the command used to invoke this instance of zsh.

       ZSH_PATCHLEVEL
              The revision string for the version number of the ChangeLog file in the zsh distri‐
              bution.  This is most useful in order to keep track of versions of the shell during
              development between releases; hence most users should not use it and should instead
              rely on $ZSH_VERSION.

       zsh_scheduled_events
              See the section `The zsh/sched Module' in zshmodules(1).

       ZSH_SUBSHELL
              Readonly integer.  Initially zero, incremented each time the shell forks to  create
              a  subshell  for  executing code.  Hence `(print $ZSH_SUBSHELL)' and `print $(print
              $ZSH_SUBSHELL)' output 1, while `( (print $ZSH_SUBSHELL) )' outputs 2.

       ZSH_VERSION
              The version number of the release of zsh.

PARAMETERS USED BY THE SHELL
       The following parameters are used by the shell.

       In cases where there are two parameters with an upper- and  lowercase  form  of  the  same
       name,  such  as  path and PATH, the lowercase form is an array and the uppercase form is a
       scalar with the elements of the array joined together by colons.   These  are  similar  to
       tied  parameters created via `typeset -T'.  The normal use for the colon-separated form is
       for exporting to the environment, while the array form is easier to manipulate within  the
       shell.   Note  that  unsetting  either of the pair will unset the other; they retain their
       special properties when recreated, and recreating one of the pair will recreate the other.

       ARGV0  If exported, its value is used as the argv[0] of external commands.   Usually  used
              in constructs like `ARGV0=emacs nethack'.

       BAUD   The  rate  in  bits per second at which data reaches the terminal.  The line editor
              will use this value in order to compensate for a slow terminal by delaying  updates
              to the display until necessary.  If the parameter is unset or the value is zero the
              compensation mechanism is turned off.  The parameter is not set by default.

              This parameter may be profitably set in some circumstances, e.g.  for  slow  modems
              dialing into a communications server, or on a slow wide area network.  It should be
              set to the baud rate of the slowest part of the link for best performance.

       cdpath <S> <Z> (CDPATH <S>)
              An array (colon-separated list) of directories specifying the search path  for  the
              cd command.

       COLUMNS <S>
              The  number  of  columns for this terminal session.  Used for printing select lists
              and for the line editor.

       CORRECT_IGNORE
              If set, is treated as a pattern during spelling correction.  Any potential  correc‐
              tion  that  matches the pattern is ignored.  For example, if the value is `_*' then
              completion functions (which, by convention, have names  beginning  with  `_')  will
              never  be  offered as spelling corrections.  The pattern does not apply to the cor‐
              rection of file names, as applied by the CORRECT_ALL option (so  with  the  example
              just  given  files  beginning with `_' in the current directory would still be com‐
              pleted).

       CORRECT_IGNORE_FILE
              If set, is treated as a pattern during spelling correction of file names.  Any file
              name  that  matches  the pattern is never offered as a correction.  For example, if
              the value is `.*' then dot file names will never be  offered  as  spelling  correc‐
              tions.  This is useful with the CORRECT_ALL option.

       DIRSTACKSIZE
              The  maximum  size  of  the  directory stack, by default there is no limit.  If the
              stack gets larger than this, it will be truncated automatically.   This  is  useful
              with the AUTO_PUSHD option.

       ENV    If  the  ENV  environment variable is set when zsh is invoked as sh or ksh, $ENV is
              sourced after the profile scripts.  The value of  ENV  is  subjected  to  parameter
              expansion,  command substitution, and arithmetic expansion before being interpreted
              as a pathname.  Note that ENV is not used unless zsh is emulating sh or ksh.

       FCEDIT The default editor for the fc builtin.  If FCEDIT is not set, the parameter  EDITOR
              is used; if that is not set either, a builtin default, usually vi, is used.

       fignore <S> <Z> (FIGNORE <S>)
              An array (colon separated list) containing the suffixes of files to be ignored dur‐
              ing filename completion.  However, if completion only generates files with suffixes
              in this list, then these files are completed anyway.

       fpath <S> <Z> (FPATH <S>)
              An array (colon separated list) of directories specifying the search path for func‐
              tion definitions.  This path is searched when a function with the -u  attribute  is
              referenced.   If  an  executable file is found, then it is read and executed in the
              current environment.

       histchars <S>
              Three characters used by the shell's history and lexical analysis  mechanism.   The
              first character signals the start of a history expansion (default `!').  The second
              character signals the start of a quick history  substitution  (default  `^').   The
              third character is the comment character (default `#').

              The  characters must be in the ASCII character set; any attempt to set histchars to
              characters with a locale-dependent meaning will be rejected with an error message.

       HISTCHARS <S> <Z>
              Same as histchars.  (Deprecated.)

       HISTFILE
              The file to save the history in when an interactive shell  exits.   If  unset,  the
              history is not saved.

       HISTORY_IGNORE
              If  set, is treated as a pattern at the time history files are written.  Any poten‐
              tial history entry that matches the pattern is skipped.  For example, if the  value
              is  `fc *' then commands that invoke the interactive history editor are never writ‐
              ten to the history file (compare the  HIST_NO_STORE  option  or  the  zshaddhistory
              hook,  either of which would prevent such commands from being added to the interac‐
              tive history at all).

       HISTSIZE <S>
              The maximum number of events stored in the internal history list.  If you  use  the
              HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST  option,  setting  this  value larger than the SAVEHIST size
              will give you the difference as a cushion for saving duplicated history events.

       HOME <S>
              The default argument for the cd command.  This is  not  set  automatically  by  the
              shell  in  sh, ksh or csh emulation, but it is typically present in the environment
              anyway, and if it becomes set it has its usual special behaviour.

       IFS <S>
              Internal field separators (by default space, tab, newline and NUL), that  are  used
              to  separate  words which result from command or parameter expansion and words read
              by the read builtin.  Any characters from the  set  space,  tab  and  newline  that
              appear  in the IFS are called IFS white space.  One or more IFS white space charac‐
              ters or one non-IFS white space character together  with  any  adjacent  IFS  white
              space  character  delimit  a  field.  If an IFS white space character appears twice
              consecutively in the IFS, this character is treated as if it were not an IFS  white
              space character.

              If  the  parameter is unset, the default is used.  Note this has a different effect
              from setting the parameter to an empty string.

       KEYBOARD_HACK
              This variable defines a character to be removed from the end of  the  command  line
              before interpreting it (interactive shells only). It is intended to fix the problem
              with keys placed annoyingly close to return and replaces the SUNKEYBOARDHACK option
              which  did this for backquotes only.  Should the chosen character be one of single‐
              quote, doublequote or backquote, there must also be an odd number of  them  on  the
              command line for the last one to be removed.

              For  backward  compatibility,  if the SUNKEYBOARDHACK option is explicitly set, the
              value of KEYBOARD_HACK reverts to backquote.  If the option  is  explicitly  unset,
              this variable is set to empty.

       KEYTIMEOUT
              The  time  the shell waits, in hundredths of seconds, for another key to be pressed
              when reading bound multi-character sequences.

       LANG <S>
              This variable determines the locale category  for  any  category  not  specifically
              selected via a variable starting with `LC_'.

       LC_ALL <S>
              This  variable  overrides  the value of the `LANG' variable and the value of any of
              the other variables starting with `LC_'.

       LC_COLLATE <S>
              This variable determines the locale category for  character  collation  information
              within ranges in glob brackets and for sorting.

       LC_CTYPE <S>
              This  variable determines the locale category for character handling functions.  If
              the MULTIBYTE option is in effect this variable or LANG should contain a value that
              reflects  the  character  set  in  use,  even if it is a single-byte character set,
              unless only the 7-bit subset (ASCII) is used.  For example, if the character set is
              ISO-8859-1,  a suitable value might be en_US.iso88591 (certain Linux distributions)
              or en_US.ISO8859-1 (MacOS).

       LC_MESSAGES <S>
              This variable determines the language in which messages should  be  written.   Note
              that zsh does not use message catalogs.

       LC_NUMERIC <S>
              This variable affects the decimal point character and thousands separator character
              for the formatted input/output functions and  string  conversion  functions.   Note
              that zsh ignores this setting when parsing floating point mathematical expressions.

       LC_TIME <S>
              This variable determines the locale category for date and time formatting in prompt
              escape sequences.

       LINES <S>
              The number of lines for this terminal session.  Used for printing select lists  and
              for the line editor.

       LISTMAX
              In  the  line  editor,  the  number of matches to list without asking first. If the
              value is negative, the list will be shown if it spans at  most  as  many  lines  as
              given by the absolute value.  If set to zero, the shell asks only if the top of the
              listing would scroll off the screen.

       LOGCHECK
              The interval in seconds between checks for login/logout activity  using  the  watch
              parameter.

       MAIL   If  this  parameter is set and mailpath is not set, the shell looks for mail in the
              specified file.

       MAILCHECK
              The interval in seconds between checks for new mail.

       mailpath <S> <Z> (MAILPATH <S>)
              An array (colon-separated list) of filenames to check for new mail.  Each  filename
              can  be  followed  by  a  `?' and a message that will be printed.  The message will
              undergo parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion with the
              variable  $_ defined as the name of the file that has changed.  The default message
              is `You have new mail'.  If an element is a directory instead of a file  the  shell
              will recursively check every file in every subdirectory of the element.

       manpath <S> <Z> (MANPATH <S> <Z>)
              An  array (colon-separated list) whose value is not used by the shell.  The manpath
              array can be useful, however, since setting it also sets MANPATH, and vice versa.

       match
       mbegin
       mend   Arrays set by the shell when the b globbing flag is used in pattern  matches.   See
              the  subsection Globbing flags in the documentation for Filename Generation in zsh‐
              expn(1).

       MATCH
       MBEGIN
       MEND   Set by the shell when the m globbing flag is used in pattern matches.  See the sub‐
              section Globbing flags in the documentation for Filename Generation in zshexpn(1).

       module_path <S> <Z> (MODULE_PATH <S>)
              An  array  (colon-separated list) of directories that zmodload searches for dynami‐
              cally loadable modules.  This  is  initialized  to  a  standard  pathname,  usually
              `/usr/local/lib/zsh/$ZSH_VERSION'.   (The `/usr/local/lib' part varies from instal‐
              lation to installation.)  For security reasons, any value set  in  the  environment
              when the shell is started will be ignored.

              These parameters only exist if the installation supports dynamic module loading.

       NULLCMD <S>
              The command name to assume if a redirection is specified with no command.  Defaults
              to cat.  For sh/ksh behavior, change this to :.  For csh-like behavior, unset  this
              parameter; the shell will print an error message if null commands are entered.

       path <S> <Z> (PATH <S>)
              An  array  (colon-separated list) of directories to search for commands.  When this
              parameter is set, each directory is scanned and all files found are put in  a  hash
              table.

       POSTEDIT <S>
              This  string is output whenever the line editor exits.  It usually contains termcap
              strings to reset the terminal.

       PROMPT <S> <Z>
       PROMPT2 <S> <Z>
       PROMPT3 <S> <Z>
       PROMPT4 <S> <Z>
              Same as PS1, PS2, PS3 and PS4, respectively.

       prompt <S> <Z>
              Same as PS1.

       PROMPT_EOL_MARK
              When the PROMPT_CR and PROMPT_SP options are set, the PROMPT_EOL_MARK parameter can
              be used to customize how the end of partial lines are shown.  This parameter under‐
              goes prompt expansion, with the PROMPT_PERCENT option set.  If not set, the default
              behavior is equivalent to the value `%B%S%#%s%b'.

       PS1 <S>
              The  primary  prompt string, printed before a command is read.  It undergoes a spe‐
              cial form of expansion before being displayed; see EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in
              zshmisc(1).  The default is `%m%# '.

       PS2 <S>
              The  secondary  prompt, printed when the shell needs more information to complete a
              command.  It is expanded in the same way as PS1.  The default is `%_> ', which dis‐
              plays any shell constructs or quotation marks which are currently being processed.

       PS3 <S>
              Selection prompt used within a select loop.  It is expanded in the same way as PS1.
              The default is `?# '.

       PS4 <S>
              The execution trace prompt.  Default is `+%N:%i> ', which displays the name of  the
              current shell structure and the line number within it.  In sh or ksh emulation, the
              default is `+ '.

       psvar <S> <Z> (PSVAR <S>)
              An array (colon-separated list) whose elements can be used in PROMPT strings.  Set‐
              ting psvar also sets PSVAR, and vice versa.

       READNULLCMD <S>
              The  command name to assume if a single input redirection is specified with no com‐
              mand.  Defaults to more.

       REPORTTIME
              If nonnegative, commands whose combined user and system execution  times  (measured
              in  seconds)  are  greater than this value have timing statistics printed for them.
              Output is suppressed for commands executed within the line editor,  including  com‐
              pletion;  commands  explicitly marked with the time keyword still cause the summary
              to be printed in this case.

       REPLY  This parameter is reserved by  convention  to  pass  string  values  between  shell
              scripts  and  shell builtins in situations where a function call or redirection are
              impossible or undesirable.  The read builtin and the select complex command may set
              REPLY,  and  filename  generation  both sets and examines its value when evaluating
              certain expressions.  Some modules also employ REPLY for similar purposes.

       reply  As REPLY, but for array values rather than strings.

       RPROMPT <S>
       RPS1 <S>
              This prompt is displayed on the right-hand side of  the  screen  when  the  primary
              prompt  is  being displayed on the left.  This does not work if the SINGLE_LINE_ZLE
              option is set.  It is expanded in the same way as PS1.

       RPROMPT2 <S>
       RPS2 <S>
              This prompt is displayed on the right-hand side of the screen  when  the  secondary
              prompt  is  being displayed on the left.  This does not work if the SINGLE_LINE_ZLE
              option is set.  It is expanded in the same way as PS2.

       SAVEHIST
              The maximum number of history events to save in the history file.

       SPROMPT <S>
              The prompt used for spelling correction.  The sequence `%R' expands to  the  string
              which  presumably  needs spelling correction, and `%r' expands to the proposed cor‐
              rection.  All other prompt escapes are also allowed.

       STTY   If this parameter is set in a command's environment, the shell runs the  stty  com‐
              mand  with the value of this parameter as arguments in order to set up the terminal
              before executing the command. The modes apply only to the command,  and  are  reset
              when  it  finishes or is suspended. If the command is suspended and continued later
              with the fg or wait builtins it will see the modes specified by STTY, as if it were
              not suspended.  This (intentionally) does not apply if the command is continued via
              `kill -CONT'.  STTY is ignored if the command is run in the background, or if it is
              in  the  environment of the shell but not explicitly assigned to in the input line.
              This avoids running stty at every external command by  accidentally  exporting  it.
              Also  note  that STTY should not be used for window size specifications; these will
              not be local to the command.

       TERM <S>
              The type of terminal in use.  This is used when looking up termcap  sequences.   An
              assignment to TERM causes zsh to re-initialize the terminal, even if the value does
              not change (e.g., `TERM=$TERM').  It is necessary to make such an  assignment  upon
              any  change  to  the terminal definition database or terminal type in order for the
              new settings to take effect.

       TERMINFO <S>
              A reference to a compiled description of  the  terminal,  used  by  the  `terminfo'
              library  when the system has it; see terminfo(5).  If set, this causes the shell to
              reinitialise the terminal, making the workaround `TERM=$TERM' unnecessary.

       TIMEFMT
              The format of process time reports with the time keyword.  The default is  `%J   %U
              user  %S  system  %P  cpu  %*E  total'.  Recognizes the following escape sequences,
              although not all may be available on all systems, and some that are  available  may
              not be useful:

              %%     A `%'.
              %U     CPU seconds spent in user mode.
              %S     CPU seconds spent in kernel mode.
              %E     Elapsed time in seconds.
              %P     The CPU percentage, computed as (100*%U+%S)/%E.
              %W     Number of times the process was swapped.
              %X     The average amount in (shared) text space used in kilobytes.
              %D     The average amount in (unshared) data/stack space used in kilobytes.
              %K     The total space used (%X+%D) in kilobytes.
              %M     The  maximum memory the process had in use at any time in megabytes.
              %F     The number of major page faults (page needed to be brought from disk).
              %R     The number of minor page faults.
              %I     The number of input operations.
              %O     The number of output operations.
              %r     The number of socket messages received.
              %s     The number of socket messages sent.
              %k     The number of signals received.
              %w     Number of voluntary context switches (waits).
              %c     Number of involuntary context switches.
              %J     The name of this job.

              A  star  may  be  inserted  between the percent sign and flags printing time.  This
              cause the time to be printed in `hh:mm:ss.ttt' format (hours and minutes  are  only
              printed if they are not zero).

       TMOUT  If this parameter is nonzero, the shell will receive an ALRM signal if a command is
              not entered within the specified number of seconds after issuing a prompt. If there
              is  a  trap  on SIGALRM, it will be executed and a new alarm is scheduled using the
              value of the TMOUT parameter after executing the trap.  If no trap is set, and  the
              idle  time  of  the terminal is not less than the value of the TMOUT parameter, zsh
              terminates.  Otherwise a new alarm is scheduled to TMOUT  seconds  after  the  last
              keypress.

       TMPPREFIX
              A pathname prefix which the shell will use for all temporary files.  Note that this
              should include an initial part for the file name as well as  any  directory  names.
              The default is `/tmp/zsh'.

       watch <S> <Z> (WATCH <S>)
              An  array  (colon-separated list) of login/logout events to report.  If it contains
              the single word `all', then all login/logout events are reported.  If  it  contains
              the  single  word `notme', then all events are reported as with `all' except $USER‐
              NAME.  An entry in this list may consist of a username, an `@' followed by a remote
              hostname,  and  a `%' followed by a line (tty).  Any or all of these components may
              be present in an entry; if  a  login/logout  event  matches  all  of  them,  it  is
              reported.

       WATCHFMT
              The  format  of login/logout reports if the watch parameter is set.  Default is `%n
              has %a %l from %m'.  Recognizes the following escape sequences:

              %n     The name of the user that logged in/out.

              %a     The observed action, i.e. "logged on" or "logged off".

              %l     The line (tty) the user is logged in on.

              %M     The full hostname of the remote host.

              %m     The hostname up to the first `.'.  If only the IP address  is  available  or
                     the  utmp field contains the name of an X-windows display, the whole name is
                     printed.

                     NOTE: The `%m' and `%M' escapes will work only if there is a host name field
                     in  the  utmp  on  your  machine.   Otherwise  they  are treated as ordinary
                     strings.

              %S (%s)
                     Start (stop) standout mode.

              %U (%u)
                     Start (stop) underline mode.

              %B (%b)
                     Start (stop) boldface mode.

              %t
              %@     The time, in 12-hour, am/pm format.

              %T     The time, in 24-hour format.

              %w     The date in `day-dd' format.

              %W     The date in `mm/dd/yy' format.

              %D     The date in `yy-mm-dd' format.

              %(x:true-text:false-text)
                     Specifies a ternary expression.  The character following the x is arbitrary;
                     the  same  character is used to separate the text for the "true" result from
                     that for the "false" result.  Both the separator and the  right  parenthesis
                     may be escaped with a backslash.  Ternary expressions may be nested.

                     The  test character x may be any one of `l', `n', `m' or `M', which indicate
                     a `true'  result  if  the  corresponding  escape  sequence  would  return  a
                     non-empty  value;  or  it may be `a', which indicates a `true' result if the
                     watched user has logged in, or `false' if he has logged out.  Other  charac‐
                     ters evaluate to neither true nor false; the entire expression is omitted in
                     this case.

                     If the result is `true', then the true-text is formatted  according  to  the
                     rules  above  and  printed,  and the false-text is skipped.  If `false', the
                     true-text is skipped and the false-text is formatted and printed.  Either or
                     both  of  the  branches may be empty, but both separators must be present in
                     any case.

       WORDCHARS <S>
              A list of non-alphanumeric characters considered part of a word by the line editor.

       ZBEEP  If set, this gives a string of characters, which can use all the same codes as  the
              bindkey  command  as  described  in the zsh/zle module entry in zshmodules(1), that
              will be output to the terminal instead of beeping.  This may have a visible instead
              of  an  audible  effect; for example, the string `\e[?5h\e[?5l' on a vt100 or xterm
              will have the effect of flashing reverse video on  and  off  (if  you  usually  use
              reverse  video,  you  should  use  the  string `\e[?5l\e[?5h' instead).  This takes
              precedence over the NOBEEP option.

       ZDOTDIR
              The directory to search for shell startup files (.zshrc, etc), if not $HOME.

       ZLE_LINE_ABORTED
              This parameter is set by the line editor when an error  occurs.   It  contains  the
              line   that   was  being  edited  at  the  point  of  the  error.   `print  -zr  --
              $ZLE_LINE_ABORTED' can be used to recover the line.  Only the most recent  line  of
              this kind is remembered.

       ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS
       ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS
              These  parameters  are  used by the line editor.  In certain circumstances suffixes
              (typically space or slash) added by the completion system will be removed automati‐
              cally,  either because the next editing command was not an insertable character, or
              because the character was marked as requiring the suffix to be removed.

              These variables can contain the sets of characters that will cause the suffix to be
              removed.  If ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS is set, those characters will cause the suffix
              to be removed; if ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS is set, those characters  will  cause  the
              suffix to be removed and replaced by a space.

              If ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS is not set, the default behaviour is equivalent to:

                     ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS=$' \t\n;&|'

              If  ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS is set but is empty, no characters have this behaviour.
              ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS takes precedence, so that the following:

                     ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS=$'&|'

              causes the characters `&' and `|' to remove the suffix but to  replace  it  with  a
              space.

              To  illustrate  the  difference,  suppose  that  the option AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH is in
              effect and the directory DIR has just been completed, with an appended /, following
              which  the  user  types  `&'.   The default result is `DIR&'.  With ZLE_REMOVE_SUF‐
              FIX_CHARS set but without including `&' the result is `DIR/&'.  With ZLE_SPACE_SUF‐
              FIX_CHARS set to include `&' the result is `DIR &'.

              Note  that  certain completions may provide their own suffix removal or replacement
              behaviour which overrides the values described here.   See  the  completion  system
              documentation in zshcompsys(1).

       ZLE_RPROMPT_INDENT <S>
              If  set,  used  to  give  the  indentation between the right hand side of the right
              prompt in the line editor as given by RPS1 or RPROMPT and the right  hand  side  of
              the screen.  If not set, the value 1 is used.

              Typically  this will be used to set the value to 0 so that the prompt appears flush
              with the right hand side of the screen.  This is not the default as many  terminals
              do  not handle this correctly, in particular when the prompt appears at the extreme
              bottom right of the screen.  Recent virtual terminals are  more  likely  to  handle
              this case correctly.  Some experimentation is necessary.



ZSHOPTIONS(1)                        General Commands Manual                        ZSHOPTIONS(1)



NAME
       zshoptions - zsh options

SPECIFYING OPTIONS
       Options  are  primarily  referred to by name.  These names are case insensitive and under‐
       scores are ignored.  For example, `allexport' is equivalent to `A__lleXP_ort'.

       The sense of an option name may be inverted by preceding it with `no', so `setopt No_Beep'
       is  equivalent to `unsetopt beep'.  This inversion can only be done once, so `nonobeep' is
       not a synonym for `beep'.  Similarly, `tify' is not a synonym for `nonotify'  (the  inver‐
       sion of `notify').

       Some options also have one or more single letter names.  There are two sets of single let‐
       ter options: one used by default, and another  used  to  emulate  sh/ksh  (used  when  the
       SH_OPTION_LETTERS option is set).  The single letter options can be used on the shell com‐
       mand line, or with the set, setopt and unsetopt builtins, as normal Unix options  preceded
       by `-'.

       The  sense of the single letter options may be inverted by using `+' instead of `-'.  Some
       of the single letter option names refer to an option being off, in which case  the  inver‐
       sion  of  that name refers to the option being on.  For example, `+n' is the short name of
       `exec', and `-n' is the short name of its inversion, `noexec'.

       In strings of single letter options supplied to the shell at startup, trailing  whitespace
       will  be  ignored;  for  example the string `-f    ' will be treated just as `-f', but the
       string `-f i' is an error.  This is because many systems which implement the  `#!'  mecha‐
       nism for calling scripts do not strip trailing whitespace.

DESCRIPTION OF OPTIONS
       In  the following list, options set by default in all emulations are marked <D>; those set
       by default only in csh, ksh, sh, or zsh emulations are marked <C>, <K>, <S>, <Z> as appro‐
       priate.   When  listing  options  (by  `setopt',  `unsetopt', `set -o' or `set +o'), those
       turned  on  by  default  appear  in  the  list  prefixed   with   `no'.    Hence   (unless
       KSH_OPTION_PRINT  is  set), `setopt' shows all options whose settings are changed from the
       default.

   Changing Directories
       AUTO_CD (-J)
              If a command is issued that can't be executed as a normal command, and the  command
              is the name of a directory, perform the cd command to that directory.

       AUTO_PUSHD (-N)
              Make cd push the old directory onto the directory stack.

       CDABLE_VARS (-T)
              If  the  argument to a cd command (or an implied cd with the AUTO_CD option set) is
              not a directory, and does not begin with a slash, try to expand the  expression  as
              if it were preceded by a `~' (see the section `Filename Expansion').

       CHASE_DOTS
              When  changing  to a directory containing a path segment `..' which would otherwise
              be treated as canceling the previous segment in the path (in other words,  `foo/..'
              would  be removed from the path, or if `..' is the first part of the path, the last
              part of the current working directory would be removed), instead resolve  the  path
              to the physical directory.  This option is overridden by CHASE_LINKS.

              For  example,  suppose  /foo/bar is a link to the directory /alt/rod.  Without this
              option set, `cd /foo/bar/..' changes to /foo; with it set, it changes to /alt.  The
              same  applies  if the current directory is /foo/bar and `cd ..' is used.  Note that
              all other symbolic links in the path will also be resolved.

       CHASE_LINKS (-w)
              Resolve symbolic links to their true values when changing directory.  This also has
              the  effect of CHASE_DOTS, i.e. a `..' path segment will be treated as referring to
              the physical parent, even if the preceding path segment is a symbolic link.

       POSIX_CD
              Modifies the behaviour of cd, chdir and pushd commands to make them more compatible
              with  the  POSIX  standard. The behaviour with the option unset is described in the
              documentation for the cd builtin in zshbuiltins(1).  If  the  option  is  set,  the
              shell  does  not test for directories beneath the local directory (`.') until after
              all directories in cdpath have been tested.

              Also, if the option is set, the conditions under which the  shell  prints  the  new
              directory  after changing to it are modified.  It is no longer restricted to inter‐
              active shells (although printing of the directory stack with pushd is still limited
              to  interactive  shells); and any use of a component of CDPATH, including a `.' but
              excluding an empty component that is otherwise treated as `.', causes the directory
              to be printed.

       PUSHD_IGNORE_DUPS
              Don't push multiple copies of the same directory onto the directory stack.

       PUSHD_MINUS
              Exchanges  the  meanings of `+' and `-' when used with a number to specify a direc‐
              tory in the stack.

       PUSHD_SILENT (-E)
              Do not print the directory stack after pushd or popd.

       PUSHD_TO_HOME (-D)
              Have pushd with no arguments act like `pushd $HOME'.

   Completion
       ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT <D>
              If unset, key functions that list completions try to return to the last  prompt  if
              given  a  numeric argument. If set these functions try to return to the last prompt
              if given no numeric argument.

       ALWAYS_TO_END
              If a completion is performed with the cursor within a word, and a  full  completion
              is  inserted,  the  cursor is moved to the end of the word.  That is, the cursor is
              moved to the end of the word if either a single match is inserted or  menu  comple‐
              tion is performed.

       AUTO_LIST (-9) <D>
              Automatically list choices on an ambiguous completion.

       AUTO_MENU <D>
              Automatically  use menu completion after the second consecutive request for comple‐
              tion, for example by pressing the tab key repeatedly. This option is overridden  by
              MENU_COMPLETE.

       AUTO_NAME_DIRS
              Any parameter that is set to the absolute name of a directory immediately becomes a
              name for that directory,  that  will  be  used  by  the  `%~'  and  related  prompt
              sequences,  and  will  be available when completion is performed on a word starting
              with `~'.  (Otherwise, the parameter must be used in the form `~param' first.)

       AUTO_PARAM_KEYS <D>
              If a parameter name was completed and a  following  character  (normally  a  space)
              automatically  inserted,  and the next character typed is one of those that have to
              come directly after the name (like `}', `:', etc.), the automatically added charac‐
              ter  is  deleted, so that the character typed comes immediately after the parameter
              name.  Completion in a brace expansion is affected similarly: the  added  character
              is a `,', which will be removed if `}' is typed next.

       AUTO_PARAM_SLASH <D>
              If  a  parameter  is completed whose content is the name of a directory, then add a
              trailing slash instead of a space.

       AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH <D>
              When the last character resulting from a completion is a slash and the next charac‐
              ter typed is a word delimiter, a slash, or a character that ends a command (such as
              a semicolon or an ampersand), remove the slash.

       BASH_AUTO_LIST
              On an ambiguous completion, automatically list choices when the completion function
              is  called twice in succession.  This takes precedence over AUTO_LIST.  The setting
              of LIST_AMBIGUOUS is respected.  If AUTO_MENU is set, the menu behaviour will  then
              start with the third press.  Note that this will not work with MENU_COMPLETE, since
              repeated completion calls immediately cycle through the list in that case.

       COMPLETE_ALIASES
              Prevents aliases on the command line from being internally substituted before  com‐
              pletion  is attempted.  The effect is to make the alias a distinct command for com‐
              pletion purposes.

       COMPLETE_IN_WORD
              If unset, the cursor is set to the end of the word if completion is started. Other‐
              wise it stays there and completion is done from both ends.

       GLOB_COMPLETE
              When  the  current  word  has a glob pattern, do not insert all the words resulting
              from the expansion but generate matches as for completion and  cycle  through  them
              like  MENU_COMPLETE.  The matches are generated as if a `*' was added to the end of
              the word, or inserted at the cursor when COMPLETE_IN_WORD is  set.   This  actually
              uses  pattern  matching,  not  globbing, so it works not only for files but for any
              completion, such as options, user names, etc.

              Note that when  the  pattern  matcher  is  used,  matching  control  (for  example,
              case-insensitive  or  anchored  matching)  cannot  be  used.   This limitation only
              applies when the current word contains a pattern; simply turning on  the  GLOB_COM‐
              PLETE option does not have this effect.

       HASH_LIST_ALL <D>
              Whenever  a  command  completion or spelling correction is attempted, make sure the
              entire command path is hashed first.  This makes the first  completion  slower  but
              avoids false reports of spelling errors.

       LIST_AMBIGUOUS <D>
              This  option  works  when  AUTO_LIST or BASH_AUTO_LIST is also set.  If there is an
              unambiguous prefix to insert on the command line, that is done without a completion
              list  being displayed; in other words, auto-listing behaviour only takes place when
              nothing would be inserted.  In the case of BASH_AUTO_LIST, this means that the list
              will be delayed to the third call of the function.

       LIST_BEEP <D>
              Beep  on an ambiguous completion.  More accurately, this forces the completion wid‐
              gets to return status 1 on an ambiguous completion, which causes the shell to  beep
              if the option BEEP is also set; this may be modified if completion is called from a
              user-defined widget.

       LIST_PACKED
              Try to make the completion list smaller (occupying  less  lines)  by  printing  the
              matches in columns with different widths.

       LIST_ROWS_FIRST
              Lay  out  the  matches in completion lists sorted horizontally, that is, the second
              match is to the right of the first one, not under it as usual.

       LIST_TYPES (-X) <D>
              When listing files that are possible completions, show the type of each file with a
              trailing identifying mark.

       MENU_COMPLETE (-Y)
              On an ambiguous completion, instead of listing possibilities or beeping, insert the
              first match immediately.  Then when completion is requested again, remove the first
              match and insert the second match, etc.  When there are no more matches, go back to
              the first one again.  reverse-menu-complete may be used to loop through the list in
              the other direction. This option overrides AUTO_MENU.

       REC_EXACT (-S)
              In completion, recognize exact matches even if they are ambiguous.

   Expansion and Globbing
       BAD_PATTERN (+2) <C> <Z>
              If  a pattern for filename generation is badly formed, print an error message.  (If
              this option is unset, the pattern will be left unchanged.)

       BARE_GLOB_QUAL <Z>
              In a glob pattern, treat a trailing set of parentheses as a qualifier list,  if  it
              contains  no  `|',  `('  or (if special) `~' characters.  See the section `Filename
              Generation'.

       BRACE_CCL
              Expand expressions in braces which would not otherwise undergo brace expansion to a
              lexically ordered list of all the characters.  See the section `Brace Expansion'.

       CASE_GLOB <D>
              Make  globbing  (filename  generation)  sensitive to case.  Note that other uses of
              patterns are always sensitive to case.  If the option is unset, the presence of any
              character  which  is  special  to  filename  generation will cause case-insensitive
              matching.  For example, cvs(/) can match the directory CVS owing to the presence of
              the globbing flag (unless the option BARE_GLOB_QUAL is unset).

       CASE_MATCH <D>
              Make  regular  expressions  using  the zsh/regex module (including matches with =~)
              sensitive to case.

       CSH_NULL_GLOB <C>
              If a pattern for filename generation has no matches, delete the  pattern  from  the
              argument  list; do not report an error unless all the patterns in a command have no
              matches.  Overrides NOMATCH.

       EQUALS <Z>
              Perform = filename expansion.  (See the section `Filename Expansion'.)

       EXTENDED_GLOB
              Treat the `#', `~' and `^' characters as part of patterns for filename  generation,
              etc.  (An initial unquoted `~' always produces named directory expansion.)

       FORCE_FLOAT
              Constants  in  arithmetic evaluation will be treated as floating point even without
              the use of a decimal point.  Integers in any base will be converted.

       GLOB (+F, ksh: +f) <D>
              Perform filename generation (globbing).  (See the section `Filename Generation'.)

       GLOB_ASSIGN <C>
              If this option is set, filename generation (globbing) is  performed  on  the  right
              hand side of scalar parameter assignments of the form `name=pattern (e.g. `foo=*').
              If the result has more than one word the parameter will become an array with  those
              words as arguments. This option is provided for backwards compatibility only: glob‐
              bing is always performed on the right hand side of array assignments  of  the  form
              `name=(value)' (e.g. `foo=(*)') and this form is recommended for clarity; with this
              option set, it is not possible to predict whether the result will be an array or  a
              scalar.

       GLOB_DOTS (-4)
              Do not require a leading `.' in a filename to be matched explicitly.

       GLOB_SUBST <C> <K> <S>
              Treat  any characters resulting from parameter expansion as being eligible for file
              expansion and filename generation, and any characters resulting from  command  sub‐
              stitution  as  being  eligible  for  filename  generation.   Braces  (and commas in
              between) do not become eligible for expansion.

       HIST_SUBST_PATTERN
              Substitutions using the :s and :& history  modifiers  are  performed  with  pattern
              matching  instead  of  string matching.  This occurs wherever history modifiers are
              valid, including glob qualifiers and parameters.  See the section Modifiers in zsh‐
              expn(1).

       IGNORE_BRACES (-I) <S>
              Do  not  perform  brace  expansion.   For historical reasons this also includes the
              effect of the IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES option.

       IGNORE_CLOSE_BRACES
              When neither this option nor IGNORE_BRACES is set, a sole close brace character `}'
              is  syntactically  significant at any point on a command line.  This has the effect
              that no semicolon or newline is necessary before the brace terminating  a  function
              or  current shell construct.  When either option is set, a closing brace is syntac‐
              tically significant only in command position.  Unlike  IGNORE_BRACES,  this  option
              does not disable brace expansion.

              For  example,  with  both  options unset a function may be defined in the following
              fashion:

                     args() { echo $# }

              while if either option is set, this does not work and something equivalent  to  the
              following is required:

                     args() { echo $#; }

       KSH_GLOB <K>
              In  pattern  matching, the interpretation of parentheses is affected by a preceding
              `@', `*', `+', `?' or `!'.  See the section `Filename Generation'.

       MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST
              All unquoted arguments of the form `anything=expression' appearing after  the  com‐
              mand  name  have filename expansion (that is, where expression has a leading `~' or
              `=') performed on expression as if it were a parameter assignment.  The argument is
              not  otherwise treated specially; it is passed to the command as a single argument,
              and  not  used  as  an  actual  parameter  assignment.   For   example,   in   echo
              foo=~/bar:~/rod,  both  occurrences of ~ would be replaced.  Note that this happens
              anyway with typeset and similar statements.

              This option respects the setting of the KSH_TYPESET option.   In  other  words,  if
              both  options  are  in  effect, arguments looking like assignments will not undergo
              word splitting.

       MARK_DIRS (-8, ksh: -X)
              Append a trailing `/' to all directory names  resulting  from  filename  generation
              (globbing).

       MULTIBYTE <C> <K> <Z>
              Respect  multibyte  characters  when  found  in  strings.  When this option is set,
              strings are examined using the system library to determine how many  bytes  form  a
              character,  depending  on  the current locale.  This affects the way characters are
              counted in pattern matching, parameter values and various delimiters.

              The option is on by default if the shell was compiled with MULTIBYTE_SUPPORT except
              in  sh  emulation;  otherwise  it is off by default and has no effect if turned on.
              The mode is off in sh emulation for compatibility but for interactive use may  need
              to be turned on if the terminal interprets multibyte characters.

              If  the  option is off a single byte is always treated as a single character.  This
              setting is designed purely for examining strings known  to  contain  raw  bytes  or
              other values that may not be characters in the current locale.  It is not necessary
              to unset the option merely because the character set for the  current  locale  does
              not contain multibyte characters.

              The  option  does  not  affect the shell's editor,  which always uses the locale to
              determine multibyte characters.  This is because the character set displayed by the
              terminal emulator is independent of shell settings.

       NOMATCH (+3) <C> <Z>
              If  a  pattern  for  filename generation has no matches, print an error, instead of
              leaving it unchanged in the argument list.  This also applies to file expansion  of
              an initial `~' or `='.

       NULL_GLOB (-G)
              If  a  pattern  for filename generation has no matches, delete the pattern from the
              argument list instead of reporting an error.  Overrides NOMATCH.

       NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT
              If numeric filenames are matched by a filename generation pattern, sort  the  file‐
              names numerically rather than lexicographically.

       RC_EXPAND_PARAM (-P)
              Array  expansions  of the form `foo${xx}bar', where the parameter xx is set to (a b
              c), are substituted with `fooabar foobbar foocbar' instead of the default  `fooa  b
              cbar'.  Note that an empty array will therefore cause all arguments to be removed.

       REMATCH_PCRE <Z>
              If  set,  regular expression matching with the =~ operator will use Perl-Compatible
              Regular Expressions from the PCRE library,  if  available.   If  not  set,  regular
              expressions will use the extended regexp syntax provided by the system libraries.

       SH_GLOB <K> <S>
              Disables  the  special  meaning of `(', `|', `)' and '<' for globbing the result of
              parameter and command substitutions, and in  some  other  places  where  the  shell
              accepts  patterns.   If  SH_GLOB  is  set but KSH_GLOB is not, the shell allows the
              interpretation of subshell expressions enclosed in parentheses in some cases  where
              there is no space before the opening parenthesis, e.g. !(true) is interpreted as if
              there were a space after the !.  This option is set by default if zsh is invoked as
              sh or ksh.

       UNSET (+u, ksh: +u) <K> <S> <Z>
              Treat unset parameters as if they were empty when substituting.  Otherwise they are
              treated as an error.

       WARN_CREATE_GLOBAL
              Print a warning message when a global parameter is created  in  a  function  by  an
              assignment.  This often indicates that a parameter has not been declared local when
              it should have been.  Parameters explicitly declared global from within a  function
              using  typeset  -g  do  not  cause a warning.  Note that there is no warning when a
              local parameter is assigned to in a nested function, which  may  also  indicate  an
              error.

   History
       APPEND_HISTORY <D>
              If  this  is  set, zsh sessions will append their history list to the history file,
              rather than replace it. Thus, multiple parallel zsh sessions will all have the  new
              entries  from their history lists added to the history file, in the order that they
              exit.  The file will still be periodically re-written to trim it when the number of
              lines   grows   20%   beyond  the  value  specified  by  $SAVEHIST  (see  also  the
              HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY option).

       BANG_HIST (+K) <C> <Z>
              Perform textual history expansion, csh-style, treating the character `!' specially.

       EXTENDED_HISTORY <C>
              Save each command's beginning timestamp (in seconds since the epoch) and the  dura‐
              tion (in seconds) to the history file.  The format of this prefixed data is:

              `: <beginning time>:<elapsed seconds>;<command>'.

       HIST_ALLOW_CLOBBER
              Add  `|'  to output redirections in the history.  This allows history references to
              clobber files even when CLOBBER is unset.

       HIST_BEEP <D>
              Beep when an attempt is made to access a history entry which isn't there.

       HIST_EXPIRE_DUPS_FIRST
              If the internal history needs to be trimmed to add the current command  line,  set‐
              ting  this  option  will  cause the oldest history event that has a duplicate to be
              lost before losing a unique event from the list.  You should be  sure  to  set  the
              value  of  HISTSIZE to a larger number than SAVEHIST in order to give you some room
              for  the  duplicated  events,  otherwise  this  option  will   behave   just   like
              HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS once the history fills up with unique events.

       HIST_FCNTL_LOCK
              When writing out the history file, by default zsh uses ad-hoc file locking to avoid
              known problems with locking on some operating systems.  With this option locking is
              done  by  means  of  the  system's  fcntl call, where this method is available.  On
              recent operating systems this may provide better performance, in particular  avoid‐
              ing history corruption when files are stored on NFS.

       HIST_FIND_NO_DUPS
              When searching for history entries in the line editor, do not display duplicates of
              a line previously found, even if the duplicates are not contiguous.

       HIST_IGNORE_ALL_DUPS
              If a new command line being added to the history list duplicates an older one,  the
              older command is removed from the list (even if it is not the previous event).

       HIST_IGNORE_DUPS (-h)
              Do not enter command lines into the history list if they are duplicates of the pre‐
              vious event.

       HIST_IGNORE_SPACE (-g)
              Remove command lines from the history list when the first character on the line  is
              a space, or when one of the expanded aliases contains a leading space.  Only normal
              aliases (not global or suffix aliases) have this behaviour.  Note that the  command
              lingers  in  the  internal history until the next command is entered before it van‐
              ishes, allowing you to briefly reuse or edit the line.  If you want to make it van‐
              ish right away without entering another command, type a space and press return.

       HIST_LEX_WORDS
              By  default,  shell  history  that is read in from files is split into words on all
              white space.  This means that arguments with quoted whitespace  are  not  correctly
              handled,  with  the consequence that references to words in history lines that have
              been read from a file may be inaccurate.  When this option is set,  words  read  in
              from  a  history  file  are divided up in a similar fashion to normal shell command
              line handling.  Although this produces more accurately delimited words, if the size
              of  the  history  file  is large this can be slow.  Trial and error is necessary to
              decide.

       HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS
              Remove function definitions from the history list.  Note that the function  lingers
              in  the  internal  history  until  the  next command is entered before it vanishes,
              allowing you to briefly reuse or edit the definition.

       HIST_NO_STORE
              Remove the history (fc -l) command from the history list when invoked.   Note  that
              the  command  lingers  in  the  internal  history until the next command is entered
              before it vanishes, allowing you to briefly reuse or edit the line.

       HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
              Remove superfluous blanks from each command line being added to the history list.

       HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY <D>
              When the history file is re-written, we normally write out a copy of the file named
              $HISTFILE.new  and  then  rename  it  over the old one.  However, if this option is
              unset, we instead truncate the old history file  and  write  out  the  new  version
              in-place.  If one of the history-appending options is enabled, this option only has
              an effect when the enlarged history file needs to be re-written to trim it down  to
              size.   Disable  this only if you have special needs, as doing so makes it possible
              to lose history entries if zsh gets interrupted during the save.

              When writing out a copy of the history file, zsh preserves the old  file's  permis‐
              sions  and  group  information, but will refuse to write out a new file if it would
              change the history file's owner.

       HIST_SAVE_NO_DUPS
              When writing out the history file, older commands that  duplicate  newer  ones  are
              omitted.

       HIST_VERIFY
              Whenever  the  user  enters  a  line with history expansion, don't execute the line
              directly; instead, perform history expansion and reload the line into  the  editing
              buffer.

       INC_APPEND_HISTORY
              This  options  works like APPEND_HISTORY except that new history lines are added to
              the $HISTFILE incrementally (as soon as they  are  entered),  rather  than  waiting
              until  the  shell exits.  The file will still be periodically re-written to trim it
              when the number of lines grows 20% beyond the value  specified  by  $SAVEHIST  (see
              also the HIST_SAVE_BY_COPY option).

       INC_APPEND_HISTORY_TIME
              This  option  is a variant of INC_APPEND_HISTORY in which, where possible, the his‐
              tory entry is written out to the file after the command is finished,  so  that  the
              time   taken  by  the  command  is  recorded  correctly  in  the  history  file  in
              EXTENDED_HISTORY format.  This means that the history entry will not  be  available
              immediately from other instances of the shell that are using the same history file.

              This  option is only useful if INC_APPEND_HISTORY and SHARE_HISTORY are turned off.
              The three options should be considered mutually exclusive.

       SHARE_HISTORY <K>

              This option both imports new commands from the history file, and also  causes  your
              typed  commands  to  be appended to the history file (the latter is like specifying
              INC_APPEND_HISTORY, which should be turned off if this option is in  effect).   The
              history  lines are also output with timestamps ala EXTENDED_HISTORY (which makes it
              easier to find the spot where we left off reading the file after it  gets  re-writ‐
              ten).

              By default, history movement commands visit the imported lines as well as the local
              lines, but you can toggle this on and off with the set-local-history  zle  binding.
              It  is  also  possible  to  create a zle widget that will make some commands ignore
              imported commands, and some include them.

              If you find that you want more control over when commands  get  imported,  you  may
              wish  to turn SHARE_HISTORY off, INC_APPEND_HISTORY or INC_APPEND_HISTORY_TIME (see
              above) on, and then manually import commands whenever you need them using `fc -RI'.

   Initialisation
       ALL_EXPORT (-a, ksh: -a)
              All parameters subsequently defined are automatically exported.

       GLOBAL_EXPORT (<Z>)
              If this option is set, passing the -x flag to the builtins declare, float, integer,
              readonly  and  typeset (but not local) will also set the -g flag;  hence parameters
              exported to the environment will not be  made  local  to  the  enclosing  function,
              unless  they  were  already  or  the flag +g is given explicitly.  If the option is
              unset, exported parameters will be made local in just the same  way  as  any  other
              parameter.

              This  option  is  set  by default for backward compatibility; it is not recommended
              that its behaviour be relied upon.  Note that the builtin export always  sets  both
              the -x and -g flags, and hence its effect extends beyond the scope of the enclosing
              function; this is the most portable way to achieve this behaviour.

       GLOBAL_RCS (-d) <D>
              If this option is  unset,  the  startup  files  /etc/zsh/zprofile,  /etc/zsh/zshrc,
              /etc/zsh/zlogin  and  /etc/zsh/zlogout  will  not  be  run.  It can be disabled and
              re-enabled at any time, including inside local startup files (.zshrc, etc.).

       RCS (+f) <D>
              After /etc/zsh/zshenv is sourced on startup, source the .zshenv, /etc/zsh/zprofile,
              .zprofile, /etc/zsh/zshrc, .zshrc, /etc/zsh/zlogin, .zlogin, and .zlogout files, as
              described in the section `Files'.  If this option  is  unset,  the  /etc/zsh/zshenv
              file is still sourced, but any of the others will not be; it can be set at any time
              to prevent the remaining startup files after the currently executing one from being
              sourced.

   Input/Output
       ALIASES <D>
              Expand aliases.

       CLOBBER (+C, ksh: +C) <D>
              Allows  `>' redirection to truncate existing files, and `>>' to create files.  Oth‐
              erwise `>!' or `>|' must be used to truncate a file, and `>>!' or `>>|' to create a
              file.

       CORRECT (-0)
              Try  to correct the spelling of commands.  Note that, when the HASH_LIST_ALL option
              is not set or when some directories in the path are not readable, this may  falsely
              report spelling errors the first time some commands are used.

              The  shell variable CORRECT_IGNORE may be set to a pattern to match words that will
              never be offered as corrections.

       CORRECT_ALL (-O)
              Try to correct the spelling of all arguments in a line.

              The shell variable CORRECT_IGNORE_FILE may be set to a pattern to match file  names
              that will never be offered as corrections.

       DVORAK Use  the  Dvorak  keyboard  instead  of the standard qwerty keyboard as a basis for
              examining spelling mistakes  for  the  CORRECT  and  CORRECT_ALL  options  and  the
              spell-word editor command.

       FLOW_CONTROL <D>
              If  this  option  is  unset, output flow control via start/stop characters (usually
              assigned to ^S/^Q) is disabled in the shell's editor.

       IGNORE_EOF (-7)
              Do not exit on end-of-file.  Require the use of exit or logout  instead.   However,
              ten  consecutive EOFs will cause the shell to exit anyway, to avoid the shell hang‐
              ing if its tty goes away.

              Also, if this option is set and the Zsh Line Editor is used, widgets implemented by
              shell  functions can be bound to EOF (normally Control-D) without printing the nor‐
              mal warning message.  This works only for normal widgets, not for  completion  wid‐
              gets.

       INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS (-k) <K> <S>
              Allow comments even in interactive shells.

       HASH_CMDS <D>
              Note  the location of each command the first time it is executed.  Subsequent invo‐
              cations of the same command will use the saved location, avoiding  a  path  search.
              If  this option is unset, no path hashing is done at all.  However, when CORRECT is
              set, commands whose names do not appear in the functions or aliases hash tables are
              hashed in order to avoid reporting them as spelling errors.

       HASH_DIRS <D>
              Whenever a command name is hashed, hash the directory containing it, as well as all
              directories that occur earlier in the path.  Has no effect if neither HASH_CMDS nor
              CORRECT is set.

       HASH_EXECUTABLES_ONLY
              When  hashing  commands  because  of HASH_CMDS, check that the file to be hashed is
              actually an executable.  This option is unset by default as if the path contains  a
              large  number  of  commands, or consists of many remote files, the additional tests
              can take a long time.  Trial and error is needed to show if this option is  benefi‐
              cial.

       MAIL_WARNING (-U)
              Print  a  warning  message  if  a  mail file has been accessed since the shell last
              checked.

       PATH_DIRS (-Q)
              Perform a path search even  on  command  names  with  slashes  in  them.   Thus  if
              `/usr/local/bin'  is  in the user's path, and he or she types `X11/xinit', the com‐
              mand `/usr/local/bin/X11/xinit' will be executed (assuming  it  exists).   Commands
              explicitly  beginning  with  `/', `./' or `../' are not subject to the path search.
              This also applies to the `.' and source builtins.

              Note that subdirectories of the current directory are always searched for  executa‐
              bles  specified in this form.  This takes place before any search indicated by this
              option, and regardless of whether `.' or the current directory appear in  the  com‐
              mand search path.

       PATH_SCRIPT <K> <S>
              If  this option is not set, a script passed as the first non-option argument to the
              shell must contain the name of the file to open.  If this option is  set,  and  the
              script  does  not  specify  a directory path, the script is looked for first in the
              current directory, then in the command path.  See the section INVOCATION in zsh(1).

       PRINT_EIGHT_BIT
              Print eight bit characters literally in completion lists, etc.  This option is  not
              necessary if your system correctly returns the printability of eight bit characters
              (see ctype(3)).

       PRINT_EXIT_VALUE (-1)
              Print the exit value of programs with non-zero exit status.  This is only available
              at the command line in interactive shells.

       RC_QUOTES
              Allow  the  character  sequence `''' to signify a single quote within singly quoted
              strings.  Note this does not apply in quoted strings using the format $'...', where
              a backslashed single quote can be used.

       RM_STAR_SILENT (-H) <K> <S>
              Do not query the user before executing `rm *' or `rm path/*'.

       RM_STAR_WAIT
              If querying the user before executing `rm *' or `rm path/*', first wait ten seconds
              and ignore anything typed in that time.  This avoids  the  problem  of  reflexively
              answering  `yes'  to  the query when one didn't really mean it.  The wait and query
              can always be avoided by expanding the `*' in ZLE (with tab).

       SHORT_LOOPS <C> <Z>
              Allow the short forms of for, repeat, select, if, and function constructs.

       SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK (-L)
              If a line ends with a backquote, and there are an odd number of backquotes  on  the
              line,  ignore  the  trailing backquote.  This is useful on some keyboards where the
              return key is too small, and the backquote key lies annoyingly close to it.  As  an
              alternative the variable KEYBOARD_HACK lets you choose the character to be removed.

   Job Control
       AUTO_CONTINUE
              With  this  option  set,  stopped jobs that are removed from the job table with the
              disown builtin command are automatically sent a CONT signal to make them running.

       AUTO_RESUME (-W)
              Treat single word simple commands without redirection as candidates for  resumption
              of an existing job.

       BG_NICE (-6) <C> <Z>
              Run all background jobs at a lower priority.  This option is set by default.

       CHECK_JOBS <Z>
              Report  the status of background and suspended jobs before exiting a shell with job
              control; a second attempt to exit the shell will succeed.   NO_CHECK_JOBS  is  best
              used only in combination with NO_HUP, else such jobs will be killed automatically.

              The  check is omitted if the commands run from the previous command line included a
              `jobs' command, since it is assumed the user is aware that there are background  or
              suspended jobs.  A `jobs' command run from one of the hook functions defined in the
              section SPECIAL FUNCTIONS in zshmisc(1) is not counted for this purpose.

       HUP <Z>
              Send the HUP signal to running jobs when the shell exits.

       LONG_LIST_JOBS (-R)
              List jobs in the long format by default.

       MONITOR (-m, ksh: -m)
              Allow job control.  Set by default in interactive shells.

       NOTIFY (-5, ksh: -b) <Z>
              Report the status of background jobs immediately, rather than  waiting  until  just
              before printing a prompt.

       POSIX_JOBS <K> <S>
              This option makes job control more compliant with the POSIX standard.

              When  the  option is not set, the MONITOR option is unset on entry to subshells, so
              that job control is no longer active.  When the option is set, the  MONITOR  option
              and  job  control  remain active in the subshell, but note that the subshell has no
              access to jobs in the parent shell.

              When the option is not set, jobs put in the background or foreground with bg or  fg
              are  displayed  with the same information that would be reported by jobs.  When the
              option is set, only the text is printed.   The  output  from  jobs  itself  is  not
              affected by the option.

              When the option is not set, job information from the parent shell is saved for out‐
              put within a subshell (for example, within a pipeline).  When the  option  is  set,
              the output of jobs is empty until a job is started within the subshell.

              When the option is set, it becomes possible to use the wait builtin to wait for the
              last job started in the background (as given by $!) even if that  job  has  already
              exited.   This  works even if the option is turned on temporarily around the use of
              the wait builtin.

   Prompting
       PROMPT_BANG <K>
              If set, `!' is treated specially in prompt  expansion.   See  EXPANSION  OF  PROMPT
              SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).

       PROMPT_CR (+V) <D>
              Print  a carriage return just before printing a prompt in the line editor.  This is
              on by default as multi-line editing is only possible if the editor knows where  the
              start of the line appears.

       PROMPT_SP <D>
              Attempt  to  preserve  a partial line (i.e. a line that did not end with a newline)
              that would otherwise be covered up by the  command  prompt  due  to  the  PROMPT_CR
              option.   This  works  by  outputting  some  cursor-control characters, including a
              series of spaces, that should make the terminal wrap to the next line when  a  par‐
              tial  line is present (note that this is only successful if your terminal has auto‐
              matic margins, which is typical).

              When a partial line is preserved, by default you will see an inverse+bold character
              at  the  end  of  the partial line:  a "%" for a normal user or a "#" for root.  If
              set, the shell parameter PROMPT_EOL_MARK can be used to customize how  the  end  of
              partial lines are shown.

              NOTE: if the PROMPT_CR option is not set, enabling this option will have no effect.
              This option is on by default.

       PROMPT_PERCENT <C> <Z>
              If set, `%' is treated specially in prompt  expansion.   See  EXPANSION  OF  PROMPT
              SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).

       PROMPT_SUBST <K> <S>
              If set, parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic expansion are per‐
              formed in prompts.  Substitutions within prompts do not affect the command status.

       TRANSIENT_RPROMPT
              Remove any right prompt from display when accepting a command line.   This  may  be
              useful with terminals with other cut/paste methods.

   Scripts and Functions
       C_BASES
              Output  hexadecimal numbers in the standard C format, for example `0xFF' instead of
              the usual `16#FF'.  If the option OCTAL_ZEROES is also set (it is not by  default),
              octal  numbers  will  be  treated  similarly  and  hence appear as `077' instead of
              `8#77'.  This option has no effect on the choice of the output  base,  nor  on  the
              output  of bases other than hexadecimal and octal.  Note that these formats will be
              understood on input irrespective of the setting of C_BASES.

       C_PRECEDENCES
              This alters the precedence of arithmetic operators to be more like C and other pro‐
              gramming languages; the section ARITHMETIC EVALUATION in zshmisc(1) has an explicit
              list.

       DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD
              Run the DEBUG trap before each command; otherwise it is  run  after  each  command.
              Setting  this  option mimics the behaviour of ksh 93; with the option unset the be‐
              haviour is that of ksh 88.

       ERR_EXIT (-e, ksh: -e)
              If a command has a non-zero exit status, execute the ZERR trap, if set,  and  exit.
              This is disabled while running initialization scripts.

              The behaviour is also disabled inside DEBUG traps.  In this case the option is han‐
              dled specially: it is unset on entry to the trap.  If the  option  DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD
              is  set,  as it is by default, and the option ERR_EXIT is found to have been set on
              exit, then the command for which the DEBUG trap is being executed is skipped.   The
              option is restored after the trap exits.

              Exiting  due  to  ERR_EXIT has certain interactions with asynchronous jobs noted in
              the section JOBS in in zshmisc(1).

       ERR_RETURN
              If a command has a non-zero exit status,  return  immediately  from  the  enclosing
              function.   The  logic  is  identical to that for ERR_EXIT, except that an implicit
              return statement is executed instead of an exit.  This will trigger an exit at  the
              outermost level of a non-interactive script.

       EVAL_LINENO <Z>
              If  set,  line  numbers of expressions evaluated using the builtin eval are tracked
              separately of the enclosing environment.  This applies both to the parameter LINENO
              and  the  line  number  output  by the prompt escape %i.  If the option is set, the
              prompt escape %N will output the string `(eval)' instead of the script or  function
              name  as an indication.   (The two prompt escapes are typically used in the parame‐
              ter PS4 to be output when the option XTRACE is set.)  If EVAL_LINENO is unset,  the
              line  number  of  the surrounding script or function is retained during the evalua‐
              tion.

       EXEC (+n, ksh: +n) <D>
              Do execute commands.  Without this option, commands are read and checked for syntax
              errors,  but  not  executed.   This  option  cannot be turned off in an interactive
              shell, except when `-n' is supplied to the shell at startup.

       FUNCTION_ARGZERO <C> <Z>
              When executing a shell function or sourcing a script, set  $0  temporarily  to  the
              name  of  the  function/script.  Note that toggling FUNCTION_ARGZERO from on to off
              (or off to on) does not change the current value of $0.  Only the state upon  entry
              to the function or script has an effect.  Compare POSIX_ARGZERO.

       LOCAL_LOOPS
              When  this  option is not set, the effect of break and continue commands may propa‐
              gate outside function scope, affecting loops in calling functions.  When the option
              is  set  in  a  calling function, a break or a continue that is not caught within a
              called function (regardless of the setting of the option within that function) pro‐
              duces a warning and the effect is cancelled.

       LOCAL_OPTIONS <K>
              If  this  option  is set at the point of return from a shell function, most options
              (including this one) which were in force upon entry to the function  are  restored;
              options  that are not restored are PRIVILEGED and RESTRICTED.  Otherwise, only this
              option, and the LOCAL_LOOPS, XTRACE  and  PRINT_EXIT_VALUE  options  are  restored.
              Hence if this is explicitly unset by a shell function the other options in force at
              the point of return will remain so.  A shell function can also guarantee  itself  a
              known  shell  configuration  with a formulation like `emulate -L zsh'; the -L acti‐
              vates LOCAL_OPTIONS.

       LOCAL_PATTERNS
              If this option is set at the point of return from a shell function,  the  state  of
              pattern disables, as set with the builtin command `disable -p', is restored to what
              it was when the function was entered.  The behaviour of this option is  similar  to
              the  effect of LOCAL_OPTIONS on options; hence `emulate -L sh' (or indeed any other
              emulation with the -L option) activates LOCAL_PATTERNS.

       LOCAL_TRAPS <K>
              If this option is set when a signal trap is set inside a function, then the  previ‐
              ous  status  of  the trap for that signal will be restored when the function exits.
              Note that this option must be set prior to altering the trap behaviour in  a  func‐
              tion;  unlike  LOCAL_OPTIONS,  the  value  on exit from the function is irrelevant.
              However, it does not need to be set before any global trap for that to be correctly
              restored by a function.  For example,

                     unsetopt localtraps
                     trap - INT
                     fn() { setopt localtraps; trap '' INT; sleep 3; }

              will restore normal handling of SIGINT after the function exits.

       MULTI_FUNC_DEF <Z>
              Allow  definitions of multiple functions at once in the form `fn1 fn2...()'; if the
              option is not set, this causes a parse error.   Definition  of  multiple  functions
              with the function keyword is always allowed.  Multiple function definitions are not
              often used and can cause obscure errors.

       MULTIOS <Z>
              Perform implicit tees or cats when multiple redirections  are  attempted  (see  the
              section `Redirection').

       OCTAL_ZEROES <S>
              Interpret  any  integer  constant  beginning  with  a  0  as  octal,  per  IEEE Std
              1003.2-1992 (ISO 9945-2:1993).  This is not enabled by default as it  causes  prob‐
              lems with parsing of, for example, date and time strings with leading zeroes.

              Sequences of digits indicating a numeric base such as the `08' component in `08#77'
              are always interpreted as decimal, regardless of leading zeroes.

       PIPE_FAIL
              By default, when a pipeline exits  the  exit  status  recorded  by  the  shell  and
              returned by the shell variable $? reflects that of the rightmost element of a pipe‐
              line.  If this option is set, the exit status instead reflects the  status  of  the
              rightmost element of the pipeline that was non-zero, or zero if all elements exited
              with zero status.

       SOURCE_TRACE
              If set, zsh will print an informational message announcing the name of each file it
              loads.  The format of the output is similar to that for the XTRACE option, with the
              message <sourcetrace>.  A file may be loaded by the shell itself when it starts  up
              and  shuts  down  (Startup/Shutdown  Files) or by the use of the `source' and `dot'
              builtin commands.

       TYPESET_SILENT
              If this is unset, executing any of the `typeset' family of commands with no options
              and  a list of parameters that have no values to be assigned but already exist will
              display the value of the parameter.  If the option is set, they will only be  shown
              when  parameters  are  selected with the `-m' option.  The option `-p' is available
              whether or not the option is set.

       VERBOSE (-v, ksh: -v)
              Print shell input lines as they are read.

       XTRACE (-x, ksh: -x)
              Print commands and their arguments as they are executed.  The output is preceded by
              the  value  of  $PS4,  formatted  as  described  in the section EXPANSION OF PROMPT
              SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).

   Shell Emulation
       BASH_REMATCH
              When set, matches performed with the =~ operator will set  the  BASH_REMATCH  array
              variable,  instead  of the default MATCH and match variables.  The first element of
              the BASH_REMATCH array will contain the entire matched text and subsequent elements
              will contain extracted substrings.  This option makes more sense when KSH_ARRAYS is
              also set, so that the entire matched portion is stored at index  0  and  the  first
              substring  is  at  index  1.   Without this option, the MATCH variable contains the
              entire matched text and the match array variable contains substrings.

       BSD_ECHO <S>
              Make the echo builtin compatible with the BSD echo(1) command.  This disables back‐
              slashed escape sequences in echo strings unless the -e option is specified.

       CONTINUE_ON_ERROR
              If  a  fatal  error  is encountered (see the section ERRORS in zshmisc(1)), and the
              code is running in a script, the shell will resume execution at the next  statement
              in  the script at the top level, in other words outside all functions or shell con‐
              structs such as loops and conditions.  This mimics  the  behaviour  of  interactive
              shells,  where  the  shell returns to the line editor to read a new command; it was
              the normal behaviour in versions of zsh before 5.0.1.

       CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY <C>
              A history reference without an event specifier will always refer  to  the  previous
              command.  Without this option, such a history reference refers to the same event as
              the previous history reference, defaulting to the previous command.

       CSH_JUNKIE_LOOPS <C>
              Allow loop bodies to take the form `list; end' instead of `do list; done'.

       CSH_JUNKIE_QUOTES <C>
              Changes the rules for single- and double-quoted text to match that of  csh.   These
              require  that embedded newlines be preceded by a backslash; unescaped newlines will
              cause an error message.  In double-quoted strings, it is made impossible to  escape
              `$',  ``'  or `"' (and `\' itself no longer needs escaping).  Command substitutions
              are only expanded once, and cannot be nested.

       CSH_NULLCMD <C>
              Do not use the values of NULLCMD and READNULLCMD when running redirections with  no
              command.  This make such redirections fail (see the section `Redirection').

       KSH_ARRAYS <K> <S>
              Emulate  ksh  array  handling as closely as possible.  If this option is set, array
              elements are numbered from zero, an array parameter without subscript refers to the
              first element instead of the whole array, and braces are required to delimit a sub‐
              script (`${path[2]}' rather than just `$path[2]').

       KSH_AUTOLOAD <K> <S>
              Emulate ksh function autoloading.  This means that when a function  is  autoloaded,
              the  corresponding  file  is  merely executed, and must define the function itself.
              (By default, the function is defined to the contents of  the  file.   However,  the
              most common ksh-style case - of the file containing only a simple definition of the
              function - is always handled in the ksh-compatible manner.)

       KSH_OPTION_PRINT <K>
              Alters the way options settings are printed: instead of separate lists of  set  and
              unset  options,  all  options are shown, marked `on' if they are in the non-default
              state, `off' otherwise.

       KSH_TYPESET <K>
              Alters the way arguments to the typeset  family  of  commands,  including  declare,
              export,  float,  integer,  local and readonly, are processed.  Without this option,
              zsh will perform normal word splitting after command  and  parameter  expansion  in
              arguments  of  an  assignment; with it, word splitting does not take place in those
              cases.

       KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT
              Treat use of a subscript of value zero in array or string expressions as  a  refer‐
              ence  to  the  first  element,  i.e.  the element that usually has the subscript 1.
              Ignored if KSH_ARRAYS is also set.

              If neither this option nor KSH_ARRAYS is set, accesses to an element of an array or
              string with subscript zero return an empty element or string, while attempts to set
              element zero of an array or string are treated as an error.  However,  attempts  to
              set  an otherwise valid subscript range that includes zero will succeed.  For exam‐
              ple, if KSH_ZERO_SUBSCRIPT is not set,

                     array[0]=(element)

              is an error, while

                     array[0,1]=(element)

              is not and will replace the first element of the array.

              This option is for compatibility with older versions of the shell and is not recom‐
              mended in new code.

       POSIX_ALIASES <K> <S>
              When this option is set, reserved words are not candidates for alias expansion:  it
              is still possible to declare any of them as an alias, but the alias will  never  be
              expanded.   Reserved  words  are  described  in  the section RESERVED WORDS in zsh‐
              misc(1).

              Alias expansion takes place while text is being read; hence when this option is set
              it  does not take effect until the end of any function or other piece of shell code
              parsed as one unit.  Note this may cause differences from other  shells  even  when
              the  option  is  in  effect.  For example, when running a command with `zsh -c', or
              even `zsh -o posixaliases -c', the entire command argument is parsed as  one  unit,
              so  aliases  defined within the argument are not available even in later lines.  If
              in doubt, avoid use of aliases in non-interactive code.

       POSIX_ARGZERO
              This option may be used to temporarily disable FUNCTION_ARGZERO and thereby restore
              the  value  of $0 to the name used to invoke the shell (or as set by the -c command
              line option).  For compatibility with previous versions of  the  shell,  emulations
              use  NO_FUNCTION_ARGZERO  instead  of POSIX_ARGZERO, which may result in unexpected
              scoping of $0 if the emulation mode is changed inside a  function  or  script.   To
              avoid this, explicitly enable POSIX_ARGZERO in the emulate command:

                     emulate sh -o POSIX_ARGZERO

              Note  that  NO_POSIX_ARGZERO  has  no  effect  unless  FUNCTION_ARGZERO was already
              enabled upon entry to the function or script.

       POSIX_BUILTINS <K> <S>
              When this option is set the command builtin can be used to  execute  shell  builtin
              commands.   Parameter  assignments  specified  before  shell  functions and special
              builtins are kept after the command completes unless the special  builtin  is  pre‐
              fixed  with  the  command  builtin.   Special  builtins  are ., :, break, continue,
              declare, eval, exit, export, integer, local, readonly, return, set, shift,  source,
              times, trap and unset.

              In  addition,  various  error conditions associated with the above builtins or exec
              cause a non-interactive shell to exit and an interactive shell  to  return  to  its
              top-level processing.

       POSIX_IDENTIFIERS <K> <S>
              When this option is set, only the ASCII characters a to z, A to Z, 0 to 9 and _ may
              be used in identifiers (names of shell parameters and modules).

              When the option is unset and multibyte character support is  enabled  (i.e.  it  is
              compiled  in  and  the option MULTIBYTE is set), then additionally any alphanumeric
              characters in the local character set  may  be  used  in  identifiers.   Note  that
              scripts  and  functions  written  with this feature are not portable, and also that
              both options must be set before the script or function is parsed; setting them dur‐
              ing  execution  is  not  sufficient  as  the syntax variable=value has already been
              parsed as a command rather than an assignment.

              If multibyte character support is not  compiled  into  the  shell  this  option  is
              ignored;  all  octets  with  the  top  bit set may be used in identifiers.  This is
              non-standard but is the traditional zsh behaviour.

       POSIX_STRINGS <K> <S>
              This option affects processing of quoted strings.  Currently it  only  affects  the
              behaviour of null characters, i.e. character 0 in the portable character set corre‐
              sponding to US ASCII.

              When this option is not set, null characters embedded within strings  of  the  form
              $'...'  are  treated as ordinary characters. The entire string is maintained within
              the shell and output to files where necessary, although owing  to  restrictions  of
              the  library interface the string is truncated at the null character in file names,
              environment variables, or in arguments to external programs.

              When this option is set, the $'...' expression is truncated at the null  character.
              Note  that  remaining parts of the same string beyond the termination of the quotes
              are not truncated.

              For example, the command line argument a$'b\0c'd is treated with the option off  as
              the characters a, b, null, c, d, and with the option on as the characters a, b, d.

       POSIX_TRAPS <K> <S>
              When  the  is option is set, the usual zsh behaviour of executing traps for EXIT on
              exit from shell functions is suppressed.  In that  case,  manipulating  EXIT  traps
              always  alters  the  global  trap  for exiting the shell; the LOCAL_TRAPS option is
              ignored for the EXIT trap.  Furthermore, a return statement executed in a trap with
              no  argument  passes back from the function the value from the surrounding context,
              not from code executed within the trap.

       SH_FILE_EXPANSION <K> <S>
              Perform filename expansion (e.g., ~ expansion) before parameter expansion,  command
              substitution,  arithmetic  expansion and brace expansion.  If this option is unset,
              it is performed after brace expansion, so things  like  `~$USERNAME'  and  `~{pfal‐
              stad,rc}' will work.

       SH_NULLCMD <K> <S>
              Do  not  use the values of NULLCMD and READNULLCMD when doing redirections, use `:'
              instead (see the section `Redirection').

       SH_OPTION_LETTERS <K> <S>
              If this option is set the shell tries to interpret single letter options (which are
              used with set and setopt) like ksh does.  This also affects the value of the - spe‐
              cial parameter.

       SH_WORD_SPLIT (-y) <K> <S>
              Causes field splitting to be performed on unquoted parameter expansions.  Note that
              this  option  has  nothing  to do with word splitting.  (See the section `Parameter
              Expansion'.)

       TRAPS_ASYNC
              While waiting for a program to exit, handle  signals  and  run  traps  immediately.
              Otherwise  the  trap  is  run after a child process has exited.  Note this does not
              affect the point at which traps are run for any case other than when the  shell  is
              waiting for a child process.

   Shell State
       INTERACTIVE (-i, ksh: -i)
              This  is an interactive shell.  This option is set upon initialisation if the stan‐
              dard input is a tty and commands are being read from standard input.  (See the dis‐
              cussion of SHIN_STDIN.)  This heuristic may be overridden by specifying a state for
              this option on the command line.  The value of this option can only be changed  via
              flags  supplied  at invocation of the shell.  It cannot be changed once zsh is run‐
              ning.

       LOGIN (-l, ksh: -l)
              This is a login shell.  If this option is not explicitly set, the shell  becomes  a
              login shell if the first character of the argv[0] passed to the shell is a `-'.

       PRIVILEGED (-p, ksh: -p)
              Turn  on privileged mode. This is enabled automatically on startup if the effective
              user (group) ID is not equal to the real user (group) ID.  Turning this option  off
              causes  the  effective user and group IDs to be set to the real user and group IDs.
              This option disables sourcing user startup files.  If zsh is  invoked  as  `sh'  or
              `ksh'  with  this  option  set, /etc/suid_profile is sourced (after /etc/profile on
              interactive shells). Sourcing ~/.profile is disabled and the contents  of  the  ENV
              variable  is  ignored.  This option cannot be changed using the -m option of setopt
              and unsetopt, and changing it inside a function always changes it globally  regard‐
              less of the LOCAL_OPTIONS option.

       RESTRICTED (-r)
              Enables restricted mode.  This option cannot be changed using unsetopt, and setting
              it inside a function always changes it globally  regardless  of  the  LOCAL_OPTIONS
              option.  See the section `Restricted Shell'.

       SHIN_STDIN (-s, ksh: -s)
              Commands  are  being read from the standard input.  Commands are read from standard
              input if no command is specified with -c and no file of commands is specified.   If
              SHIN_STDIN is set explicitly on the command line, any argument that would otherwise
              have been taken as a file to run will instead be treated  as  a  normal  positional
              parameter.  Note that setting or unsetting this option on the command line does not
              necessarily affect the state the option will have while the shell is running - that
              is  purely  an  indicator  of  whether on not commands are actually being read from
              standard input.  The value of this option can only be changed via flags supplied at
              invocation of the shell.  It cannot be changed once zsh is running.

       SINGLE_COMMAND (-t, ksh: -t)
              If  the  shell  is reading from standard input, it exits after a single command has
              been executed.  This also makes the shell non-interactive, unless  the  INTERACTIVE
              option is explicitly set on the command line.  The value of this option can only be
              changed via flags supplied at invocation of the shell.  It cannot be  changed  once
              zsh is running.

   Zle
       BEEP (+B) <D>
              Beep on error in ZLE.

       COMBINING_CHARS
              Assume that the terminal displays combining characters correctly.  Specifically, if
              a base alphanumeric character is followed by one  or  more  zero-width  punctuation
              characters,  assume  that  the zero-width characters will be displayed as modifica‐
              tions to the base character within the same width.  Not all terminals handle  this.
              If this option is not set, zero-width characters are displayed separately with spe‐
              cial mark-up.

              If this option is set, the pattern test [[:WORD:]] matches a zero-width punctuation
              character  on  the assumption that it will be used as part of a word in combination
              with a word character.  Otherwise the base shell does not handle combining  charac‐
              ters specially.

       EMACS  If ZLE is loaded, turning on this option has the equivalent effect of `bindkey -e'.
              In addition, the VI option is unset.  Turning it off has  no  effect.   The  option
              setting  is  not guaranteed to reflect the current keymap.  This option is provided
              for compatibility; bindkey is the recommended interface.

       OVERSTRIKE
              Start up the line editor in overstrike mode.

       SINGLE_LINE_ZLE (-M) <K>
              Use single-line command line editing instead of multi-line.

              Note that although this is on by default in ksh emulation it only provides superfi‐
              cial  compatibility  with  the ksh line editor and reduces the effectiveness of the
              zsh line editor.  As it has no effect on shell syntax, many users may wish to  dis‐
              able this option when using ksh emulation interactively.

       VI     If ZLE is loaded, turning on this option has the equivalent effect of `bindkey -v'.
              In addition, the EMACS option is unset.  Turning it off has no effect.  The  option
              setting  is  not guaranteed to reflect the current keymap.  This option is provided
              for compatibility; bindkey is the recommended interface.

       ZLE (-Z)
              Use the zsh line editor.  Set by default in interactive shells connected to a  ter‐
              minal.

OPTION ALIASES
       Some  options have alternative names.  These aliases are never used for output, but can be
       used just like normal option names when specifying options to the shell.

       BRACE_EXPAND
              NO_IGNORE_BRACES (ksh and bash compatibility)

       DOT_GLOB
              GLOB_DOTS (bash compatibility)

       HASH_ALL
              HASH_CMDS (bash compatibility)

       HIST_APPEND
              APPEND_HISTORY (bash compatibility)

       HIST_EXPAND
              BANG_HIST (bash compatibility)

       LOG    NO_HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS (ksh compatibility)

       MAIL_WARN
              MAIL_WARNING (bash compatibility)

       ONE_CMD
              SINGLE_COMMAND (bash compatibility)

       PHYSICAL
              CHASE_LINKS (ksh and bash compatibility)

       PROMPT_VARS
              PROMPT_SUBST (bash compatibility)

       STDIN  SHIN_STDIN (ksh compatibility)

       TRACK_ALL
              HASH_CMDS (ksh compatibility)

SINGLE LETTER OPTIONS
   Default set
       -0     CORRECT
       -1     PRINT_EXIT_VALUE
       -2     NO_BAD_PATTERN
       -3     NO_NOMATCH
       -4     GLOB_DOTS
       -5     NOTIFY
       -6     BG_NICE
       -7     IGNORE_EOF
       -8     MARK_DIRS
       -9     AUTO_LIST
       -B     NO_BEEP
       -C     NO_CLOBBER
       -D     PUSHD_TO_HOME
       -E     PUSHD_SILENT
       -F     NO_GLOB
       -G     NULL_GLOB
       -H     RM_STAR_SILENT
       -I     IGNORE_BRACES
       -J     AUTO_CD
       -K     NO_BANG_HIST
       -L     SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK
       -M     SINGLE_LINE_ZLE
       -N     AUTO_PUSHD
       -O     CORRECT_ALL
       -P     RC_EXPAND_PARAM
       -Q     PATH_DIRS
       -R     LONG_LIST_JOBS
       -S     REC_EXACT
       -T     CDABLE_VARS
       -U     MAIL_WARNING
       -V     NO_PROMPT_CR
       -W     AUTO_RESUME
       -X     LIST_TYPES
       -Y     MENU_COMPLETE
       -Z     ZLE
       -a     ALL_EXPORT
       -e     ERR_EXIT
       -f     NO_RCS
       -g     HIST_IGNORE_SPACE
       -h     HIST_IGNORE_DUPS
       -i     INTERACTIVE
       -k     INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS
       -l     LOGIN
       -m     MONITOR
       -n     NO_EXEC
       -p     PRIVILEGED
       -r     RESTRICTED
       -s     SHIN_STDIN
       -t     SINGLE_COMMAND
       -u     NO_UNSET
       -v     VERBOSE
       -w     CHASE_LINKS
       -x     XTRACE
       -y     SH_WORD_SPLIT

   sh/ksh emulation set
       -C     NO_CLOBBER
       -T     TRAPS_ASYNC
       -X     MARK_DIRS
       -a     ALL_EXPORT
       -b     NOTIFY
       -e     ERR_EXIT
       -f     NO_GLOB
       -i     INTERACTIVE
       -l     LOGIN
       -m     MONITOR
       -n     NO_EXEC
       -p     PRIVILEGED
       -r     RESTRICTED
       -s     SHIN_STDIN
       -t     SINGLE_COMMAND
       -u     NO_UNSET
       -v     VERBOSE
       -x     XTRACE

   Also note
       -A     Used by set for setting arrays
       -b     Used on the command line to specify end of option processing
       -c     Used on the command line to specify a single command
       -m     Used by setopt for pattern-matching option setting
       -o     Used in all places to allow use of long option names
       -s     Used by set to sort positional parameters



ZSHBUILTINS(1)                       General Commands Manual                       ZSHBUILTINS(1)



NAME
       zshbuiltins - zsh built-in commands

SHELL BUILTIN COMMANDS
       Some shell builtin commands take options as described in  individual  entries;  these  are
       often  referred  to  in  the  list below as `flags' to avoid confusion with shell options,
       which may also have an effect on the behaviour of builtin commands.  In this  introductory
       section, `option' always has the meaning of an option to a command that should be familiar
       to most command line users.

       Typically, options are single letters preceded by a hyphen  (-).   Options  that  take  an
       argument  accept  it  either immediately following the option letter or after white space,
       for example `print -C3 *' or `print -C 3 *' are equivalent.  Arguments to options are  not
       the same as arguments to the command; the documentation indicates which is which.  Options
       that do not take an argument may be combined in a single word, for example `print  -ca  *'
       and `print -c -a *' are equivalent.

       Some  shell  builtin  commands  also take options that begin with `+' instead of `-'.  The
       list below makes clear which commands these are.

       Options (together with their individual arguments, if any) must appear in a  group  before
       any  non-option  arguments; once the first non-option argument has been found, option pro‐
       cessing is terminated.

       All builtin commands other than precommand modifiers, even those that have no options, can
       be  given  the argument `--' to terminate option processing.  This indicates that the fol‐
       lowing words are non-option arguments, but is otherwise ignored.  This is useful in  cases
       where  arguments  to the command may begin with `-'.  For historical reasons, most builtin
       commands also recognize a single `-' in a separate word for this purpose; note  that  this
       is less standard and use of `-- is recommended.

       - simple command
              See the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       . file [ arg ... ]
              Read commands from file and execute them in the current shell environment.

              If  file  does  not contain a slash, or if PATH_DIRS is set, the shell looks in the
              components of $path to find the directory containing file.  Files  in  the  current
              directory  are  not  read  unless  `.' appears somewhere in $path.  If a file named
              `file.zwc' is found, is newer than file, and is the compiled form (created with the
              zcompile builtin) of file, then commands are read from that file instead of file.

              If  any  arguments  arg  are  given, they become the positional parameters; the old
              positional parameters are restored when the file is done executing.   If  file  was
              not  found the return status is 127; if file was found but contained a syntax error
              the return status is 126; else the return status is the exit  status  of  the  last
              command executed.

       : [ arg ... ]
              This  command  does nothing, although normal argument expansions is performed which
              may have effects on shell parameters.  A zero exit status is returned.

       alias [ {+|-}gmrsL ] [ name[=value] ... ]
              For each name with a corresponding value, define  an  alias  with  that  value.   A
              trailing space in value causes the next word to be checked for alias expansion.  If
              the -g flag is present, define a global alias; global aliases are expanded even  if
              they do not occur in command position.

              If  the -s flag is present, define a suffix alias: if the command word on a command
              line is in the form `text.name', where text is any non-empty string, it is replaced
              by  the text `value text.name'.  Note that name is treated as a literal string, not
              a pattern.  A trailing space in value is not special in this case.  For example,

                     alias -s ps=gv

              will cause the command `*.ps' to be expanded to `gv *.ps'.  As alias  expansion  is
              carried  out  earlier  than  globbing,  the  `*.ps'  will then be expanded.  Suffix
              aliases constitute a different name space from other aliases (so in the above exam‐
              ple  it  is  still possible to create an alias for the command ps) and the two sets
              are never listed together.

              For each name with no value, print the value of name, if any.  With  no  arguments,
              print  all  currently defined aliases other than suffix aliases.  If the -m flag is
              given the arguments are taken as patterns (they should be quoted to  preserve  them
              from  being  interpreted as glob patterns), and the aliases matching these patterns
              are printed.  When printing aliases and one of the -g, -r or -s flags  is  present,
              restrict the printing to global, regular or suffix aliases, respectively; a regular
              alias is one which is neither a global nor a suffix alias.   Using `+'  instead  of
              `-',  or  ending  the  option  list  with  a single `+', prevents the values of the
              aliases from being printed.

              If the -L flag is present, then print each alias in a manner suitable  for  putting
              in a startup script.  The exit status is nonzero if a name (with no value) is given
              for which no alias has been defined.

              For more on aliases, include common problems, see  the  section  ALIASING  in  zsh‐
              misc(1).

       autoload [ {+|-}UXkmtz ] [ -w ] [ name ... ]
              Equivalent to functions -u, with the exception of -X/+X and -w.

              The  flag -X may be used only inside a shell function, and may not be followed by a
              name.  It causes the calling function to be marked for autoloading and then immedi‐
              ately loaded and executed, with the current array of positional parameters as argu‐
              ments.  This replaces the previous definition of the function.  If no function def‐
              inition is found, an error is printed and the function remains undefined and marked
              for autoloading.

              The flag +X attempts to load each name as an autoloaded function, but does not exe‐
              cute  it.   The  exit  status  is zero (success) if the function was not previously
              defined and a definition for it was found.  This does not replace any existing def‐
              inition  of the function.  The exit status is nonzero (failure) if the function was
              already defined or when no definition was found.  In the latter case  the  function
              remains undefined and marked for autoloading.  If ksh-style autoloading is enabled,
              the function created will contain the contents of the file plus a call to the func‐
              tion  itself  appended  to  it, thus giving normal ksh autoloading behaviour on the
              first call to the function.  If the -m flag is also given each name is treated as a
              pattern  and  all  functions already marked for autoload that match the pattern are
              loaded.

              With the -w flag, the names are taken as names of files compiled with the  zcompile
              builtin, and all functions defined in them are marked for autoloading.

              The  flags -z and -k mark the function to be autoloaded using the zsh or ksh style,
              as if the option KSH_AUTOLOAD were unset or  were  set,  respectively.   The  flags
              override the setting of the option at the time the function is loaded.

              Note  that  the  autoload  command makes no attempt to ensure the shell options set
              during the loading or execution of the file have any particular value.   For  this,
              the emulate command can be used:

                     emulate zsh -c 'autoload -Uz func'

              arranges  that  when  func is loaded the shell is in native zsh emulation, and this
              emulation is also applied when func is run.

       bg [ job ... ]
       job ... &
              Put each specified job in the background, or the current job if none is specified.

       bindkey
              See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       break [ n ]
              Exit from an enclosing for, while, until, select or repeat loop.  If  n  is  speci‐
              fied, then break n levels instead of just one.

       builtin name [ args ... ]
              Executes the builtin name, with the given args.

       bye    Same as exit.

       cap    See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       cd [ -qsLP ] [ arg ]
       cd [ -qsLP ] old new
       cd [ -qsLP ] {+|-}n
              Change  the  current directory.  In the first form, change the current directory to
              arg, or to the value of $HOME if arg is not specified.  If arg is  `-',  change  to
              the previous directory.

              Otherwise,  if arg begins with a slash, attempt to change to the directory given by
              arg.

              If arg does not begin with a slash, the behaviour depends on  whether  the  current
              directory  `.'  occurs  in the list of directories contained in the shell parameter
              cdpath.  If it does not, first attempt to change to the  directory  arg  under  the
              current  directory,  and  if that fails but cdpath is set and contains at least one
              element attempt to change to the directory arg under each component  of  cdpath  in
              turn  until  successful.  If `.' occurs in cdpath, then cdpath is searched strictly
              in order so that `.' is only tried at the appropriate point.

              The order of testing cdpath is modified if the option POSIX_CD is set, as described
              in the documentation for the option.

              If  no directory is found, the option CDABLE_VARS is set, and a parameter named arg
              exists whose value begins with a slash, treat its value as the directory.  In  that
              case, the parameter is added to the named directory hash table.

              The  second form of cd substitutes the string new for the string old in the name of
              the current directory, and tries to change to this new directory.

              The third form of cd extracts an entry from the directory  stack,  and  changes  to
              that  directory.  An argument of the form `+n' identifies a stack entry by counting
              from the left of the list shown by the dirs command, starting with zero.  An  argu‐
              ment of the form `-n' counts from the right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS option is set, the
              meanings of `+' and `-' in this context are swapped.

              If the -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook function chpwd and the functions in
              the  array  chpwd_functions are not called.  This is useful for calls to cd that do
              not change the environment seen by an interactive user.

              If the -s option is specified, cd refuses to change the current  directory  if  the
              given  pathname  contains  symlinks.   If the -P option is given or the CHASE_LINKS
              option is set, symbolic links are resolved to their true values.  If the -L  option
              is given symbolic links are retained in the directory (and not resolved) regardless
              of the state of the CHASE_LINKS option.

       chdir  Same as cd.

       clone  See the section `The zsh/clone Module' in zshmodules(1).

       command [ -pvV ] simple command
              The simple command argument is taken as an external command instead of  a  function
              or builtin and is executed. If the POSIX_BUILTINS option is set, builtins will also
              be executed but certain special properties of them  are  suppressed.  The  -p  flag
              causes  a  default  path to be searched instead of that in $path. With the -v flag,
              command is similar to whence and with -V, it is equivalent to whence -v.

              See also the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       comparguments
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compcall
              See the section `The zsh/compctl Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compctl
              See the section `The zsh/compctl Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compdescribe
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compfiles
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compgroups
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compquote
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       comptags
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       comptry
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       compvalues
              See the section `The zsh/computil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       continue [ n ]
              Resume the next iteration of the enclosing for,  while,  until,  select  or  repeat
              loop.   If  n  is specified, break out of n-1 loops and resume at the nth enclosing
              loop.

       declare
              Same as typeset.

       dirs [ -c ] [ arg ... ]
       dirs [ -lpv ]
              With no arguments, print the contents of  the  directory  stack.   Directories  are
              added  to  this  stack with the pushd command, and removed with the cd or popd com‐
              mands.  If arguments are specified, load them onto the directory  stack,  replacing
              anything that was there, and push the current directory onto the stack.

              -c     clear the directory stack.

              -l     print  directory  names in full instead of using of using ~ expressions (see
                     Dynamic and Static named directories in zshexpn(1)).

              -p     print directory entries one per line.

              -v     number the directories in the stack when printing.

       disable [ -afmprs ] name ...
              Temporarily disable the named hash table elements or patterns.  The default  is  to
              disable builtin commands.  This allows you to use an external command with the same
              name as a builtin command.  The -a option causes  disable  to  act  on  regular  or
              global  aliases.   The  -s  option causes disable to act on suffix aliases.  The -f
              option causes disable to act on shell functions.  The -r options causes disable  to
              act on reserved words.  Without arguments all disabled hash table elements from the
              corresponding hash table are printed.  With the -m flag the arguments are taken  as
              patterns  (which  should  be quoted to prevent them from undergoing filename expan‐
              sion), and all hash table elements from the corresponding hash table matching these
              patterns are disabled.  Disabled objects can be enabled with the enable command.

              With  the  option  -p,  name ... refer to elements of the shell's pattern syntax as
              described in the section `Filename Generation'.  Certain elements can  be  disabled
              separately, as given below.

              Note   that   patterns  not  allowed  by  the  current  settings  for  the  options
              EXTENDED_GLOB, KSH_GLOB and SH_GLOB are never enabled, regardless  of  the  setting
              here.   For  example,  if EXTENDED_GLOB is not active, the pattern ^ is ineffective
              even if `disable -p "^"' has not been issued.  The list below indicates any  option
              settings  that  restrict  the  use of the pattern.  It should be noted that setting
              SH_GLOB has a wider effect then merely disabling patterns as  certain  expressions,
              in particular those involving parentheses, are parsed differently.

              The following patterns may be disabled; all the strings need quoting on the command
              line to prevent them from being interpreted immediately as patterns  and  the  pat‐
              terns are shown below in single quotes as a reminder.
              '?'    The  pattern  character  ?  wherever  it  occurs, including when preceding a
                     parenthesis with KSH_GLOB.

              '*'    The pattern character * wherever it occurs, including recursive globbing and
                     when preceding a parenthesis with KSH_GLOB.

              '['    Character classes.

              '<' (NO_SH_GLOB)
                     Numeric ranges.

              '|' (NO_SH_GLOB)
                     Alternation  in grouped patterns, case statements, or KSH_GLOB parenthesised
                     expressions.

              '(' (NO_SH_GLOB)
                     Grouping using single parentheses.  Disabling this does not disable the  use
                     of  parentheses  for KSH_GLOB where they are introduced by a special charac‐
                     ter, nor for glob qualifiers (use `setopt NO_BARE_GLOB_QUAL' to disable glob
                     qualifiers that use parentheses only).

              '~' (EXTENDED_GLOB)
                     Exclusion in the form A~B.

              '^' (EXTENDED_GLOB)
                     Exclusion in the form A^B.

              '#' (EXTENDED_GLOB)
                     The  pattern character # wherever it occurs, both for repetition of a previ‐
                     ous pattern and for indicating globbing flags.

              '?(' (KSH_GLOB)
                     The grouping form ?(...).  Note this is also disabled if '?' is disabled.

              '*(' (KSH_GLOB)
                     The grouping form *(...).  Note this is also disabled if '*' is disabled.

              '+(' (KSH_GLOB)
                     The grouping form +(...).

              '!(' (KSH_GLOB)
                     The grouping form !(...).

              '@(' (KSH_GLOB)
                     The grouping form @(...).

       disown [ job ... ]
       job ... &|
       job ... &!
              Remove the specified jobs from the job table; the shell will no longer report their
              status,  and  will  not  complain if you try to exit an interactive shell with them
              running or stopped.  If no job is specified, disown the current job.

              If the jobs are currently stopped and the AUTO_CONTINUE option is not set, a  warn‐
              ing  is  printed  containing  information about how to make them running after they
              have been disowned.  If one of the latter two forms is used, the jobs will automat‐
              ically be made running, independent of the setting of the AUTO_CONTINUE option.

       echo [ -neE ] [ arg ... ]
              Write each arg on the standard output, with a space separating each one.  If the -n
              flag is not present, print a newline at the end.   echo  recognizes  the  following
              escape sequences:

              \a     bell character
              \b     backspace
              \c     suppress final newline
              \e     escape
              \f     form feed
              \n     linefeed (newline)
              \r     carriage return
              \t     horizontal tab
              \v     vertical tab
              \\     backslash
              \0NNN  character code in octal
              \xNN   character code in hexadecimal
              \uNNNN unicode character code in hexadecimal
              \UNNNNNNNN
                     unicode character code in hexadecimal

              The -E flag, or the BSD_ECHO option, can be used to disable these escape sequences.
              In the latter case, -e flag can be used to enable them.

       echotc See the section `The zsh/termcap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       echoti See the section `The zsh/terminfo Module' in zshmodules(1).

       emulate [ -LR ] [ {zsh|sh|ksh|csh} [ flags ... ] ]
              Without any argument print current emulation mode.

              With single argument set up zsh options to emulate the specified shell as  much  as
              possible.   csh  will  never  be fully emulated.  If the argument is not one of the
              shells listed above, zsh will be used as a default; more precisely, the tests  per‐
              formed  on  the  argument  are the same as those used to determine the emulation at
              startup based on the shell name, see the section  COMPATIBILITY  in  zsh(1)  .   In
              addition  to setting shell options, the command also restores the pristine state of
              pattern enables, as if all patterns had been enabled using enable -p.

              If the emulate command occurs inside a function that has been marked for  execution
              tracing  with  functions  -t then the xtrace option will be turned on regardless of
              emulation mode or other options.  Note that code executed inside  the  function  by
              the  .,  source, or eval commands is not considered to be running directly from the
              function, hence does not provoke this behaviour.

              If the -R switch is given, all settable options are reset to  their  default  value
              corresponding  to the specified emulation mode, except for certain options describ‐
              ing the interactive environment; otherwise, only  those  options  likely  to  cause
              portability  problems  in  scripts  and functions are altered.  If the -L switch is
              given, the options LOCAL_OPTIONS, LOCAL_PATTERNS and LOCAL_TRAPS  will  be  set  as
              well,  causing  the  effects  of  the emulate command and any setopt, disable -p or
              enable -p, and trap commands to be local to the immediately surrounding shell func‐
              tion,  if  any; normally these options are turned off in all emulation modes except
              ksh. The -L switch is mutually exclusive with the use of -c in flags.

              The flags may be any of the invocation-time flags described in the section  INVOCA‐
              TION  in zsh(1), except that `-o EMACS' and `-o VI' may not be used.  Flags such as
              `+r'/`+o RESTRICTED' may be prohibited in some circumstances.

              If -c arg appears in flags, arg is evaluated while the requested emulation is  tem‐
              porarily  in  effect.  In this case the emulation mode and all options are restored
              to their previous values before emulate returns.  The -R  switch  may  precede  the
              name of the shell to emulate; note this has a meaning distinct from including -R in
              flags.

              Use of -c enables `sticky' emulation mode for functions defined within  the  evalu‐
              ated  expression:  the emulation mode is associated thereafter with the function so
              that whenever the function is executed the emulation (respecting the -R switch,  if
              present) and all options are set (and pattern disables cleared) before entry to the
              function, and the state is restored after exit.  If the function is called when the
              sticky  emulation is already in effect, either within an `emulate shell -c' expres‐
              sion or within another function with the same sticky emulation, entry and exit from
              the  function do not cause options to be altered (except due to standard processing
              such as the LOCAL_OPTIONS option).  This  also  applies  to  functions  marked  for
              autoload  within  the  sticky  emulation;  the  appropriate  set of options will be
              applied at the point the function is loaded as well as when it is run.

              For example:

                     emulate sh -c 'fni() { setopt cshnullglob; }
                     fno() { fni; }'
                     fno

              The two functions fni and fno are defined with sticky sh emulation.   fno  is  then
              executed,  causing  options associated with emulations to be set to their values in
              sh.  fni then calls fno; because fno is also marked for  sticky  sh  emulation,  no
              option  changes  take place on entry to or exit from it.  Hence the option cshnull‐
              glob, turned off by sh emulation, will be turned on within fni  and  remain  on  on
              return  to  fno.   On  exit  from  fno,  the emulation mode and all options will be
              restored to the state they were in before entry to the temporary emulation.

              The documentation above is typically sufficient for the intended purpose of execut‐
              ing  code designed for other shells in a suitable environment.  More detailed rules
              follow.
              1.     The sticky emulation environment provided by `emulate shell -c' is identical
                     to  that  provided  by  entry to a function marked for sticky emulation as a
                     consequence of being defined in such an environment.   Hence,  for  example,
                     the  sticky  emulation is inherited by subfunctions defined within functions
                     with sticky emulation.
              2.     No change of options takes place on entry to or exit from functions that are
                     not  marked  for sticky emulation, other than those that would normally take
                     place, even if those functions are called within sticky emulation.
              3.     No special handling is provided for functions marked for  autoload  nor  for
                     functions present in wordcode created by the zcompile command.
              4.     The presence or absence of the -R switch to emulate corresponds to different
                     sticky emulation modes, so for example `emulate sh -c', `emulate -R  sh  -c'
                     and `emulate csh -c' are treated as three distinct sticky emulations.
              5.     Difference in shell options supplied in addition to the basic emulation also
                     mean the sticky emulations are different, so for example  `emulate  zsh  -c'
                     and `emulate zsh -o cbases -c' are treated as distinct sticky emulations.

       enable [ -afmprs ] name ...
              Enable  the  named  hash  table elements, presumably disabled earlier with disable.
              The default is to enable builtin commands.  The -a option causes enable to  act  on
              regular  or  global aliases.  The -s option causes enable to act on suffix aliases.
              The -f option causes enable to act on shell functions.  The -r option causes enable
              to  act  on reserved words.  Without arguments all enabled hash table elements from
              the corresponding hash table are printed.  With the -m flag the arguments are taken
              as  patterns  (should be quoted) and all hash table elements from the corresponding
              hash table matching these patterns are enabled.  Enabled objects  can  be  disabled
              with the disable builtin command.

              enable -p reenables patterns disabled with disable -p.  Note that it does not over‐
              ride globbing options; for example, `enable -p "~"'  does  not  cause  the  pattern
              character  ~  to  be active unless the EXTENDED_GLOB option is also set.  To enable
              all possible patterns (so that they may be individually disabled with disable  -p),
              use `setopt EXTENDED_GLOB KSH_GLOB NO_SH_GLOB'.

       eval [ arg ... ]
              Read  the  arguments  as input to the shell and execute the resulting command(s) in
              the current shell process.  The return status is the same as if  the  commands  had
              been  executed  directly by the shell; if there are no args or they contain no com‐
              mands (i.e. are an empty string or whitespace) the return status is zero.

       exec [ -cl ] [ -a argv0 ] simple command
              Replace the current shell with an external command rather than  forking.   With  -c
              clear  the environment; with -l prepend - to the argv[0] string of the command exe‐
              cuted (to simulate a login shell); with -a argv0 set the argv[0] string of the com‐
              mand executed.  See the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       exit [ n ]
              Exit  the  shell with the exit status specified by n; if none is specified, use the
              exit status from the last command executed.  An EOF condition will also  cause  the
              shell to exit, unless the IGNORE_EOF option is set.

              See  notes  at the end of the section JOBS in in zshmisc(1) for some possibly unex‐
              pected interactions of the exit command with jobs.

       export [ name[=value] ... ]
              The specified names are marked for automatic export to the  environment  of  subse‐
              quently  executed  commands.   Equivalent to typeset -gx.  If a parameter specified
              does not already exist, it is created in the global scope.

       false [ arg ... ]
              Do nothing and return an exit status of 1.

       fc [ -e ename ] [ -m match ] [ old=new ... ] [ first [ last ] ]
       fc -l [ -nrdfEiD ] [ -t timefmt ] [ -m match ]
             [ old=new ... ] [ first [ last ] ]
       fc -p [ -a ] [ filename [ histsize [ savehistsize ] ] ]
       fc -P
       fc -ARWI [ filename ]
              Select a range of commands from first to last from the history list.  The arguments
              first  and  last may be specified as a number or as a string.  A negative number is
              used as an offset to the current history event number.  A string specifies the most
              recent  event  beginning with the given string.  All substitutions old=new, if any,
              are then performed on the commands.

              If the -l flag is given, the resulting commands are listed on standard output.   If
              the  -m  flag  is  also  given  the first argument is taken as a pattern (should be
              quoted) and only the history events matching this pattern will be shown.  Otherwise
              the  editor program ename is invoked on a file containing these history events.  If
              ename is not given, the value of the parameter FCEDIT is used; if that is  not  set
              the  value  of  the parameter EDITOR is used; if that is not set a builtin default,
              usually `vi' is used.  If ename is `-', no editor is invoked.  When editing is com‐
              plete, the edited command is executed.

              If  first is not specified, it will be set to -1 (the most recent event), or to -16
              if the -l flag is given.  If last is not specified, it will be set to first, or  to
              -1 if the -l flag is given.  However, if the current event has added entries to the
              history with `print -s' or `fc -R', then the default last for -l includes  all  new
              history entries since the current event began.

              The  flag  -r reverses the order of the commands and the flag -n suppresses command
              numbers when listing.

              Also when listing,
              -d     prints timestamps for each command
              -f     prints full time-date stamps in the US `MM/DD/YY hh:mm' format
              -E     prints full time-date stamps in the European `dd.mm.yyyy hh:mm' format
              -i     prints full time-date stamps in ISO8601 `yyyy-mm-dd hh:mm' format
              -t fmt prints time and date stamps in the given format; fmt is formatted  with  the
                     strftime  function  with  the  zsh  extensions  described for the %D{string}
                     prompt format in the section EXPANSION OF PROMPT  SEQUENCES  in  zshmisc(1).
                     The  resulting  formatted string must be no more than 256 characters or will
                     not be printed.
              -D     prints elapsed times; may be combined with one of the options above.

              `fc -p' pushes the current history list onto a stack and switches to a new  history
              list.   If the -a option is also specified, this history list will be automatically
              popped when the current function scope is exited, which is a much  better  solution
              than creating a trap function to call `fc -P' manually.  If no arguments are speci‐
              fied, the history list is left empty, $HISTFILE is unset, and $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST
              are  set  to  their  default values.  If one argument is given, $HISTFILE is set to
              that filename, $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST are left unchanged, and the  history  file  is
              read  in (if it exists) to initialize the new list.  If a second argument is speci‐
              fied, $HISTSIZE & $SAVEHIST are instead set to the single specified numeric  value.
              Finally,  if  a  third  argument is specified, $SAVEHIST is set to a separate value
              from $HISTSIZE.  You are free to change these environment values for the  new  his‐
              tory list however you desire in order to manipulate the new history list.

              `fc  -P' pops the history list back to an older list saved by `fc -p'.  The current
              list is saved to its $HISTFILE before it is destroyed (assuming that $HISTFILE  and
              $SAVEHIST  are  set appropriately, of course).  The values of $HISTFILE, $HISTSIZE,
              and $SAVEHIST are restored to the values they had when `fc -p'  was  called.   Note
              that  this  restoration  can  conflict with making these variables "local", so your
              best bet is to avoid local declarations for these variables in functions  that  use
              `fc -p'.  The one other guaranteed-safe combination is declaring these variables to
              be local at the top of your function and using the automatic option (-a)  with  `fc
              -p'.   Finally,  note  that it is legal to manually pop a push marked for automatic
              popping if you need to do so before the function exits.

              `fc -R' reads the history from the given file, `fc -W' writes the  history  out  to
              the given file, and `fc -A' appends the history out to the given file.  If no file‐
              name is specified, the $HISTFILE is assumed.  If the -I option is added to -R, only
              those  events  that  are not already contained within the internal history list are
              added.  If the -I option is added to -A or -W, only those events that are new since
              last  incremental  append/write  to  the history file are appended/written.  In any
              case, the created file will have no more than $SAVEHIST entries.

       fg [ job ... ]
       job ...
              Bring each specified job in turn to the foreground.  If no job is specified, resume
              the current job.

       float [ {+|-}EFHghlprtux ] [ -LRZ [ n ]] [ name[=value] ... ]
              Equivalent  to typeset -E, except that options irrelevant to floating point numbers
              are not permitted.

       functions [ {+|-}UXkmtTuz ] [ name ... ]
       functions -M mathfn [ min [ max [ shellfn ] ] ]
       functions -M [ -m pattern ... ]
       functions +M [ -m ] mathfn ...
              Equivalent to typeset -f, with the exception of the  -M  option.   Use  of  the  -M
              option may not be combined with any of the options handled by typeset -f.

              functions  -M  mathfn  defines mathfn as the name of a mathematical function recog‐
              nised in all forms of arithmetical expressions; see the section `Arithmetic Evalua‐
              tion'  in  zshmisc(1).   By  default  mathfn may take any number of comma-separated
              arguments.  If min is given, it must have exactly min args; if min and max are both
              given,  it  must have at least min and at most max args.  max may be -1 to indicate
              that there is no upper limit.

              By default the function is implemented by a shell function of  the  same  name;  if
              shellfn  is  specified  it gives the name of the corresponding shell function while
              mathfn remains the name used in arithmetical expressions.  The name of the function
              in  $0  is  mathfn  (not shellfn as would usually be the case), provided the option
              FUNCTION_ARGZERO is in effect.  The positional parameters  in  the  shell  function
              correspond  to  the arguments of the mathematical function call.  The result of the
              last arithmetical expression evaluated inside the shell function (even if it  is  a
              form  that  normally  only  returns  a status) gives the result of the mathematical
              function.

              functions -M with no arguments lists all such user-defined functions  in  the  same
              form  as  a definition.  With the additional option -m and a list of arguments, all
              functions whose mathfn matches one of the pattern arguments are listed.

              function +M removes the list of mathematical functions; with the additional  option
              -m the arguments are treated as patterns and all functions whose mathfn matches the
              pattern are removed.  Note that the shell function implementing  the  behaviour  is
              not removed (regardless of whether its name coincides with mathfn).

              For example, the following prints the cube of 3:

                     zmath_cube() { (( $1 * $1 * $1 )) }
                     functions -M cube 1 1 zmath_cube
                     print $(( cube(3) ))

       getcap See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       getln [ -AclneE ] name ...
              Read  the  top  value from the buffer stack and put it in the shell parameter name.
              Equivalent to read -zr.

       getopts optstring name [ arg ... ]
              Checks the args for legal options.  If the args are  omitted,  use  the  positional
              parameters.   A  valid option argument begins with a `+' or a `-'.  An argument not
              beginning with a `+' or a `-', or the argument `--', ends the options.  Note that a
              single  `-' is not considered a valid option argument.  optstring contains the let‐
              ters that getopts recognizes.  If a letter  is  followed  by  a  `:',  that  option
              requires an argument.  The options can be separated from the argument by blanks.

              Each  time  it  is  invoked, getopts places the option letter it finds in the shell
              parameter name, prepended with a `+' when arg begins with a `+'.  The index of  the
              next arg is stored in OPTIND.  The option argument, if any, is stored in OPTARG.

              The  first  option to be examined may be changed by explicitly assigning to OPTIND.
              OPTIND has an initial value of 1, and is normally reset to 1 upon exit from a shell
              function.   OPTARG  is not reset and retains its value from the most recent call to
              getopts.  If either of OPTIND or OPTARG is explicitly unset, it remains unset,  and
              the  index  or option argument is not stored.  The option itself is still stored in
              name in this case.

              A leading `:' in optstring causes getopts to store the letter of any invalid option
              in  OPTARG, and to set name to `?' for an unknown option and to `:' when a required
              argument is missing.  Otherwise, getopts sets name to `?' and prints an error  mes‐
              sage  when an option is invalid.  The exit status is nonzero when there are no more
              options.

       hash [ -Ldfmrv ] [ name[=value] ] ...
              hash can be used to directly modify the contents of the command hash table, and the
              named  directory  hash  table.  Normally one would modify these tables by modifying
              one's PATH (for the command hash table) or by creating appropriate shell parameters
              (for  the  named  directory  hash  table).   The choice of hash table to work on is
              determined by the -d option; without the option the command hash table is used, and
              with the option the named directory hash table is used.

              Given  no arguments, and neither the -r or -f options, the selected hash table will
              be listed in full.

              The -r option causes the selected hash table to be  emptied.   It  will  be  subse‐
              quently  rebuilt in the normal fashion.  The -f option causes the selected hash ta‐
              ble to be fully rebuilt immediately.  For the command hash table  this  hashes  all
              the  absolute  directories in the PATH, and for the named directory hash table this
              adds all users' home directories.  These two options cannot be used with any  argu‐
              ments.

              The -m option causes the arguments to be taken as patterns (which should be quoted)
              and the elements of the hash table matching those patterns are  printed.   This  is
              the only way to display a limited selection of hash table elements.

              For  each  name  with a corresponding value, put `name' in the selected hash table,
              associating it with the pathname `value'.  In the command hash  table,  this  means
              that  whenever  `name' is used as a command argument, the shell will try to execute
              the file given by `value'.  In the named directory  hash  table,  this  means  that
              `value' may be referred to as `~name'.

              For  each  name with no corresponding value, attempt to add name to the hash table,
              checking what the appropriate value is in the normal manner for  that  hash  table.
              If an appropriate value can't be found, then the hash table will be unchanged.

              The  -v option causes hash table entries to be listed as they are added by explicit
              specification.  If has no effect if used with -f.

              If the -L flag is present, then each hash table entry is printed in the form  of  a
              call to hash.

       history
              Same as fc -l.

       integer [ {+|-}Hghilprtux ] [ -LRZ [ n ]] [ name[=value] ... ]
              Equivalent  to  typeset -i, except that options irrelevant to integers are not per‐
              mitted.

       jobs [ -dlprs ] [ job ... ]
       jobs -Z string
              Lists information about each given job, or all jobs if job is omitted.  The -l flag
              lists  process IDs, and the -p flag lists process groups.  If the -r flag is speci‐
              fied only running jobs will be listed and if the -s flag is given only stopped jobs
              are  shown.   If the -d flag is given, the directory from which the job was started
              (which may not be the current directory of the job) will also be shown.

              The -Z option replaces the shell's argument and environment space  with  the  given
              string, truncated if necessary to fit.  This will normally be visible in ps (ps(1))
              listings.  This feature is typically used by daemons, to indicate their state.

       kill [ -s signal_name | -n signal_number | -sig ] job ...
       kill -l [ sig ... ]
              Sends either SIGTERM or the specified signal to the given jobs or processes.   Sig‐
              nals  are  given  by  number or by names, with or without the `SIG' prefix.  If the
              signal being sent is not `KILL' or `CONT', then the job will be sent a `CONT'  sig‐
              nal  if  it is stopped.  The argument job can be the process ID of a job not in the
              job list.  In the second form, kill -l, if sig is not specified  the  signal  names
              are  listed.  Otherwise, for each sig that is a name, the corresponding signal num‐
              ber is listed.  For each sig that is a signal number or a number  representing  the
              exit  status  of  a process which was terminated or stopped by a signal the name of
              the signal is printed.

              On some systems, alternative signal names are allowed for a few  signals.   Typical
              examples  are  SIGCHLD and SIGCLD or SIGPOLL and SIGIO, assuming they correspond to
              the same signal number.  kill -l will only list the preferred form, however kill -l
              alt will show if the alternative form corresponds to a signal number.  For example,
              under Linux kill -l IO and kill -l POLL both output 29, hence  kill  -IO  and  kill
              -POLL have the same effect.

              Many  systems will allow process IDs to be negative to kill a process group or zero
              to kill the current process group.

       let arg ...
              Evaluate each arg as an arithmetic expression.  See the section `Arithmetic Evalua‐
              tion'  in  zshmisc(1) for a description of arithmetic expressions.  The exit status
              is 0 if the value of the last expression is nonzero, 1 if it is zero, and 2  if  an
              error occurred.

       limit [ -hs ] [ resource [ limit ] ] ...
              Set  or  display  resource  limits.  Unless the -s flag is given, the limit applies
              only the children of the shell.  If  -s  is  given  without  other  arguments,  the
              resource  limits  of the current shell is set to the previously set resource limits
              of the children.

              If limit is not specified, print the current limit placed  on  resource,  otherwise
              set  the  limit  to  the specified value.  If the -h flag is given, use hard limits
              instead of soft limits.  If no resource is given, print all limits.

              When looping over multiple resources,  the  shell  will  abort  immediately  if  it
              detects  a  badly  formed  argument.   However, if it fails to set a limit for some
              other reason it will continue trying to set the remaining limits.

              resource can be one of:

              addressspace
                     Maximum amount of address space used.
              aiomemorylocked
                     Maximum amount of memory locked in RAM for AIO operations.
              aiooperations
                     Maximum number of AIO operations.
              cachedthreads
                     Maximum number of cached threads.
              coredumpsize
                     Maximum size of a core dump.
              cputime
                     Maximum CPU seconds per process.
              datasize
                     Maximum data size (including stack) for each process.
              descriptors
                     Maximum value for a file descriptor.
              filesize
                     Largest single file allowed.
              kqueues
                     Maximum number of kqueues allocated.
              maxproc
                     Maximum number of processes.
              maxpthreads
                     Maximum number of threads per process.
              memorylocked
                     Maximum amount of memory locked in RAM.
              memoryuse
                     Maximum resident set size.
              msgqueue
                     Maximum number of bytes in POSIX message queues.
              posixlocks
                     Maximum number of POSIX locks per user.
              pseudoterminals
                     Maximum number of pseudo-terminals.
              resident
                     Maximum resident set size.
              sigpending
                     Maximum number of pending signals.
              sockbufsize
                     Maximum size of all socket buffers.
              stacksize
                     Maximum stack size for each process.
              swapsize
                     Maximum amount of swap used.
              vmemorysize
                     Maximum amount of virtual memory.

              Which of these resource limits are available depends on the system.   resource  can
              be  abbreviated to any unambiguous prefix.  It can also be an integer, which corre‐
              sponds to the integer defined for the resource by the operating system.

              If argument corresponds to a number which is out of the range of the resources con‐
              figured  into  the shell, the shell will try to read or write the limit anyway, and
              will report an error if this fails.  As the shell does  not  store  such  resources
              internally, an attempt to set the limit will fail unless the -s option is present.

              limit is a number, with an optional scaling factor, as follows:

              nh     hours
              nk     kilobytes (default)
              nm     megabytes or minutes
              [mm:]ss
                     minutes and seconds

              The  limit command is not made available by default when the shell starts in a mode
              emulating another shell.  It can be made available with the  command  `zmodload  -F
              zsh/rlimits b:limit'.

       local [ {+|-}AEFHUahlprtux ] [ -LRZi [ n ]] [ name[=value] ] ...
              Same  as  typeset,  except  that the options -g, and -f are not permitted.  In this
              case the -x option does not force the use of -g, i.e. exported  variables  will  be
              local to functions.

       log    List  all  users currently logged in who are affected by the current setting of the
              watch parameter.

       logout [ n ]
              Same as exit, except that it only works in a login shell.

       noglob simple command
              See the section `Precommand Modifiers'.

       popd [ [-q] {+|-}n ]
              Remove an entry from the directory stack, and perform a cd to the  new  top  direc‐
              tory.  With no argument, the current top entry is removed.  An argument of the form
              `+n' identifies a stack entry by counting from the left of the list  shown  by  the
              dirs  command,  starting  with  zero.   An  argument of the form -n counts from the
              right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS option is set, the meanings of `+' and `-' in this  con‐
              text are swapped.

              If the -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook function chpwd and the functions in
              the array $chpwd_functions are not called, and  the  new  directory  stack  is  not
              printed.   This is useful for calls to popd that do not change the environment seen
              by an interactive user.

       print [ -abcDilmnNoOpPrsSz ] [ -u n ] [ -f format ] [ -C cols ]
         [ -R [ -en ]] [ arg ... ]
              With the `-f' option the arguments are printed as described  by  printf.   With  no
              flags  or  with  the  flag `-', the arguments are printed on the standard output as
              described by echo, with the  following  differences:  the  escape  sequence  `\M-x'
              metafies  the character x (sets the highest bit), `\C-x' produces a control charac‐
              ter (`\C-@' and `\C-?' give the characters NUL and delete), and `\E' is  a  synonym
              for `\e'.  Finally, if not in an escape sequence, `\' escapes the following charac‐
              ter and is not printed.

              -a     Print arguments with the column incrementing first.  Only useful with the -c
                     and -C options.

              -b     Recognize all the escape sequences defined for the bindkey command, see zsh‐
                     zle(1).

              -c     Print the arguments in columns.  Unless -a  is  also  given,  arguments  are
                     printed with the row incrementing first.

              -C cols
                     Print the arguments in cols columns.  Unless -a is also given, arguments are
                     printed with the row incrementing first.

              -D     Treat the arguments as paths, replacing directory prefixes  with  ~  expres‐
                     sions corresponding to directory names, as appropriate.

              -i     If given together with -o or -O, sorting is performed case-independently.

              -l     Print the arguments separated by newlines instead of spaces.

              -m     Take  the first argument as a pattern (should be quoted), and remove it from
                     the argument list together with subsequent arguments that do not match  this
                     pattern.

              -n     Do not add a newline to the output.

              -N     Print the arguments separated and terminated by nulls.

              -o     Print the arguments sorted in ascending order.

              -O     Print the arguments sorted in descending order.

              -p     Print the arguments to the input of the coprocess.

              -P     Perform prompt expansion (see EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1)).

              -r     Ignore the escape conventions of echo.

              -R     Emulate the BSD echo command, which does not process escape sequences unless
                     the -e flag is given.  The -n flag suppresses the  trailing  newline.   Only
                     the -e and -n flags are recognized after -R; all other arguments and options
                     are printed.

              -s     Place the results in the history list instead of  on  the  standard  output.
                     Each  argument  to the print command is treated as a single word in the his‐
                     tory, regardless of its content.

              -S     Place the results in the history list instead of on the standard output.  In
                     this  case only a single argument is allowed; it will be split into words as
                     if it were a full shell command line.  The effect is similar to reading  the
                     line from a history file with the HIST_LEX_WORDS option active.

              -u n   Print the arguments to file descriptor n.

              -z     Push the arguments onto the editing buffer stack, separated by spaces.

              If  any  of  `-m',  `-o' or `-O' are used in combination with `-f' and there are no
              arguments (after the removal process in the case of `-m') then nothing is printed.

       printf format [ arg ... ]
              Print the arguments according to the format specification. Formatting rules are the
              same as used in C. The same escape sequences as for echo are recognised in the for‐
              mat. All C conversion specifications ending in one of csdiouxXeEfgGn  are  handled.
              In  addition to this, `%b' can be used instead of `%s' to cause escape sequences in
              the argument to be recognised and `%q' can be used to quote the argument in such  a
              way that allows it to be reused as shell input. With the numeric format specifiers,
              if the corresponding argument starts with a quote character, the numeric  value  of
              the  following  character  is used as the number to print otherwise the argument is
              evaluated as an arithmetic expression. See the section `Arithmetic  Evaluation'  in
              zshmisc(1)  for a description of arithmetic expressions. With `%n', the correspond‐
              ing argument is taken as an identifier which is created as an integer parameter.

              Normally, conversion specifications are applied to each argument in order but  they
              can explicitly specify the nth argument is to be used by replacing `%' by `%n$' and
              `*' by `*n$'.  It is recommended that you do not mix references  of  this  explicit
              style with the normal style and the handling of such mixed styles may be subject to
              future change.

              If arguments remain unused after formatting, the format string is reused until  all
              arguments  have  been  consumed.  With the print builtin, this can be suppressed by
              using the -r option. If more arguments are required by the format  than  have  been
              specified, the behaviour is as if zero or an empty string had been specified as the
              argument.

       pushd [ -qsLP ] [ arg ]
       pushd [ -qsLP ] old new
       pushd [ -qsLP ] {+|-}n
              Change the current directory, and push the old current directory onto the directory
              stack.   In  the  first  form,  change the current directory to arg.  If arg is not
              specified, change to the second directory on the stack (that is, exchange  the  top
              two  entries), or change to $HOME if the PUSHD_TO_HOME option is set or if there is
              only one entry on the stack.  Otherwise, arg is interpreted as it would be  by  cd.
              The meaning of old and new in the second form is also the same as for cd.

              The third form of pushd changes directory by rotating the directory list.  An argu‐
              ment of the form `+n' identifies a stack entry by counting from  the  left  of  the
              list  shown  by the dirs command, starting with zero.  An argument of the form `-n'
              counts from the right.  If the PUSHD_MINUS option is set, the meanings of  `+'  and
              `-' in this context are swapped.

              If the -q (quiet) option is specified, the hook function chpwd and the functions in
              the array $chpwd_functions are not called, and  the  new  directory  stack  is  not
              printed.  This is useful for calls to pushd that do not change the environment seen
              by an interactive user.

              If the option -q is not specified and the shell option PUSHD_SILENT is not set, the
              directory stack will be printed after a pushd is performed.

              The options -s, -L and -P have the same meanings as for the cd builtin.

       pushln [ arg ... ]
              Equivalent to print -nz.

       pwd [ -rLP ]
              Print  the absolute pathname of the current working directory.  If the -r or the -P
              flag is specified, or the CHASE_LINKS option is set and the -L flag is  not  given,
              the printed path will not contain symbolic links.

       r      Same as fc -e -.

       read [ -rszpqAclneE ] [ -t [ num ] ] [ -k [ num ] ] [ -d delim ]
        [ -u n ] [ name[?prompt] ] [ name ...  ]
              Read  one line and break it into fields using the characters in $IFS as separators,
              except as noted below.  The first field is assigned to the first name,  the  second
              field to the second name, etc., with leftover fields assigned to the last name.  If
              name is omitted then REPLY is used for scalars and reply for arrays.

              -r     Raw mode: a `\' at the end of a line does not signify line continuation  and
                     backslashes  in  the  line  don't  quote the following character and are not
                     removed.

              -s     Don't echo back characters if reading from the terminal.

              -q     Read only one character from the terminal and set name to `y' if this  char‐
                     acter  was  `y'  or `Y' and to `n' otherwise.  With this flag set the return
                     status is zero only if the character was `y' or `Y'.   This  option  may  be
                     used  with a timeout; if the read times out, or encounters end of file, sta‐
                     tus 2 is returned.  Input is read from the terminal unless one of -u  or  -p
                     is present.  This option may also be used within zle widgets.

              -k [ num ]
                     Read  only  one  (or  num)  characters.  All are assigned to the first name,
                     without word splitting.  This flag is ignored when -q is present.  Input  is
                     read  from  the terminal unless one of -u or -p is present.  This option may
                     also be used within zle widgets.

                     Note that despite the mnemonic `key' this option does read full  characters,
                     which may consist of multiple bytes if the option MULTIBYTE is set.

              -z     Read one entry from the editor buffer stack and assign it to the first name,
                     without word splitting.  Text is pushed onto the stack with  `print  -z'  or
                     with  push-line  from the line editor (see zshzle(1)).  This flag is ignored
                     when the -k or -q flags are present.

              -e
              -E     The input read is printed (echoed) to the standard output.  If the  -e  flag
                     is used, no input is assigned to the parameters.

              -A     The  first  name is taken as the name of an array and all words are assigned
                     to it.

              -c
              -l     These flags are allowed only if called inside a function used for completion
                     (specified with the -K flag to compctl).  If the -c flag is given, the words
                     of the current command are read. If the -l flag is given, the whole line  is
                     assigned  as  a  scalar.   If  both  flags are present, -l is used and -c is
                     ignored.

              -n     Together with -c, the number of the word the cursor is on is read.  With -l,
                     the  index of the character the cursor is on is read.  Note that the command
                     name is word number 1, not word 0, and that when the cursor is at the end of
                     the line, its character index is the length of the line plus one.

              -u n   Input is read from file descriptor n.

              -p     Input is read from the coprocess.

              -d delim
                     Input is terminated by the first character of delim instead of by newline.

              -t [ num ]
                     Test if input is available before attempting to read.  If num is present, it
                     must begin with a digit and will be evaluated to give a number  of  seconds,
                     which  may  be  a  floating point number; in this case the read times out if
                     input is not available within this time.  If num is not present, it is taken
                     to  be  zero, so that read returns immediately if no input is available.  If
                     no input is available, return status 1 and do not set any variables.

                     This option is not available when reading from the editor  buffer  with  -z,
                     when  called  from within completion with -c or -l, with -q which clears the
                     input queue before reading, or within zle where other mechanisms  should  be
                     used to test for input.

                     Note  that  read  does  not attempt to alter the input processing mode.  The
                     default mode is canonical input, in which an entire line is read at a  time,
                     so  usually  `read  -t' will not read anything until an entire line has been
                     typed.  However, when reading from the terminal with -k input  is  processed
                     one key at a time; in this case, only availability of the first character is
                     tested, so that e.g. `read -t -k 2' can still block on the second character.
                     Use two instances of `read -t -k' if this is not what is wanted.

              If  the  first  argument  contains  a  `?', the remainder of this word is used as a
              prompt on standard error when the shell is interactive.

              The value (exit status) of read is 1 when an end-of-file is encountered, or when -c
              or  -l  is  present  and  the  command is not called from a compctl function, or as
              described for -q.  Otherwise the value is 0.

              The behavior of some combinations of the -k, -p, -q, -u and -z flags is  undefined.
              Presently -q cancels all the others, -p cancels -u, -k cancels -z, and otherwise -z
              cancels both -p and -u.

              The -c or -l flags cancel any and all of -kpquz.

       readonly
              Same as typeset -r.

       rehash Same as hash -r.

       return [ n ]
              Causes a shell function or `.' script to return to the  invoking  script  with  the
              return  status  specified  by n.  If n is omitted, the return status is that of the
              last command executed.

              If return was executed from a trap in a TRAPNAL function, the effect  is  different
              for zero and non-zero return status.  With zero status (or after an implicit return
              at the end of the trap), the shell will return to whatever it was  previously  pro‐
              cessing;  with  a non-zero status, the shell will behave as interrupted except that
              the return status of the trap is retained.  Note that the numeric value of the sig‐
              nal which caused the trap is passed as the first argument, so the statement `return
              $((128+$1))' will return the same status as if the signal had not been trapped.

       sched  See the section `The zsh/sched Module' in zshmodules(1).

       set [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o [ option_name ] ] ... [ {+|-}A [ name ] ] [ arg ... ]
              Set the options for the shell and/or set the positional parameters, or declare  and
              set  an  array.  If the -s option is given, it causes the specified arguments to be
              sorted before assigning them to the positional parameters (or to the array name  if
              -A  is  used).  With +s sort arguments in descending order.  For the meaning of the
              other flags, see zshoptions(1).  Flags may  be  specified  by  name  using  the  -o
              option.  If  no  option  name  is  supplied  with -o, the current option states are
              printed:  see the description of setopt below for more information on  the  format.
              With +o they are printed in a form that can be used as input to the shell.

              If  the -A flag is specified, name is set to an array containing the given args; if
              no name is specified, all arrays are printed together with their values.

              If +A is used and name is an array, the given arguments will  replace  the  initial
              elements  of  that  array;  if no name is specified, all arrays are printed without
              their values.

              The behaviour of arguments after -A name or +A name depends on whether  the  option
              KSH_ARRAYS  is  set.  If it is not set, all arguments following name are treated as
              values for the array, regardless of their form.   If  the  option  is  set,  normal
              option  processing  continues  at that point; only regular arguments are treated as
              values for the array.  This means that

                     set -A array -x -- foo

              sets array to `-x -- foo' if KSH_ARRAYS is not set, but sets the array to  foo  and
              turns on the option `-x' if it is set.

              If  the  -A  flag  is  not present, but there are arguments beyond the options, the
              positional parameters are set.  If the option list (if any) is terminated by  `--',
              and there are no further arguments, the positional parameters will be unset.

              If  no arguments and no `--' are given, then the names and values of all parameters
              are printed on the standard output.  If the only argument is `+', the names of  all
              parameters are printed.

              For  historical  reasons,  `set -' is treated as `set +xv' and `set - args' as `set
              +xv -- args' when in any other emulation mode than zsh's native mode.

       setcap See the section `The zsh/cap Module' in zshmodules(1).

       setopt [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o option_name ] [ name ... ]
              Set the options for the shell.  All options specified either with flags or by  name
              are set.

              If  no  arguments are supplied, the names of all options currently set are printed.
              The form is chosen so as to minimize the differences from the default  options  for
              the  current  emulation  (the  default  emulation being native zsh, shown as <Z> in
              zshoptions(1)).  Options that are on by default for the emulation  are  shown  with
              the  prefix no only if they are off, while other options are shown without the pre‐
              fix no and only if they are on.  In addition to options changed  from  the  default
              state  by  the user, any options activated automatically by the shell (for example,
              SHIN_STDIN or INTERACTIVE) will be shown in the list.  The format is further  modi‐
              fied  by  the  option  KSH_OPTION_PRINT, however the rationale for choosing options
              with or without the no prefix remains the same in this case.

              If the -m flag is given the arguments are taken as patterns (which should be quoted
              to protect them from filename expansion), and all options with names matching these
              patterns are set.

              Note that a bad option name does not cause execution of subsequent shell code to be
              aborted; this is behaviour is different from that of `set -o'.  This is because set
              is regarded as a special builtin by the POSIX standard, but setopt is not.

       shift [ -p ] [ n ] [ name ... ]
              The positional parameters ${n+1} ... are renamed to $1 ..., where n  is  an  arith‐
              metic  expression  that defaults to 1.  If any names are given then the arrays with
              these names are shifted instead of the positional parameters.

              If the option -p is given arguments are  instead  removed  (popped)  from  the  end
              rather than the start of the array.

       source file [ arg ... ]
              Same  as  `.',  except  that the current directory is always searched and is always
              searched first, before directories in $path.

       stat   See the section `The zsh/stat Module' in zshmodules(1).

       suspend [ -f ]
              Suspend the execution of the shell (send it a SIGTSTP) until it receives a SIGCONT.
              Unless the -f option is given, this will refuse to suspend a login shell.

       test [ arg ... ]
       [ [ arg ... ] ]
              Like  the system version of test.  Added for compatibility; use conditional expres‐
              sions instead (see the section `Conditional Expressions').   The  main  differences
              between  the  conditional expression syntax and the test and [ builtins are:  these
              commands are not handled syntactically, so for example an empty variable  expansion
              may  cause  an  argument to be omitted; syntax errors cause status 2 to be returned
              instead of a shell error; and arithmetic operators expect integer arguments  rather
              than arithmetic expressions.

              The  command  attempts to implement POSIX and its extensions where these are speci‐
              fied.  Unfortunately there are intrinsic ambiguities in the syntax;  in  particular
              there is no distinction between test operators and strings that resemble them.  The
              standard attempts to resolve these for small numbers of arguments (up to four); for
              five or more arguments compatibility cannot be relied on.  Users are urged wherever
              possible to use the `[[' test syntax which does not have these ambiguities.

       times  Print the accumulated user and system times for the shell  and  for  processes  run
              from the shell.

       trap [ arg ] [ sig ... ]
              arg is a series of commands (usually quoted to protect it from immediate evaluation
              by the shell) to be read and executed when the shell receives any  of  the  signals
              specified  by  one  or more sig args.  Each sig can be given as a number, or as the
              name of a signal either with or without the string SIG in front (e.g. 1,  HUP,  and
              SIGHUP are all the same signal).

              If  arg  is  `-', then the specified signals are reset to their defaults, or, if no
              sig args are present, all traps are reset.

              If arg is an empty string, then the specified signals are ignored by the shell (and
              by the commands it invokes).

              If  arg  is omitted but one or more sig args are provided (i.e.  the first argument
              is a valid signal number or name), the effect is the same as if arg had been speci‐
              fied as `-'.

              The  trap  command with no arguments prints a list of commands associated with each
              signal.

              If sig is ZERR then arg will be executed after each command  with  a  nonzero  exit
              status.   ERR  is  an alias for ZERR on systems that have no SIGERR signal (this is
              the usual case).

              If sig is DEBUG then arg will  be  executed  before  each  command  if  the  option
              DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD  is  set  (as it is by default), else after each command.  Here, a
              `command' is what is described as a `sublist' in the shell grammar, see the section
              SIMPLE  COMMANDS  &  PIPELINES  in  zshmisc(1).  If DEBUG_BEFORE_CMD is set various
              additional features are available.  First, it is possible to skip the next  command
              by  setting  the  option  ERR_EXIT;  see  the description of the ERR_EXIT option in
              zshoptions(1).  Also, the shell parameter ZSH_DEBUG_CMD is set to the string corre‐
              sponding  to  the command to be executed following the trap.  Note that this string
              is reconstructed from the internal format and may not be formatted the same way  as
              the original text.  The parameter is unset after the trap is executed.

              If  sig  is 0 or EXIT and the trap statement is executed inside the body of a func‐
              tion, then the command arg is executed after the function completes.  The value  of
              $?  at  the start of execution is the exit status of the shell or the return status
              of the function exiting.  If sig is 0 or EXIT and the trap statement  is  not  exe‐
              cuted  inside  the  body  of  a function, then the command arg is executed when the
              shell terminates; the trap runs before any zshexit hook functions.

              ZERR, DEBUG, and EXIT traps are not executed inside other traps.   ZERR  and  DEBUG
              traps are kept within subshells, while other traps are reset.

              Note  that  traps  defined  with the trap builtin are slightly different from those
              defined as `TRAPNAL () { ... }', as the latter have their own function  environment
              (line  numbers,  local variables, etc.) while the former use the environment of the
              command in which they were called.  For example,

                     trap 'print $LINENO' DEBUG

              will print the line number of a command executed after it has run, while

                     TRAPDEBUG() { print $LINENO; }

              will always print the number zero.

              Alternative signal names are allowed as described under  kill  above.   Defining  a
              trap  under  either  name  causes any trap under an alternative name to be removed.
              However, it is recommended that for consistency users stick exclusively to one name
              or another.

       true [ arg ... ]
              Do nothing and return an exit status of 0.

       ttyctl -fu
              The  -f  option  freezes  the  tty  (i.e.  terminal  or  terminal emulator), and -u
              unfreezes it.  When the tty is frozen, no changes  made  to  the  tty  settings  by
              external  programs  will be honored by the shell, except for changes in the size of
              the screen; the shell will simply reset the settings to their  previous  values  as
              soon  as  each command exits or is suspended.  Thus, stty and similar programs have
              no effect when the tty is frozen.  Freezing the tty  does  not  cause  the  current
              state  to  be  remembered:  instead,  it  causes  future changes to the state to be
              blocked.

              Without options it reports whether the terminal is frozen or not.

              Note that, regardless of whether the tty is frozen  or  not,  the  shell  needs  to
              change  the  settings  when  the line editor starts, so unfreezing the tty does not
              guarantee settings made on the command line are preserved.  Strings of commands run
              between  editing  the  command  line will see a consistent tty state.  See also the
              shell variable STTY for a means of initialising the  tty  before  running  external
              commands.

       type [ -wfpams ] name ...
              Equivalent to whence -v.

       typeset [ {+|-}AEFHUafghklprtuxmz ] [ -LRZi [ n ]] [ name[=value] ... ]
       typeset -T [ {+|-}Urux ] [ -LRZ [ n ]] SCALAR[=value] array [ sep ]
              Set or display attributes and values for shell parameters.

              A  parameter  is  created  for  each name that does not already refer to one.  When
              inside a function, a new parameter is created  for  every  name  (even  those  that
              already exist), and is unset again when the function completes.  See `Local Parame‐
              ters' in zshparam(1).  The same rules apply  to  special  shell  parameters,  which
              retain their special attributes when made local.

              For  each  name=value  assignment,  the  parameter name is set to value.  Note that
              arrays currently cannot be assigned in typeset expressions, only scalars and  inte‐
              gers.   Unless  the  option  KSH_TYPESET  is  set,  normal expansion rules apply to
              assignment arguments, so value may be split into separate words; if the  option  is
              set, assignments which can be recognised when expansion is performed are treated as
              single words.  For example the command typeset vbl=$(echo one two)  is  treated  as
              having  one  argument if KSH_TYPESET is set, but otherwise is treated as having the
              two arguments vbl=one and two.

              If the shell option TYPESET_SILENT is not set, for each remaining name that  refers
              to  a parameter that is set, the name and value of the parameter are printed in the
              form of an assignment.  Nothing is printed for newly-created  parameters,  or  when
              any  attribute flags listed below are given along with the name.  Using `+' instead
              of minus to introduce an attribute turns it off.

              If the -p option is given, parameters and values are printed in the form of a type‐
              set  command  and  an  assignment  (which will be printed separately for arrays and
              associative arrays), regardless of other flags and options.  Note that the -h  flag
              on parameters is respected; no value will be shown for these parameters.

              If  the -T option is given, two or three arguments must be present (an exception is
              that zero arguments are allowed to show the list  of  parameters  created  in  this
              fashion).   The  first two are the name of a scalar and an array parameter (in that
              order) that will be tied together in the manner of $PATH and $path.   The  optional
              third  argument is a single-character separator which will be used to join the ele‐
              ments of the array to form the scalar; if absent, a colon is used, as  with  $PATH.
              Only  the first character of the separator is significant; any remaining characters
              are ignored.  Only the scalar parameter may be assigned an initial value.  Both the
              scalar  and the array may otherwise be manipulated as normal.  If one is unset, the
              other will automatically be unset too.  There is no way of  untying  the  variables
              without  unsetting them, or converting the type of one of them with another typeset
              command; +T does not work, assigning an array to SCALAR is an error, and  assigning
              a  scalar  to  array sets it to be a single-element array.  Note that both `typeset
              -xT ...' and `export -T ...' work, but only the scalar will be marked  for  export.
              Setting  the value using the scalar version causes a split on all separators (which
              cannot be quoted).  It is possible to use the same two tied variables with  a  dif‐
              ferent  separator character in which case the variables remain joined as before but
              the separator is changed.  This flag has a different meaning when used with -f; see
              below.

              The  -g  (global)  flag is treated specially: it means that any resulting parameter
              will not be restricted to local scope.  Note that this does  not  necessarily  mean
              that the parameter will be global, as the flag will apply to any existing parameter
              (even if unset) from an enclosing function.  This flag does not affect the  parame‐
              ter  after  creation,  hence it has no effect when listing existing parameters, nor
              does the flag +g have any effect except in combination with -m (see below).

              If no name is present, the names and values of all parameters are printed.  In this
              case  the  attribute  flags restrict the display to only those parameters that have
              the specified attributes, and using `+' rather than `-' to introduce the flag  sup‐
              presses  printing  of  the  values  of  parameters when there is no parameter name.
              Also, if the last option is the word `+', then names are  printed  but  values  are
              not.

              If  the  -m flag is given the name arguments are taken as patterns (which should be
              quoted).  With no attribute flags, all parameters (or functions with the  -f  flag)
              with  matching  names  are  printed (the shell option TYPESET_SILENT is not used in
              this case).  Note that -m is ignored if no patterns are given.  If the +g  flag  is
              combined  with  -m,  a  new local parameter is created for every matching parameter
              that is not already local.  Otherwise -m applies all other flags or assignments  to
              the  existing  parameters.  Except when assignments are made with name=value, using
              +m forces the matching parameters to be printed, even inside a function.

              If no attribute flags are given and either no -m flag is present or the +m form was
              used,  each  parameter name printed is preceded by a list of the attributes of that
              parameter (array, association, exported, integer, readonly).  If +m  is  used  with
              attribute  flags, and all those flags are introduced with +, the matching parameter
              names are printed but their values are not.

              Attribute flags that transform the final value (-L, -R, -Z, -l, u) are only applied
              to  the  expanded value at the point of a parameter expansion expression using `$'.
              They are not applied when a parameter is retrieved internally by the shell for  any
              purpose.

              The following attribute flags may be specified:

              -A     The  names  refer to associative array parameters; see `Array Parameters' in
                     zshparam(1).

              -L     Left justify and remove leading blanks from value.   If  n  is  nonzero,  it
                     defines  the  width  of the field.  If n is zero, the width is determined by
                     the width of the value of the first assignment.   In  the  case  of  numeric
                     parameters,  the  length  of the complete value assigned to the parameter is
                     used to determine the width, not the value that would be output.

                     The width is the count of characters, which may be multibyte  characters  if
                     the  MULTIBYTE option is in effect.  Note that the screen width of the char‐
                     acter is not taken into account; if  this  is  required,  use  padding  with
                     parameter expansion flags ${(ml...)...} as described in `Parameter Expansion
                     Flags' in zshexpn(1).

                     When the parameter is expanded, it is filled on the  right  with  blanks  or
                     truncated  if necessary to fit the field.  Note truncation can lead to unex‐
                     pected results with numeric parameters.  Leading zeros are removed if the -Z
                     flag is also set.

              -R     Similar  to  -L, except that right justification is used; when the parameter
                     is expanded, the field is left filled with blanks or truncated from the end.
                     May not be combined with the -Z flag.

              -U     For  arrays (but not for associative arrays), keep only the first occurrence
                     of each duplicated value.  This may also be set for colon-separated  special
                     parameters  like  PATH  or  FIGNORE, etc.  This flag has a different meaning
                     when used with -f; see below.

              -Z     Specially handled if set along with the -L flag.  Otherwise, similar to  -R,
                     except  that  leading  zeros  are  used for padding instead of blanks if the
                     first non-blank character is a digit.  Numeric parameters are specially han‐
                     dled:  they  are always eligible for padding with zeroes, and the zeroes are
                     inserted at an appropriate place in the output.

              -a     The names refer to array parameters.  An array parameter may be created this
                     way,  but it may not be assigned to in the typeset statement.  When display‐
                     ing, both normal and associative arrays are shown.

              -f     The names refer to functions rather than parameters.  No assignments can  be
                     made,  and  the  only  other valid flags are -t, -T, -k, -u, -U and -z.  The
                     flag -t turns on execution tracing for this function; the flag -T  does  the
                     same,  but  turns  off  tracing on any function called from the present one,
                     unless that function also has the -t or -T flag.  The -u and -U flags  cause
                     the function to be marked for autoloading; -U also causes alias expansion to
                     be suppressed when the function is loaded.   The  fpath  parameter  will  be
                     searched  to  find the function definition when the function is first refer‐
                     enced; see the section `Functions'. The -k and -z flags make the function be
                     loaded  using ksh-style or zsh-style autoloading respectively. If neither is
                     given, the setting of the KSH_AUTOLOAD option determines how the function is
                     loaded.

              -h     Hide: only useful for special parameters (those marked `<S>' in the table in
                     zshparam(1)), and for local parameters with  the  same  name  as  a  special
                     parameter,  though  harmless  for  others.   A  special  parameter with this
                     attribute will not retain its special effect when made  local.   Thus  after
                     `typeset -h PATH', a function containing `typeset PATH' will create an ordi‐
                     nary local parameter without the usual behaviour  of  PATH.   Alternatively,
                     the local parameter may itself be given this attribute; hence inside a func‐
                     tion `typeset -h PATH' creates an ordinary local parameter and  the  special
                     PATH  parameter  is not altered in any way.  It is also possible to create a
                     local parameter using `typeset +h special', where the local copy of  special
                     will  retain  its  special properties regardless of having the -h attribute.
                     Global special parameters loaded from  shell  modules  (currently  those  in
                     zsh/mapfile  and  zsh/parameter) are automatically given the -h attribute to
                     avoid name clashes.

              -H     Hide value: specifies that typeset will not display the value of the parame‐
                     ter when listing parameters; the display for such parameters is always as if
                     the `+' flag had been given.  Use of the parameter is in other respects nor‐
                     mal, and the option does not apply if the parameter is specified by name, or
                     by pattern with the -m option.  This is on by default for the parameters  in
                     the  zsh/parameter  and zsh/mapfile modules.  Note, however, that unlike the
                     -h flag this is also useful for non-special parameters.

              -i     Use an internal integer representation.  If n is nonzero it defines the out‐
                     put  arithmetic  base,  otherwise  it is determined by the first assignment.
                     Bases from 2 to 36 inclusive are allowed.

              -E     Use an internal double-precision floating point representation.   On  output
                     the  variable  will be converted to scientific notation.  If n is nonzero it
                     defines the number of significant figures to display; the default is ten.

              -F     Use an internal double-precision floating point representation.   On  output
                     the  variable  will  be  converted to fixed-point decimal notation.  If n is
                     nonzero it defines the number of digits to display after the decimal  point;
                     the default is ten.

              -l     Convert  the  result  to lower case whenever the parameter is expanded.  The
                     value is not converted when assigned.

              -r     The given names are marked readonly.  Note that if name is a special parame‐
                     ter, the readonly attribute can be turned on, but cannot then be turned off.

              -t     Tags the named parameters.  Tags have no special meaning to the shell.  This
                     flag has a different meaning when used with -f; see above.

              -u     Convert the result to upper case whenever the parameter  is  expanded.   The
                     value  is  not  converted  when assigned.  This flag has a different meaning
                     when used with -f; see above.

              -x     Mark for automatic export to the environment of subsequently  executed  com‐
                     mands.   If  the  option  GLOBAL_EXPORT  is set, this implies the option -g,
                     unless +g is also explicitly given; in other words the parameter is not made
                     local  to  the  enclosing function.  This is for compatibility with previous
                     versions of zsh.

       ulimit [ [ -SHacdfiklmnpqsTtvwx | -N resource [ limit ] ... ]
              Set or display resource limits of the shell and the processes started by the shell.
              The value of limit can be a number in the unit specified below or one of the values
              `unlimited', which removes the limit on the resource, or  `hard',  which  uses  the
              current value of the hard limit on the resource.

              By default, only soft limits are manipulated. If the -H flag is given use hard lim‐
              its instead of soft limits.  If the -S flag is given together with the -H flag  set
              both hard and soft limits.

              If no options are used, the file size limit (-f) is assumed.

              If limit is omitted the current value of the specified resources are printed.  When
              more than one resource value is printed, the limit name and unit is printed  before
              each value.

              When  looping  over  multiple  resources,  the  shell  will abort immediately if it
              detects a badly formed argument.  However, if it fails to  set  a  limit  for  some
              other reason it will continue trying to set the remaining limits.

              Not  all  the  following resources are supported on all systems.  Running ulimit -a
              will show which are supported.

              -a     Lists all of the current resource limits.
              -b     Socket buffer size in bytes (N.B. not kilobytes)
              -c     512-byte blocks on the size of core dumps.
              -d     Kilobytes on the size of the data segment.
              -f     512-byte blocks on the size of files written.
              -i     The number of pending signals.
              -k     The number of kqueues allocated.
              -l     Kilobytes on the size of locked-in memory.
              -m     Kilobytes on the size of physical memory.
              -n     open file descriptors.
              -p     The number of pseudo-terminals.
              -q     Bytes in POSIX message queues.
              -r     Maximum real time priority.  On some systems where this  is  not  available,
                     such as NetBSD, this has the same effect as -T for compatibility with sh.
              -s     Kilobytes on the size of the stack.
              -T     The number of simultaneous threads available to the user.
              -t     CPU seconds to be used.
              -u     The number of processes available to the user.
              -v     Kilobytes on the size of virtual memory.  On some systems this refers to the
                     limit called `address space'.
              -w     Kilobytes on the size of swapped out memory.
              -x     The number of locks on files.

              A resource may also be specified by  integer  in  the  form  `-N  resource',  where
              resource  corresponds to the integer defined for the resource by the operating sys‐
              tem.  This may be used to set the limits for resources known to the shell which  do
              not  correspond to option letters.  Such limits will be shown by number in the out‐
              put of `ulimit -a'.

              The number may alternatively be out of the range of limits compiled into the shell.
              The  shell  will try to read or write the limit anyway, and will report an error if
              this fails.

       umask [ -S ] [ mask ]
              The umask is set to mask.  mask can be either an octal number or a  symbolic  value
              as  described  in chmod(1).  If mask is omitted, the current value is printed.  The
              -S option causes the mask to be printed as a symbolic value.  Otherwise,  the  mask
              is  printed as an octal number.  Note that in the symbolic form the permissions you
              specify are those which are to be allowed (not denied) to the users specified.

       unalias
              Same as unhash -a.

       unfunction
              Same as unhash -f.

       unhash [ -adfms ] name ...
              Remove the element named name from an internal hash table.  The default  is  remove
              elements  from the command hash table.  The -a option causes unhash to remove regu‐
              lar or global aliases; note when removing a global aliases that the  argument  must
              be  quoted  to  prevent  it from being expanded before being passed to the command.
              The -s option causes unhash to remove suffix aliases.  The -f option causes  unhash
              to  remove  shell functions.  The -d options causes unhash to remove named directo‐
              ries.  If the -m flag is given the arguments  are  taken  as  patterns  (should  be
              quoted)  and  all elements of the corresponding hash table with matching names will
              be removed.

       unlimit [ -hs ] resource ...
              The resource limit for each resource is set to the hard limit.  If the -h  flag  is
              given  and  the  shell has appropriate privileges, the hard resource limit for each
              resource is removed.  The resources of the shell process are only changed if the -s
              flag is given.

              The  unlimit  command  is  not made available by default when the shell starts in a
              mode emulating another shell.  It can be made available with the command  `zmodload
              -F zsh/rlimits b:unlimit'.

       unset [ -fmv ] name ...
              Each  named  parameter is unset.  Local parameters remain local even if unset; they
              appear unset within scope, but the previous value  will  still  reappear  when  the
              scope ends.

              Individual elements of associative array parameters may be unset by using subscript
              syntax on name, which should be quoted (or the entire command prefixed with noglob)
              to protect the subscript from filename generation.

              If  the -m flag is specified the arguments are taken as patterns (should be quoted)
              and all parameters with matching names are unset.  Note that this  cannot  be  used
              when unsetting associative array elements, as the subscript will be treated as part
              of the pattern.

              The -v flag specifies that name refers to parameters. This is  the  default  behav‐
              iour.

              unset -f is equivalent to unfunction.

       unsetopt [ {+|-}options | {+|-}o option_name ] [ name ... ]
              Unset  the  options  for  the shell.  All options specified either with flags or by
              name are unset.  If no arguments are supplied, the names of all  options  currently
              unset  are  printed.   If  the -m flag is given the arguments are taken as patterns
              (which should be quoted to preserve them from being interpreted as glob  patterns),
              and all options with names matching these patterns are unset.

       vared  See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       wait [ job ... ]
              Wait  for  the specified jobs or processes.  If job is not given then all currently
              active child processes are waited for.  Each job can be either a job  specification
              or  the process ID of a job in the job table.  The exit status from this command is
              that of the job waited for.

       whence [ -vcwfpams ] name ...
              For each name, indicate how it would be interpreted if used as a command name.

              -v     Produce a more verbose report.

              -c     Print the results in a csh-like format.  This takes precedence over -v.

              -w     For each name, print `name: word' where word is one of alias, builtin,  com‐
                     mand,  function,  hashed, reserved or none, according as name corresponds to
                     an alias, a built-in command, an external command, a shell function, a  com‐
                     mand  defined  with the hash builtin, a reserved word, or is not recognised.
                     This takes precedence over -v and -c.

              -f     Causes the contents of a shell function to be displayed, which would  other‐
                     wise not happen unless the -c flag were used.

              -p     Do a path search for name even if it is an alias, reserved word, shell func‐
                     tion or builtin.

              -a     Do a search for all occurrences of name throughout the command  path.   Nor‐
                     mally only the first occurrence is printed.

              -m     The  arguments are taken as patterns (should be quoted), and the information
                     is displayed for each command matching one of these patterns.

              -s     If a pathname contains symlinks, print the symlink-free pathname as well.

       where [ -wpms ] name ...
              Equivalent to whence -ca.

       which [ -wpams ] name ...
              Equivalent to whence -c.

       zcompile [ -U ] [ -z | -k ] [ -R | -M ] file [ name ... ]
       zcompile -ca [ -m ] [ -R | -M ] file [ name ... ]
       zcompile -t file [ name ... ]
              This builtin command can be used to compile functions or scripts, storing the  com‐
              piled  form  in  a  file,  and to examine files containing the compiled form.  This
              allows faster autoloading of functions and execution of scripts by avoiding parsing
              of the text when the files are read.

              The first form (without the -c, -a or -t options) creates a compiled file.  If only
              the file argument is given, the output file has the name  `file.zwc'  and  will  be
              placed  in  the  same directory as the file.  The shell will load the compiled file
              instead of the normal function file when the function is autoloaded; see  the  sec‐
              tion  `Autoloading  Functions'  in  zshmisc(1)  for a description of how autoloaded
              functions are searched.  The extension .zwc stands for `zsh word code'.

              If there is at least one name argument, all the named files are compiled  into  the
              output file given as the first argument.  If file does not end in .zwc, this exten‐
              sion is automatically appended.  Files containing multiple compiled  functions  are
              called  `digest'  files, and are intended to be used as elements of the FPATH/fpath
              special array.

              The second form, with the -c or -a options, writes the compiled definitions for all
              the  named  functions  into  file.   For  -c, the names must be functions currently
              defined in the shell, not those marked for autoloading.  Undefined  functions  that
              are marked for autoloading may be written by using the -a option, in which case the
              fpath is searched and the contents of the definition files for those functions,  if
              found,  are compiled into file.  If both -c and -a are given, names of both defined
              functions and functions marked for autoloading may be given.  In either  case,  the
              functions  in  files  written with the -c or -a option will be autoloaded as if the
              KSH_AUTOLOAD option were unset.

              The reason for handling loaded and not-yet-loaded functions with different  options
              is  that some definition files for autoloading define multiple functions, including
              the function with the same name as the file, and, at the end, call  that  function.
              In such cases the output of `zcompile -c' does not include the additional functions
              defined in the file, and any other initialization code in the file is lost.   Using
              `zcompile -a' captures all this extra information.

              If  the -m option is combined with -c or -a, the names are used as patterns and all
              functions whose names match one of these patterns will be written. If  no  name  is
              given,  the  definitions of all functions currently defined or marked as autoloaded
              will be written.

              Note the second form cannot be used for compiling functions that  include  redirec‐
              tions  as  part  of the definition rather than within the body of the function; for
              example

                     fn1() { { ... } >~/logfile }

              can be compiled but

                     fn1() { ... } >~/logfile

              cannot.  It is possible to use the first form of zcompile to  compile  autoloadable
              functions that include the full function definition instead of just the body of the
              function.

              The third form, with the -t option, examines an existing  compiled  file.   Without
              further  arguments,  the  names  of the original files compiled into it are listed.
              The first line of output shows the version of the shell which compiled the file and
              how  the  file will be used (i.e. by reading it directly or by mapping it into mem‐
              ory).  With arguments, nothing is output and the return status is set  to  zero  if
              definitions for all names were found in the compiled file, and non-zero if the def‐
              inition for at least one name was not found.

              Other options:

              -U     Aliases are not expanded when compiling the named files.

              -R     When the compiled file is read, its contents are  copied  into  the  shell's
                     memory,  rather  than memory-mapped (see -M).  This happens automatically on
                     systems that do not support memory mapping.

                     When compiling scripts instead of autoloadable functions, it is often desir‐
                     able  to  use  this  option; otherwise the whole file, including the code to
                     define functions which have already been defined, will remain mapped, conse‐
                     quently wasting memory.

              -M     The  compiled file is mapped into the shell's memory when read. This is done
                     in such a way that multiple instances of the shell running on the same  host
                     will  share  this  mapped file.  If neither -R nor -M is given, the zcompile
                     builtin decides what to do based on the size of the compiled file.

              -k
              -z     These options are used when the compiled file contains functions  which  are
                     to  be autoloaded. If -z is given, the function will be autoloaded as if the
                     KSH_AUTOLOAD option is not set, even if it is set at the time  the  compiled
                     file  is  read,  while if the -k is given, the function will be loaded as if
                     KSH_AUTOLOAD is set.  These options also take precedence over any -k  or  -z
                     options  specified  to  the autoload builtin. If neither of these options is
                     given, the function will be loaded as  determined  by  the  setting  of  the
                     KSH_AUTOLOAD option at the time the compiled file is read.

                     These  options may also appear as many times as necessary between the listed
                     names to specify the loading style of all following  functions,  up  to  the
                     next -k or -z.

                     The  created  file  always contains two versions of the compiled format, one
                     for big-endian machines and one for small-endian machines.   The  upshot  of
                     this  is  that the compiled file is machine independent and if it is read or
                     mapped, only one half of the file is actually used (and mapped).

       zformat
              See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zftp   See the section `The zsh/zftp Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zle    See the section `Zle Builtins' in zshzle(1).

       zmodload [ -dL ] [ ... ]
       zmodload -F [ -lLme -P param ] module [+-]feature...
       zmodload -e [ -A ] [ ... ]
       zmodload [ -a [ -bcpf [ -I ] ] ] [ -iL ] ...
       zmodload -u [ -abcdpf [ -I ] ] [ -iL ] ...
       zmodload -A [ -L ] [ modalias[=module] ... ]
       zmodload -R modalias ...
              Performs operations relating to zsh's loadable modules.  Loading of  modules  while
              the  shell  is running (`dynamical loading') is not available on all operating sys‐
              tems, or on all installations on a particular operating system, although the  zmod‐
              load command itself is always available and can be used to manipulate modules built
              into versions of the shell executable without dynamical loading.

              Without arguments the names of all currently loaded  binary  modules  are  printed.
              The  -L option causes this list to be in the form of a series of zmodload commands.
              Forms with arguments are:

              zmodload [ -i ] name ...
              zmodload -u [ -i ] name ...
                     In the simplest case, zmodload loads a binary module.  The module must be in
                     a  file  with a name consisting of the specified name followed by a standard
                     suffix, usually `.so' (`.sl' on HPUX).   If  the  module  to  be  loaded  is
                     already  loaded  the  duplicate  module  is ignored.  If zmodload detects an
                     inconsistency, such as an invalid module name or circular  dependency  list,
                     the  current code block is aborted.   Hence `zmodload module 2>/dev/null' is
                     sufficient to test whether a module is available.  If it is  available,  the
                     module is loaded if necessary, while if it is not available, non-zero status
                     is silently returned.  The option -i is accepted for compatibility  but  has
                     no effect.

                     The  named  module is searched for in the same way a command is, using $mod‐
                     ule_path instead of $path.  However, the path search is performed even  when
                     the  module  name contains a `/', which it usually does.  There is no way to
                     prevent the path search.

                     If the module supports features (see below), zmodload tries  to  enable  all
                     features  when  loading a module.  If the module was successfully loaded but
                     not all features could be enabled, zmodload returns status 2.

                     With -u, zmodload unloads modules.  The same name must  be  given  that  was
                     given  when the module was loaded, but it is not necessary for the module to
                     exist in the file system.  The -i option suppresses the error if the  module
                     is already unloaded (or was never loaded).

                     Each  module  has  a  boot  and  a cleanup function.  The module will not be
                     loaded if its boot function fails.  Similarly a module can only be  unloaded
                     if its cleanup function runs successfully.

              zmodload -F [ -almLe -P param ] module [+-]feature...
                     zmodload -F allows more selective control over the features provided by mod‐
                     ules.  With no options apart from -F, the module named module is loaded,  if
                     it  was  not already loaded, and the list of features is set to the required
                     state.  If no features are specified, the module is loaded, if  it  was  not
                     already loaded, but the state of features is unchanged.  Each feature may be
                     preceded by a + to turn the feature on, or -  to  turn  it  off;  the  +  is
                     assumed  if  neither  character is present.  Any feature not explicitly men‐
                     tioned is left in its current state; if the module was not previously loaded
                     this  means  any  such  features will remain disabled.  The return status is
                     zero if all features were set, 1 if the module failed to load, and 2 if some
                     features  could  not  be  set  (for  example,  a parameter couldn't be added
                     because there was a different parameter of the same name) but the module was
                     loaded.

                     The  standard  features  are builtins, conditions, parameters and math func‐
                     tions; these are indicated by the prefix `b:', `c:' (`C:' for an infix  con‐
                     dition),  `p:'  and `f:', respectively, followed by the name that the corre‐
                     sponding feature would have in the shell.  For example,  `b:strftime'  indi‐
                     cates  a  builtin  named  strftime  and p:EPOCHSECONDS indicates a parameter
                     named EPOCHSECONDS.  The module may provide other (`abstract')  features  of
                     its own as indicated by its documentation; these have no prefix.

                     With -l or -L, features provided by the module are listed.  With -l alone, a
                     list of features together with their states is shown, one feature per  line.
                     With  -L  alone,  a zmodload -F command that would cause enabled features of
                     the module to be turned on is shown.  With -lL, a zmodload -F  command  that
                     would  cause all the features to be set to their current state is shown.  If
                     one of these combinations is given the option -P param  then  the  parameter
                     param  is  set  to an array of features, either features together with their
                     state or (if -L alone is given) enabled features.

                     With the option -L the module name may  be  omitted;  then  a  list  of  all
                     enabled  features  for all modules providing features is printed in the form
                     of zmodload -F commands.  If -l is also given, the state of both enabled and
                     disabled features is output in that form.

                     A  set of features may be provided together with -l or -L and a module name;
                     in that case only the state of those features is considered.   Each  feature
                     may  be  preceded  by  + or - but the character has no effect.  If no set of
                     features is provided, all features are considered.

                     With -e, the command first tests that the module is loaded; if  it  is  not,
                     status  1  is returned.  If the module is loaded, the list of features given
                     as an argument is examined.  Any feature given  with  no  prefix  is  simply
                     tested  to  see if the module provides it; any feature given with a prefix +
                     or - is tested to see if is provided and in the given state.  If  the  tests
                     on all features in the list succeed, status 0 is returned, else status 1.

                     With  -m,  each entry in the given list of features is taken as a pattern to
                     be matched against the list of features provided by the module.  An  initial
                     +  or  -  must  be  given  explicitly.  This may not be combined with the -a
                     option as autoloads must be specified explicitly.

                     With -a, the given list of features is marked for autoload from  the  speci‐
                     fied  module,  which may not yet be loaded.  An optional + may appear before
                     the feature name.  If the feature is prefixed with -, any existing  autoload
                     is removed.  The options -l and -L may be used to list autoloads.  Autoload‐
                     ing is specific to individual features; when the module is loaded  only  the
                     requested feature is enabled.  Autoload requests are preserved if the module
                     is subsequently unloaded until an explicit `zmodload -Fa module -feature' is
                     issued.  It is not an error to request an autoload for a feature of a module
                     that is already loaded.

                     When the module is loaded each autoload  is  checked  against  the  features
                     actually provided by the module; if the feature is not provided the autoload
                     request is deleted.  A warning message is output; if  the  module  is  being
                     loaded  to  provide  a  different  feature, and that autoload is successful,
                     there is no effect on the status of the current command.  If the  module  is
                     already  loaded  at  the  time when zmodload -Fa is run, an error message is
                     printed and status 1 returned.

                     zmodload -Fa can be used with the -l, -L, -e and -P options for listing  and
                     testing  the existence of autoloadable features.  In this case -l is ignored
                     if -L is specified.  zmodload -FaL with no module name lists  autoloads  for
                     all modules.

                     Note that only standard features as described above can be autoloaded; other
                     features require the module to be loaded before enabling.

              zmodload -d [ -L ] [ name ]
              zmodload -d name dep ...
              zmodload -ud name [ dep ... ]
                     The -d option can be used to specify module dependencies.  The modules named
                     in  the  second  and  subsequent  arguments will be loaded before the module
                     named in the first argument.

                     With -d and one argument, all dependencies for that module are listed.  With
                     -d and no arguments, all module dependencies are listed.  This listing is by
                     default in a Makefile-like format.  The -L option changes this format  to  a
                     list of zmodload -d commands.

                     If  -d and -u are both used, dependencies are removed.  If only one argument
                     is given, all dependencies for that module are removed.

              zmodload -ab [ -L ]
              zmodload -ab [ -i ] name [ builtin ... ]
              zmodload -ub [ -i ] builtin ...
                     The -ab option  defines  autoloaded  builtins.   It  defines  the  specified
                     builtins.  When any of those builtins is called, the module specified in the
                     first argument is loaded and all its features  are  enabled  (for  selective
                     control  of  features use `zmodload -F -a' as described above).  If only the
                     name is given, one builtin is defined, with the same name as the module.  -i
                     suppresses  the  error  if the builtin is already defined or autoloaded, but
                     not if another builtin of the same name is already defined.

                     With -ab and no arguments, all autoloaded builtins are listed, with the mod‐
                     ule name (if different) shown in parentheses after the builtin name.  The -L
                     option changes this format to a list of zmodload -a commands.

                     If -b is used together with the -u option, it  removes  builtins  previously
                     defined  with  -ab.  This is only possible if the builtin is not yet loaded.
                     -i suppresses the  error  if  the  builtin  is  already  removed  (or  never
                     existed).

                     Autoload  requests are retained if the module is subsequently unloaded until
                     an explicit `zmodload -ub builtin' is issued.

              zmodload -ac [ -IL ]
              zmodload -ac [ -iI ] name [ cond ... ]
              zmodload -uc [ -iI ] cond ...
                     The -ac option is used  to  define  autoloaded  condition  codes.  The  cond
                     strings give the names of the conditions defined by the module. The optional
                     -I option is used to define infix condition names. Without this option  pre‐
                     fix condition names are defined.

                     If  given  no  condition names, all defined names are listed (as a series of
                     zmodload commands if the -L option is given).

                     The -uc option removes definitions for autoloaded conditions.

              zmodload -ap [ -L ]
              zmodload -ap [ -i ] name [ parameter ... ]
              zmodload -up [ -i ] parameter ...
                     The -p option is like the -b and -c options,  but  makes  zmodload  work  on
                     autoloaded parameters instead.

              zmodload -af [ -L ]
              zmodload -af [ -i ] name [ function ... ]
              zmodload -uf [ -i ] function ...
                     The -f option is like the -b, -p, and -c options, but makes zmodload work on
                     autoloaded math functions instead.

              zmodload -a [ -L ]
              zmodload -a [ -i ] name [ builtin ... ]
              zmodload -ua [ -i ] builtin ...
                     Equivalent to -ab and -ub.

              zmodload -e [ -A ] [ string ... ]
                     The -e option without arguments lists all loaded modules; if the  -A  option
                     is  also  given,  module  aliases  corresponding  to loaded modules are also
                     shown.  If arguments are provided, nothing is printed; the return status  is
                     set  to  zero  if all strings given as arguments are names of loaded modules
                     and to one if at least on string is not the name of a loaded  module.   This
                     can  be  used to test for the availability of things implemented by modules.
                     In this case, any aliases are automatically resolved and the -A flag is  not
                     used.

              zmodload -A [ -L ] [ modalias[=module] ... ]
                     For each argument, if both modalias and module are given, define modalias to
                     be an alias for the module module.  If the module modalias  is  ever  subse‐
                     quently  requested,  either  via a call to zmodload or implicitly, the shell
                     will attempt to load module instead.  If module is not given, show the defi‐
                     nition  of  modalias.   If  no  arguments are given, list all defined module
                     aliases.  When listing, if the -L flag was also given, list  the  definition
                     as a zmodload command to recreate the alias.

                     The  existence  of  aliases for modules is completely independent of whether
                     the name resolved is actually loaded as a module: while  the  alias  exists,
                     loading and unloading the module under any alias has exactly the same effect
                     as using the resolved name, and does not affect the connection  between  the
                     alias and the resolved name which can be removed either by zmodload -R or by
                     redefining the alias.  Chains of aliases (i.e. where the first resolved name
                     is  itself  an  alias)  are valid so long as these are not circular.  As the
                     aliases take the same format as module names, they may include path  separa‐
                     tors:   in this case, there is no requirement for any part of the path named
                     to exist as the alias will be resolved first.  For example,  `any/old/alias'
                     is always a valid alias.

                     Dependencies  added  to  aliased  modules are actually added to the resolved
                     module; these remain if the alias is removed.  It  is  valid  to  create  an
                     alias  whose name is one of the standard shell modules and which resolves to
                     a different module.  However, if a module has dependencies, it will  not  be
                     possible  to  use  the module name as an alias as the module will already be
                     marked as a loadable module in its own right.

                     Apart from the above, aliases can be used in the zmodload  command  anywhere
                     module  names  are required.  However, aliases will not be shown in lists of
                     loaded modules with a bare `zmodload'.

              zmodload -R modalias ...
                     For each modalias argument that was previously defined as a module alias via
                     zmodload  -A,  delete the alias.  If any was not defined, an error is caused
                     and the remainder of the line is ignored.

              Note that zsh makes no distinction between modules that were linked into the  shell
              and  modules that are loaded dynamically. In both cases this builtin command has to
              be used to make available the builtins and other things defined by modules  (unless
              the  module is autoloaded on these definitions). This is true even for systems that
              don't support dynamic loading of modules.

       zparseopts
              See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zprof  See the section `The zsh/zprof Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zpty   See the section `The zsh/zpty Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zregexparse
              See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zsocket
              See the section `The zsh/net/socket Module' in zshmodules(1).

       zstyle See the section `The zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1).

       ztcp   See the section `The zsh/net/tcp Module' in zshmodules(1).



ZSHZLE(1)                            General Commands Manual                            ZSHZLE(1)



NAME
       zshzle - zsh command line editor

DESCRIPTION
       If the ZLE option is set (which it is by default in  interactive  shells)  and  the  shell
       input is attached to the terminal, the user is able to edit command lines.

       There are two display modes.  The first, multiline mode, is the default.  It only works if
       the TERM parameter is set to a valid terminal type that can move the cursor up.  The  sec‐
       ond, single line mode, is used if TERM is invalid or incapable of moving the cursor up, or
       if the SINGLE_LINE_ZLE option is set.  This mode is similar to ksh, and  uses  no  termcap
       sequences.  If TERM is "emacs", the ZLE option will be unset by default.

       The  parameters BAUD, COLUMNS, and LINES are also used by the line editor.  See Parameters
       Used By The Shell in zshparam(1).

       The parameter zle_highlight is also used by the line editor;  see  Character  Highlighting
       below.   Highlighting of special characters and the region between the cursor and the mark
       (as set with set-mark-command in Emacs mode) is enabled by default; consult this reference
       for more information.  Irascible conservatives will wish to know that all highlighting may
       be disabled by the following setting:

              zle_highlight=(none)

KEYMAPS
       A keymap in ZLE contains a set of bindings between key sequences and  ZLE  commands.   The
       empty key sequence cannot be bound.

       There can be any number of keymaps at any time, and each keymap has one or more names.  If
       all of a keymap's names are deleted, it disappears.  bindkey can  be  used  to  manipulate
       keymap names.

       Initially, there are six keymaps:

       emacs  EMACS emulation
       viins  vi emulation - insert mode
       vicmd  vi emulation - command mode
       isearch
              incremental search mode
       command
              read a command name
       .safe  fallback keymap

       The  `.safe'  keymap  is  special.   It  can  never  be altered, and the name can never be
       removed.  However, it can be linked to other names, which can be removed.  In  the  future
       other  special keymaps may be added; users should avoid using names beginning with `.' for
       their own keymaps.

       In addition to these names, either `emacs' or `viins' is also linked to the  name  `main'.
       If  one  of  the  VISUAL  or EDITOR environment variables contain the string `vi' when the
       shell starts up then it will be `viins', otherwise it will be `emacs'.  bindkey's  -e  and
       -v options provide a convenient way to override this default choice.

       When  the  editor  starts  up,  it  will select the `main' keymap.  If that keymap doesn't
       exist, it will use `.safe' instead.

       In the `.safe' keymap, each single key is bound to self-insert, except for ^J (line  feed)
       and ^M (return) which are bound to accept-line.  This is deliberately not pleasant to use;
       if you are using it, it means you deleted the main keymap, and you should put it back.

   Reading Commands
       When ZLE is reading a command from the terminal, it may read a sequence that is  bound  to
       some  command and is also a prefix of a longer bound string.  In this case ZLE will wait a
       certain time to see if more characters are typed, and if not  (or  they  don't  match  any
       longer  string)  it  will  execute the binding.  This timeout is defined by the KEYTIMEOUT
       parameter; its default is 0.4 sec.  There is no timeout if the prefix string is not itself
       bound to a command.

       The  key  timeout is also applied when ZLE is reading the bytes from a multibyte character
       string when it is in the appropriate mode.  (This requires that  the  shell  was  compiled
       with  multibyte  mode  enabled;  typically  also  the locale has characters with the UTF-8
       encoding, although any multibyte encoding known to the operating system is supported.)  If
       the  second  or a subsequent byte is not read within the timeout period, the shell acts as
       if ? were typed and resets the input state.

       As well as ZLE commands, key sequences can be bound to other strings,  by  using  `bindkey
       -s'.   When  such  a sequence is read, the replacement string is pushed back as input, and
       the command reading process starts again using these  fake  keystrokes.   This  input  can
       itself  invoke  further replacement strings, but in order to detect loops the process will
       be stopped if there are twenty such replacements without a real command being read.

       A key sequence typed by the user can be turned into a command name for use in user-defined
       widgets with the read-command widget, described below.

ZLE BUILTINS
       The  ZLE  module  contains three related builtin commands. The bindkey command manipulates
       keymaps and key bindings; the vared command invokes ZLE on the value of a shell parameter;
       and the zle command manipulates editing widgets and allows command line access to ZLE com‐
       mands from within shell functions.

       bindkey [ options ] -l [ -L ] [ keymap ... ]
       bindkey [ options ] -d
       bindkey [ options ] -D keymap ...
       bindkey [ options ] -A old-keymap new-keymap
       bindkey [ options ] -N new-keymap [ old-keymap ]
       bindkey [ options ] -m
       bindkey [ options ] -r in-string ...
       bindkey [ options ] -s in-string out-string ...
       bindkey [ options ] in-string command ...
       bindkey [ options ] [ in-string ]
              bindkey's options can be divided into three categories: keymap  selection  for  the
              current  command,  operation  selection,  and others.  The keymap selection options
              are:

              -e     Selects keymap `emacs' for any operations by the current command,  and  also
                     links  `emacs' to `main' so that it is selected by default the next time the
                     editor starts.

              -v     Selects keymap `viins' for any operations by the current command,  and  also
                     links  `viins' to `main' so that it is selected by default the next time the
                     editor starts.

              -a     Selects keymap `vicmd' for any operations by the current command.

              -M keymap
                     The keymap specifies a keymap name that is selected for  any  operations  by
                     the current command.

              If  a  keymap  selection  is  required  and none of the options above are used, the
              `main' keymap is used.  Some operations do not permit  a  keymap  to  be  selected,
              namely:

              -l     List  all existing keymap names; if any arguments are given, list just those
                     keymaps.

                     If the -L option is also used, list in the form of bindkey commands to  cre‐
                     ate or link the keymaps.  `bindkey -lL main' shows which keymap is linked to
                     `main', if any, and hence if the  standard  emacs  or  vi  emulation  is  in
                     effect.   This  option  does  not show the .safe keymap because it cannot be
                     created in that fashion; however, neither is `bindkey -lL .safe' reported as
                     an error, it simply outputs nothing.

              -d     Delete all existing keymaps and reset to the default state.

              -D keymap ...
                     Delete the named keymaps.

              -A old-keymap new-keymap
                     Make  the  new-keymap name an alias for old-keymap, so that both names refer
                     to the same keymap.  The names have equal standing; if  either  is  deleted,
                     the  other  remains.  If there is already a keymap with the new-keymap name,
                     it is deleted.

              -N new-keymap [ old-keymap ]
                     Create a new keymap, named new-keymap.  If a keymap already has  that  name,
                     it  is  deleted.  If an old-keymap name is given, the new keymap is initial‐
                     ized to be a duplicate of it, otherwise the new keymap will be empty.

              To use a newly created keymap, it should be linked to main.  Hence the sequence  of
              commands  to  create and use a new keymap `mymap' initialized from the emacs keymap
              (which remains unchanged) is:

                     bindkey -N mymap emacs
                     bindkey -A mymap main

              Note that while `bindkey -A newmap main' will work when newmap is emacs  or  viins,
              it  will  not  work  for vicmd, as switching from vi insert to command mode becomes
              impossible.

              The following operations act on the `main' keymap if no keymap selection option was
              given:

              -m     Add the built-in set of meta-key bindings to the selected keymap.  Only keys
                     that are unbound or bound to self-insert are affected.

              -r in-string ...
                     Unbind the specified in-strings in the selected  keymap.   This  is  exactly
                     equivalent to binding the strings to undefined-key.

                     When -R is also used, interpret the in-strings as ranges.

                     When -p is also used, the in-strings specify prefixes.  Any binding that has
                     the given in-string as a prefix, not including the binding for the in-string
                     itself, if any, will be removed.  For example,

                            bindkey -rpM viins '^['

                     will  remove  all  bindings in the vi-insert keymap beginning with an escape
                     character (probably cursor keys), but leave the binding for the escape char‐
                     acter  itself  (probably vi-cmd-mode).  This is incompatible with the option
                     -R.

              -s in-string out-string ...
                     Bind each in-string to each out-string.  When in-string is typed, out-string
                     will  be  pushed  back  and treated as input to the line editor.  When -R is
                     also used, interpret the in-strings as ranges.

                     Note that both in-string and out-string are subject  to  the  same  form  of
                     interpretation, as described below.

              in-string command ...
                     Bind  each  in-string  to  each  command.   When  -R  is used, interpret the
                     in-strings as ranges.

              [ in-string ]
                     List key bindings.  If an in-string is specified, the binding of that string
                     in  the  selected  keymap  is displayed.  Otherwise, all key bindings in the
                     selected keymap are displayed.  (As a special case, if the -e or  -v  option
                     is used alone, the keymap is not displayed - the implicit linking of keymaps
                     is the only thing that happens.)

                     When the option -p is used, the in-string  must  be  present.   The  listing
                     shows  all  bindings  which  have  the  given  key sequence as a prefix, not
                     including any bindings for the key sequence itself.

                     When the -L option is used, the list is in the form of bindkey  commands  to
                     create the key bindings.

              When  the  -R  option is used as noted above, a valid range consists of two charac‐
              ters, with an optional `-' between them.  All characters between the two specified,
              inclusive, are bound as specified.

              For either in-string or out-string, the following escape sequences are recognised:

              \a     bell character
              \b     backspace
              \e, \E escape
              \f     form feed
              \n     linefeed (newline)
              \r     carriage return
              \t     horizontal tab
              \v     vertical tab
              \NNN   character code in octal
              \xNN   character code in hexadecimal
              \M[-]X character with meta bit set
              \C[-]X control character
              ^X     control character

              In  all  other  cases,  `\'  escapes the following character.  Delete is written as
              `^?'.  Note that `\M^?' and `^\M?' are not the same, and that (unlike  emacs),  the
              bindings  `\M-X'  and `\eX' are entirely distinct, although they are initialized to
              the same bindings by `bindkey -m'.

       vared [ -Aache ] [ -p prompt ] [ -r rprompt ]
         [ -M main-keymap ] [ -m vicmd-keymap ]
         [ -i init-widget ] [ -f finish-widget ]
         [ -t tty ] name
              The value of the parameter name is loaded into the edit buffer, and the line editor
              is invoked.  When the editor exits, name is set to the string value returned by the
              editor.  When the -c flag is given, the parameter is created if it doesn't  already
              exist.   The  -a  flag may be given with -c to create an array parameter, or the -A
              flag to create an associative array.  If the type of an existing parameter does not
              match the type to be created, the parameter is unset and recreated.

              If an array or array slice is being edited, separator characters as defined in $IFS
              will be shown quoted with a backslash, as will backslashes themselves.  Conversely,
              when the edited text is split into an array, a backslash quotes an immediately fol‐
              lowing separator character or backslash; no other special handling of  backslashes,
              or any handling of quotes, is performed.

              Individual elements of existing array or associative array parameters may be edited
              by using subscript syntax on name.  New elements are  created  automatically,  even
              without -c.

              If  the  -p flag is given, the following string will be taken as the prompt to dis‐
              play at the left.  If the -r flag is given, the following string gives  the  prompt
              to  display at the right.  If the -h flag is specified, the history can be accessed
              from ZLE. If the -e flag is given, typing ^D (Control-D) on an  empty  line  causes
              vared to exit immediately with a non-zero return value.

              The  -M option gives a keymap to link to the main keymap during editing, and the -m
              option gives a keymap to link to the vicmd keymap  during  editing.   For  vi-style
              editing,  this  allows  a  pair  of  keymaps  to  override  viins  and  vicmd.  For
              emacs-style editing, only -M is normally needed but the  -m  option  may  still  be
              used.  On exit, the previous keymaps will be restored.

              Vared  calls the usual `zle-line-init' and `zle-line-finish' hooks before and after
              it takes control. Using the -i and -f options, it is possible to replace these with
              other custom widgets.

              If  `-t  tty'  is given, tty is the name of a terminal device to be used instead of
              the default /dev/tty.  If tty does not refer to a terminal an error is reported.

       zle
       zle -l [ -L | -a ] [ string ... ]
       zle -D widget ...
       zle -A old-widget new-widget
       zle -N widget [ function ]
       zle -C widget completion-widget function
       zle -R [ -c ] [ display-string ] [ string ... ]
       zle -M string
       zle -U string
       zle -K keymap
       zle -F [ -L | -w ] [ fd [ handler ] ]
       zle -I
       zle -T [ tc function | -r tc | -L ]
       zle widget [ -n num ] [ -Nw ] [ -K keymap ] args ...
              The zle builtin performs a number of different actions concerning ZLE.

              With no options and no arguments, only the return status will be set.  It  is  zero
              if  ZLE is currently active and widgets could be invoked using this builtin command
              and non-zero otherwise.  Note that even if non-zero status  is  returned,  zle  may
              still  be active as part of the completion system; this does not allow direct calls
              to ZLE widgets.

              Otherwise, which operation it performs depends on its options:

              -l [ -L | -a ]
                     List all existing user-defined widgets.  If the -L option is used,  list  in
                     the form of zle commands to create the widgets.

                     When combined with the -a option, all widget names are listed, including the
                     builtin ones. In this case the -L option is ignored.

                     If at least one string is given, and -a is present or -L is not used,  noth‐
                     ing  will  be  printed.   The  return status will be zero if all strings are
                     names of existing widgets and non-zero if at least one string is not a  name
                     of  a  defined widget.  If -a is also present, all widget names are used for
                     the comparison including builtin widgets, else only user-defined widgets are
                     used.

                     If  at  least  one string is present and the -L option is used, user-defined
                     widgets matching any string are listed in the form of zle commands to create
                     the widgets.

              -D widget ...
                     Delete the named widgets.

              -A old-widget new-widget
                     Make  the  new-widget name an alias for old-widget, so that both names refer
                     to the same widget.  The names have equal standing; if  either  is  deleted,
                     the  other  remains.  If there is already a widget with the new-widget name,
                     it is deleted.

              -N widget [ function ]
                     Create a user-defined widget.  If there is already a widget with the  speci‐
                     fied  name,  it  is overwritten.  When the new widget is invoked from within
                     the editor, the specified shell function is called.  If no function name  is
                     specified, it defaults to the same name as the widget.  For further informa‐
                     tion, see the section Widgets in zshzle(1).

              -C widget completion-widget function
                     Create a user-defined completion widget named widget. The completion  widget
                     will  behave like the built-in completion-widget whose name is given as com‐
                     pletion-widget. To generate the completions,  the  shell  function  function
                     will be called.  For further information, see zshcompwid(1).

              -R [ -c ] [ display-string ] [ string ... ]
                     Redisplay  the command line; this is to be called from within a user-defined
                     widget to allow changes to become visible.  If a display-string is given and
                     not  empty,  this  is  shown  in the status line (immediately below the line
                     being edited).

                     If the optional strings are given they are listed below the  prompt  in  the
                     same way as completion lists are printed. If no strings are given but the -c
                     option is used such a list is cleared.

                     Note that this option is only useful for widgets that do  not  exit  immedi‐
                     ately  after  using  it because the strings displayed will be erased immedi‐
                     ately after return from the widget.

                     This command can safely be called outside user defined widgets;  if  zle  is
                     active,  the display will be refreshed, while if zle is not active, the com‐
                     mand has no effect.  In this case there will usually be no other arguments.

                     The status is zero if zle was active, else one.

              -M string
                     As with the -R option, the string will be displayed below the command  line;
                     unlike  the  -R  option, the string will not be put into the status line but
                     will instead be printed normally below the  prompt.   This  means  that  the
                     string  will  still be displayed after the widget returns (until it is over‐
                     written by subsequent commands).

              -U string
                     This pushes the characters in the string onto the input stack of ZLE.  After
                     the  widget currently executed finishes ZLE will behave as if the characters
                     in the string were typed by the user.

                     As ZLE uses a stack, if this option  is  used  repeatedly  the  last  string
                     pushed  onto  the stack will be processed first.  However, the characters in
                     each string will be processed in the order  in  which  they  appear  in  the
                     string.

              -K keymap
                     Selects  the  keymap  named  keymap.   An error message will be displayed if
                     there is no such keymap.

                     This keymap selection affects the  interpretation  of  following  keystrokes
                     within  this  invocation  of  ZLE.  Any following invocation (e.g., the next
                     command line) will start as usual with the `main' keymap selected.

              -F [ -L | -w ] [ fd [ handler ] ]
                     Only available if your system supports one of the `poll' or `select'  system
                     calls; most modern systems do.

                     Installs  handler  (the  name of a shell function) to handle input from file
                     descriptor fd.  Installing a handler for an  fd  which  is  already  handled
                     causes  the existing handler to be replaced.  Any number of handlers for any
                     number of readable file descriptors may be installed.  Note that  zle  makes
                     no attempt to check whether this fd is actually readable when installing the
                     handler.  The user must make their own arrangements for  handling  the  file
                     descriptor when zle is not active.

                     When  zle  is attempting to read data, it will examine both the terminal and
                     the list of handled fd's.  If data becomes available on a  handled  fd,  zle
                     calls  handler with the fd which is ready for reading as the first argument.
                     Under normal circumstances this is the only argument, but if  an  error  was
                     detected, a second argument provides details: `hup' for a disconnect, `nval'
                     for a closed or otherwise invalid descriptor, or `err' for any other  condi‐
                     tion.  Systems that support only the `select' system call always use `err'.

                     If the option -w is also given, the handler is instead a line editor widget,
                     typically a shell function made into a widget using `zle -N'.  In that  case
                     handler  can  use  all  the  facilities of zle to update the current editing
                     line.  Note, however, that as handling fd takes place at a low level changes
                     to  the  display  will not automatically appear; the widget should call `zle
                     -R' to force redisplay.  As of this writing, widget handlers only support  a
                     single  argument and thus are never passed a string for error state, so wid‐
                     gets must be prepared to test the descriptor themselves.

                     If either type of handler produces output to the terminal,  it  should  call
                     `zle  -I'  before doing so (see below).  Handlers should not attempt to read
                     from the terminal.

                     If no handler is given, but an fd is present, any handler  for  that  fd  is
                     removed.   If  there  is  none,  an error message is printed and status 1 is
                     returned.

                     If no arguments are given, or the -L option is supplied, a list of  handlers
                     is printed in a form which can be stored for later execution.

                     An  fd  (but  not  a handler) may optionally be given with the -L option; in
                     this case, the function will list the handler if any, else  silently  return
                     status 1.

                     Note  that  this  feature  should be used with care.  Activity on one of the
                     fd's which is not properly handled can cause the terminal  to  become  unus‐
                     able.   Removing  an  fd  handler from within a signal trap may cause unpre‐
                     dictable behavior.

                     Here is a simple example of using this feature.  A connection  to  a  remote
                     TCP  port  is  created  using  the  ztcp command; see the description of the
                     zsh/net/tcp module in zshmodules(1).  Then a handler is installed which sim‐
                     ply  prints  out  any  data  which  arrives  on  this connection.  Note that
                     `select' will indicate that the file descriptor needs handling if the remote
                     side has closed the connection; we handle that by testing for a failed read.

                            if ztcp pwspc 2811; then
                              tcpfd=$REPLY
                              handler() {
                                zle -I
                                local line
                                if ! read -r line <&$1; then
                                  # select marks this fd if we reach EOF,
                                  # so handle this specially.
                                  print "[Read on fd $1 failed, removing.]" >&2
                                  zle -F $1
                                  return 1
                                fi
                                print -r - $line
                              }
                              zle -F $tcpfd handler
                            fi

              -I     Unusually,  this  option  is  most useful outside ordinary widget functions,
                     though it may be used within if normal output to the terminal  is  required.
                     It  invalidates the current zle display in preparation for output; typically
                     this will be from a trap function.  It has no effect if zle is  not  active.
                     When  a  trap exits, the shell checks to see if the display needs restoring,
                     hence the following will print output in such a way as not  to  disturb  the
                     line being edited:

                            TRAPUSR1() {
                                # Invalidate zle display
                              [[ -o zle ]] && zle -I
                                # Show output
                              print Hello
                            }

                     In  general, the trap function may need to test whether zle is active before
                     using this method (as shown in the example), since the  zsh/zle  module  may
                     not even be loaded; if it is not, the command can be skipped.

                     It  is possible to call `zle -I' several times before control is returned to
                     the editor; the display will only be invalidated the first time to  minimise
                     disruption.

                     Note  that  there  are normally better ways of manipulating the display from
                     within zle widgets; see, for example, `zle -R' above.

                     The returned status is zero if zle was invalidated,  even  though  this  may
                     have  been  by  a previous call to `zle -I' or by a system notification.  To
                     test if a zle widget may be called at this point, execute zle with no  argu‐
                     ments and examine the return status.

              -T     This is used to add, list or remove internal transformations on the process‐
                     ing performed by the line editor.  It is typically used only  for  debugging
                     or testing and is therefore of little interest to the general user.

                     `zle  -T  transformation  func' specifies that the given transformation (see
                     below) is effected by shell function func.

                     `zle -Tr transformation' removes the given transformation if it was  present
                     (it is not an error if none was).

                     `zle -TL' can be used to list all transformations currently in operation.

                     Currently the only transformation is tc.  This is used instead of outputting
                     termcap codes to the terminal.  When the transformation is in operation  the
                     shell  function is passed the termcap code that would be output as its first
                     argument; if the operation required a numeric argument, that is passed as  a
                     second  argument.   The  function should set the shell variable REPLY to the
                     transformed termcap code.  Typically this is used  to  produce  some  simply
                     formatted  version  of the code and optional argument for debugging or test‐
                     ing.  Note that this transformation is not  applied  to  other  non-printing
                     characters such as carriage returns and newlines.

              widget [ -n num ] [ -Nw ] [ -K keymap ] args ...
                     Invoke the specified widget.  This can only be done when ZLE is active; nor‐
                     mally this will be within a user-defined widget.

                     With the options -n and -N, the current numerical argument will be saved and
                     then restored after the call to widget; `-n num' sets the numerical argument
                     temporarily to num, while `-N' sets it to the default, i.e. as if there were
                     none.

                     With  the  option  -K,  keymap will be used as the current keymap during the
                     execution of the widget.  The previous keymap will be restored when the wid‐
                     get exits.

                     Normally,  calling  a  widget in this way does not set the special parameter
                     WIDGET and related parameters, so that the environment  appears  as  if  the
                     top-level  widget called by the user were still active.  With the option -w,
                     WIDGET and related parameters are set to reflect the widget  being  executed
                     by the zle call.

                     Any  further  arguments  will be passed to the widget; note that as standard
                     argument handling is performed, any general argument list should be preceded
                     by  --.   If  it  is  a  shell function, these are passed down as positional
                     parameters; for builtin widgets it is up to the widget in question  what  it
                     does  with  them.   Currently  arguments  are  only handled by the incremen‐
                     tal-search commands, the history-search-forward and -backward and the corre‐
                     sponding  functions prefixed by vi-, and by universal-argument.  No error is
                     flagged if the command does not use the arguments,  or  only  uses  some  of
                     them.

                     The  return  status reflects the success or failure of the operation carried
                     out by the widget, or if it is a user-defined widget the  return  status  of
                     the shell function.

                     A  non-zero  return  status  causes the shell to beep when the widget exits,
                     unless the BEEP options was unset or the widget was called via the zle  com‐
                     mand.   Thus  if a user defined widget requires an immediate beep, it should
                     call the beep widget directly.

WIDGETS
       All actions in the editor are performed by `widgets'.  A widget's job is simply to perform
       some  small  action.   The  ZLE commands that key sequences in keymaps are bound to are in
       fact widgets.  Widgets can be user-defined or built in.

       The standard widgets built into ZLE are listed in Standard Widgets below.  Other  built-in
       widgets can be defined by other modules (see zshmodules(1)).  Each built-in widget has two
       names: its normal canonical name, and the same name preceded by a `.'.  The  `.'  name  is
       special:  it can't be rebound to a different widget.  This makes the widget available even
       when its usual name has been redefined.

       User-defined widgets are defined using `zle -N', and implemented as shell functions.  When
       the  widget  is  executed,  the  corresponding shell function is executed, and can perform
       editing (or other) actions.  It is recommended that user-defined widgets should  not  have
       names starting with `.'.

USER-DEFINED WIDGETS
       User-defined  widgets,  being implemented as shell functions, can execute any normal shell
       command.  They can also run other widgets (whether built-in or user-defined) using the zle
       builtin  command.   The  standard input of the function is closed to prevent external com‐
       mands from unintentionally blocking ZLE by reading from the terminal, but read -k or  read
       -q  can  be  used  to  read characters.  Finally, they can examine and edit the ZLE buffer
       being edited by reading and setting the special parameters described below.

       These special parameters are always available in widget functions, but are not in any  way
       special  outside ZLE.  If they have some normal value outside ZLE, that value is temporar‐
       ily inaccessible, but will return when the widget function exits.  These  special  parame‐
       ters in fact have local scope, like parameters created in a function using local.

       Inside  completion  widgets  and  traps  called  while ZLE is active, these parameters are
       available read-only.

       BUFFER (scalar)
              The entire contents of the edit buffer.  If it is written to, the cursor remains at
              the same offset, unless that would put it outside the buffer.

       BUFFERLINES (integer)
              The number of screen lines needed for the edit buffer currently displayed on screen
              (i.e. without any changes to the preceding parameters done after  the  last  redis‐
              play); read-only.

       CONTEXT (scalar)
              The context in which zle was called to read a line; read-only.  One of the values:

              start  The start of a command line (at prompt PS1).

              cont   A continuation to a command line (at prompt PS2).

              select In a select loop.

              vared  Editing a variable in vared.

       CURSOR (integer)
              The offset of the cursor, within the edit buffer.  This is in the range 0 to $#BUF‐
              FER, and is by definition equal to $#LBUFFER.  Attempts to move the cursor  outside
              the buffer will result in the cursor being moved to the appropriate end of the buf‐
              fer.

       CUTBUFFER (scalar)
              The last item cut using one of the `kill-' commands; the string which the next yank
              would  insert  in  the line.  Later entries in the kill ring are in the array kill‐
              ring.  Note that the command `zle copy-region-as-kill string' can be  used  to  set
              the  text  of  the  cut buffer from a shell function and cycle the kill ring in the
              same way as interactively killing text.

       HISTNO (integer)
              The current history number.  Setting this has the same effect as moving up or  down
              in  the history to the corresponding history line.  An attempt to set it is ignored
              if the line is not stored in the history.  Note this is not the same as the parame‐
              ter  HISTCMD,  which always gives the number of the history line being added to the
              main shell's history.  HISTNO refers to the line being retrieved within zle.

       KEYMAP (scalar)
              The name of the currently selected keymap; read-only.

       KEYS (scalar)
              The keys typed to invoke this widget, as a literal string; read-only.

       killring (array)
              The array of previously killed items, with the most recently  killed  first.   This
              gives  the  items  that  would be retrieved by a yank-pop in the same order.  Note,
              however, that the most recently killed item is in $CUTBUFFER; $killring  shows  the
              array of previous entries.

              The  default  size for the kill ring is eight, however the length may be changed by
              normal array operations.  Any empty string in the  kill  ring  is  ignored  by  the
              yank-pop  command,  hence the size of the array effectively sets the maximum length
              of the kill ring, while the number of non-zero strings gives  the  current  length,
              both as seen by the user at the command line.

       LASTABORTEDSEARCH (scalar)
              The  last  search string used by an interactive search that was aborted by the user
              (status 3 returned by the search widget).

       LASTSEARCH (scalar)
              The last search string used by an interactive search; read-only.  This is set  even
              if  the  search failed (status 0, 1 or 2 returned by the search widget), but not if
              it was aborted by the user.

       LASTWIDGET (scalar)
              The name of the last widget that was executed; read-only.

       LBUFFER (scalar)
              The part of the buffer that lies to the left of the  cursor  position.   If  it  is
              assigned  to,  only  that  part  of  the buffer is replaced, and the cursor remains
              between the new $LBUFFER and the old $RBUFFER.

       MARK (integer)
              Like CURSOR, but for the mark.

       NUMERIC (integer)
              The numeric argument. If no numeric argument was given, this  parameter  is  unset.
              When  this  is  set  inside  a widget function, builtin widgets called with the zle
              builtin command will use the value assigned. If it is unset inside a  widget  func‐
              tion, builtin widgets called behave as if no numeric argument was given.

       PENDING (integer)
              The  number of bytes pending for input, i.e. the number of bytes which have already
              been typed and can immediately be read. On systems where the shell is not  able  to
              get this information, this parameter will always have a value of zero.  Read-only.

       PREBUFFER (scalar)
              In  a  multi-line  input at the secondary prompt, this read-only parameter contains
              the contents of the lines before the one the cursor is currently in.

       PREDISPLAY (scalar)
              Text to be displayed before the start of the editable text buffer.  This  does  not
              have  to be a complete line; to display a complete line, a newline must be appended
              explicitly.  The text is reset on each new invocation (but  not  recursive  invoca‐
              tion) of zle.

       POSTDISPLAY (scalar)
              Text to be displayed after the end of the editable text buffer.  This does not have
              to be a complete line; to display a complete line,  a  newline  must  be  prepended
              explicitly.   The  text  is reset on each new invocation (but not recursive invoca‐
              tion) of zle.

       RBUFFER (scalar)
              The part of the buffer that lies to the right of the cursor  position.   If  it  is
              assigned  to,  only  that  part  of  the buffer is replaced, and the cursor remains
              between the old $LBUFFER and the new $RBUFFER.

       REGION_ACTIVE (integer)
              Indicates if the region is currently active.  It can be assigned 0 or 1 to  deacti‐
              vate and activate the region respectively; see Character Highlighting below.

       region_highlight (array)
              Each  element  of this array may be set to a string that describes highlighting for
              an arbitrary region of the command line that will take effect  the  next  time  the
              command line is redisplayed.  Highlighting of the non-editable parts of the command
              line in PREDISPLAY and POSTDISPLAY are possible, but note that the P flag is needed
              for character indexing to include PREDISPLAY.

              Each string consists of the following parts:

              ·      Optionally,  a  `P'  to  signify  that  the start and end offset that follow
                     include any string set by the PREDISPLAY special parameter; this  is  needed
                     if the predisplay string itself is to be highlighted.  Whitespace may follow
                     the `P'.

              ·      A start offset in the same units as CURSOR, terminated by whitespace.

              ·      An end offset in the same units as CURSOR, terminated by whitespace.

              ·      A highlight specification in the same format as used  for  contexts  in  the
                     parameter  zle_highlight,  see  Character  Highlighting  below; for example,
                     standout or fg=red,bold

              For example,

                     region_highlight=("P0 20 bold")

              specifies that the first twenty characters of the  text  including  any  predisplay
              string should be highlighted in bold.

              Note that the effect of region_highlight is not saved and disappears as soon as the
              line is accepted.

       UNDO_CHANGE_NO (integer)
              A number representing the state of the undo history.  The only use of this is pass‐
              ing  as an argument to the undo widget in order to undo back to the recorded point.
              Read-only.

       WIDGET (scalar)
              The name of the widget currently being executed; read-only.

       WIDGETFUNC (scalar)
              The name of the shell function that implements a widget defined with either zle  -N
              or  zle  -C.  In the former case, this is the second argument to the zle -N command
              that defined the widget, or the first argument if there was no second argument.  In
              the  latter  case this is the third argument to the zle -C command that defined the
              widget.  Read-only.

       WIDGETSTYLE (scalar)
              Describes the implementation behind the completion widget currently being executed;
              the  second argument that followed zle -C when the widget was defined.  This is the
              name of a builtin completion widget.  For widgets defined with zle -N this  is  set
              to the empty string.  Read-only.

       ZLE_STATE (scalar)
              Contains a set of space-separated words that describe the current zle state.

              Currently,  the  states  shown  are the insert mode as set by the overwrite-mode or
              vi-replace widgets and whether history commands will visit imported entries as con‐
              trolled  by  the set-local-history widget.  The string contains `insert' if charac‐
              ters to be inserted on the command line move existing characters to  the  right  or
              `overwrite' if characters to be inserted overwrite existing characters. It contains
              `localhistory' if only local history commands will be visited or `globalhistory' if
              imported history commands will also be visited.

              The substrings are sorted in alphabetical order so that if you want to test for two
              specific substrings in a future-proof way, you can do match by doing:

                     if [[ $ZLE_STATE == *insert*globalhistory* ]]; then ...; fi

   Special Widgets
       There are a few user-defined widgets which are special to  the  shell.   If  they  do  not
       exist,  no special action is taken.  The environment provided is identical to that for any
       other editing widget.

       zle-isearch-exit
              Executed at the end of incremental search at the point where the isearch prompt  is
              removed from the display.  See zle-isearch-update for an example.

       zle-isearch-update
              Executed  within incremental search when the display is about to be redrawn.  Addi‐
              tional output below the incremental search prompt can be generated  by  using  `zle
              -M' within the widget.  For example,

                     zle-isearch-update() { zle -M "Line $HISTNO"; }
                     zle -N zle-isearch-update

              Note  the  line  output by `zle -M' is not deleted on exit from incremental search.
              This can be done from a zle-isearch-exit widget:

                     zle-isearch-exit() { zle -M ""; }
                     zle -N zle-isearch-exit

       zle-line-init
              Executed every time the line editor is started to read a new line  of  input.   The
              following example puts the line editor into vi command mode when it starts up.

                     zle-line-init() { zle -K vicmd; }
                     zle -N zle-line-init

              (The  command inside the function sets the keymap directly; it is equivalent to zle
              vi-cmd-mode.)

       zle-line-finish
              This is similar to zle-line-init but is executed every time  the  line  editor  has
              finished reading a line of input.

       zle-history-line-set
              Executed when the history line changes.

       zle-keymap-select
              Executed every time the keymap changes, i.e. the special parameter KEYMAP is set to
              a different value, while the line editor is active.  Initialising the  keymap  when
              the line editor starts does not cause the widget to be called.

              The  value  $KEYMAP within the function reflects the new keymap.  The old keymap is
              passed as the sole argument.

              This can be used for detecting switches between the vi command (vicmd)  and  insert
              (usually main) keymaps.

STANDARD WIDGETS
       The  following  is a list of all the standard widgets, and their default bindings in emacs
       mode, vi command mode and vi insert  mode  (the  `emacs',  `vicmd'  and  `viins'  keymaps,
       respectively).

       Note  that  cursor keys are bound to movement keys in all three keymaps; the shell assumes
       that the cursor keys send the key sequences  reported  by  the  terminal-handling  library
       (termcap  or terminfo).  The key sequences shown in the list are those based on the VT100,
       common on many modern terminals, but in fact these are not necessarily bound.  In the case
       of  the  viins keymap, the initial escape character of the sequences serves also to return
       to the vicmd keymap: whether this happens is determined by the KEYTIMEOUT  parameter,  see
       zshparam(1).

   Movement
       vi-backward-blank-word (unbound) (B) (unbound)
              Move  backward  one  word, where a word is defined as a series of non-blank charac‐
              ters.

       backward-char (^B ESC-[D) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move backward one character.

       vi-backward-char (unbound) (^H h ^?) (ESC-[D)
              Move backward one character, without changing lines.

       backward-word (ESC-B ESC-b) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move to the beginning of the previous word.

       emacs-backward-word
              Move to the beginning of the previous word.

       vi-backward-word (unbound) (b) (unbound)
              Move to the beginning of the previous word, vi-style.

       beginning-of-line (^A) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move to the beginning of the line.  If already at the beginning of the  line,  move
              to the beginning of the previous line, if any.

       vi-beginning-of-line
              Move to the beginning of the line, without changing lines.

       end-of-line (^E) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move to the end of the line.  If already at the end of the line, move to the end of
              the next line, if any.

       vi-end-of-line (unbound) ($) (unbound)
              Move to the end of the line.  If an argument is given to this command,  the  cursor
              will be moved to the end of the line (argument - 1) lines down.

       vi-forward-blank-word (unbound) (W) (unbound)
              Move forward one word, where a word is defined as a series of non-blank characters.

       vi-forward-blank-word-end (unbound) (E) (unbound)
              Move  to the end of the current word, or, if at the end of the current word, to the
              end of the next word, where a word is defined as a series of non-blank characters.

       forward-char (^F ESC-[C) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move forward one character.

       vi-forward-char (unbound) (space l) (ESC-[C)
              Move forward one character.

       vi-find-next-char (^X^F) (f) (unbound)
              Read a character from the keyboard, and move to the next occurrence of  it  in  the
              line.

       vi-find-next-char-skip (unbound) (t) (unbound)
              Read  a  character from the keyboard, and move to the position just before the next
              occurrence of it in the line.

       vi-find-prev-char (unbound) (F) (unbound)
              Read a character from the keyboard, and move to the previous occurrence  of  it  in
              the line.

       vi-find-prev-char-skip (unbound) (T) (unbound)
              Read  a character from the keyboard, and move to the position just after the previ‐
              ous occurrence of it in the line.

       vi-first-non-blank (unbound) (^) (unbound)
              Move to the first non-blank character in the line.

       vi-forward-word (unbound) (w) (unbound)
              Move forward one word, vi-style.

       forward-word (ESC-F ESC-f) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move to the beginning of the next word.  The editor's idea of a word  is  specified
              with the WORDCHARS parameter.

       emacs-forward-word
              Move to the end of the next word.

       vi-forward-word-end (unbound) (e) (unbound)
              Move to the end of the next word.

       vi-goto-column (ESC-|) (|) (unbound)
              Move to the column specified by the numeric argument.

       vi-goto-mark (unbound) (`) (unbound)
              Move to the specified mark.

       vi-goto-mark-line (unbound) (') (unbound)
              Move to beginning of the line containing the specified mark.

       vi-repeat-find (unbound) (;) (unbound)
              Repeat the last vi-find command.

       vi-rev-repeat-find (unbound) (,) (unbound)
              Repeat the last vi-find command in the opposite direction.

   History Control
       beginning-of-buffer-or-history (ESC-<) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move  to  the beginning of the buffer, or if already there, move to the first event
              in the history list.

       beginning-of-line-hist
              Move to the beginning of the line.  If already at the beginning of the buffer, move
              to the previous history line.

       beginning-of-history
              Move to the first event in the history list.

       down-line-or-history (^N ESC-[B) (j) (ESC-[B)
              Move  down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line, move to the next
              event in the history list.

       vi-down-line-or-history (unbound) (+) (unbound)
              Move down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line, move to the  next
              event in the history list.  Then move to the first non-blank character on the line.

       down-line-or-search
              Move down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line, search forward in
              the history for a line beginning with the first word in the buffer.

              If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument  is
              taken as the string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.

       down-history (unbound) (^N) (unbound)
              Move to the next event in the history list.

       history-beginning-search-backward
              Search backward in the history for a line beginning with the current line up to the
              cursor.  This leaves the cursor in its original position.

       end-of-buffer-or-history (ESC->) (unbound) (unbound)
              Move to the end of the buffer, or if already there, move to the last event  in  the
              history list.

       end-of-line-hist
              Move to the end of the line.  If already at the end of the buffer, move to the next
              history line.

       end-of-history
              Move to the last event in the history list.

       vi-fetch-history (unbound) (G) (unbound)
              Fetch the history line specified by the numeric argument.   This  defaults  to  the
              current history line (i.e. the one that isn't history yet).

       history-incremental-search-backward (^R ^Xr) (unbound) (unbound)
              Search  backward incrementally for a specified string.  The search is case-insensi‐
              tive if the search string does not have uppercase letters and no  numeric  argument
              was  given.  The string may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of
              the line.  When called from a user-defined function returns the following statuses:
              0,  if  the  search succeeded; 1, if the search failed; 2, if the search term was a
              bad pattern; 3, if the search was aborted by the send-break command.

              A restricted set of editing functions is available in the  mini-buffer.   Keys  are
              looked  up in the special isearch keymap, and if not found there in the main keymap
              (note that by default the isearch  keymap  is  empty).   An  interrupt  signal,  as
              defined by the stty setting, will stop the search and go back to the original line.
              An undefined key will have the same effect.  Note that the following always perform
              the  same  task  within incremental searches and cannot be replaced by user defined
              widgets, nor can the set of functions be extended.  The supported functions are:

              accept-and-hold
              accept-and-infer-next-history
              accept-line
              accept-line-and-down-history
                     Perform the usual function after exiting incremental  search.   The  command
                     line displayed is executed.

              backward-delete-char
              vi-backward-delete-char
                     Back  up  one  place in the search history.  If the search has been repeated
                     this does not immediately erase a character in the minibuffer.

              accept-search
                     Exit incremental search, retaining the command line but performing  no  fur‐
                     ther  action.   Note  that  this function is not bound by default and has no
                     effect outside incremental search.

              backward-delete-word
              backward-kill-word
              vi-backward-kill-word
                     Back up one character in the minibuffer; if multiple searches have been per‐
                     formed since the character was inserted the search history is rewound to the
                     point just before the character was entered.  Hence this has the  effect  of
                     repeating backward-delete-char.

              clear-screen
                     Clear the screen, remaining in incremental search mode.

              history-incremental-search-backward
                     Find the next occurrence of the contents of the mini-buffer.

              history-incremental-search-forward
                     Invert the sense of the search.

              magic-space
                     Inserts a non-magical space.

              quoted-insert
              vi-quoted-insert
                     Quote the character to insert into the minibuffer.

              redisplay
                     Redisplay the command line, remaining in incremental search mode.

              vi-cmd-mode
                     Select  the `vicmd' keymap; the `main' keymap (insert mode) will be selected
                     initially.

                     In addition, the modifications that were made while in vi  insert  mode  are
                     merged to form a single undo event.

              vi-repeat-search
              vi-rev-repeat-search
                     Repeat  the  search.   The  direction  of  the  search  is  indicated in the
                     mini-buffer.

              Any character that is not bound to one of the above functions,  or  self-insert  or
              self-insert-unmeta, will cause the mode to be exited.  The character is then looked
              up and executed in the keymap in effect at that point.

              When called from a widget function by the zle command, the incremental search  com‐
              mands can take a string argument.  This will be treated as a string of keys, as for
              arguments to the bindkey command, and used as initial input for the  command.   Any
              characters  in  the  string  which  are  unused  by  the incremental search will be
              silently ignored.  For example,

                     zle history-incremental-search-backward forceps

              will search backwards for forceps, leaving the  minibuffer  containing  the  string
              `forceps'.

       history-incremental-search-forward (^S ^Xs) (unbound) (unbound)
              Search  forward  incrementally for a specified string.  The search is case-insensi‐
              tive if the search string does not have uppercase letters and no  numeric  argument
              was  given.  The string may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of
              the line.  The functions available in the mini-buffer are  the  same  as  for  his‐
              tory-incremental-search-backward.

       history-incremental-pattern-search-backward
       history-incremental-pattern-search-forward
              These  widgets  behave similarly to the corresponding widgets with no -pattern, but
              the search string typed by the user is treated as a pattern, respecting the current
              settings  of  the various options affecting pattern matching.  See FILENAME GENERA‐
              TION in zshexpn(1) for a description of patterns.  If no numeric argument was given
              lowercase  letters in the search string may match uppercase letters in the history.
              The string may begin with `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of the line.

              The prompt changes to indicate an invalid pattern; this  may  simply  indicate  the
              pattern is not yet complete.

              Note  that  only  non-overlapping matches are reported, so an expression with wild‐
              cards may return fewer matches on a line than are visible by inspection.

       history-search-backward (ESC-P ESC-p) (unbound) (unbound)
              Search backward in the history for a line beginning with the first word in the buf‐
              fer.

              If  called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument is
              taken as the string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.

       vi-history-search-backward (unbound) (/) (unbound)
              Search backward in the history for a specified string.  The string may  begin  with
              `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of the line.

              A  restricted  set of editing functions is available in the mini-buffer.  An inter‐
              rupt signal, as defined by the stty setting,  will stop the search.  The  functions
              available  in  the  mini-buffer  are:  accept-line,  backward-delete-char, vi-back‐
              ward-delete-char, backward-kill-word, vi-backward-kill-word,  clear-screen,  redis‐
              play, quoted-insert and vi-quoted-insert.

              vi-cmd-mode  is  treated  the  same as accept-line, and magic-space is treated as a
              space.  Any other character that is not bound to self-insert or  self-insert-unmeta
              will beep and be ignored. If the function is called from vi command mode, the bind‐
              ings of the current insert mode will be used.

              If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument  is
              taken as the string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.

       history-search-forward (ESC-N ESC-n) (unbound) (unbound)
              Search  forward in the history for a line beginning with the first word in the buf‐
              fer.

              If called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument  is
              taken as the string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.

       vi-history-search-forward (unbound) (?) (unbound)
              Search  forward  in  the history for a specified string.  The string may begin with
              `^' to anchor the search to the beginning of the line. The functions  available  in
              the  mini-buffer are the same as for vi-history-search-backward.  Argument handling
              is also the same as for that command.

       infer-next-history (^X^N) (unbound) (unbound)
              Search in the history list for a line matching the current one and fetch the  event
              following it.

       insert-last-word (ESC-_ ESC-.) (unbound) (unbound)
              Insert  the last word from the previous history event at the cursor position.  If a
              positive numeric argument is given, insert that word from the end of  the  previous
              history  event.  If the argument is zero or negative insert that word from the left
              (zero inserts the previous command word).  Repeating this command replaces the word
              just inserted with the last word from the history event prior to the one just used;
              numeric arguments can be used in the same way to pick a word from that event.

              When called from a shell function invoked from a user-defined widget,  the  command
              can  take  one  to  three arguments.  The first argument specifies a history offset
              which applies to successive calls to this widget: if it is -1, the  default  behav‐
              iour  is  used,  while  if it is 1, successive calls will move forwards through the
              history.  The value 0 can be used to indicate that the history line examined by the
              previous  execution  of the command will be reexamined.  Note that negative numbers
              should be preceded by a `--' argument to avoid confusing them with options.

              If two arguments are given, the second specifies the word on the  command  line  in
              normal array index notation (as a more natural alternative to the prefix argument).
              Hence 1 is the first word, and -1 (the default) is the last word.

              If a third argument is given, its value is ignored, but it is used to signify  that
              the  history  offset  is  relative to the current history line, rather than the one
              remembered after the previous invocations of insert-last-word.

              For example, the default behaviour of the command corresponds to

                     zle insert-last-word -- -1 -1

              while the command

                     zle insert-last-word -- -1 1 -

              always copies the first word of the line in the history immediately before the line
              being  edited.   This has the side effect that later invocations of the widget will
              be relative to that line.

       vi-repeat-search (unbound) (n) (unbound)
              Repeat the last vi history search.

       vi-rev-repeat-search (unbound) (N) (unbound)
              Repeat the last vi history search, but in reverse.

       up-line-or-history (^P ESC-[A) (k) (ESC-[A)
              Move up a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line, move to  the  previous
              event in the history list.

       vi-up-line-or-history (unbound) (-) (unbound)
              Move  up  a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line, move to the previous
              event in the history list.  Then move to the first non-blank character on the line.

       up-line-or-search
              Move up a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line, search backward in the
              history for a line beginning with the first word in the buffer.

              If  called from a function by the zle command with arguments, the first argument is
              taken as the string for which to search, rather than the first word in the buffer.

       up-history (unbound) (^P) (unbound)
              Move to the previous event in the history list.

       history-beginning-search-forward
              Search forward in the history for a line beginning with the current line up to  the
              cursor.  This leaves the cursor in its original position.

       set-local-history
              By default, history movement commands visit the imported lines as well as the local
              lines. This widget lets you toggle this on and off, or  set  it  with  the  numeric
              argument. Zero for both local and imported lines and nonzero for only local lines.

   Modifying Text
       vi-add-eol (unbound) (A) (unbound)
              Move to the end of the line and enter insert mode.

       vi-add-next (unbound) (a) (unbound)
              Enter insert mode after the current cursor position, without changing lines.

       backward-delete-char (^H ^?) (unbound) (unbound)
              Delete the character behind the cursor.

       vi-backward-delete-char (unbound) (X) (^H)
              Delete the character behind the cursor, without changing lines.  If in insert mode,
              this won't delete past the point where insert mode was last entered.

       backward-delete-word
              Delete the word behind the cursor.

       backward-kill-line
              Kill from the beginning of the line to the cursor position.

       backward-kill-word (^W ESC-^H ESC-^?) (unbound) (unbound)
              Kill the word behind the cursor.

       vi-backward-kill-word (unbound) (unbound) (^W)
              Kill the word behind the cursor, without going past the point where insert mode was
              last entered.

       capitalize-word (ESC-C ESC-c) (unbound) (unbound)
              Capitalize the current word and move past it.

       vi-change (unbound) (c) (unbound)
              Read a movement command from the keyboard, and kill from the cursor position to the
              endpoint of the movement.  Then enter insert mode.  If the  command  is  vi-change,
              change the current line.

       vi-change-eol (unbound) (C) (unbound)
              Kill to the end of the line and enter insert mode.

       vi-change-whole-line (unbound) (S) (unbound)
              Kill the current line and enter insert mode.

       copy-region-as-kill (ESC-W ESC-w) (unbound) (unbound)
              Copy the area from the cursor to the mark to the kill buffer.

              If  called  from a ZLE widget function in the form `zle copy-region-as-kill string'
              then string will be taken as the text to copy to the kill buffer.  The cursor,  the
              mark and the text on the command line are not used in this case.

       copy-prev-word (ESC-^_) (unbound) (unbound)
              Duplicate the word to the left of the cursor.

       copy-prev-shell-word
              Like  copy-prev-word,  but  the  word  is  found  by  using  shell parsing, whereas
              copy-prev-word looks for blanks. This makes a difference when the  word  is  quoted
              and contains spaces.

       vi-delete (unbound) (d) (unbound)
              Read a movement command from the keyboard, and kill from the cursor position to the
              endpoint of the movement.  If the command is vi-delete, kill the current line.

       delete-char
              Delete the character under the cursor.

       vi-delete-char (unbound) (x) (unbound)
              Delete the character under the cursor, without going past the end of the line.

       delete-word
              Delete the current word.

       down-case-word (ESC-L ESC-l) (unbound) (unbound)
              Convert the current word to all lowercase and move past it.

       kill-word (ESC-D ESC-d) (unbound) (unbound)
              Kill the current word.

       gosmacs-transpose-chars
              Exchange the two characters behind the cursor.

       vi-indent (unbound) (>) (unbound)
              Indent a number of lines.

       vi-insert (unbound) (i) (unbound)
              Enter insert mode.

       vi-insert-bol (unbound) (I) (unbound)
              Move to the first non-blank character on the line and enter insert mode.

       vi-join (^X^J) (J) (unbound)
              Join the current line with the next one.

       kill-line (^K) (unbound) (unbound)
              Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.  If already on the end  of  the  line,
              kill the newline character.

       vi-kill-line (unbound) (unbound) (^U)
              Kill from the cursor back to wherever insert mode was last entered.

       vi-kill-eol (unbound) (D) (unbound)
              Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.

       kill-region
              Kill from the cursor to the mark.

       kill-buffer (^X^K) (unbound) (unbound)
              Kill the entire buffer.

       kill-whole-line (^U) (unbound) (unbound)
              Kill the current line.

       vi-match-bracket (^X^B) (%) (unbound)
              Move  to the bracket character (one of {}, () or []) that matches the one under the
              cursor.  If the cursor is not on a bracket character, move  forward  without  going
              past the end of the line to find one, and then go to the matching bracket.

       vi-open-line-above (unbound) (O) (unbound)
              Open a line above the cursor and enter insert mode.

       vi-open-line-below (unbound) (o) (unbound)
              Open a line below the cursor and enter insert mode.

       vi-oper-swap-case
              Read a movement command from the keyboard, and swap the case of all characters from
              the cursor position to the endpoint of the movement.  If the  movement  command  is
              vi-oper-swap-case, swap the case of all characters on the current line.

       overwrite-mode (^X^O) (unbound) (unbound)
              Toggle between overwrite mode and insert mode.

       vi-put-before (unbound) (P) (unbound)
              Insert  the contents of the kill buffer before the cursor.  If the kill buffer con‐
              tains a sequence of lines (as opposed to characters), paste it  above  the  current
              line.

       vi-put-after (unbound) (p) (unbound)
              Insert  the  contents of the kill buffer after the cursor.  If the kill buffer con‐
              tains a sequence of lines (as opposed to characters), paste it  below  the  current
              line.

       quoted-insert (^V) (unbound) (unbound)
              Insert  the next character typed into the buffer literally.  An interrupt character
              will not be inserted.

       vi-quoted-insert (unbound) (unbound) (^Q ^V)
              Display a `^' at the cursor position, and insert the next character typed into  the
              buffer literally.  An interrupt character will not be inserted.

       quote-line (ESC-') (unbound) (unbound)
              Quote  the current line; that is, put a `'' character at the beginning and the end,
              and convert all `'' characters to `'\'''.

       quote-region (ESC-") (unbound) (unbound)
              Quote the region from the cursor to the mark.

       vi-replace (unbound) (R) (unbound)
              Enter overwrite mode.

       vi-repeat-change (unbound) (.) (unbound)
              Repeat the last vi mode text modification.  If a count was used with the  modifica‐
              tion,  it  is  remembered.   If  a count is given to this command, it overrides the
              remembered count, and is remembered for future uses of this command.  The cut  buf‐
              fer specification is similarly remembered.

       vi-replace-chars (unbound) (r) (unbound)
              Replace the character under the cursor with a character read from the keyboard.

       self-insert  (printable characters) (unbound) (printable characters and some control char‐
       acters)
              Insert a character into the buffer at the cursor position.

       self-insert-unmeta (ESC-^I ESC-^J ESC-^M) (unbound) (unbound)
              Insert a character into the buffer after stripping the meta bit and  converting  ^M
              to ^J.

       vi-substitute (unbound) (s) (unbound)
              Substitute the next character(s).

       vi-swap-case (unbound) (~) (unbound)
              Swap the case of the character under the cursor and move past it.

       transpose-chars (^T) (unbound) (unbound)
              Exchange  the  two  characters  to  the  left of the cursor if at end of line, else
              exchange the character under the cursor with the character to the left.

       transpose-words (ESC-T ESC-t) (unbound) (unbound)
              Exchange the current word with the one before it.

       vi-unindent (unbound) (<) (unbound)
              Unindent a number of lines.

       up-case-word (ESC-U ESC-u) (unbound) (unbound)
              Convert the current word to all caps and move past it.

       yank (^Y) (unbound) (unbound)
              Insert the contents of the kill buffer at the cursor position.

       yank-pop (ESC-y) (unbound) (unbound)
              Remove the text just yanked, rotate the kill-ring (the history of previously killed
              text) and yank the new top.  Only works following yank or yank-pop.

       vi-yank (unbound) (y) (unbound)
              Read  a  movement  command  from  the keyboard, and copy the region from the cursor
              position to the endpoint of the movement into the kill buffer.  If the  command  is
              vi-yank, copy the current line.

       vi-yank-whole-line (unbound) (Y) (unbound)
              Copy the current line into the kill buffer.

       vi-yank-eol
              Copy  the region from the cursor position to the end of the line into the kill buf‐
              fer.  Arguably, this is what Y should do in vi, but it isn't what it actually does.

   Arguments
       digit-argument (ESC-0..ESC-9) (1-9) (unbound)
              Start  a  new  numeric  argument,  or  add  to   the   current   one.    See   also
              vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line.   This  only works if bound to a key sequence ending
              in a decimal digit.

              Inside a widget function, a call to this function treats the last key  of  the  key
              sequence which called the widget as the digit.

       neg-argument (ESC--) (unbound) (unbound)
              Changes the sign of the following argument.

       universal-argument
              Multiply  the argument of the next command by 4.  Alternatively, if this command is
              followed by an integer (positive or negative), use that as  the  argument  for  the
              next  command.  Thus digits cannot be repeated using this command.  For example, if
              this command occurs twice, followed immediately by forward-char, move forward  six‐
              teen  spaces; if instead it is followed by -2, then forward-char, move backward two
              spaces.

              Inside a widget function, if passed an argument, i.e. `zle universal-argument num',
              the numerical argument will be set to num; this is equivalent to `NUMERIC=num'.

       argument-base
              Use  the  existing numeric argument as a numeric base, which must be in the range 2
              to 36 inclusive.  Subsequent use  of  digit-argument  and  universal-argument  will
              input  a  new  prefix in the given base.  The usual hexadecimal convention is used:
              the letter a or A corresponds to 10, and so on.  Arguments in bases requiring  dig‐
              its  from  10  upwards  are  more conveniently input with universal-argument, since
              ESC-a etc. are not usually bound to digit-argument.

              The function can be used with a command argument inside a user-defined widget.  The
              following  code  sets the base to 16 and lets the user input a hexadecimal argument
              until a key out of the digit range is typed:

                     zle argument-base 16
                     zle universal-argument

   Completion
       accept-and-menu-complete
              In a menu completion, insert the current completion into the buffer, and advance to
              the next possible completion.

       complete-word
              Attempt completion on the current word.

       delete-char-or-list (^D) (unbound) (unbound)
              Delete  the  character  under the cursor.  If the cursor is at the end of the line,
              list possible completions for the current word.

       expand-cmd-path
              Expand the current command to its full pathname.

       expand-or-complete (TAB) (unbound) (TAB)
              Attempt shell expansion on the current word.  If that fails, attempt completion.

       expand-or-complete-prefix
              Attempt shell expansion on the current word up to cursor.

       expand-history (ESC-space ESC-!) (unbound) (unbound)
              Perform history expansion on the edit buffer.

       expand-word (^X*) (unbound) (unbound)
              Attempt shell expansion on the current word.

       list-choices (ESC-^D) (^D =) (^D)
              List possible completions for the current word.

       list-expand (^Xg ^XG) (^G) (^G)
              List the expansion of the current word.

       magic-space
              Perform history expansion and insert a space into the buffer.  This is intended  to
              be bound to space.

       menu-complete
              Like  complete-word,  except  that  menu completion is used.  See the MENU_COMPLETE
              option.

       menu-expand-or-complete
              Like expand-or-complete, except that menu completion is used.

       reverse-menu-complete
              Perform menu completion, like menu-complete, except that if a  menu  completion  is
              already in progress, move to the previous completion rather than the next.

       end-of-list
              When  a  previous  completion displayed a list below the prompt, this widget can be
              used to move the prompt below the list.

   Miscellaneous
       accept-and-hold (ESC-A ESC-a) (unbound) (unbound)
              Push the contents of the buffer on the buffer stack and execute it.

       accept-and-infer-next-history
              Execute the contents of the buffer.  Then search the history list for a line match‐
              ing the current one and push the event following onto the buffer stack.

       accept-line (^J ^M) (^J ^M) (^J ^M)
              Finish  editing  the  buffer.   Normally this causes the buffer to be executed as a
              shell command.

       accept-line-and-down-history (^O) (unbound) (unbound)
              Execute the current line, and push the next history event on the buffer stack.

       auto-suffix-remove
              If the previous action added a suffix (space, slash, etc.) to the word on the  com‐
              mand  line,  remove it.  Otherwise do nothing.  Removing the suffix ends any active
              menu completion or menu selection.

              This widget is intended to be called from user-defined widgets to enforce a desired
              suffix-removal behavior.

       auto-suffix-retain
              If  the previous action added a suffix (space, slash, etc.) to the word on the com‐
              mand line, force it to be preserved.  Otherwise do nothing.  Retaining  the  suffix
              ends any active menu completion or menu selection.

              This widget is intended to be called from user-defined widgets to enforce a desired
              suffix-preservation behavior.

       beep   Beep, unless the BEEP option is unset.

       vi-cmd-mode (^X^V) (unbound) (^[)
              Enter command mode; that is, select the `vicmd' keymap.   Yes,  this  is  bound  by
              default in emacs mode.

       vi-caps-lock-panic
              Hang  until  any lowercase key is pressed.  This is for vi users without the mental
              capacity to keep track of their caps lock key (like the author).

       clear-screen (^L ESC-^L) (^L) (^L)
              Clear the screen and redraw the prompt.

       describe-key-briefly
              Reads a key sequence, then prints the function bound to that sequence.

       exchange-point-and-mark (^X^X) (unbound) (unbound)
              Exchange the cursor position (point) with the position of the mark.  Unless a nega‐
              tive  prefix  argument  is given, the region between point and mark is activated so
              that it can be highlighted.  If a zero prefix argument  is  given,  the  region  is
              activated but point and mark are not swapped.

       execute-named-cmd (ESC-x) (:) (unbound)
              Read  the  name  of  an editor command and execute it.  A restricted set of editing
              functions is available in the mini-buffer.  Keys are looked up in the special  com‐
              mand  keymap,  and  if not found there in the main keymap.  An interrupt signal, as
              defined by the stty setting, will abort the  function.   Note  that  the  following
              always  perform  the same task within the executed-named-cmd environment and cannot
              be replaced by user defined widgets, nor can the set of functions be extended.  The
              allowed functions are: backward-delete-char, vi-backward-delete-char, clear-screen,
              redisplay,   quoted-insert,    vi-quoted-insert,    backward-kill-word,    vi-back‐
              ward-kill-word,  kill-whole-line,  vi-kill-line,  backward-kill-line, list-choices,
              delete-char-or-list,    complete-word,    accept-line,    expand-or-complete    and
              expand-or-complete-prefix.

              kill-region   kills  the  last  word,  and  vi-cmd-mode  is  treated  the  same  as
              accept-line.  The space and tab characters, if not bound to one of these functions,
              will  complete  the name and then list the possibilities if the AUTO_LIST option is
              set.  Any other character that is not bound to  self-insert  or  self-insert-unmeta
              will beep and be ignored.  The bindings of the current insert mode will be used.

              Currently this command may not be redefined or called by name.

       execute-last-named-cmd (ESC-z) (unbound) (unbound)
              Redo the last function executed with execute-named-cmd.

              Currently this command may not be redefined or called by name.

       get-line (ESC-G ESC-g) (unbound) (unbound)
              Pop the top line off the buffer stack and insert it at the cursor position.

       pound-insert (unbound) (#) (unbound)
              If there is no # character at the beginning of the buffer, add one to the beginning
              of each line.  If there is one, remove a # from each line that has one.  In  either
              case,  accept  the  current  line.  The INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS option must be set for
              this to have any usefulness.

       vi-pound-insert
              If there is no # character at the beginning of the current line, add one.  If there
              is  one,  remove  it.  The INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS option must be set for this to have
              any usefulness.

       push-input
              Push the entire current multiline construct onto the buffer stack and return to the
              top-level  (PS1)  prompt.   If  the current parser construct is only a single line,
              this is exactly like push-line.  Next time the editor starts up or is  popped  with
              get-line,  the  construct will be popped off the top of the buffer stack and loaded
              into the editing buffer.

       push-line (^Q ESC-Q ESC-q) (unbound) (unbound)
              Push the current buffer onto the buffer stack and clear the buffer.  Next time  the
              editor  starts  up,  the  buffer will be popped off the top of the buffer stack and
              loaded into the editing buffer.

       push-line-or-edit
              At the top-level (PS1) prompt, equivalent  to  push-line.   At  a  secondary  (PS2)
              prompt,  move  the  entire current multiline construct into the editor buffer.  The
              latter is equivalent to push-input followed by get-line.

       read-command
              Only useful from a user-defined widget.  A keystroke is  read  just  as  in  normal
              operation,  but  instead of the command being executed the name of the command that
              would be executed is stored in the shell parameter REPLY.  This can be used as  the
              argument  of  a  future zle command.  If the key sequence is not bound, status 1 is
              returned; typically, however, REPLY is set to undefined-key to indicate  a  useless
              key sequence.

       recursive-edit
              Only  useful from a user-defined widget.  At this point in the function, the editor
              regains control until one of the standard widgets which would normally cause zle to
              exit  (typically  an  accept-line  caused  by  hitting the return key) is executed.
              Instead, control returns to  the  user-defined  widget.   The  status  returned  is
              non-zero  if  the  return  was caused by an error, but the function still continues
              executing and hence may tidy up.  This makes it safe for the user-defined widget to
              alter the command line or key bindings temporarily.

              The following widget, caps-lock, serves as an example.
                     self-insert-ucase() {
                       LBUFFER+=${(U)KEYS[-1]}
                     }

                     integer stat

                     zle -N self-insert self-insert-ucase
                     zle -A caps-lock save-caps-lock
                     zle -A accept-line caps-lock

                     zle recursive-edit
                     stat=$?

                     zle -A .self-insert self-insert
                     zle -A save-caps-lock caps-lock
                     zle -D save-caps-lock

                     (( stat )) && zle send-break

                     return $stat
              This causes typed letters to be inserted capitalised until either accept-line (i.e.
              typically the return key) is typed or the caps-lock widget is  invoked  again;  the
              later  is  handled  by saving the old definition of caps-lock as save-caps-lock and
              then rebinding it to invoke accept-line.  Note that an  error  from  the  recursive
              edit is detected as a non-zero return status and propagated by using the send-break
              widget.

       redisplay (unbound) (^R) (^R)
              Redisplays the edit buffer.

       reset-prompt (unbound) (unbound) (unbound)
              Force the prompts on both the left and right of the screen to be re-expanded,  then
              redisplay  the  edit  buffer.   This  reflects changes both to the prompt variables
              themselves and changes in the expansion of the values (for example, changes in time
              or directory, or changes to the value of variables referred to by the prompt).

              Otherwise,  the  prompt is only expanded each time zle starts, and when the display
              as been interrupted by output from another part of the shell (such as a job notifi‐
              cation) which causes the command line to be reprinted.

       send-break (^G ESC-^G) (unbound) (unbound)
              Abort  the  current  editor  function,  e.g.  execute-named-command,  or the editor
              itself, e.g. if you are in vared. Otherwise abort the parsing of the current  line;
              in this case the aborted line is available in the shell variable ZLE_LINE_ABORTED.

       run-help (ESC-H ESC-h) (unbound) (unbound)
              Push  the  buffer  onto  the  buffer stack, and execute the command `run-help cmd',
              where cmd is the current command.  run-help is normally aliased to man.

       vi-set-buffer (unbound) (") (unbound)
              Specify a buffer to be used in the following command.  There are  35  buffers  that
              can  be specified: the 26 `named' buffers "a to "z and the nine `queued' buffers "1
              to "9.  The named buffers can also be specified as "A to "Z.

              When a buffer is specified for a cut command, the text being cut replaces the  pre‐
              vious  contents  of  the  specified buffer.  If a named buffer is specified using a
              capital, the newly cut text is appended to the buffer instead of overwriting it.

              If no buffer is specified for a cut command, "1 is used, and the contents of "1  to
              "8 are each shifted along one buffer; the contents of "9 is lost.

       vi-set-mark (unbound) (m) (unbound)
              Set the specified mark at the cursor position.

       set-mark-command (^@) (unbound) (unbound)
              Set the mark at the cursor position.  If called with a negative prefix argument, do
              not set the mark but deactivate the region so that it is no longer highlighted  (it
              is still usable for other purposes).  Otherwise the region is marked as active.

       spell-word (ESC-$ ESC-S ESC-s) (unbound) (unbound)
              Attempt spelling correction on the current word.

       split-undo
              Breaks  the  undo  sequence  at  the  current change.  This is useful in vi mode as
              changes made in insert mode are coalesced on  entering  command  mode.   Similarly,
              undo will normally revert as one all the changes made by a user-defined widget.

       undefined-key
              This  command  is  executed when a key sequence that is not bound to any command is
              typed.  By default it beeps.

       undo (^_ ^Xu ^X^U) (unbound) (unbound)
              Incrementally undo the last text modification.  When  called  from  a  user-defined
              widget,  takes an optional argument indicating a previous state of the undo history
              as returned by the UNDO_CHANGE_NO variable; modifications  are  undone  until  that
              state is reached.

              Note  that  when invoked from vi command mode, the full prior change made in insert
              mode is reverted, the changes having been merged when command mode was selected.

       redo   Incrementally redo undone text modifications.

       vi-undo-change (unbound) (u) (unbound)
              Undo the last text modification.  If repeated, redo the modification.

       what-cursor-position (^X=) (unbound) (unbound)
              Print the character under the cursor, its code as an octal, decimal and hexadecimal
              number,  the current cursor position within the buffer and the column of the cursor
              in the current line.

       where-is
              Read the name of an editor command and print the  listing  of  key  sequences  that
              invoke  the  specified command.  A restricted set of editing functions is available
              in the mini-buffer.  Keys are looked up in the special command keymap, and  if  not
              found there in the main keymap.

       which-command (ESC-?) (unbound) (unbound)
              Push the buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute the command `which-command cmd'.
              where cmd is the current command.  which-command is normally aliased to whence.

       vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line (unbound) (0) (unbound)
              If the last command executed was a digit as part of an argument, continue the argu‐
              ment.  Otherwise, execute vi-beginning-of-line.

CHARACTER HIGHLIGHTING
       The line editor has the ability to highlight characters or regions of the line that have a
       particular significance.  This is controlled by the array parameter zle_highlight,  if  it
       has been set by the user.

       If  the parameter contains the single entry none all highlighting is turned off.  Note the
       parameter is still expected to be an array.

       Otherwise each entry of the array should consist of a word indicating a context for  high‐
       lighting,  then a colon, then a comma-separated list of the types of highlighting to apply
       in that context.

       The contexts available for highlighting are the following:

       default
              Any text within the command line not affected by any other highlighting.  Text out‐
              side the editable area of the command line is not affected.

       isearch
              When  one of the incremental history search widgets is active, the area of the com‐
              mand line matched by the search string or pattern.

       region The region between the cursor (point) and the mark as  set  with  set-mark-command.
              The  region is only highlighted if it is active, which is the case if set-mark-com‐
              mand or exchange-point-and-mark has been called and the line has  not  been  subse‐
              quently modified.  The region can be deactivated by calling set-mark-command with a
              negative prefix argument, or reactivated by calling exchange-point-and-mark with  a
              zero  prefix argument.  Note that whether or not the region is active has no effect
              on its use within widgets, it simply determines whether it is highlighted.

       special
              Individual characters that have no direct printable representation but are shown in
              a special manner by the line editor.  These characters are described below.

       suffix This  context is used in completion for characters that are marked as suffixes that
              will be removed if the completion ends at that  point,  the  most  obvious  example
              being  a  slash  (/)  after  a directory name.  Note that suffix removal is config‐
              urable; the circumstances under which the suffix will be  removed  may  differ  for
              different completions.

       zle_highlight  may  contain  additional  fields  for controlling how terminal sequences to
       change colours are output.  Each of the following is followed by a colon and a  string  in
       the  same  form  as for key bindings.  This will not be necessary for the vast majority of
       terminals as the defaults shown in parentheses are widely used.

       fg_start_code (\e[3)
              The start of the escape sequence for the foreground colour.  This is followed by an
              ASCII digit representing the colour.

       fg_default_code (9)
              The number to use instead of the colour to reset the default foreground colour.

       fg_end_code (m)
              The end of the escape sequence for the foreground colour.

       bg_start_code (\e[4)
              The start of the escape sequence for the background colour.  This is followed by an
              ASCII digit representing the colour.

       bg_default_code (9)
              The number to use instead of the colour to reset the default background colour.

       bg_end_code (m)
              The end of the escape sequence for the background colour.

       The available types of highlighting are the following.  Note that not all types  of  high‐
       lighting are available on all terminals:

       none   No  highlighting  is  applied  to  the given context.  It is not useful for this to
              appear with other types of highlighting; it is used to override a default.

       fg=colour
              The foreground colour should be set to colour, a decimal integer or the name of one
              of the eight most widely-supported colours.

              Not all terminals support this and, of those that do, not all provide facilities to
              test the support, hence the user should decide based on the  terminal  type.   Most
              terminals  support  the  colours black, red, green, yellow, blue, magenta, cyan and
              white, which can be set by name.  In addition. default may be used to set the  ter‐
              minal's  default  foreground  colour.   Abbreviations  are allowed; b or bl selects
              black.  Some terminals may generate additional colours if  the  bold  attribute  is
              also present.

              On  recent terminals and on systems with an up-to-date terminal database the number
              of colours supported may be tested by the command `echotc Co'; if this succeeds, it
              indicates  a limit on the number of colours which will be enforced by the line edi‐
              tor.  The number of colours is in any case limited to 256  (i.e.  the  range  0  to
              255).

              Colour is also known as color.

       bg=colour
              The  background  colour should be set to colour.  This works similarly to the fore‐
              ground colour, except the background is not usually affected by the bold attribute.

       bold   The characters in the given context are shown in a bold font.   Not  all  terminals
              distinguish bold fonts.

       standout
              The characters in the given context are shown in the terminal's standout mode.  The
              actual effect is specific to the terminal; on many terminals it is  inverse  video.
              On  some  such  terminals, where the cursor does not blink it appears with standout
              mode negated, making it less than clear where the cursor actually is.  On such ter‐
              minals  one  of the other effects may be preferable for highlighting the region and
              matched search string.

       underline
              The characters in the given context are shown underlined.  Some terminals show  the
              foreground in a different colour instead; in this case whitespace will not be high‐
              lighted.

       The characters described above as `special' are as follows.  The formatting described here
       is used irrespective of whether the characters are highlighted:

       ASCII control characters
              Control characters in the ASCII range are shown as `^' followed by the base charac‐
              ter.

       Unprintable multibyte characters
              This item applies to control characters not in the ASCII range, plus other  charac‐
              ters as follows.  If the MULTIBYTE option is in effect, multibyte characters not in
              the ASCII character set that are reported as having zero width are treated as  com‐
              bining  characters when the option COMBINING_CHARS is on.  If the option is off, or
              if a character appears where a combining character is not valid, the  character  is
              treated as unprintable.

              Unprintable  multibyte  characters  are shown as a hexadecimal number between angle
              brackets.  The number is the code point of the character in the wide character set;
              this may or may not be Unicode, depending on the operating system.

       Invalid multibyte characters
              If  the  MULTIBYTE option is in effect, any sequence of one or more bytes that does
              not form a valid character in the current character set is treated as a  series  of
              bytes each shown as a special character.  This case can be distinguished from other
              unprintable characters as the bytes  are  represented  as  two  hexadecimal  digits
              between angle brackets, as distinct from the four or eight digits that are used for
              unprintable characters that are nonetheless valid in the current character set.

              Not all systems support this: for it to work, the system's representation  of  wide
              characters  must be code values from the Universal Character Set, as defined by IS0
              10646 (also known as Unicode).

       Wrapped double-width characters
              When a double-width character appears in the final column of a line, it is  instead
              shown  on  the  next  line.  The empty space left in the original position is high‐
              lighted as a special character.

       If zle_highlight is not set or no value applies to  a  particular  context,  the  defaults
       applied are equivalent to

              zle_highlight=(region:standout special:standout
              suffix:bold isearch:underline)

       i.e. both the region and special characters are shown in standout mode.

       Within  widgets, arbitrary regions may be highlighted by setting the special array parame‐
       ter region_highlight; see above.

ZSHCOMPWID(1)                        General Commands Manual                        ZSHCOMPWID(1)



NAME
       zshcompwid - zsh completion widgets

DESCRIPTION
       The shell's programmable completion mechanism can be manipulated in  two  ways;  here  the
       low-level features supporting the newer, function-based mechanism are defined.  A complete
       set of shell functions based on these features is described in  zshcompsys(1),  and  users
       with  no interest in adding to that system (or, potentially, writing their own -- see dic‐
       tionary entry for `hubris') should skip the current section.  The older  system  based  on
       the compctl builtin command is described in zshcompctl(1).

       Completion widgets are defined by the -C option to the zle builtin command provided by the
       zsh/zle module (see zshzle(1)). For example,

              zle -C complete expand-or-complete completer

       defines a widget named `complete'.  The second argument is the name of any of the  builtin
       widgets   that   handle  completions:  complete-word,  expand-or-complete,  expand-or-com‐
       plete-prefix, menu-complete, menu-expand-or-complete, reverse-menu-complete, list-choices,
       or delete-char-or-list.  Note that this will still work even if the widget in question has
       been re-bound.

       When this newly defined widget is bound to a key using the bindkey builtin command defined
       in  the zsh/zle module (see zshzle(1)), typing that key will call the shell function `com‐
       pleter'. This function is responsible  for  generating  the  possible  matches  using  the
       builtins  described  below.   As  with  other ZLE widgets, the function is called with its
       standard input closed.

       Once the function returns, the completion code takes over control  again  and  treats  the
       matches  in  the  same manner as the specified builtin widget, in this case expand-or-com‐
       plete.

COMPLETION SPECIAL PARAMETERS
       The parameters ZLE_REMOVE_SUFFIX_CHARS and ZLE_SPACE_SUFFIX_CHARS are used by the  comple‐
       tion mechanism, but are not special.  See Parameters Used By The Shell in zshparam(1).

       Inside  completion  widgets, and any functions called from them, some parameters have spe‐
       cial meaning; outside these functions they are not special to the shell in any way.  These
       parameters  are  used  to  pass information between the completion code and the completion
       widget. Some of the builtin commands and the condition codes use  or  change  the  current
       values  of  these parameters.  Any existing values will be hidden during execution of com‐
       pletion widgets; except for compstate, the parameters are  reset  on  each  function  exit
       (including nested function calls from within the completion widget) to the values they had
       when the function was entered.

       CURRENT
              This is the number of the current word, i.e. the word the cursor is currently on in
              the  words  array.  Note that this value is only correct if the ksharrays option is
              not set.

       IPREFIX
              Initially this will be set to the empty string.  This parameter functions like PRE‐
              FIX;  it  contains  a string which precedes the one in PREFIX and is not considered
              part of the list of matches.  Typically, a string is transferred from the beginning
              of PREFIX to the end of IPREFIX, for example:

                     IPREFIX=${PREFIX%%\=*}=
                     PREFIX=${PREFIX#*=}

              causes  the  part  of the prefix up to and including the first equal sign not to be
              treated as part of a matched string.  This can be done automatically by the compset
              builtin, see below.

       ISUFFIX
              As  IPREFIX,  but  for  a suffix that should not be considered part of the matches;
              note that the ISUFFIX string follows the SUFFIX string.

       PREFIX Initially this will be set to the part of the current word from  the  beginning  of
              the  word up to the position of the cursor; it may be altered to give a common pre‐
              fix for all matches.

       QIPREFIX
              This parameter is read-only and contains the quoted string up  to  the  word  being
              completed.  E.g.  when completing `"foo', this parameter contains the double quote.
              If the -q option of compset is used (see below), and the original string was  `"foo
              bar' with the cursor on the `bar', this parameter contains `"foo '.

       QISUFFIX
              Like QIPREFIX, but containing the suffix.

       SUFFIX Initially this will be set to the part of the current word from the cursor position
              to the end; it may be altered to give a common suffix for all matches.  It is  most
              useful  when the option COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set, as otherwise the whole word on the
              command line is treated as a prefix.

       compstate
              This is an associative array with various keys and values that the completion  code
              uses to exchange information with the completion widget.  The keys are:

              all_quotes
                     The  -q  option  of  the compset builtin command (see below) allows a quoted
                     string to be broken into separate words; if the cursor is on  one  of  those
                     words,  that  word  will be completed, possibly invoking `compset -q' recur‐
                     sively.  With this key it is possible to test the types  of  quoted  strings
                     which  are  currently broken into parts in this fashion.  Its value contains
                     one character for each quoting level.  The characters are a single quote  or
                     a  double quote for strings quoted with these characters, a dollars sign for
                     strings quoted with $'...' and a backslash for strings not starting  with  a
                     quote character.  The first character in the value always corresponds to the
                     innermost quoting level.

              context
                     This will be set by the completion code to the overall context in which com‐
                     pletion is attempted. Possible values are:

                     array_value
                            when completing inside the value of an array parameter assignment; in
                            this case the words array contains the words inside the parentheses.

                     brace_parameter
                            when completing the name of a  parameter  in  a  parameter  expansion
                            beginning  with  ${.   This  context will also be set when completing
                            parameter flags following ${(; the full command line argument is pre‐
                            sented  and the handler must test the value to be completed to ascer‐
                            tain that this is the case.

                     assign_parameter
                            when completing the name of a parameter in a parameter assignment.

                     command
                            when completing for a normal command (either in command  position  or
                            for an argument of the command).

                     condition
                            when  completing  inside  a `[[...]]' conditional expression; in this
                            case the words array contains only the words inside  the  conditional
                            expression.

                     math   when  completing  in  a  mathematical environment such as a `((...))'
                            construct.

                     parameter
                            when completing the name of a  parameter  in  a  parameter  expansion
                            beginning with $ but not ${.

                     redirect
                            when completing after a redirection operator.

                     subscript
                            when completing inside a parameter subscript.

                     value  when completing the value of a parameter assignment.

              exact  Controls  the behaviour when the REC_EXACT option is set.  It will be set to
                     accept if an exact match would be accepted, and will be unset otherwise.

                     If it was set when at least one match equal to the string on  the  line  was
                     generated, the match is accepted.

              exact_string
                     The string of an exact match if one was found, otherwise unset.

              ignored
                     The  number  of words that were ignored because they matched one of the pat‐
                     terns given with the -F option to the compadd builtin command.

              insert This controls the manner in which a match is inserted into the command line.
                     On  entry  to the widget function, if it is unset the command line is not to
                     be changed; if set to unambiguous, any prefix common to all matches is to be
                     inserted;  if  set  to  automenu-unambiguous,  the  common  prefix  is to be
                     inserted and the next invocation of the completion code may start menu  com‐
                     pletion  (due to the AUTO_MENU option being set); if set to menu or automenu
                     menu completion will be started for the matches currently generated (in  the
                     latter  case  this  will happen because the AUTO_MENU is set). The value may
                     also contain the string `tab' when the completion code  would  normally  not
                     really do completion, but only insert the TAB character.

                     On  exit  it  may be set to any of the values above (where setting it to the
                     empty string is the same as unsetting it), or to a number, in which case the
                     match  whose  number is given will be inserted into the command line.  Nega‐
                     tive numbers count backward from the last match  (with  `-1'  selecting  the
                     last  match)  and out-of-range values are wrapped around, so that a value of
                     zero selects the last match and a value one more than  the  maximum  selects
                     the  first.  Unless  the  value  of  this  key ends in a space, the match is
                     inserted as in a menu completion, i.e.  without  automatically  appending  a
                     space.

                     Both  menu  and automenu may also specify the number of the match to insert,
                     given after a colon.  For example, `menu:2' says to start  menu  completion,
                     beginning with the second match.

                     Note that a value containing the substring `tab' makes the matches generated
                     be ignored and only the TAB be inserted.

                     Finally, it may also be set to all, which makes  all  matches  generated  be
                     inserted into the line.

              insert_positions
                     When  the  completion  system  inserts  an unambiguous string into the line,
                     there may be multiple places where characters are missing or where the char‐
                     acter  inserted differs from at least one match.  The value of this key con‐
                     tains a colon separated list of all these positions,  as  indexes  into  the
                     command line.

              last_prompt
                     If  this  is set to a non-empty string for every match added, the completion
                     code will move the cursor back to the previous prompt after the list of com‐
                     pletions  has  been  displayed.  Initially this is set or unset according to
                     the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option.

              list   This controls whether or how the list of matches will be displayed.   If  it
                     is  unset or empty they will never be listed; if its value begins with list,
                     they will always be listed; if it begins with autolist  or  ambiguous,  they
                     will  be  listed  when  the AUTO_LIST or LIST_AMBIGUOUS options respectively
                     would normally cause them to be.

                     If the substring force appears in the value, this makes the  list  be  shown
                     even  if  there is only one match. Normally, the list would be shown only if
                     there are at least two matches.

                     The value contains the substring packed if the LIST_PACKED option is set. If
                     this  substring  is  given for all matches added to a group, this group will
                     show the LIST_PACKED behavior. The same  is  done  for  the  LIST_ROWS_FIRST
                     option with the substring rows.

                     Finally, if the value contains the string explanations, only the explanation
                     strings, if any, will be listed and if it contains messages, only  the  mes‐
                     sages  (added with the -x option of compadd) will be listed.  If it contains
                     both explanations and messages both kinds of  explanation  strings  will  be
                     listed.   It  will  be set appropriately on entry to a completion widget and
                     may be changed there.

              list_lines
                     This gives the number of lines that are needed to display the full  list  of
                     completions.   Note  that  to calculate the total number of lines to display
                     you need to add the number of lines needed for  the  command  line  to  this
                     value, this is available as the value of the BUFFERLINES special parameter.

              list_max
                     Initially  this is set to the value of the LISTMAX parameter.  It may be set
                     to any other value; when the widget exits this value will  be  used  in  the
                     same way as the value of LISTMAX.

              nmatches
                     The number of matches generated and accepted by the completion code so far.

              old_insert
                     On entry to the widget this will be set to the number of the match of an old
                     list of completions that is currently inserted into the command line. If  no
                     match has been inserted, this is unset.

                     As  with  old_list,  the  value  of  this key will only be used if it is the
                     string keep. If it was set to this value by the widget and there was an  old
                     match  inserted  into  the  command line, this match will be kept and if the
                     value of the insert key specifies that another  match  should  be  inserted,
                     this will be inserted after the old one.

              old_list
                     This is set to yes if there is still a valid list of completions from a pre‐
                     vious completion at the time the widget is invoked.  This  will  usually  be
                     the case if and only if the previous editing operation was a completion wid‐
                     get or one of the builtin completion functions.  If there is  a  valid  list
                     and  it  is  also  currently  shown  on the screen, the value of this key is
                     shown.

                     After the widget has exited the value of this key is only used if it was set
                     to  keep.   In  this  case the completion code will continue to use this old
                     list.  If the widget generated new matches, they will not be used.

              parameter
                     The name of the parameter when completing in a subscript or in the value  of
                     a parameter assignment.

              pattern_insert
                     Normally  this  is set to menu, which specifies that menu completion will be
                     used whenever a set of matches was generated using pattern matching.  If  it
                     is  set to any other non-empty string by the user and menu completion is not
                     selected by other option settings, the code will instead insert  any  common
                     prefix for the generated matches as with normal completion.

              pattern_match
                     Locally controls the behaviour given by the GLOB_COMPLETE option.  Initially
                     it is set to `*' if and only if the option is set.   The  completion  widget
                     may  set  it to this value, to an empty string (which has the same effect as
                     unsetting it), or to any  other  non-empty  string.   If  it  is  non-empty,
                     unquoted  metacharacters on the command line will be treated as patterns; if
                     it is `*', then additionally a wildcard `*' is assumed at the  cursor  posi‐
                     tion; if it is empty or unset, metacharacters will be treated literally.

                     Note  that  the  matcher specifications given to the compadd builtin command
                     are not used if this is set to a non-empty string.

              quote  When completing inside quotes, this contains the quotation  character  (i.e.
                     either  a  single  quote,  a  double quote, or a backtick).  Otherwise it is
                     unset.

              quoting
                     When completing inside single quotes, this is  set  to  the  string  single;
                     inside  double quotes, the string double; inside backticks, the string back‐
                     tick.  Otherwise it is unset.

              redirect
                     The redirection operator when completing in a redirection position, i.e. one
                     of <, >, etc.

              restore
                     This  is  set to auto before a function is entered, which forces the special
                     parameters mentioned above (words, CURRENT,  PREFIX,  IPREFIX,  SUFFIX,  and
                     ISUFFIX)  to  be  restored to their previous values when the function exits.
                     If a function unsets it or sets it to any other string,  they  will  not  be
                     restored.

              to_end Specifies  the occasions on which the cursor is moved to the end of a string
                     when a match is inserted.  On entry to a widget function, it may  be  single
                     if this will happen when a single unambiguous match was inserted or match if
                     it will happen any time a match is inserted (for example,  by  menu  comple‐
                     tion; this is likely to be the effect of the ALWAYS_TO_END option).

                     On exit, it may be set to single as above.  It may also be set to always, or
                     to the empty string or unset; in those cases the cursor will be moved to the
                     end of the string always or never respectively.  Any other string is treated
                     as match.

              unambiguous
                     This key is read-only and will always be set  to  the  common  (unambiguous)
                     prefix the completion code has generated for all matches added so far.

              unambiguous_cursor
                     This  gives  the position the cursor would be placed at if the common prefix
                     in the unambiguous key were inserted, relative to the value of that key. The
                     cursor  would  be  placed  before the character whose index is given by this
                     key.

              unambiguous_positions
                     This contains all positions where characters in the unambiguous  string  are
                     missing  or  where  the  character inserted differs from at least one of the
                     matches.  The positions are given as indexes into the string  given  by  the
                     value of the unambiguous key.

              vared  If  completion  is  called while editing a line using the vared builtin, the
                     value of this key is set to the name of the parameter given as  an  argument
                     to vared.  This key is only set while a vared command is active.

       words  This array contains the words present on the command line currently being edited.

COMPLETION BUILTIN COMMANDS
       compadd [ -akqQfenUld12C ] [ -F array ]
       [ -P prefix ] [ -S suffix ]
       [ -p hidden-prefix ] [ -s hidden-suffix ]
       [ -i ignored-prefix ] [ -I ignored-suffix ]
       [ -W file-prefix ] [ -d array ]
       [ -J name ] [ -V name ] [ -X explanation ] [ -x message ]
       [ -r remove-chars ] [ -R remove-func ]
       [ -D array ] [ -O array ] [ -A array ]
       [ -E number ]
       [ -M match-spec ] [ -- ] [ words ... ]

              This builtin command can be used to add matches directly and control all the infor‐
              mation the completion code stores with each possible match. The  return  status  is
              zero if at least one match was added and non-zero if no matches were added.

              The completion code breaks the string to complete into seven fields in the order:

                     <ipre><apre><hpre><word><hsuf><asuf><isuf>

              The  first  field is an ignored prefix taken from the command line, the contents of
              the IPREFIX parameter plus the string given with the -i option. With the -U option,
              only  the string from the -i option is used. The field <apre> is an optional prefix
              string given with the -P option.  The <hpre> field is a string that  is  considered
              part of the match but that should not be shown when listing completions, given with
              the -p option; for example, functions that do filename generation might  specify  a
              common path prefix this way.  <word> is the part of the match that should appear in
              the list of completions, i.e. one of the words given at the end of the compadd com‐
              mand  line.  The  suffixes  <hsuf>,  <asuf>  and  <isuf> correspond to the prefixes
              <hpre>, <apre> and <ipre> and are given by the options -s, -S and -I, respectively.

              The supported flags are:

              -P prefix
                     This gives a string to be inserted before the given words.  The string given
                     is  not  considered  as part of the match and any shell metacharacters in it
                     will not be quoted when the string is inserted.

              -S suffix
                     Like -P, but gives a string to be inserted after the match.

              -p hidden-prefix
                     This gives a string that should be inserted into the command line before the
                     match  but  that  should  not  appear  in the list of matches. Unless the -U
                     option is given, this string must be matched as part of the  string  on  the
                     command line.

              -s hidden-suffix
                     Like `-p', but gives a string to insert after the match.

              -i ignored-prefix
                     This  gives  a string to insert into the command line just before any string
                     given with the `-P' option.  Without `-P' the string is inserted before  the
                     string given with `-p' or directly before the match.

              -I ignored-suffix
                     Like -i, but gives an ignored suffix.

              -a     With  this  flag  the  words  are  taken as names of arrays and the possible
                     matches are their values.  If only some elements of the arrays  are  needed,
                     the words may also contain subscripts, as in `foo[2,-1]'.

              -k     With  this  flag  the words are taken as names of associative arrays and the
                     possible matches are their keys.  As for -a, the words may also contain sub‐
                     scripts, as in `foo[(R)*bar*]'.

              -d array
                     This  adds  per-match  display strings. The array should contain one element
                     per word given. The completion code will  then  display  the  first  element
                     instead  of the first word, and so on. The array may be given as the name of
                     an array parameter or directly as a space-separated list of words in  paren‐
                     theses.

                     If  there  are  fewer display strings than words, the leftover words will be
                     displayed unchanged and if there are more display strings  than  words,  the
                     leftover display strings will be silently ignored.

              -l     This option only has an effect if used together with the -d option. If it is
                     given, the display strings are listed one per line, not arrayed in columns.

              -o     This option only has an effect if used together with the -d option.   If  it
                     is  given, the order of the output is determined by the match strings;  oth‐
                     erwise it is determined by the display strings (i.e. the  strings  given  by
                     the -d option).

              -J name
                     Gives the name of the group of matches the words should be stored in.

              -V name
                     Like  -J  but  naming an unsorted group. These are in a different name space
                     than groups created with the -J flag.

              -1     If given together with the -V option, makes only consecutive  duplicates  in
                     the  group  be  removed. If combined with the -J option, this has no visible
                     effect. Note that groups with and without this flag are  in  different  name
                     spaces.

              -2     If  given  together  with the -J or -V option, makes all duplicates be kept.
                     Again, groups with and without this flag are in different name spaces.

              -X explanation
                     The explanation string will be printed with the list of matches,  above  the
                     group currently selected.

              -x message
                     Like -X, but the message will be printed even if there are no matches in the
                     group.

              -q     The suffix given with -S will be automatically removed if the next character
                     typed  is  a blank or does not insert anything, or if the suffix consists of
                     only one character and the next character typed is the same character.

              -r remove-chars
                     This is a more versatile form of the -q option.  The suffix given with -S or
                     the slash automatically added after completing directories will be automati‐
                     cally removed if the next character typed  inserts  one  of  the  characters
                     given  in the remove-chars.  This string is parsed as a characters class and
                     understands the backslash sequences used by the print command.  For example,
                     `-r  "a-z\t"' removes the suffix if the next character typed inserts a lower
                     case character or a TAB, and `-r "^0-9"' removes  the  suffix  if  the  next
                     character  typed  inserts anything but a digit. One extra backslash sequence
                     is understood in this string: `\-' stands for  all  characters  that  insert
                     nothing. Thus `-S "=" -q' is the same as `-S "=" -r "= \t\n\-"'.

                     This  option  may also be used without the -S option; then any automatically
                     added space will be removed when one of the characters in the list is typed.

              -R remove-func
                     This is another form of the -r option. When a suffix has been  inserted  and
                     the  completion  accepted, the function remove-func will be called after the
                     next character typed.  It is passed the length of the suffix as an  argument
                     and  can  use  the special parameters available in ordinary (non-completion)
                     zle widgets (see zshzle(1)) to analyse and modify the command line.

              -f     If this flag is given, all of the matches built from  words  are  marked  as
                     being the names of files.  They are not required to be actual filenames, but
                     if they are, and the option LIST_TYPES is set, the characters describing the
                     types of the files in the completion lists will be shown. This also forces a
                     slash to be added when the name of a directory is completed.

              -e     This flag can be used to tell the completion code that the matches added are
                     parameter   names   for   a   parameter   expansion.   This  will  make  the
                     AUTO_PARAM_SLASH and AUTO_PARAM_KEYS options be used for the matches.

              -W file-prefix
                     This string is a pathname that will be prepended  to  each  of  the  matches
                     formed  by  the  given  words  together  with any prefix specified by the -p
                     option to form a complete filename for testing.  Hence it is only useful  if
                     combined with the -f flag, as the tests will not otherwise be performed.

              -F array
                     Specifies an array containing patterns. Words matching one of these patterns
                     are ignored, i.e. not considered to be possible matches.

                     The array may be the name of an array parameter or a list  of  literal  pat‐
                     terns  enclosed  in parentheses and quoted, as in `-F "(*?.o *?.h)"'. If the
                     name of an array is given, the elements of the array are taken as  the  pat‐
                     terns.

              -Q     This  flag  instructs the completion code not to quote any metacharacters in
                     the words when inserting them into the command line.

              -M match-spec
                     This gives local match specifications as  described  below  in  the  section
                     `Completion  Matching Control'. This option may be given more than once.  In
                     this case all match-specs given are concatenated with spaces between them to
                     form  the  specification string to use.  Note that they will only be used if
                     the -U option is not given.

              -n     Specifies that the words added are to be used as possible matches,  but  are
                     not to appear in the completion listing.

              -U     If this flag is given, all words given will be accepted and no matching will
                     be done by the completion code. Normally this is used in functions  that  do
                     the matching themselves.

              -O array
                     If this option is given, the words are not added to the set of possible com‐
                     pletions.  Instead, matching is done as usual and all of the words given  as
                     arguments  that  match  the string on the command line will be stored in the
                     array parameter whose name is given as array.

              -A array
                     As the -O option, except that instead of those  of  the  words  which  match
                     being  stored  in  array, the strings generated internally by the completion
                     code  are  stored.  For  example,  with  a  matching  specification  of  `-M
                     "L:|no="',  the string `nof' on the command line and the string `foo' as one
                     of the words, this option stores the string `nofoo' in  the  array,  whereas
                     the -O option stores the `foo' originally given.

              -D array
                     As  with  -O,  the  words  are not added to the set of possible completions.
                     Instead, the completion code tests whether each word in turn matches what is
                     on  the  line.  If the nth word does not match, the nth element of the array
                     is removed.  Elements for  which  the  corresponding  word  is  matched  are
                     retained.

              -C     This  option  adds  a  special match which expands to all other matches when
                     inserted into the line, even those that are added after this option is used.
                     Together  with  the -d option it is possible to specify a string that should
                     be displayed in the list for this special match.  If no string is given,  it
                     will  be shown as a string containing the strings that would be inserted for
                     the other matches, truncated to the width of the screen.

              -E     This option adds number empty matches after the words have been  added.   An
                     empty match takes up space in completion listings but will never be inserted
                     in the line and can't be selected with menu completion  or  menu  selection.
                     This  makes empty matches only useful to format completion lists and to make
                     explanatory string be shown in completion lists (since empty matches can  be
                     given  display  strings  with the -d option).  And because all but one empty
                     string would otherwise be removed, this option implies the -V and -2 options
                     (even if an explicit -J option is given).

              -
              --     This flag ends the list of flags and options. All arguments after it will be
                     taken as the words to use as matches even if they begin with hyphens.

              Except for the -M flag, if any of these flags is given more than  once,  the  first
              one (and its argument) will be used.

       compset -p number
       compset -P [ number ] pattern
       compset -s number
       compset -S [ number ] pattern
       compset -n begin [ end ]
       compset -N beg-pat [ end-pat ]
       compset -q
              This  command  simplifies  modification of the special parameters, while its return
              status allows tests on them to be carried out.

              The options are:

              -p number
                     If the contents of the PREFIX parameter is longer  than  number  characters,
                     the first number characters are removed from it and appended to the contents
                     of the IPREFIX parameter.

              -P [ number ] pattern
                     If the value of the PREFIX parameter begins with anything that  matches  the
                     pattern, the matched portion is removed from PREFIX and appended to IPREFIX.

                     Without  the  optional  number, the longest match is taken, but if number is
                     given, anything up to the numberth match is moved.  If the number  is  nega‐
                     tive,  the  numberth longest match is moved. For example, if PREFIX contains
                     the string `a=b=c', then compset -P '*\=' will move the string  `a=b='  into
                     the  IPREFIX  parameter,  but  compset  -P 1 '*\=' will move only the string
                     `a='.

              -s number
                     As -p, but transfer the last number characters from the value of  SUFFIX  to
                     the front of the value of ISUFFIX.

              -S [ number ] pattern
                     As -P, but match the last portion of SUFFIX and transfer the matched portion
                     to the front of the value of ISUFFIX.

              -n begin [ end ]
                     If the current word position  as  specified  by  the  parameter  CURRENT  is
                     greater  than  or equal to begin, anything up to the beginth word is removed
                     from the words array and the value of the parameter CURRENT  is  decremented
                     by begin.

                     If  the  optional end is given, the modification is done only if the current
                     word position is also less than or equal to end. In  this  case,  the  words
                     from position end onwards are also removed from the words array.

                     Both  begin and end may be negative to count backwards from the last element
                     of the words array.

              -N beg-pat [ end-pat ]
                     If one of the elements of the words array before the one at the index  given
                     by  the value of the parameter CURRENT matches the pattern beg-pat, all ele‐
                     ments up to and including the matching one are removed from the words  array
                     and the value of CURRENT is changed to point to the same word in the changed
                     array.

                     If the optional pattern end-pat is also given, and there is  an  element  in
                     the  words  array matching this pattern, the parameters are modified only if
                     the index of this word is higher than the one given by the CURRENT parameter
                     (so  that  the  matching word has to be after the cursor). In this case, the
                     words starting with the one matching end-pat are also removed from the words
                     array. If words contains no word matching end-pat, the testing and modifica‐
                     tion is performed as if it were not given.

              -q     The word currently being completed is split on spaces into  separate  words,
                     respecting  the  usual  shell  quoting conventions.  The resulting words are
                     stored in the words array, and CURRENT, PREFIX, SUFFIX, QIPREFIX, and QISUF‐
                     FIX are modified to reflect the word part that is completed.

              In  all  the  above  cases  the return status is zero if the test succeeded and the
              parameters were modified and non-zero  otherwise.  This  allows  one  to  use  this
              builtin in tests such as:

                     if compset -P '*\='; then ...

              This  forces  anything up to and including the last equal sign to be ignored by the
              completion code.

       compcall [ -TD ]
              This allows the use of completions defined with the  compctl  builtin  from  within
              completion  widgets.   The  list  of  matches  will  be  generated as if one of the
              non-widget completion functions (complete-word, etc.)  had been called, except that
              only  compctls  given for specific commands are used. To force the code to try com‐
              pletions defined with the -T  option  of  compctl  and/or  the  default  completion
              (whether  defined  by compctl -D or the builtin default) in the appropriate places,
              the -T and/or -D flags can be passed to compcall.

              The return status can be used to test if a matching compctl definition  was  found.
              It is non-zero if a compctl was found and zero otherwise.

              Note that this builtin is defined by the zsh/compctl module.

COMPLETION CONDITION CODES
       The following additional condition codes for use within the [[ ... ]] construct are avail‐
       able in completion widgets.  These work on the special parameters.  All of these tests can
       also  be performed by the compset builtin, but in the case of the condition codes the con‐
       tents of the special parameters are not modified.

       -prefix [ number ] pattern
              true if the test for the -P option of compset would succeed.

       -suffix [ number ] pattern
              true if the test for the -S option of compset would succeed.

       -after beg-pat
              true if the test of the -N option with only the beg-pat given would succeed.

       -between beg-pat end-pat
              true if the test for the -N option with both patterns would succeed.

COMPLETION MATCHING CONTROL
       It is possible by use of the -M option of the compadd builtin command to specify  how  the
       characters  in  the string to be completed (referred to here as the command line) map onto
       the characters in the list of matches produced by the completion code (referred to here as
       the  trial  completions).  Note  that this is not used if the command line contains a glob
       pattern and the GLOB_COMPLETE option is set or the pattern_match of the compstate  special
       association is set to a non-empty string.

       The  match-spec  given as the argument to the -M option (see `Completion Builtin Commands'
       above) consists of one or  more  matching  descriptions  separated  by  whitespace.   Each
       description  consists  of  a  letter  followed by a colon and then the patterns describing
       which character sequences on the line match which character sequences in the trial comple‐
       tion.   Any  sequence  of  characters  not  handled in this fashion must match exactly, as
       usual.

       The forms of match-spec understood are as follows. In each case, the form  with  an  upper
       case  initial  character retains the string already typed on the command line as the final
       result of completion, while with a lower case initial character the string on the  command
       line is changed into the corresponding part of the trial completion.

       m:lpat=tpat
       M:lpat=tpat
              Here,  lpat  is  a  pattern that matches on the command line, corresponding to tpat
              which matches in the trial completion.

       l:lanchor|lpat=tpat
       L:lanchor|lpat=tpat
       l:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       L:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       b:lpat=tpat
       B:lpat=tpat
              These letters are for patterns that are anchored by another  pattern  on  the  left
              side. Matching for lpat and tpat is as for m and M, but the pattern lpat matched on
              the command line must be preceded by the pattern lanchor.  The lanchor can be blank
              to  anchor  the match to the start of the command line string; otherwise the anchor
              can occur anywhere, but must match in both the command line  and  trial  completion
              strings.

              If  no  lpat  is  given  but  a ranchor is, this matches the gap between substrings
              matched by lanchor and ranchor. Unlike lanchor, the ranchor only needs to match the
              trial completion string.

              The  b  and  B forms are similar to l and L with an empty anchor, but need to match
              only the beginning of the trial completion or the word on the command line, respec‐
              tively.

       r:lpat|ranchor=tpat
       R:lpat|ranchor=tpat
       r:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       R:lanchor||ranchor=tpat
       e:lpat=tpat
       E:lpat=tpat
              As  l,  L,  b and B, with the difference that the command line and trial completion
              patterns are anchored on the right side.  Here an empty ranchor and  the  e  and  E
              forms force the match to the end of the trial completion or command line string.

       Each  lpat,  tpat or anchor is either an empty string or consists of a sequence of literal
       characters (which may be quoted with a backslash), question marks, character classes,  and
       correspondence  classes;  ordinary  shell patterns are not used.  Literal characters match
       only themselves, question marks match any character, and character classes are  formed  as
       for globbing and match any character in the given set.

       Correspondence  classes are defined like character classes, but with two differences: they
       are delimited by a pair of braces, and negated classes are not allowed, so the  characters
       !  and  ^  have no special meaning directly after the opening brace.  They indicate that a
       range of characters on the line match a range of characters in the trial  completion,  but
       (unlike  ordinary character classes) paired according to the corresponding position in the
       sequence.  For example, to make any ASCII lower case letter on the line match  the  corre‐
       sponding  upper case letter in the trial completion, you can use `m:{a-z}={A-Z}' (however,
       see below for the recommended form for this).  More than one pair of classes can occur, in
       which  case the first class before the = corresponds to the first after it, and so on.  If
       one side has more such classes than the other side, the superfluous  classes  behave  like
       normal character classes.  In anchor patterns correspondence classes also behave like nor‐
       mal character classes.

       The standard `[:name:]' forms described for standard shell patterns, see the section FILE‐
       NAME  GENERATION  in  zshexpn(1),  may  appear in correspondence classes as well as normal
       character classes.  The only special behaviour in correspondence classes is if the form on
       the  left  and the form on the right are each one of [:upper:], [:lower:].  In these cases
       the character in the word and the character on the line must be the same up to  a  differ‐
       ence  in case.  Hence to make any lower case character on the line match the corresponding
       upper case character in the trial  completion  you  can  use  `m:{[:lower:]}={[:upper:]}'.
       Although  the  matching system does not yet handle multibyte characters, this is likely to
       be a future extension, at which point this syntax will handle arbitrary  alphabets;  hence
       this  form,  rather  than  the  use of explicit ranges, is the recommended form.  In other
       cases `[:name:]' forms are allowed.  If the two forms on the left and right are the  same,
       the  characters  must  match  exactly.   In  remaining  cases, the corresponding tests are
       applied to both characters, but they are not otherwise constrained; any matching character
       in  one  set goes with any matching character in the other set:  this is equivalent to the
       behaviour of ordinary character classes.

       The pattern tpat may also be one or two stars, `*' or `**'. This means that the pattern on
       the  command line can match any number of characters in the trial completion. In this case
       the pattern must be anchored (on either side); in the case of a single  star,  the  anchor
       then  determines how much of the trial completion is to be included -- only the characters
       up to the next appearance of the anchor  will  be  matched.  With  two  stars,  substrings
       matched by the anchor can be matched, too.

       Examples:

       The  keys  of the options association defined by the parameter module are the option names
       in all-lower-case form, without underscores, and without the optional no at the  beginning
       even  though the builtins setopt and unsetopt understand option names with upper case let‐
       ters, underscores, and the optional no.  The following alters the matching rules  so  that
       the  prefix  no  and any underscore are ignored when trying to match the trial completions
       generated and upper case letters on the line match the corresponding lower case letters in
       the words:

              compadd -M 'L:|[nN][oO]= M:_= M:{[:upper:]}={[:lower:]}' - \
                ${(k)options}

       The  first part says that the pattern `[nN][oO]' at the beginning (the empty anchor before
       the pipe symbol) of the string on the line matches the empty string in the list  of  words
       generated  by  completion, so it will be ignored if present. The second part does the same
       for an underscore anywhere in the command line string, and the third part uses  correspon‐
       dence  classes  so  that any upper case letter on the line matches the corresponding lower
       case letter in the word. The use of the upper case forms of the  specification  characters
       (L  and  M) guarantees that what has already been typed on the command line (in particular
       the prefix no) will not be deleted.

       Note that the use of L in the first part means that it matches only when at the  beginning
       of  both  the command line string and the trial completion. I.e., the string `_NO_f' would
       not be completed to `_NO_foo', nor would `NONO_f' be completed to  `NONO_foo'  because  of
       the  leading  underscore  or the second `NO' on the line which makes the pattern fail even
       though they are otherwise ignored. To fix this, one would use `B:[nN][oO]=' instead of the
       first  part.  As  described  above, this matches at the beginning of the trial completion,
       independent of other characters or substrings at the beginning of the  command  line  word
       which are ignored by the same or other match-specs.

       The  second  example  makes  completion case insensitive.  This is just the same as in the
       option example, except here we wish to retain the characters in the list of completions:

              compadd -M 'm:{[:lower:]}={[:upper:]}' ...

       This makes lower case letters match their upper case counterparts.   To  make  upper  case
       letters match the lower case forms as well:

              compadd -M 'm:{[:lower:][:upper:]}={[:upper:][:lower:]}' ...

       A  nice  example for the use of * patterns is partial word completion. Sometimes you would
       like to make strings like `c.s.u' complete to strings like  `comp.source.unix',  i.e.  the
       word  on  the command line consists of multiple parts, separated by a dot in this example,
       where each part should be completed separately -- note, however, that the case where  each
       part  of  the  word,  i.e. `comp', `source' and `unix' in this example, is to be completed
       from separate sets of matches is a different problem to be solved by the implementation of
       the completion widget.  The example can be handled by:

              compadd -M 'r:|.=* r:|=*' \
                - comp.sources.unix comp.sources.misc ...

       The first specification says that lpat is the empty string, while anchor is a dot; tpat is
       *, so this can match anything except for the `.' from the anchor in the  trial  completion
       word.   So in `c.s.u', the matcher sees `c', followed by the empty string, followed by the
       anchor `.', and likewise for the second dot, and replaces the  empty  strings  before  the
       anchors,  giving  `c[omp].s[ources].u[nix]', where the last part of the completion is just
       as normal.

       With  the  pattern  shown  above,  the  string   `c.u'   could   not   be   completed   to
       `comp.sources.unix'  because the single star means that no dot (matched by the anchor) can
       be skipped. By using two stars as in `r:|.=**',  however,  `c.u'  could  be  completed  to
       `comp.sources.unix'.  This  also  shows  that in some cases, especially if the anchor is a
       real pattern, like a character class, the form with two stars may result in  more  matches
       than one would like.

       The  second  specification is needed to make this work when the cursor is in the middle of
       the string on the command line and the option COMPLETE_IN_WORD is set. In  this  case  the
       completion  code would normally try to match trial completions that end with the string as
       typed so far, i.e. it will only insert new characters at the cursor position  rather  than
       at the end.  However in our example we would like the code to recognise matches which con‐
       tain extra characters after the string on the line (the `nix' in the example).   Hence  we
       say  that  the empty string at the end of the string on the line matches any characters at
       the end of the trial completion.

       More generally, the specification

              compadd -M 'r:|[.,_-]=* r:|=*' ...

       allows one to complete words with abbreviations before any of the characters in the square
       brackets.   For  example,  to complete veryverylongfile.c rather than veryverylongheader.h
       with the above in effect, you can just type very.c before attempting completion.

       The specifications with both a left and a right anchor  are  useful  to  complete  partial
       words whose parts are not separated by some special character. For example, in some places
       strings have to be completed that are formed  `LikeThis'  (i.e.  the  separate  parts  are
       determined  by  a  leading  upper  case  letter) or maybe one has to complete strings with
       trailing numbers. Here one could use the simple form with only one anchor as in:

              compadd -M 'r:|[[:upper:]0-9]=* r:|=*' LikeTHIS FooHoo 5foo123 5bar234

       But with this, the string `H' would neither complete to `FooHoo' nor to `LikeTHIS' because
       in  each  case  there  is  an  upper case letter before the `H' and that is matched by the
       anchor. Likewise, a `2' would not be completed. In both cases this  could  be  changed  by
       using `r:|[[:upper:]0-9]=**', but then `H' completes to both `LikeTHIS' and `FooHoo' and a
       `2' matches the other strings because characters can be inserted before every  upper  case
       letter and digit. To avoid this one would use:

              compadd -M 'r:[^[:upper:]0-9]||[[:upper:]0-9]=** r:|=*' \
                  LikeTHIS FooHoo foo123 bar234

       By  using  these two anchors, a `H' matches only upper case `H's that are immediately pre‐
       ceded by something matching the left anchor `[^[:upper:]0-9]'. The effect is,  of  course,
       that `H' matches only the string `FooHoo', a `2' matches only `bar234' and so on.

       When  using  the  completion system (see zshcompsys(1)), users can define match specifica‐
       tions that are to be used for specific contexts by  using  the  matcher  and  matcher-list
       styles. The values for the latter will be used everywhere.

COMPLETION WIDGET EXAMPLE
       The first step is to define the widget:

              zle -C complete complete-word complete-files

       Then the widget can be bound to a key using the bindkey builtin command:

              bindkey '^X\t' complete

       After  that  the  shell function complete-files will be invoked after typing control-X and
       TAB. The function should then generate the matches, e.g.:

              complete-files () { compadd - * }

       This function will complete files in the current directory matching the current word.



ZSHCOMPSYS(1)                        General Commands Manual                        ZSHCOMPSYS(1)

NAME
       zshcompsys - zsh completion system

DESCRIPTION
       This describes the shell code for the `new' completion system, referred to as compsys.  It
       is written in shell functions based on the features described in zshcompwid(1).

       The  features are contextual, sensitive to the point at which completion is started.  Many
       completions are already provided.  For this reason, a user can perform a great many  tasks
       without  knowing any details beyond how to initialize the system, which is described below
       in INITIALIZATION.

       The context that decides what completion is to be performed may be
       ·      an argument or option position: these describe the position on the command line  at
              which  completion  is  requested.   For  example `first argument to rmdir, the word
              being completed names a directory';


       ·      a special context, denoting an element in the shell's syntax.  For example `a  word
              in command position' or `an array subscript'.


       A full context specification contains other elements, as we shall describe.

       Besides  commands  names  and  contexts,  the system employs two more concepts, styles and
       tags.  These provide ways for the user to configure the system's behaviour.

       Tags play a dual role.  They serve as a classification system for the  matches,  typically
       indicating  a  class  of  object that the user may need to distinguish.  For example, when
       completing arguments of the ls command the user may prefer to try  files  before  directo‐
       ries,  so  both of these are tags.  They also appear as the rightmost element in a context
       specification.

       Styles modify various operations of the completion system, such as output formatting,  but
       also  what  kinds  of completers are used (and in what order), or which tags are examined.
       Styles may accept arguments and are manipulated using the zstyle command described in  see
       zshmodules(1).

       In  summary,  tags  describe what the completion objects are, and style how they are to be
       completed.  At various points of execution,  the  completion  system  checks  what  styles
       and/or  tags  are  defined  for the current context, and uses that to modify its behavior.
       The full description of context handling, which determines how tags and other elements  of
       the  context  influence  the  behaviour of styles, is described below in COMPLETION SYSTEM
       CONFIGURATION.

       When a completion is requested, a dispatcher function is called; see  the  description  of
       _main_complete in the list of control functions below. This dispatcher decides which func‐
       tion should be called to produce the completions, and calls it. The result  is  passed  to
       one  or more completers, functions that implement individual completion strategies: simple
       completion, error correction, completion with error correction, menu selection, etc.

       More generally, the shell functions contained in the completion system are of two types:
       ·      those beginning `comp' are to be called directly; there are only a few of these;


       ·      those beginning `_' are called by the completion code.  The shell functions of this
              set,  which  implement  completion  behaviour  and  may be bound to keystrokes, are
              referred to as `widgets'.  These proliferate as new completions are required.


INITIALIZATION
       If the system was installed completely, it should be enough to  call  the  shell  function
       compinit  from  your  initialization  file;  see  the next section.  However, the function
       compinstall can be run by a user to configure various aspects of the completion system.

       Usually, compinstall will insert code into .zshrc, although if that  is  not  writable  it
       will save it in another file and tell you that file's location.  Note that it is up to you
       to make sure that the lines added to .zshrc are actually run; you may, for  example,  need
       to  move them to an earlier place in the file if .zshrc usually returns early.  So long as
       you keep them all together (including the comment lines at the start and finish), you  can
       rerun  compinstall  and  it  will correctly locate and modify these lines.  Note, however,
       that any code you add to this section by hand is likely to be lost if  you  rerun  compin‐
       stall, although lines using the command `zstyle' should be gracefully handled.

       The  new code will take effect next time you start the shell, or run .zshrc by hand; there
       is also an option to make them take  effect  immediately.   However,  if  compinstall  has
       removed definitions, you will need to restart the shell to see the changes.

       To run compinstall you will need to make sure it is in a directory mentioned in your fpath
       parameter, which should already be the case if zsh was properly configured as long as your
       startup  files  do  not  remove  the  appropriate directories from fpath.  Then it must be
       autoloaded (`autoload -U compinstall' is recommended).  You can abort the installation any
       time  you  are being prompted for information, and your .zshrc will not be altered at all;
       changes only take place right at the end, where you are specifically asked  for  confirma‐
       tion.

   Use of compinit
       This  section  describes the use of compinit to initialize completion for the current ses‐
       sion when called directly; if you have run compinstall it  will  be  called  automatically
       from your .zshrc.

       To  initialize the system, the function compinit should be in a directory mentioned in the
       fpath parameter, and should be autoloaded (`autoload -U  compinit'  is  recommended),  and
       then  run simply as `compinit'.  This will define a few utility functions, arrange for all
       the necessary shell functions to be autoloaded, and will then re-define all  widgets  that
       do  completion to use the new system.  If you use the menu-select widget, which is part of
       the zsh/complist module, you should make sure that that module is loaded before  the  call
       to  compinit so that that widget is also re-defined.  If completion styles (see below) are
       set up to perform expansion as well as completion by default, and the TAB key is bound  to
       expand-or-complete, compinit will rebind it to complete-word; this is necessary to use the
       correct form of expansion.

       Should you need to use the original completion commands, you can still bind  keys  to  the
       old widgets by putting a `.' in front of the widget name, e.g. `.expand-or-complete'.

       To speed up the running of compinit, it can be made to produce a dumped configuration that
       will be read in on future invocations; this is the default, but can be turned off by call‐
       ing  compinit  with the option -D.  The dumped file is .zcompdump in the same directory as
       the startup files (i.e. $ZDOTDIR or $HOME); alternatively, an explicit file  name  can  be
       given  by  `compinit  -d  dumpfile'.  The next invocation of compinit will read the dumped
       file instead of performing a full initialization.

       If the number of completion files changes, compinit will recognise this and produce a  new
       dump  file.   However,  if  the name of a function or the arguments in the first line of a
       #compdef function (as described below) change, it is easiest to delete the  dump  file  by
       hand  so  that compinit will re-create it the next time it is run.  The check performed to
       see if there are new functions can be omitted by giving the option -C.  In this  case  the
       dump file will only be created if there isn't one already.

       The  dumping is actually done by another function, compdump, but you will only need to run
       this yourself if you change the configuration (e.g. using compdef) and then want  to  dump
       the new one.  The name of the old dumped file will be remembered for this purpose.

       If  the  parameter _compdir is set, compinit uses it as a directory where completion func‐
       tions can be found; this is only necessary if they are not already in the function  search
       path.

       For  security  reasons  compinit  also checks if the completion system would use files not
       owned by root or by the  current  user,  or  files  in  directories  that  are  world-  or
       group-writable  or  that  are  not owned by root or by the current user.  If such files or
       directories are found, compinit will ask if the completion system should really  be  used.
       To  avoid  these tests and make all files found be used without asking, use the option -u,
       and to make compinit silently ignore all insecure files and directories use the option -i.
       This security check is skipped entirely when the -C option is given.

       The  security check can be retried at any time by running the function compaudit.  This is
       the same check used by compinit, but when it is executed directly any changes to fpath are
       made  local  to the function so they do not persist.  The directories to be checked may be
       passed as arguments; if none are given, compaudit uses fpath and _compdir to find  comple‐
       tion  system  directories, adding missing ones to fpath as necessary.  To force a check of
       exactly the directories currently named in fpath, set _compdir to an empty  string  before
       calling compaudit or compinit.

       The  function bashcompinit provides compatibility with bash's programmable completion sys‐
       tem.  When run it will define the functions, compgen and complete which correspond to  the
       bash  builtins with the same names.  It will then be possible to use completion specifica‐
       tions and functions written for bash.

   Autoloaded files
       The convention for autoloaded functions used in completion is  that  they  start  with  an
       underscore;  as already mentioned, the fpath/FPATH parameter must contain the directory in
       which they are stored.  If zsh was properly installed on  your  system,  then  fpath/FPATH
       automatically contains the required directories for the standard functions.

       For  incomplete  installations,  if  compinit does not find enough files beginning with an
       underscore (fewer than twenty) in the search path, it will try to find more by adding  the
       directory  _compdir  to the search path.  If that directory has a subdirectory named Base,
       all subdirectories will be added to the path.  Furthermore, if the subdirectory Base has a
       subdirectory  named Core, compinit will add all subdirectories of the subdirectories is to
       the path: this allows the functions to be in the same format as in the zsh source  distri‐
       bution.

       When  compinit is run, it searches all such files accessible via fpath/FPATH and reads the
       first line of each of them.  This line should contain one of  the  tags  described  below.
       Files whose first line does not start with one of these tags are not considered to be part
       of the completion system and will not be treated specially.

       The tags are:

       #compdef names... [ -[pP] patterns... [ -N names... ] ]
              The file will be made autoloadable and the function defined in it  will  be  called
              when  completing  names,  each of which is either the name of a command whose argu‐
              ments are to be completed or one of a number of special contexts in the form  -con‐
              text- described below.

              Each  name may also be of the form `cmd=service'.  When completing the command cmd,
              the function typically behaves as if the command (or special context)  service  was
              being  completed  instead.   This provides a way of altering the behaviour of func‐
              tions that can perform many different completions.  It is  implemented  by  setting
              the parameter $service when calling the function; the function may choose to inter‐
              pret this how it wishes, and simpler functions will probably ignore it.

              If the #compdef line contains one of the options -p or -P, the words following  are
              taken to be patterns.  The function will be called when completion is attempted for
              a command or context that matches one of the patterns.  The options -p and  -P  are
              used  to  specify  patterns  to  be tried before or after other completions respec‐
              tively.  Hence -P may be used to specify default actions.

              The option -N is used after a list following -p or -P; it specifies that  remaining
              words  no  longer  define  patterns.   It  is  possible to toggle between the three
              options as many times as necessary.

       #compdef -k style key-sequences...
              This option creates a widget behaving like the builtin widget style and binds it to
              the given key-sequences, if any.  The style must be one of the builtin widgets that
              perform completion, namely complete-word, delete-char-or-list,  expand-or-complete,
              expand-or-complete-prefix, list-choices, menu-complete, menu-expand-or-complete, or
              reverse-menu-complete.  If the zsh/complist module is  loaded  (see  zshmodules(1))
              the widget menu-select is also available.

              When one of the key-sequences is typed, the function in the file will be invoked to
              generate the matches.  Note that a key will not be re-bound if it already was (that
              is,  was  bound to something other than undefined-key).  The widget created has the
              same name as the file and can be bound to any other keys using bindkey as usual.

       #compdef -K widget-name style key-sequences ...
              This is similar to -k except that only one key-sequences argument may be given  for
              each  widget-name  style  pair.   However, the entire set of three arguments may be
              repeated with a different set of arguments.   Note  in  particular  that  the  wid‐
              get-name  must be distinct in each set.  If it does not begin with `_' this will be
              added.  The widget-name should not clash with the  name  of  any  existing  widget:
              names based on the name of the function are most useful.  For example,

                     #compdef -K _foo_complete complete-word "^X^C" \
                       _foo_list list-choices "^X^D"

              (all  on  one line) defines a widget _foo_complete for completion, bound to `^X^C',
              and a widget _foo_list for listing, bound to `^X^D'.

       #autoload [ options ]
              Functions with the #autoload tag are marked for autoloading but are  not  otherwise
              treated  specially.  Typically they are to be called from within one of the comple‐
              tion functions.  Any options supplied will be passed to  the  autoload  builtin;  a
              typical use is +X to force the function to be loaded immediately.  Note that the -U
              and -z flags are always added implicitly.

       The # is part of the tag name and no white space is allowed after it.  The  #compdef  tags
       use  the  compdef  function  described  below; the main difference is that the name of the
       function is supplied implicitly.

       The special contexts for which completion functions can be defined are:

       -array-value-
              The right hand side of an array-assignment (`foo=(...)')

       -brace-parameter-
              The name of a parameter expansion within braces (`${...}')

       -assign-parameter-
              The name of a parameter in an assignment, i.e. on the left hand side of an `='

       -command-
              A word in command position

       -condition-
              A word inside a condition (`[[...]]')

       -default-
              Any word for which no other completion is defined

       -equal-
              A word beginning with an equals sign

       -first-
              This is tried before any other completion function.  The function  called  may  set
              the  _compskip  parameter  to  one of various values: all: no further completion is
              attempted; a string containing the substring patterns: no pattern completion  func‐
              tions will be called; a string containing default: the function for the `-default-'
              context will not be called, but functions defined for commands will

       -math- Inside mathematical contexts, such as `((...))'

       -parameter-
              The name of a parameter expansion (`$...')

       -redirect-
              The word after a redirection operator.

       -subscript-
              The contents of a parameter subscript.

       -tilde-
              After an initial tilde (`~'), but before the first slash in the word.

       -value-
              On the right hand side of an assignment.

       Default implementations are supplied for each of these contexts.  In most cases  the  con‐
       text  -context-  is implemented by a corresponding function _context, for example the con‐
       text `-tilde-' and the function `_tilde').

       The contexts -redirect- and -value- allow  extra  context-specific  information.   (Inter‐
       nally,  this is handled by the functions for each context calling the function _dispatch.)
       The extra information is added separated by commas.

       For the -redirect- context, the extra information is in the form  `-redirect-,op,command',
       where  op  is the redirection operator and command is the name of the command on the line.
       If there is no command on the line yet, the command field will be empty.

       For the -value- context, the form is `-value-,name,command', where name is the name of the
       parameter.   In  the  case  of  elements  of an associative array, for example `assoc=(key
       <TAB>', name is expanded to `name-key'.  In certain special contexts, such  as  completing
       after `make CFLAGS=', the command part gives the name of the command, here make; otherwise
       it is empty.

       It is not necessary to define fully specific completions as the  functions  provided  will
       try to generate completions by progressively replacing the elements with `-default-'.  For
       example, when completing after `foo=<TAB>', _value will try the names `-value-,foo,' (note
       the empty command part), `-value-,foo,-default-' and`-value-,-default-,-default-', in that
       order, until it finds a function to handle the context.

       As an example:

              compdef '_files -g "*.log"' '-redirect-,2>,-default-'

       completes files matching `*.log' after `2> <TAB>' for any command with  no  more  specific
       handler defined.

       Also:

              compdef _foo -value-,-default-,-default-

       specifies that _foo provides completions for the values of parameters for which no special
       function has been defined.  This is usually handled by the function _value itself.

       The same lookup rules are used when looking up styles (as described below); for example

              zstyle ':completion:*:*:-redirect-,2>,*:*' file-patterns '*.log'

       is another way to make completion after `2> <TAB>' complete files matching `*.log'.

   Functions
       The following function is defined by compinit and may be called directly.

       compdef [ -ane ] function names... [ -[pP] patterns... [ -N names... ] ]
       compdef -d names...
       compdef -k [ -an ] function style key-sequences...
       compdef -K [ -an ] function name style key-sequences ...
              The first form defines the function to call for completion in the given contexts as
              described for the #compdef tag above.

              Alternatively,  all  the  arguments  may have the form `cmd=service'.  Here service
              should already have been defined by `cmd1=service'  lines  in  #compdef  files,  as
              described  above.   The  argument for cmd will be completed in the same way as ser‐
              vice.

              The function argument may alternatively be a string  containing  almost  any  shell
              code.   If  the string contains an equal sign, the above will take precedence.  The
              option -e may be used to specify the first argument is to  be  evaluated  as  shell
              code even if it contains an equal sign.  The string will be executed using the eval
              builtin command to generate completions.  This provides a way of avoiding having to
              define a new completion function.  For example, to complete files ending in `.h' as
              arguments to the command foo:

                     compdef '_files -g "*.h"' foo

              The option -n prevents any completions already defined for the command  or  context
              from being overwritten.

              The option -d deletes any completion defined for the command or contexts listed.

              The names may also contain -p, -P and -N options as described for the #compdef tag.
              The effect on the argument list is identical, switching between definitions of pat‐
              terns tried initially, patterns tried finally, and normal commands and contexts.

              The  parameter $_compskip may be set by any function defined for a pattern context.
              If it is set to a value containing  the  substring  `patterns'  none  of  the  pat‐
              tern-functions  will  be  called;  if it is set to a value containing the substring
              `all', no other function will be called.

              The form with -k defines a widget with the same name as the function that  will  be
              called  for each of the key-sequences; this is like the #compdef -k tag.  The func‐
              tion should generate the completions needed and  will  otherwise  behave  like  the
              builtin  widget  whose name is given as the style argument.  The widgets usable for
              this are: complete-word,  delete-char-or-list,  expand-or-complete,  expand-or-com‐
              plete-prefix,    list-choices,    menu-complete,    menu-expand-or-complete,    and
              reverse-menu-complete, as well as menu-select if the zsh/complist module is loaded.
              The  option  -n prevents the key being bound if it is already to bound to something
              other than undefined-key.

              The form with -K is similar and defines multiple widgets based on  the  same  func‐
              tion,  each  of  which  requires  the  set  of  three  arguments  name,  style  and
              key-sequences, where the latter two are as for -k and the first must  be  a  unique
              widget name beginning with an underscore.

              Wherever  applicable,  the -a option makes the function autoloadable, equivalent to
              autoload -U function.

       The function compdef can be used to associate existing completion functions with new  com‐
       mands.  For example,

              compdef _pids foo

       uses the function _pids to complete process IDs for the command foo.

       Note also the _gnu_generic function described below, which can be used to complete options
       for commands that understand the `--help' option.

COMPLETION SYSTEM CONFIGURATION
       This section gives a short overview of how the completion  system  works,  and  then  more
       detail on how users can configure how and when matches are generated.

   Overview
       When  completion  is  attempted  somewhere on the command line the completion system first
       works out the context.  This takes account of a number of  things  including  the  command
       word  (such  as  `grep' or `zsh') and options to which the current word may be an argument
       (such as the `-o' option to zsh which takes a shell option as an argument).

       This context information is condensed into a string consisting of  multiple  fields  sepa‐
       rated  by  colons,  referred to simply as `the context' in the remainder of the documenta‐
       tion.  This is used to look up styles, context-sensitive options that can be used to  con‐
       figure  the  completion system.  The context used for lookup may vary during the same call
       to the completion system.

       The context string always consists of a fixed set of fields, separated by colons and  with
       a leading colon before the first, in the form :completion:function:completer:command:argu‐
       ment:tag.  These have the following meaning:

       ·      The literal string completion, saying that this style is  used  by  the  completion
              system.   This  distinguishes the context from those used by, for example, zle wid‐
              gets and ZFTP functions.


       ·      The function, if completion is called from a named widget rather than  through  the
              normal  completion  system.  Typically this is blank, but it is set by special wid‐
              gets such as predict-on and the various functions in the Widget  directory  of  the
              distribution to the name of that function, often in an abbreviated form.


       ·      The completer currently active, the name of the function without the leading under‐
              score and with other underscores converted to hyphens.  A `completer' is in overall
              control of how completion is to be performed; `complete' is the simplest, but other
              completers exist to perform related tasks such as correction, or to modify the  be‐
              haviour  of  a later completer.  See the section `Control Functions' below for more
              information.


       ·      The command or a special -context-, just at it appears following the  #compdef  tag
              or  the compdef function.  Completion functions for commands that have sub-commands
              usually modify this field to contain the name of the command followed  by  a  minus
              sign and the sub-command.  For example, the completion function for the cvs command
              sets this field to cvs-add when completing arguments to the add subcommand.


       ·      The argument; this indicates which command line or option argument we are  complet‐
              ing.   For  command  arguments this generally takes the form argument-n, where n is
              the number of the argument, and for arguments  to  options  the  form  option-opt-n
              where  n  is  the  number of the argument to option opt.  However, this is only the
              case if the command line is parsed with standard UNIX-style options and  arguments,
              so many completions do not set this.


       ·      The  tag.  As described previously, tags are used to discriminate between the types
              of matches a completion function can generate in a certain context.  Any completion
              function may use any tag name it likes, but a list of the more common ones is given
              below.


       The context is gradually put together as the functions are  executed,  starting  with  the
       main entry point, which adds :completion: and the function element if necessary.  The com‐
       pleter then adds the completer element.  The contextual completion adds  the  command  and
       argument  options.  Finally, the tag is added when the types of completion are known.  For
       example, the context name

              :completion::complete:dvips:option-o-1:files

       says that normal completion was attempted as the first argument to the option  -o  of  the
       command dvips:

              dvips -o ...

       and the completion function will generate filenames.

       Usually completion will be tried for all possible tags in an order given by the completion
       function.  However, this can be altered by using the tag-order style.  Completion is  then
       restricted to the list of given tags in the given order.

       The  _complete_help bindable command shows all the contexts and tags available for comple‐
       tion at a particular point.   This  provides  an  easy  way  of  finding  information  for
       tag-order and other styles.  It is described in the section `Bindable Commands' below.

       Styles  determine such things as how the matches are generated, similarly to shell options
       but with much more control.  They can have any number of strings as their value.  They are
       defined with the zstyle builtin command (see zshmodules(1)).

       When  looking  up styles the completion system uses full context names, including the tag.
       Looking up the value of a style therefore consists of two things:  the context, which  may
       be matched as a pattern, and the name of the style itself, which must be given exactly.

       For example, many completion functions can generate matches in a simple and a verbose form
       and use the verbose style to decide which form should be used.  To make all such functions
       use the verbose form, put

              zstyle ':completion:*' verbose yes

       in  a startup file (probably .zshrc).  This gives the verbose style the value yes in every
       context inside the completion system, unless that context has a more specific  definition.
       It  is  best to avoid giving the context as `*' in case the style has some meaning outside
       the completion system.

       Many such general purpose styles can be configured simply by using the  compinstall  func‐
       tion.

       A  more specific example of the use of the verbose style is by the completion for the kill
       builtin.  If the style is set, the builtin lists full job texts and process command lines;
       otherwise  it  shows  the  bare  job numbers and PIDs.  To turn the style off for this use
       only:

              zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*' verbose no

       For even more control, the style can use one of the tags `jobs' or `processes'.   To  turn
       off verbose display only for jobs:

              zstyle ':completion:*:*:kill:*:jobs' verbose no

       The  -e option to zstyle even allows completion function code to appear as the argument to
       a style; this requires some understanding of the internals of  completion  functions  (see
       see zshcompwid(1))).  For example,

              zstyle -e ':completion:*' hosts 'reply=($myhosts)'

       This  forces the value of the hosts style to be read from the variable myhosts each time a
       host name is needed; this is useful if the value of myhosts can change  dynamically.   For
       another  useful  example, see the example in the description of the file-list style below.
       This form can be slow and should be avoided for commonly examined styles such as menu  and
       list-rows-first.

       Note  that the order in which styles are defined does not matter; the style mechanism uses
       the most specific possible match for a particular style to determine the  set  of  values.
       More  precisely,  strings  are  preferred  over  patterns (for example, `:completion::com‐
       plete:foo' is more specific than `:completion::complete:*'), and longer patterns are  pre‐
       ferred over shorter patterns.

       Style  names like those of tags are arbitrary and depend on the completion function.  How‐
       ever, the following two sections list some of the most common tags and styles.

   Standard Tags
       Some of the following are only used when looking up particular styles and do not refer  to
       a type of match.

       accounts
              used to look up the users-hosts style

       all-expansions
              used by the _expand completer when adding the single string containing all possible
              expansions

       all-files
              for the names of  all  files  (as  distinct  from  a  particular  subset,  see  the
              globbed-files tag).

       arguments
              for arguments to a command

       arrays for names of array parameters

       association-keys
              for keys of associative arrays; used when completing inside a subscript to a param‐
              eter of this type

       bookmarks
              when completing bookmarks (e.g. for URLs and the zftp function suite)

       builtins
              for names of builtin commands

       characters
              for single characters in arguments of commands such as stty.   Also used when  com‐
              pleting character classes after an opening bracket

       colormapids
              for X colormap ids

       colors for color names

       commands
              for  names  of  external  commands.  Also used by complex commands such as cvs when
              completing names subcommands.

       contexts
              for contexts in arguments to the zstyle builtin command

       corrections
              used by the _approximate and _correct completers for possible corrections

       cursors
              for cursor names used by X programs

       default
              used in some contexts to provide a way of supplying a default  when  more  specific
              tags  are  also  valid.  Note that this tag is used when only the function field of
              the context name is set

       descriptions
              used when looking up the value of the format style  to  generate  descriptions  for
              types of matches

       devices
              for names of device special files

       directories
              for names of directories -- local-directories is used instead when completing argu‐
              ments of cd and related builtin commands when the cdpath array is set

       directory-stack
              for entries in the directory stack

       displays
              for X display names

       domains
              for network domains

       expansions
              used by the _expand completer for individual words (as opposed to the complete  set
              of expansions) resulting from the expansion of a word on the command line

       extensions
              for X server extensions

       file-descriptors
              for numbers of open file descriptors

       files  the generic file-matching tag used by functions completing filenames

       fonts  for X font names

       fstypes
              for file system types (e.g. for the mount command)

       functions
              names  of  functions  --  normally  shell  functions, although certain commands may
              understand other kinds of function

       globbed-files
              for filenames when the name has been generated by pattern matching

       groups for names of user groups

       history-words
              for words from the history

       hosts  for hostnames

       indexes
              for array indexes

       jobs   for jobs (as listed by the `jobs' builtin)

       interfaces
              for network interfaces

       keymaps
              for names of zsh keymaps

       keysyms
              for names of X keysyms

       libraries
              for names of system libraries

       limits for system limits

       local-directories
              for names of directories that are subdirectories of the current  working  directory
              when completing arguments of cd and related builtin commands (compare path-directo‐
              ries) -- when the cdpath array is unset, directories is used instead

       manuals
              for names of manual pages

       mailboxes
              for e-mail folders

       maps   for map names (e.g. NIS maps)

       messages
              used to look up the format style for messages

       modifiers
              for names of X modifiers

       modules
              for modules (e.g. zsh modules)

       my-accounts
              used to look up the users-hosts style

       named-directories
              for named directories (you wouldn't have guessed that, would you?)

       names  for all kinds of names

       newsgroups
              for USENET groups

       nicknames
              for nicknames of NIS maps

       options
              for command options

       original
              used by the _approximate, _correct and _expand completers when offering the  origi‐
              nal string as a match

       other-accounts
              used to look up the users-hosts style

       other-files
              for  the  names of any non-directory files.  This is used instead of all-files when
              the list-dirs-first style is in effect.

       packages
              for packages (e.g. rpm or installed Debian packages)

       parameters
              for names of parameters

       path-directories
              for names of directories found by searching the cdpath array when completing  argu‐
              ments of cd and related builtin commands (compare local-directories)

       paths  used to look up the values of the expand, ambiguous and special-dirs styles

       pods   for perl pods (documentation files)

       ports  for communication ports

       prefixes
              for prefixes (like those of a URL)

       printers
              for print queue names

       processes
              for process identifiers

       processes-names
              used  to  look up the command style when generating the names of processes for kil‐
              lall

       sequences
              for sequences (e.g. mh sequences)

       sessions
              for sessions in the zftp function suite

       signals
              for signal names

       strings
              for strings (e.g. the replacement strings for the cd builtin command)

       styles for styles used by the zstyle builtin command

       suffixes
              for filename extensions

       tags   for tags (e.g. rpm tags)

       targets
              for makefile targets

       time-zones
              for time zones (e.g. when setting the TZ parameter)

       types  for types of whatever (e.g. address types for the xhost command)

       urls   used to look up the urls and local styles when completing URLs

       users  for usernames

       values for one of a set of values in certain lists

       variant
              used by _pick_variant to look up the command to run when determining  what  program
              is installed for a particular command name.

       visuals
              for X visuals

       warnings
              used to look up the format style for warnings

       widgets
              for zsh widget names

       windows
              for IDs of X windows

       zsh-options
              for shell options

   Standard Styles
       Note  that  the  values  of  several of these styles represent boolean values.  Any of the
       strings `true', `on', `yes', and `1' can be used for the  value  `true'  and  any  of  the
       strings  `false',  `off', `no', and `0' for the value `false'.  The behavior for any other
       value is undefined except where explicitly mentioned.  The default  value  may  be  either
       true or false if the style is not set.

       Some  of  these  styles are tested first for every possible tag corresponding to a type of
       match, and if no style was found, for the default tag.  The most notable  styles  of  this
       type  are  menu, list-colors and styles controlling completion listing such as list-packed
       and last-prompt.  When tested for the default tag, only the function field of the  context
       will be set so that a style using the default tag will normally be defined along the lines
       of:

              zstyle ':completion:*:default' menu ...

       accept-exact
              This is tested for the default tag in addition to the tags valid  for  the  current
              context.   If  it  is set to `true' and any of the trial matches is the same as the
              string on the command line, this match will immediately be  accepted  (even  if  it
              would otherwise be considered ambiguous).

              When  completing  pathnames  (where the tag used is `paths') this style accepts any
              number of patterns as the value in  addition  to  the  boolean  values.   Pathnames
              matching  one  of  these  patterns will be accepted immediately even if the command
              line contains some more partially typed pathname components and these match no file
              under the directory accepted.

              This  style is also used by the _expand completer to decide if words beginning with
              a tilde or parameter expansion should be  expanded.   For  example,  if  there  are
              parameters  foo and foobar, the string `$foo' will only be expanded if accept-exact
              is set to `true'; otherwise the completion system will be allowed to complete  $foo
              to  $foobar. If the style is set to `continue', _expand will add the expansion as a
              match and the completion system will also be allowed to continue.

       accept-exact-dirs
              This is used by filename completion.  Unlike accept-exact  it  is  a  boolean.   By
              default,  filename completion examines all components of a path to see if there are
              completions of that component, even if the component matches an existing directory.
              For  example,  when completion after /usr/bin/, the function examines possible com‐
              pletions to /usr.

              When this style is true, any prefix of a path that matches an existing directory is
              accepted  without any attempt to complete it further.  Hence, in the given example,
              the path /usr/bin/ is accepted immediately and completion tried in that directory.

              If you wish to inhibit this behaviour entirely, set the path-completion style  (see
              below) to false.

       add-space
              This  style is used by the _expand completer.  If it is true (the default), a space
              will be inserted after all words resulting from the expansion, or a  slash  in  the
              case  of  directory  names.   If the value is `file', the completer will only add a
              space to names of existing files.  Either a boolean true or the value `file' may be
              combined  with  `subst',  in which case the completer will not add a space to words
              generated from the expansion of a substitution of the form `$(...)' or `${...}'.

              The _prefix completer uses this style as a simple boolean  value  to  decide  if  a
              space should be inserted before the suffix.

       ambiguous
              This applies when completing non-final components of filename paths, in other words
              those with a trailing slash.  If it is set, the cursor  is  left  after  the  first
              ambiguous component, even if menu completion is in use.  The style is always tested
              with the paths tag.

       assign-list
              When completing after an equals sign that is being treated as  an  assignment,  the
              completion  system  normally  completes only one filename.  In some cases the value
              may be a list of filenames separated by colons, as with PATH  and  similar  parame‐
              ters.   This  style  can  be  set  to a list of patterns matching the names of such
              parameters.

              The default is to complete lists when the word  on  the  line  already  contains  a
              colon.

       auto-description
              If set, this style's value will be used as the description for options that are not
              described by the completion functions, but that have  exactly  one  argument.   The
              sequence  `%d'  in the value will be replaced by the description for this argument.
              Depending on personal preferences, it may be useful to set this style to  something
              like `specify: %d'.  Note that this may not work for some commands.

       avoid-completer
              This  is  used  by the _all_matches completer to decide if the string consisting of
              all matches should be added to the list currently being generated.  Its value is  a
              list  of  names  of  completers.  If any of these is the name of the completer that
              generated the matches in this completion, the string will not be added.

              The default value for this style is `_expand _old_list _correct _approximate', i.e.
              it contains the completers for which a string with all matches will almost never be
              wanted.

       cache-path
              This style defines the path where any cache files containing dumped completion data
              are  stored.   It  defaults  to  `$ZDOTDIR/.zcompcache',  or `$HOME/.zcompcache' if
              $ZDOTDIR is not defined.   The  completion  cache  will  not  be  used  unless  the
              use-cache style is set.

       cache-policy
              This  style  defines  the  function  that will be used to determine whether a cache
              needs rebuilding.  See the section on the _cache_invalid function below.

       call-command
              This style is used in the function for commands such as make and ant where  calling
              the command directly to generate matches suffers problems such as being slow or, as
              in the case of make can potentially cause actions in the makefile to  be  executed.
              If it is set to `true' the command is called to generate matches. The default value
              of this style is `false'.

       command
              In many places, completion functions need to call external commands to generate the
              list of completions.  This style can be used to override the command that is called
              in some such cases.  The elements of the value are joined with  spaces  to  form  a
              command line to execute.  The value can also start with a hyphen, in which case the
              usual command will be added to the end; this is most useful for  putting  `builtin'
              or  `command' in front to make sure the appropriate version of a command is called,
              for example to avoid calling a shell function with the same  name  as  an  external
              command.

              As  an  example,  the  completion function for process IDs uses this style with the
              processes tag to generate the IDs to complete and the list of processes to  display
              (if  the  verbose  style  is `true').  The list produced by the command should look
              like the output of the ps command.   The  first  line  is  not  displayed,  but  is
              searched for the string `PID' (or `pid') to find the position of the process IDs in
              the following lines.  If the line does not contain `PID', the first numbers in each
              of the other lines are taken as the process IDs to complete.

              Note  that  the completion function generally has to call the specified command for
              each attempt to generate the completion list.  Hence care should be taken to  spec‐
              ify  only  commands  that  take a short time to run, and in particular to avoid any
              that may never terminate.

       command-path
              This is a list of directories to search for commands to complete.  The default  for
              this style is the value of the special parameter path.

       commands
              This  is used by the function completing sub-commands for the system initialisation
              scripts (residing in /etc/init.d or somewhere not too far  away  from  that).   Its
              values  give the default commands to complete for those commands for which the com‐
              pletion function isn't able to find them out automatically.  The default  for  this
              style are the two strings `start' and `stop'.

       complete
              This  is used by the _expand_alias function when invoked as a bindable command.  If
              set to `true' and the word on the command line is not the name of an alias,  match‐
              ing alias names will be completed.

       complete-options
              This  is  used by the completer for cd, chdir and pushd.  For these commands a - is
              used to introduce a directory stack entry and completion of these is far more  com‐
              mon  than completing options.  Hence unless the value of this style is true options
              will not be completed, even after an initial -.  If it is  true,  options  will  be
              completed after an initial - unless there is a preceding -- on the command line.

       completer
              The  strings  given  as  the value of this style provide the names of the completer
              functions to use. The available completer functions are described  in  the  section
              `Control Functions' below.

              Each  string may be either the name of a completer function or a string of the form
              `function:name'.  In the first case the completer field of the context will contain
              the  name of the completer without the leading underscore and with all other under‐
              scores replaced by hyphens.  In the second case the function is  the  name  of  the
              completer  to  call, but the context will contain the user-defined name in the com‐
              pleter field of the context.  If the name starts with a hyphen, the string for  the
              context  will be build from the name of the completer function as in the first case
              with the name appended to it.  For example:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _complete:-foo

              Here, completion will call the _complete completer twice, once using `complete' and
              once  using  `complete-foo' in the completer field of the context.  Normally, using
              the same completer more than once only  makes  sense  when  used  with  the  `func‐
              tions:name'  form, because otherwise the context name will be the same in all calls
              to the completer; possible exceptions to this rule are  the  _ignored  and  _prefix
              completers.

              The  default  value for this style is `_complete _ignored': only completion will be
              done, first using the ignored-patterns style and the $fignore array and then  with‐
              out ignoring matches.

       condition
              This  style  is  used  by  the  _list  completer function to decide if insertion of
              matches should be delayed unconditionally. The default is `true'.

       delimiters
              This style is used when adding a delimiter for use with history modifiers  or  glob
              qualifiers  that  have delimited arguments.  It is an array of preferred delimiters
              to add.  Non-special characters are preferred as the completion system  may  other‐
              wise become confused.  The default list is :, +, /, -, %.  The list may be empty to
              force a delimiter to be typed.

       disabled
              If this is set to `true', the _expand_alias completer and bindable command will try
              to expand disabled aliases, too.  The default is `false'.

       domains
              A  list  of  names  of  network domains for completion.  If this is not set, domain
              names will be taken from the file /etc/resolv.conf.

       environ
              The environ style is used when completing for `sudo'.  It is set  to  an  array  of
              `VAR=value'  assignments  to be exported into the local environment before the com‐
              pletion for the target command is invoked.
              zstyle ':completion:*:sudo::' environ \
                PATH="/sbin:/usr/sbin:$PATH" HOME="/root"

       expand This style is used when completing strings consisting of multiple  parts,  such  as
              path names.

              If one of its values is the string `prefix', the partially typed word from the line
              will be expanded as far as possible even if trailing parts cannot be completed.

              If one of its values is the string `suffix', matching names  for  components  after
              the  first  ambiguous one will also be added.  This means that the resulting string
              is the longest unambiguous string possible.  However, menu completion can  be  used
              to cycle through all matches.

       fake   This  style may be set for any completion context.  It specifies additional strings
              that will always be completed  in  that  context.   The  form  of  each  string  is
              `value:description';  the  colon  and  description  may be omitted, but any literal
              colons in value must be quoted with a backslash.  Any description provided is shown
              alongside the value in completion listings.

              It  is  important  to  use  a sufficiently restrictive context when specifying fake
              strings.  Note that the styles fake-files and  fake-parameters  provide  additional
              features when completing files or parameters.

       fake-always
              This  works identically to the fake style except that the ignored-patterns style is
              not applied to it.  This makes it possible to override a set of matches  completely
              by setting the ignored patterns to `*'.

              The  following shows a way of supplementing any tag with arbitrary data, but having
              it behave for display purposes like a separate tag.  In this  example  we  use  the
              features  of  the tag-order style to divide the named-directories tag into two when
              performing completion with the standard completer complete  for  arguments  of  cd.
              The  tag  named-directories-normal  behaves  as  normal, but the tag named-directo‐
              ries-mine contains a fixed set of directories.  This has the effect of  adding  the
              match group `extra directories' with the given completions.

                     zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*' tag-order \
                       'named-directories:-mine:extra\ directories
                       named-directories:-normal:named\ directories *'
                     zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*:named-directories-mine' \
                       fake-always mydir1 mydir2
                     zstyle ':completion::complete:cd:*:named-directories-mine' \
                       ignored-patterns '*'

       fake-files
              This  style  is used when completing files and looked up without a tag.  Its values
              are of the form `dir:names...'.  This will add the names (strings separated by spa‐
              ces)  as  possible  matches  when  completing in the directory dir, even if no such
              files really exist.  The dir may be a pattern; pattern characters or colons in  dir
              should be quoted with a backslash to be treated literally.

              This  can  be  useful  on systems that support special file systems whose top-level
              pathnames can not be listed or generated with glob patterns.  It can also  be  used
              for directories for which one does not have read permission.

              The pattern form can be used to add a certain `magic' entry to all directories on a
              particular file system.

       fake-parameters
              This is used by the completion function for parameter names.  Its values are  names
              of  parameters that might not yet be set but should be completed nonetheless.  Each
              name may also be followed by a colon and a string specifying the type of the param‐
              eter  (like  `scalar',  `array' or `integer').  If the type is given, the name will
              only be completed if parameters of that type are required in  the  particular  con‐
              text.  Names for which no type is specified will always be completed.

       file-list
              This  style  controls  whether files completed using the standard builtin mechanism
              are to be listed with a long list similar to ls -l.  Note that  this  feature  uses
              the  shell  module zsh/stat for file information; this loads the builtin stat which
              will replace any external stat executable.  To avoid this the following code can be
              included in an initialization file:

                     zmodload -i zsh/stat
                     disable stat

              The  style  may  either  be  set  to  a true value (or `all'), or one of the values
              `insert' or `list', indicating that files are to be listed in long  format  in  all
              circumstances, or when attempting to insert a file name, or when listing file names
              without attempting to insert one.

              More generally, the value may be an array of any of the  above  values,  optionally
              followed  by  =num.   If  num is present it gives the maximum number of matches for
              which long listing style will be used.  For example,

                     zstyle ':completion:*' file-list list=20 insert=10

              specifies that long format will be used when listing up to 20 files or inserting  a
              file  with  up to 10 matches (assuming a listing is to be shown at all, for example
              on an ambiguous completion), else short format will be used.

                     zstyle -e ':completion:*' file-list '(( ${+NUMERIC} )) && reply=(true)'

              specifies that long format will be used any time a numeric  argument  is  supplied,
              else short format.

       file-patterns
              This  is  used  by  the standard function for completing filenames, _files.  If the
              style is unset up to three  tags  are  offered,  `globbed-files',`directories'  and
              `all-files',  depending  on  the  types of files  expected by the caller of _files.
              The first two (`globbed-files' and `directories') are normally offered together  to
              make it easier to complete files in sub-directories.

              The  file-patterns  style  provides alternatives to the default tags, which are not
              used.  Its value consists of elements of the form `pattern:tag';  each  string  may
              contain any number of such specifications separated by spaces.

              The  pattern is a pattern that is to be used to generate filenames.  Any occurrence
              of the sequence `%p' is replaced by any pattern(s) passed by the  function  calling
              _files.  Colons in the pattern must be preceded by a backslash to make them distin‐
              guishable from the colon before the tag.  If more than one pattern is  needed,  the
              patterns can be given inside braces, separated by commas.

              The  tags of all strings in the value will be offered by _files and used when look‐
              ing up other styles.  Any tags in the same word will be offered at  the  same  time
              and before later words.  If no `:tag' is given the `files' tag will be used.

              The  tag  may also be followed by an optional second colon and a description, which
              will be used for the `%d' in the value of the format style (if that is set) instead
              of the default description supplied by the completion function.  If the description
              given here contains itself a `%d', that is replaced with the  description  supplied
              by the completion function.

              For  example,  to make the rm command first complete only names of object files and
              then the names of all files if there is no matching object file:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:*:rm:*' file-patterns \
                         '*.o:object-files' '%p:all-files'

              To alter the default behaviour of file completion -- offer files matching a pattern
              and  directories  on  the  first  attempt, then all files -- to offer only matching
              files on the first attempt, then directories, and finally all files:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' file-patterns \
                         '%p:globbed-files' '*(-/):directories' '*:all-files'

              This works even where there is no special pattern: _files matches all  files  using
              the  pattern  `*' at the first step and stops when it sees this pattern.  Note also
              it will never try a pattern more than once for a single completion attempt.

              During the execution of  completion  functions,  the  EXTENDED_GLOB  option  is  in
              effect, so the characters `#', `~' and `^' have special meanings in the patterns.

       file-sort
              The  standard  filename completion function uses this style without a tag to deter‐
              mine in which order the names should be listed; menu completion will cycle  through
              them in the same order.  The possible values are: `size' to sort by the size of the
              file; `links' to sort by the number of links to the file; `modification' (or `time'
              or  `date')  to  sort  by  the last modification time; `access' to sort by the last
              access time; and `inode' (or `change') to sort by the last inode change  time.   If
              the  style  is set to any other value, or is unset, files will be sorted alphabeti‐
              cally by name.  If the value contains the string `reverse', sorting is done in  the
              opposite  order.  If the value contains the string `follow', timestamps are associ‐
              ated with the targets of symbolic links; the default is to use  the  timestamps  of
              the links themselves.

       filter This  is  used  by  the  LDAP  plugin  for e-mail address completion to specify the
              attributes to match against when filtering entries.  So for example, if  the  style
              is set to `sn', matching is done against surnames.  Standard LDAP filtering is used
              so normal completion matching is bypassed.  If this style  is  not  set,  the  LDAP
              plugin  is  skipped.   You may also need to set the command style to specify how to
              connect to your LDAP server.

       force-list
              This forces a list of completions to be shown at any point where listing  is  done,
              even  in  cases  where the list would usually be suppressed.  For example, normally
              the list is only shown if there are at least two  different  matches.   By  setting
              this style to `always', the list will always be shown, even if there is only a sin‐
              gle match that will immediately be accepted.  The style may also be set to  a  num‐
              ber.   In this case the list will be shown if there are at least that many matches,
              even if they would all insert the same string.

              This style is tested for the default tag as well as for each tag valid for the cur‐
              rent completion.  Hence the listing can be forced only for certain types of match.

       format If  this  is set for the descriptions tag, its value is used as a string to display
              above matches in completion lists.  The  sequence  `%d'  in  this  string  will  be
              replaced  with a short description of what these matches are.  This string may also
              contain the following sequences to specify output attributes, as described  in  the
              section  EXPANSION  OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1): `%B', `%S', `%U', `%F', `%K'
              and their lower case counterparts, as well as `%{...%}'.  `%F', `%K' and  `%{...%}'
              take  arguments in the same form as prompt expansion.  Note that the %G sequence is
              not available; an argument to `%{' should be used instead.

              The style is tested with each tag valid for the current  completion  before  it  is
              tested for the descriptions tag.  Hence different format strings can be defined for
              different types of match.

              Note also that some completer functions define additional `%'-sequences.  These are
              described for the completer functions that make use of them.

              Some  completion  functions display messages that may be customised by setting this
              style for the messages tag.  Here, the `%d' is replaced with a message given by the
              completion function.

              Finally,  the  format  string  is  looked up with the warnings tag, for use when no
              matches could be generated at all.  In this case the  `%d'  is  replaced  with  the
              descriptions  for the matches that were expected separated by spaces.  The sequence
              `%D' is replaced with the same descriptions separated by newlines.

              It is possible to use printf-style field width specifiers  with  `%d'  and  similar
              escape  sequences.   This  is  handled  by  the  zformat  builtin  command from the
              zsh/zutil module, see zshmodules(1).

       glob   This is used by the _expand completer.  If it is set to `true' (the default), glob‐
              bing will be attempted on the words resulting from a previous substitution (see the
              substitute style) or else the original string from the line.

       global If this is set to `true' (the default), the _expand_alias  completer  and  bindable
              command will try to expand global aliases.

       group-name
              The  completion  system can group different types of matches, which appear in sepa‐
              rate lists.  This style can be used to give the  names  of  groups  for  particular
              tags.   For  example,  in command position the completion system generates names of
              builtin and external commands, names of aliases, shell functions and parameters and
              reserved  words  as  possible completions.  To have the external commands and shell
              functions listed separately:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:commands' group-name commands
                     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*:functions' group-name functions

              As a consequence, any match with the same tag will be displayed in the same group.

              If the name given is the empty string the name of the tag for the matches  will  be
              used  as  the  name  of the group.  So, to have all different types of matches dis‐
              played separately, one can just set:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' group-name ''

              All matches for which no group name is  defined  will  be  put  in  a  group  named
              -default-.

       group-order
              This  style  is additional to the group-name style to specify the order for display
              of the groups defined by that style (compare tag-order, which determines which com‐
              pletions  appear at all).  The groups named are shown in the given order; any other
              groups are shown in the order defined by the completion function.

              For example, to have names of builtin commands, shell functions and  external  com‐
              mands appear in that order when completing in command position:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*' group-order \
                            builtins functions commands

       groups A list of names of UNIX groups.  If this is not set, group names are taken from the
              YP database or the file `/etc/group'.

       hidden If this is set to true, matches for the given context will not be listed,  although
              any  description for the matches set with the format style will be shown.  If it is
              set to `all', not even the description will be displayed.

              Note that the matches will still be completed; they are just not shown in the list.
              To  avoid  having  matches considered as possible completions at all, the tag-order
              style can be modified as described below.

       hosts  A list of names of hosts that should be completed.  If this is not  set,  hostnames
              are taken from the file `/etc/hosts'.

       hosts-ports
              This  style  is  used  by commands that need or accept hostnames and network ports.
              The strings in the value should be of the form `host:port'.  Valid ports are deter‐
              mined by the presence of hostnames; multiple ports for the same host may appear.

       ignore-line
              This  is  tested  for  each  tag valid for the current completion.  If it is set to
              `true', none of the words that are already on the line will be considered as possi‐
              ble  completions.  If it is set to `current', the word the cursor is on will not be
              considered as a possible completion.  The value `current-shown' is similar but only
              applies  if  the list of completions is currently shown on the screen.  Finally, if
              the style is set to `other', all words on the line except for the current one  will
              be excluded from the possible completions.

              The  values  `current'  and  `current-shown'  are  a  bit  like the opposite of the
              accept-exact style:  only strings with missing characters will be completed.

              Note that you almost certainly don't want to set this to `true' or  `other'  for  a
              general context such as `:completion:*'.  This is because it would disallow comple‐
              tion of, for example, options multiple  times  even  if  the  command  in  question
              accepts the option more than once.

       ignore-parents
              The  style is tested without a tag by the function completing pathnames in order to
              determine whether to ignore the names of directories already mentioned in the  cur‐
              rent  word,  or  the name of the current working directory.  The value must include
              one or both of the following strings:

              parent The name of any directory whose path is already contained in the word on the
                     line  is ignored.  For example, when completing after foo/../, the directory
                     foo will not be considered a valid completion.

              pwd    The name of the current working directory will not be completed; hence,  for
                     example,  completion  after  ../ will not use the name of the current direc‐
                     tory.

              In addition, the value may include one or both of:

              ..     Ignore the specified directories only when the word on the line contains the
                     substring `../'.

              directory
                     Ignore  the  specified  directories  only when names of directories are com‐
                     pleted, not when completing names of files.

              Excluded values act in a similar fashion to values of the  ignored-patterns  style,
              so they can be restored to consideration by the _ignored completer.

       extra-verbose
              If  set,  the completion listing is more verbose at the cost of a probable decrease
              in completion speed.  Completion performance will suffer if this style  is  set  to
              `true'.

       ignored-patterns
              A  list  of  patterns;  any  trial  completion matching one of the patterns will be
              excluded from consideration.  The _ignored completer can appear in the list of com‐
              pleters to restore the ignored matches.  This is a more configurable version of the
              shell parameter $fignore.

              Note that the EXTENDED_GLOB option is set during the execution of completion  func‐
              tions, so the characters `#', `~' and `^' have special meanings in the patterns.

       insert This  style  is  used by the _all_matches completer to decide whether to insert the
              list of all matches unconditionally instead of adding the list as another match.

       insert-ids
              When completing process IDs, for example as arguments to the kill and wait builtins
              the  name  of  a command may be converted to the appropriate process ID.  A problem
              arises when the process name typed is not unique.  By default (or if this style  is
              set explicitly to `menu') the name will be converted immediately to a set of possi‐
              ble IDs, and menu completion will be started to cycle through them.

              If the value of the style is `single', the shell will wait until the user has typed
              enough  to make the command unique before converting the name to an ID; attempts at
              completion will be unsuccessful until that  point.   If  the  value  is  any  other
              string, menu completion will be started when the string typed by the user is longer
              than the common prefix to the corresponding IDs.

       insert-tab
              If this is set to `true', the completion system will insert a TAB character (assum‐
              ing  that was used to start completion) instead of performing completion when there
              is no non-blank character to the left of the cursor.  If it is set to `false', com‐
              pletion will be done even there.

              The  value  may  also  contain  the substrings `pending' or `pending=val'.  In this
              case, the typed character will be inserted  instead  of  starting  completion  when
              there is unprocessed input pending.  If a val is given, completion will not be done
              if there are at least that many characters of unprocessed  input.   This  is  often
              useful  when  pasting  characters into a terminal.  Note however, that it relies on
              the $PENDING special parameter from the zsh/zle module being set properly which  is
              not guaranteed on all platforms.

              The  default  value  of  this  style  is  `true' except for completion within vared
              builtin command where it is `false'.

       insert-unambiguous
              This is used by the _match and _approximate completers.  These completers are often
              used  with  menu completion since the word typed may bear little resemblance to the
              final completion.  However, if this style is `true', the completer will start  menu
              completion  only if it could find no unambiguous initial string at least as long as
              the original string typed by the user.

              In the case of the _approximate completer, the completer field in the context  will
              already  have  been  set to one of correct-num or approximate-num, where num is the
              number of errors that were accepted.

              In the case of the _match completer, the style may also be set to the string  `pat‐
              tern'.   Then  the pattern on the line is left unchanged if it does not match unam‐
              biguously.

       keep-prefix
              This style is used by the _expand completer.  If it is `true', the  completer  will
              try  to  keep a prefix containing a tilde or parameter expansion.  Hence, for exam‐
              ple, the string `~/f*' would be expanded to `~/foo'  instead  of  `/home/user/foo'.
              If  the  style  is  set  to  `changed'  (the default), the prefix will only be left
              unchanged if there were other changes between the expanded words and  the  original
              word  from  the  command  line.   Any  other value forces the prefix to be expanded
              unconditionally.

              The behaviour of expand when this style is true is to cause _expand to give up when
              a  single expansion with the restored prefix is the same as the original; hence any
              remaining completers may be called.

       last-prompt
              This is a more flexible form of the ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option.  If it is true,  the
              completion  system will try to return the cursor to the previous command line after
              displaying a completion list.  It is tested for all tags valid for the current com‐
              pletion,  then the default tag.  The cursor will be moved back to the previous line
              if  this  style  is  `true'  for  all  types  of  match.   Note  that  unlike   the
              ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT option this is independent of the numeric prefix argument.

       known-hosts-files
              This  style  should  contain  a  list of files to search for host names and (if the
              use-ip style is set) IP addresses in  a  format  compatible  with  ssh  known_hosts
              files.  If it is not set, the files /etc/ssh/ssh_known_hosts and ~/.ssh/known_hosts
              are used.

       list   This style is used by the _history_complete_word bindable command.  If it is set to
              `true' it has no effect.  If it is set to `false' matches will not be listed.  This
              overrides the setting of the options controlling listing behaviour,  in  particular
              AUTO_LIST.  The context always starts with `:completion:history-words'.

       list-colors
              If  the zsh/complist module is loaded, this style can be used to set color specifi‐
              cations.  This mechanism replaces the use of the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parame‐
              ters  described  in the section `The zsh/complist Module' in zshmodules(1), but the
              syntax is the same.

              If this style is set for the default tag, the strings in the  value  are  taken  as
              specifications  that  are  to be used everywhere.  If it is set for other tags, the
              specifications are used only for matches of the type described  by  the  tag.   For
              this to work best, the group-name style must be set to an empty string.

              In  addition  to setting styles for specific tags, it is also possible to use group
              names specified explicitly by the group-name tag together with the `(group)' syntax
              allowed  by  the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters and simply using the default
              tag.

              It is possible to use any color specifications already set up for the  GNU  version
              of the ls command:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:default' list-colors ${(s.:.)LS_COLORS}

              The  default  colors  are the same as for the GNU ls command and can be obtained by
              setting the style to an empty string (i.e. '').

       list-dirs-first
              This is used by file completion.  If set, directories to be  completed  are  listed
              separately  from and before completion for other files, regardless of tag ordering.
              In addition, the tag other-files is used in place of all-files  for  the  remaining
              files, to indicate that no directories are presented with that tag.

       list-grouped
              If  this style is `true' (the default), the completion system will try to make cer‐
              tain completion listings more compact by grouping matches.   For  example,  options
              for commands that have the same description (shown when the verbose style is set to
              `true') will appear as a single entry.  However, menu  selection  can  be  used  to
              cycle through all the matches.

       list-packed
              This  is  tested  for  each tag valid in the current context as well as the default
              tag.  If it is set to `true', the corresponding matches appear in  listings  as  if
              the  LIST_PACKED  option  were  set.  If it is set to `false', they are listed nor‐
              mally.

       list-prompt
              If this style is set for the default tag, completion lists that don't  fit  on  the
              screen  can  be scrolled (see the description of the zsh/complist module in zshmod‐
              ules(1)).  The value, if not the  empty  string,  will  be  displayed  after  every
              screenful  and  the  shell  will prompt for a key press; if the style is set to the
              empty string, a default prompt will be used.

              The value may contain the escape sequences: `%l' or `%L', which will be replaced by
              the  number of the last line displayed and the total number of lines; `%m' or `%M',
              the number of the  last match shown and the total number of matches; and  `%p'  and
              `%P',  `Top'  when  at  the beginning of the list, `Bottom' when at the end and the
              position shown as a percentage of the total length otherwise.   In  each  case  the
              form  with the uppercase letter will be replaced by a string of fixed width, padded
              to the  right with spaces, while the lowercase form will be replaced by a  variable
              width  string.   As in other prompt strings, the escape sequences `%S', `%s', `%B',
              `%b', `%U', `%u' for entering and leaving the  display  modes  standout,  bold  and
              underline,  and  `%F',  `%f',  `%K',  `%k'  for  changing the foreground background
              colour, are also available, as is the form `%{...%}' for enclosing escape sequences
              which display with zero (or, with a numeric argument, some other) width.

              After  deleting this prompt the variable LISTPROMPT should be unset for the removal
              to take effect.

       list-rows-first
              This style is tested in the same  way  as  the  list-packed  style  and  determines
              whether  matches are to be listed in a rows-first fashion as if the LIST_ROWS_FIRST
              option were set.

       list-suffixes
              This style is used by the function that completes filenames.  If it  is  true,  and
              completion  is  attempted  on a string containing multiple partially typed pathname
              components, all ambiguous components will be shown.  Otherwise, completion stops at
              the first ambiguous component.

       list-separator
              The  value  of  this  style is used in completion listing to separate the string to
              complete from a description when  possible  (e.g.  when  completing  options).   It
              defaults to `--' (two hyphens).

       local  This is for use with functions that complete URLs for which the corresponding files
              are available directly from the file system.  Its value  should  consist  of  three
              strings:  a  hostname,  the  path  to the default web pages for the server, and the
              directory name used by a user placing web pages within their home area.

              For example:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' local toast \
                         /var/http/public/toast public_html

              Completion after  `http://toast/stuff/'  will  look  for  files  in  the  directory
              /var/http/public/toast/stuff,   while completion after `http://toast/~yousir/' will
              look for files in the directory ~yousir/public_html.

       mail-directory
              If set, zsh will assume that mailbox files can be found in the directory specified.
              It defaults to `~/Mail'.

       match-original
              This  is  used  by  the _match completer.  If it is set to only, _match will try to
              generate matches without inserting a `*' at the cursor position.   If  set  to  any
              other  non-empty value, it will first try to generate matches without inserting the
              `*' and if that yields no matches, it will try again with the `*' inserted.  If  it
              is  unset  or set to the empty string, matching will only be performed with the `*'
              inserted.

       matcher
              This style is tested separately for each tag valid in  the  current  context.   Its
              value is tried before any match specifications given by the matcher-list style.  It
              should be in the form described in the section  `Completion  Matching  Control'  in
              zshcompwid(1).  For examples of this, see the description of the tag-order style.

       matcher-list
              This  style  can  be  set  to a list of match specifications that are to be applied
              everywhere. Match specifications are described in the section `Completion  Matching
              Control'  in  zshcompwid(1).  The completion system will try them one after another
              for each completer selected.  For example, to try first simple completion  and,  if
              that generates no matches, case-insensitive completion:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

              By  default  each specification replaces the previous one; however, if a specifica‐
              tion is prefixed with +, it is added to the existing list.  Hence it is possible to
              create increasingly general specifications without repetition:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' matcher-list '' '+m:{a-z}={A-Z}' '+m:{A-Z}={a-z}'

              It  is  possible  to create match specifications valid for particular completers by
              using the third field of the context.  This applies only to completers  that  over‐
              ride  the  global  matcher-list, which as of this writing includes only _prefix and
              _ignored.  For example, to use the  completers  _complete  and  _prefix  but  allow
              case-insensitive completion only with _complete:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _prefix
                     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*' matcher-list \
                            '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

              User-defined  names,  as  explained  for  the completer style, are available.  This
              makes it possible to try the same completer more than  once  with  different  match
              specifications  each  time.   For example, to try normal completion without a match
              specification, then normal completion with case-insensitive matching, then  correc‐
              tion, and finally partial-word completion:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _correct _complete:foo
                     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:*' matcher-list \
                         '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'
                     zstyle ':completion:*:foo:*' matcher-list \
                         'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z} r:|[-_./]=* r:|=*'

              If  the style is unset in any context no match specification is applied.  Note also
              that some completers such as _correct and _approximate do not use the match  speci‐
              fications at all, though these completers will only ever be called once even if the
              matcher-list contains more than one element.

              Where multiple specifications are useful, note that the entire completion  is  done
              for each element of matcher-list, which can quickly reduce the shell's performance.
              As a rough rule of thumb, one to three strings will  give  acceptable  performance.
              On  the  other  hand,  putting multiple space-separated values into the same string
              does not have an appreciable impact on performance.

              If there is no current matcher or it is empty, and the option  NO_CASE_GLOB  is  in
              effect,  the  matching for files is performed case-insensitively in any case.  How‐
              ever, any matcher must explicitly specify  case-insensitive  matching  if  that  is
              required.

       max-errors
              This  is used by the _approximate and _correct completer functions to determine the
              maximum number of errors to allow.  The completer will try to generate  completions
              by  first  allowing  one error, then two errors, and so on, until either a match or
              matches were found or the maximum number of errors given by  this  style  has  been
              reached.

              If  the  value for this style contains the string `numeric', the completer function
              will take any numeric argument as the maximum number of errors allowed.  For  exam‐
              ple, with

                     zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 2 numeric

              two errors are allowed if no numeric argument is given, but with a numeric argument
              of six (as in `ESC-6 TAB'), up to six errors are accepted.  Hence with a  value  of
              `0  numeric',  no correcting completion will be attempted unless a numeric argument
              is given.

              If the value contains the string `not-numeric', the completer will not try to  gen‐
              erate corrected completions when given a numeric argument, so in this case the num‐
              ber given should be greater than zero.  For example, `2 not-numeric' specifies that
              correcting  completion  with two errors will usually be performed, but if a numeric
              argument is given, correcting completion will not be performed.

              The default value for this style is `2 numeric'.

       max-matches-width
              This style is used to determine the trade off between the width of the display used
              for  matches and the width used for their descriptions when the verbose style is in
              effect.  The value gives the number of display columns to reserve for the  matches.
              The default is half the width of the screen.

              This has the most impact when several matches have the same description and so will
              be grouped together.  Increasing the style will allow more matches  to  be  grouped
              together; decreasing it will allow more of the description to be visible.

       menu   If  this  is true in the context of any of the tags defined for the current comple‐
              tion menu completion will be used.  The value for a specific tag will  take  prece‐
              dence over that for the `default' tag.

              If  none of the values found in this way is true but at least one is set to `auto',
              the shell behaves as if the AUTO_MENU option is set.

              If one of the values is explicitly set to false, menu completion will be explicitly
              turned off, overriding the MENU_COMPLETE option and other settings.

              In  the  form  `yes=num', where `yes' may be any of the true values (`yes', `true',
              `on' and `1'), menu completion will be turned on if there are at least num matches.
              In  the form `yes=long', menu completion will be turned on if the list does not fit
              on the screen.  This does not activate menu completion if the widget normally  only
              lists completions, but menu completion can be activated in that case with the value
              `yes=long-list' (Typically, the value `select=long-list' described  later  is  more
              useful as it provides control over scrolling.)

              Similarly, with any of the `false' values (as in `no=10'), menu completion will not
              be used if there are num or more matches.

              The value of this widget also  controls  menu  selection,  as  implemented  by  the
              zsh/complist  module.   The following values may appear either alongside or instead
              of the values above.

              If the value contains the string `select', menu selection will be started  uncondi‐
              tionally.

              In the form `select=num', menu selection will only be started if there are at least
              num matches.  If the values for more than one tag provide a  number,  the  smallest
              number is taken.

              Menu  selection  can  be  turned  off explicitly by defining a value containing the
              string`no-select'.

              It is also possible to start menu selection only if the list of  matches  does  not
              fit  on  the screen by using the value `select=long'.  To start menu selection even
              if the current widget only performs listing, use the value `select=long-list'.

              To turn on menu completion or menu selection when a there are a certain  number  of
              matches  or  the  list  of  matches  does not fit on the screen, both of `yes=' and
              `select=' may be  given  twice,  once  with  a  number  and  once  with  `long'  or
              `long-list'.

              Finally,  it is possible to activate two special modes of menu selection.  The word
              `interactive' in the value causes interactive mode to be entered  immediately  when
              menu  selection  is started; see the description of the zsh/complist module in zsh‐
              modules(1) for a description of interactive mode.  Including  the  string  `search'
              does  the same for incremental search mode.  To select backward incremental search,
              include the string `search-backward'.

       muttrc If set, gives the location of the mutt configuration file.  It defaults to `~/.mut‐
              trc'.

       numbers
              This  is used with the jobs tag.  If it is `true', the shell will complete job num‐
              bers instead of the shortest unambiguous prefix of the job command  text.   If  the
              value  is  a  number, job numbers will only be used if that many words from the job
              descriptions are required to resolve ambiguities.  For example,  if  the  value  is
              `1',  strings  will only be used if all jobs differ in the first word on their com‐
              mand lines.

       old-list
              This is used by the _oldlist completer.  If it is set to  `always',  then  standard
              widgets which perform listing will retain the current list of matches, however they
              were generated; this can be turned off explicitly with the  value  `never',  giving
              the  behaviour without the _oldlist completer.  If the style is unset, or any other
              value, then the existing list of completions is displayed if  it  is  not  already;
              otherwise, the standard completion list is generated; this is the default behaviour
              of _oldlist.  However, if there is an old list and this style contains the name  of
              the completer function that generated the list, then the old list will be used even
              if it was generated by a widget which does not do listing.

              For example, suppose you type ^Xc to use the _correct_word widget, which  generates
              a list of corrections for the word under the cursor.  Usually, typing ^D would gen‐
              erate a standard list of completions for the word on the  command  line,  and  show
              that.   With  _oldlist, it will instead show the list of corrections already gener‐
              ated.

              As another example consider the _match completer: with the insert-unambiguous style
              set  to  `true'  it inserts only a common prefix string, if there is any.  However,
              this may remove parts of the original pattern, so  that  further  completion  could
              produce  more  matches  than on the first attempt.  By using the _oldlist completer
              and setting this style to _match, the  list  of  matches  generated  on  the  first
              attempt will be used again.

       old-matches
              This  is  used  by  the  _all_matches completer to decide if an old list of matches
              should be used if one exists.  This is selected by one of the `true' values  or  by
              the  string `only'.  If the value is `only', _all_matches will only use an old list
              and won't have any effect on the list of matches currently being generated.

              If this style is set it is generally unwise  to  call  the  _all_matches  completer
              unconditionally.   One possible use is for either this style or the completer style
              to be defined with the -e option to zstyle to make the style conditional.

       old-menu
              This is used by the _oldlist completer.  It controls how  menu  completion  behaves
              when  a  completion has already been inserted and the user types a standard comple‐
              tion key such as TAB.  The default behaviour of _oldlist is  that  menu  completion
              always  continues  with  the existing list of completions.  If this style is set to
              `false', however, a new completion is started if the old list was  generated  by  a
              different completion command; this is the behaviour without the _oldlist completer.

              For  example, suppose you type ^Xc to generate a list of corrections, and menu com‐
              pletion is started in one of the usual ways.  Usually, or with this  style  set  to
              false,  typing  TAB at this point would start trying to complete the line as it now
              appears.  With _oldlist, it instead continues to cycle through the list of  correc‐
              tions.

       original
              This  is used by the _approximate and _correct completers to decide if the original
              string should be added as a possible completion.  Normally, this is  done  only  if
              there are at least two possible corrections, but if this style is set to `true', it
              is always added.  Note that the style will be examined with the completer field  in
              the  context name set to correct-num or approximate-num, where num is the number of
              errors that were accepted.

       packageset
              This style is used when completing arguments of the Debian `dpkg' program.  It con‐
              tains an override for the default package set for a given context.  For example,

                     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:dpkg:option--status-1:*' \
                                    packageset avail

              causes available packages, rather than only installed packages, to be completed for
              `dpkg --status'.

       path   The function that completes color names uses this style with the colors  tag.   The
              value  should  be the pathname of a file containing color names in the format of an
              X11 rgb.txt file.  If the style is not set but this file is found in one of various
              standard locations it will be used as the default.

       path-completion
              This  is used by filename completion.  By default, filename completion examines all
              components of a path to see if there are completions of that component.  For  exam‐
              ple,  /u/b/z  can  be  completed to /usr/bin/zsh.  Explicitly setting this style to
              false inhibits this behaviour for path components up to the /  before  the  cursor;
              this overrides the setting of accept-exact-dirs.

              Even  with  the style set to false, it is still possible to complete multiple paths
              by setting the option COMPLETE_IN_WORD and moving the cursor back to the first com‐
              ponent  in  the  path  to  be  completed.   For example, /u/b/z can be completed to
              /usr/bin/zsh if the cursor is after the /u.

       pine-directory
              If set, specifies the  directory  containing  PINE  mailbox  files.   There  is  no
              default,  since recursively searching this directory is inconvenient for anyone who
              doesn't use PINE.

       ports  A list of Internet service names (network ports) to complete.  If this is not  set,
              service names are taken from the file `/etc/services'.

       prefix-hidden
              This  is used for certain completions which share a common prefix, for example com‐
              mand options beginning with dashes.  If it is `true', the prefix will not be  shown
              in the list of matches.

              The default value for this style is `false'.

       prefix-needed
              This  style  is  also  relevant  for matches with a common prefix.  If it is set to
              `true' this common prefix must be typed by the user to generate the matches.

              The style is applicable to the options, signals, jobs,  functions,  and  parameters
              completion tags.

              For  command  options,  this means that the initial `-', `+', or `--' must be typed
              explicitly before option names will be completed.

              For signals, an initial `-' is required before signal names will be completed.

              For jobs, an initial `%' is required before job names will be completed.

              For function and parameter names, an initial `_' or `.' is required before function
              or parameter names starting with those characters will be completed.

              The default value for this style is `false' for function and parameter completions,
              and  `true' otherwise.

       preserve-prefix
              This style is used when completing path names.   Its  value  should  be  a  pattern
              matching  an  initial  prefix of the word to complete that should be left unchanged
              under all circumstances.  For example, on  some  Unices  an  initial  `//'  (double
              slash)  has  a special meaning; setting this style to the string `//' will preserve
              it.  As another example, setting this style to `?:/' under Cygwin would allow  com‐
              pletion after `a:/...' and so on.

       range  This is used by the _history completer and the _history_complete_word bindable com‐
              mand to decide which words should be completed.

              If it is a single number, only the last N words from the history will be completed.

              If it is a range of the form `max:slice', the last slice words will  be  completed;
              then  if  that yields no matches, the slice words before those will be tried and so
              on.  This process stops either when at least one match was been found, or max words
              have been tried.

              The default is to complete all words from the history at once.

       recursive-files
              If  this  style  is  set,  its  value  is an array of patterns to be tested against
              `$PWD/': note the trailing slash, which allows directories in  the  pattern  to  be
              delimited  unambiguously  by  including slashes on both sides.  If an ordinary file
              completion fails and the word on the command line does not  yet  have  a  directory
              part  to  its name, the style is retrieved using the same tag as for the completion
              just attempted, then the elements tested against $PWD/ in turn.   If  one  matches,
              then  the  shell  reattempts  completion by prepending the word on the command line
              with each directory in the expansion of **/*(/) in turn.  Typically the elements of
              the style will be set to restrict the number of directories beneath the current one
              to a manageable number, for example `*/.git/*'.

              For example,

                     zstyle ':completion:*' recursive-files '*/zsh/*'

              If the current directory is /home/pws/zsh/Src, then zle_trTAB can be  completed  to
              Zle/zle_tricky.c.

       regular
              This  style is used by the _expand_alias completer and bindable command.  If set to
              `true' (the default), regular aliases will be expanded but only  in  command  posi‐
              tion.   If it is set to `false', regular aliases will never be expanded.   If it is
              set to `always', regular aliases will be expanded even if not in command position.

       rehash If this is set when completing external commands, the internal list (hash) of  com‐
              mands  will  be  updated for each search by issuing the rehash command.  There is a
              speed penalty for this which is only likely to be noticeable  when  directories  in
              the path have slow file access.

       remote-access
              If  set  to  false, certain commands will be prevented from making Internet connec‐
              tions to retrieve remote information.  This includes the  completion  for  the  CVS
              command.

              It  is  not always possible to know if connections are in fact to a remote site, so
              some may be prevented unnecessarily.

       remove-all-dups
              The _history_complete_word bindable command and the _history completer use this  to
              decide  if  all  duplicate  matches should be removed, rather than just consecutive
              duplicates.

       select-prompt
              If this is set for the default tag, its value will be displayed during menu  selec‐
              tion (see the menu style above) when the completion list does not fit on the screen
              as a whole.  The same escapes as for the list-prompt style are  understood,  except
              that  the  numbers  refer to the match or line the mark is on.  A default prompt is
              used when the value is the empty string.

       select-scroll
              This style is tested for the default tag and determines how a  completion  list  is
              scrolled  during  a  menu  selection (see the menu style above) when the completion
              list does not fit on the screen as a whole.  If the value is `0' (zero),  the  list
              is  scrolled  by half-screenfuls; if it is a positive integer, the list is scrolled
              by the given number of lines; if it is a negative number, the list is scrolled by a
              screenful minus the absolute value of the given number of lines.  The default is to
              scroll by single lines.

       separate-sections
              This style is used with the manuals tag when completing names of manual pages.   If
              it  is  `true', entries for different sections are added separately using tag names
              of the form `manual.X', where X is the section number.  When the  group-name  style
              is  also  in  effect,  pages  from different sections will appear separately.  This
              style is also used similarly with the words style when  completing  words  for  the
              dict command. It allows words from different dictionary databases to be added sepa‐
              rately.  The default for this style is `false'.

       show-ambiguity
              If the zsh/complist module is loaded, this style can be used to highlight the first
              ambiguous  character  in  completion  lists. The value is either a color indication
              such as those supported by the list-colors style  or,  with  a  value  of  true,  a
              default of underlining is selected. The highlighting is only applied if the comple‐
              tion display strings correspond to the actual matches.

       show-completer
              Tested whenever a new completer is tried.  If it is  true,  the  completion  system
              outputs  a  progress  message  in  the listing area showing what completer is being
              tried.  The message will be overwritten by any output when  completions  are  found
              and is removed after completion is finished.

       single-ignored
              This  is used by the _ignored completer when there is only one match.  If its value
              is `show', the single match will be displayed but not inserted.  If  the  value  is
              `menu', then the single match and the original string are both added as matches and
              menu completion is started, making it easy to select either of them.

       sort   Many completion widgets call _description at some point which decides  whether  the
              matches  are added sorted or unsorted (often indirectly via _wanted or _requested).
              This style can be set explicitly to one of the usual true or  false  values  as  an
              override.   If it is not set for the context, the standard behaviour of the calling
              widget is used.

              The style is tested first against the full context including the tag, and  if  that
              fails to produce a value against the context without the tag.

              If  the  calling  widget explicitly requests unsorted matches, this is usually hon‐
              oured.  However, the default (unsorted) behaviour of  completion  for  the  command
              history may be overridden by setting the style to true.

              In  the  _expand  completer,  if it is set to `true', the expansions generated will
              always be sorted.  If it is set to `menu', then the expansions are only sorted when
              they  are  offered  as single strings but not in the string containing all possible
              expansions.

       special-dirs
              Normally, the completion code will not produce the directory names `.' and `..'  as
              possible  completions.   If  this  style is set to `true', it will add both `.' and
              `..' as possible completions; if it is set to `..', only `..' will be added.

              The following example sets special-dirs to `..' when the current prefix  is  empty,
              is  a  single  `.', or consists only of a path beginning with `../'.  Otherwise the
              value is `false'.

                     zstyle -e ':completion:*' special-dirs \
                        '[[ $PREFIX = (../)#(|.|..) ]] && reply=(..)'

       squeeze-slashes
              If set  to  `true',  sequences  of  slashes  in  filename  paths  (for  example  in
              `foo//bar') will be treated as a single slash.  This is the usual behaviour of UNIX
              paths.  However, by default the file completion function behaves as if there were a
              `*' between the slashes.

       stop   If  set  to `true', the _history_complete_word bindable command will stop once when
              reaching the beginning or end of the history.  Invoking _history_complete_word will
              then  wrap  around  to  the  opposite  end of the history.  If this style is set to
              `false' (the default), _history_complete_word will loop immediately as  in  a  menu
              completion.

       strip-comments
              If  set  to `true', this style causes non-essential comment text to be removed from
              completion matches.  Currently it is only used  when  completing  e-mail  addresses
              where  it  removes  any display name from the addresses, cutting them down to plain
              user@host form.

       subst-globs-only
              This is used by the _expand completer.  If it is set to `true', the expansion  will
              only  be  used if it resulted from globbing; hence, if expansions resulted from the
              use of the substitute style described below, but these were not further changed  by
              globbing, the expansions will be rejected.

              The default for this style is `false'.

       substitute
              This  boolean style controls whether the _expand completer will first try to expand
              all substitutions in the string (such as `$(...)' and `${...}').

              The default is `true'.

       suffix This is used by the _expand completer if the word starts with a tilde or contains a
              parameter  expansion.  If it is set to `true', the word will only be expanded if it
              doesn't have a suffix, i.e. if it is something like `~foo' or  `$foo'  rather  than
              `~foo/'  or  `$foo/bar', unless that suffix itself contains characters eligible for
              expansion.  The default for this style is `true'.

       tag-order
              This provides a mechanism for sorting how the tags available in a  particular  con‐
              text will be used.

              The  values  for  the style are sets of space-separated lists of tags.  The tags in
              each value will be tried at the same time; if no match is found, the next value  is
              used.  (See the file-patterns style for an exception to this behavior.)

              For example:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:complete:-command-:*' tag-order \
                         'commands functions'

              specifies  that  completion  in command position first offers external commands and
              shell functions.  Remaining tags will be tried if no completions are found.

              In addition to tag names, each string in the value may take one  of  the  following
              forms:

              -      If  any value consists of only a hyphen, then only the tags specified in the
                     other values are generated.  Normally all tags not explicitly  selected  are
                     tried  last  if the specified tags fail to generate any matches.  This means
                     that a single value consisting only of a single hyphen turns off completion.

              ! tags...
                     A string starting with an exclamation mark specifies names of tags that  are
                     not  to  be  used.  The effect is the same as if all other possible tags for
                     the context had been listed.

              tag:label ...
                     Here, tag is one of the standard  tags  and  label  is  an  arbitrary  name.
                     Matches  are  generated  as  normal  but  the name label is used in contexts
                     instead of tag.  This is not useful in words starting with !.

                     If the label starts with a hyphen, the tag is prepended to the label to form
                     the  name  used  for lookup.  This can be used to make the completion system
                     try a certain tag more than once, supplying  different  style  settings  for
                     each attempt; see below for an example.

              tag:label:description
                     As  before, but description will replace the `%d' in the value of the format
                     style instead of the default description supplied by  the  completion  func‐
                     tion.   Spaces  in  the description must be quoted with a backslash.  A `%d'
                     appearing in description is replaced with the description given by the  com‐
                     pletion function.

              In  any of the forms above the tag may be a pattern or several patterns in the form
              `{pat1,pat2...}'.  In this case all matching tags will be used except for any given
              explicitly in the same string.

              One  use  of  these features is to try one tag more than once, setting other styles
              differently on each attempt, but still to use all the other tags without having  to
              repeat  them  all.   For  example,  to make completion of function names in command
              position ignore all the completion functions starting with an underscore the  first
              time completion is tried:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:*:-command-:*' tag-order \
                         'functions:-non-comp *' functions
                     zstyle ':completion:*:functions-non-comp' ignored-patterns '_*'

              On  the  first  attempt,  all  tags  will  be offered but the functions tag will be
              replaced by functions-non-comp.  The ignored-patterns style is set for this tag  to
              exclude functions starting with an underscore.  If there are no matches, the second
              value of the tag-order style is used which completes functions  using  the  default
              tag, this time presumably including all function names.

              The matches for one tag can be split into different groups.  For example:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' tag-order \
                         'options:-long:long\ options
                          options:-short:short\ options
                          options:-single-letter:single\ letter\ options'

                     zstyle ':completion:*:options-long' ignored-patterns '[-+](|-|[^-]*)'
                     zstyle ':completion:*:options-short' ignored-patterns '--*' '[-+]?'
                     zstyle ':completion:*:options-single-letter' ignored-patterns '???*'

              With the group-names style set, options beginning with `--', options beginning with
              a single `-' or `+' but containing multiple characters, and  single-letter  options
              will be displayed in separate groups with different descriptions.

              Another  use of patterns is to try multiple match specifications one after another.
              The matcher-list style offers something similar, but it is tested very early in the
              completion  system and hence can't be set for single commands nor for more specific
              contexts.  Here is how to try normal completion  without  any  match  specification
              and,  if  that  generates  no  matches,  try  again with case-insensitive matching,
              restricting the effect to arguments of the command foo:

                     zstyle ':completion:*:*:foo:*' tag-order '*' '*:-case'
                     zstyle ':completion:*-case' matcher 'm:{a-z}={A-Z}'

              First, all the tags offered when completing after foo are tried  using  the  normal
              tag  name.   If  that  generates no matches, the second value of tag-order is used,
              which tries all tags again except that this time each has  -case  appended  to  its
              name  for  lookup  of styles.  Hence this time the value for the matcher style from
              the second call to zstyle in the example is used to make  completion  case-insensi‐
              tive.

              It is possible to use the -e option of the zstyle builtin command to specify condi‐
              tions for the use of particular tags.  For example:

                     zstyle -e '*:-command-:*' tag-order '
                         if [[ -n $PREFIX$SUFFIX ]]; then
                           reply=( )
                         else
                           reply=( - )
                         fi'

              Completion in command position will be attempted only if the string typed so far is
              not empty.  This is tested using the PREFIX special parameter; see zshcompwid for a
              description of parameters which are special  inside  completion  widgets.   Setting
              reply  to an empty array provides the default behaviour of trying all tags at once;
              setting it to an array containing only a hyphen disables the use of  all  tags  and
              hence of all completions.

              If  no tag-order style has been defined for a context, the strings `(|*-)argument-*
              (|*-)option-* values' and `options' plus all tags offered by the  completion  func‐
              tion  will  be  used  to  provide a sensible default behavior that causes arguments
              (whether normal command arguments or arguments of options) to be  completed  before
              option names for most commands.

       urls   This is used together with the urls tag by functions completing URLs.

              If  the value consists of more than one string, or if the only string does not name
              a file or directory, the strings are used as the URLs to complete.

              If the value contains only one string which is the name of a normal file  the  URLs
              are  taken  from  that file (where the URLs may be separated by white space or new‐
              lines).

              Finally, if the only string in the value names a directory, the directory hierarchy
              rooted  at this directory gives the completions.  The top level directory should be
              the file access method, such as `http', `ftp', `bookmark' and so on.  In many cases
              the  next  level  of  directories  will be a filename.  The directory hierarchy can
              descend as deep as necessary.

              For example,

                     zstyle ':completion:*' urls ~/.urls
                     mkdir -p ~/.urls/ftp/ftp.zsh.org/pub

              allows completion of all the components  of  the  URL  ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub  after
              suitable commands such as `netscape' or `lynx'.  Note, however, that access methods
              and files are completed separately, so if the hosts style is set hosts can be  com‐
              pleted without reference to the urls style.

              See  the  description in the function _urls itself for more information (e.g. `more
              $^fpath/_urls(N)').

       use-cache
              If this is set, the completion caching layer is activated for any completions which
              use  it (via the _store_cache, _retrieve_cache, and _cache_invalid functions).  The
              directory containing the cache files can be changed with the cache-path style.

       use-compctl
              If this style is set to a string not equal to false, 0, no, and off, the completion
              system  may use any completion specifications defined with the compctl builtin com‐
              mand.  If the style is unset, this is  done  only  if  the  zsh/compctl  module  is
              loaded.   The  string  may  also  contain  the substring `first' to use completions
              defined with `compctl -T', and  the  substring  `default'  to  use  the  completion
              defined with `compctl -D'.

              Note  that  this  is only intended to smooth the transition from compctl to the new
              completion system and may disappear in the future.

              Note also that the definitions from compctl will only be used if there is  no  spe‐
              cific  completion function for the command in question.  For example, if there is a
              function _foo to complete arguments to the  command  foo,  compctl  will  never  be
              invoked  for  foo.   However,  the  compctl  version will be tried if foo only uses
              default completion.

       use-ip By default, the function _hosts that completes host names strips IP addresses  from
              entries read from host databases such as NIS and ssh files.  If this style is true,
              the corresponding IP addresses can be completed as well.  This style is not use  in
              any context where the hosts style is set; note also it must be set before the cache
              of host names is generated (typically the first completion attempt).

       users  This may be set to a list of usernames to be completed.  If it is not set all user‐
              names  will  be  completed.  Note that if it is set only that list of users will be
              completed; this is because on some systems querying all users can take  a  prohibi‐
              tive amount of time.

       users-hosts
              The  values  of  this style should be of the form `user@host' or `user:host'. It is
              used for commands that need pairs of user- and hostnames.  These commands will com‐
              plete  usernames from this style (only), and will restrict subsequent hostname com‐
              pletion to hosts paired with that user in one of the values of the style.

              It is possible to group values for sets of commands which  allow  a  remote  login,
              such  as  rlogin and ssh, by using the my-accounts tag.  Similarly, values for sets
              of commands which usually refer to the accounts of other people, such as  talk  and
              finger,  can  be grouped by using the other-accounts tag.  More ambivalent commands
              may use the accounts tag.

       users-hosts-ports
              Like users-hosts but used for commands like telnet and containing  strings  of  the
              form `user@host:port'.

       verbose
              If set, as it is by default, the completion listing is more verbose.  In particular
              many commands show descriptions for options if this style is `true'.

       word   This is used by the _list completer, which prevents the  insertion  of  completions
              until a second completion attempt when the line has not changed.  The normal way of
              finding out if the line has changed is to compare its entire contents  between  the
              two  occasions.  If this style is true, the comparison is instead performed only on
              the current word.  Hence if completion is performed on another word with  the  same
              contents, completion will not be delayed.

CONTROL FUNCTIONS
       The  initialization  script compinit redefines all the widgets which perform completion to
       call the supplied widget function _main_complete.  This function acts as a wrapper calling
       the  so-called  `completer'  functions that generate matches.  If _main_complete is called
       with arguments, these are taken as the names of completer functions to be  called  in  the
       order  given.   If  no  arguments are given, the set of functions to try is taken from the
       completer style.  For example, to use normal completion and  correction  if  that  doesn't
       generate any matches:

              zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _correct

       after  calling  compinit.  The  default value for this style is `_complete _ignored', i.e.
       normally only ordinary completion is tried, first with the effect of the  ignored-patterns
       style and then without it.  The _main_complete function uses the return status of the com‐
       pleter functions to decide if other completers should be called.  If the return status  is
       zero, no other completers are tried and the _main_complete function returns.

       If  the  first  argument  to  _main_complete is a single hyphen, the arguments will not be
       taken as names of completers.  Instead, the second argument gives a name  to  use  in  the
       completer  field  of the context and the other arguments give a command name and arguments
       to call to generate the matches.

       The following completer functions are contained in the distribution,  although  users  may
       write  their  own.   Note that in contexts the leading underscore is stripped, for example
       basic completion is performed in the context `:completion::complete:...'.

       _all_matches
              This completer can be used to add a string consisting of all other matches.  As  it
              influences later completers it must appear as the first completer in the list.  The
              list of all matches is affected  by  the  avoid-completer  and  old-matches  styles
              described above.

              It  may be useful to use the _generic function described below to bind _all_matches
              to its own keystroke, for example:

                     zle -C all-matches complete-word _generic
                     bindkey '^Xa' all-matches
                     zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' old-matches only
                     zstyle ':completion:all-matches::::' completer _all_matches

              Note that this does not generate completions by itself:  first use any of the stan‐
              dard  ways  of  generating a list of completions, then use ^Xa to show all matches.
              It is possible instead to add a standard completer to the list and request that the
              list of all matches should be directly inserted:

                     zstyle ':completion:all-matches::::' completer _all_matches _complete
                     zstyle ':completion:all-matches:*' insert true

              In this case the old-matches style should not be set.

       _approximate
              This  is  similar  to  the  basic _complete completer but allows the completions to
              undergo corrections.  The  maximum  number  of  errors  can  be  specified  by  the
              max-errors style; see the description of approximate matching in zshexpn(1) for how
              errors are counted.  Normally this completer will only be tried  after  the  normal
              _complete completer:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete _approximate

              This  will  give  correcting  completion if and only if normal completion yields no
              possible completions.  When corrected completions are  found,  the  completer  will
              normally start menu completion allowing you to cycle through these strings.

              This  completer uses the tags corrections and original when generating the possible
              corrections and the original string.  The format style for the former  may  contain
              the  additional  sequences  `%e'  and  `%o' which will be replaced by the number of
              errors accepted to generate the corrections and the original string, respectively.

              The completer progressively increases the number of errors allowed up to the  limit
              by  the max-errors style, hence if a completion is found with one error, no comple‐
              tions with two errors will be shown, and so on.  It modifies the completer name  in
              the context to indicate the number of errors being tried: on the first try the com‐
              pleter field contains `approximate-1', on the second try  `approximate-2',  and  so
              on.

              When  _approximate  is called from another function, the number of errors to accept
              may be passed with the -a option.  The argument  is  in  the  same  format  as  the
              max-errors style, all in one string.

              Note  that this completer (and the _correct completer mentioned below) can be quite
              expensive to call, especially when a large number of errors are allowed.   One  way
              to  avoid  this  is  to set up the completer style using the -e option to zstyle so
              that some completers are only used when completion is attempted a  second  time  on
              the same string, e.g.:

                     zstyle -e ':completion:*' completer '
                       if [[ $_last_try != "$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR" ]]; then
                         _last_try="$HISTNO$BUFFER$CURSOR"
                         reply=(_complete _match _prefix)
                       else
                         reply=(_ignored _correct _approximate)
                       fi'

              This  uses  the  HISTNO parameter and the BUFFER and CURSOR special parameters that
              are available inside zle and completion widgets to find out  if  the  command  line
              hasn't  changed  since  the  last  time  completion  was  tried.  Only then are the
              _ignored, _correct and _approximate completers called.

       _complete
              This completer generates all possible completions in  a  context-sensitive  manner,
              i.e.  using  the settings defined with the compdef function explained above and the
              current settings of all special parameters.  This gives the normal  completion  be‐
              haviour.

              To  complete  arguments  of  commands, _complete uses the utility function _normal,
              which is in turn responsible for finding the particular function; it  is  described
              below.   Various contexts of the form -context- are handled specifically. These are
              all mentioned above as possible arguments to the #compdef tag.

              Before trying to find a function for a specific context, _complete  checks  if  the
              parameter  `compcontext'  is set. Setting `compcontext' allows the usual completion
              dispatching to be overridden which is useful in places such as a function that uses
              vared  for input. If it is set to an array, the elements are taken to be the possi‐
              ble matches which will be completed using the  tag  `values'  and  the  description
              `value'.  If  it  is set to an associative array, the keys are used as the possible
              completions and the values (if non-empty) are used as descriptions for the matches.
              If  `compcontext'  is  set  to a string containing colons, it should be of the form
              `tag:descr:action'.  In this case the tag and descr give the tag and description to
              use  and the action indicates what should be completed in one of the forms accepted
              by the _arguments utility function described below.

              Finally, if `compcontext' is set to a string without colons, the value is taken  as
              the  name  of  the context to use and the function defined for that context will be
              called.  For this purpose, there is a special  context  named  -command-line-  that
              completes  whole command lines (commands and their arguments).  This is not used by
              the completion system itself but is nonetheless handled when explicitly called.

       _correct
              Generate corrections, but not completions, for the current word; this is similar to
              _approximate  but  will  not  allow any number of extra characters at the cursor as
              that completer does.  The effect is similar to  spell-checking.   It  is  based  on
              _approximate, but the completer field in the context name is correct.

              For example, with:

                     zstyle ':completion:::::' completer _complete _correct _approximate
                     zstyle ':completion:*:correct:::' max-errors 2 not-numeric
                     zstyle ':completion:*:approximate:::' max-errors 3 numeric

              correction  will  accept up to two errors.  If a numeric argument is given, correc‐
              tion will not be performed, but correcting completion will be, and will  accept  as
              many  errors  as  given by the numeric argument.  Without a numeric argument, first
              correction and then correcting completion will be tried, with the first one accept‐
              ing two errors and the second one accepting three errors.

              When  _correct is called as a function, the number of errors to accept may be given
              following the -a option.  The argument is in the same form a values to  the  accept
              style, all in one string.

              This  completer  function is intended to be used without the _approximate completer
              or, as in the example, just before it.  Using it after the  _approximate  completer
              is  useless  since _approximate will at least generate the corrected strings gener‐
              ated by the _correct completer -- and probably more.

       _expand
              This completer function does not really perform completion, but instead  checks  if
              the  word  on  the  command  line  is  eligible  for expansion and, if it is, gives
              detailed control over how this expansion is done.  For this to happen, the  comple‐
              tion  system  needs  to  be invoked with complete-word, not expand-or-complete (the
              default binding for TAB), as otherwise the string will be expanded by  the  shell's
              internal  mechanism  before  the completion system is started.  Note also this com‐
              pleter should be called before the _complete completer function.

              The tags used when generating expansions are all-expansions for the string contain‐
              ing all possible expansions, expansions when adding the possible expansions as sin‐
              gle matches and original when adding the original string from the line.  The  order
              in  which  these  strings  are  generated,  if  at  all,  can  be controlled by the
              group-order and tag-order styles, as usual.

              The format string for all-expansions and for expansions may  contain  the  sequence
              `%o' which will be replaced by the original string from the line.

              The  kind  of  expansion  to  be  tried  is  controlled by the substitute, glob and
              subst-globs-only styles.

              It is also possible to call _expand as a function,  in  which  case  the  different
              modes  may  be  selected  with  options:  -s for substitute, -g for glob and -o for
              subst-globs-only.

       _expand_alias
              If the word the cursor is on is an alias, it is expanded and  no  other  completers
              are  called.   The types of aliases which are to be expanded can be controlled with
              the styles regular, global and disabled.

              This function is also a bindable  command,  see  the  section  `Bindable  Commands'
              below.

       _extensions
              If  the  cursor  follows  the  string  `*.', filename extensions are completed. The
              extensions are taken from files in current directory or a  directory  specified  at
              the beginning of the current word. For exact matches, completion continues to allow
              other completers such as _expand to expand the pattern. The standard add-space  and
              prefix-hidden styles are observed.

       _history
              Complete words from the shell's command  history.  This completer can be controlled
              by the remove-all-dups, and sort styles as for the _history_complete_word  bindable
              command, see the section `Bindable Commands' below and the section `Completion Sys‐
              tem Configuration' above.

       _ignored
              The ignored-patterns style can be set to a list  of  patterns  which  are  compared
              against possible completions; matching ones are removed.  With this completer those
              matches can be reinstated, as if no ignored-patterns style were set.  The completer
              actually  generates its own list of matches; which completers are invoked is deter‐
              mined in the same way as for the _prefix completer.  The  single-ignored  style  is
              also available as described above.

       _list  This  completer  allows  the insertion of matches to be delayed until completion is
              attempted a second time without the word on the line being changed.  On  the  first
              attempt, only the list of matches will be shown.  It is affected by the styles con‐
              dition and word, see the section `Completion System Configuration' above.

       _match This completer is intended to be used after the _complete  completer.   It  behaves
              similarly  but  the  string  on  the command line may be a pattern to match against
              trial completions.  This gives the effect of the GLOB_COMPLETE option.

              Normally completion will be performed by taking the pattern from the line,  insert‐
              ing  a `*' at the cursor position and comparing the resulting pattern with the pos‐
              sible completions generated.  This can be modified with  the  match-original  style
              described above.

              The  generated matches will be offered in a menu completion unless the insert-unam‐
              biguous style is set to `true'; see the description above  for  other  options  for
              this style.

              Note  that  matcher specifications defined globally or used by the completion func‐
              tions (the styles matcher-list and matcher) will not be used.

       _menu  This completer was written as simple example function to show how  menu  completion
              can  be enabled in shell code. However, it has the notable effect of disabling menu
              selection which can be useful with _generic based widgets. It should be used as the
              first  completer  in the list.  Note that this is independent of the setting of the
              MENU_COMPLETE option and does not work with the other menu completion widgets  such
              as reverse-menu-complete, or accept-and-menu-complete.

       _oldlist
              This completer controls how the standard completion widgets behave when there is an
              existing list of completions which may have been generated by a special  completion
              (i.e.  a  separately-bound  completion command).  It allows the ordinary completion
              keys to continue to use the list of completions thus generated, instead of  produc‐
              ing a new list of ordinary contextual completions.  It should appear in the list of
              completers before any of the widgets which generate matches.  It uses  two  styles:
              old-list and old-menu, see the section `Completion System Configuration' above.

       _prefix
              This  completer can be used to try completion with the suffix (everything after the
              cursor) ignored.  In other words, the suffix will not be considered to be  part  of
              the  word to complete.  The effect is similar to the expand-or-complete-prefix com‐
              mand.

              The completer style is used to decide which other completers are to  be  called  to
              generate  matches.  If this style is unset, the list of completers set for the cur‐
              rent context is used -- except, of course, the _prefix completer itself.   Further‐
              more, if this completer appears more than once in the list of completers only those
              completers not already tried by the last invocation of _prefix will be called.

              For example, consider this global completer style:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
                         _complete _prefix _correct _prefix:foo

              Here, the _prefix completer tries normal completion but ignoring  the  suffix.   If
              that  doesn't  generate any matches, and neither does the call to the _correct com‐
              pleter after it, _prefix will be called a second time and, now only trying  correc‐
              tion  with  the suffix ignored.  On the second invocation the completer part of the
              context appears as `foo'.

              To use _prefix as the last resort  and  try  only  normal  completion  when  it  is
              invoked:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' completer _complete ... _prefix
                     zstyle ':completion::prefix:*' completer _complete

              The  add-space  style  is also respected.  If it is set to `true' then _prefix will
              insert a space between the matches generated (if any) and the suffix.

              Note that this completer is only useful if the COMPLETE_IN_WORD option is set; oth‐
              erwise,  the cursor will be moved to the end of the current word before the comple‐
              tion code is called and hence there will be no suffix.

       _user_expand
              This completer behaves similarly to the  _expand  completer  but  instead  performs
              expansions  defined by users.  The styles add-space and sort styles specific to the
              _expand completer are usable with _user_expand in addition to other styles  handled
              more generally by the completion system.  The tag all-expansions is also available.

              The  expansion depends on the array style user-expand being defined for the current
              context; remember that the context for completers is less specific  than  that  for
              contextual completion as the full context has not yet been determined.  Elements of
              the array may have one of the following forms:
              $hash

                     hash is the name of an associative array.  Note this is not a full parameter
                     expression, merely a $, suitably quoted to prevent immediate expansion, fol‐
                     lowed by the name of an associative array.   If  the  trial  expansion  word
                     matches a key in hash, the resulting expansion is the corresponding value.
              _func

                     _func  is  the  name of a shell function whose name must begin with _ but is
                     not otherwise special to the completion system.  The function is called with
                     the  trial word as an argument.  If the word is to be expanded, the function
                     should set the array reply to a list of expansions.  Optionally, it can  set
                     REPLY  to  a  word  that will be used as a description for the set of expan‐
                     sions.  The return status of the function is irrelevant.
BINDABLE COMMANDS
       In addition to the context-dependent completions provided, which are expected to  work  in
       an  intuitively  obvious way, there are a few widgets implementing special behaviour which
       can be bound separately to keys.  The following is a list of these and their default bind‐
       ings.

       _bash_completions
              This  function  is used by two widgets, _bash_complete-word and _bash_list-choices.
              It exists to provide compatibility with completion  bindings  in  bash.   The  last
              character  of  the  binding  determines what is completed: `!', command names; `$',
              environment variables; `@', host names; `/', file names; `~' user names.  In  bash,
              the  binding preceded by `\e' gives completion, and preceded by `^X' lists options.
              As some of these bindings clash with standard zsh bindings, only  `\e~'  and  `^X~'
              are  bound  by  default.   To add the rest, the following should be added to .zshrc
              after compinit has been run:

                     for key in '!' '$' '@' '/' '~'; do
                       bindkey "\e$key" _bash_complete-word
                       bindkey "^X$key" _bash_list-choices
                     done

              This includes the bindings for `~' in case they were  already  bound  to  something
              else; the completion code does not override user bindings.

       _correct_filename (^XC)
              Correct  the  filename path at the cursor position.  Allows up to six errors in the
              name.  Can also be called with an argument to correct  a  filename  path,  indepen‐
              dently of zle; the correction is printed on standard output.

       _correct_word (^Xc)
              Performs  correction of the current argument using the usual contextual completions
              as possible choices. This stores the string `correct-word' in the function field of
              the context name and then calls the _correct completer.

       _expand_alias (^Xa)
              This function can be used as a completer and as a bindable command.  It expands the
              word the cursor is on if it is an alias.  The types of alias expanded can  be  con‐
              trolled with the styles regular, global and disabled.

              When  used  as  a  bindable  command  there  is  one additional feature that can be
              selected by setting the complete style to `true'.  In this case, if the word is not
              the name of an alias, _expand_alias tries to complete the word to a full alias name
              without expanding it.  It leaves the cursor directly after the  completed  word  so
              that invoking _expand_alias once more will expand the now-complete alias name.

       _expand_word (^Xe)
              Performs  expansion  on  the  current word:  equivalent to the standard expand-word
              command, but using the _expand completer.  Before calling it, the function field of
              the context is set to `expand-word'.

       _generic
              This function is not defined as a widget and not bound by default.  However, it can
              be used to define a widget and will then store the name of the widget in the  func‐
              tion  field of the context and call the completion system.  This allows custom com‐
              pletion widgets with their own set of style settings to  be  defined  easily.   For
              example,  to define a widget that performs normal completion and starts menu selec‐
              tion:

                     zle -C foo complete-word _generic
                     bindkey '...' foo
                     zstyle ':completion:foo:*' menu yes select=1

              Note in particular that the completer style may be set for the context in order  to
              change  the  set  of  functions  used to generate possible matches.  If _generic is
              called with arguments, those are passed through to _main_complete as  the  list  of
              completers in place of those defined by the completer style.

       _history_complete_word (\e/)
              Complete   words   from   the   shell's   command  history.  This  uses  the  list,
              remove-all-dups, sort, and stop styles.

       _most_recent_file (^Xm)
              Complete the name of the most recently modified file matching the  pattern  on  the
              command line (which may be blank).  If given a numeric argument N, complete the Nth
              most recently modified file.  Note the completion, if any, is always unique.

       _next_tags (^Xn)
              This command alters the set of matches used to that for the next  tag,  or  set  of
              tags,  either  as  given by the tag-order style or as set by default; these matches
              would otherwise not be available.  Successive  invocations  of  the  command  cycle
              through all possible sets of tags.

       _read_comp (^X^R)
              Prompt  the  user  for  a string, and use that to perform completion on the current
              word.  There are two possibilities for the string.  First, it can be a set of words
              beginning  `_',  for example `_files -/', in which case the function with any argu‐
              ments will be called to generate the completions.  Unambiguous parts of  the  func‐
              tion  name  will  be completed automatically (normal completion is not available at
              this point) until a space is typed.

              Second, any other string will be passed as a set of arguments to compadd and should
              hence be an expression specifying what should be completed.

              A  very  restricted  set  of editing commands is available when reading the string:
              `DEL' and `^H' delete the last character; `^U' deletes the line, and `^C' and  `^G'
              abort  the  function,  while `RET' accepts the completion.  Note the string is used
              verbatim as a command line, so arguments must be quoted in accordance with standard
              shell rules.

              Once  a  string  has  been  read, the next call to _read_comp will use the existing
              string instead of reading a new one.  To force  a  new  string  to  be  read,  call
              _read_comp with a numeric argument.

       _complete_debug (^X?)
              This  widget performs ordinary completion, but captures in a temporary file a trace
              of the shell commands executed by the completion system.  Each  completion  attempt
              gets its own file.  A command to view each of these files is pushed onto the editor
              buffer stack.

       _complete_help (^Xh)
              This widget displays information about the context names, the tags, and the comple‐
              tion  functions  used  when  completing  at the current cursor position. If given a
              numeric argument other than 1 (as in `ESC-2 ^Xh'), then the  styles  used  and  the
              contexts for which they are used will be shown, too.

              Note  that the information about styles may be incomplete; it depends on the infor‐
              mation available from the completion functions called, which in turn is  determined
              by the user's own styles and other settings.

       _complete_help_generic
              Unlike  other  commands  listed  here,  this must be created as a normal ZLE widget
              rather than a completion widget (i.e. with zle -N).  It is used for generating help
              with a widget bound to the _generic widget that is described above.

              If this widget is created using the name of the function, as it is by default, then
              when executed it will read a key sequence.  This is expected to be bound to a  call
              to  a  completion function that uses the _generic widget.  That widget will be exe‐
              cuted, and information provided in the same format that the  _complete_help  widget
              displays for contextual completion.

              If  the widget's name contains debug, for example if it is created as `zle -N _com‐
              plete_debug_generic _complete_help_generic', it will read and execute the keystring
              for  a generic widget as before, but then generate debugging information as done by
              _complete_debug for contextual completion.

              If the widget's name contains noread, it will not  read  a  keystring  but  instead
              arrange  that  the next use of a generic widget run in the same shell will have the
              effect as described above.

              The widget works by setting the shell parameter ZSH_TRACE_GENERIC_WIDGET  which  is
              read by _generic.  Unsetting the parameter cancels any pending effect of the noread
              form.

              For example, after executing the following:

                     zle -N _complete_debug_generic _complete_help_generic
                     bindkey '^x:' _complete_debug_generic

              typing `C-x :' followed by the key sequence for a generic widget will  cause  trace
              output for that widget to be saved to a file.

       _complete_tag (^Xt)
              This  widget  completes  symbol tags created by the etags or ctags programmes (note
              there is no connection with the completion system's tags) stored in a file TAGS, in
              the  format  used  by etags, or tags, in the format created by ctags.  It will look
              back up the path hierarchy for the first occurrence of either file; if both  exist,
              the  file  TAGS is preferred.  You can specify the full path to a TAGS or tags file
              by setting the parameter $TAGSFILE or $tagsfile  respectively.   The  corresponding
              completion tags used are etags and vtags, after emacs and vi respectively.

UTILITY FUNCTIONS
       Descriptions follow for utility functions that may be useful when writing completion func‐
       tions.  If functions are installed in subdirectories, most of these  reside  in  the  Base
       subdirectory.   Like  the  example functions for commands in the distribution, the utility
       functions generating matches all follow the convention of returning status  zero  if  they
       generated completions and non-zero if no matching completions could be added.

       Two more features are offered by the _main_complete function.  The arrays compprefuncs and
       comppostfuncs may contain names of functions that are to be called immediately  before  or
       after completion has been tried.  A function will only be called once unless it explicitly
       reinserts itself into the array.

       _all_labels [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ command args ... ]
              This is a convenient interface to the _next_label function below, implementing  the
              loop shown in the _next_label example.  The command and its arguments are called to
              generate the matches.  The options stored in the parameter name will  automatically
              be  inserted  into the args passed to the command.  Normally, they are put directly
              after the command, but if one of the args is a single  hyphen,  they  are  inserted
              directly  before that.  If the hyphen is the last argument, it will be removed from
              the argument list before the command is called.  This allows _all_labels to be used
              in almost all cases where the matches can be generated by a single call to the com‐
              padd builtin command or by a call to one of the utility functions.

              For example:

                     local expl
                     ...
                     if _requested foo; then
                       ...
                       _all_labels foo expl '...' compadd ... - $matches
                     fi

              Will complete the strings from the matches parameter, using compadd with additional
              options which will take precedence over those generated by _all_labels.

       _alternative [ -O name ] [ -C name ] spec ...
              This  function is useful in simple cases where multiple tags are available.  Essen‐
              tially it implements a loop like the one described for the _tags function below.

              The tags to use and the action to perform if a tag is requested are described using
              the  specs  which  are of the form: `tag:descr:action'.  The tags are offered using
              _tags and if the tag is requested, the action is executed with the  given  descrip‐
              tion  descr.   The actions are those accepted by the _arguments function (described
              below), excluding the `->state' and `=...' forms.

              For example, the action may be a simple function call:

                     _alternative \
                         'users:user:_users' \
                         'hosts:host:_hosts'

              offers usernames and hostnames as possible matches, generated  by  the  _users  and
              _hosts functions respectively.

              Like  _arguments, this function uses _all_labels to execute the actions, which will
              loop over all sets of tags.  Special handling is only required if there is an addi‐
              tional valid tag, for example inside a function called from _alternative.

              The  option  `-O  name'  is used in the same way as by the _arguments function.  In
              other words, the elements of the name array will be passed to compadd when  execut‐
              ing an action.

              Like  _tags  this  function supports the -C option to give a different name for the
              argument context field.

       _arguments [ -nswWCRS ] [ -A pat ] [ -O name ] [ -M matchspec ] [ : ] spec...
       _arguments [ opts... ] -- [ -i pats ] [ -s pair ] [ helpspec... ]
              This function can be used to give a complete specification  for  completion  for  a
              command  whose  arguments  follow  standard  UNIX  option and argument conventions.
              Options to _arguments itself must be in separate words, i.e. -s -w, not -sw.

              When calling _arguments, all specs that describe options of  the  analyzed  command
              line  must  precede  all specs that describe non-option (aka "normal") arguments of
              the analyzed line.  To avoid ambiguity, all options to  _arguments  itself  may  be
              separated from the spec forms by a single colon.

              The -s -w -W -A and -S options describe how parsing of the command line should pro‐
              ceed, and are discussed in context below.  The `--' form is  used  to  intuit  spec
              forms  from  the  help  output  of  the command being analyzed, and is described in
              detail below.  The opts for the `--' form are otherwise the  same  options  as  the
              first form.  Note that `-s' following `--' has a distinct meaning from `-s' preced‐
              ing `--', and both may appear.

              With the option -n, _arguments sets the parameter NORMARG to the  position  of  the
              first  normal  argument in the $words array, i.e. the position after the end of the
              options.  If that argument has not been reached, NORMARG is set to -1.  The  caller
              should  declare `integer NORMARG' if the -n option is passed; otherwise the parame‐
              ter is not used.

              The option `-M matchspec' sets a match specification to use  to  completion  option
              names and values.  The default matchspec is:

                     r:|[_-]=* r:|=*

              This  allows  partial  word completion after `_' and `-', for example `-f-b' can be
              completed to `-foo-bar'.

              Each of the following forms is a spec describing  individual  sets  of  options  or
              arguments on the command line being analyzed.

              n:message:action
              n::message:action
                     This  describes the n'th normal argument.  The message will be printed above
                     the matches generated and the action indicates what can be completed in this
                     position  (see below).  If there are two colons before the message the argu‐
                     ment is optional.  If the message contains only white space, nothing will be
                     printed  above  the  matches  unless  the  action adds an explanation string
                     itself.

              :message:action
              ::message:action
                     Similar, but describes the next argument, whatever number  that  happens  to
                     be.   If  all  arguments are specified in this form in the correct order the
                     numbers are unnecessary.

              *:message:action
              *::message:action
              *:::message:action
                     This describes how arguments (usually non-option arguments, those not begin‐
                     ning  with  -  or +) are to be completed when neither of the first two forms
                     was provided.  Any number of arguments can be completed in this fashion.

                     With two colons before the message, the words special array and the  CURRENT
                     special  parameter  are  modified to refer only to the normal arguments when
                     the action is executed or evaluated.  With three colons before  the  message
                     they  are  modified  to  refer  only to the normal arguments covered by this
                     description.

              optspec
              optspec:...
                     This describes an option.  The colon indicates  handling  for  one  or  more
                     arguments to the option; if it is not present, the option is assumed to take
                     no arguments.

                     By default, options are multi-character name, one `-word' per option.   With
                     -s,  options  may  be single characters, with more than one option per word,
                     although words starting with two hyphens, such as `--prefix', are still con‐
                     sidered complete option names.  This is suitable for standard GNU options.

                     The combination of -s with -w allows single-letter options to be combined in
                     a single word even if one or more of the options take arguments.  For  exam‐
                     ple,  if  -x  takes  an argument, with no -s `-xy' is considered as a single
                     (unhandled) option; with -s -xy is an option with  the  argument  `y';  with
                     both  -s  and  -w, -xy may be the option -x and the option -y with arguments
                     still to come.

                     The option -W takes this a stage further:  it is possible to  complete  sin‐
                     gle-letter  options  even  after  an  argument that occurs in the same word.
                     However, it depends on the action performed whether options will  really  be
                     completed  at  this  point.   For  more control, use a utility function like
                     _guard as part of the action.

                     The following forms are available for the initial optspec,  whether  or  not
                     the option has arguments.

                     *optspec
                            Here optspec is one of the remaining forms below.  This indicates the
                            following optspec may be repeated.  Otherwise  if  the  corresponding
                            option is already present on the command line to the left of the cur‐
                            sor it will not be offered again.

                     -optname
                     +optname
                            In the simplest form the optspec is just the  option  name  beginning
                            with  a minus or a plus sign, such as `-foo'.  The first argument for
                            the option (if any) must follow as a separate word directly after the
                            option.

                            Either  of  `-+optname'  and  `+-optname' can be used to specify that
                            -optname and +optname are both valid.

                            In all the remaining forms, the leading `-' may  be  replaced  by  or
                            paired with `+' in this way.

                     -optname-
                            The  first argument of the option must come directly after the option
                            name in the same word.  For example, `-foo-:...' specifies  that  the
                            completed option and argument will look like `-fooarg'.

                     -optname+
                            The  first  argument may appear immediately after optname in the same
                            word, or may appear as a separate word after the option.   For  exam‐
                            ple,  `-foo+:...'  specifies  that  the completed option and argument
                            will look like either `-fooarg' or `-foo arg'.

                     -optname=
                            The argument may appear as the next word, or  in  same  word  as  the
                            option  name provided that it is separated from it by an equals sign,
                            for example `-foo=arg' or `-foo arg'.

                     -optname=-
                            The argument to the option must appear after an equals  sign  in  the
                            same word, and may not be given in the next argument.

                     optspec[explanation]
                            An  explanation  string may be appended to any of the preceding forms
                            of optspec by enclosing it in brackets, as in `-q[query operation]'.

                            The verbose style is used to decide whether the  explanation  strings
                            are displayed with the option in a completion listing.

                            If  no bracketed explanation string is given but the auto-description
                            style is set and only one argument is described for this optspec, the
                            value  of the style is displayed, with any appearance of the sequence
                            `%d' in it replaced by the message of the first optarg  that  follows
                            the optspec; see below.

                     It  is  possible  for  options with a literal `+' or `=' to appear, but that
                     character must be quoted, for example `-\+'.

                     The options -S and -A are available to simplify the specifications for  com‐
                     mands  with  standard  option parsing.  With -S, no option will be completed
                     after a `--' appearing on its own on the line; this argument will  otherwise
                     be ignored; hence in the line

                            foobar -x -- -y

                     the  `-x'  is  considered  an option but the `-y' is considered an argument,
                     while the `--' is considered to be neither.

                     With -A, no options will be completed after the first non-option argument on
                     the  line.   The -A must be followed by a pattern matching all strings which
                     are not to be taken as arguments.  For example, to make _arguments stop com‐
                     pleting  options  after  the first normal argument, but ignoring all strings
                     starting with a hyphen even if they are not described by  one  of  the  opt‐
                     specs, the form is `-A "-*"'.

                     Each optarg following an optspec must take one of the following forms:

                     :message:action
                     ::message:action
                            An  argument  to  the  option;  message and action are treated as for
                            ordinary arguments.  In the first form, the  argument  is  mandatory,
                            and in the second form it is optional.

                            This group may be repeated for options which take multiple arguments.
                            In other words, :message1:action1:message2:action2 specifies that the
                            option takes two arguments.

                     :*pattern:message:action
                     :*pattern::message:action
                     :*pattern:::message:action
                            This  describes  multiple  arguments.   Only  the  last optarg for an
                            option taking multiple arguments may be given in this form.   If  the
                            pattern is empty (i.e., :*:), all the remaining words on the line are
                            to be completed as described by the action; otherwise, all the  words
                            up  to  and including a word matching the pattern are to be completed
                            using the action.

                            Multiple colons are treated as for the  `*:...'  forms  for  ordinary
                            arguments:   when  the  message  is preceded by two colons, the words
                            special array and the CURRENT special parameter are  modified  during
                            the  execution or evaluation of the action to refer only to the words
                            after the option.  When preceded by three colons, they  are  modified
                            to refer only to the words covered by this description.

              Any  literal  colon  in  an optname, message, or action must be preceded by a back‐
              slash, `\:'.

              Each of the forms above may be preceded by a list in parentheses  of  option  names
              and  argument numbers.  If the given option is on the command line, the options and
              arguments indicated in parentheses will not be offered.  For example, `(-two -three
              1)-one:...'  completes  the option `-one'; if this appears on the command line, the
              options -two and -three and the first ordinary argument will not be completed after
              it.   `(-foo):...' specifies an ordinary argument completion; -foo will not be com‐
              pleted if that argument is already present.

              Other items may appear in the list of excluded options to  indicate  various  other
              items  that should not be applied when the current specification is matched: a sin‐
              gle star (*) for the rest arguments (i.e. a specification of the form  `*:...');  a
              colon (:) for all normal (non-option-) arguments; and a hyphen (-) for all options.
              For example, if `(*)' appears before an option and the option appears on  the  com‐
              mand  line,  the list of remaining arguments (those shown in the above table begin‐
              ning with `*:') will not be completed.

              To aid in reuse of specifications, it is possible to precede any of the forms above
              with  `!';  then  the  form  will no longer be completed, although if the option or
              argument appears on the command line they will be skipped as normal.  The main  use
              for  this  is  when  the  arguments are given by an array, and _arguments is called
              repeatedly  for  more  specific   contexts:   on   the   first   call   `_arguments
              $global_options' is used, and on subsequent calls `_arguments !$^global_options'.

              In  each  of the forms above the action determines how completions should be gener‐
              ated.  Except for the `->string' form below, the action will be executed by calling
              the _all_labels function to process all tag labels.  No special handling of tags is
              needed unless a function call introduces a new one.

              The option `-O name' specifies the name of an array whose elements will  be  passed
              as arguments to functions called to execute actions.  For example, this can be used
              to pass the same set of options for the compadd builtin to all actions.

              The forms for action are as follows.

                (single unquoted space)
                     This is useful where an argument is required  but  it  is  not  possible  or
                     desirable  to generate matches for it.  The message will be displayed but no
                     completions listed.  Note that even in this case the colon at the end of the
                     message  is  needed;  it  may  only be omitted when neither a message nor an
                     action is given.

              (item1 item2 ...)
                     One of a list of possible matches, for example:

                            :foo:(foo bar baz)

              ((item1\:desc1 ...))
                     Similar to the above, but with descriptions for each possible  match.   Note
                     the backslash before the colon.  For example,

                            :foo:((a\:bar b\:baz))

                     The  matches will be listed together with their descriptions if the descrip‐
                     tion style is set with the values tag in the context.

              ->string
                     In this form, _arguments  processes  the  arguments  and  options  and  then
                     returns  control to the calling function with parameters set to indicate the
                     state of processing; the calling function then makes  its  own  arrangements
                     for  generating  completions.  For example, functions that implement a state
                     machine can use this type of action.

                     Where _arguments encounters action in the `->string' format, it  will  strip
                     all  leading  and trailing whitespace from string and set the array state to
                     the set of all strings for which an action is to be performed.  The elements
                     of  the  array state_descr are assigned the corresponding message field from
                     each optarg containing such an action.

                     By default and in common with all other well behaved  completion  functions,
                     _arguments  returns  status  zero if it was able to add matches and non-zero
                     otherwise. However, if the -R  option  is  given,  _arguments  will  instead
                     return a status of 300 to indicate that $state is to be handled.

                     In  addition  to  $state  and  $state_descr, _arguments also sets the global
                     parameters `context', `line' and `opt_args' as described below, and does not
                     reset  any  changes made to the special parameters such as PREFIX and words.
                     This gives the calling function the choice of resetting these parameters  or
                     propagating changes in them.

                     A  function  calling  _arguments  with  at  least  one  action  containing a
                     `->string' must therefore declare appropriate local parameters:

                            local context state state_descr line
                            typeset -A opt_args

                     to prevent _arguments from altering the global environment.

              {eval-string}
                     A string in braces is evaluated as shell code to generate matches.   If  the
                     eval-string itself does not begin with an opening parenthesis or brace it is
                     split into separate words before execution.

              = action
                     If the action starts with `= ' (an equals sign followed by a space),  _argu‐
                     ments  will insert the contents of the argument field of the current context
                     as the new first element in the words special array and increment the  value
                     of  the CURRENT special parameter.  This has the effect of inserting a dummy
                     word onto the completion command line while not changing the point at  which
                     completion is taking place.

                     This  is  most  useful with one of the specifiers that restrict the words on
                     the command line on which the action is to operate (the two- and three-colon
                     forms above).  One particular use is when an action itself causes _arguments
                     on a restricted range; it is necessary to use this trick to insert an appro‐
                     priate  command  name into the range for the second call to _arguments to be
                     able to parse the line.

               word...
              word...
                     This covers all forms other than those above.  If the action starts  with  a
                     space, the remaining list of words will be invoked unchanged.

                     Otherwise  it will be invoked with some extra strings placed after the first
                     word; these are to be passed down as options to the compadd  builtin.   They
                     ensure  that  the  state specified by _arguments, in particular the descrip‐
                     tions of options and arguments, is correctly passed to the  completion  com‐
                     mand.  These additional arguments are taken from the array parameter `expl';
                     this will be set up before executing the action and hence may be referred to
                     inside  it, typically in an expansion of the form `$expl[@]' which preserves
                     empty elements of the array.

              During the performance of the action the array `line' will be  set  to  the  normal
              arguments  from  the  command  line, i.e. the words from the command line after the
              command name excluding all options and their arguments.  Options are stored in  the
              associative  array  `opt_args' with option names as keys and their arguments as the
              values.  For options that have more than  one  argument  these  are  given  as  one
              string,  separated  by  colons.   All colons in the original arguments are preceded
              with backslashes.

              The parameter `context' is set when returning to the calling function to perform an
              action  of the form `->string'.  It is set to an array of elements corresponding to
              the elements of $state.  Each element is a suitable name for the argument field  of
              the  context:  either  a string of the form `option-opt-n' for the n'th argument of
              the option -opt, or a string of the form `argument-n' for the n'th  argument.   For
              `rest'  arguments,  that is those in the list at the end not handled by position, n
              is the string `rest'.  For example, when completing the argument of the -o  option,
              the  name is `option-o-1', while for the second normal (non-option-) argument it is
              `argument-2'.

              Furthermore, during the evaluation of the action the context name in the curcontext
              parameter is altered to append the same string that is stored in the context param‐
              eter.

              The option -C tells _arguments to modify the curcontext parameter for an action  of
              the  form `->state'.  This is the standard parameter used to keep track of the cur‐
              rent context.  Here it (and not the context array) should  be  made  local  to  the
              calling function to avoid passing back the modified value and should be initialised
              to the current value at the start of the function:

                     local curcontext="$curcontext"

              This is useful where it is not possible for multiple states to be valid together.

              It is possible to specify multiple sets of options and arguments with the sets sep‐
              arated  by single hyphens.  The specifications before the first hyphen (if any) are
              shared by all the remaining sets.  The first word in every  other  set  provides  a
              name  for  the  set  which  may appear in exclusion lists in specifications, either
              alone or before one of the possible values described above.  In the second  case  a
              `-' should appear between this name and the remainder.

              For example:

                     _arguments \
                         -a \
                       - set1 \
                         -c \
                       - set2 \
                         -d \
                         ':arg:(x2 y2)'

              This  defines  two  sets.  When the command line contains the option `-c', the `-d'
              option and the argument will not be considered possible completions.  When it  con‐
              tains  `-d' or an argument, the option `-c' will not be considered.  However, after
              `-a' both sets will still be considered valid.

              If the name given for one of the mutually exclusive sets is of  the  form  `(name)'
              then only one value from each set will ever be completed; more formally, all speci‐
              fications are mutually exclusive to all other specifications in the same set.  This
              is useful for defining multiple sets of options which are mutually exclusive and in
              which the options are aliases for each other.  For example:

                     _arguments \
                         -a -b \
                       - '(compress)' \
                         {-c,--compress}'[compress]' \
                       - '(uncompress)' \
                         {-d,--decompress}'[decompress]'

              As the completion code has to parse the command line separately for each  set  this
              form of argument is slow and should only be used when necessary.  A useful alterna‐
              tive is often an option specification with  rest-arguments  (as  in  `-foo:*:...');
              here the option -foo swallows up all remaining arguments as described by the optarg
              definitions.

              The option `--' allows _arguments to work out the names of long options  that  sup‐
              port  the `--help' option which is standard in many GNU commands.  The command word
              is called with the argument `--help' and the  output  examined  for  option  names.
              Clearly,  it  can  be dangerous to pass this to commands which may not support this
              option as the behaviour of the command is unspecified.

              In addition to options, `_arguments --' will try to deduce the types  of  arguments
              available  for  options when the form `--opt=val' is valid.  It is also possible to
              provide hints by examining the help text of the command and adding helpspec of  the
              form  `pattern:message:action'; note that other _arguments spec forms are not used.
              The pattern is matched against the help text for an option, and if it  matches  the
              message  and action are used as for other argument specifiers.  The special case of
              `*:' means both message and action are empty,  which  has  the  effect  of  causing
              options having no description in the help output to be ordered in listings ahead of
              options that have a description.

              For example:

                     _arguments -- '*\*:toggle:(yes no)' \
                                   '*=FILE*:file:_files' \
                                   '*=DIR*:directory:_files -/' \
                                   '*=PATH*:directory:_files -/'

              Here, `yes' and `no' will be completed as the argument of options whose description
              ends in a star; file names will be completed for options that contain the substring
              `=FILE' in the description; and directories will be  completed  for  options  whose
              description contains `=DIR' or `=PATH'.  The last three are in fact the default and
              so need not be given explicitly, although it is possible to  override  the  use  of
              these patterns.  A typical help text which uses this feature is:

                       -C, --directory=DIR          change to directory DIR

              so  that  the  above  specifications  will  cause directories to be completed after
              `--directory', though not after `-C'.

              Note also that _arguments tries to find out automatically if the  argument  for  an
              option  is optional.  This can be specified explicitly by doubling the colon before
              the message.

              If the pattern ends in `(-)', this will be removed from the pattern and the  action
              will be used only directly after the `=', not in the next word.  This is the behav‐
              iour of a normal specification defined with the form `=-'.

              The `_arguments --' can be followed by the option `-i patterns'  to  give  patterns
              for  options  which are not to be completed.  The patterns can be given as the name
              of an array parameter or as a literal list in parentheses.  For example,

                     _arguments -- -i \
                         "(--(en|dis)able-FEATURE*)"

              will cause completion to ignore the options `--enable-FEATURE' and  `--disable-FEA‐
              TURE' (this example is useful with GNU configure).

              The  `_arguments  --' form can also be followed by the option `-s pair' to describe
              option aliases.  The pair consists of a list of  alternating  patterns  and  corre‐
              sponding  replacements,  enclosed  in  parens  and quoted so that it forms a single
              argument word in the _arguments call.

              For  example,  some  configure-script  help  output  describes  options   only   as
              `--enable-foo',  but  the script also accepts the negated form `--disable-foo'.  To
              allow completion of the second form:

                     _arguments -- -s "(#--enable- --disable-)"

              Finally, note that _arguments generally expects to be the primary function handling
              any  completion  for  which  it is used.  It may have side effects which change the
              treatment of any matches added by other functions  called  after  it.   To  combine
              _arguments  with  other  functions,  those functions should be called either before
              _arguments, as an action within a spec, or in handlers for `->state' actions.

              Here is a more general example of the use of _arguments:

                     _arguments '-l+:left border:' \
                                '-format:paper size:(letter A4)' \
                                '*-copy:output file:_files::resolution:(300 600)' \
                                ':postscript file:_files -g \*.\(ps\|eps\)' \
                                '*:page number:'

              This describes three options: `-l', `-format', and `-copy'.  The  first  takes  one
              argument described as `left border' for which no completion will be offered because
              of the empty action.  Its argument may come directly after the `-l' or  it  may  be
              given as the next word on the line.

              The `-format' option takes one argument in the next word, described as `paper size'
              for which only the strings `letter' and `A4' will be completed.

              The `-copy' option may appear more than once on the  command  line  and  takes  two
              arguments.  The first is mandatory and will be completed as a filename.  The second
              is optional (because of the second colon before the description  `resolution')  and
              will be completed from the strings `300' and `600'.

              The  last  two  descriptions  say what should be completed as arguments.  The first
              describes the first argument as a `postscript file' and makes files ending in  `ps'
              or `eps' be completed.  The last description gives all other arguments the descrip‐
              tion `page numbers' but does not offer completions.

       _cache_invalid cache_identifier
              This function returns status zero if the completions  cache  corresponding  to  the
              given  cache  identifier  needs  rebuilding.   It determines this by looking up the
              cache-policy style for the current context.  This should provide  a  function  name
              which is run with the full path to the relevant cache file as the only argument.

              Example:

                     _example_caching_policy () {
                         # rebuild if cache is more than a week old
                         local -a oldp
                         oldp=( "$1"(Nm+7) )
                         (( $#oldp ))
                     }

       _call_function return name [ args ... ]
              If  a function name exists, it is called with the arguments args.  The return argu‐
              ment gives the name of a parameter in which the return  status  from  the  function
              name should be stored; if return is empty or a single hyphen it is ignored.

              The  return status of _call_function itself is zero if the function name exists and
              was called and non-zero otherwise.

       _call_program tag string ...
              This function provides a mechanism for the user to override the use of an  external
              command.   It  looks  up  the command style with the supplied tag.  If the style is
              set, its value is used as the command to execute.  The strings  from  the  call  to
              _call_program,  or from the style if set, are concatenated with spaces between them
              and the resulting string is evaluated.  The return status is the return  status  of
              the command called.

       _combination [ -s pattern ] tag style spec ... field opts ...
              This  function  is  used  to complete combinations of values,  for example pairs of
              hostnames and usernames.  The style argument gives  the  style  which  defines  the
              pairs; it is looked up in a context with the tag specified.

              The  style  name  consists  of  field  names  separated  by  hyphens,  for  example
              `users-hosts-ports'.  For each field for a value is already known, a  spec  of  the
              form `field=pattern' is given.  For example, if the command line so far specifies a
              user `pws', the argument `users=pws' should appear.

              The next argument with no equals sign is taken as the name of the field  for  which
              completions  should  be  generated  (presumably not one of the fields for which the
              value is known).

              The matches generated will be taken from the value of the style.  These should con‐
              tain  the  possible  values  for  the combinations in the appropriate order (users,
              hosts, ports in the example above).  The different fields the values for  the  dif‐
              ferent  fields  are separated by colons.  This can be altered with the option -s to
              _combination which specifies a pattern.  Typically this is a  character  class,  as
              for  example  `-s "[:@]"' in the case of the users-hosts style.    Each `field=pat‐
              tern' specification restricts the completions which apply to elements of the  style
              with appropriately matching fields.

              If  no  style  with  the given name is defined for the given tag, or if none of the
              strings in style's value match, but a function name of the required field  preceded
              by  an underscore is defined, that function will be called to generate the matches.
              For example, if there is no `users-hosts-ports' or no matching hostname when a host
              is required, the function `_hosts' will automatically be called.

              If  the  same name is used for more than one field, in both the `field=pattern' and
              the argument that gives the name of the field to be completed, the  number  of  the
              field  (starting with one) may be given after the fieldname, separated from it by a
              colon.

              All arguments after the required field name are passed to compadd  when  generating
              matches  from  the  style  value,  or  to  the functions for the fields if they are
              called.

       _describe [ -oO | -t tag ] descr name1 [ name2 ] opts ... -- ...
              This function associates completions with descriptions.  Multiple groups  separated
              by -- can be supplied, potentially with different completion options opts.

              The descr is taken as a string to display above the matches if the format style for
              the descriptions tag is set.  This is followed by one or two names of  arrays  fol‐
              lowed by options to pass to compadd.  The first array contains the possible comple‐
              tions with their descriptions in the form  `completion:description'.   Any  literal
              colons  in completion must be quoted with a backslash.  If a second array is given,
              it should have the same number of elements as the first; in this  case  the  corre‐
              sponding  elements  are  added  as  possible  completions instead of the completion
              strings from the first array.  The completion list  will  retain  the  descriptions
              from the first array.  Finally, a set of completion options can appear.

              If  the  option  `-o'  appears before the first argument, the matches added will be
              treated as names of command options (N.B. not shell options), typically following a
              `-',  `--' or `+' on the command line.  In this case _describe uses the prefix-hid‐
              den, prefix-needed and verbose styles to find out if the strings should be added as
              completions and if the descriptions should be shown.  Without the `-o' option, only
              the verbose style is used to decide how descriptions are shown.  If  `-O'  is  used
              instead of `-o', command options are completed as above but _describe will not han‐
              dle the prefix-needed style.

              With the -t option a tag can be specified.  The default is `values' or, if  the  -o
              option is given, `options'.

              If  selected  by  the  list-grouped  style,  strings with the same description will
              appear together in the list.

              _describe uses the _all_labels function to generate the matches,  so  it  does  not
              need to appear inside a loop over tag labels.

       _description [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ spec ... ]
              This  function  is not to be confused with the previous one; it is used as a helper
              function for creating options to compadd.  It is buried inside many of  the  higher
              level completion functions and so often does not need to be called directly.

              The styles listed below are tested in the current context using the given tag.  The
              resulting options for compadd are put into the array named name (this is tradition‐
              ally  `expl', but this convention is not enforced).  The description for the corre‐
              sponding set of matches is passed to the function in descr.

              The styles tested are: format, hidden, matcher,  ignored-patterns  and  group-name.
              The  format  style  is first tested for the given tag and then for the descriptions
              tag if no value was found, while the remainder are only tested for the tag given as
              the first argument.  The function also calls _setup which tests some more styles.

              The  string  returned  by  the  format  style (if any) will be modified so that the
              sequence `%d' is replaced by the descr given as  the  third  argument  without  any
              leading  or trailing white space.  If, after removing the white space, the descr is
              the empty string, the format style will not be used and the options  put  into  the
              name  array  will  not  contain  an  explanation  string  to be displayed above the
              matches.

              If _description is called with more than  three  arguments,  the  additional  specs
              should  be  of  the form `char:str'.  These supply escape sequence replacements for
              the format style: every appearance of `%char' will be replaced by string.

              If the -x option is given, the description will be passed to compadd using  the  -x
              option  instead  of  the  default -X.  This means that the description will be dis‐
              played even if there are no corresponding matches.

              The options placed in the array name take  account  of  the  group-name  style,  so
              matches are placed in a separate group where necessary.  The group normally has its
              elements sorted (by passing the option -J to compadd), but if  an  option  starting
              with  `-V',  `-J',  `-1',  or  `-2'  is passed to _description, that option will be
              included in the array.  Hence it  is  possible  for  the  completion  group  to  be
              unsorted by giving the option `-V', `-1V', or `-2V'.

              In most cases, the function will be used like this:

                     local expl
                     _description files expl file
                     compadd "$expl[@]" - "$files[@]"

              Note  the  use  of the parameter expl, the hyphen, and the list of matches.  Almost
              all calls to compadd within the  completion  system  use  a  similar  format;  this
              ensures  that user-specified styles are correctly passed down to the builtins which
              implement the internals of completion.

       _dispatch context string ...
              This sets the current context to context and looks for completion functions to han‐
              dle  this  context by hunting through the list of command names or special contexts
              (as described above for compdef) given as string ....  The first  completion  func‐
              tion to be defined for one of the contexts in the list is used to generate matches.
              Typically, the last string is -default- to cause the function for  default  comple‐
              tion to be used as a fallback.

              The  function  sets  the parameter $service to the string being tried, and sets the
              context/command field (the fourth) of the  $curcontext  parameter  to  the  context
              given as the first argument.

       _files The  function  _files calls _path_files with all the arguments it was passed except
              for -g and -/.  The use of  these  two  options  depends  on  the  setting  of  the
              file-patterns style.

              This  function  accepts  the  full set of options allowed by _path_files, described
              below.

       _gnu_generic
              This function is a simple wrapper around the _arguments function  described  above.
              It  can  be used to determine automatically the long options understood by commands
              that produce a list when passed the option `--help'.  It is intended to be used  as
              a  top-level  completion  function in its own right.  For example, to enable option
              completion for the commands foo and bar, use

                     compdef _gnu_generic foo bar

              after the call to compinit.

              The completion system as supplied is conservative in  its  use  of  this  function,
              since it is important to be sure the command understands the option `--help'.

       _guard [ options ] pattern descr
              This function is intended to be used in the action for the specifications passed to
              _arguments and similar functions.  It returns immediately with  a  non-zero  return
              status  if  the  string to be completed does not match the pattern.  If the pattern
              matches, the descr is displayed; the function then returns status zero if the  word
              to complete is not empty, non-zero otherwise.

              The  pattern  may  be preceded by any of the options understood by compadd that are
              passed down from _description, namely -M, -J, -V, -1, -2, -n, -F and  -X.   All  of
              these options will be ignored.  This fits in conveniently with the argument-passing
              conventions of actions for _arguments.

              As an example, consider a command taking the options -n and -none, where -n must be
              followed by a numeric value in the same word.  By using:

                     _arguments '-n-: :_guard "[0-9]#" "numeric value"' '-none'

              _arguments  can  be  made  to both display the message `numeric value' and complete
              options after `-n<TAB>'.  If the `-n' is already followed by  one  or  more  digits
              (the  pattern  passed to _guard) only the message will be displayed; if the `-n' is
              followed by another character, only options are completed.

       _message [ -r12 ] [ -VJ group ] descr
       _message -e [ tag ] descr
              The descr is used in the same way as the third argument to the  _description  func‐
              tion,  except that the resulting string will always be shown whether or not matches
              were generated.  This is useful for displaying a help message in  places  where  no
              completions can be generated.

              The  format  style  is  examined with the messages tag to find a message; the usual
              tag, descriptions, is used only if the style is not set with the former.

              If the -r option is given, no style is used; the descr is taken  literally  as  the
              string  to  display.  This is most useful when the descr comes from a pre-processed
              argument list which already contains an expanded description.

              The -12VJ options and the group are passed to compadd and hence determine the group
              the message string is added to.

              The second -e form gives a description for completions with the tag tag to be shown
              even if there are no matches for that tag.  This form is called  by  _arguments  in
              the  event  that  there  is  no action for an option specification.  The tag can be
              omitted and if so the tag is taken from the parameter $curtag; this  is  maintained
              by  the  completion  system  and  so is usually correct.  Note that if there are no
              matches at the time this function is called, compstate[insert] is cleared, so addi‐
              tional matches generated later are not inserted on the command line.

       _multi_parts sep array
              The  argument sep is a separator character.  The array may be either the name of an
              array parameter or a literal array in the form `(foo bar)', a parenthesised list of
              words  separated  by whitespace.  The possible completions are the strings from the
              array.  However, each chunk delimited by sep will  be  completed  separately.   For
              example, the _tar function uses `_multi_parts / patharray' to complete partial file
              paths from the given array of complete file paths.

              The -i option causes _multi_parts to insert a unique match even  if  that  requires
              multiple  separators  to  be  inserted.  This is not usually the expected behaviour
              with filenames, but certain other types of completion, for  example  those  with  a
              fixed set of possibilities, may be more suited to this form.

              Like  other  utility  functions,  this function accepts the `-V', `-J', `-1', `-2',
              `-n', `-f', `-X', `-M', `-P', `-S', `-r', `-R', and `-q' options and passes them to
              the compadd builtin.

       _next_label [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag name descr [ options ... ]
              This function is used to implement the loop over different tag labels for a partic‐
              ular tag as described above for the tag-order style.  On each call it checks to see
              if  there  are  any  more tag labels; if there is it returns status zero, otherwise
              non-zero.  As this function requires a current tag to be set, it must always follow
              a call to _tags or _requested.

              The  -x12VJ  options  and  the first three arguments are passed to the _description
              function.  Where appropriate the tag will be replaced by a tag label in this  call.
              Any  description  given  in the tag-order style is preferred to the descr passed to
              _next_label.

              The options given after the descr are set in the parameter given by name, and hence
              are to be passed to compadd or whatever function is called to add the matches.

              Here  is  a  typical  use of this function for the tag foo.  The call to _requested
              determines if tag foo is required at all; the loop  over  _next_label  handles  any
              labels defined for the tag in the tag-order style.

                     local expl ret=1
                     ...
                     if _requested foo; then
                       ...
                       while _next_label foo expl '...'; do
                         compadd "$expl[@]" ... && ret=0
                       done
                       ...
                     fi
                     return ret

       _normal
              This is the standard function called to handle completion outside any special -con‐
              text-.  It is called both to complete the command word and also the arguments for a
              command.   In the second case, _normal looks for a special completion for that com‐
              mand, and if there is none it uses the completion for the -default- context.

              A second use is to reexamine the command line specified by the $words array and the
              $CURRENT parameter after those have been modified.  For example, the function _pre‐
              command, which completes after pre-command specifiers such as  nohup,  removes  the
              first word from the words array, decrements the CURRENT parameter, then calls _nor‐
              mal again.  The effect is that `nohup cmd ...' is treated in the same way  as  `cmd
              ...'.

              If  the  command name matches one of the patterns given by one of the options -p or
              -P to compdef, the corresponding completion function is called and then the parame‐
              ter _compskip is checked.  If it is set completion is terminated at that point even
              if no matches have been found.  This is the same effect as in the -first- context.

       _options
              This can be used to complete the names of shell options.   It  provides  a  matcher
              specification   that  ignores  a  leading  `no',  ignores  underscores  and  allows
              upper-case letters to match their lower-case  counterparts  (for  example,  `glob',
              `noglob',  `NO_GLOB'  are all completed).  Any arguments are propagated to the com‐
              padd builtin.

       _options_set and _options_unset
              These functions complete only set or unset options, with the same matching specifi‐
              cation used in the _options function.

              Note  that  you  need  to  uncomment a few lines in the _main_complete function for
              these functions to work properly.  The lines in question  are  used  to  store  the
              option  settings in effect before the completion widget locally sets the options it
              needs.  Hence these functions are not generally used by the completion system.

       _parameters
              This is used to complete the names of shell parameters.

              The option `-g pattern' limits the completion to parameters whose type matches  the
              pattern.  The type of a parameter is that shown by `print ${(t)param}', hence judi‐
              cious use of `*' in pattern is probably necessary.

              All other arguments are passed to the compadd builtin.

       _path_files
              This function is used throughout the completion system to complete  filenames.   It
              allows  completion  of  partial paths.  For example, the string `/u/i/s/sig' may be
              completed to `/usr/include/sys/signal.h'.

              The options accepted by both _path_files and _files are:

              -f     Complete all filenames.  This is the default.

              -/     Specifies that only directories should be completed.

              -g pattern
                     Specifies that only files matching the pattern should be completed.

              -W paths
                     Specifies path prefixes that are to be prepended to the string from the com‐
                     mand  line to generate the filenames but that should not be inserted as com‐
                     pletions nor shown in completion listings.  Here, paths may be the  name  of
                     an  array  parameter,  a literal list of paths enclosed in parentheses or an
                     absolute pathname.

              -F ignored-files
                     This behaves as for the corresponding option to  the  compadd  builtin.   It
                     gives  direct control over which filenames should be ignored.  If the option
                     is not present, the ignored-patterns style is used.

              Both _path_files and _files also accept the following options which are  passed  to
              compadd:  `-J',  `-V',  `-1',  `-2',  `-n', `-X', `-M', `-P', `-S', `-q', `-r', and
              `-R'.

              Finally, the _path_files function  uses the styles expand, ambiguous, special-dirs,
              list-suffixes and file-sort described above.

       _pick_variant [ -b builtin-label ] [ -c command ] [ -r name ]
          label=pattern ... label [ args ... ]
              This  function  is  used to resolve situations where a single command name requires
              more than one type of handling, either because it has  more  than  one  variant  or
              because there is a name clash between two different commands.

              The  command  to run is taken from the first element of the array words unless this
              is overridden by the option -c.  This command is run and  its  output  is  compared
              with  a series of patterns.  Arguments to be passed to the command can be specified
              at the end after all the other arguments.  The patterns to try in order  are  given
              by  the  arguments label=pattern; if the output of `command args ...' contains pat‐
              tern, then label is selected as the label for the command variant.  If none of  the
              patterns match, the final command label is selected and status 1 is returned.

              If  the `-b builtin-label' is given, the command is tested to see if it is provided
              as a shell builtin, possibly autoloaded; if so, the label builtin-label is selected
              as the label for the variant.

              If the `-r name' is given, the label picked is stored in the parameter named name.

              The  results  are  also cached in the _cmd_variant associative array indexed by the
              name of the command run.

       _regex_arguments name spec ...
              This function generates a completion function name which matches the specifications
              spec  ...,  a  set  of  regular  expressions  as  described  below.   After running
              _regex_arguments, the function name should be called as a normal  completion  func‐
              tion.   The pattern to be matched is given by the contents of the words array up to
              the current cursor position joined together with null characters; no  quotation  is
              applied.

              The arguments are grouped as sets of alternatives separated by `|', which are tried
              one after the other until one matches.  Each alternative consists of a one or  more
              specifications  which  are  tried  left  to  right, with each pattern matched being
              stripped in turn from the command line being tested, until all of  the  group  suc‐
              ceeds  or until one fails; in the latter case, the next alternative is tried.  This
              structure can be repeated to arbitrary depth by using  parentheses;  matching  pro‐
              ceeds from inside to outside.

              A  special  procedure is applied if no test succeeds but the remaining command line
              string contains no null character (implying the remaining word is the one for which
              completions  are  to  be  generated).   The  completion target is restricted to the
              remaining word and any actions for the corresponding  patterns  are  executed.   In
              this  case, nothing is stripped from the command line string.  The order of evalua‐
              tion of the actions can be determined by the tag-order style; the  various  formats
              supported  by _alternative can be used in action.  The descr is used for setting up
              the array parameter expl.

              Specification arguments take one of following forms, in which  metacharacters  such
              as `(', `)', `#' and `|' should be quoted.

              /pattern/ [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
                     This  is  a single primitive component.  The function tests whether the com‐
                     bined pattern `(#b)((#B)pattern)lookahead*' matches the command line string.
                     If  so,  `guard' is evaluated and its return status is examined to determine
                     if the test has succeeded.  The pattern string `[]' is guaranteed  never  to
                     match.   The lookahead is not stripped from the command line before the next
                     pattern is examined.

                     The argument starting with : is used in the same manner as  an  argument  to
                     _alternative.

                     A  component  is  used as follows: pattern is tested to see if the component
                     already exists on the command line.  If it does,  any  following  specifica‐
                     tions are examined to find something to complete.  If a component is reached
                     but no such pattern exists yet on the command line,  the  string  containing
                     the action is used to generate matches to insert at that point.

              /pattern/+ [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
                     This  is  similar  to  `/pattern/ ...' but the left part of the command line
                     string (i.e. the part already matched by previous patterns) is also  consid‐
                     ered part of the completion target.

              /pattern/- [%lookahead%] [-guard] [:tag:descr:action]
                     This is similar to `/pattern/ ...' but the actions of the current and previ‐
                     ously matched patterns are ignored even if the following  `pattern'  matches
                     the empty string.

              ( spec )
                     Parentheses  may  be used to groups specs; note each parenthesis is a single
                     argument to _regex_arguments.

              spec # This allows any number of repetitions of spec.

              spec spec
                     The two specs are to be matched one after the other as described above.

              spec | spec
                     Either of the two specs can be matched.

              The function _regex_words can be used as a helper function to generate matches  for
              a  set  of  alternative  words  possibly with their own arguments as a command line
              argument.

              Examples:

                     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
                     /$'[^\0]#\0'/ :'compadd aaa'

              This generates a function _tst that completes aaa as its only  argument.   The  tag
              and description for the action have been omitted for brevity (this works but is not
              recommended in normal use).  The first component matches the command word, which is
              arbitrary;  the  second  matches  any argument.  As the argument is also arbitrary,
              any following component would not depend on aaa being present.

                     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
                     /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa'

              This is a more typical use; it is similar, but any following  patterns  would  only
              match if aaa was present as the first argument.

                     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \( \
                     /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa' \
                     /$'bbb\0'/ :'compadd bbb' \) \#

              In  this  example, an indefinite number of command arguments may be completed.  Odd
              arguments are completed as aaa and even arguments as bbb.  Completion fails  unless
              the set of aaa and bbb arguments before the current one is matched correctly.

                     _regex_arguments _tst /$'[^\0]#\0'/ \
                     \( /$'aaa\0'/ :'compadd aaa' \| \
                     /$'bbb\0'/ :'compadd bbb' \) \#

              This  is similar, but either aaa or bbb may be completed for any argument.  In this
              case _regex_words could be used to generate a suitable  expression  for  the  argu‐
              ments.

       _regex_words tag description spec ...
              This  function  can  be used to generate arguments for the _regex_arguments command
              which may be inserted at any point where a set of rules is expected.  The  tag  and
              description  give a standard tag and description pertaining to the current context.
              Each spec contains two or three arguments separated by a colon: note that there  is
              no leading colon in this case.

              Each spec gives one of a set of words that may be completed at this point, together
              with arguments.  It is thus roughly equivalent to the _arguments function when used
              in normal (non-regex) completion.

              The  part of the spec before the first colon is the word to be completed.  This may
              contain a *; the entire word, before and after the * is  completed,  but  only  the
              text  before the * is required for the context to be matched, so that further argu‐
              ments may be completed after the abbreviated form.

              The second part of spec is a description for the word being completed.

              The optional third part of the spec describes how words  following  the  one  being
              completed  are  themselves to be completed.  It will be evaluated in order to avoid
              problems with quoting.  This means that typically it contains  a  reference  to  an
              array containing previously generated regex arguments.

              The  option -t term specifies a terminator for the word instead of the usual space.
              This is handled as an auto-removable suffix in the manner of the option -s  sep  to
              _values.

              The  result  of  the processing by _regex_words is placed in the array reply, which
              should be made local to the calling function.  If the set of  words  and  arguments
              may  be  matched  repeatedly, a # should be appended to the generated array at that
              point.

              For example:

                     local -a reply
                     _regex_words mydb-commands 'mydb commands' \
                       'add:add an entry to mydb:$mydb_add_cmds' \
                       'show:show entries in mydb'
                     _regex_arguments _mydb "$reply[@]"
                     _mydb "$@"

              This shows a completion function for a command mydb which takes two  command  argu‐
              ments,  add  and  show.   show takes no arguments, while the arguments for add have
              already been prepared in an array mydb_add_cmds, quite possibly by a previous  call
              to _regex_words.

       _requested [ -x ] [ -12VJ ] tag [ name descr [ command args ... ] ]
              This  function  is  called  to decide whether a tag already registered by a call to
              _tags (see below) has been requested by the user and  hence  completion  should  be
              performed for it.  It returns status zero if the tag is requested and non-zero oth‐
              erwise.  The function is typically used as part of a loop over  different  tags  as
              follows:

                     _tags foo bar baz
                     while _tags; do
                       if _requested foo; then
                         ... # perform completion for foo
                       fi
                       ... # test the tags bar and baz in the same way
                       ... # exit loop if matches were generated
                     done

              Note  that  the  test for whether matches were generated is not performed until the
              end of the _tags loop.  This is so that the user can set  the  tag-order  style  to
              specify a set of tags to be completed at the same time.

              If  name and descr are given, _requested calls the _description function with these
              arguments together with the options passed to _requested.

              If command is given, the _all_labels function will be called immediately  with  the
              same arguments.  In simple cases this makes it possible to perform the test for the
              tag and the matching in one go.  For example:

                     local expl ret=1
                     _tags foo bar baz
                     while _tags; do
                       _requested foo expl 'description' \
                           compadd foobar foobaz && ret=0
                       ...
                       (( ret )) || break
                     done

              If the command is not compadd, it must nevertheless be prepared to handle the  same
              options.

       _retrieve_cache cache_identifier
              This function retrieves completion information from the file given by cache_identi‐
              fier, stored in a directory specified by the cache-path  style  which  defaults  to
              ~/.zcompcache.   The  return  status  is zero if retrieval was successful.  It will
              only attempt retrieval if the use-cache style is set, so you can call this function
              without worrying about whether the user wanted to use the caching layer.

              See _store_cache below for more details.

       _sep_parts
              This function is passed alternating arrays and separators as arguments.  The arrays
              specify completions for parts of strings to be separated by  the  separators.   The
              arrays  may be the names of array parameters or a quoted list of words in parenthe‐
              ses.  For example, with the array `hosts=(ftp news)'  the  call  `_sep_parts  '(foo
              bar)'  @  hosts'  will  complete  the  string  `f' to `foo' and the string `b@n' to
              `bar@news'.

              This function accepts the compadd options `-V', `-J', `-1', `-2', `-n', `-X', `-M',
              `-P',  `-S', `-r', `-R', and `-q' and passes them on to the compadd builtin used to
              add the matches.

       _sequence [ -s sep ] [ -n max ] [ -d ] function [ - ] ...
              This function is a wrapper to other functions for completing items in  a  separated
              list. The same function is used to complete each item in the list. The separator is
              specified with the -s option. If -s is omitted it will use  `,'.  Duplicate  values
              are  not  matched  unless -d is specified. If there is a fixed or maximum number of
              items in the list, this can be specified with the -n option.

              Common compadd options are passed on to the function. It is possible to use compadd
              directly with _sequence, though _values may be more appropriate in this situation.

       _setup tag [ group ]
              This  function  sets up the special parameters used by the completion system appro‐
              priately for the tag given as the first argument.  It uses the styles  list-colors,
              list-packed, list-rows-first, last-prompt, accept-exact, menu and force-list.

              The  optional  group  supplies  the  name of the group in which the matches will be
              placed.  If it is not given, the tag is used as the group name.

              This function is called automatically from _description and hence is  not  normally
              called explicitly.

       _store_cache cache_identifier params ...
              This  function,  together  with  _retrieve_cache  and  _cache_invalid, implements a
              caching layer which can be used in  any  completion  function.   Data  obtained  by
              costly  operations are stored in parameters; this function then dumps the values of
              those parameters to a file.  The data can then be retrieved quickly from that  file
              via _retrieve_cache, even in different instances of the shell.

              The  cache_identifier  specifies  the file which the data should be dumped to.  The
              file is stored in a directory specified by the cache-path style which  defaults  to
              ~/.zcompcache.   The  remaining  params arguments are the parameters to dump to the
              file.

              The return status is zero if  storage  was  successful.   The  function  will  only
              attempt  storage if the use-cache style is set, so you can call this function with‐
              out worrying about whether the user wanted to use the caching layer.

              The completion function may avoid calling _retrieve_cache when it already  has  the
              completion  data  available  as  parameters.   However, in that case it should call
              _cache_invalid to check whether the data in the parameters and  in  the  cache  are
              still valid.

              See  the _perl_modules completion function for a simple example of the usage of the
              caching layer.

       _tags [ [ -C name ] tags ... ]
              If called with arguments, these are taken to be the names of tags valid for comple‐
              tions in the current context.  These tags are stored internally and sorted by using
              the tag-order style.

              Next, _tags is called repeatedly without arguments from the same  completion  func‐
              tion.   This  successively selects the first, second, etc. set of tags requested by
              the user.  The return status is zero if at least one of the tags is  requested  and
              non-zero  otherwise.   To  test  if a particular tag is to be tried, the _requested
              function should be called (see above).

              If `-C name' is given, name is temporarily stored in the argument field (the fifth)
              of  the  context in the curcontext parameter during the call to _tags; the field is
              restored on exit.  This allows _tags to use a more specific context without  having
              to change and reset the curcontext parameter (which has the same effect).

       _values [ -O name ] [ -s sep ] [ -S sep ] [ -wC ] desc spec ...
              This  is used to complete arbitrary keywords (values) and their arguments, or lists
              of such combinations.

              If the first argument is the option `-O name', it will be used in the same  way  as
              by the _arguments function.  In other words, the elements of the name array will be
              passed to compadd when executing an action.

              If the first argument (or the first argument after `-O name')  is  `-s',  the  next
              argument  is  used as the character that separates multiple values.  This character
              is automatically added after each value in an auto-removable fashion  (see  below);
              all  values  completed by `_values -s' appear in the same word on the command line,
              unlike completion using _arguments.  If this option is not present, only  a  single
              value will be completed per word.

              Normally,  _values  will  only  use  the current word to determine which values are
              already present on the command line and hence are not to be  completed  again.   If
              the -w option is given, other arguments are examined as well.

              The  first non-option argument is used as a string to print as a description before
              listing the values.

              All other arguments describe the possible values and their arguments  in  the  same
              format  used for the description of options by the _arguments function (see above).
              The only differences are that no minus or plus sign is required at  the  beginning,
              values  can have only one argument, and the forms of action beginning with an equal
              sign are not supported.

              The character separating a value from its argument can be set using the  option  -S
              (like  -s, followed by the character to use as the separator in the next argument).
              By default the equals sign will be used as the separator between values  and  argu‐
              ments.

              Example:

                     _values -s , 'description' \
                             '*foo[bar]' \
                             '(two)*one[number]:first count:' \
                             'two[another number]::second count:(1 2 3)'

              This  describes  three  possible  values:  `foo',  `one',  and `two'.  The first is
              described as `bar', takes no argument and may appear more than once.  The second is
              described  as `number', may appear more than once, and takes one mandatory argument
              described as `first count'; no action is specified, so it will  not  be  completed.
              The `(two)' at the beginning says that if the value `one' is on the line, the value
              `two' will no longer be considered a possible completion.  Finally, the last  value
              (`two')  is  described as `another number' and takes an optional argument described
              as `second count' for which the completions (to appear after an `=') are `1',  `2',
              and  `3'.   The  _values  function will complete lists of these values separated by
              commas.

              Like _arguments, this function temporarily adds another context name  component  to
              the  arguments  element  (the  fifth)  of  the  current context while executing the
              action.  Here this name is just the name of the value for  which  the  argument  is
              completed.

              The  style  verbose  is  used to decide if the descriptions for the values (but not
              those for the arguments) should be printed.

              The associative array val_args is used to report values and their  arguments;  this
              works  similarly  to  the opt_args associative array used by _arguments.  Hence the
              function calling _values should declare the local  parameters  state,  state_descr,
              line, context and val_args:

                     local context state state_descr line
                     typeset -A val_args

              when using an action of the form `->string'.  With this function the context param‐
              eter will be set to the name of the value whose argument is to be completed.   Note
              that for _values, the state and state_descr are scalars rather than arrays.  Only a
              single matching state is returned.

              Note also that _values normally adds the character used as  the  separator  between
              values  as an auto-removable suffix (similar to a `/' after a directory).  However,
              this is not possible for a `->string' action as the matches for  the  argument  are
              generated  by  the calling function.  To get the usual behaviour, the calling func‐
              tion can add the separator x as a suffix by passing  the  options  `-qS  x'  either
              directly or indirectly to compadd.

              The  option -C is treated in the same way as it is by _arguments.  In that case the
              parameter curcontext should be made local instead of context (as described above).

       _wanted [ -x ] [ -C name ]  [ -12VJ ] tag name descr command args ...
              In many contexts, completion can only generate one particular set of matches,  usu‐
              ally  corresponding  to  a  single  tag.   However, it is still necessary to decide
              whether the user requires matches of this type.  This function is useful in such  a
              case.

              The  arguments to _wanted are the same as those to _requested, i.e. arguments to be
              passed to _description.  However, in this case the command is  not  optional;   all
              the  processing  of  tags, including the loop over both tags and tag labels and the
              generation of matches, is carried out automatically by _wanted.

              Hence to offer only one tag and immediately add the corresponding matches with  the
              given description:

                     local expl
                     _wanted tag expl 'description' \
                         compadd matches...

              Note  that,  as  for  _requested,  the command must be able to accept options to be
              passed down to compadd.

              Like _tags this function supports the -C option to give a different  name  for  the
              argument context field.  The -x option has the same meaning as for _description.

COMPLETION DIRECTORIES
       In  the source distribution, the files are contained in various subdirectories of the Com‐
       pletion directory.  They may have been installed in the same structure, or into one single
       function  directory.   The  following  is a description of the files found in the original
       directory structure.  If you wish to alter an installed file, you will need to copy it  to
       some  directory  which  appears earlier in your fpath than the standard directory where it
       appears.

       Base   The core functions and special completion widgets automatically bound to keys.  You
              will  certainly  need  most  of these, though will probably not need to alter them.
              Many of these are documented above.

       Zsh    Functions for completing arguments of shell builtin commands and utility  functions
              for this.  Some of these are also used by functions from the Unix directory.

       Unix   Functions  for  completing  arguments  of external commands and suites of commands.
              They may need modifying for your system, although in many  cases  some  attempt  is
              made  to decide which version of a command is present.  For example, completion for
              the mount command tries to determine the system it is running on, while  completion
              for many other utilities try to decide whether the GNU version of the command is in
              use, and hence whether the --help option is supported.

       X, AIX, BSD, ...
              Completion and utility function for commands available only on some systems.  These
              are  not arranged hierarchically, so, for example, both the Linux and Debian direc‐
              tories, as well as the X directory, may be useful on your system.



ZSHCOMPCTL(1)                        General Commands Manual                        ZSHCOMPCTL(1)



NAME
       zshcompctl - zsh programmable completion

DESCRIPTION
       This version of zsh has two ways of performing completion of words on  the  command  line.
       New users of the shell may prefer to use the newer and more powerful system based on shell
       functions; this is described in zshcompsys(1), and the basic shell mechanisms  which  sup‐
       port  it  are  described  in zshcompwid(1).  This manual entry describes the older compctl
       command.
       compctl [ -CDT ] options [ command ... ]
       compctl [ -CDT ] options [ -x pattern options - ... -- ] [ + options [ -x ... -- ] ... [+]
       ] [ command ... ]
       compctl -M match-specs ...
       compctl -L [ -CDTM ] [ command ... ]
       compctl + command ...

       Control  the editor's completion behavior according to the supplied set of options.  Vari‐
       ous editing commands, notably expand-or-complete-word, usually bound to tab, will  attempt
       to  complete  a word typed by the user, while others, notably delete-char-or-list, usually
       bound to ^D in EMACS editing mode, list the possibilities;  compctl  controls  what  those
       possibilities are.  They may for example be filenames (the most common case, and hence the
       default), shell variables, or words from a user-specified list.

COMMAND FLAGS
       Completion of the arguments of a command may be different for each command or may use  the
       default.   The  behavior  when  completing  the command word itself may also be separately
       specified.  These correspond to the following flags and arguments, all  of  which  (except
       for  -L) may be combined with any combination of the options described subsequently in the
       section `Option Flags':

       command ...
              controls completion for the named commands, which must be listed last on  the  com‐
              mand  line.   If  completion  is attempted for a command with a pathname containing
              slashes and no completion definition is found, the search is retried with the  last
              pathname  component.  If  the command starts with a =, completion is tried with the
              pathname of the command.

              Any of the command strings may be patterns of the form normally used  for  filename
              generation.   These  should be quoted to protect them from immediate expansion; for
              example the command string 'foo*' arranges for completion of the words of any  com‐
              mand beginning with foo.  When completion is attempted, all pattern completions are
              tried in the reverse order of their definition until one matches.  By default, com‐
              pletion  then  proceeds as normal, i.e. the shell will try to generate more matches
              for the specific command on the command line; this can be overridden  by  including
              -tn in the flags for the pattern completion.

              Note  that  aliases  are  expanded before the command name is determined unless the
              COMPLETE_ALIASES option is set.  Commands may not be combined with the -C, -D or -T
              flags.

       -C     controls completion when the command word itself is being completed.  If no compctl
              -C command has been issued,  the names of any executable command  (whether  in  the
              path or specific to the shell, such as aliases or functions) are completed.

       -D     controls default completion behavior for the arguments of commands not assigned any
              special behavior.  If no compctl -D command has been  issued,  filenames  are  com‐
              pleted.

       -T     supplies  completion  flags  to  be  used before any other processing is done, even
              before processing for compctls defined for specific commands.  This  is  especially
              useful  when  combined  with  extended  completion  (the  -x  flag, see the section
              `Extended Completion' below).  Using this flag  you  can  define  default  behavior
              which  will  apply to all commands without exception, or you can alter the standard
              behavior for all commands.  For example, if your access to the user database is too
              slow and/or it contains too many users (so that completion after `~' is too slow to
              be usable), you can use

                     compctl -T -x 's[~] C[0,[^/]#]' -k friends -S/ -tn

              to complete the strings in the array friends after a `~'.  The C[...]  argument  is
              necessary  so  that this form of ~-completion is not tried after the directory name
              is finished.

       -L     lists the existing completion behavior in a manner  suitable  for  putting  into  a
              start-up  script;  the  existing  behavior  is not changed.  Any combination of the
              above forms, or the -M flag (which must follow the -L flag), may be specified, oth‐
              erwise all defined completions are listed.  Any other flags supplied are ignored.

       no argument
              If  no  argument  is given, compctl lists all defined completions in an abbreviated
              form;  with a list of options, all completions with those flags set  (not  counting
              extended completion) are listed.

       If the + flag is alone and followed immediately by the command list, the completion behav‐
       ior for all the commands in the list is reset to the default.  In other words,  completion
       will subsequently use the options specified by the -D flag.

       The  form with -M as the first and only option defines global matching specifications (see
       zshcompwid). The match specifications given will be  used  for  every  completion  attempt
       (only  when  using compctl, not with the new completion system) and are tried in the order
       in which they are defined until one generates at least one match. E.g.:

              compctl -M '' 'm:{a-zA-Z}={A-Za-z}'

       This will first try completion without any global match specifications (the empty  string)
       and, if that generates no matches, will try case insensitive completion.

OPTION FLAGS
       [ -fcFBdeaRGovNAIOPZEnbjrzu/12 ]
       [ -k array ] [ -g globstring ] [ -s subststring ]
       [ -K function ]
       [ -Q ] [ -P prefix ] [ -S suffix ]
       [ -W file-prefix ] [ -H num pattern ]
       [ -q ] [ -X explanation ] [ -Y explanation ]
       [ -y func-or-var ] [ -l cmd ] [ -h cmd ] [ -U ]
       [ -t continue ] [ -J name ] [ -V name ]
       [ -M match-spec ]

       The remaining options specify the type of command arguments to look for during completion.
       Any combination of these flags may be specified; the result is a sorted list  of  all  the
       possibilities.  The options are as follows.

   Simple Flags
       These produce completion lists made up by the shell itself:

       -f     Filenames and file system paths.

       -/     Just file system paths.

       -c     Command names, including aliases, shell functions, builtins and reserved words.

       -F     Function names.

       -B     Names of builtin commands.

       -m     Names of external commands.

       -w     Reserved words.

       -a     Alias names.

       -R     Names of regular (non-global) aliases.

       -G     Names of global aliases.

       -d     This  can be combined with -F, -B, -w, -a, -R and -G to get names of disabled func‐
              tions, builtins, reserved words or aliases.

       -e     This option (to show enabled commands) is in effect by default, but may be combined
              with  -d;  -de in combination with -F, -B, -w, -a, -R and -G will complete names of
              functions, builtins, reserved words or aliases whether or not they are disabled.

       -o     Names of shell options (see zshoptions(1)).

       -v     Names of any variable defined in the shell.

       -N     Names of scalar (non-array) parameters.

       -A     Array names.

       -I     Names of integer variables.

       -O     Names of read-only variables.

       -p     Names of parameters used by the shell (including special parameters).

       -Z     Names of shell special parameters.

       -E     Names of environment variables.

       -n     Named directories.

       -b     Key binding names.

       -j     Job names:  the first word of the job leader's command line.  This is  useful  with
              the kill builtin.

       -r     Names of running jobs.

       -z     Names of suspended jobs.

       -u     User names.

   Flags with Arguments
       These  have user supplied arguments to determine how the list of completions is to be made
       up:

       -k array
              Names taken from the elements of $array (note that the `$' does not appear  on  the
              command  line).  Alternatively, the argument array itself may be a set of space- or
              comma-separated values in parentheses, in which any delimiter may be escaped with a
              backslash; in this case the argument should be quoted.  For example,

                     compctl -k "(cputime filesize datasize stacksize
                                 coredumpsize resident descriptors)" limit

       -g globstring
              The  globstring is expanded using filename globbing; it should be quoted to protect
              it from immediate expansion. The resulting filenames are taken as the possible com‐
              pletions.  Use `*(/)' instead of `*/' for directories.  The fignore special parame‐
              ter is not applied to the resulting files.  More than one pattern may be given sep‐
              arated by blanks. (Note that brace expansion is not part of globbing.  Use the syn‐
              tax `(either|or)' to match alternatives.)

       -s subststring
              The subststring is split into words and these words are  than  expanded  using  all
              shell expansion mechanisms (see zshexpn(1)).  The resulting words are taken as pos‐
              sible completions.  The fignore special parameter is not applied to  the  resulting
              files.  Note that -g is faster for filenames.

       -K function
              Call  the  given  function  to get the completions.  Unless the name starts with an
              underscore, the function is passed two arguments: the prefix and the suffix of  the
              word on which completion is to be attempted, in other words those characters before
              the cursor position, and those from the cursor position onwards.  The whole command
              line  can  be  accessed  with the -c and -l flags of the read builtin. The function
              should set the variable reply to an array containing the completions  (one  comple‐
              tion  per element); note that reply should not be made local to the function.  From
              such a function the command line can be accessed with the -c and -l  flags  to  the
              read builtin.  For example,

                     function whoson { reply=(`users`); }
                     compctl -K whoson talk

              completes  only  logged-on  users  after `talk'.  Note that `whoson' must return an
              array, so `reply=`users`' would be incorrect.

       -H num pattern
              The possible completions are taken from the last num  history  lines.   Only  words
              matching  pattern  are  taken.   If  num  is  zero or negative the whole history is
              searched and if pattern is the empty string all words are taken (as with  `*').   A
              typical use is

                     compctl -D -f + -H 0 ''

              which  forces completion to look back in the history list for a word if no filename
              matches.

   Control Flags
       These do not directly specify types of name to be completed, but  manipulate  the  options
       that do:

       -Q     This  instructs  the  shell not to quote any metacharacters in the possible comple‐
              tions.  Normally the results of a completion are inserted  into  the  command  line
              with  any  metacharacters quoted so that they are interpreted as normal characters.
              This is appropriate for filenames  and  ordinary  strings.   However,  for  special
              effects,  such as inserting a backquoted expression from a completion array (-k) so
              that the expression will not be evaluated until the complete line is executed, this
              option must be used.

       -P prefix
              The  prefix  is inserted just before the completed string; any initial part already
              typed will be completed and the whole prefix ignored for completion purposes.   For
              example,

                     compctl -j -P "%" kill

              inserts a `%' after the kill command and then completes job names.

       -S suffix
              When  a  completion is found the suffix is inserted after the completed string.  In
              the case of menu completion the suffix is inserted immediately,  but  it  is  still
              possible  to  cycle  through the list of completions by repeatedly hitting the same
              key.

       -W file-prefix
              With directory file-prefix:  for command, file, directory and  globbing  completion
              (options  -c, -f, -/, -g), the file prefix is implicitly added in front of the com‐
              pletion.  For example,

                     compctl -/ -W ~/Mail maildirs

              completes any subdirectories to any depth beneath the  directory  ~/Mail,  although
              that  prefix  does  not appear on the command line.  The file-prefix may also be of
              the form accepted by the -k flag, i.e. the name of an array or a  literal  list  in
              parenthesis. In this case all the directories in the list will be searched for pos‐
              sible completions.

       -q     If used with a suffix as specified by the -S option, this causes the suffix  to  be
              removed  if  the  next character typed is a blank or does not insert anything or if
              the suffix consists of only one character and the next character typed is the  same
              character; this the same rule used for the AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH option.  The option is
              most useful for list separators (comma, colon, etc.).

       -l cmd This option restricts the range of command line words that  are  considered  to  be
              arguments.   If  combined  with  one  of the extended completion patterns `p[...]',
              `r[...]', or `R[...]'  (see the section `Extended Completion' below) the  range  is
              restricted to the range of arguments specified in the brackets.  Completion is then
              performed as if these had been given as arguments to  the  cmd  supplied  with  the
              option.  If the cmd string is empty the first word in the range is instead taken as
              the command name, and command name completion performed on the first  word  in  the
              range.  For example,

                     compctl -x 'r[-exec,;]' -l '' -- find

              completes  arguments  between `-exec' and the following `;' (or the end of the com‐
              mand line if there is no such string) as if they were a separate command line.

       -h cmd Normally zsh completes quoted strings as a whole. With this option, completion  can
              be  done separately on different parts of such strings. It works like the -l option
              but makes the completion code work on the parts of the current word that are  sepa‐
              rated  by  spaces. These parts are completed as if they were arguments to the given
              cmd. If cmd is the empty string, the first part is completed as a command name,  as
              with -l.

       -U     Use  the whole list of possible completions, whether or not they actually match the
              word on the command line.  The word typed so far will be  deleted.   This  is  most
              useful  with  a function (given by the -K option) which can examine the word compo‐
              nents passed to it (or via the read builtin's -c and -l flags) and use its own cri‐
              teria  to  decide  what  matches.   If there is no completion, the original word is
              retained.  Since the produced possible completions seldom have  interesting  common
              prefixes  and  suffixes, menu completion is started immediately if AUTO_MENU is set
              and this flag is used.

       -y func-or-var
              The list provided by func-or-var is displayed instead of the  list  of  completions
              whenever  a  listing  is  required;  the  actual completions to be inserted are not
              affected.  It can be provided in two ways. Firstly, if func-or-var begins with a  $
              it  defines  a  variable,  or if it begins with a left parenthesis a literal array,
              which contains the list.  A variable may have been set by  a  call  to  a  function
              using  the  -K  option.  Otherwise it contains the name of a function which will be
              executed to create the list.  The function will be passed as an argument  list  all
              matching  completions, including prefixes and suffixes expanded in full, and should
              set the array reply to the result.  In both cases, the display list  will  only  be
              retrieved after a complete list of matches has been created.

              Note  that  the  returned  list does not have to correspond, even in length, to the
              original set of matches, and may be passed as a scalar instead  of  an  array.   No
              special  formatting  of characters is performed on the output in this case; in par‐
              ticular, newlines are printed literally and if they appear  output  in  columns  is
              suppressed.

       -X explanation
              Print  explanation  when trying completion on the current set of options. A `%n' in
              this string is replaced by the number of matches that were added for this  explana‐
              tion string.  The explanation only appears if completion was tried and there was no
              unique match, or when listing  completions.  Explanation  strings  will  be  listed
              together with the matches of the group specified together with the -X option (using
              the -J or -V option). If the same  explanation  string  is  given  to  multiple  -X
              options,  the  string  appears only once (for each group) and the number of matches
              shown for the `%n' is the total number of all matches for each of  these  uses.  In
              any case, the explanation string will only be shown if there was at least one match
              added for the explanation string.

              The sequences %B, %b, %S, %s, %U, and %u specify output attributes (bold, standout,
              and  underline),  %F,  %f,  %K,  %k  specify foreground and background colours, and
              %{...%} can be used to include literal escape sequences as in prompts.

       -Y explanation
              Identical to -X, except that the explanation first  undergoes  expansion  following
              the  usual  rules  for strings in double quotes.  The expansion will be carried out
              after any functions are called for the -K or -y options, allowing them to set vari‐
              ables.

       -t continue
              The  continue-string  contains  a  character that specifies which set of completion
              flags should be used next.  It is useful:

              (i) With -T, or when trying a list of pattern completions, when compctl would  usu‐
              ally  continue  with  ordinary  processing  after finding matches; this can be sup‐
              pressed with `-tn'.

              (ii) With a list of alternatives separated by +, when compctl would  normally  stop
              when  one  of the alternatives generates matches.  It can be forced to consider the
              next set of completions by adding `-t+' to the flags of the alternative before  the
              `+'.

              (iii)  In an extended completion list (see below), when compctl would normally con‐
              tinue until a set of conditions succeeded, then use only the immediately  following
              flags.   With  `-t-',  compctl  will continue trying extended completions after the
              next `-'; with `-tx' it will attempt completion with the default  flags,  in  other
              words those before the `-x'.

       -J name
              This gives the name of the group the matches should be placed in. Groups are listed
              and sorted separately; likewise, menu completion will  offer  the  matches  in  the
              groups  in  the order in which the groups were defined. If no group name is explic‐
              itly given, the matches are stored in a group named default. The first time a group
              name is encountered, a group with that name is created. After that all matches with
              the same group name are stored in that group.

              This can be useful with non-exclusive alternative completions.  For example, in

                     compctl -f -J files -t+ + -v -J variables foo

              both files and variables are possible completions, as the -t+ forces both  sets  of
              alternatives  before  and  after the + to be considered at once.  Because of the -J
              options, however, all files are listed before all variables.

       -V name
              Like -J, but matches within the group will not be sorted in listings  nor  in  menu
              completion.  These  unsorted  groups  are in a different name space from the sorted
              ones, so groups defined as -J files and -V files are distinct.

       -1     If given together with the -V option, makes  only  consecutive  duplicates  in  the
              group be removed. Note that groups with and without this flag are in different name
              spaces.

       -2     If given together with the -J or -V option, makes all duplicates  be  kept.  Again,
              groups with and without this flag are in different name spaces.

       -M match-spec
              This  defines  additional  matching control specifications that should be used only
              when testing words for the list of flags this flag appears in. The  format  of  the
              match-spec string is described in zshcompwid.

ALTERNATIVE COMPLETION
       compctl [ -CDT ] options + options [ + ... ] [ + ] command ...

       The  form  with  `+'  specifies  alternative options. Completion is tried with the options
       before the first `+'. If this produces no matches completion is tried with the flags after
       the `+' and so on. If there are no flags after the last `+' and a match has not been found
       up to that point, default completion is tried.  If the list of flags contains a -t with  a
       + character, the next list of flags is used even if the current list produced matches.

       Additional  options  are  available  that  restrict completion to some part of the command
       line; this is referred to as `extended completion'.

EXTENDED COMPLETION
       compctl [ -CDT ] options -x pattern options - ... --
                [ command ... ]
       compctl [ -CDT ] options [ -x pattern options - ... -- ]
                [ + options [ -x ... -- ] ... [+] ] [ command ... ]

       The form with `-x' specifies extended completion for the commands given; as shown, it  may
       be combined with alternative completion using `+'.  Each pattern is examined in turn; when
       a match is found, the corresponding options, as described in the  section  `Option  Flags'
       above,  are  used  to  generate  possible completions.  If no pattern matches, the options
       given before the -x are used.

       Note that each pattern should be supplied as a single argument and  should  be  quoted  to
       prevent expansion of metacharacters by the shell.

       A  pattern  is  built  of  sub-patterns separated by commas; it matches if at least one of
       these sub-patterns matches (they are `or'ed). These sub-patterns are in turn  composed  of
       other  sub-patterns separated by white spaces which match if all of the sub-patterns match
       (they are `and'ed).  An element of the sub-patterns is of the  form  `c[...][...]',  where
       the  pairs  of  brackets  may be repeated as often as necessary, and matches if any of the
       sets of brackets match (an `or').  The example below makes this clearer.

       The elements may be any of the following:

       s[string]...
              Matches if the current word on the command line starts  with  one  of  the  strings
              given in brackets.  The string is not removed and is not part of the completion.

       S[string]...
              Like s[string] except that the string is part of the completion.

       p[from,to]...
              Matches  if  the number of the current word is between one of the from and to pairs
              inclusive. The comma and to are optional; to defaults to the same  value  as  from.
              The numbers may be negative: -n refers to the n'th last word on the line.

       c[offset,string]...
              Matches if the string matches the word offset by offset from the current word posi‐
              tion.  Usually offset will be negative.

       C[offset,pattern]...
              Like c but using pattern matching instead.

       w[index,string]...
              Matches if the word in position index is equal to the corresponding  string.   Note
              that the word count is made after any alias expansion.

       W[index,pattern]...
              Like w but using pattern matching instead.

       n[index,string]...
              Matches  if  the  current  word  contains string.  Anything up to and including the
              indexth occurrence of this string will not be considered part  of  the  completion,
              but  the  rest  will.   index may be negative to count from the end: in most cases,
              index will be 1 or -1.  For example,

                     compctl -s '`users`' -x 'n[1,@]' -k hosts -- talk

              will usually complete usernames, but if you insert an @ after the name, names  from
              the array hosts (assumed to contain hostnames, though you must make the array your‐
              self) will be completed.  Other commands such as rcp can be handled similarly.

       N[index,string]...
              Like n except that the string will be taken as a character class.  Anything  up  to
              and including the indexth occurrence of any of the characters in string will not be
              considered part of the completion.

       m[min,max]...
              Matches if the total number of words lies between min and max inclusive.

       r[str1,str2]...
              Matches if the cursor is after a word with prefix str1.  If there is  also  a  word
              with  prefix str2 on the command line after the one matched by str1 it matches only
              if the cursor is before this word. If the comma and str2 are omitted, it matches if
              the cursor is after a word with prefix str1.

       R[str1,str2]...
              Like r but using pattern matching instead.

       q[str]...
              Matches  the  word currently being completed is in single quotes and the str begins
              with the letter `s', or if completion is done in double quotes and str starts  with
              the letter `d', or if completion is done in backticks and str starts with a `b'.

EXAMPLE
              compctl -u -x 's[+] c[-1,-f],s[-f+]' \
                -g '~/Mail/*(:t)' - 's[-f],c[-1,-f]' -f -- mail

       This is to be interpreted as follows:

       If the current command is mail, then

              if ((the current word begins with + and the previous word is -f)
              or (the current word begins with -f+)), then complete the
              non-directory part (the `:t' glob modifier) of files in the directory
              ~/Mail; else

              if the current word begins with -f or the previous word was -f, then
              complete any file; else

              complete user names.




ZSHMODULES(1)                        General Commands Manual                        ZSHMODULES(1)



NAME
       zshmodules - zsh loadable modules

DESCRIPTION
       Some  optional  parts of zsh are in modules, separate from the core of the shell.  Each of
       these modules may be linked in to the shell at build time, or can  be  dynamically  linked
       while  the shell is running if the installation supports this feature.  Modules are linked
       at runtime with the zmodload command, see zshbuiltins(1).

       The modules that are bundled with the zsh distribution are:

       zsh/attr
              Builtins for manipulating extended attributes (xattr).

       zsh/cap
              Builtins for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capability (privilege) sets.

       zsh/clone
              A builtin that can clone a running shell onto another terminal.

       zsh/compctl
              The compctl builtin for controlling completion.

       zsh/complete
              The basic completion code.

       zsh/complist
              Completion listing extensions.

       zsh/computil
              A module with utility builtins needed for the shell function based completion  sys‐
              tem.

       zsh/curses
              curses windowing commands

       zsh/datetime
              Some date/time commands and parameters.

       zsh/deltochar
              A ZLE function duplicating EMACS' zap-to-char.

       zsh/example
              An example of how to write a module.

       zsh/files
              Some basic file manipulation commands as builtins.

       zsh/langinfo
              Interface to locale information.

       zsh/mapfile
              Access to external files via a special associative array.

       zsh/mathfunc
              Standard scientific functions for use in mathematical evaluations.

       zsh/newuser
              Arrange for files for new users to be installed.

       zsh/parameter
              Access to internal hash tables via special associative arrays.

       zsh/pcre
              Interface to the PCRE library.

       zsh/regex
              Interface to the POSIX regex library.

       zsh/sched
              A builtin that provides a timed execution facility within the shell.

       zsh/net/socket
              Manipulation of Unix domain sockets

       zsh/stat
              A builtin command interface to the stat system call.

       zsh/system
              A builtin interface to various low-level system features.

       zsh/net/tcp
              Manipulation of TCP sockets

       zsh/termcap
              Interface to the termcap database.

       zsh/terminfo
              Interface to the terminfo database.

       zsh/zftp
              A builtin FTP client.

       zsh/zle
              The Zsh Line Editor, including the bindkey and vared builtins.

       zsh/zleparameter
              Access to internals of the Zsh Line Editor via parameters.

       zsh/zprof
              A module allowing profiling for shell functions.

       zsh/zpty
              A builtin for starting a command in a pseudo-terminal.

       zsh/zselect
              Block and return when file descriptors are ready.

       zsh/zutil
              Some utility builtins, e.g. the one for supporting configuration via styles.

THE ZSH/ATTR MODULE
       The  zsh/attr  module  is used for manipulating extended attributes.  The -h option causes
       all commands to operate on symbolic links instead of their targets.  The builtins in  this
       module are:

       zgetattr [ -h ] filename attribute [ parameter ]
              Get  the  extended attribute attribute from the specified filename. If the optional
              argument parameter is given, the attribute is set  on  that  parameter  instead  of
              being printed to stdout.

       zsetattr [ -h ] filename attribute value
              Set the extended attribute attribute on the specified filename to value.

       zdelattr [ -h ] filename attribute
              Remove the extended attribute attribute from the specified filename.

       zlistattr [ -h ] filename [ parameter ]
              List  the  extended  attributes  currently  set  on  the specified filename. If the
              optional argument parameter is given, the list of attributes is set on that parame‐
              ter instead of being printed to stdout.

       zgetattr  and  zlistattr  allocate  memory  dynamically.   If  the  attribute  or  list of
       attributes grows between the allocation and the call to get them, they return 2.   On  all
       other  errors, 1 is returned.  This allows the calling function to check for this case and
       retry.

THE ZSH/CAP MODULE
       The zsh/cap module is used for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capability  sets.   If  the
       operating system does not support this interface, the builtins defined by this module will
       do nothing.  The builtins in this module are:

       cap [ capabilities ]
              Change the shell's process capability sets to the specified capabilities, otherwise
              display the shell's current capabilities.

       getcap filename ...
              This  is  a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility.  It displays the
              capability sets on each specified filename.

       setcap capabilities filename ...
              This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility.  It sets the capa‐
              bility sets on each specified filename to the specified capabilities.

THE ZSH/CLONE MODULE
       The zsh/clone module makes available one builtin command:

       clone tty
              Creates  a forked instance of the current shell, attached to the specified tty.  In
              the new shell, the PID, PPID and TTY special parameters are changed  appropriately.
              $!  is  set  to  zero  in the new shell, and to the new shell's PID in the original
              shell.

              The return status of the builtin is zero in both shells if successful, and non-zero
              on error.

              The target of clone should be an unused terminal, such as an unused virtual console
              or a virtual terminal created by

              xterm -e sh -c 'trap : INT QUIT TSTP; tty; while :; do sleep 100000000; done'

              Some words of explanation are warranted about this long xterm  command  line:  when
              doing  clone  on  a  pseudo-terminal, some other session ("session" meant as a unix
              session group, or SID) is already owning the terminal. Hence the cloned zsh  cannot
              acquire the pseudo-terminal as a controlling tty. That means two things:

              the job control signals will go to the sh-started-by-xterm process
                    group (that's why we disable INT QUIT and TSTP with trap; otherwise
                    the while loop could get suspended or killed)

              the cloned shell will have job control disabled, and the job
                    control keys (control-C, control-\ and control-Z) will not work.

              This does not apply when cloning to an unused vc.

              Cloning  to  a  used (and unprepared) terminal will result in two processes reading
              simultaneously from the same terminal, with input bytes going  randomly  to  either
              process.

              clone is mostly useful as a shell built-in replacement for openvt.

THE ZSH/COMPCTL MODULE
       The  zsh/compctl  module makes available two builtin commands. compctl, is the old, depre‐
       cated way to control completions for ZLE.  See zshcompctl(1).  The other builtin  command,
       compcall can be used in user-defined completion widgets, see zshcompwid(1).

THE ZSH/COMPLETE MODULE
       The  zsh/complete  module  makes  available  several builtin commands which can be used in
       user-defined completion widgets, see zshcompwid(1).

THE ZSH/COMPLIST MODULE
       The zsh/complist module offers three extensions to completion  listings:  the  ability  to
       highlight matches in such a list, the ability to scroll through long lists and a different
       style of menu completion.

   Colored completion listings
       Whenever one of the parameters ZLS_COLORS or ZLS_COLOURS is set and the zsh/complist  mod‐
       ule  is loaded or linked into the shell, completion lists will be colored.  Note, however,
       that complist will not automatically be loaded if it is not linked in:   on  systems  with
       dynamic loading, `zmodload zsh/complist' is required.

       The  parameters  ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS describe how matches are highlighted.  To turn
       on highlighting an empty value suffices, in which case all the default values given  below
       will  be used.  The format of the value of these parameters is the same as used by the GNU
       version of  the  ls  command:  a  colon-separated  list  of  specifications  of  the  form
       `name=value'.   The  name  may be one of the following strings, most of which specify file
       types for which the value will be used.  The strings and their default values are:

       no 0   for normal text (i.e. when displaying something other than a matched file)

       fi 0   for regular files

       di 32  for directories

       ln 36  for symbolic links.  If this has the  special  value  target,  symbolic  links  are
              dereferenced and the target file used to determine the display format.

       pi 31  for named pipes (FIFOs)

       so 33  for sockets

       bd 44;37
              for block devices

       cd 44;37
              for character devices

       or none
              for a symlink to nonexistent file (default is the value defined for ln)

       mi none
              for  a  non-existent  file (default is the value defined for fi); this code is cur‐
              rently not used

       su 37;41
              for files with setuid bit set

       sg 30;43
              for files with setgid bit set

       tw 30;42
              for world writable directories with sticky bit set

       ow 34;43
              for world writable directories without sticky bit set

       sa none
              for files with an associated suffix alias; this is only tested after specific  suf‐
              fixes, as described below

       st 37;44
              for directories with sticky bit set but not world writable

       ex 35  for executable files

       lc \e[ for the left code (see below)

       rc m   for the right code

       tc 0   for  the  character  indicating  the  file  type   printed  after  filenames if the
              LIST_TYPES option is set

       sp 0   for the spaces printed after matches to align the next column

       ec none
              for the end code

       Apart from these strings, the name may also be an asterisk (`*') followed by  any  string.
       The  value  given  for  such  a string will be used for all files whose name ends with the
       string.  The  name  may  also  be  an  equals  sign  (`=')  followed  by  a  pattern;  the
       EXTENDED_GLOB option will be turned on for evaluation of the pattern.  The value given for
       this pattern will be used for all matches (not just filenames) whose  display  string  are
       matched  by the pattern.  Definitions for the form with the leading equal sign take prece‐
       dence over the values defined for file types, which in turn take precedence over the  form
       with the leading asterisk (file extensions).

       The leading-equals form also allows different parts of the displayed strings to be colored
       differently.  For this, the pattern has to use the  `(#b)'  globbing  flag  and  pairs  of
       parentheses  surrounding  the parts of the strings that are to be colored differently.  In
       this case the value may consist of more than one color code separated by equal signs.  The
       first code will be used for all parts for which no explicit code is specified and the fol‐
       lowing codes will be used for the parts matched by the sub-patterns in  parentheses.   For
       example,  the specification `=(#b)(?)*(?)=0=3=7' will be used for all matches which are at
       least two characters long and will use the code `3' for the first character, `7'  for  the
       last character and `0' for the rest.

       All  three  forms  of name may be preceded by a pattern in parentheses.  If this is given,
       the value will be used only for matches in groups whose names are matched by  the  pattern
       given  in the parentheses.  For example, `(g*)m*=43' highlights all matches beginning with
       `m' in groups whose names  begin with `g' using the color code `43'.  In case of the `lc',
       `rc', and `ec' codes, the group pattern is ignored.

       Note  also  that all patterns are tried in the order in which they appear in the parameter
       value until the first one matches which is then used.

       When printing a match, the code prints the value of lc, the value for the file-type or the
       last  matching  specification  with  a `*', the value of rc, the string to display for the
       match itself, and then the value of ec if that is defined or the values of lc, no, and  rc
       if ec is not defined.

       The  default values are ISO 6429 (ANSI) compliant and can be used on vt100 compatible ter‐
       minals such as xterms.  On monochrome terminals the default values will  have  no  visible
       effect.   The  colors function from the contribution can be used to get associative arrays
       containing the codes for ANSI terminals (see the  section  `Other  Functions'  in  zshcon‐
       trib(1)).  For example, after loading colors, one could use `$colors[red]' to get the code
       for foreground color red and `$colors[bg-green]' for the code for background color green.

       If the completion system invoked by compinit is used, these parameters should not  be  set
       directly  because  the system controls them itself.  Instead, the list-colors style should
       be used (see the section `Completion System Configuration' in zshcompsys(1)).

   Scrolling in completion listings
       To enable scrolling through a completion list, the LISTPROMPT parameter must be set.   Its
       value  will  be  used  as  the prompt; if it is the empty string, a default prompt will be
       used.  The value may contain escapes of the form `%x'.   It  supports  the  escapes  `%B',
       `%b',  `%S',  `%s',  `%U',  `%u',  `%F', `%f', `%K', `%k' and `%{...%}' used also in shell
       prompts as well as three pairs of additional sequences: a `%l' or `%L' is replaced by  the
       number  of the last line shown and the total number of lines in the form `number/total'; a
       `%m' or `%M' is replaced with the number of the last match shown and the total  number  of
       matches;  and  `%p'  or `%P' is replaced with `Top', `Bottom' or the position of the first
       line shown in percent of the total number of lines, respectively.  In each of these  cases
       the  form  with the uppercase letter will be replaced with a string of fixed width, padded
       to the right with spaces, while the lowercase form will not be padded.

       If the parameter LISTPROMPT is set, the completion code will not ask if the list should be
       shown.   Instead  it  immediately  starts  displaying  the  list, stopping after the first
       screenful, showing the prompt at the bottom, waiting  for  a  keypress  after  temporarily
       switching  to  the  listscroll  keymap.   Some of the zle functions have a special meaning
       while scrolling lists:

       send-break
              stops listing discarding the key pressed

       accept-line, down-history, down-line-or-history
       down-line-or-search, vi-down-line-or-history
              scrolls forward one line

       complete-word, menu-complete, expand-or-complete
       expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-complete-or-expand
              scrolls forward one screenful

       accept-search
              stop listing but take no other action

       Every other character stops listing and immediately processes the key as usual.   Any  key
       that  is not bound in the listscroll keymap or that is bound to undefined-key is looked up
       in the keymap currently selected.

       As for the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters, LISTPROMPT should not  be  set  directly
       when  using  the  shell  function based completion system.  Instead, the list-prompt style
       should be used.

   Menu selection
       The zsh/complist module also offers an alternative style of selecting matches from a list,
       called  menu  selection,  which  can  be used if the shell is set up to return to the last
       prompt after showing a completion  list  (see  the  ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT  option  in  zshop‐
       tions(1)).

       Menu  selection  can be invoked directly by the widget menu-select defined by this module.
       This is a standard ZLE widget that can be bound to a key in the usual way as described  in
       zshzle(1).

       Alternatively,  the parameter MENUSELECT can be set to an integer, which gives the minimum
       number of matches that must be present before menu selection is automatically  turned  on.
       This second method requires that menu completion be started, either directly from a widget
       such as menu-complete, or due to one of the options MENU_COMPLETE or AUTO_MENU being  set.
       If  MENUSELECT  is set, but is 0, 1 or empty, menu selection will always be started during
       an ambiguous menu completion.

       When using the completion system based on shell functions, the MENUSELECT parameter should
       not  be  used  (like the ZLS_COLORS and ZLS_COLOURS parameters described above).  Instead,
       the menu style should be used with the select=... keyword.

       After menu selection is started, the matches will be listed. If  there  are  more  matches
       than fit on the screen, only the first screenful is shown.  The matches to insert into the
       command line can be selected from this list.  In the list one match is  highlighted  using
       the value for ma from the ZLS_COLORS or ZLS_COLOURS parameter.  The default value for this
       is `7' which forces the selected  match  to  be  highlighted  using  standout  mode  on  a
       vt100-compatible  terminal.  If neither ZLS_COLORS nor ZLS_COLOURS is set, the same termi‐
       nal control sequence as for the `%S' escape in prompts is used.

       If there are more matches than fit on the screen and the parameter MENUPROMPT is set,  its
       value  will  be  shown  below the matches.  It supports the same escape sequences as LIST‐
       PROMPT, but the number of the match or line shown will be that of the one where  the  mark
       is placed.  If its value is the empty string, a default prompt will be used.

       The  MENUSCROLL parameter can be used to specify how the list is scrolled.  If the parame‐
       ter is unset, this is done line by line, if it is set to `0' (zero), the list will  scroll
       half  the number of lines of the screen.  If the value is positive, it gives the number of
       lines to scroll and if it is negative, the list will be scrolled the number  of  lines  of
       the screen minus the (absolute) value.

       As  for  the  ZLS_COLORS,  ZLS_COLOURS  and  LISTPROMPT parameters, neither MENUPROMPT nor
       MENUSCROLL should be set directly when using the shell function based  completion  system.
       Instead, the select-prompt and select-scroll styles should be used.

       The  completion  code sometimes decides not to show all of the matches in the list.  These
       hidden matches are either matches for which  the  completion  function  which  added  them
       explicitly  requested that they not appear in the list (using the -n option of the compadd
       builtin command) or they are matches which duplicate a string already in the list (because
       they differ only in things like prefixes or suffixes that are not displayed).  In the list
       used for menu selection, however, even these matches are shown so that it is  possible  to
       select  them.   To highlight such matches the hi and du capabilities in the ZLS_COLORS and
       ZLS_COLOURS parameters are supported for hidden matches of  the  first  and  second  kind,
       respectively.

       Selecting  matches  is  done  by  moving the mark around using the zle movement functions.
       When not all matches can be shown on the screen at the same time, the list will scroll  up
       and  down  when crossing the top or bottom line.  The following zle functions have special
       meaning during menu selection.  Note that the  following  always  perform  the  same  task
       within  the menu selection map and cannot be replaced by user defined widgets, nor can the
       set of functions be extended:

       accept-line, accept-search
              accept the current match and leave menu selection (but do  not  cause  the  command
              line to be accepted)

       send-break
              leaves menu selection and restores the previous contents of the command line

       redisplay, clear-screen
              execute their normal function without leaving menu selection

       accept-and-hold, accept-and-menu-complete
              accept  the  currently inserted match and continue selection allowing to select the
              next match to insert into the line

       accept-and-infer-next-history
              accepts the current match and then tries completion with menu selection again;   in
              the  case of files this allows one to select a directory and immediately attempt to
              complete files in it;  if there are no matches, a message is shown and one can  use
              undo  to  go  back to completion on the previous level, every other key leaves menu
              selection (including the other zle functions which  are  otherwise  special  during
              menu selection)

       undo   removes  matches  inserted  during the menu selection by one of the three functions
              before

       down-history, down-line-or-history
       vi-down-line-or-history,  down-line-or-search
              moves the mark one line down

       up-history, up-line-or-history
       vi-up-line-or-history, up-line-or-search
              moves the mark one line up

       forward-char, vi-forward-char
              moves the mark one column right

       backward-char, vi-backward-char
              moves the mark one column left

       forward-word, vi-forward-word
       vi-forward-word-end, emacs-forward-word
              moves the mark one screenful down

       backward-word, vi-backward-word, emacs-backward-word
              moves the mark one screenful up

       vi-forward-blank-word, vi-forward-blank-word-end
              moves the mark to the first line of the next group of matches

       vi-backward-blank-word
              moves the mark to the last line of the previous group of matches

       beginning-of-history
              moves the mark to the first line

       end-of-history
              moves the mark to the last line

       beginning-of-buffer-or-history, beginning-of-line
       beginning-of-line-hist, vi-beginning-of-line
              moves the mark to the leftmost column

       end-of-buffer-or-history, end-of-line
       end-of-line-hist, vi-end-of-line
              moves the mark to the rightmost column

       complete-word, menu-complete, expand-or-complete
       expand-or-complete-prefix, menu-expand-or-complete
              moves the mark to the next match

       reverse-menu-complete
              moves the mark to the previous match

       vi-insert
              this toggles between normal and interactive mode;  in  interactive  mode  the  keys
              bound to self-insert and self-insert-unmeta insert into the command line as in nor‐
              mal editing mode but without leaving menu selection; after each  character  comple‐
              tion  is tried again and the list changes to contain only the new matches; the com‐
              pletion widgets make the longest unambiguous string be inserted in the command line
              and undo and backward-delete-char go back to the previous set of matches

       history-incremental-search-forward
       history-incremental-search-backward
              this  starts  incremental  searches  in  the list of completions displayed; in this
              mode, accept-line only leaves incremental search, going back  to  the  normal  menu
              selection mode

       All  movement functions wrap around at the edges; any other zle function not listed leaves
       menu selection and executes that function.  It is possible to make widgets  in  the  above
       list  do  the  same by using the form of the widget with a `.' in front.  For example, the
       widget `.accept-line' has the effect of leaving menu selection and  accepting  the  entire
       command line.

       During  this selection the widget uses the keymap menuselect.  Any key that is not defined
       in this keymap or that is bound to undefined-key is looked  up  in  the  keymap  currently
       selected.   This  is  used  to  ensure  that the most important keys used during selection
       (namely the cursor keys, return, and TAB) have sensible defaults.  However,  keys  in  the
       menuselect  keymap can be modified directly using the bindkey builtin command (see zshmod‐
       ules(1)). For example, to make the return key leave menu selection without  accepting  the
       match currently selected one could call

              bindkey -M menuselect '^M' send-break

       after loading the zsh/complist module.

THE ZSH/COMPUTIL MODULE
       The zsh/computil module adds several builtin commands that are used by some of the comple‐
       tion functions in the completion system based on shell  functions  (see  zshcompsys(1)  ).
       Except  for compquote these builtin commands are very specialised and thus not very inter‐
       esting when writing your own completion functions.  In  summary,  these  builtin  commands
       are:

       comparguments
              This  is  used by the _arguments function to do the argument and command line pars‐
              ing.  Like compdescribe it has an option -i to do the parsing and  initialize  some
              internal  state  and various options to access the state information to decide what
              should be completed.

       compdescribe
              This is used by the _describe function to build the displays for the matches and to
              get the strings to add as matches with their options.  On the first call one of the
              options -i or -I should be supplied as the first argument.  In the first case, dis‐
              play  strings  without  the descriptions will be generated, in the second case, the
              string used to separate the matches from their descriptions must be  given  as  the
              second  argument  and the descriptions (if any) will be shown.  All other arguments
              are like the definition arguments to _describe itself.

              Once compdescribe has been called with either the -i or the -I option,  it  can  be
              repeatedly  called with the -g option and the names of four parameters as its argu‐
              ments.  This will step through the different sets of matches and store the value of
              compstate[list]  in  the first scalar, the options for compadd in the second array,
              the matches in the third array, and the strings to be displayed in  the  completion
              listing  in  the fourth array.  The arrays may then be directly given to compadd to
              register the matches with the completion code.

       compfiles
              Used by the _path_files function to optimize complex recursive filename  generation
              (globbing).   It  does three things.  With the -p and -P options it builds the glob
              patterns to use, including the paths already handled and  trying  to  optimize  the
              patterns with respect to the prefix and suffix from the line and the match specifi‐
              cation currently used.  The -i option does the directory tests for the  ignore-par‐
              ents style and the -r option tests if a component for some of the matches are equal
              to the string on the line and removes all other matches if that is true.

       compgroups
              Used by the _tags function to implement the internals  of  the  group-order  style.
              This  only takes its arguments as names of completion groups and creates the groups
              for it (all six types: sorted and unsorted, both without removing duplicates,  with
              removing all duplicates and with removing consecutive duplicates).

       compquote [ -p ] names ...
              There  may  be  reasons  to write completion functions that have to add the matches
              using the -Q option to compadd and perform quoting themselves.  Instead  of  inter‐
              preting the first character of the all_quotes key of the compstate special associa‐
              tion and using the q flag for parameter expansions, one can use this  builtin  com‐
              mand.   The arguments are the names of scalar or array parameters and the values of
              these parameters are quoted as needed for the innermost quoting level.  If  the  -p
              option  is  given,  quoting is done as if there is some prefix before the values of
              the parameters, so that a leading equal sign will not be quoted.

              The return status is non-zero in case of an error and zero otherwise.

       comptags
       comptry
              These implement the internals of the tags mechanism.

       compvalues
              Like comparguments, but for the _values function.

THE ZSH/CURSES MODULE
       The zsh/curses module makes available one builtin command and various parameters.

   Builtin
       zcurses init
       zcurses end
       zcurses addwin targetwin nlines ncols begin_y begin_x [ parentwin ]
       zcurses delwin targetwin
       zcurses refresh [ targetwin ... ]
       zcurses touch targetwin ...
       zcurses move targetwin new_y new_x
       zcurses clear targetwin [ redraw | eol | bot ]
       zcurses position targetwin array
       zcurses char targetwin character
       zcurses string targetwin string
       zcurses border targetwin border
       zcurses attr targetwin [ {+/-}attribute | fg_col/bg_col ] [...]
       zcurses bg targetwin [ {+/-}attribute | fg_col/bg_col | @char ] [...]
       zcurses scroll targetwin [ on | off | {+/-}lines ]
       zcurses input targetwin [ param [ kparam [ mparam ] ] ]
       zcurses mouse [ delay num | {+/-}motion ]
       zcurses timeout targetwin intval
       zcurses querychar targetwin [ param ]
              Manipulate curses windows.  All  uses  of  this  command  should  be  bracketed  by
              `zcurses  init'  to initialise use of curses, and `zcurses end' to end it; omitting
              `zcurses end' can cause the terminal to be in an unwanted state.

              The subcommand addwin creates a window with nlines lines and  ncols  columns.   Its
              upper  left  corner will be placed at row begin_y and column begin_x of the screen.
              targetwin is a string and refers to the name of a  window  that  is  not  currently
              assigned.   Note  in  particular  the curses convention that vertical values appear
              before horizontal values.

              If addwin is given an existing window as the final argument, the new window is cre‐
              ated as a subwindow of parentwin.  This differs from an ordinary new window in that
              the memory of the window contents is shared with the parent's  memory.   Subwindows
              must  be  deleted before their parent.  Note that the coordinates of subwindows are
              relative to the screen, not the parent, as with other windows.

              Use the subcommand delwin to delete a window created with addwin.   Note  that  end
              does not implicitly delete windows, and that delwin does not erase the screen image
              of the window.

              The window corresponding to the full visible screen is  called  stdscr;  it  always
              exists after `zcurses init' and cannot be delete with delwin.

              The subcommand refresh will refresh window targetwin; this is necessary to make any
              pending changes (such as characters you have prepared for output with char) visible
              on  the  screen.   refresh  without an argument causes the screen to be cleared and
              redrawn.  If multiple windows are given, the screen is updated once at the end.

              The subcommand touch marks the targetwins listed as  changed.   This  is  necessary
              before  refreshing  windows  if a window that was in front of another window (which
              may be stdscr) is deleted.

              The subcommand move moves the cursor position in targetwin to new coordinates new_y
              and  new_x.  Note that the subcommand string (but not the subcommand char) advances
              the cursor position over the characters added.

              The subcommand clear erases the contents of targetwin.  One (and no more than  one)
              of  three  options  may be specified.  With the option redraw, in addition the next
              refresh of targetwin will cause the screen to be cleared and repainted.   With  the
              option  eol, targetwin is only cleared to the end of the current cursor line.  With
              the option bot, targetwin is cleared to the end of the window,  i.e  everything  to
              the right and below the cursor is cleared.

              The subcommand position writes various positions associated with targetwin into the
              array named array.  These are, in order:
              -      The y and x coordinates of the cursor relative to the top left of targetwin
              -      The y and x coordinates of the top left of targetwin on the screen
              -      The size of targetwin in y and x dimensions.

              Outputting characters and strings are achieved by char and string respectively.

              To draw a border around window targetwin, use border.  Note that the border is  not
              subsequently  handled  specially:   in  other  words, the border is simply a set of
              characters output at the edge of the window.  Hence  it  can  be  overwritten,  can
              scroll off the window, etc.

              The  subcommand attr will set targetwin's attributes or foreground/background color
              pair for any successive character output.  Each attribute given on the line may  be
              prepended  by  a  +  to set or a - to unset that attribute; + is assumed if absent.
              The attributes supported are blink, bold, dim, reverse, standout, and underline.

              Each fg_col/bg_col attribute (to be read as `fg_col on bg_col') sets the foreground
              and  background  color for character output.  The color default is sometimes avail‐
              able (in particular if the library is ncurses), specifying the foreground or  back‐
              ground  color  with  which the terminal started.  The color pair default/default is
              always available.

              bg overrides the color and other attributes of all characters in the  window.   Its
              usual  use is to set the background initially, but it will overwrite the attributes
              of any characters at the time when it is called.   In  addition  to  the  arguments
              allowed with attr, an argument @char specifies a character to be shown in otherwise
              blank areas of the window.  Owing to limitations of curses this cannot be a  multi‐
              byte character (use of ASCII characters only is recommended).  As the specified set
              of attributes override the existing background, turning attributes off in the argu‐
              ments is not useful, though this does not cause an error.

              The subcommand scroll can be used with on or off to enabled or disable scrolling of
              a window when the cursor would otherwise move below the window  due  to  typing  or
              output.  It can also be used with a positive or negative integer to scroll the win‐
              dow up or down the given number of lines without changing the current cursor  posi‐
              tion  (which  therefore  appears  to move in the opposite direction relative to the
              window).  In the second case, if scrolling is off it is temporarily  turned  on  to
              allow the window to be scrolled.

              The  subcommand  input  reads a single character from the window without echoing it
              back.  If param is supplied the character is assigned to the parameter param,  else
              it is assigned to the parameter REPLY.

              If  both  param and kparam are supplied, the key is read in `keypad' mode.  In this
              mode special keys such as function keys and arrow keys return the name of  the  key
              in  the  parameter kparam.  The key names are the macros defined in the curses.h or
              ncurses.h with the prefix `KEY_' removed; see also the description of the parameter
              zcurses_keycodes below.  Other keys cause a value to be set in param as before.  On
              a successful return only one of param or kparam contains a  non-empty  string;  the
              other is set to an empty string.

              If  mparam  is  also  supplied, input attempts to handle mouse input.  This is only
              available with the ncurses library; mouse handling can be detected by checking  for
              the exit status of `zcurses mouse' with no arguments.  If a mouse button is clicked
              (or double- or triple-clicked, or pressed or released  with  a  configurable  delay
              from being clicked) then kparam is set to the string MOUSE, and mparam is set to an
              array consisting of the following elements:
              -      An identifier to discriminate different input devices; this is  only  rarely
                     useful.
              -      The  x,  y and z coordinates of the mouse click relative to the full screen,
                     as three elements in that order (i.e. the y coordinate is, unusually,  after
                     the  x  coordinate).   The  z coordinate is only available for a few unusual
                     input devices and is otherwise set to zero.
              -      Any events that occurred as separate items; usually there will be just  one.
                     An   event   consists  of  PRESSED,  RELEASED,  CLICKED,  DOUBLE_CLICKED  or
                     TRIPLE_CLICKED followed immediately (in the same element) by the  number  of
                     the button.
              -      If the shift key was pressed, the string SHIFT.
              -      If the control key was pressed, the string CTRL.
              -      If the alt key was pressed, the string ALT.

              Not  all  mouse  events may be passed through to the terminal window; most terminal
              emulators handle some mouse  events  themselves.   Note  that  the  ncurses  manual
              implies  that  using input both with and without mouse handling may cause the mouse
              cursor to appear and disappear.

              The subcommand mouse can be used to configure the use of the mouse.   There  is  no
              window  argument;  mouse  options  are  global.   `zcurses mouse' with no arguments
              returns status 0 if mouse handling is possible, else status 1.  Otherwise, the pos‐
              sible  arguments  (which  may be combined on the same command line) are as follows.
              delay num sets the maximum delay in milliseconds between press and  release  events
              to be considered as a click; the value 0 disables click resolution, and the default
              is one sixth of a second.  motion proceeded by an optional `+' (the default)  or  -
              turns  on  or  off  reporting  of  mouse  motion in addition to clicks, presses and
              releases, which are always reported.  However, it appears reports for mouse  motion
              are not currently implemented.

              The subcommand timeout specifies a timeout value for input from targetwin.  If int‐
              val is negative, `zcurses input' waits indefinitely for a character  to  be  typed;
              this  is  the  default.  If intval is zero, `zcurses input' returns immediately; if
              there is typeahead it is returned, else no input is done and status 1 is  returned.
              If  intval  is positive, `zcurses input' waits intval milliseconds for input and if
              there is none at the end of that period returns status 1.

              The subcommand querychar queries the character at the current cursor position.  The
              return  values  are  stored in the array named param if supplied, else in the array
              reply.  The first value is the character (which may be a multibyte character if the
              system  supports  them);  the  second  is the color pair in the usual fg_col/bg_col
              notation, or 0 if color is not supported.  Any attributes  other  than  color  that
              apply  to the character, as set with the subcommand attr, appear as additional ele‐
              ments.

   Parameters
       ZCURSES_COLORS
              Readonly integer.  The maximum number of colors the terminal supports.  This  value
              is  initialised  by  the  curses  library and is not available until the first time
              zcurses init is run.

       ZCURSES_COLOR_PAIRS
              Readonly integer.  The maximum number of color  pairs  fg_col/bg_col  that  may  be
              defined in `zcurses attr' commands; note this limit applies to all color pairs that
              have been used whether or not they are currently active.  This value is initialised
              by  the  curses  library  and is not available until the first time zcurses init is
              run.

       zcurses_attrs
              Readonly array.  The attributes supported by zsh/curses; available as soon  as  the
              module is loaded.

       zcurses_colors
              Readonly  array.  The colors supported by zsh/curses; available as soon as the mod‐
              ule is loaded.

       zcurses_keycodes
              Readonly array.  The values that may be returned in the second  parameter  supplied
              to  `zcurses  input'  in  the order in which they are defined internally by curses.
              Not all function keys are listed, only F0; curses reserves space for F0 up to F63.

       zcurses_windows
              Readonly array.  The current list of windows, i.e. all windows that have been  cre‐
              ated with `zcurses addwin' and not removed with `zcurses delwin'.

THE ZSH/DATETIME MODULE
       The zsh/datetime module makes available one builtin command:

       strftime [ -s scalar ] format epochtime
       strftime -r [ -q ] [ -s scalar ] format timestring
              Output the date denoted by epochtime in the format specified.

              With  the  option  -r  (reverse),  use  the format format to parse the input string
              timestring and output the number of seconds since  the  epoch  at  which  the  time
              occurred.  If no timezone is parsed, the current timezone is used; other parameters
              are set to zero if not present.  If timestring does not match  format  the  command
              returns  status 1; it will additionally print an error message unless the option -q
              (quiet) is  given.   If  timestring  matches  format  but  not  all  characters  in
              timestring  were used, the conversion succeeds; however, a warning is issued unless
              the option -q is given.  The matching is implemented by the system  function  strp‐
              time;  see  strptime(3).   This means that zsh format extensions are not available,
              however for reverse lookup they are not required.  If the function  is  not  imple‐
              mented, the command returns status 2 and (unless -q is given) prints a message.

              If  -s  scalar  is given, assign the date string (or epoch time in seconds if -r is
              given) to scalar instead of printing it.

       The zsh/datetime module makes available several parameters; all are readonly:

       EPOCHREALTIME
              A floating point value representing the number of seconds  since  the  epoch.   The
              notional  accuracy  is to nanoseconds if the clock_gettime call is available and to
              microseconds otherwise, but in practice the  range  of  double  precision  floating
              point and shell scheduling latencies may be significant effects.

       EPOCHSECONDS
              An integer value representing the number of seconds since the epoch.

       epochtime
              An  array  value containing the number of seconds since the epoch in the first ele‐
              ment and the remainder of the time since the epoch in  nanoseconds  in  the  second
              element.   To  ensure the two elements are consistent the array should be copied or
              otherwise referenced as a single substitution before the values are used.  The fol‐
              lowing idiom may be used:

                     for secs nsecs in $epochtime; do
                       ...
                     done

THE ZSH/DELTOCHAR MODULE
       The zsh/deltochar module makes available two ZLE functions:

       delete-to-char
              Read  a  character from the keyboard, and delete from the cursor position up to and
              including the next (or, with repeat count n, the nth) instance of  that  character.
              Negative repeat counts mean delete backwards.

       zap-to-char
              This behaves like delete-to-char, except that the final occurrence of the character
              itself is not deleted.

THE ZSH/EXAMPLE MODULE
       The zsh/example module makes available one builtin command:

       example [ -flags ] [ args ... ]
              Displays the flags and arguments it is invoked with.

       The purpose of the module is to serve as an example of how to write a module.

THE ZSH/FILES MODULE
       The zsh/files module makes  available  some  common  commands  for  file  manipulation  as
       builtins;  these  commands  are  probably not needed for many normal situations but can be
       useful in emergency recovery situations with constrained resources.  The commands  do  not
       implement all features now required by relevant standards committees.

       For  all  commands,  a  variant  beginning zf_ is also available and loaded automatically.
       Using the features capability of zmodload will let you load only those names you want.

       The commands loaded by default are:

       chgrp [ -hRs ] group filename ...
              Changes group of files specified.  This is equivalent to  chown  with  a  user-spec
              argument of `:group'.

       chown [ -hRs ] user-spec filename ...
              Changes ownership and group of files specified.

              The user-spec can be in four forms:

              user   change owner to user; do not change group
              user:: change owner to user; do not change group
              user:  change owner to user; change group to user's primary group
              user:group
                     change owner to user; change group to group
              :group do not change owner; change group to group

              In  each  case,  the  `:' may instead be a `.'.  The rule is that if there is a `:'
              then the separator is `:', otherwise if there is a `.' then the separator  is  `.',
              otherwise there is no separator.

              Each  of user and group may be either a username (or group name, as appropriate) or
              a decimal user ID (group ID).  Interpretation as a name takes precedence, if  there
              is an all-numeric username (or group name).

              If  the  target is a symbolic link, the -h option causes chown to set the ownership
              of the link instead of its target.

              The -R option causes chown to recursively descend into  directories,  changing  the
              ownership  of all files in the directory after changing the ownership of the direc‐
              tory itself.

              The -s option is a zsh extension to chown functionality.  It enables  paranoid  be‐
              haviour,  intended  to avoid security problems involving a chown being tricked into
              affecting files other than the ones intended.  It will refuse  to  follow  symbolic
              links,  so  that  (for  example) ``chown luser /tmp/foo/passwd'' can't accidentally
              chown /etc/passwd if /tmp/foo happens to be a link to /etc.   It  will  also  check
              where  it  is after leaving directories, so that a recursive chown of a deep direc‐
              tory tree can't end up recursively chowning /usr as a result of  directories  being
              moved up the tree.

       ln [ -dfhins ] filename dest
       ln [ -dfhins ] filename ... dir
              Creates  hard (or, with -s, symbolic) links.  In the first form, the specified des‐
              tination is created, as a link to the specified filename.  In the second form, each
              of the filenames is taken in turn, and linked to a pathname in the specified direc‐
              tory that has the same last pathname component.

              Normally, ln will not attempt to create hard links to directories.  This check  can
              be overridden using the -d option.  Typically only the super-user can actually suc‐
              ceed in creating hard links to directories.  This does not apply to symbolic  links
              in any case.

              By  default,  existing files cannot be replaced by links.  The -i option causes the
              user to be queried about replacing existing files.  The -f option  causes  existing
              files to be silently deleted, without querying.  -f takes precedence.

              The  -h  and  -n options are identical and both exist for compatibility; either one
              indicates that if the target is a symlink then it should not be dereferenced.  Typ‐
              ically this is used in combination with -sf so that if an existing link points to a
              directory then it will be removed, instead of followed.  If  this  option  is  used
              with  multiple  filenames and the target is a symbolic link pointing to a directory
              then the result is an error.

       mkdir [ -p ] [ -m mode ] dir ...
              Creates directories.  With the -p option, non-existing parent directories are first
              created  if  necessary,  and  there  will  be no complaint if the directory already
              exists.  The -m option can be used to specify (in octal) a set of file  permissions
              for  the created directories, otherwise mode 777 modified by the current umask (see
              umask(2)) is used.

       mv [ -fi ] filename dest
       mv [ -fi ] filename ... dir
              Moves files.  In the first form, the specified filename is moved to  the  specified
              destination.  In the second form, each of the filenames is taken in turn, and moved
              to a pathname in the specified directory that has the same last pathname component.

              By default, the user will be queried before replacing any file that the user cannot
              write  to,  but  writable files will be silently removed.  The -i option causes the
              user to be queried about replacing any existing files.  The -f  option  causes  any
              existing files to be silently deleted, without querying.  -f takes precedence.

              Note  that  this mv will not move files across devices.  Historical versions of mv,
              when actual renaming is impossible, fall back on copying  and  removing  files;  if
              this  behaviour  is  desired,  use cp and rm manually.  This may change in a future
              version.

       rm [ -dfirs ] filename ...
              Removes files and directories specified.

              Normally, rm will not remove directories (except  with  the  -r  option).   The  -d
              option  causes rm to try removing directories with unlink (see unlink(2)), the same
              method used for files.  Typically only  the  super-user  can  actually  succeed  in
              unlinking directories in this way.  -d takes precedence over -r.

              By  default, the user will be queried before removing any file that the user cannot
              write to, but writable files will be silently removed.  The -i  option  causes  the
              user  to  be  queried  about  removing any files.  The -f option causes files to be
              silently deleted, without querying, and suppresses all error indications.  -f takes
              precedence.

              The -r option causes rm to recursively descend into directories, deleting all files
              in the directory before removing the directory with  the  rmdir  system  call  (see
              rmdir(2)).

              The  -s  option is a zsh extension to rm functionality.  It enables paranoid behav‐
              iour, intended to avoid common security problems  involving  a  root-run  rm  being
              tricked into removing files other than the ones intended.  It will refuse to follow
              symbolic links, so that (for example)  ``rm  /tmp/foo/passwd''  can't  accidentally
              remove  /etc/passwd  if  /tmp/foo happens to be a link to /etc.  It will also check
              where it is after leaving directories, so that a recursive removal of a deep direc‐
              tory  tree  can't end up recursively removing /usr as a result of directories being
              moved up the tree.

       rmdir dir ...
              Removes empty directories specified.

       sync   Calls the system call of the same name (see sync(2)), which flushes  dirty  buffers
              to disk.  It might return before the I/O has actually been completed.

THE ZSH/LANGINFO MODULE
       The zsh/langinfo module makes available one parameter:

       langinfo
              An associative array that maps langinfo elements to their values.

              Your implementation may support a number of the following keys:

              CODESET,  D_T_FMT,  D_FMT,  T_FMT,  RADIXCHAR,  THOUSEP, YESEXPR, NOEXPR, CRNCYSTR,
              ABDAY_{1..7}, DAY_{1..7}, ABMON_{1..12}, MON_{1..12}, T_FMT_AMPM,  AM_STR,  PM_STR,
              ERA, ERA_D_FMT, ERA_D_T_FMT, ERA_T_FMT, ALT_DIGITS

THE ZSH/MAPFILE MODULE
       The zsh/mapfile module provides one special associative array parameter of the same name.

       mapfile
              This associative array takes as keys the names of files; the resulting value is the
              content of the file.  The value is treated identically to  any  other  text  coming
              from  a  parameter.   The  value may also be assigned to, in which case the file in
              question is written (whether or not it originally existed); or an  element  may  be
              unset,  which  will  delete  the  file  in  question.   For  example,  `vared  map‐
              file[myfile]' works as expected, editing the file `myfile'.

              When the array is accessed as a whole, the keys are the names of files in the  cur‐
              rent directory, and the values are empty (to save a huge overhead in memory).  Thus
              ${(k)mapfile} has the same affect as the glob operator *(D), since files  beginning
              with  a  dot  are  not  special.   Care  must  be taken with expressions such as rm
              ${(k)mapfile}, which will delete every file in the current  directory  without  the
              usual `rm *' test.

              The parameter mapfile may be made read-only; in that case, files referenced may not
              be written or deleted.

              A file may conveniently be read into an array as one line per element with the form
              `array=("${(f@)mapfile[filename]}")'.   The double quotes and the `@' are necessary
              to prevent empty lines from being removed.  Note that if the file ends with a  new‐
              line,  the  shell  will  split on the final newline, generating an additional empty
              field;   this   can   be   suppressed   by   using   `array=("${(f@)${mapfile[file‐
              name]%$'\n'}}")'.

   Limitations
       Although  reading and writing of the file in question is efficiently handled, zsh's inter‐
       nal memory management may be arbitrarily baroque; however, mapfile is  usually  very  much
       more efficient than anything involving a loop.  Note in particular that the whole contents
       of the file will always reside physically  in  memory  when  accessed  (possibly  multiple
       times, due to standard parameter substitution operations).  In particular, this means han‐
       dling of sufficiently long files (greater than the machine's swap space, or than the range
       of the pointer type) will be incorrect.

       No errors are printed or flagged for non-existent, unreadable, or unwritable files, as the
       parameter mechanism is too low in the shell execution hierarchy to make this convenient.

       It is unfortunate that the mechanism for loading modules does not yet allow  the  user  to
       specify the name of the shell parameter to be given the special behaviour.

THE ZSH/MATHFUNC MODULE
       The  zsh/mathfunc  module provides standard mathematical functions for use when evaluating
       mathematical formulae.  The syntax agrees with normal C and FORTRAN conventions, for exam‐
       ple,

              (( f = sin(0.3) ))

       assigns the sine of 0.3 to the parameter f.

       Most  functions take floating point arguments and return a floating point value.  However,
       any necessary conversions from or to integer type will be performed automatically  by  the
       shell.   Apart  from atan with a second argument and the abs, int and float functions, all
       functions behave as noted in the manual page for the corresponding C function, except that
       any  arguments out of range for the function in question will be detected by the shell and
       an error reported.

       The following functions take a single floating point argument: acos, acosh,  asin,  asinh,
       atan,  atanh,  cbrt,  ceil,  cos, cosh, erf, erfc, exp, expm1, fabs, floor, gamma, j0, j1,
       lgamma, log, log10, log1p, logb, sin, sinh, sqrt, tan, tanh, y0, y1.   The  atan  function
       can optionally take a second argument, in which case it behaves like the C function atan2.
       The ilogb function takes a single floating point argument, but returns an integer.

       The function signgam takes no arguments, and returns an integer, which is the  C  variable
       of the same name, as described in gamma(3).  Note that it is therefore only useful immedi‐
       ately after a call to gamma or lgamma.  Note also that `signgam()' and `signgam' are  dis‐
       tinct expressions.

       The  following  functions  take  two  floating  point  arguments:  copysign,  fmod, hypot,
       nextafter.

       The following take an integer first argument and a floating point second argument: jn, yn.

       The following take a floating point first argument and an integer second argument:  ldexp,
       scalb.

       The function abs does not convert the type of its single argument; it returns the absolute
       value of either a floating point number or an integer.  The functions float and  int  con‐
       vert their arguments into a floating point or integer value (by truncation) respectively.

       Note that the C pow function is available in ordinary math evaluation as the `**' operator
       and is not provided here.

       The function rand48 is available if your system's mathematical library  has  the  function
       erand48(3).  It returns a pseudo-random floating point number between 0 and 1.  It takes a
       single string optional argument.

       If the argument is not present, the random number seed is initialised by  three  calls  to
       the rand(3) function --- this produces the same random numbers as the next three values of
       $RANDOM.

       If the argument is present, it gives the name of a scalar parameter where the current ran‐
       dom number seed will be stored.  On the first call, the value must contain at least twelve
       hexadecimal digits (the remainder of the string is ignored), or  the  seed  will  be  ini‐
       tialised in the same manner as for a call to rand48 with no argument.  Subsequent calls to
       rand48(param) will then maintain the seed in the parameter param as  a  string  of  twelve
       hexadecimal  digits,  with  no  base signifier.  The random number sequences for different
       parameters are completely independent, and are also independent from that used by calls to
       rand48 with no argument.

       For example, consider

              print $(( rand48(seed) ))
              print $(( rand48() ))
              print $(( rand48(seed) ))

       Assuming  $seed  does  not exist, it will be initialised by the first call.  In the second
       call, the default seed is initialised; note, however, that because of  the  properties  of
       rand()  there  is a correlation between the seeds used for the two initialisations, so for
       more secure uses, you should generate your own 12-byte seed.  The third  call  returns  to
       the  same sequence of random numbers used in the first call, unaffected by the intervening
       rand48().

THE ZSH/NEWUSER MODULE
       The zsh/newuser module is loaded at boot if it is available, the RCS option  is  set,  and
       the  PRIVILEGED option is not set (all three are true by default).  This takes place imme‐
       diately after commands in the global zshenv file (typically /etc/zsh/zshenv), if any, have
       been  executed.   If  the module is not available it is silently ignored by the shell; the
       module may safely be removed from $MODULE_PATH by the administrator if it is not required.

       On loading, the module tests if any of the start-up files .zshenv,  .zprofile,  .zshrc  or
       .zlogin  exist  in  the directory given by the environment variable ZDOTDIR, or the user's
       home directory if that is not set.  The test is not performed and the  module  halts  pro‐
       cessing  if  the shell was in an emulation mode (i.e. had been invoked as some other shell
       than zsh).

       If none of the start-up files were found, the module then looks for the file newuser first
       in a sitewide directory, usually the parent directory of the site-functions directory, and
       if that is not found the module searches in a version-specific directory, usually the par‐
       ent  of the functions directory containing version-specific functions.  (These directories
       can  be  configured  when  zsh  is  built  using   the   --enable-site-scriptdir=dir   and
       --enable-scriptdir=dir flags to configure, respectively; the defaults are prefix/share/zsh
       and prefix/share/zsh/$ZSH_VERSION where the default prefix is /usr/local.)

       If the file newuser is found, it is then sourced in the same manner as  a  start-up  file.
       The  file  is expected to contain code to install start-up files for the user, however any
       valid shell code will be executed.

       The zsh/newuser module is then unconditionally unloaded.

       Note that it is possible to achieve exactly the same effect as the zsh/newuser  module  by
       adding  code  to  /etc/zsh/zshenv.   The  module  exists simply to allow the shell to make
       arrangements for new users without the need for intervention by  package  maintainers  and
       system administrators.

       The  script supplied with the module invokes the shell function zsh-newuser-install.  This
       may be invoked directly by the user even if the zsh/newuser  module  is  disabled.   Note,
       however,  that  if  the module is not installed the function will not be installed either.
       The function is documented in the section User Configuration Functions in zshcontrib(1).

THE ZSH/PARAMETER MODULE
       The zsh/parameter module gives access to some of the internal  hash  tables  used  by  the
       shell by defining some special parameters.

       options
              The  keys  for  this associative array are the names of the options that can be set
              and unset using the setopt and unsetopt builtins. The value of each key  is  either
              the  string  on  if the option is currently set, or the string off if the option is
              unset.  Setting a key to one of these strings is  like  setting  or  unsetting  the
              option, respectively. Unsetting a key in this array is like setting it to the value
              off.

       commands
              This array gives access to the command hash table. The keys are the names of exter‐
              nal commands, the values are the pathnames of the files that would be executed when
              the command would be invoked. Setting a key in this array defines a  new  entry  in
              this  table  in the same way as with the hash builtin. Unsetting a key as in `unset
              "commands[foo]"' removes the entry for the given key from the command hash table.

       functions
              This associative array maps names of enabled functions to their  definitions.  Set‐
              ting a key in it is like defining a function with the name given by the key and the
              body given by the value. Unsetting a key removes the definition  for  the  function
              named by the key.

       dis_functions
              Like functions but for disabled functions.

       builtins
              This  associative  array  gives  information  about  the builtin commands currently
              enabled. The keys are the names of the builtin commands and the values  are  either
              `undefined' for builtin commands that will automatically be loaded from a module if
              invoked or `defined' for builtin commands that are already loaded.

       dis_builtins
              Like builtins but for disabled builtin commands.

       reswords
              This array contains the enabled reserved words.

       dis_reswords
              Like reswords but for disabled reserved words.

       patchars
              This array contains the enabled pattern characters.

       dis_patchars
              Like patchars but for disabled pattern characters.

       aliases
              This maps the names of the regular aliases currently enabled to their expansions.

       dis_aliases
              Like aliases but for disabled regular aliases.

       galiases
              Like aliases, but for global aliases.

       dis_galiases
              Like galiases but for disabled global aliases.

       saliases
              Like raliases, but for suffix aliases.

       dis_saliases
              Like saliases but for disabled suffix aliases.

       parameters
              The keys in this associative array  are  the  names  of  the  parameters  currently
              defined.  The  values are strings describing the type of the parameter, in the same
              format used by the t parameter flag, see zshexpn(1) .  Setting or unsetting keys in
              this array is not possible.

       modules
              An  associative  array  giving information about modules. The keys are the names of
              the modules loaded, registered to be autoloaded, or aliased. The value  says  which
              state  the  named module is in and is one of the strings `loaded', `autoloaded', or
              `alias:name', where name is the name the module is aliased to.

              Setting or unsetting keys in this array is not possible.

       dirstack
              A normal array holding the elements of the directory stack. Note that the output of
              the  dirs  builtin  command includes one more directory, the current working direc‐
              tory.

       history
              This associative array maps history event numbers to the full history lines.

       historywords
              A special array containing the words stored in the history.

       jobdirs
              This associative array maps job numbers to the directories from which the  job  was
              started (which may not be the current directory of the job).

              The keys of the associative arrays are usually valid job numbers, and these are the
              values output with, for example, ${(k)jobdirs}.  Non-numeric job references may  be
              used  when  looking  up  a value; for example, ${jobdirs[%+]} refers to the current
              job.

       jobtexts
              This associative array maps job numbers to the texts of the command lines that were
              used to start the jobs.

              Handling of the keys of the associative array is as described for jobdirs above.

       jobstates
              This  associative  array  gives  information about the states of the jobs currently
              known. The keys are the job  numbers  and  the  values  are  strings  of  the  form
              `job-state:mark:pid=state...'.  The job-state gives the state the whole job is cur‐
              rently in, one of `running', `suspended', or `done'. The mark is `+' for  the  cur‐
              rent  job,  `-'  for  the previous job and empty otherwise. This is followed by one
              `pid=state' for every process in the job. The pids are, of course, the process  IDs
              and the state describes the state of that process.

              Handling of the keys of the associative array is as described for jobdirs above.

       nameddirs
              This  associative  array  maps the names of named directories to the pathnames they
              stand for.

       userdirs
              This associative array maps user names to the pathnames of their home directories.

       usergroups
              This associative array maps names of system groups of which the current user  is  a
              member  to  the  corresponding group identifiers.  The contents are the same as the
              groups output by the id command.

       funcfiletrace
              This array contains the absolute line numbers and corresponding file names for  the
              point  where  the  current  function, sourced file, or (if EVAL_LINENO is set) eval
              command was called.  The array is of the same length as funcsourcetrace  and  func‐
              trace,  but differs from funcsourcetrace in that the line and file are the point of
              call, not the point of definition, and differs from functrace in  that  all  values
              are  absolute  line  numbers in files, rather than relative to the start of a func‐
              tion, if any.

       funcsourcetrace
              This array contains the file names and line numbers of the points where  the  func‐
              tions,  sourced  files,  and  (if EVAL_LINENO is set) eval commands currently being
              executed were defined.  The line number is the line where the  `function  name'  or
              `name  ()'  started.   In  the  case  of an autoloaded function  the line number is
              reported as zero.  The format of each element is  filename:lineno.   For  functions
              autoloaded  from  a  file in native zsh format, where only the body of the function
              occurs in the file, or for files that have been  executed  by  the  source  or  `.'
              builtins,  the  trace  information is shown as filename:0, since the entire file is
              the definition.

              Most users will be  interested  in  the  information  in  the  funcfiletrace  array
              instead.

       funcstack
              This  array contains the names of the functions, sourced files, and (if EVAL_LINENO
              is set) eval commands. currently being executed. The first element is the  name  of
              the function using the parameter.

              The  standard  shell  array  zsh_eval_context  can be used to determine the type of
              shell construct being executed at each depth: note, however, that is in  the  oppo‐
              site  order,  with  the most recent item last, and it is more detailed, for example
              including an entry for toplevel, the main shell code being executed either interac‐
              tively or from a script, which is not present in $funcstack.

       functrace
              This  array contains the names and line numbers of the callers corresponding to the
              functions currently being executed.  The format of  each  element  is  name:lineno.
              Callers  are also shown for sourced files; the caller is the point where the source
              or `.' command was executed.

THE ZSH/PCRE MODULE
       The zsh/pcre module makes some commands available as builtins:

       pcre_compile [ -aimxs ] PCRE
              Compiles a perl-compatible regular expression.

              Option -a will force the  pattern  to  be  anchored.   Option  -i  will  compile  a
              case-insensitive  pattern.  Option -m will compile a multi-line pattern; that is, ^
              and $ will match newlines within the pattern.  Option -x will compile  an  extended
              pattern,  wherein  whitespace  and # comments are ignored.  Option -s makes the dot
              metacharacter match all characters, including those that indicate newline.

       pcre_study
              Studies the previously-compiled PCRE which may result in faster matching.

       pcre_match [ -v var ] [ -a arr ] [ -n offset ] [ -b ] string
              Returns successfully if string matches the previously-compiled PCRE.

              Upon successful match, if the expression captures  substrings  within  parentheses,
              pcre_match  will  set the array $match to those substrings, unless the -a option is
              given, in which case it will set the array arr.  Similarly, the variable MATCH will
              be  set to the entire matched portion of the string, unless the -v option is given,
              in which case the variable var will be set.  No variables are altered if  there  is
              no successful match.  A -n option starts searching for a match from the byte offset
              position in string.  If the -b option is given, the variable ZPCRE_OP will  be  set
              to  an  offset  pair  string,  representing the byte offset positions of the entire
              matched portion within the string.  For example, a ZPCRE_OP set to  "32  45"  indi‐
              cates that the matched portion began on byte offset 32 and ended on byte offset 44.
              Here, byte offset position 45 is the position directly after the  matched  portion.
              Keep  in  mind  that  the byte position isn't necessarily the same as the character
              position when UTF-8 characters are involved.  Consequently, the byte  offset  posi‐
              tions are only to be relied on in the context of using them for subsequent searches
              on string, using an offset position as an argument  to  the  -n  option.   This  is
              mostly used to implement the "find all non-overlapping matches" functionality.

              A simple example of "find all non-overlapping matches":

                     string="The following zip codes: 78884 90210 99513"
                     pcre_compile -m "\d{5}"
                     accum=()
                     pcre_match -b -- $string
                     while [[ $? -eq 0 ]] do
                         b=($=ZPCRE_OP)
                         accum+=$MATCH
                         pcre_match -b -n $b[2] -- $string
                     done
                     print -l $accum

       The zsh/pcre module makes available the following test condition:

       expr -pcre-match pcre
              Matches a string against a perl-compatible regular expression.

              For example,

                     [[ "$text" -pcre-match ^d+$ ]] &&
                     print text variable contains only "d's".

              If  the  REMATCH_PCRE  option is set, the =~ operator is equivalent to -pcre-match,
              and the NO_CASE_MATCH option may be used.  Note that NO_CASE_MATCH never applies to
              the pcre_match builtin, instead use the -i switch of pcre_compile.

THE ZSH/REGEX MODULE
       The zsh/regex module makes available the following test condition:

       expr -regex-match regex
              Matches a string against a POSIX extended regular expression.  On successful match,
              matched portion of the string will normally be placed in the  MATCH  variable.   If
              there are any capturing parentheses within the regex, then the match array variable
              will contain those.  If the match is not successful, then the variables will not be
              altered.

              For example,

                     [[ alphabetical -regex-match ^a([^a]+)a([^a]+)a ]] &&
                     print -l $MATCH X $match

              If the option REMATCH_PCRE is not set, then the =~ operator will automatically load
              this module as needed and will invoke the -regex-match operator.

              If BASH_REMATCH is set, then the array BASH_REMATCH will be set  instead  of  MATCH
              and match.

THE ZSH/SCHED MODULE
       The zsh/sched module makes available one builtin command and one parameter.

       sched [-o] [+]hh:mm[:ss] command ...
       sched [-o] [+]seconds command ...
       sched [ -item ]
              Make an entry in the scheduled list of commands to execute.  The time may be speci‐
              fied in either absolute or relative time, and either as hours, minutes and (option‐
              ally)  seconds  separated by a colon, or seconds alone.  An absolute number of sec‐
              onds indicates the time since the epoch (1970/01/01 00:00); this is useful in  com‐
              bination  with the features in the zsh/datetime module, see the zsh/datetime module
              entry in zshmodules(1).

              With no arguments, prints the list of scheduled commands.  If the scheduled command
              has the -o flag set, this is shown at the start of the command.

              With  the argument `-item', removes the given item from the list.  The numbering of
              the list is continuous and entries are in time order, so the numbering  can  change
              when entries are added or deleted.

              Commands are executed either immediately before a prompt, or while the shell's line
              editor is waiting for input.  In the latter case it is useful to be able to produce
              output that does not interfere with the line being edited.  Providing the option -o
              causes the shell to clear the command line before the event and  redraw  it  after‐
              wards.   This  should be used with any scheduled event that produces visible output
              to the terminal; it is not needed, for example, with output that updates a terminal
              emulator's title bar.

              The  sched builtin is not made available by default when the shell starts in a mode
              emulating another shell.  It can be made available with the  command  `zmodload  -F
              zsh/sched b:sched'.

       zsh_scheduled_events
              A  readonly  array corresponding to the events scheduled by the sched builtin.  The
              indices of the array correspond to the numbers shown when  sched  is  run  with  no
              arguments (provided that the KSH_ARRAYS option is not set).  The value of the array
              consists of the scheduled time in seconds since the epoch  (see  the  section  `The
              zsh/datetime  Module'  for  facilities for using this number), followed by a colon,
              followed by any options (which may be empty but will be preceded by  a  `-'  other‐
              wise), followed by a colon, followed by the command to be executed.

              The  sched builtin should be used for manipulating the events.  Note that this will
              have an immediate effect on the contents of the array, so that indices  may  become
              invalid.

THE ZSH/NET/SOCKET MODULE
       The zsh/net/socket module makes available one builtin command:

       zsocket [ -altv ] [ -d fd ] [ args ]
              zsocket  is  implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell command line edit‐
              ing, file I/O, and job control mechanisms.

   Outbound Connections
       zsocket [ -v ] [ -d fd ] filename
              Open a new Unix domain connection to filename.  The shell parameter REPLY  will  be
              set to the file descriptor associated with that connection.  Currently, only stream
              connections are supported.

              If -d is specified, its argument will be taken as the target  file  descriptor  for
              the connection.

              In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Inbound Connections
       zsocket -l [ -v ] [ -d fd ] filename
              zsocket  -l  will  open  a socket listening on filename.  The shell parameter REPLY
              will be set to the file descriptor associated with that listener.

              If -d is specified, its argument will be taken as the target  file  descriptor  for
              the connection.

              In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

       zsocket -a [ -tv ] [ -d targetfd ] listenfd
              zsocket  -a  will  accept an incoming connection to the socket associated with lis‐
              tenfd.  The shell parameter REPLY will be set to  the  file  descriptor  associated
              with the inbound connection.

              If  -d  is  specified, its argument will be taken as the target file descriptor for
              the connection.

              If -t is specified, zsocket will return if no incoming connection is pending.  Oth‐
              erwise it will wait for one.

              In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

THE ZSH/STAT MODULE
       The zsh/stat module makes available one builtin command under two possible names:

       zstat  [  -gnNolLtTrs  ] [ -f fd ] [ -H hash ] [ -A array ] [ -F fmt ] [ +element ] [ file
       ... ]
       stat ...
              The command acts as a front end to the stat system call (see  stat(2)).   The  same
              command  is  provided with two names; as the name stat is often used by an external
              command it is recommended that only the zstat form of the command  is  used.   This
              can  be  arranged  by  loading  the  module  with the command `zmodload -F zsh/stat
              b:zstat'.

              If the stat call fails, the appropriate system error message printed and  status  1
              is  returned.   The fields of struct stat give information about the files provided
              as arguments to the command.  In addition to those available from the stat call, an
              extra element `link' is provided.  These elements are:

              device The number of the device on which the file resides.

              inode  The unique number of the file on this device (`inode' number).

              mode   The mode of the file; that is, the file's type and access permissions.  With
                     the -s option, this will be returned as a string corresponding to the  first
                     column in the display of the ls -l command.

              nlink  The number of hard links to the file.

              uid    The user ID of the owner of the file.  With the -s option, this is displayed
                     as a user name.

              gid    The group ID of the file.  With the -s option, this is displayed as a  group
                     name.

              rdev   The raw device number.  This is only useful for special devices.

              size   The size of the file in bytes.

              atime
              mtime
              ctime  The  last  access,  modification and inode change times of the file, respec‐
                     tively, as the number of seconds since midnight GMT on  1st  January,  1970.
                     With  the  -s  option, these are printed as strings for the local time zone;
                     the format can be altered with the -F option, and with  the  -g  option  the
                     times are in GMT.

              blksize
                     The  number of bytes in one allocation block on the device on which the file
                     resides.

              block  The number of disk blocks used by the file.

              link   If the file is a link and the -L option is in effect, this contains the name
                     of  the file linked to, otherwise it is empty.  Note that if this element is
                     selected (``zstat +link'') then the -L option is automatically used.

              A particular element may be selected by including its name preceded by a `+' in the
              option  list;  only  one  element  is allowed.  The element may be shortened to any
              unique set of leading characters.  Otherwise, all elements will be  shown  for  all
              files.

              Options:

              -A array
                     Instead  of  displaying  the  results  on standard output, assign them to an
                     array, one struct stat element per array element for each file in order.  In
                     this  case neither the name of the element nor the name of the files appears
                     in array unless the -t or -n options were given,  respectively.   If  -t  is
                     given,  the  element  name appears as a prefix to the appropriate array ele‐
                     ment; if -n is given, the file name appears as a separate array element pre‐
                     ceding all the others.  Other formatting options are respected.

              -H hash
                     Similar to -A, but instead assign the values to hash.  The keys are the ele‐
                     ments listed above.  If the -n option is provided then the name of the  file
                     is included in the hash with key name.

              -f fd  Use  the  file on file descriptor fd instead of named files; no list of file
                     names is allowed in this case.

              -F fmt Supplies a strftime (see strftime(3)) string for the formatting of the  time
                     elements.  The -s option is implied.

              -g     Show the time elements in the GMT time zone.  The -s option is implied.

              -l     List  the  names  of  the  type  elements (to standard output or an array as
                     appropriate) and return immediately; options other than -A and arguments are
                     ignored.

              -L     Perform  an  lstat  (see  lstat(2)) rather than a stat system call.  In this
                     case, if the file is a link, information about the link itself  rather  than
                     the  target file is returned.  This option is required to make the link ele‐
                     ment useful.  It's important to note that this is the  exact  opposite  from
                     ls(1), etc.

              -n     Always show the names of files.  Usually these are only shown when output is
                     to standard output and there is more than one file in the list.

              -N     Never show the names of files.

              -o     If a raw file mode is printed, show it in octal, which is  more  useful  for
                     human  consumption  than  the  default  of  decimal.  A leading zero will be
                     printed in this case.  Note that this does not affect whether a raw or  for‐
                     matted file mode is shown, which is controlled by the -r and -s options, nor
                     whether a mode is shown at all.

              -r     Print raw data (the default format) alongside string data (the  -s  format);
                     the string data appears in parentheses after the raw data.

              -s     Print  mode, uid, gid and the three time elements as strings instead of num‐
                     bers.  In each case the format is like that of ls -l.

              -t     Always show the type names for the elements of struct stat.   Usually  these
                     are  only  shown when output is to standard output and no individual element
                     has been selected.

              -T     Never show the type names of the struct stat elements.

THE ZSH/SYSTEM MODULE
       The zsh/system module makes available various builtin commands and parameters.

   Builtins
       syserror [ -e errvar ] [ -p prefix ] [ errno | errname ]
              This command prints out the error message associated with  errno,  a  system  error
              number, followed by a newline to standard error.

              Instead  of the error number, a name errname, for example ENOENT, may be used.  The
              set of names is the same as the contents of the array errnos, see below.

              If the string prefix is given, it is printed in front of the error message, with no
              intervening space.

              If  errvar  is  supplied, the entire message, without a newline, is assigned to the
              parameter names errvar and nothing is output.

              A return status of 0 indicates the message was successfully  printed  (although  it
              may not be useful if the error number was out of the system's range), a return sta‐
              tus of 1 indicates an error in the parameters, and a return status of  2  indicates
              the error name was not recognised (no message is printed for this).

       sysread [ -c countvar ] [ -i infd ] [ -o outfd ]
         [ -s bufsize ] [ -t timeout ] [ param ]
              Perform  a  single  system  read  from file descriptor infd, or zero if that is not
              given.  The result of the read is stored in param or REPLY if that  is  not  given.
              If  countvar  is given, the number of bytes read is assigned to the parameter named
              by countvar.

              The maximum number of bytes read is bufsize or 8192 if that is not  given,  however
              the command returns as soon as any number of bytes was successfully read.

              If  timeout  is given, it specifies a timeout in seconds, which may be zero to poll
              the file descriptor.  This is handled by the poll system call if available,  other‐
              wise the select system call if available.

              If  outfd is given, an attempt is made to write all the bytes just read to the file
              descriptor outfd.  If this fails, because of a system error  other  than  EINTR  or
              because  of an internal zsh error during an interrupt, the bytes read but not writ‐
              ten are stored in the parameter named by param if supplied (no default is  used  in
              this case), and the number of bytes read but not written is stored in the parameter
              named by countvar if that is supplied.  If it was successful, countvar contains the
              full number of bytes transferred, as usual, and param is not set.

              The  error  EINTR  (interrupted  system  call)  is handled internally so that shell
              interrupts are transparent to the caller.  Any other error causes a return.

              The possible return statuses are
              0      At least one byte of data was successfully read and, if  appropriate,  writ‐
                     ten.

              1      There was an error in the parameters to the command.  This is the only error
                     for which a message is printed to standard error.

              2      There was an error on the read, or on polling the input file descriptor  for
                     a timeout.  The parameter ERRNO gives the error.

              3      Data  were  successfully read, but there was an error writing them to outfd.
                     The parameter ERRNO gives the error.

              4      The attempt to read timed out.  Note this does not set ERRNO as this is  not
                     a system error.

              5      No  system error occurred, but zero bytes were read.  This usually indicates
                     end of file.  The parameters are set according to the usual rules; no  write
                     to outfd is attempted.

       syswrite [ -c countvar ] [ -o outfd ] data
              The  data (a single string of bytes) are written to the file descriptor outfd, or 1
              if that is not given, using the write system call.  Multiple write  operations  may
              be used if the first does not write all the data.

              If  countvar  is given, the number of byte written is stored in the parameter named
              by countvar; this may not be the full length of data if an error occurred.

              The error EINTR (interrupted system call) is handled internally by retrying; other‐
              wise an error causes the command to return.  For example, if the file descriptor is
              set to non-blocking output, an error EAGAIN  (on  some  systems,  EWOULDBLOCK)  may
              result in the command returning early.

              The  return  status  may  be 0 for success, 1 for an error in the parameters to the
              command, or 2 for an error on the write; no error message is printed  in  the  last
              case, but the parameter ERRNO will reflect the error that occurred.

       zsystem flock [ -t timeout ] [ -f var ] [-er] file
       zsystem flock -u fd_expr
              The  builtin  zsystem's  subcommand  flock  performs advisory file locking (via the
              fcntl(2) system call) over the entire contents of the given  file.   This  form  of
              locking  requires  the  processes accessing the file to cooperate; its most obvious
              use is between two instances of the shell itself.

              In the first form the named file, which must already exist, is locked by opening  a
              file  descriptor  to the file and applying a lock to the file descriptor.  The lock
              terminates when the shell process that created the  lock  exits;  it  is  therefore
              often convenient to create file locks within subshells, since the lock is automati‐
              cally released when the subshell exits.  Status 0 is returned if the lock succeeds,
              else status 1.

              In  the  second form the file descriptor given by the arithmetic expression fd_expr
              is closed, releasing a lock.  The file descriptor can be queried by using  the  `-f
              var'  form  during the lock; on a successful lock, the shell variable var is set to
              the file descriptor used for locking.  The  lock  will  be  released  if  the  file
              descriptor  is  closed  by any other means, for example using `exec {var}>&-'; how‐
              ever, the form described here performs a safety check that the file  descriptor  is
              in use for file locking.

              By  default  the  shell  waits indefinitely for the lock to succeed.  The option -t
              timeout specifies a timeout for the lock in seconds;  currently  this  must  be  an
              integer.  The shell will attempt to lock the file once a second during this period.
              If the attempt times out, status 2 is returned.

              If the option -e is given, the file descriptor for the lock is preserved  when  the
              shell  uses  exec  to start a new process; otherwise it is closed at that point and
              the lock released.

              If the option -r is given, the lock is only for reading, otherwise it is for  read‐
              ing and writing.  The file descriptor is opened accordingly.

       zsystem supports subcommand
              The  builtin zsystem's subcommand supports tests whether a given subcommand is sup‐
              ported.  It returns status 0 if so, else status 1.   It  operates  silently  unless
              there was a syntax error (i.e. the wrong number of arguments), in which case status
              255 is returned.  Status 1 can indicate one of two things:  subcommand is known but
              not supported by the current operating system, or subcommand is not known (possibly
              because this is an older version of the shell before it was implemented).

   Parameters
       errnos A readonly array of the names of errors defined on the system.  These are typically
              macros defined in C by including the system header file errno.h.  The index of each
              name (assuming the option KSH_ARRAYS is unset) corresponds  to  the  error  number.
              Error numbers num before the last known error which have no name are given the name
              Enum in the array.

              Note that aliases for errors are not handled; only the canonical name is used.

       sysparams
              A readonly associative array.  The keys are:
       pid    Returns the process ID of the current process,  even  in  subshells.   Compare  $$,
              which returns the process ID of the main shell process.

       ppid   Returns  the  process  ID  of the parent of the current process, even in subshells.
              Compare $PPID, which returns the process  ID  of  the  parent  of  the  main  shell
              process.

THE ZSH/NET/TCP MODULE
       The zsh/net/tcp module makes available one builtin command:

       ztcp [ -acflLtv ] [ -d fd ] [ args ]
              ztcp  is  implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell command line editing,
              file I/O, and job control mechanisms.

              If ztcp is run with no options, it will output the contents of its session table.

              If it is run with only the option -L, it will output the contents  of  the  session
              table  in  a format suitable for automatic parsing.  The option is ignored if given
              with a command to open or close a session.  The output consists of a set of  lines,
              one per session, each containing the following elements separated by spaces:

              File descriptor
                     The  file  descriptor in use for the connection.  For normal inbound (I) and
                     outbound (O) connections this may be read and written  by  the  usual  shell
                     mechanisms.  However, it should only be close with `ztcp -c'.

              Connection type
                     A letter indicating how the session was created:

                     Z      A session created with the zftp command.

                     L      A connection opened for listening with `ztcp -l'.

                     I      An inbound connection accepted with `ztcp -a'.

                     O      An outbound connection created with `ztcp host ...'.

              The local host
                     This  is  usually set to an all-zero IP address as the address of the local‐
                     host is irrelevant.

              The local port
                     This is likely to be zero unless the connection is for listening.

              The remote host
                     This is the fully qualified domain name of the peer, if available,  else  an
                     IP  address.   It is an all-zero IP address for a session opened for listen‐
                     ing.

              The remote port
                     This is zero for a connection opened for listening.

   Outbound Connections
       ztcp [ -v ] [ -d fd ] host [ port ]
              Open a new TCP connection to host.  If the port is omitted, it will default to port
              23.   The  connection  will  be  added to the session table and the shell parameter
              REPLY will be set to the file descriptor associated with that connection.

              If -d is specified, its argument will be taken as the target  file  descriptor  for
              the connection.

              In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Inbound Connections
       ztcp -l [ -v ] [ -d fd ] port
              ztcp  -l will open a socket listening on TCP port.  The socket will be added to the
              session table and the shell parameter REPLY will be  set  to  the  file  descriptor
              associated with that listener.

              If  -d  is  specified, its argument will be taken as the target file descriptor for
              the connection.

              In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

       ztcp -a [ -tv ] [ -d targetfd ] listenfd
              ztcp -a will accept an incoming connection to the port  associated  with  listenfd.
              The  connection  will  be  added to the session table and the shell parameter REPLY
              will be set to the file descriptor associated with the inbound connection.

              If -d is specified, its argument will be taken as the target  file  descriptor  for
              the connection.

              If  -t is specified, ztcp will return if no incoming connection is pending.  Other‐
              wise it will wait for one.

              In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Closing Connections
       ztcp -cf [ -v ] [ fd ]
       ztcp -c [ -v ] [ fd ]
              ztcp -c will close the socket associated with fd.  The socket will be removed  from
              the  session table.  If fd is not specified, ztcp will close everything in the ses‐
              sion table.

              Normally, sockets registered by zftp (see zshmodules(1) )  cannot  be  closed  this
              way.  In order to force such a socket closed, use -f.

              In order to elicit more verbose output, use -v.

   Example
       Here  is  how to create a TCP connection between two instances of zsh.  We need to pick an
       unassigned port; here we use the randomly chosen 5123.

       On host1,
              zmodload zsh/net/tcp
              ztcp -l 5123
              listenfd=$REPLY
              ztcp -a $listenfd
              fd=$REPLY
       The second from last command blocks until there is an incoming connection.

       Now create a connection from host2 (which may, of course, be the same machine):
              zmodload zsh/net/tcp
              ztcp host1 5123
              fd=$REPLY

       Now on each host, $fd contains a file descriptor for talking to the other.   For  example,
       on host1:
              print This is a message >&$fd
       and on host2:
              read -r line <&$fd; print -r - $line
       prints `This is a message'.

       To tidy up, on host1:
              ztcp -c $listenfd
              ztcp -c $fd
       and on host2
              ztcp -c $fd

THE ZSH/TERMCAP MODULE
       The zsh/termcap module makes available one builtin command:

       echotc cap [ arg ... ]
              Output  the  termcap value corresponding to the capability cap, with optional argu‐
              ments.

       The zsh/termcap module makes available one parameter:

       termcap
              An associative array that maps termcap capability codes to their values.

THE ZSH/TERMINFO MODULE
       The zsh/terminfo module makes available one builtin command:

       echoti cap [ arg ]
              Output the terminfo value corresponding to the capability  cap,  instantiated  with
              arg if applicable.

       The zsh/terminfo module makes available one parameter:

       terminfo
              An associative array that maps terminfo capability names to their values.

THE ZSH/ZFTP MODULE
       The zsh/zftp module makes available one builtin command:

       zftp subcommand [ args ]
              The  zsh/zftp  module  is  a client for FTP (file transfer protocol).  It is imple‐
              mented as a builtin to allow full use of shell command line editing, file I/O,  and
              job  control mechanisms.  Often, users will access it via shell functions providing
              a more powerful interface; a set is provided  with  the  zsh  distribution  and  is
              described  in  zshzftpsys(1).   However, the zftp command is entirely usable in its
              own right.

              All commands consist of the command name zftp followed by the name of a subcommand.
              These  are  listed  below.   The  return  status  of each subcommand is supposed to
              reflect the success or failure of the remote operation.  See a description  of  the
              variable  ZFTP_VERBOSE for more information on how responses from the server may be
              printed.

   Subcommands
       open host[:port] [ user [ password [ account ] ] ]
              Open a new FTP session to host, which may be the name of a TCP/IP connected host or
              an  IP  number  in  the  standard  dot  notation.   If  the argument is in the form
              host:port, open a connection to TCP port port instead of the standard FTP port  21.
              This  may  be  the  name  of  a  TCP  service  or a number:  see the description of
              ZFTP_PORT below for more information.

              If IPv6 addresses in colon format are used, the host should be surrounded by quoted
              square    brackets    to    distinguish    it    from   the   port,   for   example
              '[fe80::203:baff:fe02:8b56]'.  For consistency this is allowed with  all  forms  of
              host.

              Remaining  arguments are passed to the login subcommand.  Note that if no arguments
              beyond host are supplied, open will not automatically call login.  If no  arguments
              at all are supplied, open will use the parameters set by the params subcommand.

              After  a  successful  open,  the  shell variables ZFTP_HOST, ZFTP_PORT, ZFTP_IP and
              ZFTP_SYSTEM are available; see `Variables' below.

       login [ name [ password [ account ] ] ]
       user [ name [ password [ account ] ] ]
              Login the user name with parameters password and account.  Any  of  the  parameters
              can  be  omitted,  and  will  be read from standard input if needed (name is always
              needed).  If standard input is a terminal, a prompt for each one will be printed on
              standard  error  and password will not be echoed.  If any of the parameters are not
              used, a warning message is printed.

              After a successful login, the shell variables ZFTP_USER, ZFTP_ACCOUNT and  ZFTP_PWD
              are available; see `Variables' below.

              This command may be re-issued when a user is already logged in, and the server will
              first be reinitialized for a new user.

       params [ host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ] ]
       params -
              Store the given parameters for a later open command with no arguments.  Only  those
              given  on  the  command  line  will  be remembered.  If no arguments are given, the
              parameters currently set are printed, although the password will appear as  a  line
              of stars; the return status is one if no parameters were set, zero otherwise.

              Any  of  the  parameters  may be specified as a `?', which may need to be quoted to
              protect it from shell expansion.  In this case, the appropriate parameter  will  be
              read  from  stdin as with the login subcommand, including special handling of pass‐
              word.  If the `?' is followed by a string, that is used as the prompt  for  reading
              the  parameter instead of the default message (any necessary punctuation and white‐
              space should be included at the end of the prompt).  The first letter of the param‐
              eter  (only)  may be quoted with a `\'; hence an argument "\\$word" guarantees that
              the string from the shell parameter $word will be treated literally, whether or not
              it begins with a `?'.

              If instead a single `-' is given, the existing parameters, if any, are deleted.  In
              that case, calling open with no arguments will cause an error.

              The list of parameters is not deleted after a close, however it will be deleted  if
              the zsh/zftp module is unloaded.

              For example,

                     zftp params ftp.elsewhere.xx juser '?Password for juser: '

              will  store  the  host ftp.elsewhere.xx and the user juser and then prompt the user
              for the corresponding password with the given prompt.

       test   Test the connection; if the server has reported that it has closed  the  connection
              (maybe due to a timeout), return status 2; if no connection was open anyway, return
              status 1; else return status 0.  The test subcommand is silent, apart from messages
              printed by the $ZFTP_VERBOSE mechanism, or error messages if the connection closes.
              There is no network overhead for this test.

              The test is only supported on systems with either the select(2) or  poll(2)  system
              calls; otherwise the message `not supported on this system' is printed instead.

              The  test subcommand will automatically be called at the start of any other subcom‐
              mand for the current session when a connection is open.

       cd directory
              Change the remote directory to directory.  Also alters the shell variable ZFTP_PWD.

       cdup   Change the remote directory to the one higher in the directory tree.  Note that  cd
              .. will also work correctly on non-UNIX systems.

       dir [ args... ]
              Give  a (verbose) listing of the remote directory.  The args are passed directly to
              the server. The command's behaviour is implementation dependent, but a UNIX  server
              will  typically interpret args as arguments to the ls command and with no arguments
              return the result of `ls -l'. The directory is listed to standard output.

       ls [ args ]
              Give a (short) listing of the remote directory.  With no args, produces a raw  list
              of  the  files  in  the  directory, one per line.  Otherwise, up to vagaries of the
              server implementation, behaves similar to dir.

       type [ type ]
              Change the type for the transfer to type, or print the  current  type  if  type  is
              absent.   The  allowed  values are `A' (ASCII), `I' (Image, i.e. binary), or `B' (a
              synonym for `I').

              The FTP default for a transfer is ASCII.  However, if zftp finds  that  the  remote
              host  is  a  UNIX  machine  with  8-bit byes, it will automatically switch to using
              binary for file transfers upon open.  This can subsequently be overridden.

              The transfer type is only passed to the remote  host  when  a  data  connection  is
              established; this command involves no network overhead.

       ascii  The same as type A.

       binary The same as type I.

       mode [ S | B ]
              Set  the  mode  type to stream (S) or block (B).  Stream mode is the default; block
              mode is not widely supported.

       remote files...
       local [ files... ]
              Print the size and last modification time of the remote or local files.   If  there
              is  more  than  one  item  on the list, the name of the file is printed first.  The
              first number is the file size, the second is the last modification time of the file
              in  the  format  CCYYMMDDhhmmSS  consisting of year, month, date, hour, minutes and
              seconds in GMT.  Note that this format, including the  length,  is  guaranteed,  so
              that  time strings can be directly compared via the [[ builtin's < and > operators,
              even if they are too long to be represented as integers.

              Not all servers support the commands for  retrieving  this  information.   In  that
              case, the remote command will print nothing and return status 2, compared with sta‐
              tus 1 for a file not found.

              The local command (but not remote) may be used with no arguments, in which case the
              information  comes  from  examining file descriptor zero.  This is the same file as
              seen by a put command with no further redirection.

       get file [...]
              Retrieve all files from the server, concatenating them and sending them to standard
              output.

       put file [...]
              For  each  file,  read  a file from standard input and send that to the remote host
              with the given name.

       append file [...]
              As put, but if the remote file already exists, data is appended to  it  instead  of
              overwriting it.

       getat file point
       putat file point
       appendat file point
              Versions of get, put and append which will start the transfer at the given point in
              the remote file.  This is useful for appending to an incomplete local  file.   How‐
              ever,  note  that  this ability is not universally supported by servers (and is not
              quite the behaviour specified by the standard).

       delete file [...]
              Delete the list of files on the server.

       mkdir directory
              Create a new directory directory on the server.

       rmdir directory
              Delete the directory directory  on the server.

       rename old-name new-name
              Rename file old-name to new-name on the server.

       site args...
              Send a host-specific command to the server.  You will probably only  need  this  if
              instructed by the server to use it.

       quote args...
              Send  the  raw FTP command sequence to the server.  You should be familiar with the
              FTP command set as defined in  RFC959  before  doing  this.   Useful  commands  may
              include STAT and HELP.  Note also the mechanism for returning messages as described
              for the variable ZFTP_VERBOSE below, in particular that all messages from the  con‐
              trol connection are sent to standard error.

       close
       quit   Close  the  current  data  connection.  This unsets the shell parameters ZFTP_HOST,
              ZFTP_PORT, ZFTP_IP, ZFTP_SYSTEM, ZFTP_USER, ZFTP_ACCOUNT, ZFTP_PWD,  ZFTP_TYPE  and
              ZFTP_MODE.

       session [ sessname ]
              Allows  multiple  FTP  sessions  to be used at once.  The name of the session is an
              arbitrary string of characters; the default session is called `default'.   If  this
              command  is called without an argument, it will list all the current sessions; with
              an argument, it will either switch to the existing session called sessname, or cre‐
              ate a new session of that name.

              Each session remembers the status of the connection, the set of connection-specific
              shell parameters (the same set as are unset when a connection closes, as  given  in
              the  description  of close), and any user parameters specified with the params sub‐
              command.  Changing to a previous session restores those values; changing to  a  new
              session initialises them in the same way as if zftp had just been loaded.  The name
              of the current session is given by the parameter ZFTP_SESSION.

       rmsession [ sessname ]
              Delete a session; if a name is not given, the current session is deleted.   If  the
              current  session  is deleted, the earliest existing session becomes the new current
              session, otherwise the current session  is  not  changed.   If  the  session  being
              deleted  is the only one, a new session called `default' is created and becomes the
              current session; note that this is a new session even if the session being  deleted
              is  also  called  `default'.  It  is recommended that sessions not be deleted while
              background commands which use zftp are still active.

   Parameters
       The following shell parameters are used by zftp.  Currently none of them are special.

       ZFTP_TMOUT
              Integer.  The time in seconds to wait for a network operation  to  complete  before
              returning an error.  If this is not set when the module is loaded, it will be given
              the default value 60.  A value of zero turns off timeouts.  If a timeout occurs  on
              the  control  connection  it will be closed.  Use a larger value if this occurs too
              frequently.

       ZFTP_IP
              Readonly.  The IP address of the current connection in dot notation.

       ZFTP_HOST
              Readonly.  The hostname of the current remote server.  If the host was opened as an
              IP  number,  ZFTP_HOST  contains  that  instead; this saves the overhead for a name
              lookup, as IP numbers are most commonly used when a nameserver is unavailable.

       ZFTP_PORT
              Readonly.  The number of the remote TCP port to which the connection is open  (even
              if  the  port  was  originally  specified as a named service).  Usually this is the
              standard FTP port, 21.

              In the unlikely event that your system does not  have  the  appropriate  conversion
              functions,  this  appears  in network byte order.  If your system is little-endian,
              the port then consists of two swapped bytes and the standard port will be  reported
              as  5376.   In that case, numeric ports passed to zftp open will also need to be in
              this format.

       ZFTP_SYSTEM
              Readonly.  The system type string returned by the server in response to an FTP SYST
              request.   The  most  interesting case is a string beginning "UNIX Type: L8", which
              ensures maximum compatibility with a local UNIX host.

       ZFTP_TYPE
              Readonly.  The type to be used for data transfers , either `A' or  `I'.    Use  the
              type subcommand to change this.

       ZFTP_USER
              Readonly.  The username currently logged in, if any.

       ZFTP_ACCOUNT
              Readonly.   The  account  name  of  the  current user, if any.  Most servers do not
              require an account name.

       ZFTP_PWD
              Readonly.  The current directory on the server.

       ZFTP_CODE
              Readonly.  The three digit code of the last FTP reply from the server as a  string.
              This  can still be read after the connection is closed, and is not changed when the
              current session changes.

       ZFTP_REPLY
              Readonly.  The last line of the last reply sent by the server.  This can  still  be
              read  after  the  connection is closed, and is not changed when the current session
              changes.

       ZFTP_SESSION
              Readonly.  The name of the current FTP session; see the description of the  session
              subcommand.

       ZFTP_PREFS
              A  string of preferences for altering aspects of zftp's behaviour.  Each preference
              is a single character.  The following are defined:

              P      Passive:  attempt to make the remote server initiate data  transfers.   This
                     is slightly more efficient than sendport mode.  If the letter S occurs later
                     in the string, zftp will use sendport mode if passive mode is not available.

              S      Sendport:  initiate transfers by the  FTP  PORT  command.   If  this  occurs
                     before any P in the string, passive mode will never be attempted.

              D      Dumb:   use  only the bare minimum of FTP commands.  This prevents the vari‐
                     ables ZFTP_SYSTEM and ZFTP_PWD from being set, and will mean all connections
                     default  to  ASCII  type.   It may prevent ZFTP_SIZE from being set during a
                     transfer if the server does not send it anyway (many servers do).

              If ZFTP_PREFS is not set when zftp is loaded, it will be set to a default of  `PS',
              i.e. use passive mode if available, otherwise fall back to sendport mode.

       ZFTP_VERBOSE
              A  string  of digits between 0 and 5 inclusive, specifying which responses from the
              server should be printed.  All responses go to standard error.  If any of the  num‐
              bers  1  to  5 appear in the string, raw responses from the server with reply codes
              beginning with that digit will be printed to standard error.  The  first  digit  of
              the three digit reply code is defined by RFC959 to correspond to:

              1.     A positive preliminary reply.

              2.     A positive completion reply.

              3.     A positive intermediate reply.

              4.     A transient negative completion reply.

              5.     A permanent negative completion reply.

              It  should  be  noted that, for unknown reasons, the reply `Service not available',
              which forces termination of a connection, is classified  as  421,  i.e.  `transient
              negative', an interesting interpretation of the word `transient'.

              The  code  0  is  special:   it  indicates  that all but the last line of multiline
              replies read from the server will be printed to standard error in a processed  for‐
              mat.   By  convention,  servers  use this mechanism for sending information for the
              user to read.  The appropriate reply code, if it matches the same  response,  takes
              priority.

              If ZFTP_VERBOSE is not set when zftp is loaded, it will be set to the default value
              450, i.e., messages destined for the user and all errors will be printed.   A  null
              string is valid and specifies that no messages should be printed.

   Functions
       zftp_chpwd
              If  this function is set by the user, it is called every time the directory changes
              on the server, including when a user is logged in, or when a connection is  closed.
              In the last case, $ZFTP_PWD will be unset; otherwise it will reflect the new direc‐
              tory.

       zftp_progress
              If this function is set by the user, it will be called during a get, put or  append
              operation each time sufficient data has been received from the host.  During a get,
              the data is sent to standard output, so it is vital that this function should write
              to standard error or directly to the terminal, not to standard output.

              When  it  is  called  with  a  transfer in progress, the following additional shell
              parameters are set:

              ZFTP_FILE
                     The name of the remote file being transferred from or to.

              ZFTP_TRANSFER
                     A G for a get operation and a P for a put operation.

              ZFTP_SIZE
                     The total size of the complete file being transferred: the same as the first
                     value  provided  by  the remote and local subcommands for a particular file.
                     If the server cannot supply this value for a remote file being retrieved, it
                     will  not  be  set.   If input is from a pipe the value may be incorrect and
                     correspond simply to a full pipe buffer.

              ZFTP_COUNT
                     The amount of data so far transferred; a number between zero and $ZFTP_SIZE,
                     if that is set.  This number is always available.

              The   function  is  initially  called  with  ZFTP_TRANSFER  set  appropriately  and
              ZFTP_COUNT set to zero.  After the transfer  is  finished,  the  function  will  be
              called  one more time with ZFTP_TRANSFER set to GF or PF, in case it wishes to tidy
              up.  It is otherwise never called twice with the same value of ZFTP_COUNT.

              Sometimes the progress meter may cause disruption.  It is up to the user to  decide
              whether the function should be defined and to use unfunction when necessary.

   Problems
       A  connection  may  not be opened in the left hand side of a pipe as this occurs in a sub‐
       shell and the file information is not updated in the main shell.  In the case of  type  or
       mode  changes  or  closing  the  connection in a subshell, the information is returned but
       variables are not updated until the next call to zftp.  Other status changes in  subshells
       will not be reflected by changes to the variables (but should be otherwise harmless).

       Deleting  sessions  while  a  zftp command is active in the background can have unexpected
       effects, even if it does not use the session being deleted.  This  is  because  all  shell
       subprocesses  share  information  on  the state of all connections, and deleting a session
       changes the ordering of that information.

       On some operating systems, the control connection is not valid after  a  fork(),  so  that
       operations in subshells, on the left hand side of a pipeline, or in the background are not
       possible, as they should be.  This is presumably a bug in the operating system.

THE ZSH/ZLE MODULE
       The zsh/zle module contains the Zsh Line Editor.  See zshzle(1).

THE ZSH/ZLEPARAMETER MODULE
       The zsh/zleparameter module defines two special parameters that  can  be  used  to  access
       internal information of the Zsh Line Editor (see zshzle(1)).

       keymaps
              This array contains the names of the keymaps currently defined.

       widgets
              This  associative array contains one entry per widget defined. The name of the wid‐
              get is the key and the value gives information about the widget. It is  either  the
              string  `builtin'  for  builtin  widgets,  a  string  of  the  form `user:name' for
              user-defined widgets, where name is the name of the shell function implementing the
              widget,  or  it is a string of the form `completion:type:name', for completion wid‐
              gets. In the last case type is the name of the builtin widgets the completion  wid‐
              get  imitates in its behavior and name is the name of the shell function implement‐
              ing the completion widget.

THE ZSH/ZPROF MODULE
       When loaded, the zsh/zprof causes shell functions to be profiled.  The  profiling  results
       can be obtained with the zprof builtin command made available by this module.  There is no
       way to turn profiling off other than unloading the module.

       zprof [ -c ]
              Without the -c option, zprof lists profiling results to standard output.  The  for‐
              mat is comparable to that of commands like gprof.

              At the top there is a summary listing all functions that were called at least once.
              This summary is sorted in decreasing order of the amount of  time  spent  in  each.
              The lines contain the number of the function in order, which is used in other parts
              of the list in suffixes of the form `[num]', then the number of calls made  to  the
              function.   The next three columns list the time in milliseconds spent in the func‐
              tion and its descendants, the average time in milliseconds spent  in  the  function
              and  its  descendants  per call and the percentage of time spent in all shell func‐
              tions used in this function and its descendants.  The following three columns  give
              the same information, but counting only the time spent in the function itself.  The
              final column shows the name of the function.

              After the summary, detailed information about every function that  was  invoked  is
              listed, sorted in decreasing order of the amount of time spent in each function and
              its descendants.  Each of these entries consists of descriptions for the  functions
              that  called  the  function  described, the function itself, and the functions that
              were called from it.  The description for the function itself has the  same  format
              as in the summary (and shows the same information).  The other lines don't show the
              number of the function at the beginning and have their function named  indented  to
              make  it  easier to distinguish the line showing the function described in the sec‐
              tion from the surrounding lines.

              The information shown in this case is almost the same as in the summary,  but  only
              refers  to the call hierarchy being displayed.  For example, for a calling function
              the column showing the total running time lists the time  spent  in  the  described
              function  and  its descendants only for the times when it was called from that par‐
              ticular calling function.  Likewise, for a called function, this columns lists  the
              total time spent in the called function and its descendants only for the times when
              it was called from the function described.

              Also in this case, the column showing the number of calls to a function also  shows
              a slash and then the total number of invocations made to the called function.

              As  long  as  the  zsh/zprof  module is loaded, profiling will be done and multiple
              invocations of the zprof builtin command will show the times and numbers  of  calls
              since  the  module  was loaded.  With the -c option, the zprof builtin command will
              reset its internal counters and will not show the listing.

THE ZSH/ZPTY MODULE
       The zsh/zpty module offers one builtin:

       zpty [ -e ] [ -b ] name [ arg ... ]
              The arguments following name are concatenated with spaces between, then executed as
              a  command,  as  if  passed  to  the  eval builtin.  The command runs under a newly
              assigned pseudo-terminal; this is useful  for  running  commands  non-interactively
              which  expect an interactive environment.  The name is not part of the command, but
              is used to refer to this command in later calls to zpty.

              With the -e option, the pseudo-terminal is set up  so  that  input  characters  are
              echoed.

              With  the  -b  option,  input  to  and  output  from  the  pseudo-terminal are made
              non-blocking.

       zpty -d [ names ... ]
              The second form, with the -d option, is used to delete commands previously started,
              by  supplying  a  list  of  their  names.   If no names are given, all commands are
              deleted.  Deleting a command causes the HUP signal to be sent to the  corresponding
              process.

       zpty -w [ -n ] name [ strings ... ]
              The  -w  option  can be used to send the to command name the given strings as input
              (separated by spaces).  If the -n option is not given, a newline is  added  at  the
              end.

              If  no  strings  are provided, the standard input is copied to the pseudo-terminal;
              this may stop before copying the full input if the pseudo-terminal is non-blocking.

              Note that the command under the pseudo-terminal sees  this  input  as  if  it  were
              typed,  so  beware  when  sending special tty driver characters such as word-erase,
              line-kill, and end-of-file.

       zpty -r [ -mt ] name [ param [ pattern ] ]
              The -r option can be used to read the output of the command name.  With only a name
              argument, the output read is copied to the standard output.  Unless the pseudo-ter‐
              minal is non-blocking, copying continues until the command under the  pseudo-termi‐
              nal  exits;  when  non-blocking, only as much output as is immediately available is
              copied.  The return status is zero if any output is copied.

              When also given a param argument, at most one line is read and stored in the param‐
              eter  named  param.   Less  than  a full line may be read if the pseudo-terminal is
              non-blocking.  The return status is zero if at least one  character  is  stored  in
              param.

              If  a  pattern is given as well, output is read until the whole string read matches
              the pattern, even in the non-blocking case.  The  return  status  is  zero  if  the
              string  read  matches  the  pattern,  or if the command has exited but at least one
              character could still be read.  If the option -m is present, the return  status  is
              zero only if the pattern matches.  As of this writing, a maximum of one megabyte of
              output can be consumed this way; if a full megabyte is read  without  matching  the
              pattern, the return status is non-zero.

              In  all  cases, the return status is non-zero if nothing could be read, and is 2 if
              this is because the command has finished.

              If the -r option is combined with the -t  option,  zpty  tests  whether  output  is
              available  before  trying  to  read.   If  no output is available, zpty immediately
              returns the status 1.  When used with a pattern, the behaviour on a failed poll  is
              similar  to  when the command has exited:  the return value is zero if at least one
              character could still be read even if the pattern failed to match.

       zpty -t name
              The -t option without the -r option can be used to test whether the command name is
              still  running.   It returns a zero status if the command is running and a non-zero
              value otherwise.

       zpty [ -L ]
              The last form, without any arguments,  is  used  to  list  the  commands  currently
              defined.   If the -L option is given, this is done in the form of calls to the zpty
              builtin.

THE ZSH/ZSELECT MODULE
       The zsh/zselect module makes available one builtin command:

       zselect [ -rwe -t timeout -a array ] [ fd ... ]
              The zselect builtin is a front-end to the `select' system call, which blocks  until
              a  file descriptor is ready for reading or writing, or has an error condition, with
              an optional timeout.  If this is not available on your system, the  command  prints
              an  error  message  and returns status 2 (normal errors return status 1).  For more
              information, see your systems documentation for select(3).  Note there is  no  con‐
              nection with the shell builtin of the same name.

              Arguments  and  options may be intermingled in any order.  Non-option arguments are
              file descriptors, which must be decimal integers.  By default, file descriptors are
              to  be  tested  for  reading, i.e. zselect will return when data is available to be
              read from the file descriptor, or more precisely, when a read  operation  from  the
              file  descriptor will not block.  After a -r, -w and -e, the given file descriptors
              are to be tested for reading, writing, or error conditions.  These options  and  an
              arbitrary list of file descriptors may be given in any order.

              (The  presence of an `error condition' is not well defined in the documentation for
              many implementations of the select system call.  According to  recent  versions  of
              the  POSIX  specification,  it  is really an exception condition, of which the only
              standard example is out-of-band data received  on  a  socket.   So  zsh  users  are
              unlikely to find the -e option useful.)

              The option `-t timeout' specifies a timeout in hundredths of a second.  This may be
              zero, in which case the file descriptors will simply be  polled  and  zselect  will
              return  immediately.  It is possible to call zselect with no file descriptors and a
              non-zero timeout for use as a finer-grained replacement for `sleep'; note, however,
              the return status is always 1 for a timeout.

              The  option  `-a  array'  indicates  that  array should be set to indicate the file
              descriptor(s) which are ready.  If the option is not given, the array reply will be
              used  for  this  purpose.  The array will contain a string similar to the arguments
              for zselect.  For example,

                     zselect -t 0 -r 0 -w 1

              might return immediately with status 0 and $reply containing `-r 0 -w  1'  to  show
              that both file descriptors are ready for the requested operations.

              The  option  `-A assoc' indicates that the associative array assoc should be set to
              indicate the file descriptor(s( which are ready.  This option overrides the  option
              -a,  nor  will  reply be modified.  The keys of assoc are the file descriptors, and
              the corresponding values are any of the characters `rwe' to indicate the condition.

              The command returns status 0 if some file descriptors are ready  for  reading.   If
              the  operation  timed out, or a timeout of 0 was given and no file descriptors were
              ready, or there was an error, it returns status 1 and the array  will  not  be  set
              (nor  modified  in  any  way).   If  there was an error in the select operation the
              appropriate error message is printed.

THE ZSH/ZUTIL MODULE
       The zsh/zutil module only adds some builtins:

       zstyle [ -L [ pattern [ style ] ] ]
       zstyle [ -e | - | -- ] pattern style strings ...
       zstyle -d [ pattern [ styles ... ] ]
       zstyle -g name [ pattern [ style ] ]
       zstyle -abs context style name [ sep ]
       zstyle -Tt context style [ strings ...]
       zstyle -m context style pattern
              This builtin command is used to define and lookup  styles.   Styles  are  pairs  of
              names  and  values,  where  the  values consist of any number of strings.  They are
              stored together with patterns and lookup is done by giving  a  string,  called  the
              `context',  which is compared to the patterns.  The definition stored for the first
              matching pattern will be returned.

              For ordering of comparisons, patterns are searched from most specific to least spe‐
              cific,  and  patterns  that  are equally specific keep the order in which they were
              defined.  A pattern is considered to be more specific than another if  it  contains
              more  components (substrings separated by colons) or if the patterns for the compo‐
              nents are more specific, where simple strings are considered to  be  more  specific
              than patterns and complex patterns are considered to be more specific than the pat‐
              tern `*'.

              The first form (without arguments) lists the  definitions.   Styles  are  shown  in
              alphabetic order and patterns are shown in the order zstyle will test them.

              If  the  -L  option  is given, listing is done in the form of calls to zstyle.  The
              optional first argument is a pattern which will be matched against the string  sup‐
              plied as the pattern for the context; note that this means, for example, `zstyle -L
              ":completion:*"' will match any supplied pattern beginning `:completion:', not just
              ":completion:*":  use ":completion:\*" to match that.  The optional second argument
              limits the output to a specific style (not a pattern).  -L is not  compatible  with
              any other options.

              The other forms are the following:

              zstyle [ - | -- | -e ] pattern style strings ...
                     Defines  the  given style for the pattern with the strings as the value.  If
                     the -e option is given, the strings will be concatenated (separated by  spa‐
                     ces)  and  the  resulting string will be evaluated (in the same way as it is
                     done by the eval builtin command) when the style is looked up.  In this case
                     the parameter `reply' must be assigned to set the strings returned after the
                     evaluation.  Before evaluating the value, reply is unset, and if it is still
                     unset after the evaluation, the style is treated as if it were not set.

              zstyle -d [ pattern [ styles ... ] ]
                     Delete  style  definitions.  Without  arguments all definitions are deleted,
                     with a pattern all definitions for that  pattern  are  deleted  and  if  any
                     styles are given, then only those styles are deleted for the pattern.

              zstyle -g name [ pattern [ style ] ]
                     Retrieve  a  style  definition.  The name is used as the name of an array in
                     which the results are stored. Without any further  arguments,  all  patterns
                     defined are returned. With a pattern the styles defined for that pattern are
                     returned and with both a pattern and a style, the value strings of that com‐
                     bination is returned.

              The other forms can be used to look up or test patterns.

              zstyle -s context style name [ sep ]
                     The parameter name is set to the value of the style interpreted as a string.
                     If the value contains several strings they are concatenated with spaces  (or
                     with the sep string if that is given) between them.

              zstyle -b context style name
                     The  value  is  stored in name as a boolean, i.e. as the string `yes' if the
                     value has only one string and that string is equal to one of `yes',  `true',
                     `on',  or `1'. If the value is any other string or has more than one string,
                     the parameter is set to `no'.

              zstyle -a context style name
                     The value is stored in name as an array. If name is declared as an  associa‐
                     tive  array,   the  first,  third, etc. strings are used as the keys and the
                     other strings are used as the values.

              zstyle -t context style [ strings ...]
              zstyle -T context style [ strings ...]
                     Test the value of a style, i.e. the -t option only returns  a  status  (sets
                     $?).   Without any strings the return status is zero if the style is defined
                     for at least one matching pattern, has only one string  in  its  value,  and
                     that is equal to one of `true', `yes', `on' or `1'. If any strings are given
                     the status is zero if and only if at least one of the strings is equal to at
                     least  one  of the strings in the value. If the style is defined but doesn't
                     match, the return status is 1. If the style is not defined, the status is 2.

                     The -T option tests the values of the style like -t, but it  returns  status
                     zero (rather than 2) if the style is not defined for any matching pattern.

              zstyle -m context style pattern
                     Match  a  value.  Returns status zero if the pattern matches at least one of
                     the strings in the value.

       zformat -f param format specs ...
       zformat -a array sep specs ...
              This builtin provides two different forms of formatting. The first form is selected
              with  the  -f  option. In this case the format string will be modified by replacing
              sequences starting with a percent sign in it with strings  from  the  specs.   Each
              spec  should  be of the form `char:string' which will cause every appearance of the
              sequence `%char' in format to be replaced by the string.  The `%' sequence may also
              contain optional minimum and maximum field width specifications between the `%' and
              the `char' in the form `%min.maxc', i.e. the minimum field width is given first and
              if  the  maximum field width is used, it has to be preceded by a dot.  Specifying a
              minimum field width makes the result be padded with spaces  to  the  right  if  the
              string is shorter than the requested width.  Padding to the left can be achieved by
              giving a negative minimum field width.  If a maximum field width is specified,  the
              string  will  be truncated after that many characters.  After all `%' sequences for
              the given specs have been processed, the resulting string is stored in the  parame‐
              ter param.

              The %-escapes also understand ternary expressions in the form used by prompts.  The
              % is followed by a `(' and then an ordinary format specifier character as described
              above.   There may be a set of digits either before or after the `('; these specify
              a test number, which defaults to zero.  Negative  numbers  are  also  allowed.   An
              arbitrary  delimiter character follows the format specifier, which is followed by a
              piece of `true' text, the delimiter character again, a piece of `false' text, and a
              closing  parenthesis.  The complete expression (without the digits) thus looks like
              `%(X.text1.text2)', except that the `.' character is arbitrary.   The  value  given
              for the format specifier in the char:string expressions is evaluated as a mathemat‐
              ical expression, and compared with the test number.  If they are the same, text1 is
              output, else text2 is output.  A parenthesis may be escaped in text2 as %).  Either
              of text1 or text2 may contain nested %-escapes.

              For example:

                     zformat -f REPLY "The answer is '%3(c.yes.no)'." c:3

              outputs "The answer is 'yes'." to REPLY since the value for the format specifier  c
              is 3, agreeing with the digit argument to the ternary expression.

              The  second form, using the -a option, can be used for aligning strings.  Here, the
              specs are of the form `left:right' where `left' and `right' are arbitrary  strings.
              These  strings  are  modified by replacing the colons by the sep string and padding
              the left strings with spaces to the right so that the sep  strings  in  the  result
              (and hence the right strings after them) are all aligned if the strings are printed
              below each other.  All strings without a colon are left unchanged and  all  strings
              with  an  empty  right  string  have the trailing colon removed.  In both cases the
              lengths of the strings are not used to determine how the other strings  are  to  be
              aligned.  The resulting strings are stored in the array.

       zregexparse
              This implements some internals of the _regex_arguments function.

       zparseopts [ -D ] [ -K ] [ -M ] [ -E ] [ -a array ] [ -A assoc ] specs
              This  builtin  simplifies the parsing of options in positional parameters, i.e. the
              set of arguments given by $*.  Each spec describes one option and must  be  of  the
              form  `opt[=array]'.   If  an  option  described  by opt is found in the positional
              parameters it is copied into the  array  specified  with  the  -a  option;  if  the
              optional `=array' is given, it is instead copied into that array.

              Note  that it is an error to give any spec without an `=array' unless one of the -a
              or -A options is used.

              Unless the -E option is given,  parsing  stops  at  the  first  string  that  isn't
              described  by one of the specs.  Even with -E, parsing always stops at a positional
              parameter equal to `-' or `--'.

              The opt description must be one of the following.  Any of  the  special  characters
              can appear in the option name provided it is preceded by a backslash.

              name
              name+  The  name  is  the name of the option without the leading `-'.  To specify a
                     GNU-style long option, one of the usual two leading `-' must be included  in
                     name; for example, a `--file' option is represented by a name of `-file'.

                     If a `+' appears after name, the option is appended to array each time it is
                     found in the positional parameters; without the `+' only the last occurrence
                     of the option is preserved.

                     If  one  of  these  forms  is used, the option takes no argument, so parsing
                     stops if the next positional parameter does not also begin with `-'  (unless
                     the -E option is used).

              name:
              name:-
              name:: If  one  or  two  colons  are  given, the option takes an argument; with one
                     colon, the argument is mandatory and with two colons it  is  optional.   The
                     argument is appended to the array after the option itself.

                     An  optional  argument is put into the same array element as the option name
                     (note that this makes empty  strings  as  arguments  indistinguishable).   A
                     mandatory  argument  is  added as a separate element unless the `:-' form is
                     used, in which case the argument is put into the same element.

                     A `+' as described above may appear between the name and the first colon.

              The options of zparseopts itself are:

              -a array
                     As described above, this names the default  array  in  which  to  store  the
                     recognised options.

              -A assoc
                     If this is given, the options and their values are also put into an associa‐
                     tive array with the option names as keys and the arguments (if any)  as  the
                     values.

              -D     If  this  option is given, all options found are removed from the positional
                     parameters of the calling shell or shell function, up to but  not  including
                     any not described by the specs.  This is similar to using the shift builtin.

              -K     With  this  option,  the  arrays  specified  with the -a option and with the
                     `=array' forms are kept unchanged when none of the specs for them  is  used.
                     Otherwise the entire array is replaced when any of the specs is used.  Indi‐
                     vidual elements of associative arrays specified with the -A option are  pre‐
                     served  by  -K.   This  allows assignment of default values to arrays before
                     calling zparseopts.

              -M     This changes the assignment rules to implement a map among equivalent option
                     names.   If any spec uses the `=array' form, the string array is interpreted
                     as the name of another spec, which is used to choose where to store the val‐
                     ues.   If  no  other  spec  is  found, the values are stored as usual.  This
                     changes only the way the values are stored, not the way  $*  is  parsed,  so
                     results  may  be  unpredictable  if  the `name+' specifier is used inconsis‐
                     tently.

              -E     This changes the parsing rules to not stop at the first  string  that  isn't
                     described  by  one  of  the  specs.   It can be used to test for or (if used
                     together with -D) extract options and their arguments,  ignoring  all  other
                     options and arguments that may be in the positional parameters.

              For example,

                     set -- -a -bx -c y -cz baz -cend
                     zparseopts a=foo b:=bar c+:=bar

              will have the effect of

                     foo=(-a)
                     bar=(-b x -c y -c z)

              The arguments from `baz' on will not be used.

              As an example for the -E option, consider:

                     set -- -a x -b y -c z arg1 arg2
                     zparseopts -E -D b:=bar

              will have the effect of

                     bar=(-b y)
                     set -- -a x -c z arg1 arg2

              I.e.,  the option -b and its arguments are taken from the positional parameters and
              put into the array bar.

              The -M option can be used like this:

                     set -- -a -bx -c y -cz baz -cend
                     zparseopts -A bar -M a=foo b+: c:=b

              to have the effect of

                     foo=(-a)
                     bar=(-a '' -b xyz)



ZSHCALSYS(1)                         General Commands Manual                         ZSHCALSYS(1)



NAME
       zshcalsys - zsh calendar system

DESCRIPTION
       The shell is supplied with a series of functions to replace and  enhance  the  traditional
       Unix  calendar  programme,  which  warns the user of imminent or future events, details of
       which are stored in a text file (typically calendar in the user's  home  directory).   The
       version provided here includes a mechanism for alerting the user when an event is due.

       In  addition  a  function  age is provided that can be used in a glob qualifier; it allows
       files to be selected based on their modification times.

       The format of the calendar file and the dates used there in and in the  age  function  are
       described  first, then the functions that can be called to examine and modify the calendar
       file.

       The functions here depend on the availability of the zsh/datetime module which is  usually
       installed  with  the  shell.   The  library  function  strptime() must be available; it is
       present on most recent operating systems.

FILE AND DATE FORMATS
   Calendar File Format
       The calendar file is by default ~/calendar.  This can be configured by  the  calendar-file
       style,  see  the  section STYLES below.  The basic format consists of a series of separate
       lines, with no indentation, each including a date and time  specification  followed  by  a
       description of the event.

       Various  enhancements  to this format are supported, based on the syntax of Emacs calendar
       mode.  An indented line indicates a continuation line that continues  the  description  of
       the  event  from  the preceding line (note the date may not be continued in this way).  An
       initial ampersand (&) is ignored for compatibility.

       An indented line on which the first non-whitespace character is # is  not  displayed  with
       the calendar entry, but is still scanned for information.  This can be used to hide infor‐
       mation useful to the calendar system but not to the user, such as  the  unique  identifier
       used by calendar_add.

       The  Emacs  extension  that a date with no description may refer to a number of succeeding
       events at different times is not supported.

       Unless the done-file style has been altered, any events  which  have  been  processed  are
       appended  to the file with the same name as the calendar file with the suffix .done, hence
       ~/calendar.done by default.

       An example is shown below.

   Date Format
       The format of the date and time is designed to allow flexibility without admitting ambigu‐
       ity.   (The words `date' and `time' are both used in the documentation below; except where
       specifically noted this implies a string that may include both a date and a time  specifi‐
       cation.)   Note that there is no localization support; month and day names must be in Eng‐
       lish and separator characters are fixed.  Matching is case insensitive, and only the first
       three  letters  of  the names are significant, although as a special case a form beginning
       "month" does not match "Monday".  Furthermore, time zones are not handled; all  times  are
       assumed to be local.

       It  is recommended that, rather than exploring the intricacies of the system, users find a
       date format that is natural to them and stick to it.  This will avoid unexpected  effects.
       Various key facts should be noted.

       ·      In  particular,  note  the confusion between month/day/year and day/month/year when
              the month is numeric; these formats should be avoided if  at  all  possible.   Many
              alternatives are available.

       ·      The year must be given in full to avoid confusion, and only years from 1900 to 2099
              inclusive are matched.

       The following give some obvious examples; users finding here a format they  like  and  not
       subject  to  vagaries  of  style  may  skip  the full description.  As dates and times are
       matched separately (even though the time may be embedded in the date), any date format may
       be mixed with any format for the time of day provide the separators are clear (whitespace,
       colons, commas).

              2007/04/03 13:13
              2007/04/03:13:13
              2007/04/03 1:13 pm
              3rd April 2007, 13:13
              April 3rd 2007 1:13 p.m.
              Apr 3, 2007 13:13
              Tue Apr 03 13:13:00 2007
              13:13 2007/apr/3

       More detailed rules follow.

       Times are parsed and extracted before dates.  They must use colons to separate  hours  and
       minutes,  though  a  dot  is allowed before seconds if they are present.  This limits time
       formats to the following:

       ·      HH:MM[:SS[.FFFFF]] [am|pm|a.m.|p.m.]

       ·      HH:MM.SS[.FFFFF] [am|pm|a.m.|p.m.]

       Here, square brackets indicate optional elements, possibly with  alternatives.   Fractions
       of  a second are recognised but ignored.  For absolute times (the normal format require by
       the calendar file and the age function) a date is mandatory but a time of day is not;  the
       time  returned  is at the start of the date.  One variation is allowed: if a.m. or p.m. or
       one of their variants is present, an hour without a minute is allowed, e.g. 3 p.m..

       Time zones are not handled, though if one is matched following  a  time  specification  it
       will be removed to allow a surrounding date to be parsed.  This only happens if the format
       of the timezone is not too unusual.  The following are examples of forms that  are  under‐
       stood:

              +0100
              GMT
              GMT-7
              CET+1CDT

       Any  part  of  the timezone that is not numeric must have exactly three capital letters in
       the name.

       Dates suffer from the ambiguity between DD/MM/YYYY and MM/DD/YYYY.  It is recommended this
       form  is  avoided  with  purely  numeric dates, but use of ordinals, eg. 3rd/04/2007, will
       resolve the ambiguity as the ordinal is always parsed as the day of the month.  Years must
       be  four  digits  (and the first two must be 19 or 20); 03/04/08 is not recognised.  Other
       numbers may have leading zeroes, but they are not required.  The following are handled:

       ·      YYYY/MM/DD

       ·      YYYY-MM-DD

       ·      YYYY/MNM/DD

       ·      YYYY-MNM-DD

       ·      DD[th|st|rd] MNM[,] [ YYYY ]

       ·      MNM DD[th|st|rd][,] [ YYYY ]

       ·      DD[th|st|rd]/MM[,] YYYY

       ·      DD[th|st|rd]/MM/YYYY

       ·      MM/DD[th|st|rd][,] YYYY

       ·      MM/DD[th|st|rd]/YYYY

       Here, MNM is at least the first three letters of a month name, matched case-insensitively.
       The  remainder of the month name may appear but its contents are irrelevant, so janissary,
       febrile, martial, apricot, maybe, junta, etc. are happily handled.

       Where the year is shown as optional, the current year is assumed.  There are only two such
       cases,  the form Jun 20 or 14 September (the only two commonly occurring forms, apart from
       a "the" in some forms of English, which isn't currently supported).  Such  dates  will  of
       course become ambiguous in the future, so should ideally be avoided.

       Times  may follow dates with a colon, e.g. 1965/07/12:09:45; this is in order to provide a
       format with no whitespace.  A comma and whitespace are allowed,  e.g.  1965/07/12,  09:45.
       Currently  the  order  of  these  separators  is not checked, so illogical formats such as
       1965/07/12, : ,09:45 will also be matched.  For simplicity such variations are  not  shown
       in  the  list above.  Otherwise, a time is only recognised as being associated with a date
       if there is only whitespace in between, or if the time was embedded in the date.

       Days of the week are not normally scanned, but will be ignored if they occur at the  start
       of  the date pattern only.  However, in contexts where it is useful to specify dates rela‐
       tive to today, days of the week with no other date specification may be given.  The day is
       assumed  to be either today or within the past week.  Likewise, the words yesterday, today
       and tomorrow are handled.  All matches are case-insensitive.  Hence if  today  is  Monday,
       then Sunday is equivalent to yesterday, Monday is equivalent to today, but Tuesday gives a
       date six days ago.  This is not generally useful within the calendar file.  Dates in  this
       format may be combined with a time specification; for example Tomorrow, 8 p.m..

       For example, the standard date format:

              Fri Aug 18 17:00:48 BST 2006

       is  handled  by  matching  HH:MM:SS and removing it together with the matched (but unused)
       time zone.  This leaves the following:

              Fri Aug 18 2006

       Fri is ignored and the rest is matched according to the standard rules.

   Relative Time Format
       In certain places relative times are handled.  Here, a date is not allowed; instead a com‐
       bination  of  various  supported periods are allowed, together with an optional time.  The
       periods must be in order from most to least significant.

       In some cases, a more accurate calculation is possible when there is an anchor date:  off‐
       sets  of months or years pick the correct day, rather than being rounded, and it is possi‐
       ble to pick a particular day in a month as `(1st Friday)',  etc.,  as  described  in  more
       detail below.

       Anchors are available in the following cases.  If one or two times are passed to the func‐
       tion calendar, the start time acts an anchor for the end time when the end time  is  rela‐
       tive  (even  if the start time is implicit).  When examining calendar files, the scheduled
       event being examined anchors the warning time when it is given explicitly by means of  the
       WARN  keyword; likewise, the scheduled event anchors a repetition period when given by the
       RPT keyword, so that specifications such as RPT 2 months, 3rd Thursday are  handled  prop‐
       erly.  Finally, the -R argument to calendar_scandate directly provides an anchor for rela‐
       tive calculations.

       The periods handled, with possible abbreviations are:

       Years  years, yrs, ys, year, yr, y, yearly.  A year is 365.25  days  unless  there  is  an
              anchor.

       Months months,  mons,  mnths,  mths, month, mon, mnth, mth, monthly.  Note that m, ms, mn,
              mns are ambiguous and are not handled.  A month is a period of 30 days rather  than
              a calendar month unless there is an anchor.

       Weeks  weeks, wks, ws, week, wk, w, weekly

       Days   days, dys, ds, day, dy, d, daily

       Hours  hours, hrs, hs, hour, hr, h, hourly

       Minutes
              minutes, mins, minute, min, but not m, ms, mn or mns

       Seconds
              seconds, secs, ss, second, sec, s

       Spaces  between the numbers are optional, but are required between items, although a comma
       may be used (with or without spaces).

       The forms yearly to hourly allow the number to be omitted; it is assumed  to  be  1.   For
       example,  1  d and daily are equivalent.  Note that using those forms with plurals is con‐
       fusing; 2 yearly is the same as 2 years, not twice yearly, so it is recommended they  only
       be used without numbers.

       When an anchor time is present, there is an extension to handle regular events in the form
       of the nth someday of the month.  Such a specification must occur  immediately  after  any
       year  and  month  specification,  but  before  any  time  of  day, and must be in the form
       n(th|st|rd) day, for example 1st Tuesday or 3rd Monday.  As  in  other  places,  days  are
       matched  case insensitively, must be in English, and only the first three letters are sig‐
       nificant except that a form beginning `month' does not match `Monday'.  No attempt is made
       to sanitize the resulting date; attempts to squeeze too many occurrences into a month will
       push the day into the next month (but in the obvious fashion, retaining the correct day of
       the week).

       Here are some examples:

              30 years 3 months 4 days 3:42:41
              14 days 5 hours
              Monthly, 3rd Thursday
              4d,10hr

   Example
       Here is an example calendar file.  It uses a consistent date format, as recommended above.

              Feb 1, 2006 14:30 Pointless bureaucratic meeting
              Mar 27, 2006 11:00 Mutual recrimination and finger pointing
                Bring water pistol and waterproofs
              Mar 31, 2006 14:00 Very serious managerial pontification
                # UID 12C7878A9A50
              Apr 10, 2006 13:30 Even more pointless blame assignment exercise WARN 30 mins
              May 18, 2006 16:00 Regular moaning session RPT monthly, 3rd Thursday

       The  second  entry  has a continuation line.  The third entry has a continuation line that
       will not be shown when the entry is displayed, but the unique identifier will be  used  by
       the  calendar_add function when updating the event.  The fourth entry will produce a warn‐
       ing 30 minutes before the event (to allow you to equip yourself appropriately).  The fifth
       entry repeats after a month on the 3rd Thursday, i.e. June 15, 2006, at the same time.

USER FUNCTIONS
       This section describes functions that are designed to be called directly by the user.  The
       first part describes those functions associated with the user's calendar; the second  part
       describes the use in glob qualifiers.

   Calendar system functions
       calendar [ -abdDsv ] [ -C calfile ] [ -n num ] [ -S showprog ] [ [ start ] end ](
       calendar -r [ -abdDrsv ] [ -C calfile ] [ -n num ] [ -S showprog ] [ start ]
              Show events in the calendar.

              With  no  arguments,  show events from the start of today until the end of the next
              working day after today.  In other words, if today is Friday, Saturday, or  Sunday,
              show up to the end of the following Monday, otherwise show today and tomorrow.

              If end is given, show events from the start of today up to the time and date given,
              which is in the format described in the previous section.  Note that if this  is  a
              date  the  time  is assumed to be midnight at the start of the date, so that effec‐
              tively this shows all events before the given date.

              end may start with a +, in which case the remainder of the specification is a rela‐
              tive  time format as described in the previous section indicating the range of time
              from the start time that is to be included.

              If start is also given, show events starting from that time and date.  The word now
              can be used to indicate the current time.

              To  implement  an  alert  when events are due, include calendar -s in your ~/.zshrc
              file.

              Options:

              -a     Show all items in the calendar, regardless of the start and end.

              -b     Brief:  don't display continuation lines (i.e. indented lines following  the
                     line with the date/time), just the first line.

              -B lines
                     Brief:  display at most the first lines lines of the calendar entry.  `-B 1'
                     is equivalent to `-b'.

              -C calfile
                     Explicitly specify a calendar file instead of the value of the calendar-file
                     style or the default ~/calendar.

              -d     Move  any events that have passed from the calendar file to the "done" file,
                     as given by the done-file style or the default which is  the  calendar  file
                     with .done appended.  This option is implied by the -s option.

              -D     Turns off the option -d, even if the -s option is also present.

              -n num, -num
                     Show at least num events, if present in the calendar file, regardless of the
                     start and end.

              -r     Show all the remaining options in the calendar, ignoring the given end time.
                     The start time is respected; any argument given is treated as a start time.

              -s     Use  the  shell's sched command to schedule a timed event that will warn the
                     user when an event is due.  Note that the sched command  only  runs  if  the
                     shell  is  at  an interactive prompt; a foreground task blocks the scheduled
                     task from running until it is finished.

                     The timed event usually runs the programme calendar_show to show the  event,
                     as described in the section UTILITY FUNCTIONS below.

                     By  default,  a warning of the event is shown five minutes before it is due.
                     The warning period can be configured by the style warn-time or for a  single
                     calendar  entry  by  including  WARN reltime in the first line of the entry,
                     where reltime is one of the usual relative time formats.

                     A repeated event may be indicated by including RPT reldate in the first line
                     of  the  entry.   After  the  scheduled  event has been displayed it will be
                     re-entered into the calendar file at  a  time  reldate  after  the  existing
                     event.   Note  that this is currently the only use made of the repeat count,
                     so that it is not possible to query the schedule  for  a  recurrence  of  an
                     event in the calendar until the previous event has passed.

                     If  RPT  is used, it is also possible to specify that certain recurrences of
                     an event are rescheduled or cancelled.  This is  done  with  the  OCCURRENCE
                     keyword,  followed  by whitespace and the date and time of the occurrence in
                     the regular sequence, followed by whitespace and either the date and time of
                     the  rescheduled event or the exact string CANCELLED.  In this case the date
                     and time must be in exactly the "date with local time" format  used  by  the
                     text/calendar  MIME  type  (RFC 2445), <YYYY><MM><DD>T<hh><mm><ss> (note the
                     presence of the literal character T).  The first word  (the  regular  recur‐
                     rence)  may  be something other than a proper date/time to indicate that the
                     event is additional to the normal sequence; a convention  that  retains  the
                     formatting appearance is XXXXXXXXTXXXXXX.

                     Furthermore, it is useful to record the next regular recurrence (as then the
                     displayed date may be for a rescheduled event so cannot be used  for  calcu‐
                     lating the regular sequence).  This is specified by RECURRENCE and a time or
                     date in the same format.  calendar_add  adds  such  an  indication  when  it
                     encounters  a  recurring event that does not include one, based on the head‐
                     line date/time.

                     If calendar_add is used to update  occurrences  the  UID  keyword  described
                     there  should be present in both the existing entry and the added occurrence
                     in order to identify recurring event sequences.

                     For example,

                            Thu May 6, 2010 11:00 Informal chat RPT 1 week
                              # RECURRENCE 20100506T110000
                              # OCCURRENCE 20100513T110000 20100513T120000
                              # OCCURRENCE 20100520T110000 CANCELLED

                     The event that occurs at 11:00 on 13th  May  2010  is  rescheduled  an  hour
                     later.   The  event  that occurs a week later is cancelled.  The occurrences
                     are given on a continuation line starting with a #  character  so  will  not
                     usually be displayed as part of the event.  As elsewhere, no account of time
                     zones is taken with the times. After the  next  event  occurs  the  headline
                     date/time  will  be  `Thu May 13, 2010 12:00' while the RECURRENCE date/time
                     will be `20100513T110000' (note that cancelled  and  moved  events  are  not
                     taken  account  of  in  the  RECURRENCE, which records what the next regular
                     recurrence is, but they are accounted for in the headline date/time).

                     It is safe to run calendar -s to reschedule an existing event (if the calen‐
                     dar file has changed, for example), and also to have it running in multiples
                     instances of the shell since the calendar file is locked when in use.

                     By default, expired events are moved to the "done" file; see the -d  option.
                     Use -D to prevent this.

              -S showprog
                     Explicitly  specify a programme to be used for showing events instead of the
                     value of the show-prog style or the default calendar_show.

              -v     Verbose:  show more information about stages of processing.  This is  useful
                     for  confirming  that  the function has successfully parsed the dates in the
                     calendar file.

       calendar_add [ -BL ] event ...
              Adds a single event to the calendar in the appropriate  location.   The  event  can
              contain  multiple  lines,  as  described in the section Calendar File Format above.
              Using this function ensures that the calendar file  is  sorted  in  date  and  time
              order.   It  also  makes  special  arrangements  for  locking  the file while it is
              altered.  The old calendar is left in a file with the suffix .old.

              The option -B indicates that backing up the calendar file will be  handled  by  the
              caller  and  should not be performed by calendar_add.  The option -L indicates that
              calendar_add does not need to lock the calendar  file  as  it  is  already  locked.
              These options will not usually be needed by users.

              If  the  style  reformat-date  is  true, the date and time of the new entry will be
              rewritten into the standard date format:  see the descriptions of  this  style  and
              the style date-format.

              The  function  can  use  a  unique identifier stored with each event to ensure that
              updates to existing events are treated correctly.  The  entry  should  contain  the
              word  UID,  followed by whitespace, followed by a word consisting entirely of hexa‐
              decimal digits of arbitrary length (all digits are significant,  including  leading
              zeroes).   As  the UID is not directly useful to the user, it is convenient to hide
              it on an indented continuation line starting with a #, for example:

                     Aug 31, 2007 09:30  Celebrate the end of the holidays
                       # UID 045B78A0

              The second line will not be shown by the calendar function.

              It is possible to specify the RPT keyword followed by CANCELLED instead of a  rela‐
              tive  time.  This causes any matched event or series of events to be cancelled (the
              original event does not have to be marked as recurring in order to be cancelled  by
              this  method).  A UID is required in order to match an existing event in the calen‐
              dar.

              calendar_add will attempt to manage recurrences and occurrences of repeating events
              as  described for event scheduling by calendar -s above.  To reschedule or cancel a
              single event calendar_add should be called with an entry that includes the  correct
              UID but does not include the RPT keyword as this is taken to mean the entry applies
              to a series of repeating events and hence replaces all existing information.   Each
              rescheduled  or  cancelled  occurrence must have an OCCURRENCE keyword in the entry
              passed to calendar_add which will be merged into the calendar file.   Any  existing
              reference  to  the  occurrence is replaced.  An occurrence that does not refer to a
              valid existing event is added as a one-off occurrence to the same calendar entry.

       calendar_edit
              This calls the user's editor to edit the calendar file.  If  there  are  arguments,
              they  are  taken  as the editor to use (the file name is appended to the commands);
              otherwise, the editor is given by the variable VISUAL, if set,  else  the  variable
              EDITOR.

              If  the  calendar scheduler was running, then after editing the file calendar -s is
              called to update it.

              This function locks out the calendar system during the edit.  Hence  it  should  be
              used  to  edit  the  calendar  file if there is any possibility of a calendar event
              occurring meanwhile.  Note this can lead to another shell with  calendar  functions
              enabled  hanging  waiting for a lock, so it is necessary to quit the editor as soon
              as possible.

       calendar_parse calendar-entry
              This is the internal function that analyses the parts of a calendar entry, which is
              passed  as  the only argument.  The function returns status 1 if the argument could
              not be parsed as a calendar entry and status 2 if the  wrong  number  of  arguments
              were  passed; it also sets the parameter reply to an empty associative array.  Oth‐
              erwise, it returns status 0 and sets elements of the  associative  array  reply  as
              follows:

              time   The time as a string of digits in the same units as $EPOCHSECONDS
              schedtime
                     The  regularly  scheduled  time.  This may differ from the actual event time
                     time if this is a recurring event and the next occurrence has been  resched‐
                     uled.  Then time gives the actual time and schedtime the time of the regular
                     recurrence before modification.
              text1  The text from the line not including the date and time  of  the  event,  but
                     including any WARN or RPT keywords and values.
              warntime
                     Any  warning time given by the WARN keyword as a string of digits containing
                     the time at which to warn in the same units as $EPOCHSECONDS.  (Note this is
                     an  absolute time, not the relative time passed down.)  Not set no WARN key‐
                     word and value were matched.
              warnstr
                     The raw string matched after the WARN keyword, else unset.
              rpttime
                     Any recurrence time given by the RPT keyword as a string of digits  contain‐
                     ing  the  time  of the recurrence in the same units as $EPOCHSECONDS.  (Note
                     this is an absolute time.)  Not  set  if  no  RPT  keyword  and  value  were
                     matched.
              schedrpttime
                     The  next regularly scheduled occurrence of a recurring event before modifi‐
                     cation.  This may differ from rpttime, which is the actual time of the event
                     that may have been rescheduled from the regular time.
              rptstr The raw string matched after the RPT keyword, else unset.
              text2  The  text  from the line after removal of the date and any keywords and val‐
                     ues.

       calendar_showdate [ -r ] [ -f fmt ] date-spec ...
              The given date-spec is interpreted and the corresponding date and time printed.  If
              the initial date-spec begins with a + or - it is treated as relative to the current
              time; date-specs after the first are treated as relative to the date calculated  so
              far and a leading + is optional in that case.  This allows one to use the system as
              a date calculator.  For example, calendar_showdate '+1 month, 1st Friday' shows the
              date of the first Friday of next month.

              With the option -r nothing is printed but the value of the date and time in seconds
              since the epoch is stored in the parameter REPLY.

              With the option -f fmt the given date/time conversion format is passed to strftime;
              see notes on the date-format style below.

              In  order  to  avoid  ambiguity with negative relative date specifications, options
              must occur in separate words; in other words, -r and -f should not be  combined  in
              the same word.

       calendar_sort
              Sorts  the calendar file into date and time order.    The old calendar is left in a
              file with the suffix .old.

   Glob qualifiers
       The function age can be autoloaded and use separately from the calendar  system,  although
       it  uses  the  function  calendar_scandate  for date formatting.  It requires the zsh/stat
       builtin, but uses only the builtin zstat.

       age selects files having a given modification time for use as a glob qualifier.  The  for‐
       mat  of  the  date is the same as that understood by the calendar system, described in the
       section FILE AND DATE FORMATS above.

       The function can take one or two arguments, which can be supplied either directly as  com‐
       mand or arguments, or separately as shell parameters.

              print *(e:age 2006/10/04 2006/10/09:)

       The example above matches all files modified between the start of those dates.  The second
       argument may alternatively be a relative time introduced by a +:

              print *(e:age 2006/10/04 +5d:)

       The example above is equivalent to the previous example.

       In addition to the special use of days of the week, today and  yesterday,  times  with  no
       date  may  be  specified;  these  apply  to today.  Obviously such uses become problematic
       around midnight.

              print *(e-age 12:00 13:30-)

       The example above shows files modified between 12:00 and 13:00 today.

              print *(e:age 2006/10/04:)

       The example above matches all files modified on that date.   If  the  second  argument  is
       omitted  it  is  taken  to be exactly 24 hours after the first argument (even if the first
       argument contains a time).

              print *(e-age 2006/10/04:10:15 2006/10/04:10:45-)

       The example above supplies times.  Note that whitespace within the time and date  specifi‐
       cation  must  be quoted to ensure age receives the correct arguments, hence the use of the
       additional colon to separate the date and time.

              AGEREF=2006/10/04:10:15
              AGEREF2=2006/10/04:10:45
              print *(+age)

       This shows the same example before using another form of argument passing.  The dates  and
       times  in  the parameters AGEREF and AGEREF2 stay in effect until unset, but will be over‐
       ridden if any argument is passed as an explicit argument to age.   Any  explicit  argument
       causes both parameters to be ignored.

       Instead of an explicit date and time, it's possible to use the modification time of a file
       as the date and time for either argument by introducing the file name with a colon:

              print *(e-age :file1-)

       matches all files created on the same day (24 hours starting from midnight) as file1.

              print *(e-age :file1 :file2-)

       matches all files modified no earlier than file1 and no later than file2;  precision  here
       is to the nearest second.

STYLES
       The  zsh  style  mechanism using the zstyle command is describe in zshmodules(1).  This is
       the same mechanism used in the completion system.

       The styles below are all examined in the context :datetime:function:, for  example  :date‐
       time:calendar:.

       calendar-file
              The location of the main calendar.  The default is ~/calendar.

       date-format
              A  strftime format string (see strftime(3)) with the zsh extensions providing vari‐
              ous numbers with no leading zero or space if  the  number  is  a  single  digit  as
              described  for  the  %D{string}  prompt  format  in the section EXPANSION OF PROMPT
              SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1).

              This is used for outputting dates in calendar, both to support the  -v  option  and
              when adding recurring events back to the calendar file, and in calendar_showdate as
              the final output format.

              If the style is not set, the default used is similar the standard system format  as
              output  by  the  date command (also known as `ctime format'): `%a %b %d %H:%M:%S %Z
              %Y'.

       done-file
              The location of the file to which events  which  have  passed  are  appended.   The
              default  is the calendar file location with the suffix .done.  The style may be set
              to an empty string in which case a "done" file will not be maintained.

       reformat-date
              Boolean, used by calendar_add.  If it is true, the date and  time  of  new  entries
              added  to  the  calendar  will  be  reformatted  to  the  format given by the style
              date-format or its default.  Only the date and time of the event itself  is  refor‐
              matted;  any  subsidiary  dates  and times such as those associated with repeat and
              warning times are left alone.

       show-prog
              The programme run by calendar for showing events.  It will be passed the start time
              and  stop  time  of the events requested in seconds since the epoch followed by the
              event text.  Note that calendar -s uses a start time and stop  time  equal  to  one
              another to indicate alerts for specific events.

              The default is the function calendar_show.

       warn-time
              The time before an event at which a warning will be displayed, if the first line of
              the event does not include the text EVENT reltime.  The default is 5 minutes.

UTILITY FUNCTIONS
       calendar_lockfiles
              Attempt to lock the files given in the argument.  To prevent problems with  network
              file  locking  this is done in an ad hoc fashion by attempting to create a symbolic
              link to the file with the name file.lockfile.  No other system level functions  are
              used  for  locking,  i.e. the file can be accessed and modified by any utility that
              does not use this mechanism.  In particular, the user is not prevented from editing
              the calendar file at the same time unless calendar_edit is used.

              Three  attempts are made to lock the file before giving up.  If the module zsh/zse‐
              lect is available, the  times  of  the  attempts  are  jittered  so  that  multiple
              instances of the calling function are unlikely to retry at the same time.

              The  files locked are appended to the array lockfiles, which should be local to the
              caller.

              If all files were successfully locked, status zero is returned, else status one.

              This function may be used as a general file locking function,  although  this  will
              only work if only this mechanism is used to lock files.

       calendar_read
              This is a backend used by various other functions to parse the calendar file, which
              is passed as the only argument.  The array calendar_entries is set to the  list  of
              events  in the file; no pruning is done except that ampersands are removed from the
              start of the line.  Each entry may contain multiple lines.

       calendar_scandate
              This is a generic function to parse dates and times that  may  be  used  separately
              from  the  calendar  system.   The  argument  is  a  date  or time specification as
              described in the section FILE AND DATE FORMATS above.  The parameter REPLY  is  set
              to  the  number  of seconds since the epoch corresponding to that date or time.  By
              default, the date and time may occur anywhere within the given argument.

              Returns status zero if the date and time were successfully parsed, else one.

              Options:
              -a     The date and time are anchored to the start of the argument; they  will  not
                     be matched if there is preceding text.

              -A     The  date  and  time are anchored to both the start and end of the argument;
                     they will not be matched if the is any other text in the argument.

              -d     Enable additional debugging output.

              -m     Minus.  When -R anchor_time is also given the relative  time  is  calculated
                     backwards from anchor_time.

              -r     The argument passed is to be parsed as a relative time.

              -R anchor_time
                     The  argument  passed is to be parsed as a relative time.  The time is rela‐
                     tive to anchor_time, a time in seconds since the  epoch,  and  the  returned
                     value  is  the  absolute  time corresponding to advancing anchor_time by the
                     relative time given.  This allows lengths of months to  be  correctly  taken
                     into  account.  If the final day does not exist in the given month, the last
                     day of the final month is given.  For example, if the anchor time is  during
                     31st  January  2007  and the relative time is 1 month, the final time is the
                     same time of day during 28th February 2007.

              -s     In addition to setting REPLY, set REPLY2 to the remainder  of  the  argument
                     after  the date and time have been stripped.  This is empty if the option -A
                     was given.

              -t     Allow a time with no date specification.  The date is assumed to  be  today.
                     The  behaviour  is  unspecified  if  the  iron tongue of midnight is tolling
                     twelve.

       calendar_show
              The function used by default to display events.  It accepts a start  time  and  end
              time for events, both in epoch seconds, and an event description.

              The  event  is  always  printed  to standard output.  If the command line editor is
              active (which will usually be the case) the command line will be redisplayed  after
              the output.

              If  the parameter DISPLAY is set and the start and end times are the same (indicat‐
              ing a scheduled event), the function uses the command xmessage to display a  window
              with the event details.

BUGS
       As  the  system  is  based  entirely  on  shell  functions (with a little support from the
       zsh/datetime module) the mechanisms used are not as robust as those provided  by  a  dedi‐
       cated  calendar  utility.   Consequently  the  user should not rely on the shell for vital
       alerts.

       There is no calendar_delete function.

       There is no localization support for dates and times, nor any support for the use of  time
       zones.

       Relative periods of months and years do not take into account the variable number of days.

       The calendar_show function is currently hardwired to use xmessage for displaying alerts on
       X Window System displays.  This should be configurable and ideally integrate  better  with
       the desktop.

       calendar_lockfiles  hangs  the shell while waiting for a lock on a file.  If called from a
       scheduled task, it should instead reschedule the event that caused it.



ZSHTCPSYS(1)                         General Commands Manual                         ZSHTCPSYS(1)



NAME
       zshtcpsys - zsh tcp system

DESCRIPTION
       A module zsh/net/tcp is provided to provide network I/O over TCP/IP from within the shell;
       see  its description in zshmodules(1) .  This manual page describes a function suite based
       on the module.  If the module is installed, the functions are  usually  installed  at  the
       same  time,  in  which case they will be available for autoloading in the default function
       search path.  In addition to the zsh/net/tcp module, the zsh/zselect  module  is  used  to
       implement  timeouts on read operations.  For troubleshooting tips, consult the correspond‐
       ing advice for the zftp functions described in zshzftpsys(1) .

       There are functions corresponding to the basic I/O operations open, close, read and  send,
       named  tcp_open  etc., as well as a function tcp_expect for pattern match analysis of data
       read as input.  The system makes it easy to receive data from and send  data  to  multiple
       named  sessions  at  once.   In addition, it can be linked with the shell's line editor in
       such a way that input data is automatically  shown  at  the  terminal.   Other  facilities
       available including logging, filtering and configurable output prompts.

       To use the system where it is available, it should be enough to `autoload -U tcp_open' and
       run tcp_open as documented below to start a session.  The tcp_open function will  autoload
       the remaining functions.

TCP USER FUNCTIONS
   Basic I/O
       tcp_open [-qz] host port [ sess ]
       tcp_open [-qz] [ -s sess | -l sess,... ] ...
       tcp_open [-qz] [-a fd | -f fd ] [ sess ]
              Open  a new session.  In the first and simplest form, open a TCP connection to host
              host at port port; numeric and symbolic forms are understood for both.

              If sess is given, this becomes the name of the session which can be used  to  refer
              to  multiple  different  TCP  connections.  If sess is not given, the function will
              invent a numeric name value (note this is not the same as the  file  descriptor  to
              which  the  session is attached).  It is recommended that session names not include
              `funny' characters, where funny characters are not well-defined  but  certainly  do
              not include alphanumerics or underscores, and certainly do include whitespace.

              In  the second case, one or more sessions to be opened are given by name.  A single
              session name is given after -s and a comma-separated list after  -l;  both  options
              may  be  repeated as many times as necessary.  A failure to open any session causes
              tcp_open to abort.  The host and port are read from the file .ztcp_sessions in  the
              same directory as the user's zsh initialisation files, i.e. usually the home direc‐
              tory, but $ZDOTDIR if that is set.  The file consists of lines each giving  a  ses‐
              sion name and the corresponding host and port, in that order (note the session name
              comes first, not last), separated by whitespace.

              The third form allows passive and fake TCP connections.  If the option -a is  used,
              its  argument is a file descriptor open for listening for connections.  No function
              front-end is provided to open such a file descriptor, but a call to `ztcp -l  port'
              will  create one with the file descriptor stored in the parameter $REPLY.  The lis‐
              tening port can be closed with `ztcp -c fd'.  A call to `tcp_open -a fd' will block
              until a remote TCP connection is made to port on the local machine.  At this point,
              a session is created in the usual way and  is  largely  indistinguishable  from  an
              active connection created with one of the first two forms.

              If  the option -f is used, its argument is a file descriptor which is used directly
              as if it were a TCP session.  How well the remainder of  the  TCP  function  system
              copes with this depends on what actually underlies this file descriptor.  A regular
              file is likely to be unusable; a FIFO (pipe) of some sort  will  work  better,  but
              note  that it is not a good idea for two different sessions to attempt to read from
              the same FIFO at once.

              If the option -q is given with any of the three  forms,  tcp_open  will  not  print
              informational  messages, although it will in any case exit with an appropriate sta‐
              tus.

              If the line editor (zle) is in use, which is typically the case  if  the  shell  is
              interactive,  tcp_open  installs a handler inside zle which will check for new data
              at the same time as it checks for keyboard input.  This is convenient as the  shell
              consumes  no CPU time while waiting; the test is performed by the operating system.
              Giving the option -z to any of the forms of  tcp_open  prevents  the  handler  from
              being  installed, so data must be read explicitly.  Note, however, this is not nec‐
              essary for executing complete sets of send and read commands from  a  function,  as
              zle  is  not  active at this point.  Generally speaking, the handler is only active
              when the shell is waiting for input at a command prompt or in  the  vared  builtin.
              The option has no effect if zle is not active; `[[ -o zle]]' will test for this.

              The  first session to be opened becomes the current session and subsequent calls to
              tcp_open do not change  it.   The  current  session  is  stored  in  the  parameter
              $TCP_SESS; see below for more detail about the parameters used by the system.

              The  function tcp_on_open, if defined, is called when a session is opened.  See the
              description below.

       tcp_close [-qn] [ -a | -l sess,... | sess ... ]
              Close the named sessions, or the current session if none is given, or all open ses‐
              sions  if -a is given.  The options -l and -s are both handled for consistency with
              tcp_open, although the latter is redundant.

              If the session being closed is the current one, $TCP_SESS is unset, leaving no cur‐
              rent session, even if there are other sessions still open.

              If  the  session was opened with tcp_open -f, the file descriptor is closed so long
              as it is in the range 0 to 9 accessible directly from the  command  line.   If  the
              option -n is given, no attempt will be made to close file descriptors in this case.
              The -n option is not used for genuine ztcp session; the file descriptors are always
              closed with the session.

              If the option -q is given, no informational messages will be printed.

       tcp_read [-bdq] [ -t TO ] [ -T TO ]
           [ -a | -u fd ... | -l sess,... | -s sess ...]
              Perform  a  read  operation on the current session, or on a list of sessions if any
              are given with -u, -l or -s, or all open sessions if the option -a is  given.   Any
              of the -u, -l or -s options may be repeated or mixed together.  The -u option spec‐
              ifies a file descriptor directly (only those managed by this  system  are  useful),
              the other two specify sessions as described for tcp_open above.

              The  function checks for new data available on all the sessions listed.  Unless the
              -b option is given, it will not block waiting for new data.  Any one line  of  data
              from any of the available sessions will be read, stored in the parameter $TCP_LINE,
              and displayed to standard output unless $TCP_SILENT contains  a  non-empty  string.
              When  printed  to standard output the string $TCP_PROMPT will be shown at the start
              of the line; the default form for this includes the name of the session being read.
              See  below for more information on these parameters.  In this mode, tcp_read can be
              called repeatedly until it returns status 2 which indicates all pending input  from
              all specified sessions has been handled.

              With  the  option  -b,  equivalent  to an infinite timeout, the function will block
              until a line is available to read from one of  the  specified  sessions.   However,
              only a single line is returned.

              The  option  -d  indicates  that all pending input should be drained.  In this case
              tcp_read may process multiple lines in the manner given above;  only  the  last  is
              stored  in $TCP_LINE, but the complete set is stored in the array $tcp_lines.  This
              is cleared at the start of each call to tcp_read.

              The options -t and -T specify a timeout in seconds, which may be a  floating  point
              number  for  increased  accuracy.   With -t the timeout is applied before each line
              read.  With -T, the timeout applies to the overall  operation,  possibly  including
              multiple read operations if the option -d is present; without this option, there is
              no distinction between -t and -T.

              The function does not print informational messages, but if the option -q is  given,
              no error message is printed for a non-existent session.

              A  return  status  of 2 indicates a timeout or no data to read.  Any other non-zero
              return status indicates some error condition.

              See tcp_log for how to control where data is sent by tcp_read.

       tcp_send [-cnq] [ -s sess | -l sess,... ] data ...
       tcp_send [-cnq] -a data ...
              Send the supplied data strings to all the specified sessions in turn.  The underly‐
              ing  operation  differs  little from a `print -r' to the session's file descriptor,
              although it attempts to prevent the shell from dying owing to a SIGPIPE  caused  by
              an attempt to write to a defunct session.

              The  option  -c  causes  tcp_send to behave like cat.  It reads lines from standard
              input until end of input and sends them in turn to the specified session(s) exactly
              as if they were given as data arguments to individual tcp_send commands.

              The  option  -n  prevents  tcp_send  from  putting a newline at the end of the data
              strings.

              The remaining options all behave as for tcp_read.

              The data arguments are  not  further  processed  once  they  have  been  passed  to
              tcp_send; they are simply passed down to print -r.

              If  the parameter $TCP_OUTPUT is a non-empty string and logging is enabled then the
              data sent to each session will be echoed to the log  file(s)  with  $TCP_OUTPUT  in
              front where appropriate, much in the manner of $TCP_PROMPT.

   Session Management
       tcp_alias [-q] alias=sess ...
       tcp_alias [-q] [ alias ] ...
       tcp_alias -d [-q] alias ...
              This function is not particularly well tested.

              The first form creates an alias for a session name; alias can then be used to refer
              to the existing session sess.  As many aliases may be listed as required.

              The second form lists any aliases specified, or all aliases if none.

              The third form deletes all the aliases listed.  The  underlying  sessions  are  not
              affected.

              The option -q suppresses an inconsistently chosen subset of error messages.

       tcp_log [-asc] [ -n | -N ] [ logfile ]
              With  an  argument  logfile,  all  future input from tcp_read will be logged to the
              named file.  Unless -a (append) is given, this file will first be truncated or cre‐
              ated empty.  With no arguments, show the current status of logging.

              With  the option -s, per-session logging is enabled.  Input from tcp_read is output
              to the file logfile.sess.  As the session is  automatically  discriminated  by  the
              filename,  the contents are raw (no $TCP_PROMPT).  The option  -a applies as above.
              Per-session logging and logging of all data in one file are not mutually exclusive.

              The option -c closes all logging, both complete and per-session logs.

              The options -n and -N respectively turn off or  restore  output  of  data  read  by
              tcp_read to standard output; hence `tcp_log -cn' turns off all output by tcp_read.

              The  function  is purely a convenient front end to setting the parameters $TCP_LOG,
              $TCP_LOG_SESS, $TCP_SILENT, which are described below.

       tcp_rename old new
              Rename session old to session new.  The old name becomes invalid.

       tcp_sess [ sess [ command  ... ] ]
              With no arguments, list all the open sessions and associated file descriptors.  The
              current  session is marked with a star.  For use in functions, direct access to the
              parameters $tcp_by_name, $tcp_by_fd and $TCP_SESS is probably more convenient;  see
              below.

              With  a  sess  argument,  set  the  current session to sess.  This is equivalent to
              changing $TCP_SESS directly.

              With additional arguments, temporarily set the current session while executing  the
              string  command  ....   The  first argument is re-evaluated so as to expand aliases
              etc., but the remaining arguments are passed through as  the  appear  to  tcp_sess.
              The original session is restored when tcp_sess exits.

   Advanced I/O
       tcp_command send-options ... send-arguments ...
              This  is a convenient front-end to tcp_send.  All arguments are passed to tcp_send,
              then the function pauses waiting for data.  While data is arriving at  least  every
              $TCP_TIMEOUT  (default  0.3)  seconds, data is handled and printed out according to
              the current settings.  Status 0 is always returned.

              This is generally only useful for interactive use, to prevent the display  becoming
              fragmented  by output returned from the connection.  Within a programme or function
              it is generally better to handle reading data by a more explicit method.

       tcp_expect [ -q ] [ -p  var  | -P  var ] [ -t  to | -T TO]
           [ -a | -s sess ... | -l sess,... ] pattern ...
              Wait for input matching any of the given patterns from any of  the  specified  ses‐
              sions.   Input is ignored until an input line matches one of the given patterns; at
              this point status zero is returned, the matching line is stored in  $TCP_LINE,  and
              the  full  set  of  lines read during the call to tcp_expect is stored in the array
              $tcp_expect_lines.

              Sessions are specified in the same way as tcp_read: the default is to use the  cur‐
              rent session, otherwise the sessions specified by -a, -s, or -l are used.

              Each  pattern is a standard zsh extended-globbing pattern; note that it needs to be
              quoted to avoid it being expanded immediately  by  filename  generation.   It  must
              match  the  full line, so to match a substring there must be a `*' at the start and
              end.  The line matched against includes the $TCP_PROMPT added by tcp_read.   It  is
              possible  to  include the globbing flags `#b' or `#m' in the patterns to make back‐
              references available in the parameters $MATCH, $match, etc., as  described  in  the
              base zsh documentation on pattern matching.

              Unlike tcp_read, the default behaviour of tcp_expect is to block indefinitely until
              the required input is found.  This can be modified by specifying a timeout with  -t
              or  -T;  these  function  as in tcp_read, specifying a per-read or overall timeout,
              respectively, in seconds, as an integer or floating-point number.  As tcp_read, the
              function returns status 2 if a timeout occurs.

              The function returns as soon as any one of the patterns given match.  If the caller
              needs to know which of the patterns matched, the option -p  var  can  be  used;  on
              return,  $var is set to the number of the pattern using ordinary zsh indexing, i.e.
              the first is 1, and so on.  Note the absence of a `$' in front of  var.   To  avoid
              clashes,  the parameter cannot begin with `_expect'.  The index -1 is used if there
              is a timeout and 0 if there is no match.

              The option -P var works similarly to -p, but instead of numerical indexes the regu‐
              lar  arguments  must  begin  with a prefix followed by a colon: that prefix is then
              used as a tag to which var is set when the argument matches.  The  tag  timeout  is
              used  if  there is a timeout and the empty string if there is no match.  Note it is
              acceptable for different arguments to start with the same prefix if the matches  do
              not need to be distinguished.

              The option -q is passed directly down to tcp_read.

              As  all  input is done via tcp_read, all the usual rules about output of lines read
              apply.  One exception is that the parameter $tcp_lines will only reflect  the  line
              actually  matched  by  tcp_expect;  use $tcp_expect_lines for the full set of lines
              read during the function call.

       tcp_proxy
              This is a simple-minded function to accept a TCP connection and execute  a  command
              with I/O redirected to the connection.  Extreme caution should be taken as there is
              no security whatsoever and this can leave your computer open to  the  world.   Ide‐
              ally, it should only be used behind a firewall.

              The first argument is a TCP port on which the function will listen.

              The  remaining  arguments give a command and its arguments to execute with standard
              input, standard output and standard error redirected  to  the  file  descriptor  on
              which  the  TCP  session  has  been accepted.  If no command is given, a new zsh is
              started.  This gives everyone on your network direct access to your account,  which
              in many cases will be a bad thing.

              The command is run in the background, so tcp_proxy can then accept new connections.
              It continues to accept new connections until interrupted.

       tcp_spam [-ertv] [ -a | -s  sess | -l sess,... ] cmd ...
              Execute `cmd ...' for each session in turn.  Note this  executes  the  command  and
              arguments;  it  does  not  send  the  command line as data unless the -t (transmit)
              option is given.

              The sessions may be selected explicitly with the standard -a, -s or -l options,  or
              may  be  chosen  implicitly.   If none of the three options is given the rules are:
              first, if the array $tcp_spam_list is set, this is taken as the list  of  sessions,
              otherwise  all  sessions  are  taken.   Second,  any  sessions  given  in the array
              $tcp_no_spam_list are removed from the list of sessions.

              Normally, any sessions added by the `-a' flag  or  when  all  sessions  are  chosen
              implicitly  are  spammed  in alphabetic order; sessions given by the $tcp_spam_list
              array or on the command line are spammed in the order given.  The -r flag  reverses
              the order however it was arrived it.

              The  -v flag specifies that a $TCP_PROMPT will be output before each session.  This
              is output after any modification to TCP_SESS by the user-defined tcp_on_spam  func‐
              tion  described  below.   (Obviously that function is able to generate its own out‐
              put.)

              If the option -e is present, the line given as cmd ... is executed using eval, oth‐
              erwise it is executed without any further processing.

       tcp_talk
              This  is  a  fairly  simple-minded  attempt to force input to the line editor to go
              straight to the default TCP_SESSION.

              An escape string, $TCP_TALK_ESCAPE, default `:', is used to allow access to  normal
              shell operation.  If it is on its own at the start of the line, or followed only by
              whitespace, the line editor returns to normal operation.  Otherwise, the string and
              any  following  whitespace  are  skipped  and the remainder of the line executed as
              shell input without any change of the line editor's operating mode.

              The current implementation is somewhat deficient in terms of  use  of  the  command
              history.   For  this reason, many users will prefer to use some form of alternative
              approach for sending data easily to the current session.  One simple approach is to
              alias some special character (such as `%') to `tcp_command --'.

       tcp_wait
              The sole argument is an integer or floating point number which gives the seconds to
              delay.  The shell will do nothing for that period except wait for input on all  TCP
              sessions  by  calling tcp_read -a.  This is similar to the interactive behaviour at
              the command prompt when zle handlers are installed.

   `One-shot' file transfer
       tcp_point port
       tcp_shoot host port
              This pair of functions provide a simple way to transfer a file  between  two  hosts
              within  the  shell.  Note, however, that bulk data transfer is currently done using
              cat.  tcp_point reads any data arriving at port and sends it  to  standard  output;
              tcp_shoot  connects  to port on host and sends its standard input.  Any unused port
              may be used; the standard mechanism for picking a port is  to  think  of  a  random
              four-digit number above 1024 until one works.

              To transfer a file from host woodcock to host springes, on springes:

                     tcp_point 8091 >output_file

              and on woodcock:

                     tcp_shoot springes 8091 <input_file

              As  these  two  functions do not require tcp_open to set up a TCP connection first,
              they may need to be autoloaded separately.

TCP USER-DEFINED FUNCTIONS
       Certain functions, if defined by the user, will be called by the function system  in  cer‐
       tain contexts.  This facility depends on the module zsh/parameter, which is usually avail‐
       able in interactive shells as the completion system depends on it.  None of the  functions
       need be defined; they simply provide convenient hooks when necessary.

       Typically, these are called after the requested action has been taken, so that the various
       parameters will reflect the new state.

       tcp_on_alias alias fd
              When an alias is defined, this function will be called with two arguments: the name
              of the alias, and the file descriptor of the corresponding session.

       tcp_on_awol sess fd
              If  the  function tcp_fd_handler is handling input from the line editor and detects
              that the file descriptor is no longer reusable, by default it removes it  from  the
              list of file descriptors handled by this method and prints a message.  If the func‐
              tion tcp_on_awol is defined it is called immediately before  this  point.   It  may
              return  status  100,  which indicates that the normal handling should still be per‐
              formed; any other return status indicates that no further action  should  be  taken
              and  the tcp_fd_handler should return immediately with the given status.  Typically
              the action of tcp_on_awol will be to close the session.

              The variable TCP_INVALIDATE_ZLE will be a non-empty string if it  is  necessary  to
              invalidate  the  line editor display using `zle -I' before printing output from the
              function.

              (`AWOL' is military jargon for `absent without leave' or some variation.  It has no
              pre-existing technical meaning known to the author.)

       tcp_on_close sess fd
              This  is  called  with  the  name of a session being closed and the file descriptor
              which corresponded to that session.  Both will be invalid by the time the  function
              is called.

       tcp_on_open sess fd
              This  is called after a new session has been defined with the session name and file
              descriptor as arguments.  If it returns a non-zero status, opening the  session  is
              assumed to fail and the session is closed again; however, tcp_open will continue to
              attempt to open any remaining sessions given on the command line.

       tcp_on_rename oldsess fd newsess
              This is called after a session has been renamed with the three arguments  old  ses‐
              sion name, file descriptor, new session name.

       tcp_on_spam sess command ...
              This is called once for each session spammed, just before a command is executed for
              a session by tcp_spam.  The arguments are the session name followed by the  command
              list  to be executed.  If tcp_spam was called with the option -t, the first command
              will be tcp_send.

              This function is called after $TCP_SESS  is  set  to  reflect  the  session  to  be
              spammed, but before any use of it is made.  Hence it is possible to alter the value
              of $TCP_SESS within this function.  For example, the session arguments to  tcp_spam
              could include extra information to be stripped off and processed in tcp_on_spam.

              If  the  function sets the parameter $REPLY to `done', the command line is not exe‐
              cuted; in addition, no prompt is printed for the -v option to tcp_spam.

       tcp_on_unalias alias fd
              This is called with the name of an  alias  and  the  corresponding  session's  file
              descriptor after an alias has been deleted.

TCP UTILITY FUNCTIONS
       The  following  functions are used by the TCP function system but will rarely if ever need
       to be called directly.

       tcp_fd_handler
              This is the function installed by tcp_open for handling input from within the  line
              editor,  if  that is required.  It is in the format documented for the builtin `zle
              -F' in zshzle(1) .

              While active, the function sets the parameter TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE to 1.  This allows
              shell  code  called  internally (for example, by setting tcp_on_read) to tell if is
              being called when the shell is otherwise idle at the editor prompt.

       tcp_output [ -q ] -P prompt -F fd -S sess
              This function is used for both logging and handling output to standard output, from
              within tcp_read and (if $TCP_OUTPUT is set) tcp_send.

              The prompt to use is specified by -P; the default is the empty string.  It can con‐
              tain:
              %c     Expands to 1 if the session is the current session, otherwise 0.  Used  with
                     ternary expressions such as `%(c.-.+)' to output `+' for the current session
                     and `-' otherwise.

              %f     Replaced by the session's file descriptor.

              %s     Replaced by the session name.

              %%     Replaced by a single `%'.

              The option -q suppresses output to standard output, but not to any log files  which
              are configured.

              The  -S and -F options are used to pass in the session name and file descriptor for
              possible replacement in the prompt.

TCP USER PARAMETERS
       Parameters follow the usual convention that uppercase is used for  scalars  and  integers,
       while lowercase is used for normal and associative array.  It is always safe for user code
       to read these parameters.  Some parameters may also be set; these  are  noted  explicitly.
       Others  are  included  in this group as they are set by the function system for the user's
       benefit, i.e. setting them is typically not useful but is benign.

       It is often also useful to make settable parameters local to  a  function.   For  example,
       `local TCP_SILENT=1' specifies that data read during the function call will not be printed
       to standard output, regardless of the setting  outside  the  function.   Likewise,  `local
       TCP_SESS=sess'  sets  a  session  for  the duration of a function, and `local TCP_PROMPT='
       specifies that no prompt is used for input during the function.

       tcp_expect_lines
              Array.  The set of lines read during the last call  to  tcp_expect,  including  the
              last ($TCP_LINE).

       tcp_filter
              Array.  May be set directly.  A set of extended globbing patterns which, if matched
              in tcp_output, will cause the line not to be printed to standard output.  The  pat‐
              terns  should  be  defined as described for the arguments to tcp_expect.  Output of
              line to log files is not affected.

       TCP_HANDLER_ACTIVE
              Scalar.  Set to 1 within tcp_fd_handler to indicate to functions called recursively
              that they have been called during an editor session.  Otherwise unset.

       TCP_LINE
              The last line read by tcp_read, and hence also tcp_expect.

       TCP_LINE_FD
              The file descriptor from which $TCP_LINE was read.  ${tcp_by_fd[$TCP_LINE_FD]} will
              give the corresponding session name.

       tcp_lines
              Array. The set of lines read during the last call to tcp_read, including  the  last
              ($TCP_LINE).

       TCP_LOG
              May be set directly, although it is also controlled by tcp_log.  The name of a file
              to which output from all sessions will be sent.  The output  is  proceeded  by  the
              usual  $TCP_PROMPT.   If it is not an absolute path name, it will follow the user's
              current directory.

       TCP_LOG_SESS
              May be set directly, although it is also controlled by tcp_log.  The prefix  for  a
              set  of  files  to which output from each session separately will be sent; the full
              filename is ${TCP_LOG_SESS}.sess.  Output to each file is raw; no prompt is  added.
              If it is not an absolute path name, it will follow the user's current directory.

       tcp_no_spam_list
              Array.  May be set directly.  See tcp_spam for how this is used.

       TCP_OUTPUT
              May be set directly.  If a non-empty string, any data sent to a session by tcp_send
              will be logged.  This parameter gives the prompt to be used in a file specified  by
              $TCP_LOG but not in a file generated from $TCP_LOG_SESS.  The prompt string has the
              same format as TCP_PROMPT and the same rules for its use apply.

       TCP_PROMPT
              May be set directly.  Used as the prefix for data read by tcp_read which is printed
              to standard output or to the log file given by $TCP_LOG, if any.  Any `%s', `%f' or
              `%%' occurring in the string will be replaced by the name of the session, the  ses‐
              sion's  underlying  file descriptor, or a single `%', respectively.  The expression
              `%c' expands to 1 if the session being read is the current session, else 0; this is
              most useful in ternary expressions such as `%(c.-.+)' which outputs `+' if the ses‐
              sion is the current one, else `-'.

              If the prompt starts with %P, this is stripped and the complete result of the  pre‐
              vious  stage is passed through standard prompt %-style formatting before being out‐
              put.

       TCP_READ_DEBUG
              May be set directly.  If this has non-zero length, tcp_read will give some  limited
              diagnostics about data being read.

       TCP_SECONDS_START
              This value is created and initialised to zero by tcp_open.

              The  functions  tcp_read and tcp_expect use the shell's SECONDS parameter for their
              own timing purposes.  If that parameter is not of floating point type on  entry  to
              one  of  the  functions, it will create a local parameter SECONDS which is floating
              point and set the parameter TCP_SECONDS_START to the previous  value  of  $SECONDS.
              If  the  parameter is already floating point, it is used without a local copy being
              created and TCP_SECONDS_START is not set.  As the global value is zero,  the  shell
              elapsed time is guaranteed to be the sum of $SECONDS and $TCP_SECONDS_START.

              This  can  be  avoided  by setting SECONDS globally to a floating point value using
              `typeset -F SECONDS'; then the TCP functions will never make a local copy and never
              set TCP_SECONDS_START to a non-zero value.

       TCP_SESS
              May be set directly.  The current session; must refer to one of the sessions estab‐
              lished by tcp_open.

       TCP_SILENT
              May be set directly, although it is also controlled by  tcp_log.   If  of  non-zero
              length,  data  read  by tcp_read will not be written to standard output, though may
              still be written to a log file.

       tcp_spam_list
              Array.  May be set directly.  See the description of the function tcp_spam for  how
              this is used.

       TCP_TALK_ESCAPE
              May  be set directly.  See the description of the function tcp_talk for how this is
              used.

       TCP_TIMEOUT
              May be set directly.  Currently this is only used by the function tcp_command,  see
              above.

TCP USER-DEFINED PARAMETERS
       The  following parameters are not set by the function system, but have a special effect if
       set by the user.

       tcp_on_read
              This should be an associative array; if it is  not,  the  behaviour  is  undefined.
              Each  key  is  the name of a shell function or other command, and the corresponding
              value is a shell pattern (using EXTENDED_GLOB).  Every line read from a TCP session
              directly  or indirectly using tcp_read (which includes lines read by tcp_expect) is
              compared against the pattern.  If the line matches, the command given in the key is
              called  with  two  arguments: the name of the session from which the line was read,
              and the line itself.

              If any function called to handle a line returns a non-zero status, the line is  not
              output.   Thus a tcp_on_read handler containing only the instruction `return 1' can
              be used to suppress output of particular lines (see,  however,  tcp_filter  above).
              However,  the line is still stored in TCP_LINE and tcp_lines; this occurs after all
              tcp_on_read processing.

TCP UTILITY PARAMETERS
       These parameters are controlled by the function system; they may  be  read  directly,  but
       should not usually be set by user code.

       tcp_aliases
              Associative  array.   The keys are the names of sessions established with tcp_open;
              each value is a space-separated list of aliases which refer to that session.

       tcp_by_fd
              Associative array.  The keys are session file descriptors; each value is  the  name
              of that session.

       tcp_by_name
              Associative  array.   The  keys  are  the names of sessions; each value is the file
              descriptor associated with that session.

TCP EXAMPLES
       Here is a trivial example using a remote calculator.

       TO create a calculator server on port 7337 (see the dc manual page for quite how infuriat‐
       ing the underlying command is):

              tcp_proxy 7337 dc

       To connect to this from the same host with a session also named `dc':

              tcp_open localhost 7337 dc

       To  send a command to the remote session and wait a short while for output (assuming dc is
       the current session):

              tcp_command 2 4 + p

       To close the session:

              tcp_close

       The tcp_proxy needs to be killed to be stopped.  Note this will not usually kill any  con‐
       nections  which  have  already  been  accepted,  and also that the port is not immediately
       available for reuse.

       The following chunk of code puts a list of sessions into an xterm header, with the current
       session followed by a star.

              print -n "\033]2;TCP:" ${(k)tcp_by_name:/$TCP_SESS/$TCP_SESS\*} "\a"

TCP BUGS
       The function tcp_read uses the shell's normal read builtin.  As this reads a complete line
       at once, data arriving without a terminating newline  can  cause  the  function  to  block
       indefinitely.

       Though  the  function  suite works well for interactive use and for data arriving in small
       amounts, the performance when large amounts of data are being exchanged is  likely  to  be
       extremely poor.



ZSHZFTPSYS(1)                        General Commands Manual                        ZSHZFTPSYS(1)



NAME
       zshzftpsys - zftp function front-end

DESCRIPTION
       This  describes  the  set  of  shell functions supplied with the source distribution as an
       interface to the zftp builtin command, allowing you to perform  FTP  operations  from  the
       shell  command  line or within functions or scripts.  The interface is similar to a tradi‐
       tional FTP client (e.g. the ftp command itself, see ftp(1)), but as it  is  entirely  done
       within  the  shell  all the familiar completion, editing and globbing features, and so on,
       are present, and macros are particularly simple to write as they are just  ordinary  shell
       functions.

       The  prerequisite is that the zftp command, as described in zshmodules(1) , must be avail‐
       able in the version of zsh installed at your site.  If the shell is configured to load new
       commands  at  run time, it probably is: typing `zmodload zsh/zftp' will make sure (if that
       runs silently, it has worked).  If this is not the case, it is possible  zftp  was  linked
       into  the  shell anyway: to test this, type `which zftp' and if zftp is available you will
       get the message `zftp: shell built-in command'.

       Commands given directly with zftp builtin may be interspersed  between  the  functions  in
       this  suite;  in a few cases, using zftp directly may cause some of the status information
       stored in shell parameters to become invalid.  Note in particular the description  of  the
       variables $ZFTP_TMOUT, $ZFTP_PREFS and $ZFTP_VERBOSE for zftp.

INSTALLATION
       You  should  make  sure  all the functions from the Functions/Zftp directory of the source
       distribution are available; they all begin with the two letters `zf'.   They  may  already
       have  been  installed on your system; otherwise, you will need to find them and copy them.
       The directory should appear as one of the  elements  of  the  $fpath  array  (this  should
       already  be  the  case if they were installed), and at least the function zfinit should be
       autoloaded; it will autoload the rest.  Finally, to initialize the use of the  system  you
       need  to  call  the  zfinit  function.  The following code in your .zshrc will arrange for
       this; assume the functions are stored in the directory ~/myfns:

              fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
              autoload -U zfinit
              zfinit

       Note that zfinit assumes you are using the zmodload method to load the zftp  command.   If
       it is already built into the shell, change zfinit to zfinit -n.  It is helpful (though not
       essential) if the call to zfinit appears after any code to initialize the  new  completion
       system, else unnecessary compctl commands will be given.

FUNCTIONS
       The  sequence  of operations in performing a file transfer is essentially the same as that
       in a standard FTP client.  Note that, due to a quirk of the shell's getopts  builtin,  for
       those  functions  that  handle  options  you  must  use `--' rather than `-' to ensure the
       remaining arguments are treated literally (a single `-' is treated as an argument).

   Opening a connection
       zfparams [ host [ user [ password ... ] ] ]
              Set or show the parameters for a future zfopen with no arguments.  If no  arguments
              are  given,  the  current parameters are displayed (the password will be shown as a
              line of asterisks).  If a host is given, and either the user or  password  is  not,
              they  will  be prompted for; also, any parameter given as `?' will be prompted for,
              and if the `?' is followed by a string, that will be used as the prompt.  As zfopen
              calls zfparams to store the parameters, this usually need not be called directly.

              A  single argument `-' will delete the stored parameters.  This will also cause the
              memory of the last directory (and so on) on the other host to be deleted.

       zfopen [ -1 ] [ host [ user [ password [ account ] ] ] ]
              If host is present, open a connection to that host under username user  with  pass‐
              word  password  (and, on the rare occasions when it is necessary, account account).
              If a necessary parameter is missing or given as `?' it will be  prompted  for.   If
              host is not present, use a previously stored set of parameters.

              If  the  command  was  successful,  and the terminal is compatible with xterm or is
              sun-cmd, a summary will appear in the title bar, giving  the  local  host:directory
              and  the  remote  host:directory;  this  is  handled  by  the  function zftp_chpwd,
              described below.

              Normally, the host, user and password are internally recorded for later re-opening,
              either  by  a  zfopen  with  no  arguments, or automatically (see below).  With the
              option `-1', no information is stored.  Also, if an  open  command  with  arguments
              failed,  the parameters will not be retained (and any previous parameters will also
              be deleted).  A zfopen on its own, or a zfopen -1, never alters the stored  parame‐
              ters.

              Both   zfopen   and   zfanon  (but  not  zfparams)  understand  URLs  of  the  form
              ftp://host/path... as meaning to connect to the host, then change directory to path
              (which must be a directory, not a file).  The `ftp://' can be omitted; the trailing
              `/' is enough to trigger recognition of the path.  Note prefixes other than  `ftp:'
              are  not  recognized, and that all characters after the first slash beyond host are
              significant in path.

       zfanon [ -1 ] host
              Open a connection host for anonymous FTP.  The username used is  `anonymous'.   The
              password (which will be reported the first time) is generated as user@host; this is
              then stored in the shell parameter $EMAIL_ADDR which can alternatively be set manu‐
              ally to a suitable string.

   Directory management
       zfcd [ dir ]
       zfcd -
       zfcd old new
              Change  the  current  directory  on the remote server:  this is implemented to have
              many of the features of the shell builtin cd.

              In the first form with dir present, change to the directory dir.  The command `zfcd
              ..'  is  treated specially, so is guaranteed to work on non-UNIX servers (note this
              is handled internally by zftp).  If dir is omitted, has the effect of `zfcd ~'.

              The second form changes to the directory previously current.

              The third form attempts to change the current  directory  by  replacing  the  first
              occurrence of the string old with the string new in the current directory.

              Note  that  in this command, and indeed anywhere a remote filename is expected, the
              string which on the local host corresponds to `~' is converted back to a `~' before
              being  passed  to the remote machine.  This is convenient because of the way expan‐
              sion is performed on the command line before zfcd receives a string.  For  example,
              suppose  the  command  is  `zfcd ~/foo'.  The shell will expand this to a full path
              such as `zfcd /home/user2/pws/foo'.  At this stage,  zfcd  recognises  the  initial
              path  as  corresponding  to  `~'  and will send the directory to the remote host as
              ~/foo, so that the `~' will be expanded by the server to the  correct  remote  host
              directory.   Other  named  directories  of the form `~name' are not treated in this
              fashion.

       zfhere Change directory on the remote server to the one corresponding to the current local
              directory,  with  special  handling of `~' as in zfcd.  For example, if the current
              local directory is ~/foo/bar, then zfhere performs the effect of `zfcd ~/foo/bar'.

       zfdir [ -rfd ] [ - ] [ dir-options ] [ dir ]
              Produce a long directory listing.  The arguments dir-options  and  dir  are  passed
              directly to the server and their effect is implementation dependent, but specifying
              a particular remote directory dir  is  usually  possible.   The  output  is  passed
              through  a pager given by the environment variable $PAGER, or `more' if that is not
              set.

              The directory is usually cached for re-use.  In fact, two  caches  are  maintained.
              One is for use when there is no dir-options or dir, i.e. a full listing of the cur‐
              rent remote directory; it is flushed when the  current  remote  directory  changes.
              The  other  is kept for repeated use of zfdir with the same arguments; for example,
              repeated use of `zfdir /pub/gnu' will only require the directory to be retrieved on
              the first call.  Alternatively, this cache can be re-viewed with the -r option.  As
              relative directories will confuse zfdir, the -f option can be  used  to  force  the
              cache to be flushed before the directory is listed.  The option -d will delete both
              caches without showing a directory listing; it will also delete the cache  of  file
              names in the current remote directory, if any.

       zfls [ ls-options ] [ dir ]
              List  files  on  the  remote server.  With no arguments, this will produce a simple
              list of file names for the current remote  directory.   Any  arguments  are  passed
              directly to the server.  No pager and no caching is used.

   Status commands
       zftype [ type ]
              With  no  arguments,  show  the  type  of  data to be transferred, usually ASCII or
              binary.  With an argument, change the type: the types `A' or `ASCII' for ASCII data
              and  `B'  or  `BINARY', `I' or `IMAGE' for binary data are understood case-insensi‐
              tively.

       zfstat [ -v ]
              Show the status of the current or last connection, as well as the status of some of
              zftp's status variables.  With the -v option, a more verbose listing is produced by
              querying the server for its version of events, too.

   Retrieving files
       The commands for retrieving files all take at least  two  options.  -G  suppresses  remote
       filename  expansion  which  would  otherwise  be  performed (see below for a more detailed
       description of that).  -t attempts to set the modification time of the local file to  that
       of  the  remote  file: see the description of the function zfrtime below for more informa‐
       tion.

       zfget [ -Gtc ] file1 ...
              Retrieve all the listed files file1 ... one at a time from the remote server.  If a
              file  contains a `/', the full name is passed to the remote server, but the file is
              stored locally under the name given by the part after the final `/'.  The option -c
              (cat)  forces  all  files to be sent as a single stream to standard output; in this
              case the -t option has no effect.

       zfuget [ -Gvst ] file1 ...
              As zfget, but only retrieve files where the version on the remote server  is  newer
              (has  a  later  modification time), or where the local file does not exist.  If the
              remote file is older but the files have different sizes, or if the  sizes  are  the
              same  but  the  remote  file  is newer, the user will usually be queried.  With the
              option -s, the command runs silently and will always retrieve the file in either of
              those two cases.  With the option -v, the command prints more information about the
              files while it is working out whether or not to transfer them.

       zfcget [ -Gt ] file1 ...
              As zfget, but if any of the local files exists, and is shorter than the correspond‐
              ing remote file, the command assumes that it is the result of a partially completed
              transfer and attempts to transfer the rest of the file.  This is useful on  a  poor
              connection which keeps failing.

              Note  that  this  requires a commonly implemented, but non-standard, version of the
              FTP protocol, so is not guaranteed to work on all servers.

       zfgcp [ -Gt ] remote-file local-file
       zfgcp [ -Gt ] rfile1 ... ldir
              This retrieves files from the remote server with arguments  behaving  similarly  to
              the cp command.

              In the first form, copy remote-file from the server to the local file local-file.

              In  the  second form, copy all the remote files rfile1 ... into the local directory
              ldir retaining the same basenames.  This assumes UNIX directory semantics.

   Sending files
       zfput [ -r ] file1 ...
              Send all the file1 ... given separately to the remote server.  If a  filename  con‐
              tains a `/', the full filename is used locally to find the file, but only the base‐
              name is used for the remote file name.

              With the option -r, if any of the files are directories they are  sent  recursively
              with  all  their subdirectories, including files beginning with `.'.  This requires
              that the remote machine understand UNIX file semantics, since  `/'  is  used  as  a
              directory separator.

       zfuput [ -vs ] file1 ...
              As  zfput,  but only send files which are newer than their local equivalents, or if
              the remote file does not exist.  The logic is the same as for zfuget, but  reversed
              between local and remote files.

       zfcput file1 ...
              As  zfput,  but  if  any  remote  file already exists and is shorter than the local
              equivalent, assume it is the result of an incomplete transfer and send the rest  of
              the  file to append to the existing part.  As the FTP append command is part of the
              standard set, this is in principle more likely to work than zfcget.

       zfpcp local-file remote-file
       zfpcp lfile1 ... rdir
              This sends files to the remote server with arguments behaving similarly to  the  cp
              command.

              With two arguments, copy local-file to the server as remote-file.

              With more than two arguments, copy all the local files lfile1 ... into the existing
              remote directory rdir retaining the same basenames.  This  assumes  UNIX  directory
              semantics.

              A  problem  arises if you attempt to use zfpcp lfile1 rdir, i.e. the second form of
              copying but with two arguments, as the command has no simple way of knowing if rdir
              corresponds  to  a directory or a filename.  It attempts to resolve this in various
              ways.  First, if the rdir argument is `.' or `..' or ends in a slash, it is assumed
              to  be  a directory.  Secondly, if the operation of copying to a remote file in the
              first form failed, and the remote server sends back the expected failure  code  553
              and  a reply including the string `Is a directory', then zfpcp will retry using the
              second form.

   Closing the connection
       zfclose
              Close the connection.

   Session management
       zfsession [ -lvod ] [ sessname ]
              Allows you to manage multiple FTP sessions at once.  By default,  connections  take
              place in a session called `default'; by giving the command `zfsession sessname' you
              can change to a new or existing session with a name of your choice.  The  new  ses‐
              sion remembers its own connection, as well as associated shell parameters, and also
              the host/user parameters set by zfparams.  Hence you can  have  different  sessions
              set  up  to connect to different hosts, each remembering the appropriate host, user
              and password.

              With no arguments, zfsession prints the name  of  the  current  session;  with  the
              option  -l  it  lists all sessions which currently exist, and with the option -v it
              gives a verbose list showing the host and directory for  each  session,  where  the
              current  session  is  marked with an asterisk.  With -o, it will switch to the most
              recent previous session.

              With -d, the given session (or else the current one) is removed; everything  to  do
              with  it is completely forgotten.  If it was the only session, a new session called
              `default' is created and made current.  It is safest not to delete  sessions  while
              background commands using zftp are active.

       zftransfer sess1:file1 sess2:file2
              Transfer  files between two sessions; no local copy is made.  The file is read from
              the session sess1 as file1 and written to session sess2 as file  file2;  file1  and
              file2  may  be relative to the current directories of the session.  Either sess1 or
              sess2 may be omitted (though the colon should be retained if there is a possibility
              of  a  colon appearing in the file name) and defaults to the current session; file2
              may be omitted or may end with a slash, in which case the basename of file1 will be
              added.  The sessions sess1 and sess2 must be distinct.

              The  operation  is  performed  using  pipes, so it is required that the connections
              still be valid in a subshell, which is not the case under versions of some  operat‐
              ing systems, presumably due to a system bug.

   Bookmarks
       The  two  functions  zfmark and zfgoto allow you to `bookmark' the present location (host,
       user and directory) of the current FTP connection for later use.  The file to be used  for
       storing  and  retrieving bookmarks is given by the parameter $ZFTP_BMFILE; if not set when
       one of the two functions is called, it will be set to the file .zfbkmarks in the directory
       where your zsh startup files live (usually ~).

       zfmark [ bookmark ]
              If  given  an  argument,  mark  the current host, user and directory under the name
              bookmark for later use by zfgoto.  If there is no connection open, use  the  values
              for  the  last connection immediately before it was closed; it is an error if there
              was none.  Any existing bookmark under the same name will be silently replaced.

              If not given an argument, list the existing bookmarks and the points to which  they
              refer in the form user@host:directory; this is the format in which they are stored,
              and the file may be edited directly.

       zfgoto [ -n ] bookmark
              Return to the location given by bookmark, as previously  set  by  zfmark.   If  the
              location has user `ftp' or `anonymous', open the connection with zfanon, so that no
              password is required.  If the user and host parameters match those stored  for  the
              current  session,  if  any,  those will be used, and again no password is required.
              Otherwise a password will be prompted for.

              With the option -n, the bookmark is taken to be a nickname stored by the ncftp pro‐
              gram in its bookmark file, which is assumed to be ~/.ncftp/bookmarks.  The function
              works identically in other ways.  Note that there is no  mechanism  for  adding  or
              modifying ncftp bookmarks from the zftp functions.

   Other functions
       Mostly, these functions will not be called directly (apart from zfinit), but are described
       here for completeness.  You may wish to alter zftp_chpwd and zftp_progress, in particular.

       zfinit [ -n ]
              As described above, this is used to initialize the zftp function  system.   The  -n
              option should be used if the zftp command is already built into the shell.

       zfautocheck [ -dn ]
              This function is called to implement automatic reopening behaviour, as described in
              more detail below.  The options must appear in the first argument; -n prevents  the
              command  from  changing to the old directory, while -d prevents it from setting the
              variable do_close, which it otherwise does as a flag for automatically closing  the
              connection  after  a  transfer.   The  host  and directory for the last session are
              stored in the variable $zflastsession, but the internal host/user/password  parame‐
              ters must also be correctly set.

       zfcd_match prefix suffix
              This  performs  matching  for  completion of remote directory names.  If the remote
              server is UNIX, it will attempt to persuade the server to list the remote directory
              with  subdirectories  marked,  which usually works but is not guaranteed.  On other
              hosts it simply calls zfget_match and hence completes all files, not just  directo‐
              ries.  On some systems, directories may not even look like filenames.

       zfget_match prefix suffix
              This performs matching for completion of remote filenames.  It caches files for the
              current directory (only) in the shell parameter $zftp_fcache.  It is in the form to
              be  called  by  the  -K  option  of compctl, but also works when called from a wid‐
              get-style completion function with prefix and suffix set appropriately.

       zfrglob varname
              Perform remote globbing, as describes in more detail below.  varname is the name of
              a  variable  containing  the pattern to be expanded; if there were any matches, the
              same variable will be set to the expanded set of filenames on return.

       zfrtime lfile rfile [ time ]
              Set the local file lfile to have the same modification  time  as  the  remote  file
              rfile, or the explicit time time in FTP format CCYYMMDDhhmmSS for the GMT timezone.
              This uses the shell's zsh/datetime module to perform the  conversion  from  GMT  to
              local time.

       zftp_chpwd
              This function is called every time a connection is opened, or closed, or the remote
              directory changes.  This version alters the title bar  of  an  xterm-compatible  or
              sun-cmd  terminal  emulator  to  reflect the local and remote hostnames and current
              directories.  It works best when combined with the function chpwd.  In  particular,
              a function of the form

                     chpwd() {
                       if [[ -n $ZFTP_USER ]]; then
                         zftp_chpwd
                       else
                         # usual chpwd e.g put host:directory in title bar
                       fi
                     }

              fits in well.

       zftp_progress
              This  function shows the status of the transfer.  It will not write anything unless
              the output is going to a terminal; however, if you  transfer  files  in  the  back‐
              ground,  you  should  turn  off  progress  reports  by hand using `zstyle ':zftp:*'
              progress none'.  Note also that if you alter it, any output  must  be  to  standard
              error,  as  standard output may be a file being received.  The form of the progress
              meter, or whether it is used at all, can be configured without altering  the  func‐
              tion, as described in the next section.

       zffcache
              This  is  used to implement caching of files in the current directory for each ses‐
              sion separately.  It is used by zfget_match and zfrglob.

MISCELLANEOUS FEATURES
   Configuration
       Various styles are available using the standard shell style mechanism, described  in  zsh‐
       modules(1). Briefly, the command `zstyle ':zftp:*' style value ...'.  defines the style to
       have value value; more than one value may be given, although that is  not  useful  in  the
       cases described here.  These values will then be used throughout the zftp function system.
       For more precise control, the first argument, which gives a context  in  which  the  style
       applies,  can  be modified to include a particular function, as for example `:zftp:zfget':
       the style will then have the given value only in the zfget function.  Values for the  same
       style  in  different  contexts  may be set; the most specific function will be used, where
       strings are held to be more specific than patterns, and longer patterns and  shorter  pat‐
       terns.   Note that only the top level function name, as called by the user, is used; call‐
       ing of lower level functions is transparent to the user.  Hence modifications to the title
       bar  in zftp_chpwd use the contexts :zftp:zfopen, :zftp:zfcd, etc., depending where it was
       called from.  The following styles are understood:

       progress
              Controls the way that zftp_progress reports on the  progress  of  a  transfer.   If
              empty,  unset,  or  `none',  no  progress report is made; if `bar' a growing bar of
              inverse video is shown; if `percent' (or any other string, though this  may  change
              in  future),  the  percentage  of  the  file  transferred  is shown.  The bar meter
              requires that the width of the terminal be available  via  the  $COLUMNS  parameter
              (normally this is set automatically).  If the size of the file being transferred is
              not available, bar and percent meters will simply show the number of  bytes  trans‐
              ferred so far.

              When  zfinit  is run, if this style is not defined for the context :zftp:*, it will
              be set to `bar'.

       update Specifies the minimum time interval between updates of the progress meter  in  sec‐
              onds.   No  update  is  made  unless new data has been received, so the actual time
              interval is limited only by $ZFTP_TIMEOUT.

              As described for progress, zfinit will force this to default to 1.

       remote-glob
              If set to `1', `yes' or `true', filename generation (globbing) is performed on  the
              remote machine instead of by zsh itself; see below.

       titlebar
              If  set  to  `1',  `yes'  or `true', zftp_chpwd will put the remote host and remote
              directory into the titlebar of terminal emulators such as  xterm  or  sun-cmd  that
              allow this.

              As described for progress, zfinit will force this to default to 1.

       chpwd  If  set to `1' `yes' or `true', zftp_chpwd will call the function chpwd when a con‐
              nection is closed.  This is useful if the remote host details  were  put  into  the
              terminal title bar by zftp_chpwd and your usual chpwd also modifies the title bar.

              When  zfinit  is  run, it will determine whether chpwd exists and if so it will set
              the default value for the style to 1 if none exists already.

       Note that there is also an associative array zfconfig which contains values  used  by  the
       function system.  This should not be modified or overwritten.

   Remote globbing
       The  commands for retrieving files usually perform filename generation (globbing) on their
       arguments; this can be turned off by passing the option -G to each of the commands.   Nor‐
       mally  this operates by retrieving a complete list of files for the directory in question,
       then matching these locally against the pattern supplied.  This has the advantage that the
       full  range  of  zsh  patterns (respecting the setting of the option EXTENDED_GLOB) can be
       used.  However, it means that the directory part of a filename will not  be  expanded  and
       must  be  given  exactly.  If the remote server does not support the UNIX directory seman‐
       tics, directory handling is problematic and it is recommended that globbing only  be  used
       within  the  current directory.  The list of files in the current directory, if retrieved,
       will be cached, so that subsequent globs in the same directory without an intervening zfcd
       are much faster.

       If  the  remote-glob style (see above) is set, globbing is instead performed on the remote
       host: the server is asked for a list of matching files.  This is highly dependent  on  how
       the  server  is  implemented, though typically UNIX servers will provide support for basic
       glob patterns.  This may in some cases be faster, as it avoids retrieving the entire  list
       of directory contents.

   Automatic and temporary reopening
       As  described  for  the zfopen command, a subsequent zfopen with no parameters will reopen
       the connection to the last host (this includes connections made with the zfanon  command).
       Opened  in  this  fashion,  the connection starts in the default remote directory and will
       remain open until explicitly closed.

       Automatic re-opening is also available.  If a connection is not currently open and a  com‐
       mand requiring a connection is given, the last connection is implicitly reopened.  In this
       case the directory which was current when the connection was closed again becomes the cur‐
       rent  directory  (unless,  of  course, the command given changes it).  Automatic reopening
       will also take place if the connection was close by the remote server for whatever  reason
       (e.g. a timeout).  It is not available if the -1 option to zfopen or zfanon was used.

       Furthermore, if the command issued is a file transfer, the connection will be closed after
       the transfer is finished, hence providing a one-shot mode for transfers.   This  does  not
       apply  to directory changing or listing commands; for example a zfdir may reopen a connec‐
       tion but will leave it open.  Also, automatic closure will only ever happen  in  the  same
       command  as  automatic  opening, i.e a zfdir directly followed by a zfget will never close
       the connection automatically.

       Information about the previous connection is given by the zfstat function.  So, for  exam‐
       ple, if that reports:

              Session:        default
              Not connected.
              Last session:   ftp.bar.com:/pub/textfiles

       then  the  command  zfget  file.txt  will  attempt  to reopen a connection to ftp.bar.com,
       retrieve the file /pub/textfiles/file.txt, and immediately close the connection again.  On
       the other hand, zfcd ..  will open the connection in the directory /pub and leave it open.

       Note that all the above is local to each session; if you return to a previous session, the
       connection for that session is the one which will be reopened.

   Completion
       Completion of local and remote files, directories, sessions and  bookmarks  is  supported.
       The  older, compctl-style completion is defined when zfinit is called; support for the new
       widget-based completion system is provided in the  function  Completion/Zsh/Command/_zftp,
       which  should  be  installed  with  the other functions of the completion system and hence
       should automatically be available.



ZSHCONTRIB(1)                        General Commands Manual                        ZSHCONTRIB(1)



NAME
       zshcontrib - user contributions to zsh

DESCRIPTION
       The Zsh source distribution includes a number of items contributed by the user  community.
       These  are  not inherently a part of the shell, and some may not be available in every zsh
       installation.  The most significant of these are documented here.   For  documentation  on
       other  contributed items such as shell functions, look for comments in the function source
       files.

UTILITIES
   Accessing On-Line Help
       The key sequence ESC h is normally bound by ZLE to execute the run-help widget  (see  zsh‐
       zle(1)).   This  invokes the run-help command with the command word from the current input
       line as its argument.  By default, run-help is an alias for the man command, so this often
       fails  when the command word is a shell builtin or a user-defined function.  By redefining
       the run-help alias, one can improve the on-line help provided by the shell.

       The helpfiles utility, found in the Util directory of the distribution, is a Perl  program
       that  can be used to process the zsh manual to produce a separate help file for each shell
       builtin and for many other shell features as well.  The  autoloadable  run-help  function,
       found  in Functions/Misc, searches for these helpfiles and performs several other tests to
       produce the most complete help possible for the command.

       Help  files  are  installed  by  default  to   a   subdirectory   of   /usr/share/zsh   or
       /usr/local/share/zsh.

       To create your own help files with helpfiles, choose or create a directory where the indi‐
       vidual command help files will reside.  For example, you might choose ~/zsh_help.  If  you
       unpacked the zsh distribution in your home directory, you would use the commands:

              mkdir ~/zsh_help
              perl ~/zsh-5.0.7/Util/helpfiles ~/zsh_help

       The HELPDIR parameter tells run-help where to look for the help files. When unset, it uses
       the default installation path.  To use your own set of help files, set this to the  appro‐
       priate path in one of your startup files:

              HELPDIR=~/zsh_help

       To  use  the run-help function, you need to add lines something like the following to your
       .zshrc or equivalent startup file:

              unalias run-help
              autoload run-help

       Note that in order for `autoload run-help' to work, the run-help file must be  in  one  of
       the  directories  named in your fpath array (see zshparam(1)).  This should already be the
       case if you have a standard zsh installation; if it is not,  copy  Functions/Misc/run-help
       to an appropriate directory.

   Recompiling Functions
       If you frequently edit your zsh functions, or periodically update your zsh installation to
       track the latest developments, you may find that function digests compiled with the  zcom‐
       pile  builtin  are frequently out of date with respect to the function source files.  This
       is not usually a problem, because zsh always looks for the  newest  file  when  loading  a
       function,  but  it may cause slower shell startup and function loading.  Also, if a digest
       file is explicitly used as an element of fpath, zsh won't check whether any of its  source
       files has changed.

       The  zrecompile  autoloadable function, found in Functions/Misc, can be used to keep func‐
       tion digests up to date.

       zrecompile [ -qt ] [ name ... ]
       zrecompile [ -qt ] -p args [ -- args ... ]
              This tries to find *.zwc files and automatically re-compile them if at least one of
              the  original  files is newer than the compiled file.  This works only if the names
              stored in the compiled files are full paths or are relative to the  directory  that
              contains the .zwc file.

              In the first form, each name is the name of a compiled file or a directory contain‐
              ing *.zwc files that should be checked.  If no arguments are given, the directories
              and *.zwc files in fpath are used.

              When  -t  is given, no compilation is performed, but a return status of zero (true)
              is set if there are files that need to be re-compiled and non-zero  (false)  other‐
              wise.   The  -q  option  quiets the chatty output that describes what zrecompile is
              doing.

              Without the -t option, the return status is zero if all files that needed re-compi‐
              lation  could be compiled and non-zero if compilation for at least one of the files
              failed.

              If the -p option is given, the args are interpreted as one or more  sets  of  argu‐
              ments for zcompile, separated by `--'.  For example:

                     zrecompile -p \
                                -R ~/.zshrc -- \
                                -M ~/.zcompdump -- \
                                ~/zsh/comp.zwc ~/zsh/Completion/*/_*

              This  compiles  ~/.zshrc  into ~/.zshrc.zwc if that doesn't exist or if it is older
              than ~/.zshrc. The compiled file will be marked for reading instead of mapping. The
              same  is  done  for  ~/.zcompdump  and  ~/.zcompdump.zwc, but this compiled file is
              marked for mapping. The last line re-creates the file ~/zsh/comp.zwc if any of  the
              files matching the given pattern is newer than it.

              Without  the  -p  option,  zrecompile  does not create function digests that do not
              already exist, nor does it add new functions to the digest.

       The following shell loop is an example of a method for creating function digests  for  all
       functions in your fpath, assuming that you have write permission to the directories:

              for ((i=1; i <= $#fpath; ++i)); do
                dir=$fpath[i]
                zwc=${dir:t}.zwc
                if [[ $dir == (.|..) || $dir == (.|..)/* ]]; then
                  continue
                fi
                files=($dir/*(N-.))
                if [[ -w $dir:h && -n $files ]]; then
                  files=(${${(M)files%/*/*}#/})
                  if ( cd $dir:h &&
                       zrecompile -p -U -z $zwc $files ); then
                    fpath[i]=$fpath[i].zwc
                  fi
                fi
              done

       The -U and -z options are appropriate for functions in the default zsh installation fpath;
       you may need to use different options for your personal function directories.

       Once the digests have been created and your fpath modified to refer to them, you can  keep
       them up to date by running zrecompile with no arguments.

   Keyboard Definition
       The  large  number  of possible combinations of keyboards, workstations, terminals, emula‐
       tors, and window systems makes it impossible for zsh to have  built-in  key  bindings  for
       every  situation.   The zkbd utility, found in Functions/Misc, can help you quickly create
       key bindings for your configuration.

       Run zkbd either as an autoloaded function, or as a shell script:

              zsh -f ~/zsh-5.0.7/Functions/Misc/zkbd

       When you run zkbd, it first asks you to enter your terminal type; if the default it offers
       is  correct,  just  press return.  It then asks you to press a number of different keys to
       determine characteristics of your keyboard and terminal; zkbd warns you if it  finds  any‐
       thing out of the ordinary, such as a Delete key that sends neither ^H nor ^?.

       The  keystrokes  read  by zkbd are recorded as a definition for an associative array named
       key, written to a file in the subdirectory .zkbd within either your HOME or ZDOTDIR direc‐
       tory.   The  name  of  the  file  is composed from the TERM, VENDOR and OSTYPE parameters,
       joined by hyphens.

       You may read this file into your .zshrc or another startup file with the `source'  or  `.'
       commands, then reference the key parameter in bindkey commands, like this:

              source ${ZDOTDIR:-$HOME}/.zkbd/$TERM-$VENDOR-$OSTYPE
              [[ -n ${key[Left]} ]] && bindkey "${key[Left]}" backward-char
              [[ -n ${key[Right]} ]] && bindkey "${key[Right]}" forward-char
              # etc.

       Note that in order for `autoload zkbd' to work, the zkdb file must be in one of the direc‐
       tories named in your fpath array (see zshparam(1)).  This should already be  the  case  if
       you  have a standard zsh installation; if it is not, copy Functions/Misc/zkbd to an appro‐
       priate directory.

   Dumping Shell State
       Occasionally you may encounter what appears to be a bug in the shell, particularly if  you
       are  using  a  beta  version of zsh or a development release.  Usually it is sufficient to
       send a description of the problem to one of the zsh mailing lists (see zsh(1)), but  some‐
       times  one  of the zsh developers will need to recreate your environment in order to track
       the problem down.

       The script named reporter, found in the Util directory of the  distribution,  is  provided
       for  this  purpose.   (It  is  also  possible  to  autoload  reporter, but reporter is not
       installed in fpath by default.)  This script outputs a detailed dump of the  shell  state,
       in the form of another script that can be read with `zsh -f' to recreate that state.

       To  use  reporter,  read  the script into your shell with the `.' command and redirect the
       output into a file:

              . ~/zsh-5.0.7/Util/reporter > zsh.report

       You should check the zsh.report file for any sensitive information such as  passwords  and
       delete  them by hand before sending the script to the developers.  Also, as the output can
       be voluminous, it's best to wait for the developers to ask  for  this  information  before
       sending it.

       You  can  also  use  reporter to dump only a subset of the shell state.  This is sometimes
       useful for creating startup files for the first time.  Most of the output from reporter is
       far  more detailed than usually is necessary for a startup file, but the aliases, options,
       and zstyles states may be useful because they include only changes from the defaults.  The
       bindings state may be useful if you have created any of your own keymaps, because reporter
       arranges to dump the keymap creation commands as well as the bindings for every keymap.

       As is usual with automated tools, if you create a startup file with reporter,  you  should
       edit  the  results to remove unnecessary commands.  Note that if you're using the new com‐
       pletion system, you should not dump  the  functions  state  to  your  startup  files  with
       reporter; use the compdump function instead (see zshcompsys(1)).

       reporter [ state ... ]
              Print  to  standard  output  the  indicated subset of the current shell state.  The
              state arguments may be one or more of:

              all    Output everything listed below.
              aliases
                     Output alias definitions.
              bindings
                     Output ZLE key maps and bindings.
              completion
                     Output old-style compctl commands.  New completion is covered  by  functions
                     and zstyles.
              functions
                     Output autoloads and function definitions.
              limits Output limit commands.
              options
                     Output setopt commands.
              styles Same as zstyles.
              variables
                     Output shell parameter assignments, plus export commands for any environment
                     variables.
              zstyles
                     Output zstyle commands.

              If the state is omitted, all is assumed.

       With the exception of `all', every state can be abbreviated by any prefix, even  a  single
       letter; thus a is the same as aliases, z is the same as zstyles, etc.

   Manipulating Hook Functions
       add-zsh-hook [-dD] hook function
              Several  functions  are  special  to the shell, as described in the section SPECIAL
              FUNCTIONS, see zshmisc(1), in that they are automatic called at  a  specific  point
              during  shell execution.  Each has an associated array consisting of names of func‐
              tions to be called at the same point; these are so-called  `hook  functions'.   The
              shell  function  add-zsh-hook provides a simple way of adding or removing functions
              from the array.

              hook is one  of  chpwd,  periodic,  precmd,  preexec,  zshaddhistory,  zshexit,  or
              zsh_directory_name,  the  special  functions  in  question.   Note  that zsh_direc‐
              tory_name is called in a different way from the other functions, but may  still  be
              manipulated as a hook.

              function  is name of an ordinary shell function.  If no options are given this will
              be added to the array of functions to be executed in the given context.

              If the option -d is given, the function is removed from the array of  functions  to
              be executed.

              If  the  option  -D is given, the function is treated as a pattern and any matching
              names of functions are removed from the array of functions to be executed.

              The options -U, -z and -k are passed as arguments to autoload  for  function.   For
              functions contributed with zsh, the options -Uz are appropriate.

REMEMBERING RECENT DIRECTORIES
       The  function  cdr allows you to change the working directory to a previous working direc‐
       tory from a list maintained automatically.  It is similar  in  concept  to  the  directory
       stack controlled by the pushd, popd and dirs builtins, but is more configurable, and as it
       stores all entries in files it is maintained across sessions and (by default) between ter‐
       minal  emulators in the current session.  (The pushd directory stack is not actually modi‐
       fied or used by cdr unless you configure it to do so as  described  in  the  configuration
       section below.)

   Installation
       The  system  works  by  means  of  a hook function that is called every time the directory
       changes.  To install the system, autoload the required functions and use the  add-zsh-hook
       function described above:

              autoload -Uz chpwd_recent_dirs cdr add-zsh-hook
              add-zsh-hook chpwd chpwd_recent_dirs

       Now  every  time  you  change directly interactively, no matter which command you use, the
       directory to which you change will be remembered in most-recent-first order.

   Use
       All direct user interaction is via the cdr function.

       The argument to cdr is a number N corresponding to the Nth most recently changed-to direc‐
       tory.   1  is the immediately preceding directory; the current directory is remembered but
       is not offered as a destination.  Note that if you have multiple windows open 1 may  refer
       to  a  directory  changed  to in another window; you can avoid this by having per-terminal
       files for storing directory as described for the recent-dirs-file style below.

       If you set the recent-dirs-default style described below cdr will behave the same as cd if
       given  a  non-numeric  argument,  or more than one argument.  The recent directory list is
       updated just the same however you change directory.

       If the argument is omitted, 1 is assumed.  This is similar to pushd's behaviour  of  swap‐
       ping the two most recent directories on the stack.

       Completion  for  the argument to cdr is available if compinit has been run; menu selection
       is recommended, using:

              zstyle ':completion:*:*:cdr:*:*' menu selection

       to allow you to cycle through recent directories; the order is  preserved,  so  the  first
       choice  is  the  most  recent directory before the current one.  The verbose style is also
       recommended to ensure the directory is shown; this style is on by default so no action  is
       required unless you have changed it.

   Options
       The behaviour of cdr may be modified by the following options.

       -l     lists  the numbers and the corresponding directories in abbreviated form (i.e. with
              ~ substitution reapplied), one per line.  The directories here are not quoted (this
              would  only  be an issue if a directory name contained a newline).  This is used by
              the completion system.

       -r     sets the variable reply to the current set of directories.  Nothing is printed  and
              the directory is not changed.

       -e     allows  you  to edit the list of directories, one per line.  The list can be edited
              to any extent you like; no sanity checking is performed.  Completion is  available.
              No  quoting  is  necessary (except for newlines, where I have in any case no sympa‐
              thy); directories are in unabbreviated from and contain an absolute path, i.e. they
              start with /.  Usually the first entry should be left as the current directory.

   Configuration
       Configuration is by means of the styles mechanism that should be familiar from completion;
       if not, see the description of the zstyle command in see zshmodules(1).  The  context  for
       setting  styles  should  be  ':chpwd:*'  in case the meaning of the context is extended in
       future, for example:

              zstyle ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-max 0

       sets the value of the recent-dirs-max style to 0.  In practice the style name is  specific
       enough that a context of '*' should be fine.

       An exception is recent-dirs-insert, which is used exclusively by the completion system and
       so has the usual completion system context (':completion:*' if nothing  more  specific  is
       needed), though again '*' should be fine in practice.

       recent-dirs-default
              If true, and the command is expecting a recent directory index, and either there is
              more than one argument or the argument is not an  integer,  then  fall  through  to
              "cd".   This  allows the lazy to use only one command for directory changing.  Com‐
              pletion recognises this, too; see recent-dirs-insert for how to control  completion
              when this option is in use.

       recent-dirs-file
              The  file  where  the  list  of  directories  is  saved.   The  default  is ${ZDOT‐
              DIR:-$HOME}/.chpwd-recent-dirs, i.e. this is in your home directory unless you have
              set  the  variable  ZDOTDIR  to point somewhere else.  Directory names are saved in
              $'...' quoted form, so each line in the file can be supplied directly to the  shell
              as an argument.

              The  value of this style may be an array.  In this case, the first file in the list
              will always be  used  for  saving  directories  while  any  other  files  are  left
              untouched.   When  reading  the  recent directory list, if there are fewer than the
              maximum number of entries in the first file, the contents of  later  files  in  the
              array  will  be appended with duplicates removed from the list shown.  The contents
              of the two files are not sorted together, i.e. all the entries in  the  first  file
              are  shown  first.   The  special  value  +  can appear in the list to indicate the
              default file should be read at that point.  This allows effects like the following:

                     zstyle ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-file \
                     ~/.chpwd-recent-dirs-${TTY##*/} +

              Recent directories are read from a file numbered according  to  the  terminal.   If
              there are insufficient entries the list is supplemented from the default file.

              It is possible to use zstyle -e to make the directory configurable at run time:

                     zstyle -e ':chpwd:*' recent-dirs-file pick-recent-dirs-file
                     pick-recent-dirs-file() {
                       if [[ $PWD = ~/text/writing(|/*) ]]; then
                         reply=(~/.chpwd-recent-dirs-writing)
                       else
                         reply=(+)
                       fi
                     }

              In  this  example,  if the current directory is ~/text/writing or a directory under
              it, then use a special file for saving recent directories, else use the default.

       recent-dirs-insert
              Used by completion.  If recent-dirs-default is true,  then  setting  this  to  true
              causes  the  actual directory, rather than its index, to be inserted on the command
              line; this has the same effect as using the corresponding index, but makes the his‐
              tory  clearer  and the line easier to edit.  With this setting, if part of an argu‐
              ment was already typed, normal directory completion rather  than  recent  directory
              completion  is  done; this is because recent directory completion is expected to be
              done by cycling through entries menu fashion.

              If the value of the style is always, then only  recent  directories  will  be  com‐
              pleted;  in  that case, use the cd command when you want to complete other directo‐
              ries.

              If the value is fallback, recent directories  will  be  tried  first,  then  normal
              directory  completion  is performed if recent directory completion failed to find a
              match.

              Finally, if the value is both then both sets  of  completions  are  presented;  the
              usual  tag  mechanism  can  be used to distinguish results, with recent directories
              tagged as recent-dirs.  Note that the recent directories inserted  are  abbreviated
              with directory names where appropriate.

       recent-dirs-max
              The maximum number of directories to save to the file.  If this is zero or negative
              there is no maximum.  The default is 20.  Note this includes the current directory,
              which  isn't  offered,  so the highest number of directories you will be offered is
              one less than the maximum.

       recent-dirs-prune
              This style is an array determining what directories should (or should not) be added
              to the recent list.  Elements of the array can include:

              parent Prune  parents  (more  accurately,  ancestors)  from  the  recent  list.  If
                     present, changing directly down by any number of directories causes the cur‐
                     rent  directory  to  be  overwritten.   For  example,  changing from ~pws to
                     ~pws/some/other/dir causes ~pws not to  be  left  on  the  recent  directory
                     stack.   This only applies to direct changes to descendant directories; ear‐
                     lier directories on the list are not pruned.   For  example,  changing  from
                     ~pws/yet/another to ~pws/some/other/dir does not cause ~pws to be pruned.

              pattern:pattern
                     Gives  a  zsh pattern for directories that should not be added to the recent
                     list (if not already there).  This element can be repeated to add  different
                     patterns.   For  example,  'pattern:/tmp(|/*)' stops /tmp or its descendants
                     from being added.  The EXTENDED_GLOB option is always turned  on  for  these
                     patterns.

       recent-dirs-pushd
              If  set  to  true, cdr will use pushd instead of cd to change the directory, so the
              directory is saved on the directory stack.  As the directory  stack  is  completely
              separate  from  the list of files saved by the mechanism used in this file there is
              no obvious reason to do this.

   Use with dynamic directory naming
       It is possible to refer to recent directories using the dynamic directory name  syntax  by
       using the supplied function zsh_directory_name_cdr a hook:

              autoload -Uz add-zsh-hook
              add-zsh-hook -Uz zsh_directory_name zsh_directory_name_cdr

       When  this  is  done, ~[1] will refer to the most recent directory other than $PWD, and so
       on.  Completion after ~[...  also works.

   Details of directory handling
       This section is for the curious or confused; most users will not need to know this  infor‐
       mation.

       Recent  directories  are  saved  to a file immediately and hence are preserved across ses‐
       sions.  Note currently no file locking is applied: the  list  is  updated  immediately  on
       interactive  commands  and  nowhere  else (unlike history), and it is assumed you are only
       going to change directory in one window at once.  This is not safe on shared accounts, but
       in  any  case  the system has limited utility when someone else is changing to a different
       set of directories behind your back.

       To make this a little safer, only directory changes  instituted  from  the  command  line,
       either  directly  or  indirectly  through shell function calls (but not through subshells,
       evals, traps, completion functions and the like) are saved.  Shell functions should use cd
       -q  or pushd -q to avoid side effects if the change to the directory is to be invisible at
       the command line.  See the contents of the function chpwd_recent_dirs for more details.

GATHERING INFORMATION FROM VERSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
       In a lot of cases, it is nice to automatically retrieve information from  version  control
       systems (VCSs), such as subversion, CVS or git, to be able to provide it to the user; pos‐
       sibly in the user's prompt. So that you can instantly tell which branch you are  currently
       on, for example.

       In order to do that, you may use the vcs_info function.

       The  following VCSs are supported, showing the abbreviated name by which they are referred
       to within the system:
       Bazaar (bzr)
              http://bazaar-vcs.org/
       Codeville (cdv)
              http://codeville.org/
       Concurrent Versioning System (cvs)
              http://www.nongnu.org/cvs/
       Darcs (darcs)
              http://darcs.net/
       Fossil (fossil)
              http://fossil-scm.org/
       Git (git)
              http://git-scm.com/
       GNU arch (tla)
              http://www.gnu.org/software/gnu-arch/
       Mercurial (hg)
              http://mercurial.selenic.com/
       Monotone (mtn)
              http://monotone.ca/
       Perforce (p4)
              http://www.perforce.com/
       Subversion (svn)
              http://subversion.tigris.org/
       SVK (svk)
              http://svk.bestpractical.com/

       There  is  also  support  for   the   patch   management   system   quilt   (http://savan‐
       nah.nongnu.org/projects/quilt). See Quilt Support below for details.

       To load vcs_info:

              autoload -Uz vcs_info

       It  can  be  used  in any existing prompt, because it does not require any specific $psvar
       entries to be available.

   Quickstart
       To get this feature working quickly (including colors), you can do the  following  (assum‐
       ing, you loaded vcs_info properly - see above):

              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' actionformats \
                  '%F{5}(%f%s%F{5})%F{3}-%F{5}[%F{2}%b%F{3}|%F{1}%a%F{5}]%f '
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' formats       \
                  '%F{5}(%f%s%F{5})%F{3}-%F{5}[%F{2}%b%F{5}]%f '
              zstyle ':vcs_info:(sv[nk]|bzr):*' branchformat '%b%F{1}:%F{3}%r'
              precmd () { vcs_info }
              PS1='%F{5}[%F{2}%n%F{5}] %F{3}%3~ ${vcs_info_msg_0_}%f%# '

       Obviously,  the last two lines are there for demonstration. You need to call vcs_info from
       your precmd function. Once that is done you need a single quoted  '${vcs_info_msg_0_}'  in
       your prompt.

       To be able to use '${vcs_info_msg_0_}' directly in your prompt like this, you will need to
       have the PROMPT_SUBST option enabled.

       Now call the vcs_info_printsys utility from the command line:

              % vcs_info_printsys
              ## list of supported version control backends:
              ## disabled systems are prefixed by a hash sign (#)
              bzr
              cdv
              cvs
              darcs
              fossil
              git
              hg
              mtn
              p4
              svk
              svn
              tla
              ## flavours (cannot be used in the enable or disable styles; they
              ## are enabled and disabled with their master [git-svn -> git])
              ## they *can* be used in contexts: ':vcs_info:git-svn:*'.
              git-p4
              git-svn
              hg-git
              hg-hgsubversion
              hg-hgsvn

       You may not want all of these because there is no point in running the code to detect sys‐
       tems you do not use.  So there is a way to disable some backends altogether:

              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable bzr cdv darcs mtn svk tla

       You may also pick a few from that list and enable only those:

              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable git cvs svn

       If  you  rerun  vcs_info_printsys  after  one of these commands, you will see the backends
       listed in the disable style (or backends not in the enable  style  -  if  you  used  that)
       marked  as  disabled by a hash sign.  That means the detection of these systems is skipped
       completely. No wasted time there.

   Configuration
       The vcs_info feature can be configured via zstyle.

       First, the context in which we are working:
              :vcs_info:vcs-string:user-context:repo-root-name

       vcs-string
              is one of: git, git-svn, git-p4, hg, hg-git, hg-hgsubversion, hg-hgsvn, darcs, bzr,
              cdv, mtn, svn, cvs, svk, tla, p4 or fossil. When hooks are active the hooks name is
              added after a `+'. (See Hooks in vcs_info below.)

       user-context
              is a freely configurable string, assignable by the user as the  first  argument  to
              vcs_info (see its description below).

       repo-root-name
              is  the  name of a repository in which you want a style to match. So, if you want a
              setting specific to /usr/src/zsh, with that being  a  CVS  checkout,  you  can  set
              repo-root-name to zsh to make it so.

       There  are  three  special  values  for  vcs-string: The first is named -init-, that is in
       effect as long as there was no decision what VCS backend to use. The second is  -preinit-;
       it  is  used  before  vcs_info is run, when initializing the data exporting variables. The
       third special value is formats and is used by the  vcs_info_lastmsg  for  looking  up  its
       styles.

       The  initial  value of repo-root-name is -all- and it is replaced with the actual name, as
       soon as it is known. Only use this part of the context for defining the  formats,  action‐
       formats  or  branchformat  styles,  as it is guaranteed that repo-root-name is set up cor‐
       rectly for these only. For all other styles, just use '*' instead.

       There are two pre-defined values for user-context:
       default
              the one used if none is specified
       command
              used by vcs_info_lastmsg to lookup its styles

       You can of course use ':vcs_info:*' to match all VCSs in all user-contexts at once.

       This is a description of all styles that are looked up.

       formats
              A list of formats, used when actionformats is not used (which is most of the time).

       actionformats
              A list of formats, used if there is a special  action  going  on  in  your  current
              repository; like an interactive rebase or a merge conflict.

       branchformat
              Some backends replace %b in the formats and actionformats styles above, not only by
              a branch name but also by a revision number. This style lets you  modify  how  that
              string should look.

       nvcsformats
              These "formats" are exported when we didn't detect a version control system for the
              current directory or vcs_info was disabled. This is useful if you want vcs_info  to
              completely  take  over  the  generation of your prompt. You would do something like
              PS1='${vcs_info_msg_0_}' to accomplish that.

       hgrevformat
              hg uses both a hash and a revision number to reference a specific  changeset  in  a
              repository.  With  this style you can format the revision string (see branchformat)
              to include either or both. It's only useful when get-revision is  true.  Note,  the
              full  40-character  revision  id is not available (except when using the use-simple
              option) because executing hg more than once per prompt is too slow; you may custom‐
              ize this behavior using hooks.

       max-exports
              Defines the maximum number of vcs_info_msg_*_ variables vcs_info will export.

       enable A  list  of  backends  you want to use. Checked in the -init- context. If this list
              contains an item called NONE no backend is used at all and vcs_info will  do  noth‐
              ing. If this list contains ALL, vcs_info will use all known backends. Only with ALL
              in enable will the disable style have any effect. ALL and NONE  are  case  insensi‐
              tive.

       disable
              A  list  of  VCSs  you don't want vcs_info to test for repositories (checked in the
              -init- context, too). Only used if enable contains ALL.

       disable-patterns
              A list of patterns that are checked against $PWD. If a  pattern  matches,  vcs_info
              will be disabled. This style is checked in the :vcs_info:-init-:*:-all- context.

              Say, ~/.zsh is a directory under version control, in which you do not want vcs_info
              to be active, do:
                     zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable-patterns "$HOME/.zsh(|/*)"

       use-quilt
              If enabled, the quilt support code is active in `addon' mode.   See  Quilt  Support
              for details.

       quilt-standalone
              If enabled, `standalone' mode detection is attempted if no VCS is active in a given
              directory. See Quilt Support for details.

       quilt-patch-dir
              Overwrite the value of the $QUILT_PATCHES environment variable. See  Quilt  Support
              for details.

       quiltcommand
              When quilt itself is called in quilt support the value of this style is used as the
              command name.

       check-for-changes
              If enabled, this style causes the %c and %u format escapes to show when the working
              directory  has  uncommitted  changes. The strings displayed by these escapes can be
              controlled via the stagedstr and unstagedstr styles. The only  backends  that  cur‐
              rently  support  this  option  are  git,  hg,  and bzr (the latter two only support
              unstaged).

              For this style to be evaluated with the hg backend, the get-revision style needs to
              be  set  and the use-simple style needs to be unset. The latter is the default; the
              former is not.

              With the bzr backend, lightweight checkouts only honor this style if the use-server
              style is set.

              Note,  the  actions taken if this style is enabled are potentially expensive (read:
              they may be slow, depending on how big the current repository is).   Therefore,  it
              is disabled by default.

       check-for-staged-changes
              This  style is like check-for-changes, but it never checks the worktree files, only
              the metadata in the .${vcs} dir.  Therefore, this style  initializes  only  the  %c
              escape  (with  stagedstr)  but  not  the  %u  escape.   This  style  is faster than
              check-for-changes.

              In the git backend, this style checks for changes in the index.  Other backends  do
              not currently implement this style.

              This style is disabled by default.

       stagedstr
              This string will be used in the %c escape if there are staged changes in the repos‐
              itory.

       unstagedstr
              This string will be used in the %u escape if there  are  unstaged  changes  in  the
              repository.

       command
              This  style causes vcs_info to use the supplied string as the command to use as the
              VCS's binary. Note, that setting this in ':vcs_info:*' is not a good idea.

              If the value of this style is empty (which is the default), the used binary name is
              the name of the backend in use (e.g. svn is used in an svn repository).

              The  repo-root-name part in the context is always the default -all- when this style
              is looked up.

              For example, this style can be used to use binaries from  non-default  installation
              directories.  Assume,  git  is  installed in /usr/bin but your sysadmin installed a
              newer version in /usr/local/bin. Instead of changing the order of your $PATH param‐
              eter, you can do this:
                     zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*:-all-' command /usr/local/bin/git

       use-server
              This  is  used by the Perforce backend (p4) to decide if it should contact the Per‐
              force server to find out if a directory is managed by Perforce.  This is  the  only
              reliable  way of doing this, but runs the risk of a delay if the server name cannot
              be found.  If the server (more specifically,  the  host:port  pair  describing  the
              server)   cannot  be  contacted,  its  name  is  put  into  the  associative  array
              vcs_info_p4_dead_servers and is not contacted again during the session until it  is
              removed  by  hand.   If you do not set this style, the p4 backend is only usable if
              you have set the environment variable P4CONFIG to a file name and have  correspond‐
              ing  files  in  the  root directories of each Perforce client.  See comments in the
              function VCS_INFO_detect_p4 for more detail.

              The Bazaar backend (bzr) uses this to permit contacting  the  server  about  light‐
              weight checkouts, see the check-for-changes style.

       use-simple
              If  there  are two different ways of gathering information, you can select the sim‐
              pler one by setting this style to true; the default is to use  the  not-that-simple
              code,  which is potentially a lot slower but might be more accurate in all possible
              cases. This style is used by the bzr and hg backends. In the case  of  hg  it  will
              invoke  the  external hexdump program to parse the binary dirstate cache file; this
              method will not return the local revision number.

       get-revision
              If set to true, vcs_info goes the extra mile to figure out the revision of a repos‐
              itory's work tree (currently for the git and hg backends, where this kind of infor‐
              mation is not always vital). For git, the hash value of the currently  checked  out
              commit  is  available  via the %i expansion. With hg, the local revision number and
              the corresponding global hash are available via %i.

       get-mq If set to true, the hg backend will look for a Mercurial Queue  (mq)  patch  direc‐
              tory. Information will be available via the `%m' replacement.

       get-bookmarks
              If  set  to  true, the hg backend will try to get a list of current bookmarks. They
              will be available via the `%m' replacement.

       use-prompt-escapes
              Determines if we assume that the assembled string  from  vcs_info  includes  prompt
              escapes. (Used by vcs_info_lastmsg.)

       debug  Enable  debugging  output  to track possible problems. Currently this style is only
              used by vcs_info's hooks system.

       hooks  A list style that defines hook-function names. See  Hooks  in  vcs_info  below  for
              details.

       The default values for these styles in all contexts are:

       formats
              " (%s)-[%b]%u%c-"
       actionformats
              " (%s)-[%b|%a]%u%c-"
       branchformat
              "%b:%r" (for bzr, svn, svk and hg)
       nvcsformats
              ""
       hgrevformat
              "%r:%h"
       max-exports
              2
       enable ALL
       disable
              (empty list)
       disable-patterns
              (empty list)
       check-for-changes
              false
       check-for-staged-changes
              false
       stagedstr
              (string: "S")
       unstagedstr
              (string: "U")
       command
              (empty string)
       use-server
              false
       use-simple
              false
       get-revision
              false
       get-mq true
       get-bookmarks
              false
       use-prompt-escapes
              true
       debug  false
       hooks  (empty list)
       use-quilt
              false
       quilt-standalone
              false
       quilt-patch-dir
              empty - use $QUILT_PATCHES
       quiltcommand
              quilt

       In normal formats and actionformats the following replacements are done:

       %s     The VCS in use (git, hg, svn, etc.).
       %b     Information about the current branch.
       %a     An identifier that describes the action. Only makes sense in actionformats.
       %i     The current revision number or identifier. For hg the hgrevformat style may be used
              to customize the output.
       %c     The string from the stagedstr style if there are staged changes in the repository.
       %u     The string from the unstagedstr style if there are unstaged changes in the  reposi‐
              tory.
       %R     The base directory of the repository.
       %r     The repository name. If %R is /foo/bar/repoXY, %r is repoXY.
       %S     A  subdirectory  within  a repository. If $PWD is /foo/bar/repoXY/beer/tasty, %S is
              beer/tasty.
       %m     A "misc" replacement. It is at the discretion of the backend to  decide  what  this
              replacement  expands to. It is currently used by the hg and git backends to display
              patch information from the mq and stgit extensions.

       In branchformat these replacements are done:

       %b     The branch name.
       %r     The current revision number or the hgrevformat style for hg.

       In hgrevformat these replacements are done:

       %r     The current local revision number.
       %h     The current global revision identifier.

       In patch-format and nopatch-format these replacements are done:

       %p     The name of the top-most applied patch (applied-string).
       %u     The number of unapplied patches (unapplied-string).
       %n     The number of applied patches.
       %c     The number of unapplied patches.
       %a     The number of all patches.
       %g     The names of active mq guards (hg backend).
       %G     The number of active mq guards (hg backend).

       Not all VCS backends have to support all replacements. For nvcsformats no replacements are
       performed at all, it is just a string.

   Oddities
       If you want to use the %b (bold off) prompt expansion in formats, which expands %b itself,
       use %%b. That will cause the vcs_info expansion to replace %%b  with  %b,  so  that  zsh's
       prompt  expansion  mechanism  can handle it. Similarly, to hand down %b from branchformat,
       use %%%%b. Sorry for this inconvenience, but it cannot be easily avoided.  Luckily  we  do
       not clash with a lot of prompt expansions and this only needs to be done for those.

   Quilt Support
       Quilt  is not a version control system, therefore this is not implemented as a backend. It
       can help keeping track of a series of patches. People use it to keep a set of changes they
       want  to  use  on  top  of software packages (which is tightly integrated into the package
       build process - the Debian project does this for a large number of  packages).  Quilt  can
       also  help  individual  developers  keep track of their own patches on top of real version
       control systems.

       The vcs_info integration tries to support both ways of using quilt by having two  slightly
       different modes of operation: `addon' mode and `standalone' mode).

       For  `addon' mode to become active vcs_info must have already detected a real version con‐
       trol system controlling the directory. If that is the case, a directory that holds quilt's
       patches needs to be found. That directory is configurable via the `QUILT_PATCHES' environ‐
       ment variable. If that variable exists its value is used, otherwise the value `patches' is
       assumed. The value from $QUILT_PATCHES can be overwritten using the `quilt-patches' style.
       (Note: you can use vcs_info to keep the value of $QUILT_PATCHES correct all the  time  via
       the post-quilt hook).

       When  the  directory  in  question is found, quilt is assumed to be active. To gather more
       information, vcs_info looks for a directory called `.pc'; Quilt  uses  that  directory  to
       track  its current state. If this directory does not exist we know that quilt has not done
       anything to the working directory (read: no patches have been applied yet).

       If patches are applied, vcs_info will try to find out which. If you  want  to  know  which
       patches  of  a series are not yet applied, you need to activate the get-unapplied style in
       the appropriate context.

       vcs_info allows for very detailed control over how the gathered information  is  presented
       (see the below sections, Styles and Hooks in vcs_info), all of which are documented below.
       Note there are a number of other patch tracking systems that work on top of a certain ver‐
       sion control system (like stgit for git, or mq for hg); the configuration for systems like
       that are generally configured the same way as the quilt support.

       If the quilt support is working in `addon' mode, the produced string  is  available  as  a
       simple  format replacement (%Q to be precise), which can be used in formats and actionfor‐
       mats; see below for details).

       If, on the other hand, the support code is working in  `standalone'  mode,  vcs_info  will
       pretend  as  if  quilt  were an actual version control system. That means that the version
       control system identifier (which otherwise would be something like `svn' or `cvs') will be
       set to `-quilt-'. This has implications on the used style context where this identifier is
       the second element. vcs_info will have filled in a proper  value  for  the  "repository's"
       root  directory  and  the  string  containing  the information about quilt's state will be
       available as the `misc' replacement (and %Q for compatibility with `addon' mode.

       What is left to discuss is how `standalone' mode is detected. The detection  itself  is  a
       series  of  searches  for directories. You can have this detection enabled all the time in
       every directory that is not otherwise under version control. If you know there is  only  a
       limited  set  of  trees where you would like vcs_info to try and look for Quilt in `stand‐
       alone' mode to minimise the amount of searching on every call to  vcs_info,  there  are  a
       number of ways to do that:

       Essentially,  `standalone'  mode  detection  is controlled by a style called `quilt-stand‐
       alone'. It is a string style and its value can have different effects. The simplest values
       are:  `always' to run detection every time vcs_info is run, and `never' to turn the detec‐
       tion off entirely.

       If the value of quilt-standalone is something else, it is interpreted differently. If  the
       value  is  the  name  of  a scalar variable the value of that variable is checked and that
       value is used in the same `always'/`never' way as described above.

       If the value of quilt-standalone is an array, the elements  of  that  array  are  used  as
       directory names under which you want the detection to be active.

       If  quilt-standalone  is an associative array, the keys are taken as directory names under
       which you want the detection to be active, but only if  the  corresponding  value  is  the
       string `true'.

       Last, but not least, if the value of quilt-standalone is the name of a function, the func‐
       tion is called without arguments and the return value decides whether detection should  be
       active. A `0' return value is true; a non-zero return value is interpreted as false.

       Note,  if  there  is  both  a function and a variable by the name of quilt-standalone, the
       function will take precedence.

   Function Descriptions (Public API)
       vcs_info [user-context]
              The  main  function,  that  runs  all  backends  and  assembles   all   data   into
              ${vcs_info_msg_*_}.  This  is the function you want to call from precmd if you want
              to include up-to-date information in your prompt (see Variable description  below).
              If  an  argument  is  given,  that  string  will  be used instead of default in the
              user-context field of the style context.

       vcs_info_hookadd
              Statically registers a number of functions to a given hook. The hook  needs  to  be
              given  as the first argument; what follows is a list of hook-function names to reg‐
              ister to the hook. The `+vi-' prefix needs to  be  left  out  here.  See  Hooks  in
              vcs_info below for details.

       vcs_info_hookdel
              Remove  hook-functions  from  a given hook. The hook needs to be given as the first
              non-option argument; what follows is a list of hook-function names  to  un-register
              from  the hook. If `-a' is used as the first argument, all occurrences of the func‐
              tions are unregistered. Otherwise only the last occurrence is removed (if  a  func‐
              tion  was registered to a hook more than once) . The `+vi-' prefix needs to be left
              out here. See Hooks in vcs_info below for details.

       vcs_info_lastmsg
              Outputs the last ${vcs_info_msg_*_} value.  Takes into account  the  value  of  the
              use-prompt-escapes  style in ':vcs_info:formats:command:-all-'. It also only prints
              max-exports values.

       vcs_info_printsys [user-context]
              Prints a list of all supported version control systems. Useful to find out possible
              contexts (and which of them are enabled) or values for the disable style.

       vcs_info_setsys
              Initializes vcs_info's internal list of available backends. With this function, you
              can add support for new VCSs without restarting the shell.

       All functions named VCS_INFO_* are for internal use only.

   Variable Description
       ${vcs_info_msg_N_} (Note the trailing underscore)
              Where N is an integer, e.g., vcs_info_msg_0_. These variables are the  storage  for
              the  informational message the last vcs_info call has assembled. These are strongly
              connected to the formats, actionformats and  nvcsformats  styles  described  above.
              Those  styles  are  lists.  The  first  member  of  that  list  gets  expanded into
              ${vcs_info_msg_0_},  the  second  into  ${vcs_info_msg_1_}   and   the   Nth   into
              ${vcs_info_msg_N-1_}.  These parameters are exported into the environment. (See the
              max-exports style above.)

       All variables named VCS_INFO_* are for internal use only.

   Hooks in vcs_info
       Hooks are places in vcs_info where you can run your own code. That  code  can  communicate
       with the code that called it and through that, change the system's behaviour.

       For configuration, hooks change the style context:
              :vcs_info:vcs-string+hook-name:user-context:repo-root-name

       To register functions to a hook, you need to list them in the hooks style in the appropri‐
       ate context.

       Example:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*+foo:*' hooks bar baz

       This registers functions to the hook `foo' for all backends. In order to  avoid  namespace
       problems, all registered function names are prepended by a `+vi-', so the actual functions
       called for the `foo' hook are `+vi-bar' and `+vi-baz'.

       If you would like to register a function to a hook regardless of the current context,  you
       may  use the vcs_info_hookadd function. To remove a function that was added like that, the
       vcs_info_hookdel function can be used.

       If something seems weird, you can enable the `debug' boolean style in the  proper  context
       and  the hook-calling code will print what it tried to execute and whether the function in
       question existed.

       When you register more than one function to a hook, all functions are executed  one  after
       another  until one function returns non-zero or until all functions have been called. Con‐
       text-sensitive hook functions are executed before statically  registered  ones  (the  ones
       added by vcs_info_hookadd).

       You may pass data between functions via an associative array, user_data.  For example:
              +vi-git-myfirsthook(){
                  user_data[myval]=$myval
              }
              +vi-git-mysecondhook(){
                  # do something with ${user_data[myval]}
              }

       There are a number of variables that are special in hook contexts:

       ret    The return value that the hooks system will return to the caller. The default is an
              integer `zero'. If and how a changed ret value changes the execution of the  caller
              depends on the specific hook. See the hook documentation below for details.

       hook_com
              An  associated  array which is used for bidirectional communication from the caller
              to hook functions. The used keys depend on the specific hook.

       context
              The active context of the hook. Functions that wish to change this variable  should
              make it local scope first.

       vcs    The  current  VCS  after  it was detected. The same values as in the enable/disable
              style are used. Available in all hooks except start-up.

       Finally, the full list of currently available hooks:

       start-up
              Called after starting vcs_info but before the VCS in this directory is  determined.
              It  can be used to deactivate vcs_info temporarily if necessary. When ret is set to
              1, vcs_info aborts and does nothing; when set to 2, vcs_info sets up everything  as
              if no version control were active and exits.

       pre-get-data
              Same as start-up but after the VCS was detected.

       gen-hg-bookmark-string
              Called  in the Mercurial backend when a bookmark string is generated; the get-revi‐
              sion and get-bookmarks styles must be true.

              This hook gets the names of the Mercurial bookmarks that  vcs_info  collected  from
              `hg'.

              When setting ret to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[hg-bookmark-string]} will be
              used in the %m escape in formats and actionformats and will  be  available  in  the
              global backend_misc array as ${backend_misc[bookmarks]}.

       gen-applied-string
              Called  in  the git (with stgit or during rebase), and hg (with mq) backends and in
              quilt support when the applied-string is generated; the use-quilt  zstyle  must  be
              true for quilt (the mq and stgit backends are active by default).

              This  hook gets the names of all applied patches which vcs_info collected so far in
              the opposite order, which means that the first argument is the top-most  patch  and
              so forth.

              When  setting  ret  to  non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[applied-string]} will be
              used in the %m escape in formats and actionformats; it will  be  available  in  the
              global  backend_misc  array as $backend_misc[patches]}; and it will be available as
              %p in the patch-format and nopatch-format styles.

       gen-unapplied-string
              Called in the git (with stgit or during rebase), and hg (with mq)  backend  and  in
              quilt  support when the unapplied-string is generated; the get-unapplied style must
              be true.

              This hook gets the names of all unapplied patches which vcs_info collected  so  far
              in the opposite order, which mean that the first argument is the patch next-in-line
              to be applied and so forth.

              When setting ret to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[unapplied-string]}  will  be
              available as %u in the patch-format and nopatch-format styles.

       gen-mqguards-string
              Called  in the hg backend when guards-string is generated; the get-mq style must be
              true (default).

              This hook gets the names of any active mq guards.

              When setting ret to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[guards-string]} will be used
              in the %g escape in the patch-format and nopatch-format styles.

       no-vcs This hooks is called when no version control system was detected.

              The `hook_com' parameter is not used.

       post-backend
              Called as soon as the backend has finished collecting information.

              The `hook_com' keys available are as for the set-message hook.

       post-quilt
              Called  after  the  quilt  support  is done. The following information is passed as
              arguments to the hook: 1. the quilt-support mode (`addon' or `standalone'); 2.  the
              directory  that contains the patch series; 3. the directory that holds quilt's sta‐
              tus information (the `.pc' directory) or the  string  "-nopc-"  if  that  directory
              wasn't found.

              The `hook_com' parameter is not used.

       set-branch-format
              Called  before  `branchformat'  is set. The only argument to the hook is the format
              that is configured at this point.

              The `hook_com' keys considered are `branch' and `revision'.  They are  set  to  the
              values figured out so far by vcs_info and any change will be used directly when the
              actual replacement is done.

              If ret is set to non-zero, the string in ${hook_com[branch-replace]} will  be  used
              unchanged as the `%b' replacement in the variables set by vcs_info.

       set-hgrev-format
              Called  before  a `hgrevformat' is set. The only argument to the hook is the format
              that is configured at this point.

              The `hook_com' keys considered are `hash' and `localrev'.  They are set to the val‐
              ues  figured  out  so far by vcs_info and any change will be used directly when the
              actual replacement is done.

              If ret is set to non-zero, the string  in  ${hook_com[rev-replace]}  will  be  used
              unchanged as the `%i' replacement in the variables set by vcs_info.

       set-message
              Called  each  time  before  a `vcs_info_msg_N_' message is set.  It takes two argu‐
              ments; the first being the `N' in the message variable name, the second is the cur‐
              rently configured formats or actionformats.

              There  are  a  number  of  `hook_com' keys, that are used here: `action', `branch',
              `base', `base-name', `subdir', `staged', `unstaged', `revision', `misc', `vcs'  and
              one  `miscN'  entry for each backend-specific data field (N starting at zero). They
              are set to the values figured out so far by vcs_info and any change  will  be  used
              directly when the actual replacement is done.

              Since  this  hook  is triggered multiple times (once for each configured formats or
              actionformats), each of the `hook_com' keys mentioned above (except for  the  miscN
              entries)  has an `_orig' counterpart, so even if you changed a value to your liking
              you can still get the original value in the next run. Changing the  `_orig'  values
              is probably not a good idea.

              If  ret  is  set  to  non-zero,  the  string  in  ${hook_com[message]} will be used
              unchanged as the message by vcs_info.

       If all of this sounds rather confusing, take a look at the Examples section below and also
       in the Misc/vcs_info-examples file in the Zsh source.  They contain some explanatory code.

   Examples
       Don't use vcs_info at all (even though it's in your prompt):
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable NONE

       Disable the backends for bzr and svk:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' disable bzr svk

       Disable everything but bzr and svk:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*' enable bzr svk

       Provide a special formats for git:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*' formats       ' GIT, BABY! [%b]'
              zstyle ':vcs_info:git:*' actionformats ' GIT ACTION! [%b|%a]'

       All  %x  expansion  in all sorts of formats ("formats", "actionformats", branchformat, you
       name it) are done using the `zformat' builtin from the `zsh/zutil' module. That means  you
       can  do  everything  with these %x items what zformat supports. In particular, if you want
       something that is really long to have a fixed width, like a hash in a mercurial branchfor‐
       mat,  you  can  do  this:  %12.12i. That'll shrink the 40 character hash to its 12 leading
       characters. The form is actually `%min.maxx'. More is  possible.   See  the  section  `The
       zsh/zutil Module' in zshmodules(1) for details.

       Use the quicker bzr backend
              zstyle ':vcs_info:bzr:*' use-simple true

       If you do use use-simple, please report if it does `the-right-thing[tm]'.

       Display the revision number in yellow for bzr and svn:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:(svn|bzr):*' branchformat '%b%{'${fg[yellow]}'%}:%r'

       If  you  want  colors, make sure you enclose the color codes in %{...%} if you want to use
       the string provided by vcs_info in prompts.

       Here is how to print the VCS information as a command (not in a prompt):
              alias vcsi='vcs_info command; vcs_info_lastmsg'

       This way, you can even define different formats for output  via  vcs_info_lastmsg  in  the
       ':vcs_info:*:command:*' namespace.

       Now as promised, some code that uses hooks: say, you'd like to replace the string `svn' by
       `subversion' in vcs_info's %s formats replacement.

       First, we will tell vcs_info to call a function when populating the message variables with
       the gathered information:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*+set-message:*' hooks svn2subversion

       Nothing  happens.  Which is reasonable, since we didn't define the actual function yet. To
       see what the hooks subsystem is trying to do, enable the `debug' style:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*+*:*' debug true

       That should give you an idea what is going on. Specifically,  the  function  that  we  are
       looking  for is `+vi-svn2subversion'. Note, the `+vi-' prefix. So, everything is in order,
       just as documented. When you are done checking out the debugging output, disable it again:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:*+*:*' debug false

       Now, let's define the function:
              function +vi-svn2subversion() {
                  [[ ${hook_com[vcs_orig]} == svn ]] && hook_com[vcs]=subversion
              }

       Simple enough. And it could have even been simpler, if only we had registered our function
       in  a less generic context. If we do it only in the `svn' backend's context, we don't need
       to test which the active backend is:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:svn+set-message:*' hooks svn2subversion
              function +vi-svn2subversion() {
                  hook_com[vcs]=subversion
              }

       And finally a little more elaborate example, that uses a hook to create a customised book‐
       mark string for the hg backend.

       Again, we start off by registering a function:
              zstyle ':vcs_info:hg+gen-hg-bookmark-string:*' hooks hgbookmarks

       And then we define the `+vi-hgbookmarks function:
              function +vi-hgbookmarks() {
                  # The default is to connect all bookmark names by
                  # commas. This mixes things up a little.
                  # Imagine, there's one type of bookmarks that is
                  # special to you. Say, because it's *your* work.
                  # Those bookmarks look always like this: "sh/*"
                  # (because your initials are sh, for example).
                  # This makes the bookmarks string use only those
                  # bookmarks. If there's more than one, it
                  # concatenates them using commas.
                  # The bookmarks returned by `hg' are available in
                  # the function's positional parameters.
                  local s="${(Mj:,:)@:#sh/*}"
                  # Now, the communication with the code that calls
                  # the hook functions is done via the hook_com[]
                  # hash. The key at which the `gen-hg-bookmark-string'
                  # hook looks is `hg-bookmark-string'. So:
                  hook_com[hg-bookmark-string]=$s
                  # And to signal that we want to use the string we
                  # just generated, set the special variable `ret' to
                  # something other than the default zero:
                  ret=1
                  return 0
              }

       Some longer examples and code snippets which might be useful are available in the examples
       file located at Misc/vcs_info-examples in the Zsh source directory.

       This concludes our guided tour through zsh's vcs_info.

PROMPT THEMES
   Installation
       You should make sure all the functions from the Functions/Prompts directory of the  source
       distribution  are  available; they all begin with the string `prompt_' except for the spe‐
       cial function`promptinit'.  You also need the `colors' function from Functions/Misc.   All
       of  these  functions may already have been installed on your system; if not, you will need
       to find them and copy them.  The directory should appear as one of  the  elements  of  the
       fpath  array  (this  should  already be the case if they were installed), and at least the
       function promptinit should be autoloaded; it will autoload the rest.  Finally, to initial‐
       ize the use of the system you need to call the promptinit function.  The following code in
       your .zshrc will arrange for this; assume  the  functions  are  stored  in  the  directory
       ~/myfns:

              fpath=(~/myfns $fpath)
              autoload -U promptinit
              promptinit

   Theme Selection
       Use  the prompt command to select your preferred theme.  This command may be added to your
       .zshrc following the call to promptinit in  order  to  start  zsh  with  a  theme  already
       selected.

       prompt [ -c | -l ]
       prompt [ -p | -h ] [ theme ... ]
       prompt [ -s ] theme [ arg ... ]
              Set  or  examine the prompt theme.  With no options and a theme argument, the theme
              with that name is set as the current theme.  The available themes are determined at
              run  time;  use the -l option to see a list.  The special theme `random' selects at
              random one of the available themes and sets your prompt to that.

              In some cases the theme may be modified by one or more arguments, which  should  be
              given  after the theme name.  See the help for each theme for descriptions of these
              arguments.

              Options are:

              -c     Show the currently selected theme and its parameters, if any.
              -l     List all available prompt themes.
              -p     Preview the theme named by theme, or all themes if no theme is given.
              -h     Show help for the theme named by theme, or for the  prompt  function  if  no
                     theme is given.
              -s     Set theme as the current theme and save state.

       prompt_theme_setup
              Each available theme has a setup function which is called by the prompt function to
              install that theme.  This function may define other functions as necessary to main‐
              tain the prompt, including functions used to preview the prompt or provide help for
              its use.  You should not normally call a theme's setup function directly.

ZLE FUNCTIONS
   Widgets
       These functions all implement user-defined ZLE widgets (see zshzle(1)) which can be  bound
       to keystrokes in interactive shells.  To use them, your .zshrc should contain lines of the
       form

              autoload function
              zle -N function

       followed by an appropriate bindkey command to associate the function with a key  sequence.
       Suggested bindings are described below.

       bash-style word functions
              If  you are looking for functions to implement moving over and editing words in the
              manner of bash, where only alphanumeric characters are considered word  characters,
              you  can  use the functions described in the next section.  The following is suffi‐
              cient:

                     autoload -U select-word-style
                     select-word-style bash

       forward-word-match, backward-word-match
       kill-word-match, backward-kill-word-match
       transpose-words-match, capitalize-word-match
       up-case-word-match, down-case-word-match
       select-word-style, match-word-context, match-words-by-style
              The eight `-match' functions are drop-in replacements for the builtin widgets with‐
              out  the  suffix.  By default they behave in a similar way.  However, by the use of
              styles and the function  select-word-style,  the  way  words  are  matched  can  be
              altered.

              The  simplest  way  of configuring the functions is to use select-word-style, which
              can either be called as a normal function with the appropriate argument, or invoked
              as a user-defined widget that will prompt for the first character of the word style
              to be used.  The first time it is invoked, the eight -match functions will automat‐
              ically replace the builtin versions, so they do not need to be loaded explicitly.

              The word styles available are as follows.  Only the first character is examined.

              bash   Word characters are alphanumeric characters only.

              normal As  in  normal shell operation:  word characters are alphanumeric characters
                     plus any characters present in the string given by the parameter $WORDCHARS.

              shell  Words are complete shell  command  arguments,  possibly  including  complete
                     quoted strings, or any tokens special to the shell.

              whitespace
                     Words are any set of characters delimited by whitespace.

              default
                     Restore the default settings; this is usually the same as `normal'.

              All  but  `default'  can  be  input  as an upper case character, which has the same
              effect but with subword matching turned on.  In this case, words  with  upper  case
              characters are treated specially: each separate run of upper case characters, or an
              upper case character followed by any number of other characters,  is  considered  a
              word.   The  style  subword-range  can supply an alternative character range to the
              default `[:upper:]'; the value of the style is treated as the contents of a `[...]'
              pattern  (note that the outer brackets should not be supplied, only those surround‐
              ing named ranges).

              More control can be obtained using the zstyle  command,  as  described  in  zshmod‐
              ules(1).   Each  style  is looked up in the context :zle:widget where widget is the
              name of the user-defined widget, not the name of the function implementing  it,  so
              in  the  case of the definitions supplied by select-word-style the appropriate con‐
              texts are :zle:forward-word, and so  on.   The  function  select-word-style  itself
              always defines styles for the context `:zle:*' which can be overridden by more spe‐
              cific (longer) patterns as well as explicit contexts.

              The style word-style specifies the rules to use.  This may have the following  val‐
              ues.

              normal Use  the  standard  shell  rules,  i.e. alphanumerics and $WORDCHARS, unless
                     overridden by the styles word-chars or word-class.

              specified
                     Similar to normal, but only the specified characters, and not also  alphanu‐
                     merics, are considered word characters.

              unspecified
                     The negation of specified.  The given characters are those which will not be
                     considered part of a word.

              shell  Words are obtained by using the syntactic rules for generating shell command
                     arguments.   In  addition,  special tokens which are never command arguments
                     such as `()' are also treated as words.

              whitespace
                     Words are whitespace-delimited strings of characters.

              The first three of those rules usually use $WORDCHARS, but the value in the parame‐
              ter  can be overridden by the style word-chars, which works in exactly the same way
              as $WORDCHARS.  In addition, the style word-class uses character  class  syntax  to
              group  characters  and  takes  precedence  over  word-chars  if  both are set.  The
              word-class style does not include the surrounding brackets of the character  class;
              for  example, `-:[:alnum:]' is a valid word-class to include all alphanumerics plus
              the characters `-' and `:'.  Be careful including `]', `^' and  `-'  as  these  are
              special inside character classes.

              word-style may also have `-subword' appended to its value to turn on subword match‐
              ing, as described above.

              The style skip-chars is mostly useful for transpose-words  and  similar  functions.
              If  set,  it gives a count of characters starting at the cursor position which will
              not be considered part of the word and are treated as  space,  regardless  of  what
              they actually are.  For example, if

                     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words' skip-chars 1

              has  been  set,  and  transpose-words-match  is  called with the cursor on the X of
              fooXbar, where X can be any character, then the resulting expression is barXfoo.

              Finer grained control can be obtained by setting the style word-context to an array
              of  pairs of entries.  Each pair of entries consists of a pattern and a subcontext.
              The shell argument the cursor is on is matched against each pattern in  turn  until
              one  matches;  if it does, the context is extended by a colon and the corresponding
              subcontext.  Note that the test is made against the original word on the line, with
              no  stripping  of quotes.  Special handling is done between words: the current con‐
              text is examined and if it contains the string back, the word before the cursor  is
              considered,  else  the  word  after  cursor  is considered. Some examples are given
              below.

              The style skip-whitespace-first is only used with the forward-word widget.   If  it
              is  set  to  true, then forward-word skips any non-word-characters, followed by any
              non-word-characters: this is similar to the behaviour of other word-orientated wid‐
              gets, and also that used by other editors, however it differs from the standard zsh
              behaviour.  When using select-word-style the widget is set in the context :zle:* to
              true  if  the word style is bash and false otherwise.  It may be overridden by set‐
              ting it in the more specific context :zle:forward-word*.

              Here are some examples of use of the styles, actually  taken  from  the  simplified
              interface in select-word-style:

                     zstyle ':zle:*' word-style standard
                     zstyle ':zle:*' word-chars ''

              Implements  bash-style  word  handling for all widgets, i.e. only alphanumerics are
              word characters; equivalent to setting the parameter WORDCHARS empty for the  given
              context.

                     style ':zle:*kill*' word-style space

              Uses  space-delimited  words for widgets with the word `kill' in the name.  Neither
              of the styles word-chars nor word-class is used in this case.

              Here are some examples of use of the word-context style to extend the context.

                     zstyle ':zle:*' word-context "*/*" file "[[:space:]]" whitespace
                     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:whitespace' word-style shell
                     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:filename' word-style normal
                     zstyle ':zle:transpose-words:filename' word-chars ''

              This provides two different ways of using transpose-words depending on whether  the
              cursor  is on whitespace between words or on a filename, here any word containing a
              /.  On whitespace, complete arguments as defined by standard shell  rules  will  be
              transposed.   In  a  filename,  only  alphanumerics will be transposed.  Elsewhere,
              words will be transposed using the default style for :zle:transpose-words.

              The word matching and all the handling of zstyle settings is  actually  implemented
              by  the function match-words-by-style.  This can be used to create new user-defined
              widgets.  The calling  function  should  set  the  local  parameter  curcontext  to
              :zle:widget, create the local parameter matched_words and call match-words-by-style
              with no arguments.  On return, matched_words will be set to an array with the  ele‐
              ments:  (1)  the  start of the line (2) the word before the cursor (3) any non-word
              characters between that word and the cursor (4) any non-word character at the  cur‐
              sor position plus any remaining non-word characters before the next word, including
              all characters specified by the skip-chars style, (5) the word at or following  the
              cursor  (6)  any  non-word  characters following that word (7) the remainder of the
              line.  Any of the elements may be an empty string; the calling function should test
              for this to decide whether it can perform its function.

              It  is  possible to pass options with arguments to match-words-by-style to override
              the use of styles.  The options are:
              -w     word-style
              -s     skip-chars
              -c     word-class
              -C     word-chars
              -r     subword-range

              For example, match-words-by-style -w shell -c 0 may be used to extract the  command
              argument around the cursor.

              The  word-context  style  is  implemented by the function match-word-context.  This
              should not usually need to be called directly.

       copy-earlier-word
              This widget works like a combination of insert-last-word and  copy-prev-shell-word.
              Repeated  invocations  of the widget retrieve earlier words on the relevant history
              line.  With a numeric argument N, insert the Nth word from the history line; N  may
              be negative to count from the end of the line.

              If  insert-last-word  has been used to retrieve the last word on a previous history
              line, repeated invocations will replace that word with earlier words from the  same
              line.

              Otherwise,  the  widget  applies  to words on the line currently being edited.  The
              widget style can be set to the name of another widget  that  should  be  called  to
              retrieve   words.    This   widget   must   accept  the  same  three  arguments  as
              insert-last-word.

       cycle-completion-positions
              After inserting an unambiguous string into the command line, the new function based
              completion  system  may  know about multiple places in this string where characters
              are missing or differ from at least one of the  possible  matches.   It  will  then
              place  the cursor on the position it considers to be the most interesting one, i.e.
              the one where one can disambiguate between as many matches as possible with as lit‐
              tle typing as possible.

              This  widget  allows  the cursor to be easily moved to the other interesting spots.
              It can be invoked repeatedly to cycle between all positions reported by the comple‐
              tion system.

       delete-whole-word-match
              This  is  another  function which works like the -match functions described immedi‐
              ately above, i.e. using styles to decide the word boundaries.  However, it is not a
              replacement for any existing function.

              The  basic  behaviour is to delete the word around the cursor.  There is no numeric
              prefix handling; only the single word around the cursor is considered.  If the wid‐
              get  contains the string kill, the removed text will be placed in the cutbuffer for
              future yanking.  This can be obtained by defining kill-whole-word-match as follows:

                     zle -N kill-whole-word-match delete-whole-word-match

              and then binding the widget kill-whole-word-match.

       up-line-or-beginning-search, down-line-or-beginning-search
              These  widgets  are  similar  to  the  builtin  functions   up-line-or-search   and
              down-line-or-search:  if in a multiline buffer they move up or down within the buf‐
              fer, otherwise they search for a history line matching the  start  of  the  current
              line.  In this case, however, they search for a line which matches the current line
              up to the current cursor position, in the manner of  history-beginning-search-back‐
              ward and -forward, rather than the first word on the line.

       edit-command-line
              Edit the command line using your visual editor, as in ksh.

                     bindkey -M vicmd v edit-command-line

       expand-absolute-path
              Expand  the  file  name  under  the  cursor to an absolute path, resolving symbolic
              links.  Where possible, the initial path segment is turned into a  named  directory
              or reference to a user's home directory.

       history-search-end
              This function implements the widgets history-beginning-search-backward-end and his‐
              tory-beginning-search-forward-end.  These commands work by first calling the corre‐
              sponding  builtin  widget  (see `History Control' in zshzle(1)) and then moving the
              cursor to the end of the line.  The original  cursor  position  is  remembered  and
              restored  before  calling the builtin widget a second time, so that the same search
              is repeated to look farther through the history.

              Although you autoload only one function, the commands to use it are  slightly  dif‐
              ferent because it implements two widgets.

                     zle -N history-beginning-search-backward-end \
                            history-search-end
                     zle -N history-beginning-search-forward-end \
                            history-search-end
                     bindkey '\e^P' history-beginning-search-backward-end
                     bindkey '\e^N' history-beginning-search-forward-end

       history-beginning-search-menu
              This  function  implements  yet another form of history searching.  The text before
              the cursor is used  to  select  lines  from  the  history,  as  for  history-begin‐
              ning-search-backward  except that all matches are shown in a numbered menu.  Typing
              the appropriate digits inserts the full history line.   Note  that  leading  zeroes
              must  be  typed  (they  are only shown when necessary for removing ambiguity).  The
              entire history is searched; there is no distinction between forwards and backwards.

              With a prefix argument, the search is not anchored to the start of  the  line;  the
              string typed by the use may appear anywhere in the line in the history.

              If  the  widget  name  contains  `-end'  the cursor is moved to the end of the line
              inserted.  If the widget name contains `-space' any space  in  the  text  typed  is
              treated  as  a wildcard and can match anything (hence a leading space is equivalent
              to giving a prefix argument).  Both forms can be combined, for example:

                     zle -N history-beginning-search-menu-space-end \
                            history-beginning-search-menu

       history-pattern-search
              The function history-pattern-search implements widgets which prompt for  a  pattern
              with  which  to  search  the  history backwards or forwards.  The pattern is in the
              usual zsh format, however the first character may be ^ to anchor the search to  the
              start  of the line, and the last character may be $ to anchor the search to the end
              of the line.  If the search was not anchored to the end of the line the  cursor  is
              positioned just after the pattern found.

              The commands to create bindable widgets are similar to those in the example immedi‐
              ately above:

                     autoload -U history-pattern-search
                     zle -N history-pattern-search-backward history-pattern-search
                     zle -N history-pattern-search-forward history-pattern-search

       incarg Typing the keystrokes for this widget with the cursor placed on or to the  left  of
              an  integer  causes  that  integer to be incremented by one.  With a numeric prefix
              argument, the number is incremented by the amount of the argument  (decremented  if
              the  prefix argument is negative).  The shell parameter incarg may be set to change
              the default increment to something other than one.

                     bindkey '^X+' incarg

       incremental-complete-word
              This allows incremental completion of a word.  After starting this command, a  list
              of  completion  choices  can be shown after every character you type, which you can
              delete with ^H or DEL.  Pressing return accepts the completion so far  and  returns
              you to normal editing (that is, the command line is not immediately executed).  You
              can hit TAB to do normal completion, ^G  to  abort  back  to  the  state  when  you
              started, and ^D to list the matches.

              This works only with the new function based completion system.

                     bindkey '^Xi' incremental-complete-word

       insert-composed-char
              This function allows you to compose characters that don't appear on the keyboard to
              be inserted into the command line.  The command is followed by two keys correspond‐
              ing  to  ASCII  characters  (there is no prompt).  For accented characters, the two
              keys are a base character followed by a code for the accent, while for  other  spe‐
              cial characters the two characters together form a mnemonic for the character to be
              inserted.  The two-character codes are a subset of those given by RFC 1345 (see for
              example http://www.faqs.org/rfcs/rfc1345.html).

              The  function  may optionally be followed by up to two characters which replace one
              or both of the characters read from the keyboard; if both characters are  supplied,
              no input is read.  For example, insert-composed-char a: can be used within a widget
              to insert an a with umlaut into the command line.  This has the advantages over use
              of a literal character that it is more portable.

              For  best  results zsh should have been built with support for multibyte characters
              (configured with --enable-multibyte); however, the function works for  the  limited
              range of characters available in single-byte character sets such as ISO-8859-1.

              The character is converted into the local representation and inserted into the com‐
              mand line at the cursor position.  (The conversion is done within the shell,  using
              whatever  facilities the C library provides.)  With a numeric argument, the charac‐
              ter and its code are previewed in the status line

              The function may be run outside zle in which case it prints the character (together
              with a newline) to standard output.  Input is still read from keystrokes.

              See  insert-unicode-char  for  an  alternative  way of inserting Unicode characters
              using their hexadecimal character number.

              The set of accented characters is  reasonably  complete  up  to  Unicode  character
              U+0180,  the  set of special characters less so.  However, it is very sporadic from
              that point.  Adding new characters is easy, however; see the  function  define-com‐
              posed-chars.  Please send any additions to zsh-workers AT zsh.org.

              The  codes  for  the second character when used to accent the first are as follows.
              Note that not every character can take every accent.
              !      Grave.
              '      Acute.
              >      Circumflex.
              ?      Tilde.  (This is not ~ as RFC 1345 does not assume that character is present
                     on the keyboard.)
              -      Macron.  (A horizontal bar over the base character.)
              (      Breve.  (A shallow dish shape over the base character.)
              .      Dot  above the base character, or in the case of i no dot, or in the case of
                     L and l a centered dot.
              :      Diaeresis (Umlaut).
              c      Cedilla.
              _      Underline, however there are currently no underlined characters.
              /      Stroke through the base character.
              "      Double acute (only supported on a few letters).
              ;      Ogonek.  (A little forward facing hook at the bottom right  of  the  charac‐
                     ter.)
              <      Caron.  (A little v over the letter.)
              0      Circle over the base character.
              2      Hook over the base character.
              9      Horn over the base character.

              The  most  common  characters from the Arabic, Cyrillic, Greek and Hebrew alphabets
              are available; consult RFC 1345 for the appropriate sequences.  In addition, a  set
              of  two  letter codes not in RFC 1345 are available for the double-width characters
              corresponding to ASCII characters from !  to ~ (0x21  to  0x7e)  by  preceding  the
              character with ^, for example ^A for a double-width A.

              The following other two-character sequences are understood.

              ASCII characters
                     These are already present on most keyboards:
              <(     Left square bracket
              //     Backslash (solidus)
              )>     Right square bracket
              (!     Left brace (curly bracket)
              !!     Vertical bar (pipe symbol)
              !)     Right brace (curly bracket)
              '?     Tilde

              Special letters
                     Characters found in various variants of the Latin alphabet:
              ss     Eszett (scharfes S)
              D-, d- Eth
              TH, th Thorn
              kk     Kra
              'n     'n
              NG, ng Ng
              OI, oi Oi
              yr     yr
              ED     ezh

              Currency symbols
              Ct     Cent
              Pd     Pound sterling (also lira and others)
              Cu     Currency
              Ye     Yen
              Eu     Euro (N.B. not in RFC 1345)

              Punctuation characters
                     References  to  "right"  quotes  indicate the shape (like a 9 rather than 6)
                     rather than their grammatical use.  (For example, a "right" low double quote
                     is used to open quotations in German.)
              !I     Inverted exclamation mark
              BB     Broken vertical bar
              SE     Section
              Co     Copyright
              -a     Spanish feminine ordinal indicator
              <<     Left guillemet
              --     Soft hyphen
              Rg     Registered trade mark
              PI     Pilcrow (paragraph)
              -o     Spanish masculine ordinal indicator
              >>     Right guillemet
              ?I     Inverted question mark
              -1     Hyphen
              -N     En dash
              -M     Em dash
              -3     Horizontal bar
              :3     Vertical ellipsis
              .3     Horizontal midline ellipsis
              !2     Double vertical line
              =2     Double low line
              '6     Left single quote
              '9     Right single quote
              .9     "Right" low quote
              9'     Reversed "right" quote
              "6     Left double quote
              "9     Right double quote
              :9     "Right" low double quote
              9"     Reversed "right" double quote
              /-     Dagger
              /=     Double dagger

              Mathematical symbols
              DG     Degree
              -2, +-, -+
                     - sign, +/- sign, -/+ sign
              2S     Superscript 2
              3S     Superscript 3
              1S     Superscript 1
              My     Micro
              .M     Middle dot
              14     Quarter
              12     Half
              34     Three quarters
              *X     Multiplication
              -:     Division
              %0     Per mille
              FA, TE, /0
                     For all, there exists, empty set
              dP, DE, NB
                     Partial derivative, delta (increment), del (nabla)
              (-, -) Element of, contains
              *P, +Z Product, sum
              *-, Ob, Sb
                     Asterisk, ring, bullet
              RT, 0(, 00
                     Root sign, proportional to, infinity

              Other symbols
              cS, cH, cD, cC
                     Card suits: spades, hearts, diamonds, clubs
              Md, M8, M2, Mb, Mx, MX
                     Musical notation: crotchet (quarter note), quaver (eighth note), semiquavers
                     (sixteenth notes), flag sign, natural sign, sharp sign
              Fm, Ml Female, male

              Accents on their own
              '>     Circumflex (same as caret, ^)
              '!     Grave (same as backtick, `)
              ',     Cedilla
              ':     Diaeresis (Umlaut)
              'm     Macron
              ''     Acute

       insert-files
              This function allows you type a file pattern, and see the results of the  expansion
              at  each  step.   When you hit return, all expansions are inserted into the command
              line.

                     bindkey '^Xf' insert-files

       insert-unicode-char
              When first executed, the user inputs a set of hexadecimal digits.  This  is  termi‐
              nated  with  another  call to insert-unicode-char.  The digits are then turned into
              the corresponding Unicode character.  For example, if the widget is bound  to  ^XU,
              the character sequence `^XU 4 c ^XU' inserts L (Unicode U+004c).

              See  insert-composed-char  for  a way of inserting characters using a two-character
              mnemonic.

       narrow-to-region [ -p pre ] [ -P post ]
           [ -S statepm | -R statepm ] [ -n ] [ start end ])
       narrow-to-region-invisible
              Narrow the editable portion of the buffer to the region between the cursor and  the
              mark, which may be in either order.  The region may not be empty.

              narrow-to-region  may  be  used  as  a  widget  or  called  as  a  function  from a
              user-defined widget; by default, the text outside the editable area  remains  visi‐
              ble.   A  recursive-edit  is  performed  and  the  original widening status is then
              restored.  Various options and arguments are available when it is called as a func‐
              tion.

              The  options  -p pretext and -P posttext may be used to replace the text before and
              after the display for the duration of the function; either or both may be an  empty
              string.

              If  the option -n is also given, pretext or posttext will only be inserted if there
              is text before or after the region respectively which will be made invisible.

              Two numeric arguments may be given which will be used instead  of  the  cursor  and
              mark positions.

              The option -S statepm is used to narrow according to the other options while saving
              the original state in the parameter with name statepm, while the option -R  statepm
              is used to restore the state from the parameter; note in both cases the name of the
              parameter is required.  In the second case, other options and arguments are irrele‐
              vant.  When this method is used, no recursive-edit is performed; the calling widget
              should call this function with the option -S, perform its own editing on  the  com‐
              mand  line  or  pass  control  to the user via `zle recursive-edit', then call this
              function with the option -R.  The argument statepm must be a suitable name  for  an
              ordinary  parameter,  except  that  parameters  beginning with the prefix _ntr_ are
              reserved for use within narrow-to-region.  Typically the parameter will be local to
              the calling function.

              narrow-to-region-invisible  is  a  simple  widget which calls narrow-to-region with
              arguments which replace any text outside the region with `...'.

              The display is restored (and the widget returns) upon any zle command  which  would
              usually cause the line to be accepted or aborted.  Hence an additional such command
              is required to accept or abort the current line.

              The return status of both widgets is zero if the line was accepted, else non-zero.

              Here is a trivial example of a widget using this feature.
                     local state
                     narrow-to-region -p $'Editing restricted region\n' \
                       -P '' -S state
                     zle recursive-edit
                     narrow-to-region -R state

       predict-on
              This set of functions implements predictive typing  using  history  search.   After
              predict-on, typing characters causes the editor to look backward in the history for
              the first line beginning with what you have typed so far.  After predict-off, edit‐
              ing  returns  to  normal for the line found.  In fact, you often don't even need to
              use predict-off, because if the line doesn't match something in the history, adding
              a  key performs standard completion, and then inserts itself if no completions were
              found.  However, editing in the middle of a line is liable to  confuse  prediction;
              see the toggle style below.

              With the function based completion system (which is needed for this), you should be
              able to type TAB at almost any point to advance the cursor to the next  ``interest‐
              ing''  character position (usually the end of the current word, but sometimes some‐
              where in the middle of the word).  And of course as soon as the entire line is what
              you want, you can accept with return, without needing to move the cursor to the end
              first.

              The first time predict-on is used, it creates several additional widget functions:

              delete-backward-and-predict
                     Replaces the backward-delete-char widget.  You do  not  need  to  bind  this
                     yourself.
              insert-and-predict
                     Implements  predictive  typing  by replacing the self-insert widget.  You do
                     not need to bind this yourself.
              predict-off
                     Turns off predictive typing.

              Although you autoload only the predict-on function, it is  necessary  to  create  a
              keybinding for predict-off as well.

                     zle -N predict-on
                     zle -N predict-off
                     bindkey '^X^Z' predict-on
                     bindkey '^Z' predict-off

       read-from-minibuffer
              This  is  most useful when called as a function from inside a widget, but will work
              correctly as a widget in its own right.  It prompts for a value below  the  current
              command  line;  a  value may be input using all of the standard zle operations (and
              not  merely  the  restricted  set  available  when  executing,  for  example,  exe‐
              cute-named-cmd).  The value is then returned to the calling function in the parame‐
              ter $REPLY and the editing buffer restored to its previous state.  If the read  was
              aborted  by  a  keyboard  break  (typically  ^G), the function returns status 1 and
              $REPLY is not set.

              If one argument is supplied to the function it is taken as a prompt, otherwise `? '
              is  used.  If two arguments are supplied, they are the prompt and the initial value
              of $LBUFFER, and if a third argument is given it is the initial value of  $RBUFFER.
              This  provides  a  default  value  and  starting cursor placement.  Upon return the
              entire buffer is the value of $REPLY.

              One option is available: `-k num' specifies that num  characters  are  to  be  read
              instead  of a whole line.  The line editor is not invoked recursively in this case,
              so depending on the terminal settings the input may not be visible,  and  only  the
              input  keys are placed in $REPLY, not the entire buffer.  Note that unlike the read
              builtin num must be given; there is no default.

              The name is a slight misnomer, as in fact the shell's own minibuffer is  not  used.
              Hence  it  is still possible to call executed-named-cmd and similar functions while
              reading a value.

       replace-argument, replace-argument-edit
              The function replace-argument can be used to replace a command line argument in the
              current  command line or, if the current command line is empty, in the last command
              line executed (the new command line is not executed).  Arguments are  as  delimited
              by standard shell syntax,

              If  a  numeric  argument  is  given, that specifies the argument to be replaced.  0
              means the command name, as in  history  expansion.   A  negative  numeric  argument
              counts backward from the last word.

              If no numeric argument is given, the current argument is replaced; this is the last
              argument if the previous history line is being used.

              The function prompts for a replacement argument.

              If the widget contains the string edit, for example is defined as

                     zle -N replace-argument-edit replace-argument

              then the function presents the current value of the argument for editing, otherwise
              the editing buffer for the replacement is initially empty.

       replace-string, replace-pattern
       replace-string-again, replace-pattern-again
              The  function  replace-string  implements three widgets.  If defined under the same
              name as the function, it prompts for two strings; the first (source) string will be
              replaced by the second everywhere it occurs in the line editing buffer.

              If  the widget name contains the word `pattern', for example by defining the widget
              using the command `zle -N replace-pattern replace-string',  then  the  matching  is
              performed  using  zsh  patterns.  All zsh extended globbing patterns can be used in
              the source string; note that unlike filename generation the pattern does  not  need
              to  match an entire word, nor do glob qualifiers have any effect.  In addition, the
              replacement string can contain parameter or command substitutions.  Furthermore,  a
              `&'  in the replacement string will be replaced with the matched source string, and
              a backquoted digit `\N' will  be  replaced  by  the  Nth  parenthesised  expression
              matched.  The form `\{N}' may be used to protect the digit from following digits.

              If the widget instead contains the word `regex' (or `regexp'), then the matching is
              performed  using  regular  expressions,  respecting  the  setting  of  the   option
              RE_MATCH_PCRE (see the description of the function regexp-replace below).  The spe‐
              cial replacement facilities described above for pattern matching are available.

              By default the previous source or replacement string will not be offered for  edit‐
              ing.   However, this feature can be activated by setting the style edit-previous in
              the context :zle:widget (for example, :zle:replace-string) to true.  In addition, a
              positive  numeric  argument forces the previous values to be offered, a negative or
              zero argument forces them not to be.

              The function replace-string-again can be used to repeat the  previous  replacement;
              no  prompting  is done.  As with replace-string, if the name of the widget contains
              the word `pattern' or `regex', pattern or regular expression matching is performed,
              else  a  literal string replacement.  Note that the previous source and replacement
              text are the same whether pattern, regular expression or string matching is used.

              In addition, replace-string shows the previous replacement  above  the  prompt,  so
              long  as  there  was one during the current session; if the source string is empty,
              that replacement will be repeated without the widget prompting  for  a  replacement
              string.

              For example, starting from the line:

                     print This line contains fan and fond

              and  invoking  replace-pattern  with  the source string `f(?)n' and the replacement
              string `c\1r' produces the not very useful line:

                     print This line contains car and cord

              The  range  of  the  replacement  string  can  be  limited  by   using   the   nar‐
              row-to-region-invisible widget.  One limitation of the current version is that undo
              will cycle through changes to the replacement and source strings before undoing the
              replacement itself.

       send-invisible
              This is similar to read-from-minibuffer in that it may be called as a function from
              a widget or as a widget of its own, and interactively reads  input  from  the  key‐
              board.  However, the input being typed is concealed and a string of asterisks (`*')
              is shown instead.  The value is saved in the parameter $INVISIBLE to which a refer‐
              ence  is  inserted into the editing buffer at the restored cursor position.  If the
              read was aborted by a keyboard break (typically ^G) or another escape from  editing
              such  as  push-line, $INVISIBLE is set to empty and the original buffer is restored
              unchanged.

              If one argument is supplied to the function it is  taken  as  a  prompt,  otherwise
              `Non-echoed text: ' is used (as in emacs).  If a second and third argument are sup‐
              plied they are used to begin and end the reference to $INVISIBLE that  is  inserted
              into the buffer.  The default is to open with ${, then INVISIBLE, and close with },
              but many other effects are possible.

       smart-insert-last-word
              This function may replace the insert-last-word widget, like so:

                     zle -N insert-last-word smart-insert-last-word

              With a numeric prefix, or when passed command line arguments in a call from another
              widget, it behaves like insert-last-word, except that words in comments are ignored
              when INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS is set.

              Otherwise, the rightmost ``interesting'' word from the previous  command  is  found
              and  inserted.  The default definition of ``interesting'' is that the word contains
              at least one alphabetic character, slash, or backslash.   This  definition  may  be
              overridden by use of the match style.  The context used to look up the style is the
              widget name, so usually the context is :insert-last-word.  However,  you  can  bind
              this function to different widgets to use different patterns:

                     zle -N insert-last-assignment smart-insert-last-word
                     zstyle :insert-last-assignment match '[[:alpha:]][][[:alnum:]]#=*'
                     bindkey '\e=' insert-last-assignment

              If no interesting word is found and the auto-previous style is set to a true value,
              the search continues upward through the history.  When auto-previous  is  unset  or
              false  (the default), the widget must be invoked repeatedly in order to search ear‐
              lier history lines.

       transpose-lines
              Only useful with a multi-line editing buffer; the lines here are lines  within  the
              current on-screen buffer, not history lines.  The effect is similar to the function
              of the same name in Emacs.

              Transpose the current line with the previous line and move the cursor to the  start
              of  the  next  line.   Repeating  this  (which  can be done by providing a positive
              numeric prefix argument) has the effect of moving the line above the cursor down by
              a number of lines.

              With  a  negative  numeric  prefix  argument,  requires two lines above the cursor.
              These two lines are transposed and the cursor moved to the start  of  the  previous
              line.   Using a numeric prefix less than -1 has the effect of moving the line above
              the cursor up by minus that number of lines.

       which-command
              This function is a drop-in replacement for the builtin  widget  which-command.   It
              has  enhanced  behaviour,  in  that it correctly detects whether or not the command
              word needs to be expanded as an alias; if so, it continues tracing the command word
              from the expanded alias until it reaches the command that will be executed.

              The  style  whence  is available in the context :zle:$WIDGET; this may be set to an
              array to give the command and options that will be used to investigate the  command
              word found.  The default is whence -c.

       zcalc-auto-insert
              This  function  is useful together with the zcalc function described in the section
              Mathematical Functions.  It should be bound to a key representing a binary operator
              such  as  `+',  `-',  `*'  or `/'.  When running in zcalc, if the key occurs at the
              start of the line or immediately following an open parenthesis, the text "ans "  is
              inserted  before the representation of the key itself.  This allows easy use of the
              answer from the previous calculation in the current line.  The text to be  inserted
              before   the   symbol   typed   can   be   modified   by   setting   the   variable
              ZCALC_AUTO_INSERT_PREFIX.

              Hence, for example, typing `+12' followed by return adds 12 to the previous result.

              When not in zcalc, the key simply inserts the symbol itself.

   Utility Functions
       These functions are useful in constructing widgets.  They should be loaded with  `autoload
       -U function' and called as indicated from user-defined widgets.

       split-shell-arguments
              This  function  splits  the  line  currently  being edited into shell arguments and
              whitespace.  The result is stored in the array reply.  The array contains  all  the
              parts of the line in order, starting with any whitespace before the first argument,
              and finishing with any whitespace after the last argument.  Hence (so long  as  the
              option  KSH_ARRAYS  is not set) whitespace is given by odd indices in the array and
              arguments by even indices.  Note that no  stripping  of  quotes  is  done;  joining
              together  all  the elements of reply in order is guaranteed to produce the original
              line.

              The parameter REPLY is set to the index of the word in  reply  which  contains  the
              character  after  the  cursor,  where the first element has index 1.  The parameter
              REPLY2 is set to the index of the character under the cursor in  that  word,  where
              the first character has index 1.

              Hence reply, REPLY and REPLY2 should all be made local to the enclosing function.

              See the function modify-current-argument, described below, for an example of how to
              call this function.

       modify-current-argument [ expr-using-$ARG | func ]
              This function provides a simple method of allowing user-defined widgets  to  modify
              the  command line argument under the cursor (or immediately to the left of the cur‐
              sor if the cursor is between arguments).

              The argument can be an expression which when evaluated operates on the shell param‐
              eter  ARG,  which will have been set to the command line argument under the cursor.
              The expression should be suitably quoted to prevent it being evaluated too early.

              Alternatively, if the argument does not contain the string ARG, it is assumed to be
              a  shell function, to which the current command line argument is passed as the only
              argument.  The function should set the variable REPLY to the new value for the com‐
              mand  line  argument.  If the function returns non-zero status, so does the calling
              function.

              For example, a user-defined widget containing the following code converts the char‐
              acters in the argument under the cursor into all upper case:

                     modify-current-argument '${(U)ARG}'

              The  following strips any quoting from the current word (whether backslashes or one
              of the styles of quotes), and replaces it with single quoting throughout:

                     modify-current-argument '${(qq)${(Q)ARG}}'

              The following performs  directory  expansion  on  the  command  line  argument  and
              replaces it by the absolute path:

                     expand-dir() {
                       REPLY=${~1}
                       REPLY=${REPLY:a}
                     }
                     modify-current-argument expand-dir

              In practice the function expand-dir would probably not be defined within the widget
              where modify-current-argument is called.

   Styles
       The behavior of several of the above widgets can be controlled by the use  of  the  zstyle
       mechanism.   In  particular,  widgets  that interact with the completion system pass along
       their context to any completions that they invoke.

       break-keys
              This style is used by the incremental-complete-word widget. Its value should  be  a
              pattern, and all keys matching this pattern will cause the widget to stop incremen‐
              tal completion without the key having any further  effect.  Like  all  styles  used
              directly  by  incremental-complete-word,  this style is looked up using the context
              `:incremental'.

       completer
              The incremental-complete-word and insert-and-predict widgets set up their top-level
              context  name  before calling completion.  This allows one to define different sets
              of completer functions for normal completion and for these widgets.   For  example,
              to  use  completion, approximation and correction for normal completion, completion
              and correction for incremental completion and only completion  for  prediction  one
              could use:

                     zstyle ':completion:*' completer \
                             _complete _correct _approximate
                     zstyle ':completion:incremental:*' completer \
                             _complete _correct
                     zstyle ':completion:predict:*' completer \
                             _complete

              It  is  a good idea to restrict the completers used in prediction, because they may
              be automatically invoked as you type.  The _list and _menu completers should  never
              be  used  with  prediction.   The  _approximate, _correct, _expand, and _match com‐
              pleters may be used, but be aware that they may change characters anywhere  in  the
              word  behind the cursor, so you need to watch carefully that the result is what you
              intended.

       cursor The insert-and-predict widget uses this style, in the context `:predict', to decide
              where to place the cursor after completion has been tried.  Values are:

              complete
                     The  cursor is left where it was when completion finished, but only if it is
                     after a character equal to the one just inserted by  the  user.   If  it  is
                     after another character, this value is the same as `key'.

              key    The  cursor is left after the nth occurrence of the character just inserted,
                     where n is the number of times that character appeared in  the  word  before
                     completion was attempted.  In short, this has the effect of leaving the cur‐
                     sor after the character just typed even if the  completion  code  found  out
                     that no other characters need to be inserted at that position.

              Any  other  value  for this style unconditionally leaves the cursor at the position
              where the completion code left it.

       list   When using the incremental-complete-word widget, this style  says  if  the  matches
              should  be  listed on every key press (if they fit on the screen).  Use the context
              prefix `:completion:incremental'.

              The insert-and-predict widget uses this style to decide if the completion should be
              shown  even if there is only one possible completion.  This is done if the value of
              this style is the string always.  In this  case  the  context  is  `:predict'  (not
              `:completion:predict').

       match  This  style  is  used  by  smart-insert-last-word  to provide a pattern (using full
              EXTENDED_GLOB syntax) that matches an interesting word.  The context is the name of
              the  widget  to  which  smart-insert-last-word  is  bound (see above).  The default
              behavior of smart-insert-last-word is equivalent to:

                     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:]/\\]*'

              However, you might want to include words that contain spaces:

                     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*[[:alpha:][:space:]/\\]*'

              Or include numbers as long as the word is at least two characters long:

                     zstyle :insert-last-word match '*([[:digit:]]?|[[:alpha:]/\\])*'

              The above example causes redirections like "2>" to be included.

       prompt The incremental-complete-word widget shows the value of this style  in  the  status
              line  during  incremental completion.  The string value may contain any of the fol‐
              lowing substrings in the manner of the PS1 and other prompt parameters:

              %c     Replaced by the name of the completer function that  generated  the  matches
                     (without the leading underscore).

              %l     When  the list style is set, replaced by `...' if the list of matches is too
                     long to fit on the screen and with an empty string otherwise.  If  the  list
                     style is `false' or not set, `%l' is always removed.

              %n     Replaced by the number of matches generated.

              %s     Replaced  by  `-no match-', `-no prefix-', or an empty string if there is no
                     completion matching the word on the line, if the matches have no common pre‐
                     fix  different  from the word on the line, or if there is such a common pre‐
                     fix, respectively.

              %u     Replaced by the unambiguous part of all matches, if there is any, and if  it
                     is different from the word on the line.

              Like `break-keys', this uses the `:incremental' context.

       stop-keys
              This  style  is used by the incremental-complete-word widget.  Its value is treated
              similarly to the one for the break-keys style (and uses the same context:  `:incre‐
              mental').   However,  in this case all keys matching the pattern given as its value
              will stop incremental completion and will then execute their usual function.

       toggle This boolean style is used by predict-on and its related  widgets  in  the  context
              `:predict'.   If  set  to  one  of the standard `true' values, predictive typing is
              automatically toggled off in situations where it is unlikely to be useful, such  as
              when editing a multi-line buffer or after moving into the middle of a line and then
              deleting a character.  The default is  to  leave  prediction  turned  on  until  an
              explicit call to predict-off.

       verbose
              This  boolean  style  is  used by predict-on and its related widgets in the context
              `:predict'.  If set to one of the standard `true' values, these widgets  display  a
              message below the prompt when the predictive state is toggled.  This is most useful
              in combination with the toggle style.  The default does not display these messages.

       widget This style is similar to the command style: For widget functions that  use  zle  to
              call  other  widgets, this style can sometimes be used to override the widget which
              is called.  The context for this style is the name of the calling widget  (not  the
              name  of the calling function, because one function may be bound to multiple widget
              names).

                     zstyle :copy-earlier-word widget smart-insert-last-word

              Check the documentation for the calling widget or function to determine whether the
              widget style is used.

EXCEPTION HANDLING
       Two  functions  are  provided  to  enable zsh to provide exception handling in a form that
       should be familiar from other languages.

       throw exception
              The function throw throws the named exception.  The name is an arbitrary string and
              is  only  used by the throw and catch functions.  An exception is for the most part
              treated the same as a shell error, i.e. an unhandled exception will cause the shell
              to  abort  all processing in a function or script and to return to the top level in
              an interactive shell.

       catch exception-pattern
              The function catch returns status zero if an exception was thrown and  the  pattern
              exception-pattern matches its name.  Otherwise it returns status 1.  exception-pat‐
              tern  is  a  standard  shell  pattern,  respecting  the  current  setting  of   the
              EXTENDED_GLOB  option.   An  alias catch is also defined to prevent the argument to
              the function from matching filenames, so patterns may be used unquoted.  Note  that
              as  exceptions are not fundamentally different from other shell errors it is possi‐
              ble to catch shell errors by using an empty string  as  the  exception  name.   The
              shell  variable  CAUGHT is set by catch to the name of the exception caught.  It is
              possible to rethrow an exception by calling the throw function again once an excep‐
              tion has been caught.

       The functions are designed to be used together with the always construct described in zsh‐
       misc(1).  This is important as only this  construct  provides  the  required  support  for
       exceptions.  A typical example is as follows.

              {
                # "try" block
                # ... nested code here calls "throw MyExcept"
              } always {
                # "always" block
                if catch MyExcept; then
                  print "Caught exception MyExcept"
                elif catch ''; then
                  print "Caught a shell error.  Propagating..."
                  throw ''
                fi
                # Other exceptions are not handled but may be caught further
                # up the call stack.
              }

       If all exceptions should be caught, the following idiom might be preferable.

              {
                # ... nested code here throws an exception
              } always {
                if catch *; then
                  case $CAUGHT in
                    (MyExcept)
                    print "Caught my own exception"
                    ;;
                    (*)
                    print "Caught some other exception"
                    ;;
                  esac
                fi
              }

       In  common with exception handling in other languages, the exception may be thrown by code
       deeply nested inside the `try' block.  However, note that it must  be  thrown  inside  the
       current  shell,  not in a subshell forked for a pipeline, parenthesised current-shell con‐
       struct, or some form of command or process substitution.

       The system internally uses the shell variable EXCEPTION to record the name of  the  excep‐
       tion  between throwing and catching.  One drawback of this scheme is that if the exception
       is not handled the variable EXCEPTION remains set and may be incorrectly recognised as the
       name  of an exception if a shell error subsequently occurs.  Adding unset EXCEPTION at the
       start of the outermost layer of any code that uses exception handling will eliminate  this
       problem.

MIME FUNCTIONS
       Three  functions  are  available to provide handling of files recognised by extension, for
       example to dispatch a file text.ps when executed as a command to an appropriate viewer.

       zsh-mime-setup [ -fv ] [ -l [ suffix ... ] ]
       zsh-mime-handler [-l] command arguments ...
              These two functions use the files ~/.mime.types and  /etc/mime.types,  which  asso‐
              ciate types and extensions, as well as ~/.mailcap and /etc/mailcap files, which as‐
              sociate types and the programs that handle them.  These are provided on  many  sys‐
              tems with the Multimedia Internet Mail Extensions.

              To  enable  the  system,  the function zsh-mime-setup should be autoloaded and run.
              This allows files with extensions to be treated as executable; such files  be  com‐
              pleted by the function completion system.  The function zsh-mime-handler should not
              need to be called by the user.

              The system works by setting up suffix aliases  with  `alias  -s'.   Suffix  aliases
              already installed by the user will not be overwritten.

              For  suffixes defined in lower case, upper case variants will also automatically be
              handled (e.g. PDF is automatically handled  if  handling  for  the  suffix  pdf  is
              defined), but not vice versa.

              Repeated  calls to zsh-mime-setup do not override the existing mapping between suf‐
              fixes and executable files unless the option -f is given.  Note, however, that this
              does  not  override  existing  suffix  aliases  assigned  to  handlers  other  than
              zsh-mime-handler.

              Calling zsh-mime-setup with the option  -l  lists  the  existing  mappings  without
              altering  them.  Suffixes to list (which may contain pattern characters that should
              be quoted from immediate interpretation on the command line) may be given as  addi‐
              tional arguments, otherwise all suffixes are listed.

              Calling  zsh-mime-setup with the option -v causes verbose output to be shown during
              the setup operation.

              The system respects the mailcap flags needsterminal and  copiousoutput,  see  mail‐
              cap(4).

              The  functions  use the following styles, which are defined with the zstyle builtin
              command (see zshmodules(1)).  They should be defined before zsh-mime-setup is  run.
              The  contexts used all start with :mime:, with additional components in some cases.
              It is recommended that a trailing * (suitably quoted) be appended to style patterns
              in case the system is extended in future.  Some examples are given below.

              For files that have multiple suffixes, e.g. .pdf.gz, where the context includes the
              suffix it will be looked up starting with the longest possible suffix until a match
              for  the style is found.  For example, if .pdf.gz produces a match for the handler,
              that will be used; otherwise the handler for .gz will be used.  Note that, owing to
              the  way suffix aliases work, it is always required that there be a handler for the
              shortest possible suffix, so in this example .pdf.gz can only be handled if .gz  is
              also  handled  (though not necessarily in the same way).  Alternatively, if no han‐
              dling for .gz on its own is needed, simply adding the command

                     alias -s gz=zsh-mime-handler

              to the initialisation code is sufficient; .gz will not be handled on its  own,  but
              may be in combination with other suffixes.

              current-shell
                     If  this boolean style is true, the mailcap handler for the context in ques‐
                     tion is run using the eval builtin instead of by starting a new sh  process.
                     This  is  more efficient, but may not work in the occasional cases where the
                     mailcap handler uses strict POSIX syntax.

              disown If this boolean style is true, mailcap handlers started  in  the  background
                     will  be  disowned, i.e. not subject to job control within the parent shell.
                     Such handlers nearly always produce their own windows, so  the  only  likely
                     harmful  side  effect of setting the style is that it becomes harder to kill
                     jobs from within the shell.

              execute-as-is
                     This style gives a list of patterns to be matched against files  passed  for
                     execution  with  a  handler  program.   If the file matches the pattern, the
                     entire command line is executed in its current form, with no handler.   This
                     is  useful for files which might have suffixes but nonetheless be executable
                     in their own right.  If the style is not set, the pattern *(*) *(/) is used;
                     hence  executable  files  are executed directly and not passed to a handler,
                     and the option AUTO_CD may be used to change to directories that  happen  to
                     have MIME suffixes.

              execute-never
                     This  style  is  useful  in combination with execute-as-is.  It is set to an
                     array of patterns corresponding to full paths to files that should never  be
                     treated  as  executable, even if the file passed to the MIME handler matches
                     execute-as-is.  This is useful for file systems that  don't  handle  execute
                     permission  or  that contain executables from another operating system.  For
                     example, if /mnt/windows is a Windows mount, then

                            zstyle ':mime:*' execute-never '/mnt/windows/*'

                     will ensure that any files found in that area will be executed as MIME types
                     even  if they are executable.  As this example shows, the complete file name
                     is matched against the pattern, regardless of how the file was passed to the
                     handler.   The  file  is  resolved  to  a  full  path  using the :A modifier
                     described in the subsection Modifiers in zshexpn(1); this  means  that  sym‐
                     bolic  links are resolved where possible, so that links into other file sys‐
                     tems behave in the correct fashion.

              file-path
                     Used if the style find-file-in-path is true for the same context.  Set to an
                     array of directories that are used for searching for the file to be handled;
                     the default is the command path given by the special  parameter  path.   The
                     shell  option  PATH_DIRS  is respected; if that is set, the appropriate path
                     will be searched even if the name of the file to be handled as it appears on
                     the  command  line  contains  a `/'.  The full context is :mime:.suffix:, as
                     described for the style handler.

              find-file-in-path
                     If set, allows files whose  names  do  not  contain  absolute  paths  to  be
                     searched  for  in  the  command  path or the path specified by the file-path
                     style.  If the file is not found in the  path,  it  is  looked  for  locally
                     (whether  or  not  the current directory is in the path); if it is not found
                     locally, the handler will abort unless the handle-nonexistent style is  set.
                     Files found in the path are tested as described for the style execute-as-is.
                     The full context is :mime:.suffix:, as described for the style handler.

              flags  Defines flags to go with a handler; the context is as for the handler style,
                     and the format is as for the flags in mailcap.

              handle-nonexistent
                     By  default,  arguments that don't correspond to files are not passed to the
                     MIME handler in order to prevent it from intercepting commands found in  the
                     path  that  happen  to  have suffixes.  This style may be set to an array of
                     extended glob patterns for arguments that will be passed to the handler even
                     if  they  don't  exist.   If  it  is  not  explicitly  set  it  defaults  to
                     [[:alpha:]]#:/* which allows URLs to be passed  to  the  MIME  handler  even
                     though they don't exist in that format in the file system.  The full context
                     is :mime:.suffix:, as described for the style handler.

              handler
                     Specifies a handler for a suffix; the suffix is  given  by  the  context  as
                     :mime:.suffix:,  and  the  format of the handler is exactly that in mailcap.
                     Note in particular the `.' and trailing colon to distinguish this use of the
                     context.  This overrides any handler specified by the mailcap files.  If the
                     handler requires a terminal, the flags style should be set  to  include  the
                     word needsterminal, or if the output is to be displayed through a pager (but
                     not if the handler is itself a pager), it should include copiousoutput.

              mailcap
                     A list of files in the format of ~/.mailcap and /etc/mailcap to be read dur‐
                     ing  setup,  replacing  the  default list which consists of those two files.
                     The context is :mime:.  A + in the list will  be  replaced  by  the  default
                     files.

              mailcap-priorities
                     This  style  is  used  to resolve multiple mailcap entries for the same MIME
                     type.  It consists of an array of  the  following  elements,  in  descending
                     order  of priority; later entries will be used if earlier entries are unable
                     to resolve the entries being compared.  If none of  the  tests  resolve  the
                     entries, the first entry encountered is retained.

                     files  The  order  of  files  (entries  in the mailcap style) read.  Earlier
                            files are preferred.  (Note this does not resolve entries in the same
                            file.)

                     priority
                            The priority flag from the mailcap entry.  The priority is an integer
                            from 0 to 9 with the default value being 5.

                     flags  The test given by the mailcap-prio-flags option is  used  to  resolve
                            entries.

                     place  Later  entries  are  preferred;  as the entries are strictly ordered,
                            this test always succeeds.

                     Note that as this style is handled during  initialisation,  the  context  is
                     always :mime:, with no discrimination by suffix.

              mailcap-prio-flags
                     This  style  is  used  when  the keyword flags is encountered in the list of
                     tests specified by the mailcap-priorities style.  It should be set to a list
                     of  patterns,  each  of  which  is tested against the flags specified in the
                     mailcap entry (in other words, the  sets  of  assignments  found  with  some
                     entries in the mailcap file).  Earlier patterns in the list are preferred to
                     later ones, and matched patterns are preferred to unmatched ones.

              mime-types
                     A list of files in the format of ~/.mime.types  and  /etc/mime.types  to  be
                     read  during  setup,  replacing the default list which consists of those two
                     files.  The context is :mime:.  A + in the list  will  be  replaced  by  the
                     default files.

              never-background
                     If  this  boolean  style is set, the handler for the given context is always
                     run in the foreground, even if the flags provided in the mailcap entry  sug‐
                     gest it need not be (for example, it doesn't require a terminal).

              pager  If  set, will be used instead of $PAGER or more to handle suffixes where the
                     copiousoutput flag is set.  The context is as for handler, i.e.  :mime:.suf‐
                     fix: for handling a file with the given suffix.

              Examples:

                     zstyle ':mime:*' mailcap ~/.mailcap /usr/local/etc/mailcap
                     zstyle ':mime:.txt:' handler less %s
                     zstyle ':mime:.txt:' flags needsterminal

              When  zsh-mime-setup  is  subsequently run, it will look for mailcap entries in the
              two files given.  Files of suffix .txt will be handled by running `less  file.txt'.
              The flag needsterminal is set to show that this program must run attached to a ter‐
              minal.

              As there are several steps to  dispatching  a  command,  the  following  should  be
              checked  if  attempting  to  execute  a  file  by  extension .ext does not have the
              expected effect.

              The command `alias -s ext' should show `ps=zsh-mime-handler'.  If  it  shows  some‐
              thing else, another suffix alias was already installed and was not overwritten.  If
              it shows nothing, no handler was installed:  this is most likely because no handler
              was found in the .mime.types and mailcap combination for .ext files.  In that case,
              appropriate handling should be added to ~/.mime.types and mailcap.

              If the extension is handled by zsh-mime-handler but the file  is  not  opened  cor‐
              rectly,  either the handler defined for the type is incorrect, or the flags associ‐
              ated with it are in appropriate.  Running zsh-mime-setup -l will show  the  handler
              and,  if  there  are  any,  the flags.  A %s in the handler is replaced by the file
              (suitably quoted if necessary).  Check that the handler program  listed  lists  and
              can  be  run  in  the  way shown.  Also check that the flags needsterminal or copi‐
              ousoutput are set if the handler needs to be run under a terminal; the second  flag
              is  used if the output should be sent to a pager.  An example of a suitable mailcap
              entry for such a program is:

                     text/html; /usr/bin/lynx '%s'; needsterminal

              Running `zsh-mime-handler -l command line' prints the command line  that  would  be
              executed, simplified to remove the effect of any flags, and quoted so that the out‐
              put can be run as a complete zsh command line.  This is used by the completion sys‐
              tem to decide how to complete after a file handled by zsh-mime-setup.

       pick-web-browser
              This  function  is  separate from the two MIME functions described above and can be
              assigned directly to a suffix:

                     autoload -U pick-web-browser
                     alias -s html=pick-web-browser

              It is provided as an intelligent front end to dispatch a web browser.   It  may  be
              run  as  either  a  function  or  a shell script.  The status 255 is returned if no
              browser could be started.

              Various styles are available to customize the choice of browsers:

              browser-style
                     The value of the style is an array giving preferences  in  decreasing  order
                     for the type of browser to use.  The values of elements may be

                     running
                            Use a GUI browser that is already running when an X Window display is
                            available.  The browsers listed in the x-browsers style are tried  in
                            order  until  one  is  found; if it is, the file will be displayed in
                            that browser, so the user may need to check whether it has  appeared.
                            If  no  running browser is found, one is not started.  Browsers other
                            than Firefox, Opera and  Konqueror  are  assumed  to  understand  the
                            Mozilla syntax for opening a URL remotely.

                     x      Start  a  new  GUI  browser  when  an  X Window display is available.
                            Search for the availability of one of  the  browsers  listed  in  the
                            x-browsers  style and start the first one that is found.  No check is
                            made for an already running browser.

                     tty    Start a terminal-based browser.  Search for the availability  of  one
                            of  the browsers listed in the tty-browsers style and start the first
                            one that is found.

                     If the style is not set the default running x tty is used.

              x-browsers
                     An array in decreasing order of preference of browsers to use  when  running
                     under  the  X  Window  System.  The array consists of the command name under
                     which to start the browser.  They are looked up in the context :mime: (which
                     may be extended in future, so appending `*' is recommended).  For example,

                            zstyle ':mime:*' x-browsers opera konqueror firefox

                     specifies  that pick-web-browser should first look for a running instance of
                     Opera, Konqueror or Firefox, in that order, and if  it  fails  to  find  any
                     should  attempt  to  start  Opera.   The default is firefox mozilla netscape
                     opera konqueror.

              tty-browsers
                     An array similar to x-browsers, except that it gives browsers to use when no
                     X Window display is available.  The default is elinks links lynx.

              command
                     If  it is set this style is used to pick the command used to open a page for
                     a browser.  The  context  is  :mime:browser:new:$browser:  to  start  a  new
                     browser  or  :mime:browser:running:$browser:  to  open  a  URL  in a browser
                     already running on the current  X  display,  where  $browser  is  the  value
                     matched  in the x-browsers or tty-browsers style.  The escape sequence %b in
                     the style's value will be replaced by the browser, while %u will be replaced
                     by  the  URL.  If the style is not set, the default for all new instances is
                     equivalent to %b %u and the defaults for using running browsers are  equiva‐
                     lent  to  the values kfmclient openURL %u for Konqueror, firefox -new-tab %u
                     for Firefox, opera -newpage %u for Opera, and %b -remote  "openUrl(%u)"  for
                     all others.

MATHEMATICAL FUNCTIONS
       zcalc [ -ef ] [ expression ... ]
              A  reasonably  powerful  calculator  based on zsh's arithmetic evaluation facility.
              The syntax is similar to that of formulae in most programming  languages;  see  the
              section  `Arithmetic  Evaluation'  in  zshmisc(1)  for  details.   The mathematical
              library zsh/mathfunc will be loaded if  it  is  available;  see  the  section  `The
              zsh/mathfunc  Module'  in  zshmodules(1).  The mathematical functions correspond to
              the raw system libraries, so trigonometric functions are evaluated  using  radians,
              and so on.

              Each  line  typed  is evaluated as an expression.  The prompt shows a number, which
              corresponds to a positional parameter where  the  result  of  that  calculation  is
              stored.   For  example, the result of the calculation on the line preceded by `4> '
              is available as $4.  The last value calculated is available as ans.   Full  command
              line  editing,  including  the  history of previous calculations, is available; the
              history is saved in the file ~/.zcalc_history.  To exit, enter a blank line or type
              `:q' on its own (`q' is allowed for historical compatibility).

              A  line  ending  with a single backslash is treated in the same fashion as it is in
              command line editing:  the backslash is removed,  the  function  prompts  for  more
              input  (the  prompt  is preceded by `...' to indicate this), and the lines are com‐
              bined into one to get the final result.  In addition, if the input so far  contains
              more open than close parentheses zcalc will prompt for more input.

              If  arguments  are given to zcalc on start up, they are used to prime the first few
              positional parameters.  A visual indication of this is given  when  the  calculator
              starts.

              The  constants  PI (3.14159...) and E (2.71828...) are provided.  Parameter assign‐
              ment is possible, but note that all parameters will be put into the  global  names‐
              pace.

              The  output  base  can  be  initialised by passing the option `-#base', for example
              `zcalc -#16' (the `#' may have to be quoted,  depending  on  the  globbing  options
              set).

              If  the  option `-e' is set, the function runs non-interactively: the arguments are
              treated as expressions to be evaluated as if entered interactively line by line.

              If the option `-f' is set, all numbers are treated as  floating  point,  hence  for
              example  the expression `3/4' evaluates to 0.75 rather than 0.  Options must appear
              in separate words.

              The prompt is configurable via the parameter ZCALCPROMPT, which undergoes  standard
              prompt  expansion.   The  index of the current entry is stored locally in the first
              element of the array psvar, which can be referred to in ZCALCPROMPT as `%1v'.   The
              default prompt is `%1v> '.

              A  few  special commands are available; these are introduced by a colon.  For back‐
              ward compatibility, the colon may be omitted for certain commands.   Completion  is
              available if compinit has been run.

              The  output  precision  may  be specified within zcalc by special commands familiar
              from many calculators.
              :norm  The default output format.  It corresponds to the printf  %g  specification.
                     Typically this shows six decimal digits.

              :sci digits
                     Scientific  notation,  corresponding to the printf %g output format with the
                     precision given by digits.  This produces either fixed point or  exponential
                     notation depending on the value output.

              :fix digits
                     Fixed  point notation, corresponding to the printf %f output format with the
                     precision given by digits.

              :eng digits
                     Exponential notation, corresponding to the printf %E output format with  the
                     precision given by digits.

              :raw   Raw  output:  this is the default form of the output from a math evaluation.
                     This may show more precision than the number actually possesses.

              Other special commands:
              :!line...
                     Execute line... as a normal shell command line.  Note that it is executed in
                     the  context  of the function, i.e. with local variables.  Space is optional
                     after :!.

              :local arg ...
                     Declare variables local to the function.  Note that  certain  variables  are
                     used  by  the  function  for its own purposes.  Other variables may be used,
                     too, but they will be taken from or put into the global scope.

              :function name [ body ]
                     Define a mathematical function or (with no body) delete it.   :function  may
                     be abbreviated to :func or simply :f.  The name may contain the same charac‐
                     ters as a shell function name.  The function is defined using  zmathfuncdef,
                     see below.

                     Note that zcalc takes care of all quoting.  Hence for example:

                            :f cube $1 * $1 * $1

                     defines a function to cube the sole argument.

              [#base]
                     This is not a special command, rather part of normal arithmetic syntax; how‐
                     ever, when this form appears on a line by itself the default output radix is
                     set  to  base.  Use, for example, `[#16]' to display hexadecimal output pre‐
                     ceded by an indication of the base, or `[##16]' just to display the raw num‐
                     ber  in  the  given base.  Bases themselves are always specified in decimal.
                     `[#]' restores the normal output format.  Note that setting an  output  base
                     suppresses floating point output; use `[#]' to return to normal operation.

              See the comments in the function for a few extra tips.

       zmathfuncdef [ mathfunc [ body ] ]
              A convenient front end to functions -M.

              With two arguments, define a mathematical function named mathfunc which can be used
              in any form of arithmetic evaluation.  body is a mathematical expression to  imple‐
              ment  the  function.   It may contain references to position parameters $1, $2, ...
              to refer to mandatory parameters and  ${1:-defvalue}  ...   to  refer  to  optional
              parameters.   Note  that  the forms must be strictly adhered to for the function to
              calculate the correct number of arguments.  The implementation is held in  a  shell
              function  named  zsh_math_func_mathfunc; usually the user will not need to refer to
              the shell function directly.  Any existing function of the same  name  is  silently
              replaced.

              With  one  argument, remove the mathematical function mathfunc as well as the shell
              function implementation.

              With no arguments, list all mathfunc functions in a form suitable for restoring the
              definition.  The functions have not necessarily been defined by zmathfuncdef.

USER CONFIGURATION FUNCTIONS
       The  zsh/newuser  module comes with a function to aid in configuring shell options for new
       users.  If the module is installed, this function can also be run by hand.  It  is  avail‐
       able  even  if  the module's default behaviour, namely running the function for a new user
       logging in without startup files, is inhibited.

       zsh-newuser-install [ -f ]
              The function presents the user with various options for customizing their  initial‐
              ization  scripts.   Currently  only  ~/.zshrc  is handled.  $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc is used
              instead if the parameter ZDOTDIR is set; this provides a way for the user  to  con‐
              figure a file without altering an existing .zshrc.

              By  default  the  function  exits immediately if it finds any of the files .zshenv,
              .zprofile, .zshrc, or .zlogin in the  appropriate  directory.   The  option  -f  is
              required  in order to force the function to continue.  Note this may happen even if
              .zshrc itself does not exist.

              As currently configured, the function will exit immediately if the  user  has  root
              privileges; this behaviour cannot be overridden.

              Once activated, the function's behaviour is supposed to be self-explanatory.  Menus
              are present allowing the user to alter the value of options and  parameters.   Sug‐
              gestions for improvements are always welcome.

              When  the  script  exits, the user is given the opportunity to save the new file or
              not; changes are not irreversible until this point.  However, the script is careful
              to  restrict  changes to the file only to a group marked by the lines `# Lines con‐
              figured   by   zsh-newuser-install'   and   `#   End   of   lines   configured   by
              zsh-newuser-install'.   In  addition,  the old version of .zshrc is saved to a file
              with the suffix .zni appended.

              If the function edits an existing .zshrc, it is up to the user to ensure  that  the
              changes  made will take effect.  For example, if control usually returns early from
              the existing .zshrc the lines will not be executed; or a later initialization  file
              may  override  options  or  parameters,  and  so  on.  The function itself does not
              attempt to detect any such conflicts.

OTHER FUNCTIONS
       There are a large number of helpful functions in the Functions/Misc directory of  the  zsh
       distribution.   Most  are very simple and do not require documentation here, but a few are
       worthy of special mention.

   Descriptions
       colors This function initializes several associative arrays to map  color  names  to  (and
              from)  the  ANSI standard eight-color terminal codes.  These are used by the prompt
              theme system (see above).  You seldom should need to run colors more than once.

              The eight base colors are: black, red, green,  yellow,  blue,  magenta,  cyan,  and
              white.   Each  of these has codes for foreground and background.  In addition there
              are seven intensity attributes: bold, faint, standout, underline,  blink,  reverse,
              and conceal.  Finally, there are seven codes used to negate attributes: none (reset
              all attributes to the defaults), normal  (neither  bold  nor  faint),  no-standout,
              no-underline, no-blink, no-reverse, and no-conceal.

              Some terminals do not support all combinations of colors and intensities.

              The associative arrays are:

              color
              colour Map  all  the  color  names to their integer codes, and integer codes to the
                     color names.  The eight base names map to the foreground color codes, as  do
                     names  prefixed  with  `fg-',  such as `fg-red'.  Names prefixed with `bg-',
                     such as `bg-blue', refer to the background codes.  The reverse mapping  from
                     code  to  color  yields  base name for foreground codes and the bg- form for
                     backgrounds.

                     Although it is a misnomer to call them `colors', these arrays also  map  the
                     other fourteen attributes from names to codes and codes to names.

              fg
              fg_bold
              fg_no_bold
                     Map  the  eight basic color names to ANSI terminal escape sequences that set
                     the corresponding foreground text properties.  The fg sequences  change  the
                     color without changing the eight intensity attributes.

              bg
              bg_bold
              bg_no_bold
                     Map  the  eight basic color names to ANSI terminal escape sequences that set
                     the corresponding background properties.  The bg sequences change the  color
                     without changing the eight intensity attributes.

              In  addition,  the scalar parameters reset_color and bold_color are set to the ANSI
              terminal escapes that turn off all attributes and turn on bold  intensity,  respec‐
              tively.

       fned name
              Same  as zed -f.  This function does not appear in the zsh distribution, but can be
              created by linking zed to the name fned in some directory in your fpath.

       is-at-least needed [ present ]
              Perform a greater-than-or-equal-to comparison of two strings having the format of a
              zsh  version  number; that is, a string of numbers and text with segments separated
              by dots or dashes.  If the present string is not provided,  $ZSH_VERSION  is  used.
              Segments  are paired left-to-right in the two strings with leading non-number parts
              ignored.  If one string has fewer segments than the other, the missing segments are
              considered zero.

              This  is useful in startup files to set options and other state that are not avail‐
              able in all versions of zsh.

                     is-at-least 3.1.6-15 && setopt NO_GLOBAL_RCS
                     is-at-least 3.1.0 && setopt HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS
                     is-at-least 2.6-17 || print "You can't use is-at-least here."

       nslookup [ arg ... ]
              This wrapper function for the nslookup command requires the  zsh/zpty  module  (see
              zshmodules(1)).   It behaves exactly like the standard nslookup except that it pro‐
              vides customizable prompts  (including  a  right-side  prompt)  and  completion  of
              nslookup  commands, host names, etc. (if you use the function-based completion sys‐
              tem).  Completion styles may be set with the context prefix `:completion:nslookup'.

              See also the pager, prompt and rprompt styles below.

       regexp-replace var regexp replace
              Use regular expressions to perform a global search and replace operation on a vari‐
              able.   If  the option RE_MATCH_PCRE is not set, POSIX extended regular expressions
              are used, else Perl-compatible regular expressions (this requires the shell  to  be
              linked against the pcre library).

              var  is the name of the variable containing the string to be matched.  The variable
              will be modified directly by the function.   The  variables  MATCH,  MBEGIN,  MEND,
              match,  mbegin,  mend should be avoided as these are used by the regular expression
              code.

              regexp is the regular expression to match against the string.

              replace is the replacement text.  This can contain parameter,  command  and  arith‐
              metic  expressions  which  will  be replaced:  in particular, a reference to $MATCH
              will be replaced by the text matched by the pattern.

              The return status is 0 if at least one match was performed, else 1.

       run-help cmd
              This function is designed to be invoked by the run-help ZLE widget, in place of the
              default alias.  See `Accessing On-Line Help' above for setup instructions.

              In  the discussion which follows, if cmd is a file system path, it is first reduced
              to its rightmost component (the file name).

              Help is first sought by looking for a file named cmd in the directory named by  the
              HELPDIR  parameter.   If no file is found, an assistant function, alias, or command
              named run-help-cmd is sought.  If found, the assistant is executed with the rest of
              the  current command line (everything after the command name cmd) as its arguments.
              When neither file nor assistant is found, the external command `man cmd' is run.

              An example assistant for the "ssh" command:

                     run-help-ssh() {
                         emulate -LR zsh
                         local -a args
                         # Delete the "-l username" option
                         zparseopts -D -E -a args l:
                         # Delete other options, leaving: host command
                         args=(${@:#-*})
                         if [[ ${#args} -lt 2 ]]; then
                             man ssh
                         else
                             run-help $args[2]
                         fi
                     }

              Several of these assistants are provided in the  Functions/Misc  directory.   These
              must  be  autoloaded, or placed as executable scripts in your search path, in order
              to be found and used by run-help.

              run-help-git
              run-help-svk
              run-help-svn
                     Assistant functions for the git, svk, and svn commands.

       tetris Zsh was once accused of not being as complete as Emacs, because it lacked a  Tetris
              game.  This function was written to refute this vicious slander.

              This function must be used as a ZLE widget:

                     autoload -U tetris
                     zle -N tetris
                     bindkey keys tetris

              To  start a game, execute the widget by typing the keys.  Whatever command line you
              were editing disappears temporarily, and your keymap is also  temporarily  replaced
              by  the  Tetris  control keys.  The previous editor state is restored when you quit
              the game (by pressing `q') or when you lose.

              If you quit in the middle of a game, the next invocation of the tetris widget  will
              continue where you left off.  If you lost, it will start a new game.

       zargs [ option ... -- ] [ input ... ] [ -- command [ arg ... ] ]
              This  function  has  a  similar  purpose to GNU xargs.  Instead of reading lines of
              arguments from the standard input, it takes them from the command  line.   This  is
              useful because zsh, especially with recursive glob operators, often can construct a
              command line for a shell function that is longer than can be accepted by an  exter‐
              nal command.

              The  option list represents options of the zargs command itself, which are the same
              as those of xargs.  The input list is the collection of strings (often file  names)
              that become the arguments of the command, analogous to the standard input of xargs.
              Finally, the arg list consists of those arguments (usually options) that are passed
              to  the  command  each  time  it runs.  The arg list precedes the elements from the
              input list in each run.  If no command is provided, then no arg list  may  be  pro‐
              vided, and in that event the default command is `print' with arguments `-r --'.

              For  example,  to get a long ls listing of all plain files in the current directory
              or its subdirectories:

                     autoload -U zargs
                     zargs -- **/*(.) -- ls -l

              Note that `--' is used both to mark the end of the option list and to mark the  end
              of  the  input  list, so it must appear twice whenever the input list may be empty.
              If there is guaranteed to be at least one input and the first input does not  begin
              with a `-', then the first `--' may be omitted.

              In  the event that the string `--' is or may be an input, the -e option may be used
              to  change  the  end-of-inputs  marker.   Note  that  this  does  not  change   the
              end-of-options marker.  For example, to use `..' as the marker:

                     zargs -e.. -- **/*(.) .. ls -l

              This  is a good choice in that example because no plain file can be named `..', but
              the best end-marker depends on the circumstances.

              The options -i, -I, -l, -L, and -n differ  slightly  from  their  usage  in  xargs.
              There  are  no input lines for zargs to count, so -l and -L count through the input
              list, and -n counts the number of arguments passed to each  execution  of  command,
              including  any  arg list.  Also, any time -i or -I is used, each input is processed
              separately as if by `-L 1'.

              For details of the other zargs options, see xargs(1) (but note  the  difference  in
              function between zargs and xargs) or run zargs with the --help option.

       zed [ -f ] name
       zed -b This function uses the ZLE editor to edit a file or function.

              Only one name argument is allowed.  If the -f option is given, the name is taken to
              be that of a function; if the function is marked for autoloading, zed searches  for
              it  in  the  fpath and loads it.  Note that functions edited this way are installed
              into the current shell, but not written back to the autoload file.

              Without -f, name is the path name of the file to edit, which need not exist; it  is
              created on write, if necessary.

              While  editing,  the function sets the main keymap to zed and the vi command keymap
              to zed-vicmd.  These will be copied from the existing main  and  vicmd  keymaps  if
              they  do  not exist the first time zed is run.  They can be used to provide special
              key bindings used only in zed.

              If it creates the keymap, zed rebinds the return key to insert  a  line  break  and
              `^X^W'  to  accept the edit in the zed keymap, and binds `ZZ' to accept the edit in
              the zed-vicmd keymap.

              The bindings alone can be installed by running `zed  -b'.   This  is  suitable  for
              putting into a startup file.  Note that, if rerun, this will overwrite the existing
              zed and zed-vicmd keymaps.

              Completion is available, and styles may be set with the  context  prefix  `:comple‐
              tion:zed'.

              A  zle  widget  zed-set-file-name  is  available.   This can be called by name from
              within zed using `\ex zed-set-file-name' (note,  however,  that  because  of  zed's
              rebindings  you  will have to type ^j at the end instead of the return key), or can
              be bound to a key in either of the zed or zed-vicmd keymaps after `zed -b' has been
              run.   When  the  widget  is  called,  it prompts for a new name for the file being
              edited.  When zed exits the file will be written under that name and  the  original
              file will be left alone.  The widget has no effect with `zed -f'.

              While zed-set-file-name is running, zed uses the keymap zed-normal-keymap, which is
              linked from the main keymap in effect at the time  zed  initialised  its  bindings.
              (This  is to make the return key operate normally.)  The result is that if the main
              keymap has been changed, the widget won't notice.  This is not a concern  for  most
              users.

       zcp [ -finqQvwW ] srcpat dest
       zln [ -finqQsvwW ] srcpat dest
              Same  as zmv -C and zmv -L, respectively.  These functions do not appear in the zsh
              distribution, but can be created by linking zmv to the names zcp and  zln  in  some
              directory in your fpath.

       zkbd   See `Keyboard Definition' above.

       zmv [ -finqQsvwW ] [ -C | -L | -M | -[pP] program ] [ -o optstring ] srcpat dest
              Move  (usually,  rename)  files  matching the pattern srcpat to corresponding files
              having names of the form given by dest, where srcpat contains parentheses surround‐
              ing patterns which will be replaced in turn by $1, $2, ... in dest.  For example,

                     zmv '(*).lis' '$1.txt'

              renames  `foo.lis'  to  `foo.txt', `my.old.stuff.lis' to `my.old.stuff.txt', and so
              on.

              The pattern is always treated as an EXTENDED_GLOB pattern.  Any file whose name  is
              not  changed  by  the  substitution  is  simply ignored.  Any error (a substitution
              resulted in an empty string, two substitutions gave the same result,  the  destina‐
              tion  was an existing regular file and -f was not given) causes the entire function
              to abort without doing anything.

              Options:

              -f     Force overwriting of destination files.  Not currently passed  down  to  the
                     mv/cp/ln command due to vagaries of implementations (but you can use -o-f to
                     do that).
              -i     Interactive: show each line to be executed and ask the user whether to  exe‐
                     cute it.  `Y' or `y' will execute it, anything else will skip it.  Note that
                     you just need to type one character.
              -n     No execution: print what would happen, but don't do it.
              -q     Turn bare glob qualifiers off: now  assumed  by  default,  so  this  has  no
                     effect.
              -Q     Force  bare  glob qualifiers on.  Don't turn this on unless you are actually
                     using glob qualifiers in a pattern.
              -s     Symbolic, passed down to ln; only works with -L.
              -v     Verbose: print each command as it's being executed.
              -w     Pick out wildcard parts of the pattern, as described above,  and  implicitly
                     add parentheses for referring to them.
              -W     Just like -w, with the addition of turning wildcards in the replacement pat‐
                     tern into sequential ${1} .. ${N} references.
              -C
              -L
              -M     Force cp, ln or mv, respectively, regardless of the name of the function.
              -p program
                     Call program instead of cp, ln or mv.  Whatever it does, it should at  least
                     understand  the  form `program -- oldname newname' where oldname and newname
                     are filenames generated by zmv.  program will be split into words, so  might
                     be e.g. the name of an archive tool plus a copy or rename subcommand.
              -P program
                     As  -p  program, except that program does not accept a following -- to indi‐
                     cate the end of options.  In this case filenames must already be in  a  sane
                     form for the program in question.
              -o optstring
                     The  optstring is split into words and passed down verbatim to the cp, ln or
                     mv command called to perform the work.  It should probably begin with a `-'.

              Further examples:

                     zmv -v '(* *)' '${1// /_}'

              For any file in the current directory with at least one space in the name,  replace
              every space by an underscore and display the commands executed.

              For  more  complete  examples  and other implementation details, see the zmv source
              file, usually located in one of the directories named in your fpath,  or  in  Func‐
              tions/Misc/zmv in the zsh distribution.

       zrecompile
              See `Recompiling Functions' above.

       zstyle+ context style value [ + subcontext style value ... ]
              This  makes  defining styles a bit simpler by using a single `+' as a special token
              that allows you to append a context name to the previously used context name.  Like
              this:

                     zstyle+ ':foo:bar' style1 value1 \
                            +':baz'     style2 value2 \
                            +':frob'    style3 value3

              This  defines `style1' with `value1' for the context :foo:bar as usual, but it also
              defines `style2' with `value2' for  the  context  :foo:bar:baz  and  `style3'  with
              `value3'  for  :foo:bar:frob.  Any subcontext may be the empty string to re-use the
              first context unchanged.

   Styles
       insert-tab
              The zed function sets this style in context `:completion:zed:*' to turn off comple‐
              tion  when  TAB is typed at the beginning of a line.  You may override this by set‐
              ting your own value for this context and style.

       pager  The nslookup function looks up this style in the context `:nslookup'  to  determine
              the program used to display output that does not fit on a single screen.

       prompt
       rprompt
              The  nslookup  function  looks  up this style in the context `:nslookup' to set the
              prompt and the right-side prompt, respectively.  The usual expansions for  the  PS1
              and RPS1 parameters may be used (see EXPANSION OF PROMPT SEQUENCES in zshmisc(1)).



ZSHALL(1)                            General Commands Manual                            ZSHALL(1)



FILES
       $ZDOTDIR/.zshenv
       $ZDOTDIR/.zprofile
       $ZDOTDIR/.zshrc
       $ZDOTDIR/.zlogin
       $ZDOTDIR/.zlogout
       ${TMPPREFIX}*   (default is /tmp/zsh*)
       /etc/zsh/zshenv
       /etc/zsh/zprofile
       /etc/zsh/zshrc
       /etc/zsh/zlogin
       /etc/zsh/zlogout    (installation-specific - /etc is the default)

SEE ALSO
       sh(1), csh(1), tcsh(1), rc(1), bash(1), ksh(1)

       IEEE  Standard  for information Technology - Portable Operating System Interface (POSIX) -
       Part 2: Shell and Utilities, IEEE Inc, 1993, ISBN 1-55937-255-9.



zsh 5.0.7                                October 7, 2014                                ZSHALL(1)


/man
rootr.net - man pages